Updated source of the manual. (And ChangeLog got left out of the last
[exim.git] / doc / doc-src / spec.src
CommitLineData
d43194df 1. $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-src/spec.src,v 1.4 2005/01/26 14:52:08 ph10 Exp $
495ae4b0 2.
4964e932
PH
3.set version "4.50"
4.set previousversion "4.40"
d43194df 5.set versionmonth "February"
4964e932 6.set versionyear "2005"
495ae4b0
PH
7.set ACL "ACL"
8
9. The last of those is to make ACL index entries easier to type. It is put
10. up here so that it gets picked up by the HTML converter, which otherwise
11. skips to the first chapter. A longer version is set below for use in the
12. printed index.
13
14.set sgcal true
15.set html false
16.set texinfo false
17
18.if !set style
19.library "a4ps"
20.linelength ~~sys.linelength + 0.2in
21.set newlinelength ~~sys.linelength
22.emphasis ~~sys.linelength + 0.1in
23.pagedepth ~~sys.pagedepth - 0.2in
24.bindfont 51 "atl/Times-Bold" 9
25.bindfont 52 "atl/Times-Roman" 9
26.bindfont 53 "atl/Times-Roman" 7
27.bindfont 54 "atl/Courier" 9
28.bindfont 55 "atl/Courier-Bold" ~~maintypesize
29.bindfont 56 "atl/Times-Italic" 7
30.bindfont 57 "atl/Times-Bold" 7
31.bindfont 58 "atl/Symbol" 7
32.set ssspaceb 1.50
33
34.if ~~sgcal
35. Used for the "small print" incorporated code stuff. Only rm, it, bf, sp are
36. actually used at present.
37. rm it sl bf bi ss tt sp sc
38.fontgroup 9 = 53 56 0 57 0 0 0 58 0
39.fi
40.fi
41
42.if !~~sys.fancy
43.fontgroup 9 = 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
44.fi
45
46.include "markup.sg"
47
48.if ~~sys.fancy
49.flag $smc{ "$push$g0$f54"
50.flag $sm{ "$push$g0$f53"
51.flag $smi{ "$push$g0$f56"
52.flag $as{ "$push$g0$f52"
53.flag $ab{ "$push$g0$f51"
54.flag $cb{ "$push$g0$f55"
55.
56.else
57.flag $smc{ "$push"
58.flag $sm{ "$push"
59.flag $smi{ "$push"
60.flag $cb{ "$push"
61.fi
62
63.macro isunderscore "string"
64.set string "~~1"
65.set length length "~~1"
66.undrec 1
67.endm
68
69.macro undrec "offset"
70.if ~~1 > ~~length
71.set underscore false
72.else
73.set sub "~~string"(1,~~1)
74.if "~~sub" == "_"
75.set underscore true
76.else
77.set next ~~1 + 1
78.undrec ~~next
79.fi
80.fi
81.endm
82
83.macro testunderscore "string"
84.isunderscore "~~1"
85.newline
86.endm
87
88.macro tabs 6
89.if ~~sys.fancy
90.tabset ~~1em
91.else
92.set temp (~~1 * 5)/4
93.tabset ~~temp em
94.fi
95.endm
96
97.macro startoptions
98.newline
99.push
100.if ~~sys.fancy
101.indent 6em
102.else
103.indent 7em
104.fi
105.endm
106
107.macro endoptions
108.newline
109.pop
110.endm
111
112.macro option "option" ""
113.newpar
114.index \-~~1-\ option
115.tempindent 0
116\-~~1-\~~2#$i
117.nosep
118.endm
119
120.macro startitems
121.newline
122.push
123.indent 3em
124.endm
125
126.macro enditems
127.newline
128.pop
129.endm
130
131.macro item "item" "6"
132.newpar
133.if ~~sys.leftonpage < ~~2ld
134.newpage
135.fi
136.tempindent 0
137\**~~1**\
138.blank
139.endm
140
d43194df
PH
141.macro startconf ""
142.set confsection "~~1"
495ae4b0
PH
143.newline
144.push
145.if ~~sys.fancy
146.indent 2em
147.tabset 9em
148.else
149.indent 4em
150.tabset 13em
151.fi
152.endm
153
154.macro endconf
155.newline
156.pop
157.endm
158
159.macro conf "option" "type" "default" "6"
160.newpar
161.if ~~sys.leftonpage < ~~4ld
162.newpage
163.fi
164.testunderscore "~~1"
165.if ~~underscore
166.index \~~1\
167.else
168.index \~~1\ option
169.fi
d43194df
PH
170.if "~~confsection" == ""
171.set inssect ""
172.else
173.set inssect "$rm{Use:} $it{~~confsection}###"
174.fi
495ae4b0 175.tempindent 0
d43194df 176\**~~1**\ $c ~~inssect$rm{Type:} $it{~~2} $e $rm{Default:} $it{~~3}
495ae4b0
PH
177.blank
178.endm
179
180.set contents true
181.set figurenumber -1
182.set displayindent 2em
183
184.index @$1, @$2, etc. $it{see numerical variables}
185.index address||rewriting $it{see rewriting}
186.index CR character $it{see carriage return}
187.index CRL $it{see certificate revocation list}
188.index delivery||failure report $it{see bounce message}
189.index dialup $it{see intermittently connected hosts}
4964e932 190.index exiscan $it{see content scanning}
495ae4b0
PH
191.index failover $it{see fallback}
192.index fallover $it{see fallback}
193.index filter||Sieve $it{see Sieve filter}
194.index ident $it{see RFC 1413}
195.index LF character $it{see linefeed}
196.index maximum $it{see limit}
197.index NUL $it{see binary zero}
d43194df 198.index passwd file $it{see \(/etc/passwd)\}
495ae4b0
PH
199.index process id $it{see pid}
200.index RBL $it{see DNS list}
201.index redirection $it{see address redirection}
202.index return path||$it{see also envelope sender}
4964e932 203.index scanning $it{see content scanning}
495ae4b0
PH
204.index SSL $it{see TLS}
205.index string||expansion $it{see expansion}
206.index top bit $it{see 8-bit characters}
207.index variables $it{see expansion, variables}
208.index zero, binary $it{see binary zero}
209
210. This is used for the printed index. See setting above for
211. the HTML index value.
212
213.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
214
215. ======================================================
216
217.push
218.disable filling
219.justify centre
220.nofoot
221.space 8ld
222$chead{University of Cambridge Computing Service}
223.space 2ld
224$chead{Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent}
225.space 3ld
226by
227.space 1ld
228Philip Hazel
229.space ~~sys.leftonpage - 15*~~sys.linedepth
230.justify left
231University Computing Service
232New Museums Site
233Pembroke Street
234Cambridge CB2 3QH
235United Kingdom
236.blank
237.tabs 6
238$it{phone:} $t +44 1223 334600
239$it{fax:} $t +44 1223 334679
240$it{email:} $t ph10 $it{at} cus.cam.ac.uk
241.blank
242Edition for Exim ~~version, ~~versionmonth ~~versionyear
243.space 2ld
244.if ~~sgcal
245.fontgroup 1
246.fi
247$c$rm{Copyright (c) University of Cambridge ~~versionyear}
248
249
250.if ~~sgcal
251.fontgroup 0
252.font 0
253.fi
254
255.pop
256.newpage
257
258. Blank verso for title page
259.space 1ld
260.newpage
261
262
263. Set up for actual text pages
264.page 1
265. The first one to prevent a warning from sgfr
266. set runningfoot "~~chapter"
267.set runningfoot ""
268
269.if ~~sys.fancy
270.footdepth 2ld
271.foot
272.if "~~runningfoot" == ""
273.set rhs ""
274.else
275.set rhs "~~runningfoot (~~chapter)"
276.fi
277.set lhs "Exim ~~version"
278.linelength ~~newlinelength
279$it{~~lhs}$c[~~sys.pagenumber]$e$it{~~rhs}
280.endfoot
281.fi
282
283
284
285
286.
287.
288.
289.
290. ============================================================================
291.chapter Introduction
292.set runningfoot "introduction"
293
294.if ~~sys.fancy
295$c$bi{If I have seen further it is by standing on the shoulders of giants.}##(Isaac Newton)
296.elif !~~html
297$c"If I have seen further it is by standing on the shoulders of giants."
298.newline
299$e (Isaac Newton)
300.else
301\*If I have seen further it is by standing on the shoulders of giants.*\
302(Isaac Newton).
303.fi
304.blank 4
305
306Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
307Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
308run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
309used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
310
311Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
312BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd, GNU/Linux,
313HI-OSF (Hitachi), HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD, QNX, SCO, SCO
314SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4, Tru64-Unix (formerly
4964e932
PH
315Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware. Some of these operating
316systems are no longer current and cannot easily be tested, so the configuration
317files may no longer work in practice.
495ae4b0
PH
318
319There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
320that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
321not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
322
323The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
324the file \(NOTICE)\. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
325Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file \(LICENCE)\.
326
327The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
328unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
329which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
330of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
331mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
332
333Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
334experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
335contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
336were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
337new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
338
339Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
340development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
341systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
342\(ACKNOWLEDGMENTS)\, in which I have started recording the names of
343contributors.
344
d43194df 345
495ae4b0
PH
346.section Exim documentation
347.index documentation
d43194df 348.em
495ae4b0
PH
349This edition of the Exim specification applies to version ~~version of Exim.
350Substantive changes from the ~~previousversion edition are marked by bars in
351the right-hand margin in the PostScript, PDF, and plain text versions of the
352document, and by green text in the HTML version, as shown by this paragraph.
353Changes are not marked in the Texinfo version, because Texinfo doesn't support
354change bars. Minor corrections and rewordings are not marked.
d43194df 355.nem
495ae4b0
PH
356
357This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
358is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
359with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
360and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
361it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
362Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
363a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
364very wide interest.
365
366.index books about Exim
367An `easier' discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
368introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled
369.if ~~html
370[(A HREF="http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/")]
371$it{The Exim SMTP Mail Server},
372[(/A)]
4964e932 373published by UIT Cambridge.
495ae4b0
PH
374.else
375$it{The Exim SMTP Mail Server}, published by UIT Cambridge
376(\?http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/?\).
377.fi
378
379This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
380Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
381with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
382published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
383
384.index \(doc/NewStuff)\
385.index \(doc/ChangeLog)\
386.index change log
387As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
388yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
d43194df
PH
389digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
390new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
391\(doc/NewStuff)\ in the Exim distribution.
392
393.em
394Some features may be classified as `experimental'. These may change
395incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
396they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
397can be found in the file \(doc/experimental.txt)\.
398.nem
399
400All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
401change) are noted briefly in the file called \(doc/ChangeLog)\.
495ae4b0
PH
402
403.index \(doc/spec.txt)\
404This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in \(doc/spec.txt)\ so
405that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the \(doc)\
406directory are:
407.display rm
408.tabs 18
409\(OptionLists.txt)\ $t $rm{list of all options in alphabetical order}
410\(dbm.discuss.txt)\ $t $rm{discussion about DBM libraries}
411\(exim.8)\ $t $rm{a man page of Exim's command line options}
d43194df
PH
412.newline
413.em
414\(experimental.txt)\ $t $rm{documentation of experimental features}
415.nem
416.newline
495ae4b0
PH
417\(filter.txt)\ $t $rm{specification of the filter language}
418\(pcrepattern.txt)\ $t $rm{specification of PCRE regular expressions}
419\(pcretest.txt)\ $t $rm{specification of the PCRE testing program}
420\(Exim3.upgrade)\ $t $rm{upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3}
421\(Exim4.upgrade)\ $t $rm{upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4}
422.endd
423The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
424available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
425~~SECTavail below tells you how to get hold of these.
426
427
d43194df 428.section FTP and web sites
495ae4b0
PH
429.index web site
430.index FTP site
d43194df
PH
431.em
432The primary distribution site for Exim is currently the University of
433Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in \*Where to find the Exim
434distribution*\ below. In addition, there is a
435.if ~~html
436[(A HREF="http://www.exim.org/")]
437.fi
438web site
439.if ~~html
440[(/A)]
441.fi
442and an
443.if ~~html
444[(A HREF="ftp://ftp.exim.org/")]
445.fi
446FTP site
447.if ~~html
448[(/A)]
449.fi
450at \exim.org\. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge.
451The \exim.org\ site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
452Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453
454As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
455differently formatted versions of the documentation, including the
495ae4b0
PH
456.index FAQ
457.if ~~html
458[(A HREF="FAQ.html")]
459.fi
460FAQ
461.if ~~html
462[(/A)]
463.fi
d43194df
PH
464in both text and HTML formats. The HTML version comes with a keyword-in-context
465index. A recent addition to the online information is the
466.index wiki
467.if ~~html
468[(A HREF="http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/")]
469Exim wiki.
470[(/A)]
471.else
472Exim wiki (\?http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/?\).
473.fi
474We hope that this will make it easier for Exim users to contribute examples,
475tips, and know-how for the benefit of others.
476.nem
495ae4b0 477
d43194df 478.section Mailing lists
495ae4b0 479.index mailing lists||for Exim users
d43194df 480The following are the two main Exim mailing lists:
495ae4b0
PH
481.display rm
482.tabs 28
483$it{exim-users@@exim.org} $t general discussion list
484$it{exim-announce@@exim.org} $t moderated, low volume announcements list
485.endd
486You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
487or search the archives via the
488.if ~~html
489[(A HREF="http://www.exim.org/maillist.html")]
490.fi
491mailing lists
492.if ~~html
493[(/A)]
494.fi
495link on the Exim home page. The $it{exim-users} mailing list is also forwarded
496to \?http://www.egroups.com/list/exim-users?\, an archiving system with
497searching capabilities.
498
499.section Exim training
500.index training courses
501From time to time (approximately annually at the time of writing),
502lecture-based training courses are run by the author of Exim in Cambridge, UK.
503Details can be found on the web site
504.if ~~html
505[(A HREF="http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/")]
506.fi
507\?http://www-tus@.csx@.cam@.ac.uk/courses/exim/?\.
508.if ~~html
509[(/A)]
510.fi
511
512.section Bug reports
513.index bug reports
514.index reporting bugs
515Reports of obvious bugs should be emailed to \*bugs@@exim.org*\. However, if
516you are unsure whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is
517to post a message to the $it{exim-users} mailing list and have it discussed.
518
519
d43194df 520.em
495ae4b0
PH
521.section Where to find the Exim distribution
522.rset SECTavail "~~chapter.~~section"
523.index FTP site
524.index distribution||ftp site
525The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
526.display rm
527.if ! ~~sys.fancy
528.indent 0
529.fi
530\?ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim?\
531.endd
d43194df 532This is mirrored by
495ae4b0
PH
533.display rm
534.if ! ~~sys.fancy
535.indent 0
536.fi
d43194df 537\?ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim?\
495ae4b0 538.endd
d43194df
PH
539The file references that follow are relative to the \(exim)\ directories at
540these sites.
541
542There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around the world.
543Those that I know about are listed in the file called \(Mirrors)\.
544
545Within the \(exim)\ directory there are subdirectories called \(exim3)\ (for
546previous Exim 3 distributions), \(exim4)\ (for the latest Exim 4
547distributions), and \(Testing)\ for testing versions. In the \(exim4)\
548subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
495ae4b0
PH
549.display rm
550\(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
551\(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.bz2)\
552.endd
553where $it{n.nn} is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
554files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
555The \(.bz2)\ file is usually a lot smaller than the \(.gz)\ file.
556.index distribution||signing details
557.index distribution||public key
558.index public key for signed distribution
d43194df
PH
559The distributions are currently signed with Philip Hazel's GPG key. The
560corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
561also a copy in the file \(Public-Key)\. The signatures for the tar bundles are
562in:
495ae4b0
PH
563.display rm
564\(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz.sig)\
565\(exim-$it{n.nn}.tar.bz2.sig)\
566.endd
d43194df
PH
567For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
568separate file in the directory \(ChangeLogs)\ so that it is possible to
569find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
495ae4b0
PH
570
571.index documentation||available formats
572The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
573documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
574inside the \(exim4)\ directory of the FTP site:
575.display rm
576\(exim-html-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
577\(exim-pdf-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
578\(exim-postscript-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
579\(exim-texinfo-$it{n.nn}.tar.gz)\
580.endd
581These tar files contain only the \(doc)\ directory, not the complete
582distribution, and are also available in \(.bz2)\ as well as \(.gz)\ forms.
583
584.index FAQ
d43194df 585The FAQ is available for downloading in two different formats in these files:
495ae4b0 586.display rm
d43194df
PH
587\(exim4/FAQ.txt.gz)\
588\(exim4/FAQ.html.tar.gz)\
495ae4b0
PH
589.endd
590The first of these is a single ASCII file that can be searched with a text
591editor. The second is a directory of HTML files, normally accessed by starting
592at \(index.html)\. The HTML version of the FAQ (which is also included in the
593HTML documentation tarbundle) includes a keyword-in-context index, which is
594often the most convenient way of finding your way around.
595
596.section Wish list
597.index wish list
598A wish list is maintained, containing ideas for new features that have been
d43194df
PH
599submitted. From time to time the file is exported to the ftp site into the file
600\(exim4/WishList)\. Items are removed from the list if they get implemented.
495ae4b0
PH
601
602
603.section Contributed material
604.index contributed material
d43194df
PH
605At the ftp site, there is a directory called \(Contrib)\ that contains
606miscellaneous files contributed to the Exim community by Exim users. There is
607also a collection of contributed configuration examples in
608\(exim4/config.samples.tar.gz)\. These samples are referenced from the FAQ.
609.nem
495ae4b0
PH
610
611.section Limitations
612.index limitations of Exim
613.numberpars $.
614Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses
615in RFC 2822 domain format only.
616.index bang paths||not handled by Exim
617It cannot handle UUCP `bang paths', though simple two-component bang paths can
618be converted by a straightforward rewriting configuration. This restriction
619does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to UUCP as a transport mechanism,
620provided that domain addresses are used.
621.nextp
622.index domainless addresses
623.index address||without domain
624Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
625local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
626configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
627systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
628arrival.
629.nextp
630.index transport||external
631.index external transports
632The only external transport currently implemented is an SMTP transport over a
633TCP/IP network (using sockets, including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
634transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
635and pipes, optionally in \*batched SMTP*\ format; these facilities can be used
636to send messages to some other transport mechanism such as UUCP, provided it
637can handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
638.nextp
639Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
640such mail are large, it is better to get the messages `delivered' into files
641(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
642other means.
643.nextp
d43194df
PH
644.em
645Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
4964e932 646are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
d43194df
PH
647are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
648compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
649a number of common scanners are provided.
650.nem
495ae4b0
PH
651.endp
652
653
654
655.section Run time configuration
656Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
657into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
658values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
659file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
660distribution, and is described in chapter ~~CHAPdefconfil below.
661
662
663.section Calling interface
664.index Sendmail compatibility||command line interface
665Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
666can be a straight replacement for \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ or
667\(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
668about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
669Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
670example, \-bp-\, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
671format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6723, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter ~~CHAPcommandline
673documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
674made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
675
676Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
677line options. There is also an optional monitor program called \*eximon*\, which
678displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
679interface to Exim's command line administration options.
680
681
682.section Terminology
683.index terminology definitions
684.index body of message||definition of
685The \*body*\ of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
686It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the \*header*\ (see
687below) by a blank line.
688
689.index bounce message||definition of
690When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
d43194df
PH
691delivery failure message or a `non-delivery report' (NDR). The term \*bounce*\
692is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often called
693\*bounce messages*\. This is a convenient shorthand for `delivery failure error
694report'. Such messages have an empty sender address in the message's
695\*envelope*\ (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give rise to
696further bounce messages.
495ae4b0
PH
697
698The term \*default*\ appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
699value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
700also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
701otherwise.
702
703The term \*defer*\ is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
704destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
705down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are \*deferred*\
706until a later time.
707
708The word \*domain*\ is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
709host's name. It is $it{not} used in that sense here, where it normally
710refers to the part of an email address following the @@ sign.
711
712.index envelope, definition of
713.index sender||definition of
714A message in transit has an associated \*envelope*\, as well as a header and a
715body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
716be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
717sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
718envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
719messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
720
721.index message||header, definition of
722.index header section||definition of
723The \*header*\ of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
724of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as ::From::, ::To::,
725::Subject::, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
726indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
727line.
728
729.index local part||definition of
730.index domain||definition of
731The term \*local part*\, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
732part of an email address that precedes the @@ sign. The part that follows the
733@@ sign is called the \*domain*\ or \*mail domain*\.
734
735.index local delivery||definition of
736.index remote delivery, definition of
737The terms \*local delivery*\ and \*remote delivery*\ are used to distinguish
738delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
739TCP/IP to a remote host.
740
741.index return path||definition of
742\*Return path*\ is another name that is used for the sender address in a
743message's envelope.
744
745.index queue||definition of
746The term \*queue*\ is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
747because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
748Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
749normally no ordering of waiting messages.
750
751.index queue runner||definition of
752The term \*queue runner*\ is used to describe a process that scans the queue
753and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
754is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command \runq\, but in Exim
755the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
756
757.index spool directory||definition of
758The term \*spool directory*\ is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
759messages on its queue -- that is, those that it is in the process of
760delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
761mailboxes are stored, which is called a `spool directory' by some people. In
762the Exim documentation, `spool' is always used in the first sense.
763
764
765
766.
767.
768.
769.
770. ============================================================================
771.chapter Incorporated code
772.set runningfoot "incorporated code"
773.index incorporated code
774.index regular expressions||library
775.index PCRE
776A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
777.numberpars $.
778Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the Exim
d43194df
PH
779monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright (c) University
780of Cambridge. The source is distributed in the directory \(src/pcre)\. However,
781this is a cut-down version of PCRE. If you want to use the PCRE library in
782other programs, you should obtain and install the full version from
783\?ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre?\.
495ae4b0
PH
784
785.space 1ld
786.nextp
787.index cdb||acknowledgement
788Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
d43194df
PH
789contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
790Online Ltd. which contains the following statements:
495ae4b0
PH
791.rule
792.push
793.if ~~sgcal
794.fontgroup 9
795.font 0
796.fi
797Copyright (c) 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
798
799This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
800the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
801Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
802version.
803
804This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
805the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
806\?http://www.pobox.com/@~djb/cdb.html?\. This implementation borrows some code
807from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license restrictions applied
808to it).
809.newline
810.pop
811.rule
812The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
813It does not link against an external cdb library.
814.space 1ld
815.nextp
816.index SPA authentication
817.index Samba project
818.index Microsoft Secure Password Authentication
819Client support for Microsoft's \*Secure Password Authentication*\ is provided
4964e932 820by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
495ae4b0
PH
821Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
822under the Gnu GPL.
823
824.space 1ld
825.nextp
826.index Cyrus
827.index \*pwcheck*\ daemon
828.index \*pwauthd*\ daemon
829Support for calling the Cyrus \*pwcheck*\ and \*saslauthd*\ daemons is provided
830by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
831Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
832conditions expressed therein.
833
834.rule
835.push
836.if ~~sgcal
837.fontgroup 9
838.font 0
839.fi
840Copyright (c) 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
841
842Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
843modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
844are met:
845
846.if ~~sgcal
847.cancelflag $npbracket
848.flag $npbracket "" "."
849.fi
850.numberpars
851Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
852notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
853.nextp
854Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
855notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
856the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
857distribution.
858.nextp
859The name `Carnegie Mellon University' must not be used to
860endorse or promote products derived from this software without
861prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
862details, please contact
863.display rm
864Office of Technology Transfer
865Carnegie Mellon University
8665000 Forbes Avenue
867Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
868(412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
869tech-transfer@@andrew.cmu.edu
870.endd
871.nextp
872Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
873acknowledgment:
874.newline
875.push
876.indent ~~sys.indent + 3em
877.justify left
878$it{This product includes software developed by Computing Services
879at Carnegie Mellon University (\?http://www.cmu.edu/computing/?\).}
880.newline
881.pop
4964e932 882.endp
495ae4b0
PH
883.if ~~sgcal
884.cancelflag $npbracket
885.flag $npbracket "(" ")"
886.fi
887
888CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
889THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
890AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
891FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
892WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
893AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
894OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
895.newline
896.pop
897.rule
898
899.space 1ld
900.nextp
901.index monitor
902.index X-windows
903.index Athena
904The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
905modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
906This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
907below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
908
909.rule
910.push
911.if ~~sgcal
912.fontgroup 9
913.font 0
914.fi
915Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
916and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
917.blank
918$c All Rights Reserved
919.blank
920Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
921documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
922provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
923both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
924supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
925used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
926software without specific, written prior permission.
927
928DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
929ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
930DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
931ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
932WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
933ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
934SOFTWARE.
935.newline
936.pop
937.rule
d43194df
PH
938.space 1ld
939.nextp
940.em
941Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
942not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
943contributors are happy to see their code incoporated into Exim under the GPL.
944.nem
495ae4b0
PH
945.endp
946
947
948
949.
950.
951.
952.
953. ============================================================================
954.chapter How Exim receives and delivers mail
955.set runningfoot "receiving & delivering mail"
956
957.section Overall philosophy
958.index design philosophy
959Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
960to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
961most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
962maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
963it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
964has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
965
966
967.section Policy control
968.index policy control||overview
969Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
970Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
971`open relays' by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of unsolicited
972junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible facilities for
973specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
974.numberpars $.
975.index ~~ACL||introduction
976Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
d43194df 977incoming mail by means of \*Access Control Lists*\ (ACLs). Each list is a
495ae4b0 978series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
d43194df
PH
979several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
980host. However, the most common places are after each \\RCPT\\ command, and at
981the very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting
982or rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at
983these two points (see chapter ~~CHAPACL). Denial of access results in an SMTP
984error code.
495ae4b0 985.nextp
4964e932 986An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
495ae4b0
PH
987case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
988.nextp
d43194df
PH
989.em
990When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
991provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
992spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
993which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
994.nem
995.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
996When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
997host, but before the final acknowledgement has been sent, a locally supplied C
998function called \*local@_scan()*\ can be run to inspect the message and decide
999whether to accept it or not (see chapter ~~CHAPlocalscan). If the message is
1000accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
1001.nextp
d43194df
PH
1002.em
1003Using the \*local@_scan()*\ mechanism is another way of calling external
1004scanner software. The \SA-Exim\ add-on package works this way. It does not
1005require Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
1006.nem
1007.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
1008After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
1009the form of the $it{system filter} (see chapter ~~CHAPsystemfilter). This runs
1010at the start of every delivery process.
1011.endp
1012
1013.section User filters
1014.index filter||introduction
1015.index Sieve filter
4964e932
PH
1016In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
1017setting up appropriate \(.forward)\ files in their home directories. See
1018chapter ~~CHAPredirect (about the \%redirect%\ router) for the configuration
1019needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
495ae4b0
PH
1020.if ~~html
1021[(A HREF="filter_toc.html")]
1022.fi
1023\*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\
1024.if ~~html
1025[(/A)]
1026.fi
1027for user details. Two different kinds of filtering are available:
1028.numberpars $.
4964e932 1029Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined by
495ae4b0
PH
1030RFC 3028.
1031.nextp
4964e932 1032Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
495ae4b0
PH
1033powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
1034.endp
1035User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
1036
1037
1038.section Message identification
1039.rset SECTmessiden "~~chapter.~~section"
1040.index message||ids, details of format
1041.index format||of message id
1042.index id of message
1043.index base62
1044.index base36
1045.index Darwin
1046.index Cygwin
1047Every message handled by Exim is given a \*message id*\ which is sixteen
1048characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
1049example \"16VDhn-0001bo-D3"\. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
1050normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
4964e932
PH
1051system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
1052(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
495ae4b0
PH
1053id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
1054not case-sensitive.
1055
1056.index pid (process id)||re-use of
1057The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
1058Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
1059within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
4964e932
PH
1060be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
1061the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
495ae4b0
PH
1062somewhat eccentric:
1063.numberpars $.
1064The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1065started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1066contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1067way of representing the date and time of day).
1068.nextp
1069After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1070received the message.
1071.nextp
1072There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1073.numberpars alpha
1074.index \localhost@_number\
1075If \localhost@_number\ is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1076time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1077that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1078systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1079.nextp
1080If \localhost@_number\ is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1081the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1082(1/100) of a second.
1083.endp
1084.endp
1085After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1086appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1087received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1088pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1089will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1090
1091.section Receiving mail
1092.index receiving mail
1093.index message||reception
1094The only way Exim can receive mail from a remote host is using SMTP over
1095TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are tranferred using
1096SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1097there are several possibilities:
1098.numberpars $.
1099If the process runs Exim with the \-bm-\ option, the message is read
1100non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1101command line, or from the body of the message if \-t-\ is also used.
1102.nextp
1103If the process runs Exim with the \-bS-\ option, the message is also read
1104non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1105the message in a series of SMTP \\RCPT\\ commands, terminated by a \\DATA\\
1106command. This is so-called `batch SMTP' format,
1107but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1108envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1109.nextp
1110If the process runs Exim with the \-bs-\ option, the message is read
1111interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1112passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1113This is `real' SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1114example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1115.nextp
1116A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1117(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1118does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1119in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1120.endp
1121
1122.index message||sender, constructed by Exim
1123.index sender||constructed by Exim
1124In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1125constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1126qualification domain (which can be set by the \qualify@_domain\ configuration
1127option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1128SMTP \\MAIL\\ command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1129certain users (`trusted users') to specify a different sender address
1130unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1131address. The \-f-\ option or the SMTP \\MAIL\\ command is used to specify these
1132different addresses. See section ~~SECTtrustedadmin for details of trusted
1133users, and the \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option for a way of allowing untrusted
1134users to change sender addresses.
1135
4964e932
PH
1136Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1137checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1138(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1139number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1140individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
495ae4b0
PH
1141requirements are not met. The \*local@_scan()*\ function (see chapter
1142~~CHAPlocalscan) is run for all incoming messages.
1143
1144Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1145received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1146connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1147queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1148configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1149message is received.
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154.section Handling an incoming message
1155.index spool directory||files that hold a message
1156.index file||how a message is held
1157When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1158first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message,
1159and the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The
1160names of the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by $tt{-H} for
1161the file containing the envelope and header, and $tt{-D} for the data file.
1162
1163.index spool directory||\(input)\ sub-directory
1164By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1165\(input)\ inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1166not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets very large; to
1167improve performance in such cases, the \split@_spool@_directory\ option can be
1168used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1169whose names are single letters or digits.
1170
1171The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1172the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1173any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1174a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1175first spool file is described in chapter ~~CHAPspool.
1176
1177.index rewriting||addresses
1178Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1179(see chapter ~~CHAPrewrite) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1180both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1181If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1182example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1183generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1184rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1185different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1186addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1187delivered (see chapters ~~CHAProutergeneric and ~~CHAPtransportgeneric).
1188
1189
1190.section Life of a message
1191.index message||life of
1192.index message||frozen
1193A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1194its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1195administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1196cannot proceed -- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1197recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked `frozen' on the
1198spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1199
1200.index frozen messages||thawing
1201.index message||thawing frozen
1202An administrator can `thaw' such messages when the problem has been corrected,
1203and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In addition, an
1204administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message to be sent.
1205
1206.index \auto@_thaw\
1207There is an option called \auto@_thaw\, which can be used to cause Exim to
1208retry frozen messages after a certain time. When this is set, no message will
1209remain on the queue for ever, because the delivery timeout will eventually be
1210reached. Delivery failure reports (bounce messages) that reach this timeout are
1211discarded.
1212.index \timeout@_frozen@_after\
1213There is also an option called \timeout@_frozen@_after\, which discards frozen
1214messages after a certain time.
1215
1216.index message||log file for
1217.index log||file for each message
1218While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1219attempt to the main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1220delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter ~~CHAPlog). The log lines
1221are also written to a separate $it{message log} file for each message. These
1222logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally deleted
1223along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
4964e932 1224The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
495ae4b0
PH
1225\no@_message@_logs\; this might give an improvement in performance on very
1226busy systems.
1227
1228.index journal file
1229.index file||journal
1230All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1231spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1232address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1233message id followed by $tt{-J}. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1234addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the $tt{-H} file)
1235is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1236Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1237minimize the possibility of data loss.
1238
1239Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1240the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1241time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1242updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1243deliveries caused by crashes.
1244
1245
1246.section Processing an address for delivery
1247.rset SECTprocaddress "~~chapter.~~section"
1248.index drivers||definition of
1249.index router||definition of
1250.index transport||definition of
1251The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called $it{routers} and
1252$it{transports}, and collectively these are known as $it{drivers}. Code for a
1253number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1254specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1255ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1256
1257.index drivers||instance definition
4964e932
PH
1258Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an \*instance*\
1259of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1260you can set up several different \%smtp%\ transports, each with different
495ae4b0
PH
1261option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1262instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
4964e932 1263instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
495ae4b0
PH
1264configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1265the driver's features in general.
1266
1267A $it{router} is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1268its delivery should happen, by routing it to a specific transport, or
1269converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1270alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1271to be bounced.
1272
1273A $it{transport} is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1274spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a $it{local}
1275transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1276$it{remote} transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1277to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1278several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1279
1280.index preconditions||definition of
1281An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1282turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1283specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1284detail shortly. As a simple example, the diagram below illustrates how each
1285recipient address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three
1286routers that are configured in various ways.
1287
1288.if ~~sys.fancy
1289.figure "Routing an address" rm
1290.indent 0
4964e932 1291.call aspic -sgcal -nv
495ae4b0
PH
1292centre ~~sys.linelength;
1293magnify 0.8;
1294boundingbox 30;
1295 ibox depth 14 "address";
1296B: arrow down 44;
1297 textdepth 14;
1298A: box width 100 "first router" "conditions ok?";
1299 arrow right "yes";
1300C: box width 100 "run" "first router";
1301 arrow down "fail";
1302D: ibox depth 20 "address bounces";
1303
1304 arc clockwise from right of C "accept";
1305 arrow down 10;
1306 ibox "queue for" "transport";
1307
1308 arrow down from A align bottom of D plus (0,-20) "no"(-6,20)/r;
1309E: box width 100 "second router" "conditions ok?";
1310 arrow right "yes";
1311F: box width 100 "run" "second router";
1312 line right 100 "redirect";
1313 line up align middle of B;
1314 arrow left to middle of B "new addresses";
1315
1316 line down 20 from bottom left of F plus (30,0);
1317 arrow left align centre of E "decline";
1318
1319 line down 20 from bottom right of F plus (-30,0);
1320 arrow right "fail";
1321 ibox width 64 "address" "bounces";
1322
1323 arrow down 64 from E "no"(-6,20)/r;
1324G: box width 100 "third router" "conditions ok?";
1325 arrow right "yes";
1326H: box width 100 "run" "third router";
1327 arc clockwise from right of H "accept";
1328 arrow down 10;
1329 ibox "queue for" "transport";
1330
1331 line down 20 from bottom of H;
1332 arrow left align centre of G "decline";
1333 arrow down 64 from G "no"(-6,20)/r;
1334
1335 ibox "no more routers" "address bounces";
1336.endcall
1337.endfigure
1338.elif !~~html
1339.display asis
1340
1341 address
1342 |
1343 |<------------- new addresses -----------------------------
1344 V |
1345 ----------------- ----------------- |
1346 | first router |----- yes ----->| run |--- accept |
1347 | conditions ok?| | first router | | |
1348 ----------------- ----------------- | |
1349 | | V |
1350 no | fail | queue for |
1351 | V transport |
1352 | address bounces |
1353 | |
1354 V |
1355 ----------------- ----------------- |
1356 | second router |----- yes ----->| run |----redirect ----
1357 | conditions ok?| | second router |
1358 ----------------- -----------------
1359 | | |
1360 no | | |
1361 |<-------- decline ----------- --- fail ---> address
1362 | bounces
1363 V
1364 ----------------- -----------------
1365 | third router |----- yes ----->| run |--- accept
1366 | conditions ok?| | third router | |
1367 ----------------- ----------------- |
1368 | | V
1369 no | | queue for
1370 |<-------- decline --------------- transport
1371 |
1372 V
1373 no more routers
1374 address bounces
1375.endd
1376.else
1377[(img src="routing.gif" alt="Routing an address")][(br)]
1378.fi
1379To make this a more concrete example, we'll describe it in terms of some actual
1380routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1381routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1382configuration.
1383
1384The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1385addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1386are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1387is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1388its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do $it{not}
1389match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1390find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1391queued for a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1392configured to fail the address.
1393
1394The example pictured could be a configuration of this type. The second and
1395third routers can only be run for addresses for which the preconditions for
1396the first router are not met. If one of these preconditions checks the
1397domain, the second and third routers are run only for domains that are somehow
1398special to the local host.
1399
1400The second router does redirection -- also known as aliasing and forwarding.
1401When it generates one or more new addresses from the original, each of them is
1402routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the router may cause an address
4964e932 1403to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the address, in which case the
495ae4b0
PH
1404address is passed to the next router.
1405
1406The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1407address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1408see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1409local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1410the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1411the address is bounced.
1412
1413
1414.section Processing an address for verification
1415.index router||for verification
1416.index verifying||address, overview
4964e932
PH
1417As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1418are also used for \*address verification*\. Verification can be requested as
1419one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1420sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the \-bv-\ and
495ae4b0
PH
1421\-bvs-\ command line options.
1422
4964e932
PH
1423When an address is being verified, the routers are run in `verify mode'. This
1424does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
495ae4b0
PH
1425detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1426when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1427sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1428previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
4964e932 1429checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the \no@_verify\ option
495ae4b0
PH
1430would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1431
1432
1433
1434.section Running an individual router
1435.rset SECTrunindrou "~~chapter.~~section"
1436.index router||running details
1437.index preconditions||checking
1438.index router||result of running
1439As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1440running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1441passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router $it{are} met,
1442the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1443the following:
1444.numberpars $.
1445\*accept*\: The router accepts the address, and either queues it for a
1446transport, or generates one or more `child' addresses. Processing the original
4964e932 1447address ceases,
495ae4b0
PH
1448.index \unseen\ option
1449unless the \unseen\ option is set on the router. This option
1450can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1451for keeping archive copies of messages). When \unseen\ is set, the address is
1452passed to the next router. Normally, however, an \*accept*\ return marks the
1453end of routing.
1454
1455.index case of local parts
1456.index address||duplicate, discarding
1457If child addresses are generated, Exim checks to see whether they are
1458duplicates of any existing recipient addresses. During this check, local parts
1459are treated as case-sensitive. Duplicate addresses are discarded. Each of the
1460remaining child addresses is then processed independently, starting with the
1461first router by default. It is possible to change this by setting the
1462\redirect@_router\ option to specify which router to start at for child
1463addresses. Unlike \pass@_router\ (see below) the router specified by
1464\redirect@_router\ may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1465.nextp
1466\*pass*\: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1467requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1468is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1469\pass@_router\ option. However, (unlike \redirect@_router\) the named router
1470must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1471.nextp
1472\*decline*\: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1473recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1474this can be prevented by setting the \no@_more\ option. When \no@_more\ is set,
1475all the remaining routers are skipped.
1476.nextp
1477\*fail*\: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1478the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1479original address unless \unseen\ is set on the router.
1480.nextp
1481\*defer*\: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A database
1482may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further processing of
1483the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again next time the
1484message is considered for delivery.
1485.nextp
1486\*error*\: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1487its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1488.endp
1489If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1490any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable.
4964e932
PH
1491The default error message in this situation is `unrouteable address', but you
1492can set your own message by making use of the \cannot@_route@_message\ option.
1493This can be set for any router; the value from the last router that `saw'
495ae4b0
PH
1494the address is used.
1495
1496Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1497met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1498You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
4964e932 1499when the relevant conditions are met. The \%redirect%\ router has a `fail'
495ae4b0
PH
1500facility for this purpose.
1501
1502
1503
1504.section Router preconditions
1505.rset SECTrouprecon "~~chapter.~~section"
1506.index router||preconditions, order of processing
1507.index preconditions||order of processing
1508The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1509order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1510described in more detail in chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric.
1511.numberpars $.
1512The \local@_part@_prefix\ and \local@_part@_suffix\ options can specify that
1513the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1514suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1515skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1516removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1517of any other conditions.
1518.nextp
4964e932
PH
1519Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1520only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1521\verify\ option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
495ae4b0 1522address.
4964e932
PH
1523Setting the \verify\ option actually sets two options, \verify@_sender\ and
1524\verify@_recipient\, which independently control the use of the router for
1525sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
495ae4b0
PH
1526you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1527.nextp
4964e932
PH
1528If the \address@_test\ option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1529run with the \-bt-\ option to test an address routing. This can be helpful when
1530the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it makes it
495ae4b0
PH
1531possible to use \-bt-\ to test subsequent delivery routing without having to
1532simulate the effect of the scanner.
1533.nextp
1534Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1535opposed to routing it for delivery. The \verify@_only\ option controls this.
1536.nextp
1537Certain routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to check an
1538address given in the SMTP \\EXPN\\ command (see the \expn\ option).
1539.nextp
1540If the \domains\ option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set of
1541domains that it defines.
1542.nextp
1543If the \local@_parts\ option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1544the set of local parts that it defines. If \local@_part@_prefix\ or
1545\local@_part@_suffix\ is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1546part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1547that include affixes, you can do so by using a \condition\ option (see below)
1548that uses the variables \$local@_part$\, \$local@_part@_prefix$\, and
1549\$local@_part@_suffix$\ as necessary.
1550.nextp
1551If the \check@_local@_user\ option is set, the local part must be the name of
1552an account on the local host.
4964e932 1553If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the local user are placed in
495ae4b0
PH
1554\$local@_user@_uid$\ and \$local@_user@_gid$\; these values can be used in the
1555remaining preconditions.
1556.nextp
1557If the \router@_home@_directory\ option is set, it is expanded at this point,
4964e932
PH
1558because it overrides the value of \$home$\. If this expansion were left till
1559later, the value of \$home$\ as set by \check@_local@_user\ would be used in
1560subsequent tests. Having two different values of \$home$\ in the same router
495ae4b0
PH
1561could lead to confusion.
1562.nextp
1563If the \senders\ option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the set
1564of addresses that it defines.
1565.nextp
1566If the \require@_files\ option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1567specified files is tested.
1568.nextp
1569.index customizing||precondition
1570If the \condition\ option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option uses
1571an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1572Expanded strings are described in chapter ~~CHAPexpand.
1573.endp
1574
1575Note that \require@_files\ comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use it
1576to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1577part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1578\exists\ expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1579\require@_files\ option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1580going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1581example, \(.procmailrc)\).
1582
1583
1584.section Delivery in detail
1585.index delivery||in detail
1586When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1587.numberpars $.
1588If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1589filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1590message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1591fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1592files, described in the separate document entitled
1593.if ~~html
1594[(A HREF="filter.html")]
1595.fi
1596\*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\.
1597.if ~~html
1598[(/A)]
1599.fi
1600.index Sieve filter||not available for system filter
1601(\**Note**\: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1602Some additional features are available in system filters -- see chapter
1603~~CHAPsystemfilter for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1604filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1605if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1606be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1607condition \first@_delivery\ can be used to detect the first run of the system
1608filter.
1609.nextp
1610Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1611its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle
1612the address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because
1613routers can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains
1614can be processed entirely independently of each other.
1615.nextp
1616.index routing||loops in
1617.index loop||while routing
1618A router that accepts an address may set up a local or a remote transport for
1619it. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address is
1620placed on a list for the particular transport, to be run later. Alternatively,
1621the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically from alias,
1622forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this process from
1623the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address which has an
1624identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1625.nextp
1626When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1627handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1628doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1629local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1630collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1631addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1632address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1633addresses to the same domain.
1634.nextp
1635Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1636non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1637deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1638to Exim (`the Exim user'), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1639run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1640one message is set by the \remote@_max@_parallel\ option.
4964e932 1641The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
495ae4b0 1642deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
495ae4b0
PH
1643.nextp
1644.index queue runner
1645When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1646database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1647address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1648Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1649reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1650queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1651follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1652better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1653causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1654.nextp
1655.index delivery||retry in remote transports
1656Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1657deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1658retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1659reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1660not. See chapter ~~CHAPretry for details of retry strategies.
1661.nextp
1662If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1663appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1664for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1665messages to other addresses.
1666.nextp
1667.index delivery||deferral
1668If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1669the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1670\*deferred*\.
1671.nextp
1672When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1673handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1674deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1675.endp
1676
1677
1678.section Retry mechanism
1679.index delivery||retry mechanism
1680.index retry||description of mechanism
1681.index queue runner
1682Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1683attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1684uses the \-q-\ option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1685intervals, or use some other means (such as \*cron*\) to start them. If you do
1686not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1687first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1688it way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1689passed its retry time.
1690You can run several queue runners at once.
1691
1692Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1693address (see chapter ~~CHAPretry). These rules also specify when Exim should
1694give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a bounce
1695message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and error
1696combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated as
1697permanent.
1698
1699
1700.section Temporary delivery failure
1701.index delivery||temporary failure
1702There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1703particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1704connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1705detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1706Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1707is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1708impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1709also apply.
1710
1711If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1712waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1713connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
4964e932 1714deferred,
495ae4b0
PH
1715.index hints database
1716Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1717SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1718for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1719connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1720one connection.
1721
1722
1723
1724.section Permanent delivery failure
1725.index delivery||permanent failure
1726.index bounce message||when generated
1727When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1728bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1729errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1730delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1731many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1732attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1733message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1734See chapter ~~CHAPemsgcust for details.
1735
1736.index ::X-Failed-Recipients:: header line
1737Bounce messages contain an ::X-Failed-Recipients:: header line that lists the
1738failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1739automatically.
1740
1741.index bounce message||recipient of
1742A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1743obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1744address given in the \\MAIL\\ command. However, when an address is
1745expanded via a forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified
1746for delivery failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion
1747(see section ~~SECTmailinglists) it is common to direct bounce messages to the
1748manager of the list.
1749
1750
1751
1752.section Failures to deliver bounce messages
1753.index bounce message||failure to deliver
1754If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1755itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1756but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1757which can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1758for only a short time (see \timeout@_frozen@_after\ and
1759\ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\).
1760
1761
1762
1763.
1764.
1765.
1766.
1767. ============================================================================
1768.chapter Building and installing Exim
1769.set runningfoot "building/installing"
1770
1771.index building Exim
1772.section Unpacking
1773Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when upacked,
1774creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1775\(exim-~~version)\) into which the following files are placed:
1776.display rm
1777.if !~~sys.fancy && ~~sgcal
1778.tabs 16
1779.else
4964e932 1780.tabs 22
495ae4b0
PH
1781.fi
1782\(ACKNOWLEDGMENTS)\ $t contains some acknowledgments
1783.newline
1784\(CHANGES)\ $t contains a reference to where changes are documented
1785\(LICENCE)\ $t the GNU General Public Licence
1786\(Makefile)\ $t top-level make file
1787\(NOTICE)\ $t conditions for the use of Exim
1788\(README)\ $t list of files, directories and simple build instructions
1789.endd
1790Other files whose names begin with \(README)\ may also be present. The
1791following subdirectories are created:
1792.display rm
1793.if !~~sys.fancy && ~~sgcal
1794.tabs 16
1795.else
1796.tabs 22
1797.fi
1798\(Local)\ $t an empty directory for local configuration files
1799\(OS)\ $t OS-specific files
1800\(doc)\ $t documentation files
1801\(exim@_monitor)\$t source files for the Exim monitor
1802\(scripts)\ $t scripts used in the build process
1803\(src)\ $t remaining source files
1804\(util)\ $t independent utilities
1805.endd
1806The main utility programs are contained in the \(src)\ directory, and are built
1807with the Exim binary. The \(util)\ directory contains a few optional scripts
1808that may be useful to some sites.
1809
1810.section Multiple machine architectures and operating systems
1811.index building Exim||multiple OS/architectures
1812The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1813a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1814source files. Compilation does not take place in the \(src)\ directory. Instead,
1815a \*build directory*\ is created for each architecture and operating system.
1816.index symbolic link||to build directory
1817Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1818the actual building takes place.
1819
1820In most cases, Exim can discover the machine architecture and operating system
1821for itself, but the defaults can be overridden if necessary.
1822
1823.section DBM libraries
1824.rset SECTdb "~~chapter.~~section"
1825.index DBM||libraries, discussion of
1826.index hints database||DBM files used for
1827Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1828DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1829databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1830different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1831
1832.index Solaris||DBM library for
1833.index IRIX, DBM library for
1834.index BSD, DBM library for
1835.index Linux, DBM library for
1836If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1837Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1838may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1839you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1840
1841.index \*ndbm*\ DBM library
1842Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1843via the \*ndbm*\ interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1844versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1845some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1846distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1847versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardised on the
1848Berkeley DB library.
1849
1850Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1851use. When a program opens a file called \(dbmfile)\, there are four
1852possibilities:
1853.numberpars
1854A traditional \*ndbm*\ implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1855Solaris, operates on two files called \(dbmfile.dir)\ and \(dbmfile.pag)\.
1856.nextp
1857.index \*gdbm*\ DBM library
1858The GNU library, \*gdbm*\, operates on a single file. If used via its \*ndbm*\
1859compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1860\(dbmfile.dir)\ and \(dbmfile.pag)\, but if used via its native interface, the
1861file name is used unmodified.
1862.nextp
1863.index Berkeley DB library
1864The Berkeley DB package, if called via its \*ndbm*\ compatibility interface,
1865operates on a single file called \(dbmfile.db)\, but otherwise looks to the
1866programmer exactly the same as the traditional \*ndbm*\ implementation.
1867.nextp
1868If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1869file called \(dbmfile)\; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1870the traditional \*ndbm*\ interface.
1871.nextp
1872To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1873Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
18742.$it{x} and 3.$it{x} were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1875numbered 4.$it{x}. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1876versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1877.display rm
1878\?http://www.sleepycat.com/?\
1879.endd
1880.nextp
1881.index \*tdb*\ DBM library
1882Yet another DBM library, called \*tdb*\, has become available from
1883.display rm
1884\?http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb?\
1885.endd
1886It has its own interface, and also operates on a single file.
1887.endp
1888.index \\USE@_DB\\
1889.index DBM||libraries, configuration for building
1890Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1891to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1892\\USE@_DB\\ in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1893\(Local/Makefile)\). For example:
1894.display asis
1895USE_DB=yes
1896.endd
1897Similarly, for gdbm you set \\USE@_GDBM\\, and for tdb you set \\USE@_TDB\\. An
1898error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1899
1900At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1901thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1902configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1903Linux) assume type (4) by setting \\USE@_DB\\ as their default, and the
1904configuration files for Cygwin set \\USE@_GDBM\\. Anything you set in
1905\(Local/Makefile)\, however, overrides these system defaults.
1906
1907As well as setting \\USE@_DB\\, \\USE@_GDBM\\, or \\USE@_TDB\\, it may also be
1908necessary to set \\DBMLIB\\, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1909in one of these lines:
1910.display asis
1911DBMLIB = -ldb
1912DBMLIB = -ltdb
1913.endd
4964e932 1914Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
495ae4b0
PH
1915place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1916the default path. You may need to set \\INCLUDE\\ to specify where the header
4964e932 1917file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in \\DBMLIB\\, as in
495ae4b0
PH
1918this example:
1919.display asis
1920INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1921DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1922.endd
1923
1924There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1925file \(doc/dbm.discuss.txt)\ in the Exim distribution.
1926
1927
1928.section Pre-building configuration
1929.index building Exim||pre-building configuration
1930.index configuration for building Exim
1931.index \(Local/Makefile)\
1932.index \(src/EDITME)\
1933Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1934independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1935\(Local/Makefile)\. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1936\(src/EDITME)\, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1937therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1938building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1939\(src/EDITME)\ to \(Local/Makefile)\, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1940
1941There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1942without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1943(\\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1944(\\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\), and the identity of the Exim user (\\EXIM@_USER\\ and
1945maybe \\EXIM@_GROUP\\ as well). The value of \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ can in fact be
1946a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1947
1948There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1949at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1950machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1951directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1952you specify them in \(Local/Makefile)\ instead of at run time, so that errors
1953detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1954be logged.
1955
d43194df
PH
1956.index content scanning||specifying at build time
1957.em
1958Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning sofware directly from
1959access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1960facilities, you need to set
1961.display asis
1962WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1963.endd
1964in your \(Local/Makefile)\. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1965chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
1966.nem
1967
495ae4b0
PH
1968.index \(Local/eximon.conf)\
1969.index \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\
1970If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1971required. The file \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\ must be edited appropriately for
1972your installation and saved under the name \(Local/eximon.conf)\. If you are
1973happy with the default settings described in \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\,
1974\(Local/eximon.conf)\ can be empty, but it must exist.
1975
1976This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1977operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1978to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1979configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1980defaults to \gcc\. See section ~~SECToverride below for details of how to do
1981this.
1982
1983
1984.section Support for iconv()
1985.index \*iconv()*\ support
4964e932
PH
1986The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1987described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1988in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1989character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the \@$h@_\
1990mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
495ae4b0
PH
1991(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1992supports the \*iconv()*\ function.
1993
1994However, some of the operating systems that supply \*iconv()*\ do not support
1995very many conversions. The GNU \libiconv\ library (available from
1996\?http:/@/www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/?\) can be installed on such systems to
1997remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply \*iconv()*\ at
4964e932 1998all. After installing \libiconv\, you should add
495ae4b0 1999.display asis
4964e932
PH
2000HAVE_ICONV=yes
2001.endd
495ae4b0
PH
2002to your \(Local/Makefile)\ and rebuild Exim.
2003
2004
2005.section Including TLS/SSL encryption support
2006.rset SECTinctlsssl "~~chapter.~~section"
2007.index TLS||including support for TLS
2008.index encryption||including support for
2009.index \\SUPPORT@_TLS\\
2010.index OpenSSL||building Exim with
2011.index GnuTLS||building Exim with
2012Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the \\STARTTLS\\
4964e932
PH
2013command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
2014start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
d43194df
PH
2015\tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ runtime option and the \-tls-on-connect-\ command
2016line option).
495ae4b0 2017
4964e932 2018If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
495ae4b0
PH
2019OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
2020implementing SSL.
2021
2022If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
2023.display asis
2024SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2025TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
2026.endd
2027in \(Local/Makefile)\. You may also need to specify the locations of the
2028OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
2029.display asis
2030SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2031TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
2032TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
2033.endd
2034
2035If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
2036.index \\USE@_GNUTLS\\
2037.display asis
2038SUPPORT_TLS=yes
2039USE_GNUTLS=yes
2040TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2041.endd
2042in \(Local/Makefile)\, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
2043library and include files. For example:
2044.display asis
2045SUPPORT_TLS=yes
4964e932 2046USE_GNUTLS=yes
495ae4b0
PH
2047TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2048TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2049.endd
2050You do not need to set \\TLS@_INCLUDE\\ if the relevant directory is already
4964e932 2051specified in \\INCLUDE\\. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS
495ae4b0
PH
2052are given in chapter ~~CHAPTLS.
2053
2054
2055
2056.section Use of tcpwrappers
2057.index tcpwrappers, building Exim to support
2058.index \\USE@_TCP@_WRAPPERS\\
2059Exim can be linked with the \*tcpwrappers*\ library in order to check incoming
2060SMTP calls using the \*tcpwrappers*\ control files. This may be a convenient
2061alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2062already making use of \*tcpwrappers*\ for other purposes. To do this, you should
2063set \\USE@_TCP@_WRAPPERS\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\, arrange for the file
2064\(tcpd.h)\ to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2065\(libwrap.a)\ is available at link time, typically by including \-lwrap-\ in
2066\\EXTRALIBS@_EXIM\\. For example, if \*tcpwrappers*\ is installed in
2067\(/usr/local)\, you might have
2068.display
2069USE@_TCP@_WRAPPERS=yes
2070CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2071.newline
2072EXTRALIBS@_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2073.endd
2074in \(Local/Makefile)\. The name to use in the \*tcpwrappers*\ control files is
2075`exim'. For example, the line
2076.display
2077exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2078.endd
2079in your \(/etc/hosts.allow)\ file allows connections from the local host, from
2080the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in \*friendly.domain.example*\.
2081All other connections are denied. Consult the \*tcpwrappers*\ documentation for
2082further details.
2083
2084
2085.section Including support for IPv6
2086.index IPv6||including support for
2087Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2088\\HAVE@_IPV6=YES\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2089it may also be necessary to set \\IPV6@_INCLUDE\\ and \\IPV6@_LIBS\\ on systems
2090where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2091library files.
2092
d43194df
PH
2093.em
2094Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2095defined. AAAA records (analagous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2096currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2097as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to
2098be over-complex, and its status was reduced to `experimental'. It is not known
2099if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
2100this is included only if you set \\SUPPORT@_A6=YES\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The
2101support has not been tested for some time.
2102.nem
495ae4b0
PH
2103
2104.section The building process
2105.index build directory
2106Once \(Local/Makefile)\ (and \(Local/eximon.conf)\, if required) have been
2107created, run \*make*\ at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2108operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2109For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2110\(build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc)\ is created.
2111.index symbolic link||to source files
2112Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2113
4964e932 2114\**Warning**\: The \-j-\ (parallel) flag must not be used with \*make*\; the
495ae4b0 2115building process fails if it is set.
495ae4b0
PH
2116
2117If this is the first time \*make*\ has been run, it calls a script that builds
2118a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2119\(Local)\ directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2120\*make*\. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2121then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2122number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command \*make
2123makefile*\ can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2124directory, should this ever be necessary.
2125
2126If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2127\(README)\ file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2128.if ~~html
2129[(A HREF="FAQ.html")]
2130.fi
2131FAQ,
2132.if ~~html
2133[(/A)]
2134.fi
2135where some common problems are covered.
2136
2137
2138
2139.section Overriding build-time options for Exim
2140.index build-time options, overriding
2141.rset SECToverride "~~chapter.~~section"
2142The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2143consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2144values, followed by a fixed set of \*make*\ instructions. If a value is set
2145more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2146convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2147order:
2148.display rm
2149\(OS/Makefile-Default)\
2150\(OS/Makefile-)\<<ostype>>
2151\(Local/Makefile)\
2152\(Local/Makefile-)\<<ostype>>
2153\(Local/Makefile-)\<<archtype>>
2154\(Local/Makefile-)\<<ostype>>-<<archtype>>
2155\(OS/Makefile-Base)\
2156.endd
2157.index \(Local/Makefile)\
2158where <<ostype>> is the operating system type and <<archtype>> is the
2159.index building Exim||operating system type
2160.index building Exim||architecture type
2161architecture type. \(Local/Makefile)\ is required to exist, and the building
2162process fails if it is absent. The other three \(Local)\ files are optional,
2163and are often not needed.
2164
2165The values used for <<ostype>> and <<archtype>> are obtained from scripts
2166called \(scripts/os-type)\ and \(scripts/arch-type)\ respectively. If either of
2167the environment variables \\EXIM@_OSTYPE\\ or \\EXIM@_ARCHTYPE\\ is set, their
2168values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2169Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the \uname\ command. If this
2170fails, the shell variables \\OSTYPE\\ and \\ARCHTYPE\\ are inspected. A number
2171of $it{ad hoc} transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2172that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2173to find out what values are being used on your system.
2174
2175
2176\(OS/Makefile-Default)\ contains comments about the variables that are set
2177therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2178needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2179file for your operating system (\(OS/Makefile-<<ostype>>)\) to see what the
2180default values are.
2181
2182
2183.index building Exim||overriding default settings
2184If you need to change any of the values that are set in \(OS/Makefile-Default)\
4964e932 2185or in \(OS/Makefile-<<ostype>>)\, or to add any new definitions, you do not
495ae4b0
PH
2186need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2187putting the new values in an appropriate \(Local)\ file. For example,
2188.index Tru64-Unix build-time settings
2189when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2190formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
4964e932 2191compiler is called \*cc*\ rather than \*gcc*\. Also, the compiler must be
495ae4b0 2192called with the option \-std1-\, to make it recognize some of the features of
4964e932 2193Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
495ae4b0
PH
2194default.) To do this, you should create a file called \(Local/Makefile-OSF1)\
2195containing the lines
2196.display
2197CC=cc
2198CFLAGS=-std1
2199.endd
4964e932 2200If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
495ae4b0
PH
2201these lines directly into \(Local/Makefile)\.
2202
2203Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2204files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2205the contents of the \(Local)\ directory.
2206
2207
2208.index NIS lookup type||including support for
2209.index NIS@+ lookup type||including support for
2210.index LDAP||including support for
2211.index lookup||inclusion in binary
2212Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2213lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2214not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2215and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2216which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2217case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for \(Local/Makefile)\ are:
2218.display asis
2219LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2220LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2221LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2222.endd
2223and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2224\(src/EDITME)\. In most cases the relevant include files and interface
2225libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2226.index cdb||including support for
2227However, in the case of cdb, which is included in the binary only if
2228.display asis
2229LOOKUP_CDB=yes
2230.endd
2231is set, the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2232files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2233binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2234errors.
2235
2236.index Perl||including support for
2237Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2238subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2239.display asis
2240EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2241.endd
2242must be defined in \(Local/Makefile)\. Details of this facility are given in
2243chapter ~~CHAPperl.
2244
2245.index X11 libraries, location of
2246The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2247operating systems, and of course there are different versions of X11 to cope
2248with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2249monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2250The following three variables are set in \(OS/Makefile-Default)\:
2251.display asis
2252X11=/usr/X11R6
2253XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2254XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2255.endd
2256These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2257example, in \(OS/Makefile-SunOS5)\ there is
2258.display asis
2259X11=/usr/openwin
2260XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2261XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2262.endd
2263If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2264definition of all three of these variables into your
2265\(Local/Makefile-<<ostype>>)\ file.
2266
2267.index \\EXTRALIBS\\
2268If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2269variable called \\EXTRALIBS\\, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2270default is not defined. In contrast, \\EXTRALIBS@_EXIM\\ is used only on the
2271command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2272.index DBM||libraries, configuration for building
2273There is also \\DBMLIB\\, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2274use DBM functions (see also section ~~SECTdb). Finally, there is
2275\\EXTRALIBS@_EXIMON\\, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2276binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2277libraries.
2278
2279.index configuration file||editing
2280The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2281files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2282necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is, \(Local/Makefile)\
2283or \(Local/eximon.conf)\) before rebuilding.
2284
2285.section OS-specific header files
2286.index \(os.h)\
2287.index building Exim||OS-specific C header files
2288The \(OS)\ directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2289\(os.h-<<ostype>>)\. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2290normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2291recognized in the file \(OS/os.configuring)\, which should be consulted if you
2292are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2293
2294
2295.section Overriding build-time options for the monitor
2296.index building Eximon||overriding default options
2297A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2298where the files that are involved are
2299.display rm
2300\(OS/eximon.conf-Default)\
2301\(OS/eximon.conf-)\<<ostype>>
2302\(Local/eximon.conf)\
2303\(Local/eximon.conf-)\<<ostype>>
2304\(Local/eximon.conf-)\<<archtype>>
2305\(Local/eximon.conf-)\<<ostype>>-<<archtype>>
2306.endd
2307.index \(Local/eximon.conf)\
2308As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2309\(OS/eximon.conf-<<ostype>>)\ file is also optional. The default values in
2310\(OS/eximon.conf-Default)\ can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2311variables of the same name, preceded by \\EXIMON@_\\. For example, setting
2312\\EXIMON@_LOG@_DEPTH\\ in the environment overrides the value of
2313\\LOG@_DEPTH\\ at run time.
2314
2315
2316
2317.section Installing Exim binaries and scripts
2318.index installing Exim
2319.index \\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\
2320The command \*make install*\ runs the \*exim@_install*\ script with no
2321arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2322whose name is specified by the \\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\ setting in
4964e932 2323\(Local/Makefile)\.
495ae4b0
PH
2324
2325Exim's run time configuration file is named by the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ setting
2326.index \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
2327in \(Local/Makefile)\. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2328exist, the default configuration file \(src/configure.default)\ is copied there
2329by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2330is left alone. If \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ is a colon-separated list, naming several
2331alternative files, no default is installed.
2332
2333.index system aliases file
2334.index \(/etc/aliases)\
2335One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2336default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2337The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2338\\SYSTEM@_ALIASES@_FILE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ (\(/etc/aliases)\ by default).
2339If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2340and outputs a comment to the user.
2341
2342The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2343aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2344kept in \(/etc/aliases)\. However, some operating systems are now using
2345\(/etc/mail/aliases)\. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2346Exim's configuration if necessary.
2347
2348The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2349and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory \(/var/mail)\,
2350running as the local user. System aliases and \(.forward)\ files in users' home
2351directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2352other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2353over SMTP.
2354
2355The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2356going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2357\*setuid*\ bit set,
2358.index setuid||installing Exim with
2359for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run \*make install*\ as root so
2360that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in some special
2361situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries) it may be
2362possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see chapter
2363~~CHAPsecurity for details).
2364
2365It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2366distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2367command such as
2368.display asis
2369make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2370.endd
4964e932
PH
2371This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2372paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
495ae4b0 2373configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name \*is*\ modified.)
4964e932 2374For backwards compatibility, \\ROOT\\ is used if \\DESTDIR\\ is not set,
495ae4b0
PH
2375but this usage is deprecated.
2376
2377.index installing Exim||what is not installed
2378Running \*make install*\ does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2379\*convert4r4*\, or the \*pcretest*\ test program. You will probably run the
2380first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
2381isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the \(doc)\
2382directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2383\\INFO@_DIRECTORY\\, as described in section ~~SECTinsinfdoc below.
2384
2385For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix \(.O)\
2386to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2387installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2388for example \(exim-~~version-1)\. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2389called \(exim)\ to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2390of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name \(exim)\ is never absent
2391from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2392
2393.index installing Exim||testing the script
2394If you want to see what the \*make install*\ will do before running it for
2395real, you can pass the \-n-\ option to the installation script by this command:
2396.display asis
2397make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2398.endd
2399The contents of the variable \\INSTALL@_ARG\\ are passed to the installation
2400script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2401the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2402directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2403command:
2404.display
2405(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim@_install -n)
2406.endd
2407
2408.index installing Exim||install script options
2409There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2410.numberpars $.
2411\-no@_chown-\ bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2412to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2413.nextp
2414\-no@_symlink-\ bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link \(exim)\ to the
2415installed binary.
2416.endp
2417\\INSTALL@_ARG\\ can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2418.display asis
2419make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2420.endd
2421
4964e932
PH
2422The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2423to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
495ae4b0
PH
2424without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2425.display asis
2426make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2427.endd
2428
2429
2430.section Installing info documentation
2431.rset SECTinsinfdoc "~~chapter.~~section"
2432.index installing Exim||\*info*\ documentation
2433Not all systems use the GNU \*info*\ system for documentation, and for this
2434reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2435distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2436~~SECTavail).
2437
2438If you have defined \\INFO@_DIRECTORY\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ and the Texinfo
2439source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running \*make
2440install*\ automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2441
2442
2443.section Setting up the spool directory
2444.index spool directory||creating
2445When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2446exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2447directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2448necessary.
2449
2450
2451
2452.section Testing
2453.index testing||installation
2454Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2455syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2456Exim binary directory is within your \\PATH\\ environment variable:
2457.display
2458exim -bV
2459.endd
2460If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2461Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
4964e932 2462the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
495ae4b0
PH
2463other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2464Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2465example,
2466.display
2467exim -bt <<local username>>
2468.endd
2469should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2470.display
2471exim -bt <<remote address>>
2472.endd
2473a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2474This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2475user agent. For example:
2476.display
2477exim -v postmaster@@your.domain.example
2478From: user@@your.domain.example
2479To: postmaster@@your.domain.example
2480Subject: Testing Exim
2481
2482This is a test message.
2483^D
2484.endd
2485The \-v-\ option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2486In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2487arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing `Completed'.
2488
2489.index delivery||problems with
2490If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (\*mainlog*\ and
2491\*paniclog*\) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2492of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2493\-d-\ option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2494with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2495.display
2496exim -d -M <<message-id>>
2497.endd
2498You must be root or an `admin user' in order to do this. The \-d-\ option
2499produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2500For example, if you use \-d-all+route-\ only the debugging information relevant
2501to routing is included. (See the \-d-\ option in chapter ~~CHAPcommandline for
2502more details.)
2503
2504.index `sticky' bit
2505.index lock files
2506One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2507local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2508`sticky bit' set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2509writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2510is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the `sticky bit' on the
2511directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2512that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2513\%local@_delivery%\ transport in the default configuration file). Another
2514approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2515\*fcntl()*\ locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2516agents also use \*fcntl()*\ locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2517see chapter ~~CHAPappendfile.
2518
2519One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2520the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2521\-oX-\ option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2522port, or \*inetd*\ can be used to do this. The \-bh-\ option and the
2523\*exim@_checkaccess*\ utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2524incoming SMTP mail.
2525
2526Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2527be done by building a binary with a different \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ setting. From
2528within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2529that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2530production version.
2531
2532.section Replacing another MTA with Exim
2533.index replacing another MTA
2534Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2535general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2536is either \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\, or \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ (depending on the
2537operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the \*exim*\
2538binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2539normally done by renaming any existing file and making \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\
2540or \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\
2541.index symbolic link||to \*exim*\ binary
2542a symbolic link to the \*exim*\ binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2543privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2544and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2545
2546.index FreeBSD, MTA indirection
2547.index \(/etc/mail/mailer.conf)\
2548Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2549example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2550\(/etc/mail/mailer.conf)\ instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2551described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2552as follows:
2553.display asis
2554sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2555send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2556mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2557newaliases /usr/bin/true
2558.endd
2559
2560Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited \(/etc/mail/mailer.conf)\,
2561your Exim installation is `live'. Check it by sending a message from your
2562favourite user agent.
2563
2564You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2565have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2566various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2567command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2568use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2569.if ~~html
2570[(A HREF="filter.html")]
2571.fi
2572\*Exim's interface to mail filtering*\
2573.if ~~html
2574[(/A)]
2575.fi
2576available to them.
2577
2578
2579.section Upgrading Exim
2580.index upgrading Exim
2581If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2582version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2583call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2584to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-exec itself, and thereby pick up the new
2585binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2586version of Exim.
2587
2588
2589.section Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris
2590.index Solaris||stopping Exim on
2591The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2592.display
2593/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2594.endd
2595If \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2596fails to stop Exim because it uses the command \*ps -e*\ and greps the output
2597for the text `sendmail'; this is not present because the actual program name
2598(that is, `exim') is given by the \*ps*\ command with these options. A solution
2599is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2600.display asis
2601pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2602.endd
2603to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2604
4964e932
PH
2605Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not `stop Exim'. Messages can
2606still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
495ae4b0
PH
2607(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2608
2609
2610.
2611.
2612.
2613.
2614. ============================================================================
2615.chapter The Exim command line
2616.set runningfoot "command line"
2617.rset CHAPcommandline ~~chapter
2618.index command line||options
2619.index options||command line
2620
2621Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2622each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2623options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2624some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2625combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2626The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2627
2628.section Setting options by program name
2629.index \*mailq*\
2630If Exim is called under the name \*mailq*\, it behaves as if the option \-bp-\
4964e932
PH
2631were present before any other options.
2632The \-bp-\ option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
495ae4b0
PH
2633standard output.
2634This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2635that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2636\(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ or \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\.
2637
2638.index \*rsmtp*\
2639If Exim is called under the name \*rsmtp*\ it behaves as if the option \-bS-\
2640were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The \-bS-\
2641option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP format.
2642
2643.index \*rmail*\
2644If Exim is called under the name \*rmail*\ it behaves as if the \-i-\ and
2645\-oee-\ options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2646Smail. The name \*rmail*\ is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2647
2648.index \*runq*\
2649.index queue runner
2650If Exim is called under the name \*runq*\ it behaves as if the option \-q-\ were
2651present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The \-q-\
2652option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2653
2654.index \*newaliases*\
2655.index alias file||building
2656.index Sendmail compatibility||calling Exim as \*newaliases*\
2657If Exim is called under the name \*newaliases*\ it behaves as if the option
2658\-bi-\ were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2659This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2660the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2661command if called with the \-bi-\ option.
2662
2663.section Trusted and admin users
2664.rset SECTtrustedadmin "~~chapter.~~section"
2665Some Exim options are available only to \*trusted users*\ and others are
2666available only to \*admin users*\. In the description below, the phrases `Exim
2667user' and `Exim group' mean the user and group defined by \\EXIM@_USER\\ and
2668\\EXIM@_GROUP\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ or set by the \exim@_user\ and
2669\exim@_group\ options. These do not necessarily have to use the name `exim'.
2670
2671.numberpars $.
2672.index trusted user||definition of
2673.index user||trusted, definition of
2674The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2675\trusted@_users\ configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2676supplementary group is one of those listed in the \trusted@_groups\
2677configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2678
2679.index `From' line
2680.index envelope sender
2681Trusted users are always permitted to use the \-f-\ option or a leading `From '
2682line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to Exim through
2683the local interface (see the \-bm-\ and \-f-\ options below). See the
2684\untrusted@_set@_sender\ option for a way of permitting non-trusted users to
2685set envelope senders.
2686.index ::From:: header line
2687.index ::Sender:: header line
2688For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the ::From::
2689header line, and a ::Sender:: line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2690::Sender:: line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2691
2692Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2693protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2694locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2695have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2696users may in some circumstances use \-f-\, but can never set the other values
2697that are available to trusted users.
2698.nextp
2699.index user||admin, definition of
2700.index admin user||definition of
2701The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2702Exim group or of any group listed in the \admin@_groups\ configuration option.
2703The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2704
2705Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2706operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2707necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2708the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2709
2710By default, the use of the \-M-\, \-q-\, \-R-\, and \-S-\ options to cause Exim
2711to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2712However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the \prod@_requires@_admin\
2713option false (that is, specifying \no@_prod@_requires@_admin\).
2714
2715Similarly, the use of the \-bp-\ option to list all the messages in the queue
2716is restricted to admin users unless \queue@_list@_requires@_admin\ is set
2717false.
2718.endp
2719
4964e932
PH
2720\**Warning**\: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2721edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2722getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
495ae4b0
PH
2723~~CHAPconf.
2724
2725
2726
2727.section Command line options
2728The command options are described in alphabetical order below.
2729
2730.startoptions
2731
2732.option @-
2733.index options||command line, terminating
2734This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2735therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2736rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2737
2738.option -help
2739This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
4964e932 2740The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
495ae4b0
PH
2741no arguments.
2742
2743.option B <<type>>
2744.index 8-bit characters
2745.index Sendmail compatibility||8-bit characters
2746This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2747clean; it ignores this option.
2748
2749.option bd
2750.index daemon
2751.index SMTP listener
2752.index queue runner
2753This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2754the \-bd-\ option is combined with the \-q-\<<time>> option, to specify that
2755the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2756
2757The \-bd-\ option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the \-d-\
2758(debugging) or \-v-\ (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2759disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2760stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2761
2762By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2763all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2764ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2765~~CHAPinterfaces contains a description of the options that control this.
2766
2767.index daemon||process id (pid)
2768.index pid (process id)||of daemon
2769When a listening daemon is started without the use of \-oX-\ (that is, without
2770overriding the normal configuration), it writes its process id to a file called
2771\(exim-daemon.pid)\ in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden
2772by setting \\PID@_FILE@_PATH\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The file is written while
2773Exim is still running as root.
2774
2775When \-oX-\ is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2776process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, \-oP-\ can be
2777used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2778
2779.index \\SIGHUP\\
2780The \\SIGHUP\\ signal can be used to cause the daemon to re-exec itself. This
2781should be done whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is
4964e932 2782incorporated into it by means of the \.include\ facility, is changed, and also
495ae4b0
PH
2783whenever a new version of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this
2784when other files that are referenced from the configuration (for example, alias
2785files) are changed, because these are reread each time they are used.
2786
2787.option bdf
2788This option has the same effect as \-bd-\ except that it never disconnects from
2789the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2790
2791.option be
2792.index testing||string expansion
2793.index expansion||testing
2794Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2795prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2796files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
d43194df
PH
2797of data.
2798.em
2799If Exim was built with \\USE@_READLINE\\=yes in \(Local/Makefile)\, it tries
2800to load the \libreadline\ library dynamically whenever the \-be-\ option is
2801used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the \*readline()*\
2802function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2803test data. A line history is supported.
2804.nem
495ae4b0 2805
d43194df
PH
2806Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2807continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, whitespace at the start of
2808continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2809string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2810configuration file (for example, \$qualify@_domain$\) are available, but no
2811message-specific values (such as \$domain$\) are set, because no message is
2812being processed.
495ae4b0
PH
2813
2814.option bF #<<filename>>
2815.index system filter||testing
2816.index testing||system filter
2817This option is the same as \-bf-\ except that it assumes that the filter being
2818tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2819system filters are recognized.
2820
2821.option bf #<<filename>>
2822.index filter||testing
2823.index testing||filter file
2824.index forward file||testing
2825.index testing||forward file
2826.index Sieve filter||testing
d43194df
PH
2827This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2828to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2829there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2830supplied.
2831.em
2832If you want to test a system filter file, use \-bF-\ instead of \-bf-\. You can
2833use both \-bF-\ and \-bf-\ on the same command, in order to
2834test a system filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2835.display asis
2836exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2837.endd
2838This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2839variables that are used by the user filter.
2840.nem
2841
2842If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
495ae4b0
PH
2843.display asis
2844# Exim filter
2845# Sieve filter
2846.endd
2847it is taken to be a normal \(.forward)\ file, and is tested for validity under
4964e932 2848that interpretation. See sections ~~SECTitenonfilred to ~~SECTspecitredli for a
495ae4b0
PH
2849description of the possible contents of non-filter redirection lists.
2850
2851The result of an Exim command that uses \-bf-\, provided no errors are
2852detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2853with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2854separate document entitled \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\.
2855
2856.index `From' line
2857.index envelope sender
2858.index \-f-\ option||for filter testing
2859When testing a filter file, the envelope sender can be set by the \-f-\ option,
2860or by a `From ' line at the start of the test message. Various parameters that
2861would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message can
d43194df
PH
2862be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four options).
2863
2864.em
2865.option bfd #<<domain>>
2866This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2867tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is the value of
2868\$qualify@_domain$\.
2869
2870.option bfl #<<local part>>
2871This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2872tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is the username of the
2873process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
495ae4b0
PH
2874suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2875actually being delivered.
2876
d43194df
PH
2877.option bfp #<<prefix>>
2878This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2879file is being tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is an empty
2880prefix.
2881
2882.option bfp #<<suffix>>
2883This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2884file is being tested by means of the \-bf-\ option. The default is an empty
2885suffix.
2886.em
2887
2888
495ae4b0
PH
2889.option bh #<<IP address>>
2890.index testing||incoming SMTP
2891.index SMTP||testing incoming
2892.index testing||relay control
2893.index relaying||testing configuration
2894.index policy control||testing
2895.index debugging||\-bh-\ option
2896This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2897standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2898after a full stop. For example:
2899.display asis
2900exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2901exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2902.endd
d43194df
PH
2903.em
2904When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2905of the second example above, the value of \$sender@_host@_address$\ after
2906conversion to the canonical form is \"fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678"\.
2907.nem
2908
495ae4b0
PH
2909Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2910include lines beginning with `LOG' for anything that would have been logged.
4964e932
PH
2911This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2912messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
495ae4b0
PH
2913test your relay controls using \-bh-\.
2914
2915.index RFC 1413
2916\**Warning 1**\: You cannot test features of the configuration that rely on
2917ident (RFC 1413) callouts. These cannot be done when testing using
2918\-bh-\ because there is no incoming SMTP connection.
2919
2920\**Warning 2**\: Address verification callouts (see section ~~SECTcallver) are
4964e932 2921also skipped when testing using \-bh-\. If you want these callouts to occur,
495ae4b0
PH
2922use \-bhc-\ instead.
2923
2924Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2925written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2926lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The \-oMi-\ option
2927can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important.
2928
2929The \*exim@_checkaccess*\ utility is a `packaged' version of \-bh-\ whose
2930output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2931acceptable or not. See section ~~SECTcheckaccess.
2932
2933.option bhc #<<IP address>>
4964e932
PH
2934This option operates in the same way as \-bh-\, except that address
2935verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2936updating the callout cache database.
495ae4b0
PH
2937
2938.option bi
2939.index alias file||building
2940.index building alias file
2941.index Sendmail compatibility||\-bi-\ option
2942Sendmail interprets the \-bi-\ option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2943Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2944this behaviour. However, calls to \(/usr/lib/sendmail)\ with the \-bi-\ option
2945tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2946recognized.
2947
2948If \-bi-\ is encountered, the command specified by the \bi@_command\
2949configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2950the \-oA-\ option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2951The command set by \bi@_command\ may not contain arguments. The command can use
2952the \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files if
2953this is required. If the \bi@_command\ option is not set, calling Exim with
2954\-bi-\ is a no-op.
2955
2956.option bm
2957.index local message reception
2958This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2959locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2960command arguments (except when \-t-\ is also present -- see below). Each
2961argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2962default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2963if no other conflicting option is present.
2964
2965If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2966qualified by the values of the \qualify@_domain\ or \qualify@_recipient\
2967options, as appropriate. The \-bnq-\ option (see below) provides a way of
2968suppressing this for special cases.
2969
4964e932 2970Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of the
495ae4b0
PH
2971non-SMTP ACL. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for details.
2972.index return code||for \-bm-\
2973The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2974action is controlled by the \-oe$it{x}-\ option setting -- see below.
2975
2976.index message||format
2977.index format||message
2978.index `From' line
2979.index UUCP||`From' line
2980.index Sendmail compatibility||`From' line
2981The format of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2982compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2983.display
2984From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2985From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2986.endd
2987(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2988is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2989authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2990matching against the regular expression defined by the \uucp@_from@_pattern\
4964e932 2991option, which can be changed if necessary.
495ae4b0
PH
2992.index \-f-\ option||overriding `From' line
2993The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2994\-f-\ option, but if a \-f-\ option is also present, its argument is used in
2995preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2996trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2997
2998.option bnq
2999.index address||qualification, suppressing
3000By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3001without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3002is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
4964e932
PH
3003envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3004\qualify@_domain\, and recipient addresses using \qualify@_recipient\ (which
495ae4b0
PH
3005defaults to the value of \qualify@_domain\).
3006
3007Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if \-bS-\ (batch SMTP) is
3008being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3009content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3010header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3011syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3012
3013The \-bnq-\ option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3014messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3015addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3016unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3017
3018
3019.option bP
3020.index configuration options, extracting
3021.index options||configuration, extracting
3022If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3023main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3024of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3025arguments, for example:
3026.display
3027exim -bP qualify@_domain hold@_domains
3028.endd
3029However, any option setting that is preceded by the word `hide' in the
3030configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3031users, the output is as in this example:
3032.display asis
3033mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3034.endd
3035If \configure@_file\ is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3036configuration file is output.
4964e932 3037If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
495ae4b0
PH
3038is the name of the file that was actually used.
3039
3040.index daemon||process id (pid)
3041.index pid (process id)||of daemon
3042If \log__file__path\ or \pid@_file@_path\ are given, the names of the
3043directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3044respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3045sub-directory of the spool directory called \log\, and the pid file is written
3046directly into the spool directory.
3047
3048If \-bP-\ is followed by a name preceded by \"+"\, for example,
3049.display asis
3050exim -bP +local_domains
3051.endd
3052it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3053local part) and outputs what it finds.
3054
3055.index options||router, extracting
3056.index options||transport, extracting
3057If one of the words \router\, \transport\, or \authenticator\ is given,
3058followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3059that driver are output. For example:
3060.display
3061exim -bP transport local@_delivery
3062.endd
3063The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3064options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3065using one of the words \router@_list\, \transport@_list\, or
3066\authenticator@_list\, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3067settings can be obtained by using \routers\, \transports\, or \authenticators\.
3068
3069
3070.option bp
3071.index queue||listing messages on
3072.index listing||messages on the queue
3073This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3074standard output. If the \-bp-\ option is followed by a list of message ids,
3075just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3076admin user. However, the \queue__list__requires__admin\ option can be set false
3077to allow any user to see the queue.
3078
3079Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3080.display
308125m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@@wonderland.fict.example>
3082 red.king@@looking-glass.fict.example
3083 <<other addresses>>
3084.endd
3085.index message||size in queue listing
3086.index size||of message
3087The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3088(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3089identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3090envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3091`<>'. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3092the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3093before the sender address.
3094.index frozen messages||in queue listing
3095If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3096`$*$$*$$*$ frozen $*$$*$$*$' is displayed at the end of this line.
3097
3098The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3099displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3100been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3101expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3102displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3103complete.
3104
3105
3106.option bpa
3107This option operates like \-bp-\, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3108that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3109alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with `+D' instead
3110of just `D'.
3111
3112
3113.option bpc
3114.index queue||count of messages on
3115This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3116to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3117\queue__list__requires__admin\ is set false.
3118
3119
3120.option bpr
3121This option operates like \-bp-\, but the output is not sorted into
3122chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3123lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3124going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3125
3126.option bpra
3127This option is a combination of \-bpr-\ and \-bpa-\.
3128
3129.option bpru
3130This option is a combination of \-bpr-\ and \-bpu-\.
3131
3132
3133.option bpu
3134This option operates like \-bp-\ but shows only undelivered top-level addresses
3135for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or forwarding are
3136not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a router with
3137the \one@_time\ option set.
3138
3139
3140.option brt
3141.index testing||retry configuration
3142.index retry||configuration testing
3143This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3144arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3145and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3146.display asis
3147exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3148Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3149.endd
3150See chapter ~~CHAPretry for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3151argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3152\*local@_part@@domain*\, or it can be just a domain name. The second argument is
3153an optional second domain name; if no retry rule is found for the first
3154argument, the second is tried. This ties in with Exim's behaviour when looking
3155for retry rules for remote hosts -- if no rule is found that matches the host,
3156one that matches the mail domain is sought. The final argument is the name of a
3157specific delivery error, as used in setting up retry rules, for example
3158`quota@_3d'.
3159
3160.option brw
3161.index testing||rewriting
3162.index rewriting||testing
3163This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3164a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3165complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3166would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3167~~CHAPrewrite for further details.
3168
3169.option bS
3170.index SMTP||batched incoming
3171.index batched SMTP input
3172This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3173for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3174submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3175input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3176input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3177\untrusted@_set@_sender\ is set, the senders in the SMTP \\MAIL\\ commands are
3178believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3179
3180The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3181dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3182provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3183
3184As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3185messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter ~~CHAPACL).
3186Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using \qualify@_domain\ and
3187\qualify@_recipient\, as appropriate, unless the \-bnq-\ option is used.
3188
3189Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. \\HELO\\ and \\EHLO\\ act
3190as \\RSET\\; \\VRFY\\, \\EXPN\\, \\ETRN\\, and \\HELP\\ act as \\NOOP\\;
3191\\QUIT\\ quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3192
3193If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3194error streams, and Exim gives up immediately.
3195.index return code||for \-bS-\
3196The return code is 0 if no error was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages
3197were accepted before the error was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3198
3199More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3200~~SECTincomingbatchedSMTP.
3201
3202.option bs
3203.index SMTP||local input
3204.index local SMTP input
3205This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3206on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
4964e932 3207policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter ~~CHAPACL) are applied.
495ae4b0
PH
3208
3209Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3210messages to the MTA.
3211.index sender||source of
3212In this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or \untrusted@_set@_sender\ is
3213set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP \\MAIL\\ commands.
3214Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3215the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3216\qualify@_domain\ and \qualify@_recipient\, as appropriate, unless the \-bnq-\
3217option is used.
3218
3219.index inetd
3220The \-bs-\ option is also used to run Exim from \*inetd*\, as an alternative to
3221using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
4964e932
PH
3222whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3223\*inetd*\, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3224above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3225Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
495ae4b0
PH
3226the listening daemon.
3227
3228.option bt
3229.index testing||addresses
3230.index address||testing
3231This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3232as an address to be tested for deliverability. The results are written to the
d43194df
PH
3233standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no
3234details of the failure are output, because these might contain sensitive
3235information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
495ae4b0
PH
3236
3237If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
d43194df
PH
3238right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3239.em
3240Unlike the \-be-\ test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3241\*readline()*\ function, because it is running as \*root*\ and there are
3242security issues.
3243.nem
3244
3245Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3246(compare the \-bv-\ option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3247written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3248\no@_address@_test\ set is bypassed. This can make \-bt-\ easier to use for
3249genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3250program.
495ae4b0
PH
3251
3252.index return code||for \-bt-\
3253The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3254failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3255code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3256
3257\**Warning**\: \-bt-\ can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3258routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
4964e932 3259message,
495ae4b0
PH
3260.index \-f-\ option||for address testing
3261you can use the \-f-\ option to set an appropriate sender when running
3262\-bt-\ tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3263default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3264whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3265those conditions using \-bt-\. The \-N-\ option provides a possible way of
3266doing such tests.
3267
3268.option bV
3269.index version number of Exim, verifying
3270This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3271number, and compilation date of the \*exim*\ binary to the standard output.
3272It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3273specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3274name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3275
d43194df
PH
3276.em
3277As part of its operation, \-bV-\ causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3278configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3279values that to be expanded. You cannot rely on \-bV-\ alone to discover (for
3280example) all the typos in the configuration; some realistic testing is needed.
3281The \-bh-\ and \-N-\ options provide more dynamic testing facilities.
3282.nem
3283
3284
495ae4b0
PH
3285.option bv
3286.index verifying||address, using \-bv-\
3287.index address||verification
3288This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3289taken as an address to be verified. During normal operation, verification
3290happens mostly as a consequence processing a \verify\ condition in an ACL (see
3291chapter ~~CHAPACL). If you want to test an entire ACL, see the \-bh-\ option.
3292
3293If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3294failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3295usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3296
3297If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
d43194df
PH
3298right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3299.em
3300Unlike the \-be-\ test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3301\*readline()*\ function, because it is running as \*exim*\ and there are
3302security issues.
3303.nem
3304
3305Verification differs from address testing (the \-bt-\ option) in that routers
3306that have \no@_verify\ set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3307router that has \fail@_verify\ set, verification fails. The address is verified
3308as a recipient if \-bv-\ is used; to test verification for a sender address,
3309\-bvs-\ should be used.
495ae4b0
PH
3310
3311If the \-v-\ option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3312address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3313latter case. Otherwise, more details are given of how the address has been
3314handled, and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses
3315are also considered. Without \-v-\, generating more than one address by
3316redirection causes verification to end sucessfully.
3317
3318.index return code||for \-bv-\
3319The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3320failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3321code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3322
3323If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3324address of a message, you should use the \-f-\ option to set an appropriate
3325sender when running \-bv-\ tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3326calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3327
3328.option bvs
3329This option acts like \-bv-\, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3330than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3331might happen.
3332
3333.option C #<<filelist>>
3334.index configuration file||alternate
3335.index \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
3336.index alternate configuration file
3337This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3338list instead of from the list specified by the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
3339compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3340name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3341file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3342proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3343
d43194df
PH
3344When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3345list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3346immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3347the caller. However, if \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is defined in
3348\(Local/Makefile)\, root privilege is retained for \-C-\ only if the caller of
3349Exim is root.
3350.em
3351That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3352option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3353However, if you are using a `packaged' version of Exim (source or binary), the
3354packagers might have enabled it.
3355.nem
495ae4b0
PH
3356
3357Setting \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ locks out the possibility of testing a
3358configuration using \-C-\ right through message reception and delivery, even if
3359the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as
3360the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
3361use of \-C-\ causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4964e932 3362delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
495ae4b0
PH
3363\-odq-\, and another to do the delivery, using \-M-\).
3364
3365If \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ is defined \(in Local/Makefile)\, it specifies a
3366prefix string with which any file named in a \-C-\ command line option
3367must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence \"/../"\.
3368However, if the value of the \-C-\ option is identical to the value of
3369\\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\, Exim ignores \-C-\ and proceeds as
4964e932 3370usual. There is no default setting for \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\; when it is
495ae4b0
PH
3371unset, any file name can be used with \-C-\.
3372
3373\\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3374to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3375broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3376configuration file.
3377
3378The \-C-\ facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3379syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3380caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3381require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3382specified by this option.
3383
3384.option D <<macro>>=<<value>>
3385.index macro||setting on command line
3386This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3387(see section ~~SECTmacrodefs). However, like \-C-\, if it is used by an
4964e932 3388unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
495ae4b0
PH
3389If \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, the use of \-D-\ is
3390completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3391
3392The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
4964e932
PH
3393command line item. \-D-\ can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3394string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
495ae4b0
PH
3395synonymous:
3396.display asis
3397exim -DABC ...
3398exim -DABC= ...
3399.endd
4964e932
PH
3400To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3401quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
495ae4b0
PH
3402example:
3403.display asis
3404exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3405.endd
3406\-D-\ may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3407
3408.option d <<debug options>>
3409.index debugging||list of selectors
3410.index debugging||\-d-\ option
3411This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3412error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3413database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3414filter files should be protected. When \-d-\ is used, \-v-\ is assumed. If
3415\-d-\ is given on its own, a lot of standard debugging data is output. This can
3416be reduced, or increased to include some more rarely needed information, by
3417following \-d-\ with a string made up of names preceded by plus or minus
3418characters. These add or remove sets of debugging data, respectively. For
3419example, \-d+filter-\ adds filter debugging, whereas \-d-all+filter-\ selects
3420only filter debugging. The available debugging categories are:
3421.display flow
3422.tabs 21
3423.
3424. The odd formatting of the lines below is deliberate. It does not affect the
3425. SGCAL output, but by putting in the space it keeps things aligned in the man
3426. page that is automatically generated from this text.
3427.
3428acl $t $rm{ACL interpretation}
3429auth $t $rm{authenticators}
3430deliver $t $rm{general delivery logic}
3431dns $t $rm{DNS lookups (see also resolver)}
3432dnsbl $t $rm{DNS black list (aka RBL) code}
3433exec $t $rm{arguments for \execv@(@)\ calls}
3434expand $t $rm{detailed debugging for string expansions}
3435filter $t $rm{filter handling}
3436hints@_lookup $t $rm{hints data lookups}
3437host@_lookup $t $rm{all types of name-to-IP address handling}
3438ident $t $rm{ident lookup}
3439interface $t $rm{lists of local interfaces}
3440lists $t $rm{matching things in lists}
3441load $t $rm{system load checks}
4964e932 3442local@_scan $t $rm{can be used by \*local@_scan()*\ (see chapter ~~CHAPlocalscan)}
495ae4b0
PH
3443lookup $t $rm{general lookup code and all lookups}
3444memory $t $rm{memory handling}
3445pid $t $rm{add pid to debug output lines}
3446process@_info $t $rm{setting info for the process log}
3447queue@_run $t $rm{queue runs}
3448receive $t $rm{general message reception logic}
3449resolver $t $rm{turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output}
3450retry $t $rm{retry handling}
3451rewrite $t $rm{address rewriting}
3452route $t $rm{address routing}
3453timestamp $t $rm{add timestamp to debug output lines}
3454tls $t $rm{TLS logic}
3455transport $t $rm{transports}
3456uid $t $rm{changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid}
3457verify $t $rm{address verification logic}
3458
3459all $t $rm{all of the above, and also \-v-\}
3460.endd
495ae4b0
PH
3461.index resolver, debugging output
3462.index DNS||resolver, debugging output
4964e932 3463The \"resolver"\ option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
495ae4b0
PH
3464with \\DEBUG\\ enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3465unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3466rather than stderr.
495ae4b0
PH
3467
3468The default (\-d-\ with no argument) omits \"expand"\, \"filter"\,
3469\"interface"\, \"load"\, \"memory"\, \"pid"\, \"resolver"\, and \"timestamp"\.
3470However, the \"pid"\ selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3471daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3472automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3473run in parallel.
3474
3475The \"timestamp"\ selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3476of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3477in processing.
3478
3479If the \debug@_print\ option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3480any debugging is selected, or if \-v-\ is used.
3481
d43194df
PH
3482.em
3483.option dd <<debug options>>
3484This option behaves exactly like \-d-\ except when used on a command that
3485starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3486subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3487behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3488.nem
3489
495ae4b0 3490.option dropcr
4964e932
PH
3491This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3492handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
495ae4b0
PH
3493described in section ~~SECTlineendings.
3494
3495
3496.option E
3497.index bounce message||generating
3498This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3499failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3500and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3501generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3502could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3503follow the characters \-E-\. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3504new message contains the id, following `R=', as a cross-reference.
3505
3506.option e$it{x}
3507There are a number of Sendmail options starting with \-oe-\ which seem to be
3508called by various programs without the leading \o\ in the option. For example,
3509the \vacation\ program uses \-eq-\. Exim treats all options of the form
3510\-e$it{x}-\ as synonymous with the corresponding \-oe$it{x}-\ options.
3511
3512.option F #<<string>>
3513.index sender||name
3514.index name||of sender
3515This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3516message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's \*gecos*\
3517entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3518their \*gecos*\ entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3519between \-F-\ and the <<string>> is optional.
3520
3521.option f #<<address>>
3522.index sender||address
3523.index address||sender
3524.index trusted user
3525.index envelope sender
3526.index user||trusted
3527This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3528message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3529by a trusted user, but \untrusted@_set@_sender\ can be set to allow untrusted
d43194df
PH
3530users to use it.
3531.em
3532Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3533trusted users are defined by the \trusted@_users\ or \trusted@_groups\ options.
3534
3535In the absence of \-f-\, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender of a local
3536message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify domain.
495ae4b0 3537
4964e932 3538There is one exception to the restriction on the use of \-f-\: an empty sender
d43194df
PH
3539can be specified by any user, trusted or not,
3540.nem
3541to create a message that can never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be
3542specified either as an empty string, or as a pair of angle brackets with
3543nothing between them, as in these examples of shell commands:
495ae4b0
PH
3544.display asis
3545exim -f '<>' user@domain
3546exim -f "" user@domain
3547.endd
3548In addition, the use of \-f-\ is not restricted when testing a filter file with
3549\-bf-\ or when testing or verifying addresses using the \-bt-\ or \-bv-\
3550options.
3551
3552Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3553it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the ::From:: header
3554refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a ::Sender:: header,
3555though this can be overridden by setting \no@_local@_from@_check\.
3556
3557.index `From' line
3558White space between \-f-\ and the <<address>> is optional
3559(that is, they can be given as two arguments or one combined argument).
3560The sender of a locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by
3561an initial `From ' line in the message -- see the description of \-bm-\ above
3562-- but if \-f-\ is also present, it overrides `From'.
3563
3564.option G
3565.index Sendmail compatibility||\-G-\ option ignored
3566This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3567
3568.option h #<<number>>
3569.index Sendmail compatibility||\-h-\ option ignored
3570This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3571Sendmail it overrides the `hop count' obtained by counting ::Received::
3572headers.)
3573
3574.option i
3575.index Solaris||\*mail*\ command
3576.index dot||in incoming, non-SMTP message
3577This option, which has the same effect as \-oi-\, specifies that a dot on a
3578line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3579no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the \*mailx*\
3580command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also \-ti-\.
3581
3582.option M #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3583.index forcing delivery
3584.index delivery||forcing attempt
3585.index frozen messages||forcing delivery
3586This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3587any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3588delivery attempt. The settings of \queue@_domains\, \queue@_smtp@_domains\, and
4964e932 3589\hold@_domains\ are ignored.
495ae4b0
PH
3590.index hints database||overriding retry hints
3591Retry hints for any of the addresses are
3592overridden -- Exim tries to deliver even if the normal retry time has not yet
3593been reached. This option requires the caller to be an admin user. However,
3594there is an option called \prod@_requires@_admin\ which can be set false to
3595relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the \-q-\, \-R-\, and
3596\-S-\ options).
3597
3598
3599.option Mar #<<message id>>#<<address>>#<<address>> ...
3600.index message||adding recipients
3601.index recipient||adding
3602This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3603message (`ar' for `add recipients'). The first argument must be a message id,
3604and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3605active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3606can be used only by an admin user.
3607
3608.index SMTP||passed connection
3609.index SMTP||multiple deliveries
3610.index multiple SMTP deliveries
3611.option MC #<<transport>>#<<hostname>>#<<sequence number>>#<<message id>>
3612This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3613by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3614an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3615given in chapter ~~CHAPSMTP. This must be the final option, and the caller must
3616be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3617
3618.option MCA
3619This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3620by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option. It signifies that the connection
3621to the remote host has been authenticated.
3622
3623.option MCP
4964e932
PH
3624This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3625by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option. It signifies that the server to
495ae4b0
PH
3626which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3627
3628.option MCQ #<<process id>> <<pipe fd>>
3629This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3630by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option when the original delivery was
3631started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3632together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3633signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3634messages through the same SMTP connection.
3635
3636.option MCS
3637This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3638by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option, and passes on the fact that the
3639SMTP \\SIZE\\ option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3640connection.
3641
3642.option MCT
3643This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3644by Exim in conjunction with the \-MC-\ option, and passes on the fact that the
3645host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3646
3647.option Mc #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3648.index hints database||not overridden by \-Mc-\
3649.index delivery||manually started, not forced
3650This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3651but unlike the \-M-\ option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3652that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3653provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3654order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter ~~CHAPsecurity).
3655However, \-Mc-\ can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3656respects retry times and other options such as \hold@_domains\ that are
3657overridden when \-M-\ is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3658If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3659\-q-\ with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3660and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3661
3662.option Mes #<<message id>>#<<address>>
3663.index message||changing sender
3664.index sender||changing
3665This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3666given address, which must be a fully qualified address or `<>' (`es' for `edit
3667sender'). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must be a
3668message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message is
3669active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This
3670option can be used only by an admin user.
3671
3672.option Mf #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3673.index freezing messages
3674.index message||manually freezing
3675This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as `frozen'. This
3676prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is `thawed',
3677either manually or as a result of the \auto@_thaw\ configuration option.
3678However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3679attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3680user.
3681
3682.option Mg #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3683.index giving up on messages
3684.index message||abandoning delivery attempts
3685.index delivery||abandoning further attempts
3686This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3687including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4964e932 3688their status is not altered.
495ae4b0
PH
3689For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message is sent to the sender,
3690containing the text `cancelled by administrator'. Bounce messages are just
3691discarded.
3692This option can be used only by an admin user.
3693
3694.option Mmad #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3695.index delivery||cancelling all
3696This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3697as already delivered (`mad' for `mark all delivered'). However, if any message
3698is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3699This option can be used only by an admin user.
3700
3701.option Mmd #<<message id>>#<<address>>#<<address>> ...
3702.index delivery||cancelling by address
3703.index recipient||removing
3704.index removing recipients
3705This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3706(`md' for `mark delivered'). The first argument must be a message id, and the
3707remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3708addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3709(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3710can be used only by an admin user.
3711
3712.option Mrm #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3713.index removing messages
3714.index abandoning mail
3715.index message||manually discarding
3716This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3717bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3718the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3719only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3720placed on the queue.
3721
3722.option Mt #<<message id>>#<<message id>> ...
3723.index thawing messages
3724.index unfreezing messages
3725.index frozen messages||thawing
3726.index message||thawing frozen
3727This option requests Exim to `thaw' any of the listed messages that are
3728`frozen', so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the messages
3729are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an
3730admin user.
3731
3732.option Mvb #<<message id>>
3733.index listing||message body
3734.index message||listing body of
3735This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3736written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3737
3738.option Mvh #<<message id>>
3739.index listing||message headers
3740.index header lines||listing
3741.index message||listing header lines
3742This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3743written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3744
3745.option Mvl #<<message id>>
3746.index listing||message log
3747.index message||listing message log
3748This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3749the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3750
3751.option m
3752This is apparently a synonym for \-om-\ that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3753treats it that way too.
3754
3755.option N
3756.index debugging||\-N-\ option
3757.index debugging||suppressing delivery
3758This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3759level. It implies \-v-\. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery --
3760it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3761had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3762database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with `$*$>' rather
3763than `=>'.
3764
3765Because \-N-\ discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3766user are allowed to use it with \-bd-\, \-q-\, \-R-\ or \-M-\. In other words,
3767an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to which it
3768will apply. Although transportation never fails when \-N-\ is set, an address
3769may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a routing
3770problem. Once \-N-\ has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to the
3771message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen for
3772that message.
3773
3774.option n
3775.index Sendmail compatibility||\-n-\ option ignored
3776This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean `no aliasing'. It is ignored by
3777Exim.
3778
3779.option O #<<data>>
4964e932 3780This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean `set option`. It is ignored by
495ae4b0
PH
3781Exim.
3782
3783.option oA #<<file name>>
3784.index Sendmail compatibility||\-oA-\ option
3785This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with \-bi-\ to specify an
3786alternative alias file name. Exim handles \-bi-\ differently; see the
3787description above.
3788
3789.index SMTP||passed connection
3790.option oB #<<n>>
3791.index SMTP||multiple deliveries
3792.index multiple SMTP deliveries
3793This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3794be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any \%smtp%\
3795transport. If <<n>> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3796
3797.option odb
3798.index background delivery
3799.index delivery||in the background
3800This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3801including the listening daemon. It requests `background' delivery of such
d43194df
PH
3802messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3803delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3804processes to finish.
3805.em
3806When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits, leaving
3807the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output and
3808error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3809.nem
3810This is the default action if none of the \-od-\ options are present.
495ae4b0
PH
3811
3812If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3813(\queue@_only\ or \queue@_only@_file\, for example) is in effect, \-odb-\
3814overrides it if \queue@_only@_override\ is set true, which is the default
3815setting. If \queue@_only@_override\ is set false, \-odb-\ has no effect.
3816
3817.option odf
3818.index foreground delivery
3819.index delivery||in the foreground
3820This option requests `foreground' (synchronous) delivery when Exim has accepted
3821a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3822\-odb-\.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the
3823message, and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
d43194df
PH
3824.em
3825The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3826process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3827during deliveries.
3828.nem
4964e932 3829However, like \-odb-\, this option has no effect if \queue@_only@_override\ is
495ae4b0
PH
3830false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3831
d43194df
PH
3832.em
3833If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the message
3834is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception process
3835exists. See chapter ~~CHAPnonqueueing for a way of setting up a restricted
3836configuration that never queues messages.
3837.nem
3838
495ae4b0
PH
3839.option odi
3840This option is synonymous with \-odf-\. It is provided for compatibility with
3841Sendmail.
3842
3843.option odq
3844.index non-immediate delivery
3845.index delivery||suppressing immediate
3846.index queueing incoming messages
3847This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3848including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3849not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3850are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3851process encounters them.
3852There are several configuration options (such as \queue@_only\) that can be
3853used to queue incoming messages under certain conditions. This option overrides
3854all of them and also \-odqs-\. It always forces queueing.
3855
3856.option odqs
3857.index SMTP||delaying delivery
4964e932 3858This option is a hybrid between \-odb-\/\-odi-\ and \-odq-\.
495ae4b0
PH
3859However, like \-odb-\ and \-odi-\, this option has no effect if
3860\queue@_only@_override\ is false and one of the queueing options in the
3861configuration file is in effect.
3862
3863When \-odqs-\ does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3864message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if \-odi-\ is also
3865present.
3866The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done in the normal
3867way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not done at this
3868time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue runner
3869process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which messages are
3870waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same host can be
3871sent in a single SMTP connection. The \queue@_smtp@_domains\ configuration
3872option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the \-qq-\ option.
3873
3874.option oee
3875.index error||reporting
3876If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3877example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3878message.
3879.index return code||for \-oee-\
3880Provided this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3881exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3882is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3883the default \-oe$it{x}-\ option if Exim is called as \*rmail*\.
3884
3885.option oem
3886.index error||reporting
3887.index return code||for \-oem-\
3888This is the same as \-oee-\, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3889return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3890This is the default \-oe$it{x}-\ option, unless Exim is called as \*rmail*\.
3891
3892.option oep
3893.index error||reporting
3894If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3895error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3896.index return code||for \-oep-\
3897The return code is 1 for all errors.
3898
3899.option oeq
3900.index error||reporting
3901This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3902effect as \-oep-\.
3903
3904.option oew
3905.index error||reporting
3906This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3907effect as \-oem-\.
3908
3909.option oi
3910.index dot||in incoming, non-SMTP message
3911This option, which has the same effect as \-i-\, specifies that a dot on a line
3912by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
4964e932 3913Otherwise, a single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing
495ae4b0 3914for other lines that start with a dot.
495ae4b0
PH
3915This option is set by default if Exim is called as \*rmail*\. See also \-ti-\.
3916
3917.option oitrue
3918This option is treated as synonymous with \-oi-\.
3919
3920.option oMa #<<host address>>
3921.index sender||host address, specifying for local message
3922A number of options starting with \-oM-\ can be used to set values associated
3923with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3924over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4964e932 3925\-bh-\,
495ae4b0
PH
3926\-be-\,
3927\-bf-\, \-bF-\, \-bt-\, or \-bv-\ testing options. In other circumstances, they
3928are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3929
3930The \-oMa-\ option sets the sender host address. This may include a port number
3931at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3932.display asis
3933exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3934.endd
3935An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets, followed
3936by a colon and the port number:
3937.display asis
3938exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3939.endd
3940The IP address is placed in the \$sender@_host@_address$\ variable, and the
3941port, if present, in \$sender@_host@_port$\.
3942
3943.option oMaa #<<name>>
3944.index authentication||name, specifying for local message
3945See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMaa-\
3946option sets the value of \$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ (the authenticator
3947name). See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3948
3949.option oMai #<<string>>
3950.index authentication||id, specifying for local message
3951See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMai-\
4964e932 3952option sets the
495ae4b0
PH
3953value of \$authenticated@_id$\ (the id that was authenticated).
3954This overrides the default value (the caller's login id) for messages from
3955local sources. See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for a discussion of authenticated
3956ids.
3957
3958.option oMas #<<address>>
3959.index authentication||sender, specifying for local message
3960See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMas-\
3961option sets the authenticated sender value
4964e932 3962in \$authenticated@_sender$\.
495ae4b0
PH
3963It overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
3964messages from local sources. See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for a discussion of
3965authenticated senders.
3966
3967.option oMi #<<interface address>>
3968.index interface||address, specifying for local message
3969See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMi-\
3970option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
3971using the same syntax as for \-oMa-\.
4964e932 3972The interface address is placed in \$interface@_address$\ and the port number,
495ae4b0
PH
3973if present, in \$interface@_port$\.
3974
3975.option oMr #<<protocol name>>
3976.index protocol||incoming, specifying for local message
3977See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMr-\
d43194df
PH
3978option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
3979\$received@_protocol$\. However, this applies only when \-bs-\ is not used. For
3980interactive SMTP input (\-bs-\), the protocol is always
3981.em
3982`local-' followed by one of the standard SMTP protocol names (see the
3983description of \$received@_protocol$\ in section ~~SECTexpvar).
3984.nem
3985For \-bS-\ (batch SMTP) however, the protocol can be set by \-oMr-\.
495ae4b0
PH
3986
3987.option oMs #<<host name>>
3988.index sender||host name, specifying for local message
3989See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMs-\
4964e932
PH
3990option sets the sender host name
3991in \$sender@_host@_name$\. When this option is present, Exim does not attempt
495ae4b0
PH
3992to look up a host name from an IP address; it uses the name it is given.
3993
3994.option oMt #<<ident string>>
3995.index sender||ident string, specifying for local message
3996See \-oMa-\ above for general remarks about the \-oM-\ options. The \-oMt-\
3997option sets the sender ident value
4964e932 3998in \$sender@_ident$\.
495ae4b0
PH
3999The default setting for local callers is the login id of the calling process.
4000
4001.option om
4002.index Sendmail compatibility||\-om-\ option ignored
4003In Sendmail, this option means `me too', indicating that the sender of a
4004message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4005expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4006
4007.option oo
4008.index Sendmail compatibility||\-oo-\ option ignored
4009This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies `old style headers', whatever
4010that means.
4011
4012.option oP #<<path>>
4013.index pid (process id)||of daemon
4014.index daemon||process id (pid)
4964e932 4015This option is useful only in conjunction with \-bd-\ or \-q-\ with a time
495ae4b0
PH
4016value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4017written. When \-oX-\ is used with \-bd-\, or when \-q-\ with a time is used
4018without \-bd-\, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4019because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4020
4021.option or #<<time>>
4022.index timeout||for non-SMTP input
4023This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4024set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4025by the \receive@_timeout\ option. The format used for specifying times is
4026described in section ~~SECTtimeformat.
4027
4028.option os #<<time>>
4029.index timeout||for SMTP input
4030.index SMTP||timeout, input
4031This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4032applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4033the \smtp@_receive@_timeout\ option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4034for specifying times is described in section ~~SECTtimeformat.
4035
4036.option ov
4037This option has exactly the same effect as \-v-\.
4038
4039.option oX #<<number or string>>
4040.index TCP/IP||setting listening ports
4041.index TCP/IP||setting listening interfaces
4042.index port||receiving TCP/IP
4043This option is relevant only when the \-bd-\ (start listening daemon) option is
4044also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details of
4045the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given in
4046chapter ~~CHAPinterfaces. When \-oX-\ is used to start a daemon, no pid file is
4047written unless \-oP-\ is also present to specify a pid file name.
4048
4049.option pd
4050.index Perl||starting the interpreter
4051This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4052chapter ~~CHAPperl). It overrides the setting of the \perl@_at@_start\ option,
4053forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is needed.
4054
4055.option ps
4056.index Perl||starting the interpreter
4057This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4058chapter ~~CHAPperl). It overrides the setting of the \perl@_at@_start\ option,
4059forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is started.
4060
495ae4b0
PH
4061.option p<<rval>>:<<sval>>
4062For compatibility with Sendmail, this option
4063is equivalent to
4964e932 4064.display
495ae4b0
PH
4065-oMr <<rval>> -oMs <<sval>>
4066.endd
4067It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4068host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4069Note the Exim already has two private options, \-pd-\ and \-ps-\, that refer to
4070embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of \"p"\ or
4071\"s"\ using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
495ae4b0
PH
4072
4073.option q
4074.index queue runner||starting manually
4075This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4076configuration option called \prod@_requires@_admin\ which can be set false to
4077relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the \-M-\, \-R-\, and
4078\-S-\ options).
4079
4080.index queue runner||description of operation
4081The \-q-\ option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4082waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4083for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4084process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4085have not been reached. Use \-qf-\ (see below) if you want to override this.
4086.index SMTP||passed connection
4087.index SMTP||multiple deliveries
4088.index multiple SMTP deliveries
4089If the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4090passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4091proceeding.
4092
4093When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4094process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4095mail, one message at a time. Use \-q-\ with a time (see below) if you want this
4096to be repeated periodically.
4097
4098Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4099random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4100If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4101MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4102
4103It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4104order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4105\queue@_run@_in@_order\ option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4106
4107.option q <<qflags>>
4108The \-q-\ option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4109behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4110appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4111
4112.option qq...
4113.index queue||double scanning
4114.index queue||routing
4115.index routing||whole queue before delivery
4116An option starting with \-qq-\ requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4117stage, the queue is scanned as if the \queue@_smtp@_domains\ option matched
4118every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4964e932 4119transports are run.
495ae4b0
PH
4120.index hints database||remembering routing
4121The hints database that remembers which messages are
4122waiting for specific hosts is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been
4123deferred. After this is complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with
4124routing and delivery taking place as normal. Messages that are routed to the
4125same host should mostly be delivered down a single SMTP
4126.index SMTP||passed connection
4127.index SMTP||multiple deliveries
4128.index multiple SMTP deliveries
4129connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4130This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4131intermittently.
4132
4133.option q[q]i...
4134.index queue||initial delivery
4135If the \*i*\ flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4136those messages that haven't previously been tried. (\*i*\ stands for `initial
4137delivery'.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4138\-odq-\ and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4139
4140.option q[q][i]f...
4964e932 4141.index queue||forcing delivery
495ae4b0
PH
4142.index delivery||forcing in queue run
4143If one \*f*\ flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4144message, whereas without \f\ only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4145their retry times are tried.
4146
4147.option q[q][i]ff...
4148.index frozen messages||forcing delivery
4149If \*ff*\ is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4150frozen or not.
4151
4152.option q[q][i][f[f]]l
4153.index queue||local deliveries only
4154The \*l*\ (the letter `ell') flag specifies that only local deliveries are to be
4155done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue for
4156later delivery.
4157
4158.option q <<qflags>>#<<start id>>#<<end id>>
4159.index queue||delivering specific messages
4160When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4161lexically less than a given value by following the \-q-\ option with a starting
4162message id. For example:
4163.display
4164exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4165.endd
4166Messages that arrived earlier than \"0t5C6f-0000c8-00"\ are not inspected. If a
4167second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4168are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4169.display
4170exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4171.endd
4172just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from \-M-\
4173in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from \-Mc-\ in that it
4174counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection mechanism does
4175not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There are also other
4176ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a queue run -- see
4177\-R-\ and \-S-\.
4178
4179.option q <<qflags>><<time>>
4180.index queue runner||starting periodically
4181.index periodic queue running
4182When a time value is present, the \-q-\ option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4183starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4184(whose format is described in section ~~SECTtimeformat). This form of the \-q-\
4185option is commonly combined with the \-bd-\ option, in which case a single
4186daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a combined
4187daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4188.display
4189/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4190.endd
4191Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4192process every 30 minutes.
4193
4964e932 4194When a daemon is started by \-q-\ with a time value, but without \-bd-\, no pid
495ae4b0
PH
4195file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the \-oP-\ option.
4196
4197.option qR <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4198This option is synonymous with \-R-\. It is provided for Sendmail
4199compatibility.
4200
4201.option qS <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4202This option is synonymous with \-S-\.
4203
4204.option R <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4205.index queue runner||for specific recipients
4206.index delivery||to given domain
4207.index domain||delivery to
4208The <<rsflags>> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4209is optional, unless the string is \*f*\, \*ff*\, \*r*\, \*rf*\, or \*rff*\,
4210which are the possible values for <<rsflags>>. White space is required if
4211<<rsflags>> is not empty.
4212
4213This option is similar to \-q-\ with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4214perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4215queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4216address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4217way. If the <<rsflags>> start with \*r*\, <<string>> is interpreted as a regular
4218expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4219
4220Once a message is selected, all its addresses are processed. For the first
4221selected message, Exim overrides any retry information and forces a delivery
4222attempt for each undelivered address. This means that if delivery of any
4223address in the first message is successful, any existing retry information is
4224deleted, and so delivery attempts for that address in subsequently selected
4225messages (which are processed without forcing) will run. However, if delivery
4226of any address does not succeed, the retry information is updated, and in
4227subsequently selected messages, the failing address will be skipped.
4228
4229If the <<rsflags>> contain \*f*\ or \*ff*\, the delivery forcing applies to all
4230selected messages, not just the first;
4231.index frozen messages||forcing delivery
4232frozen messages are included when \*ff*\ is present.
4233
4234The \-R-\ option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4235to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4236command \\ETRN\\ is accepted by its ACL (see chapter ~~CHAPACL), its default
4237effect is to run Exim with the \-R-\ option, but it can be configured to run an
4238arbitrary command instead.
4239
4240.option r
4241This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for \-f-\.
4242
4243.index delivery||from given sender
4244.option S <<rsflags>>#<<string>>
4245.index queue runner||for specific senders
4246This option acts like \-R-\ except that it checks the string against each
4247message's sender instead of against the recipients. If \-R-\ is also set, both
4248conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4249has \*f*\ or \*ff*\ in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4250
495ae4b0
PH
4251.option Tqt#<<times>>
4252This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite.
4253It is not recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up
4964e932
PH
4254of explicit `queue times' so that various warning/retry features can be
4255tested.
495ae4b0
PH
4256
4257.option t
4258.index recipient||extracting from header lines
4259.index ::Bcc:: header line
4260.index ::Cc:: header line
4261.index ::To:: header line
4262When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4263input, the \-t-\ option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4264from the ::To::, ::Cc::, and ::Bcc:: header lines in the message instead of from
4265the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting takes
4266place.
4267
4268.index Sendmail compatibility||\-t-\ option
4269If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4270is $it{not} to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4271the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4272and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4273Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4274Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail $it{add}
4275argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4276Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4277instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4278\extract__addresses__remove__arguments\ false.
4279
4280If a ::Bcc:: header line is present, it is removed from the message unless
4281there is no ::To:: or ::Cc::, in which case a ::Bcc:: line with no data is
4282created. This is necessary for conformity with the original RFC 822 standard;
4283the requirement has been removed in RFC 2822, but that is still very new.
4284
4285.index \Resent@-\ header lines||with \-t-\
4964e932 4286If there are any \Resent@-\ header lines in the message, Exim extracts
495ae4b0 4287recipients from all ::Resent-To::, ::Resent-Cc::, and ::Resent-Bcc:: header
4964e932
PH
4288lines instead of from ::To::, ::Cc::, and ::Bcc::. This is for compatibility
4289with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
495ae4b0
PH
4290\-t-\ was used in conjunction with \Resent@-\ header lines.)
4291
4292RFC 2822 talks about different sets of \Resent@-\ header lines (for when a
4293message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4294added at the front of the message, and separated by ::Received:: lines. It is
4295not at all clear how \-t-\ should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4296nor indeed exactly what constitutes a `set'.
4297In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The \Resent@-\ lines are
4298often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4299once, it is common for the original set of \Resent@-\ headers to be renamed as
4300\X-Resent@-\ when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4301
4302.option ti
4964e932 4303This option is exactly equivalent to \-t-\ \-i-\. It is provided for
495ae4b0
PH
4304compatibility with Sendmail.
4305
4306.option tls-on-connect
4307.index TLS||use without STARTTLS
4308.index TLS||automatic start
d43194df
PH
4309This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support.
4310.em
4311It forces all incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is
4312listed in the \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ option. See section ~~SECTsupobssmt and
4313chapter ~~CHAPTLS for further details.
4314.nem
495ae4b0
PH
4315
4316.option U
4317.index Sendmail compatibility||\-U-\ option ignored
4318Sendmail uses this option for `initial message submission', and its
4319documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4320syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4321set. Exim ignores this option.
4322
4323.option v
4324This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4325describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4326receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4327dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4328the log if the setting of \log@_selector\ discards them. Any relevant selectors
4329are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is unconditional.
4330
4331.option x
4332AIX uses \-x-\ for a private purpose (`mail from a local mail program has
4333National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item').
4334It sets \-x-\ when calling the MTA from its \mail\ command. Exim ignores this
4335option.
4336
4337.endoptions
4338
4339
4340
4341.
4342.
4343.
4344.
4345. ============================================================================
4346.chapter The Exim run time configuration file
4347.set runningfoot "configuration file"
4348.rset CHAPconf ~~chapter
4349
4350.index run time configuration
4351.index configuration file||general description
4352.index \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
d43194df
PH
4353.index configuration file||errors in
4354.index error||in configuration file
4355.index return code||for bad configuration
495ae4b0
PH
4356Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4357binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4964e932 4358because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
495ae4b0
PH
4359control.
4360
d43194df
PH
4361.em
4362If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4363writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4364The message is also written to the panic log. \**Note**\: only simple syntax
4365errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4366not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4367actually alter the string.
4368.nem
4369
4370
495ae4b0
PH
4371The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4372reasons, and is specified by the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ compilation option. In
4373most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4374give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4375existing file in the list.
4376
4377.index \\EXIM@_USER\\
4378.index \\EXIM@_GROUP\\
d43194df
PH
4379.index \\CONFIGURE@_OWNER\\
4380.index \\CONFIGURE@_GROUP\\
495ae4b0
PH
4381.index configuration file||ownership
4382.index ownership||configuration file
d43194df
PH
4383The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4384specified at compile time by the \\EXIM@_USER\\ option, or by the user that is
4385specified at compile time by the \\CONFIGURE@_OWNER\\ option (if set). The
4386configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4387group is the one specified at compile time by the \\EXIM@_GROUP\\ option
4388.em
4389or by the \\CONFIGURE@_GROUP\\ option.
4390.nem
495ae4b0 4391
4964e932
PH
4392\**Warning**\: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4393to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4394easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4395of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
495ae4b0
PH
4396configuration is not group writeable.
4397
495ae4b0 4398A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
d43194df
PH
4399is provided in the file \(src/configure.default)\. If \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\
4400defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4401configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4402\\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4403~~CHAPdefconfil is a `walk-through' discussion of the default configuration.
495ae4b0
PH
4404
4405
4406.section Using a different configuration file
4407.index configuration file||alternate
4408A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the \-C-\ command line
4409option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when \-C-\
4410is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the Exim
4964e932 4411user (or unless the argument for \-C-\ is identical to the built-in value from
495ae4b0
PH
4412\\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\). \-C-\ is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4413configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4414on a configuration file specified by \-C-\.
4415
4416The privileged use of \-C-\ by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4417\\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ when building Exim. However,
4418if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4419configuration using \-C-\ right through message reception and delivery, even if
4420the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as
4421the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4422use of \-C-\ causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4964e932 4423delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
495ae4b0
PH
4424\-odq-\, and another to do the delivery, using \-M-\).
4425
4426If \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ is defined \(in Local/Makefile)\, it specifies a
4427prefix string with which any file named in a \-C-\ command line option must
4428start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence \"/../"\. There
4429is no default setting for \\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\; when it is unset, any file
4430name can be used with \-C-\.
4431
4432One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the \-D-\ command line
4964e932 4433option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
495ae4b0
PH
4434configuration file. However, like \-C-\, the use of this option by a
4435non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4436If \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, the use of \-D-\ is
4437completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4438
4439Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4440share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4441If \\CONFIGURE@_FILE@_USE@_NODE\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, Exim first
4442looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4443and the machine's node name, as obtained from the \*uname()*\ function. If this
4964e932 4444file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
495ae4b0
PH
4445each file name in the list given by \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ or \-C-\.
4446
4447In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4448different effective uids and the \\CONFIGURE@_FILE@_USE@_EUID\\ is defined to
4449help with this. See the comments in \(src/EDITME)\ for details.
4450
4451
4452.section Configuration file format
4453.rset SECTconffilfor "~~chapter.~~section"
4454.index configuration file||format of
4455.index format||configuration file
4456Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4457option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4458are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4459is introduced by the word `begin' followed by the name of the part. The
4460optional parts are:
4461
4462.numberpars $.
4463\*ACL*\: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail.
4464.nextp
4465.index \\AUTH\\||configuration
4466\*authenticators*\: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4467are concerned with the SMTP \\AUTH\\ command (see chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH).
4468.nextp
4469\*routers*\: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4470addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered.
4471.nextp
4472\*transports*\: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4473define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations.
4474.nextp
4475\*retry*\: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be immediately delivered.
4476.nextp
4477\*rewrite*\: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4478when new addresses are generated during delivery.
4479.nextp
4480\*local@_scan*\: Private options for the \*local@_scan()*\ function. If you
4481want to use this feature, you must set
4482.display asis
4483LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4484.endd
4964e932 4485in \(Local/Makefile)\ before building Exim. Full details of the
495ae4b0
PH
4486\*local@_scan()*\ facility are given in chapter ~~CHAPlocalscan.
4487.endp
d43194df
PH
4488.index configuration file||leading whitespace in
4489.index configuration file||trailing whitespace in
4490.index whitespace||in configuration file
4491.em
4492Leading and trailing whitespace in configuration lines is always ignored.
4493.nem
495ae4b0
PH
4494Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a @# character (ignoring
4495leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. \**Note**\: a
4496@# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4497and does not introduce a comment.
4498
d43194df
PH
4499Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash.
4500.em
4501Note that the general rule for whitespace means that trailing white space after
4502the backslash is ignored, and leading white space at the start of continuation
4503lines is also ignored.
4504.nem
495ae4b0
PH
4505Comment lines beginning with @# (but not empty lines) may appear in the middle
4506of a sequence of continuation lines.
4507
4508A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4509default, which is supplied in \(src/configure.default)\, and add, delete, or
4510change settings as required.
4511
4512The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4513described in chapters ~~CHAPACL, ~~CHAPretry, and ~~CHAPrewrite, respectively.
4514The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic items in common,
4515and these are described below, from section ~~SECTcos onwards. Before that, the
4516inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are described.
4517
4518
4519.section File inclusions in the configuration file
4520.index inclusions in configuration file
4521.index configuration file||including other files
4522.index .include in configuration file
4523.index .include@_if@_exists in configuration file
4524You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4525using this syntax:
4526.display
4527@.include <<file name>>
4528.endd
4529or
4530.display
4531@.include@_if@_exists <<file name>>
4532.endd
4964e932
PH
4533on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4534the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
495ae4b0
PH
4535second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4536
4537Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4538configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4539If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4540because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4541
4542The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4543comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4544for example:
4545.display asis
4546hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4547 .include /some/file
4548.endd
4964e932
PH
4549Include processing happens
4550after
495ae4b0
PH
4551macro processing (see below). Its effect is to process the lines of the file as
4552if they occurred inline where the inclusion appears.
4553
4554
4555.section Macros in the configuration file
4556.rset SECTmacrodefs "~~chapter.~~section"
4557.index macro||description of
4558.index configuration file||macros
4559If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4560`begin' line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4561definition, and must be of the form
4562.display
4563<<name>> = <<rest of line>>
4564.endd
4565The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4566in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4567continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4568space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4569a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4570
4571Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4572files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4573scanned for each in turn, in the order in which they are defined. The
4574replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4575for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4576the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4577define
4578.display asis
4579ABCD_XYZ = <<something>>
4580ABCD = <<something else>>
4581.endd
4582but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4583error.
4584
4585Macro expansion is applied to individual lines from the file, before checking
4586for line continuation or file inclusion (see below). If a line consists solely
4587of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the line is ignored.
4588A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a comment line or a
4589\".include"\ line.
4590
4591As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4592up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4593strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4594.display asis
4595ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4596 login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
4597.endd
4598This can then be used in a \%redirect%\ router setting like this:
4599.display asis
4600data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4601.endd
4602In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4603address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists -- see section
4604~~SECTnamedlists.
4605
4606Macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the \-D-\ command line
4607option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when \-D-\ is used, unless called
4608by root or the Exim user.
4609
4610
4611.section Conditional skips in the configuration file
4612.index configuration file||conditional skips
4613.index .ifdef
4614You can use the directives \".ifdef"\, \".ifndef"\, \".elifdef"\,
4964e932
PH
4615\".elifndef"\, \".else"\, and \".endif"\ to dynamically include or exclude
4616portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4617read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
495ae4b0
PH
4618
4619The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4620be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4621that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4622line. Thus:
4623.display
4624@.ifdef AAA
4625message@_size@_limit = 50M
4626@.else
4627message@_size@_limit = 100M
4628@.endif
4629.endd
4630sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro \"AAA"\ is defined, and 100M
4631otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4632is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an `or' condition. To
4633obtain an `and' condition, you need to use nested \".ifdef"\s.
4634
4635Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4636it is not very useful, because the condition `there was a macro substitution
4637in this line' will always be true.
4638
4639Text following \".else"\ and \".endif"\ is ignored, and can be used as comment
4640to clarify complicated nestings.
4641
4642
4643.section Common option syntax
4644.rset SECTcos "~~chapter.~~section"
4645.index common option syntax
4646.index syntax of common options
4647.index configuration file||common option syntax
4648For the main set of options, driver options, and \*local@_scan()*\ options,
4649each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4650lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4651these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4652space) and then the value. For example:
4653.display asis
4654qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4655.endd
4656Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4657accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the \-bP-\ command line
4658option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the word
4659`hide'. For example:
4660.display asis
4661hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4662.endd
4663For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4664.display asis
4665mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4666.endd
4667If `hide' is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on all
4668instances of the same driver.
4669
4670The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4671that are found in option settings.
4672
4673.section Boolean options
4674.index format||boolean
4675.index boolean configuration values
4676Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4677different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4678the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4679if it is preceded by `no@_' or `not@_' the switch is turned off. However,
4680boolean options may optionally be followed by an equals sign and one of the
4681words `true', `false', `yes', or `no', as an alternative syntax. For example,
4682the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4683.display asis
4684queue_only
4685queue_only = true
4686.endd
4687The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4688.display asis
4689no_queue_only
4690queue_only = false
4691.endd
4692You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4693
4694
4695
4696.section Integer values
4697.index integer configuration values
4698.index format||integer
4699If an integer data item starts with the characters `0x', the remainder of it
4700is interpreted as a hexadecimal number. Otherwise, it is treated as octal if it
4701starts with the digit 0, and decimal if not. If an integer value is followed by
4702the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if it is followed by the letter M, it
4703is multiplied by 1024x1024.
4704
4705When the values of integer option settings are output, values which are an
4964e932 4706exact multiple of 1024 or 1024x1024 are
495ae4b0
PH
4707sometimes, but not always,
4708printed using the letters K and M. The printing style is independent of the
4709actual input format that was used.
4710
4711.section Octal integer values
4712.index integer format
4713.index format||octal integer
4714The value of an option specified as an octal integer is always interpreted in
4715octal, whether or not it starts with the digit zero. Such options are always
4716output in octal.
4717
4718
4719.section Fixed point number values
4720.index fixed point configuration values
4721.index format||fixed point
4722A fixed point number consists of a decimal integer, optionally followed by a
4723decimal point and up to three further digits.
4724
4725
4726.section Time interval values
4727.index time interval||specifying in configuration
4728.index format||time interval
4729.rset SECTtimeformat "~~chapter.~~section"
4730A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4731the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4732.display rm
4733.tabs 5
4734\s\ $t seconds
4735\m\ $t minutes
4736\h\ $t hours
4737\d\ $t days
4738\w\ $t weeks
4739.endd
4740For example, `3h50m' specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4741intervals are output in the same format.
4964e932 4742Exim does not restrict the values; it is perfectly acceptable, for example, to
495ae4b0
PH
4743specify `90m' instead of `1h30m'.
4744
4745
4746.section String values
4747.index string||format of configuration values
4748.index format||string
4749.rset SECTstrings "~~chapter.~~section"
4750If a string data item does not start with a double-quote character, it is taken
4751as consisting of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines,
4752starting at the first character after any leading white space, with trailing
4753white space characters removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in
4754the string. Because Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with @#) at an
4755early stage, they can appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The
4756following settings are therefore equivalent:
4757.display asis
4758trusted_users = uucp:mail
4759
4760trusted_users = uucp:\
4761 # This comment line is ignored
4762 mail
4763.endd
4764.index string||quoted
4765.index escape characters in quoted strings
4766If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4767double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4768continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4769.display
4770.tabs 15
4771@\@\ $t $rm{single backslash}
4772@\n $t $rm{newline}
4773@\r $t $rm{carriage return}
4774@\t $t $rm{tab}
4775@\<<octal digits>> $t $rm{up to 3 octal digits specify one character}
4776@\x<<hex digits>> $t $rm{up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one character}
4777.endd
4778If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4779character, that character replaces the pair.
4780
4781Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4782insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4783trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4784current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4785in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4786and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4787
4788.section Expanded strings
4789.index string||expansion, definition of
4790.index expansion||definition of
4791Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to \*string expansion*\,
4792by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4793circumstances (see chapter ~~CHAPexpand). The input syntax for such strings is
4794as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted strings
4795is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place. However,
4796backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any backslashes that
4797are required for that reason must be doubled if they are within a quoted
4798configuration string.
4799
4800.section User and group names
4801.index user name||format of
4802.index format||user name
4803.index group||name format
4804.index format||group name
4805User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4806above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4807either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4808\*getpwnam()*\ or \*getgrnam()*\ function, as appropriate.
4809
4810.section List construction
4811.index list||syntax of in configuration
4812.index format||list item in configuration
4813.index string list, definition
4814.rset SECTlistconstruct "~~chapter.~~section"
d43194df
PH
4815The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4816default separator. Many of these options are shown with type `string list' in
4817the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as `domain list',
4818`host list', `address list', or `local part list'. Syntactically, they are all
4819the same; however, those other than `string list' are subject to particular
4820kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter ~~CHAPdomhosaddlists.
495ae4b0
PH
4821
4822In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4823input syntax is concerned. The \trusted@_users\ setting in section
4824~~SECTstrings above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item in
4825a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space on
4826each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4827start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4828example, the list
4829.display asis
4830local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4831.endd
4832contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address
d43194df 4833@:@:1.
495ae4b0
PH
4834.index list||separator, changing
4835.index IPv6||addresses in lists
d43194df
PH
4836Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4837introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4838with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4839character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4840above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
495ae4b0
PH
4841.display asis
4842local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4843.endd
4844This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4845\log@_file@_path\. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4846confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4847
4848
d43194df
PH
4849.em
4850.section Empty items in lists
4851.rset SECTempitelis "~~chapter.~~section"
4852.index list||empty item in
4853An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
4854separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
4855.display asis
4856senders = user@domain :
4857.endd
4858contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
4859in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
4860items, the second of which is empty:
4861.display asis
4862senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
4863.endd
4864\**Note**\: there must be whitespace between the two colons, as otherwise they
4865are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
4866would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
4867just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
4868.display asis
4869senders = :
4870.endd
4871In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
4872is at the end of the list.
4873.nem
4874
4875
495ae4b0
PH
4876.section Format of driver configurations
4877.rset SECTfordricon "~~chapter.~~section"
4878.index drivers||configuration format
4879There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
4880and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
4881instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
4882a sequence of lines like this:
4883.display
4884<<instance name>>:
4885 <<option>>
4886 ...
4887 <<option>>
4888.endd
4889In the following example, the instance name is \%localuser%\, and it is
4890followed by three options settings:
4891.display asis
4892localuser:
4893 driver = accept
4894 check_local_user
4895 transport = local_delivery
4896.endd
4964e932 4897For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses -- by the
495ae4b0
PH
4898setting of the \driver\ option -- and (optionally) some configuration settings.
4899For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to deliver with
4900SMTP you would use the \%smtp%\ driver; if you want to deliver to a local file
4901you would use the \%appendfile%\ driver. Each of the drivers is described in
4902detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
4903
4904You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
4905the same underlying driver (each must have a different name).
4906
4907The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
4908passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
4909transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
4910authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
4911them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
4912server.
4913
4914.index generic options
4915.index options||generic, definition of
4916Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option:
4917$it{generic} and $it{private}. The generic options are those that apply to all
4918drivers of the same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all
4919authenticators).
4920The \driver\ option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
4921.index private options
4922The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
4923they all have default values.
4924
4925The options may appear in any order, except that the \driver\ option must
4926precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
4927this reason, it is recommended that \driver\ always be the first option.
4928
4929Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
4930elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
4931with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
4932a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
4933instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
4934confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
4935configuration lines:
4936.display asis
4937remote_smtp:
4938 driver = smtp
4939.endd
4940create an instance of the \%smtp%\ transport driver whose name is
4941\%remote@_smtp%\. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
4942different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
4943instance of the \%smtp%\ transport, with different options, might be defined
4944thus:
4945.display asis
4946special_smtp:
4947 driver = smtp
4948 port = 1234
4949 command_timeout = 10s
4950.endd
4951The names \%remote@_smtp%\ and \%special@_smtp%\ would be used to reference
4952these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
4953lines.
4954
4955Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
4956list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
4957defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the \-bP-\ command line
4958option.
4959
4960
4961
4962
4963
4964
4965.
4966.
4967.
4968.
4969. ============================================================================
4970.chapter The default configuration file
4971.set runningfoot "default configuration"
4972.rset CHAPdefconfil "~~chapter"
4973.index configuration file||default, `walk through'
4974.index default||configuration file `walk through'
4975The default configuration file supplied with Exim as \(src/configure.default)\
4976is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
4977the way Exim is configured, this chapter `walks through' the default
4978configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
4979of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
4980itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
4981initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
4982mentioned at all in the default configuration.
4983
4984
4985.section Main configuration settings
4986The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
4987file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
4988the line
4989.display asis
4990# primary_hostname =
4991.endd
4992This is a commented-out setting of the \primary@_hostname\ option. Exim needs
4993to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
4994can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
4995it is unset, Exim uses the \*uname()*\ system function to obtain the host name.
4996
4997The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
4998.display asis
4999domainlist local_domains = @
5000domainlist relay_to_domains =
5001hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5002.endd
5003These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5004domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5005domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5006configuration file (see section ~~SECTnamedlists).
5007
5008The first line defines a domain list called \*local@_domains*\; this is used
5009later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
4964e932 5010on the local host.
495ae4b0
PH
5011.index @@ in a domain list
5012There is just one item in this list, the string `@@'. This is a special form of
5013entry which means `the name of the local host'. Thus, if the local host is
5014called \*a.host.example*\, mail to \*any.user@@a.host.example*\ is expected to
5015be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5016the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5017
5018The second line defines a domain list called \*relay@_to@_domains*\, but the
5019list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5020controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5021domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5022domain is permitted.
5023
5024The third line defines a host list called \*relay@_from@_hosts*\. This list is
5025used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5026that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5027loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5028submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5029hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5030
5031Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5032we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5033and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5034
5035The next configuration line is a genuine option setting:
5036.display asis
5037acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5038.endd
5039This option specifies an \*Access Control List*\ (ACL) which is to be used
4964e932 5040during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every
495ae4b0
PH
5041\\RCPT\\ command). The name of the list is \*acl@_check@_rcpt*\, and we will
5042come to its definition below, in the ACL section of the configuration. ACLs
5043control which recipients are accepted for an incoming message -- if a
5044configuration does not provide an ACL to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be
5045accepted.
5046
5047Two commented-out options settings are next:
5048.display asis
5049# qualify_domain =
5050# qualify_recipient =
5051.endd
5052The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5053complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5054receives a message from a local process. If you do not set \qualify@_domain\,
5055the value of \primary@_hostname\ is used. If you set both of these options, you
5056can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient addresses. If
5057you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5058
5059.index domain literal||recognizing format
5060The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5061addresses of the form \*user@@[10.11.12.13]*\ that is, with a `domain literal'
5062(an IP address) instead of a named domain.
5063.display asis
5064# allow_domain_literals
5065.endd
495ae4b0
PH
5066The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5067Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5068quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5069try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
4964e932 5070people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
495ae4b0 5071\*postmaster*\) where domain literals are still useful.
495ae4b0
PH
5072
5073The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5074.display asis
5075never_users = root
5076.endd
5077It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5078convention is to set up \*root*\ as an alias for the system administrator. This
5079setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5080The list of users specified by \never@_users\ is not, however, the complete
5081list; the build-time configuration in \(Local/Makefile)\ has an option called
5082\\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
4964e932 5083contents of \never@_users\ are added to this list. By default
495ae4b0
PH
5084\\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ also specifies root.
5085
5086When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5087Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5088line,
5089.display asis
5090host_lookup = *
5091.endd
5092specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5093in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5094information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5095or restrict the lookup to hosts on `nearby' networks.
4964e932 5096Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
495ae4b0
PH
5097because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5098unreachable.
5099
5100The next two lines are concerned with \*ident*\ callbacks, as defined by RFC
51011413 (hence their names):
5102.display asis
5103rfc1413_hosts = *
5104rfc1413_query_timeout = 30s
5105.endd
5106These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5107You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5108that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5109Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5110messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5111result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5112delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5113
5114When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5115be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5116if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5117find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5118.display asis
5119# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5120# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5121.endd
5122show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5123and recipient addresses, respectively.
5124
5125The \percent@_hack@_domains\ option is also commented out:
5126.display asis
5127# percent_hack_domains =
5128.endd
5129It provides a list of domains for which the `percent hack' is to operate. This
5130is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5131anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5132
5133The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5134concerned with messages that have been `frozen' on Exim's queue. When a message
5135is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing occurs when
5136a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender address of
5137the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the bounce cannot be
5138delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there are also other
5139conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not always bounce
5140messages.
5141.display asis
5142ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5143timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5144.endd
5145The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5146discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5147message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5148after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5149bounce message ever lasts a week.
5150
5151
5152.section ACL configuration
5153.index default||ACLs
5154.index ~~ACL||default configuration
5155In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5156It starts with the line
5157.display asis
5158begin acl
5159.endd
5160and it contains the definition of one ACL called \*acl@_check@_rcpt*\ that was
5161referenced in the setting of \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ above.
5162.index \\RCPT\\||ACL for
5163This ACL is used for every \\RCPT\\ command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5164\\RCPT\\ command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5165are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5166rejected. The \\RCPT\\ command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5167result of the ACL processing.
5168.display asis
5169acl_check_rcpt:
5170.endd
5171This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5172ACL, and names it.
5173.display asis
5174accept hosts = :
5175.endd
5176This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5177But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5178names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5179list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message didn't come from a remote
5180host. The colon is important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can
5181never match anything.
5182
5183What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5184messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5185input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5186manner.
5187.display asis
5188deny domains = +local_domains
5189 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5190
5191deny domains = !+local_domains
5192 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
4964e932
PH
5193.endd
5194These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
495ae4b0
PH
5195characters `@@', `%', `!', `/', `|', or dots in unusual places. Although these
5196characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of `@@' and leading
5197dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur in Internet mail
5198addresses.
5199
5200The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5201addresses (percent is still sometimes used -- see the \percent@_hack@_domains\
5202option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5203in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5204programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5205at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5206characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5207policy of being as safe as possible.
5208
5209The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5210to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5211first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5212\*local@_domains*\ domain list. The `+' character is used to indicate a
5213reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5214\*local@_domains*\, but in general there may be many.
5215
5216The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5217block local parts that begin with a dot or contain `@@', `%', `!', `/', or `|'.
5218If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will have to
5219modify this rule.
5220
5221Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5222allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider local
5223parts constructed as `first-initial.second-initial.family-name' when applied to
5224someone like the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local
5225part starting with a dot or containing `/../' can cause trouble if it is used
5226as part of a file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for
5227local parts that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the
5228local part is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5229
5230The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5231allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5232and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5233with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5234local part. However, the sequence `/../' is barred. The use of `@@', `%', and
5235`!' is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users (or
5236your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5237
5238.display asis
5239accept local_parts = postmaster
5240 domains = +local_domains
5241.endd
5242This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5243local part is \*postmaster*\ and the domain is one of those listed in the
5244\*local@_domains*\ domain list. The `+' character is used to indicate a
5245reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5246\*local@_domains*\, but in general there may be many.
5247
5248The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5249by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5250in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5251.display asis
5252require verify = sender
5253.endd
5254This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5255ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5256address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
4964e932
PH
5257see if a
5258bounce
495ae4b0
PH
5259message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote addresses, basic
5260verification checks only the domain, but \*callouts*\ can be used for more
5261verification if required. Section ~~SECTaddressverification discusses the
5262details of address verification.
5263
5264.display asis
5265# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address is \
5266# in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5267# $dnslist_text
5268# dnslists = black.list.example
5269#
5270# warn message = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is \
5271# in a black list at $dnslist_domain
5272# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5273# dnslists = black.list.example
5274.endd
5275These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5276sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5277from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second merely inserts a warning header
5278line.
5279
5280.display asis
5281accept domains = +local_domains
5282 endpass
5283 message = unknown user
5284 verify = recipient
5285.endd
5286This statement accepts the incoming recipient address if its domain is one of
5287the local domains, but only if the address can be verified. Verification of
5288local addresses normally checks both the local part and the domain. The
5289\endpass\ line needs some explanation: if the condition above \endpass\ fails,
5290that is, if the address is not in a local domain, control is passed to the next
5291ACL statement. However, if the condition below \endpass\ fails, that is, if a
5292recipient in a local domain cannot be verified, access is denied and the
5293recipient is rejected.
5294.index customizing||ACL failure message
5295The \message\ modifier provides a customized error message for the failure.
5296.display asis
5297accept domains = +relay_to_domains
5298 endpass
5299 message = unrouteable address
5300 verify = recipient
5301.endd
5302This statement accepts the incoming recipient address if its domain is one of
5303the domains for which this host is a relay, but again, only if the address can
5304be verified.
5305.display asis
5306accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5307.endd
5308Control reaches this statement only if the recipient's domain is neither a
5309local domain, nor a relay domain. The statement accepts the address if the
5310message is coming from one of the hosts that are defined as being allowed to
5311relay through this host. Recipient verification is omitted here, because in
5312many cases the clients are dumb MUAs that do not cope well with SMTP error
5313responses. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should probably add
5314recipient verification here.
5315.display asis
5316accept authenticated = *
5317.endd
5318Control reaches here for attempts to relay to arbitrary domains from arbitrary
5319hosts. The statement accepts the address only if the client host has
5320authenticated itself. The default configuration does not define any
5321authenticators, which means that no client can in fact authenticate. You will
5322need to add authenticator definitions if you want to make use of this ACL
5323statement.
5324.display asis
5325deny message = relay not permitted
5326.endd
5327The final statement denies access, giving a specific error message. Reaching
5328the end of the ACL also causes access to be denied, but with the generic
5329message `administrative prohibition'.
5330
5331
5332.section Router configuration
5333.index default||routers
5334.index routers||default
5335The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5336by the line
5337.display asis
5338begin routers
5339.endd
5340Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5341messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5342accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5343matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5344manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5345
5346.index domain literal||default router
5347.display asis
5348# domain_literal:
5349# driver = ipliteral
5350# domains = !+local_domains
5351# transport = remote_smtp
5352.endd
5353This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5354support domain literal addresses (those of the form \*user@@[10.9.8.7]*\). If
5355you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5356\allow@_domain@_literals\ in the main part of the configuration.
5357
5358.display asis
5359dnslookup:
5360 driver = dnslookup
5361 domains = ! +local_domains
5362 transport = remote_smtp
5363.newline
5364 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5365.newline
5366 no_more
5367.endd
5368The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5369domains. This is specified by the line
5370.display asis
5371domains = ! +local_domains
5372.endd
5373The \domains\ option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5374exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5375that are not in the domain list called \*local@_domains*\ (which was defined at
5376the start of the configuration). The plus sign before \*local@_domains*\
5377indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5378passed on to the following routers.
5379
5380The name of the router driver is \%dnslookup%\,
5381and is specified by the \driver\ option. Do not be confused by the fact that
4964e932
PH
5382the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5383instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the \driver\ option must be one
495ae4b0
PH
5384of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5385
5386The \%dnslookup%\ router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5387DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5388router succeeds, the address is queued for the \%remote@_smtp%\ transport, as
5389specified by the \transport\ option. If the router does not find the domain in
5390the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the \no@_more\ setting, so the
5391address fails and is bounced.
5392
5393The \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5394be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
4964e932 5395encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
495ae4b0
PH
5396whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5397Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5398email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5399continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5400out.
5401.display asis
5402system_aliases:
5403 driver = redirect
5404 allow_fail
5405 allow_defer
5406 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5407# user = exim
5408 file_transport = address_file
5409 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5410.endd
5411Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5412domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5413alias in the \(/etc/aliases)\ file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5414data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5415the value of the \data\ option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5416the next router.
5417
4964e932
PH
5418\(/etc/aliases)\ is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5419often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
495ae4b0
PH
5420file. However, you can change this by setting \\SYSTEM@_ALIASES@_FILE\\ in
5421\(Local/Makefile)\ before building Exim.
5422
5423.display asis
5424userforward:
5425 driver = redirect
5426 check_local_user
5427 file = $home/.forward
5428 no_verify
5429 no_expn
5430 check_ancestor
5431# allow_filter
5432 file_transport = address_file
5433 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5434 reply_transport = address_reply
5435.endd
5436This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5437redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5438individual users. The \check@_local@_user\ setting means that the first thing it
5439does is to check that the local part of the address is the login name of a
5440local user. If it is not, the router is skipped. When a local user is found,
5441the file called \(.forward)\ in the user's home directory is consulted. If it
5442does not exist, or is empty, the router declines. Otherwise, the contents of
4964e932 5443\(.forward)\ are interpreted as redirection data (see chapter ~~CHAPredirect
495ae4b0
PH
5444for more details).
5445
5446.index Sieve filter||enabling in default router
5447Traditional \(.forward)\ files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5448files. Exim supports this by default. However, if \allow@_filter\ is set (it is
5449commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set of
5450Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with `@#Exim
5451filter' or `@#Sieve filter', respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5452separate document entitled \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\.
5453
5454The \no@_verify\ and \no@_expn\ options mean that this router is skipped when
5455verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP \\EXPN\\
4964e932 5456command.
495ae4b0
PH
5457There are two reasons for doing this:
5458.numberpars
4964e932 5459Whether or not a local user has a \(.forward)\ file is not really relevant when
495ae4b0
PH
5460checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5461unnecessary work.
5462.nextp
4964e932
PH
5463More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an \\EXPN\\
5464command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
495ae4b0
PH
5465The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5466It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' \(.forward)\ files at
5467this time.
5468.endp
5469
5470The setting of \check@_ancestor\ prevents the router from generating a new
5471address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5472works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5473forwarding -- see section ~~SECTredlocmai).
5474
5475The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5476forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5477auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a \(.forward)\ file contains
5478.display asis
5479a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5480.endd
5481the delivery to \(/home/spqr/archive)\ is done by running the \address@_file\
5482transport.
5483.display asis
5484localuser:
5485 driver = accept
5486 check_local_user
5487 transport = local_delivery
5488.endd
5489The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5490part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and queuing it for
5491the \%local@_delivery%\ transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5492routers, so the address is bounced.
5493
5494
5495.section Transport configuration
5496.index default||transports
5497.index transports||default
5498Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5499only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5500not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5501.display asis
5502begin transports
5503.endd
5504One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5505.display asis
5506remote_smtp:
5507 driver = smtp
5508.endd
5509This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5510options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5511.display asis
5512local_delivery:
5513 driver = appendfile
5514 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5515 delivery_date_add
5516 envelope_to_add
5517 return_path_add
5518# group = mail
5519# mode = 0660
5520.endd
5521This \%appendfile%\ transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5522traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5523local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the \(/var/mail)\
5524directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5525under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5526show how this can be done.
5527
5528Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: ::Delivery-date::,
5529::Envelope-to:: and ::Return-path::. This action is requested by the three
5530similarly-named options above.
5531.display asis
5532address_pipe:
5533 driver = pipe
5534 return_output
5535.endd
5536This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5537redirection (aliasing or users' \(.forward)\ files). The \return@_output\
5538option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5539sender.
5540.display asis
5541address_file:
5542 driver = appendfile
5543 delivery_date_add
5544 envelope_to_add
5545 return_path_add
5546.endd
5547This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5548redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5549\%appendfile%\, because it comes from the \%redirect%\ router.
5550.display asis
5551address_reply:
5552 driver = autoreply
5553.endd
5554This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5555filter files.
5556
5557
5558.section Default retry rule
5559.index retry||default rule
5560.index default||retry rule
5561The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5562Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5563introduced by the line
5564.display asis
5565begin retry
5566.endd
5567In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5568errors:
5569.display asis
5570* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5571.endd
5572This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
55732 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
55741.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5575is not delivered after 4 days of failure, it is bounced.
5576
5577
5578.section Rewriting configuration
5579The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5580.display asis
5581begin rewrite
5582.endd
5583contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5584rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5585
5586
5587.section Authenticators configuration
5588.index \\AUTH\\||configuration
5589The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5590.display asis
5591begin authenticators
5592.endd
5593defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP \\AUTH\\ command. No authenticators
5594are specified in the default configuration file.
5595
5596
5597
5598.
5599.
5600.
5601.
5602. ============================================================================
5603.chapter Regular expressions
5604.set runningfoot "regular expressions"
5605.rset CHAPregexp ~~chapter
5606
5607.index regular expressions||library
5608.index PCRE
5609Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5610uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5611matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5612regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5613Jeffrey Friedl's
5614.if ~~html
5615[(A HREF="http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex/")]
5616.fi
5617$it{Mastering Regular Expressions}
5618.if ~~html
5619[(/A)]
5620.fi
5621(O'Reilly, ISBN 0-596-00289-0).
5622
4964e932 5623The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
495ae4b0
PH
5624are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
5625\(doc/pcrepattern.txt)\ in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
5626tarbundle of Exim documentation, and as an appendix to the
5627.if ~~html
5628[(A HREF="http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/")]
5629.fi
5630Exim book.
5631.if ~~html
5632[(/A)]
5633.fi
5634It describes in detail the features of the regular expressions that PCRE
5635supports, so no further description is included here. The PCRE functions are
5636called from Exim using the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE
5637options set), except that the \\PCRE@_CASELESS\\ option is set when the
5638matching is required to be case-insensitive.
5639
4964e932
PH
5640In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5641it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
495ae4b0
PH
5642or an `ends with' wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5643second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5644.display asis
5645domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5646.endd
5647The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5648precedes interpretation -- see section ~~SECTlittext for more discussion of
5649this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5650regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5651backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5652normal effect of `anchoring' it to the start of the string that is being
5653matched.
5654
4964e932 5655There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
495ae4b0
PH
5656recognition of a regular expression: these are the \match\ condition in a
5657string expansion, and the \matches\ condition in an Exim filter file. In these
5658cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if it
5659does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can match
5660anywhere in the subject string.
5661
4964e932 5662In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
495ae4b0
PH
5663you must code the @$ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5664.display asis
5665domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5666.endd
4964e932 5667matches the domain \*123.example*\, but it also matches \*123.example.com*\.
495ae4b0
PH
5668You need to use:
5669.display asis
5670domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5671.endd
5672if you want \*example*\ to be the top-level domain. (The backslash before the
5673@$ is another artefact of string expansion.)
495ae4b0
PH
5674
5675
5676.section Testing regular expressions
5677.index testing||regular expressions
5678.index regular expressions||testing
5679.index \*pcretest*\
5680A program called \*pcretest*\ forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
5681with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
5682testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
5683expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
5684directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
5685of various options in \(doc/pcretest.txt)\, but for simple testing, none are
5686needed. This is the output of a sample run of \*pcretest*\:
5687.display
5688 re> $cb{/^([^@@]+)@@.+@\.(ac|edu)@\.(?!kr)[a-z]@{2@}@$/}
5689data> $cb{x@@y.ac.uk}
5690 0: x@@y.ac.uk
5691 1: x
5692 2: ac
5693data> $cb{x@@y.ac.kr}
5694No match
5695data> $cb{x@@y.edu.com}
5696No match
5697data> $cb{x@@y.edu.co}
5698 0: x@@y.edu.co
5699 1: x
5700 2: edu
5701.endd
5702.if ~~sys.fancy
5703Input typed by the user is shown in bold face.
5704.fi
5705After the `re>' prompt, a regular expression enclosed in delimiters is
5706expected. If this compiles without error, `data>' prompts are given for strings
5707against which the expression is matched. An empty data line causes a new
5708regular expression to be read. If the match is successful, the captured
5709substring values (that is, what would be in the variables \$0$\, \$1$\, \$2$\,
5710etc.) are shown. The above example tests for an email address whose domain ends
5711with either `ac' or `edu' followed by a two-character top-level domain that is
5712not `kr'. The local part is captured in \$1$\ and the `ac' or `edu' in \$2$\.
5713
5714
5715
5716
5717
5718
5719.
5720.
5721.
5722.
5723. ============================================================================
5724.chapter File and database lookups
5725.set runningfoot "file/database lookups"
5726.rset CHAPfdlookup "~~chapter"
5727.index file||lookup
5728.index database lookups
5729.index lookup||description of
5730Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5731messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5732.numberpars
5733A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
4964e932
PH
5734cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5735lookup.
495ae4b0
PH
5736.nextp
5737Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5738way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5739returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5740succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5741chapter ~~CHAPdomhosaddlists.
5742.endp
5743It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
5744lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
4964e932 5745processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
495ae4b0
PH
5746Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
5747.display asis
5748domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
5749domains = lsearch;/some/file
5750.endd
5751The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
5752String expansions are described in detail in chapter ~~CHAPexpand. The
5753expansion takes place first, and the file that is searched could contain lines
5754like this:
5755.display asis
5756192.168.3.4: domain1 : domain2 : ...
5757192.168.1.9: domain3 : domain4 : ...
5758.endd
4964e932 5759Thus, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and possibly other
495ae4b0
PH
5760types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
5761
4964e932 5762In the second case, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
495ae4b0
PH
5763Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
5764in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
5765.display asis
4964e932 5766domain1:
495ae4b0
PH
5767domain2:
5768.endd
4964e932 5769Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
495ae4b0
PH
5770matches the list item.
5771
4964e932 5772It is possible to use both kinds of lookup at once. Consider a file containing
495ae4b0
PH
5773lines like this:
5774.display asis
5775192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
5776.endd
4964e932
PH
5777If the value of \$sender@_host@_address$\ is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
5778first \domains\ setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
495ae4b0
PH
5779causes a second lookup to occur.
5780
5781The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
5782available. Any of them can be used in either of the circumstances described
4964e932 5783above. The syntax requirements for the two cases are described in chapters
495ae4b0
PH
5784~~CHAPexpand and ~~CHAPdomhosaddlists, respectively.
5785
5786.section Lookup types
5787.index lookup||types of
5788.index single-key lookup||definition of
5789Two different styles of data lookup are implemented:
5790.numberpars $.
5791The \*single-key*\ style requires the specification of a file in which to look,
d43194df
PH
5792and a single key to search for.
5793.em
5794The key must be a non-empty string for the lookup to succeed.
5795.nem
5796The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
495ae4b0
PH
5797.nextp
5798.index query-style lookup||definition of
5799The \*query*\ style accepts a generalized database query.
5800No particular key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can
5801use whichever Exim variable(s) you need to construct the database query.
5802.endp
5803The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
5804the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
5805default settings in \(src/EDITME)\ are:
5806.display asis
5807LOOKUP_DBM=yes
5808LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
5809.endd
5810which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
5811For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
5812libraries and header files before building Exim.
5813
5814
5815
5816.section Single-key lookup types
5817.rset SECTsinglekeylookups "~~chapter.~~section"
5818.index lookup||single-key types
5819.index single-key lookup||list of types
5820The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
5821.numberpars $.
5822.index cdb||description of
5823.index lookup||cdb
5824.index binary zero||in lookup key
5825\%cdb%\: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
5826string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
5827indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
5828re-creation. As such, it is particulary suitable for large files containing
5829aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
5830be found in several places:
5831.display rm
5832\?http://www.pobox.com/@~djb/cdb.html?\
5833\?ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/?\
5834\?http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html?\
5835.endd
5836A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
5837because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
5838However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
5839you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
5840.nextp
5841.index DBM||lookup type
5842.index lookup||dbm
5843.index binary zero||in lookup key
5844\%dbm%\: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
5845DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
5846zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
5847~~SECTdb for a discussion of DBM libraries.
5848.index Berkeley DB library||file format
4964e932
PH
5849For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the \\DB@_HASH\\ style of database
5850when building DBM files using the \exim@_dbmbuild\ utility. However, when using
495ae4b0
PH
5851Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with the
5852\\DB@_UNKNOWN\\ option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
4964e932 5853that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
495ae4b0
PH
5854other applications. (For earlier DB versions, \\DB@_HASH\\ is always used.)
5855
5856.nextp
5857.index lookup||dbmnz
5858.index lookup||dbm, terminating zero
5859.index binary zero||in lookup key
5860.index Courier
5861.index \(/etc/userdbshadow.dat)\
5862.index dmbnz lookup type
5863\%dbmnz%\: This is the same as \%dbm%\, except that a terminating binary zero
5864is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
5865if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
5866other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
5867use \%dbmnz%\ rather than \%dbm%\ if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
5868calls using the passwords from Courier's \(/etc/userdbshadow.dat)\ file. Exim's
5869utility program for creating DBM files (\*exim@_dbmbuild*\) includes the zeros
5870by default, but has an option to omit them (see section ~~SECTdbmbuild).
5871.nextp
5872.index lookup||dsearch
5873.index dsearch lookup type
5874\%dsearch%\: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for a file
5875whose name is the key. The key may not contain any forward slash characters.
5876The result of a successful lookup is the name of the file. An example of how
5877this lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
5878~~SECTvirtualdomains.
5879.nextp
5880.index lookup||iplsearch
5881.index iplsearch lookup type
495ae4b0
PH
5882\%iplsearch%\: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
5883terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
5884file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
5885IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
5886being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
5887.display asis
58881.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
5889192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
5890"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
5891"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
5892.endd
5893The key for an \%iplsearch%\ lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
5894file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
5895key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
4964e932 5896`best' match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
495ae4b0
PH
5897\%iplsearch%\ is the same as for \%lsearch%\.
5898
5899\**Warning 1**\: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
5900\%iplsearch%\ can \*not*\ be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
5901lookup types support only literal keys.
5902
4964e932 5903\**Warning 2**\: In a host list, you must always use \%net-iplsearch%\ so that
495ae4b0
PH
5904the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
5905~~SECThoslispatsikey).
495ae4b0
PH
5906
5907.nextp
5908.index linear search
5909.index lookup||lsearch
5910.index lsearch lookup type
5911\%lsearch%\: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
5912line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
5913end of the line. The first occurrence that is found in the file is used. White
5914space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the line,
5915with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
5916continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
5917space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
5918junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
5919colon, for example:
5920.display
5921baduser: :fail:
5922.endd
5923Empty lines and lines beginning with @# are ignored, even if they occur in the
5924middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
5925that the keys in an \%lsearch%\ file are literal strings. There is no
5926wildcarding of any kind.
5927
5928.index lookup||lsearch, colons in keys
d43194df
PH
5929.index whitespace||in lsearch key
5930In most \%lsearch%\ files, keys are not required to contain colons or @#
5931characters, or whitespace. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
5932If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
5933matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
5934contents (see section ~~SECTstrings). An optional colon is permitted after
5935quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
5936quotes for the data part of an \%lsearch%\ line.
495ae4b0
PH
5937.nextp
5938.index NIS lookup type
5939.index lookup||NIS
5940.index binary zero||in lookup key
5941\%nis%\: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
5942the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
5943\%nis0%\ which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
5944reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
5945aliases; the full map names must be used.
5946.nextp
5947.index wildlsearch lookup type
5948.index lookup||wildlsearch
5949.index nwildlsearch lookup type
5950.index lookup||nwildlsearch
5951\%wildlsearch%\ or \%nwildlsearch%\: These search a file linearly, like
5952\%lsearch%\, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key may
5953be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is that for
4964e932 5954\%wildlsearch%\, each key in the file is string-expanded before being used,
495ae4b0
PH
5955whereas for \%nwildlsearch%\, no expansion takes place.
5956
5957Like \%lsearch%\, the testing is done case-insensitively. The following forms
5958of wildcard are recognized:
5959.numberpars "$*$"
5960The string may begin with an asterisk to mean `begins with'. For example:
5961.display asis
5962*.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
5963*fish data for anythingfish
5964.endd
5965.nextp
5966The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
5967example, for \%wildlsearch%\:
5968.display asis
5969^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
5970.endd
4964e932
PH
5971Note the use of \"@\N"\ to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
5972expression. If you are using \%nwildlsearch%\, where the keys are not
495ae4b0
PH
5973string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
5974.display asis
5975^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
5976.endd
5977
5978If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
5979either quote it (see \%lsearch%\ above), or represent these characters in other
5980ways. For example, \"@\s"\ can be used for white space and \"@\x3A"\ for a
5981colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
5982escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
5983.nextp
5984Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function
4964e932
PH
5985that is used to implement
5986\%(n)wildlsearch%\
495ae4b0
PH
5987means that the string may begin with a lookup name terminated by a semicolon,
5988and followed by lookup data. For example:
5989.display asis
5990cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
5991.endd
5992The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
5993.endp
5994Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
5995continuation rules for the data are the same as for \%lsearch%\, and keys may
5996be followed by optional colons.
5997
5998\**Warning**\: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
5999\%(n)wildlsearch%\ can \*not*\ be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6000lookup types support only literal keys.
6001.endp
6002
6003.section Query-style lookup types
6004.index lookup||query-style types
6005.index query-style lookup||list of types
4964e932 6006The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
495ae4b0
PH
6007many of them are given in later sections.
6008.numberpars $.
6009.index DNS||as a lookup type
6010.index lookup||DNS
d43194df
PH
6011\%dnsdb%\: This does a DNS search for
6012.em
6013one or more records whose domain names are given in the supplied query. The
6014resulting data is the contents of the records.
6015.nem
6016See section ~~SECTdnsdb.
495ae4b0
PH
6017.nextp
6018.index Interbase lookup type
6019.index lookup||Interbase
6020\%ibase%\: This does a lookup in an Interbase database.
6021.nextp
6022.index LDAP||lookup type
6023.index lookup||LDAP
6024\%ldap%\: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6025returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called \%ldapm%\
6026that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6027called \%ldapdn%\ returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6028any attribute values. See section ~~SECTldap.
6029.nextp
6030.index MySQL||lookup type
6031.index lookup||MySQL
6032\%mysql%\: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a MySQL
6033database. See section ~~SECTsql.
6034.nextp
6035.index NIS@+ lookup type
6036.index lookup||NIS+
6037\%nisplus%\: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6038the field to be returned. See section ~~SECTnisplus.
6039.nextp
6040.index Oracle||lookup type
6041.index lookup||Oracle
6042\%oracle%\: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6043Oracle database. See section ~~SECTsql.
6044.nextp
6045.index lookup||passwd
6046.index passwd lookup type
d43194df 6047.index \(/etc/passwd)\
495ae4b0
PH
6048\%passwd%\ is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6049lookup calls \*getpwnam()*\ to interrogate the system password data, and on
6050success, the result string is the same as you would get from an \%lsearch%\
6051lookup on a traditional \(/etc/passwd file)\, though with \"*"\ for the
6052password value. For example:
6053.display asis
6054*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6055.endd
6056.nextp
6057.index PostgreSQL lookup type
6058.index lookup||PostgreSQL
6059\%pgsql%\: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6060PostgreSQL database. See section ~~SECTsql.
6061.nextp
6062\%testdb%\: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6063not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6064.nextp
6065.index whoson lookup type
6066.index lookup||whoson
6067\%whoson%\: \*Whoson*\ (\?http://whoson.sourceforge.net?\) is a proposed
6068Internet protocol that allows Internet server programs to check whether a
6069particular (dynamically allocated) IP address is currently allocated to a known
6070(trusted) user and, optionally, to obtain the identity of the said user. In
6071Exim, this can be used to implement `POP before SMTP' checking using ACL
6072statements such as
6073.display asis
6074require condition = \
6075 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6076.endd
6077The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6078the authenticated user.
6079.endp
6080
6081.section Temporary errors in lookups
6082.index lookup||temporary error in
6083Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6084completed. For example, a NIS or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6085reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6086options such as a list of local domains.
6087
6088When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6089of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6090temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6091or may give up altogether.
6092
6093
6094.section Default values in single-key lookups
6095.rset SECTdefaultvaluelookups "~~chapter.~~section"
6096.index wildcard lookups
6097.index lookup||default values
6098.index lookup||wildcard
6099.index lookup||$*$ added to type
6100.index default||in single-key lookups
6101In this context, a `default value' is a value specified by the administrator
6102that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6103
6104If `$*$' is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, \lsearch$*$\) and
6105the initial lookup fails, the key `$*$' is looked up in the file to provide
6106a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6107
6108.index @*@@ with single-key lookup
6109.index lookup||$*$@@ added to type
6110.index alias file||per-domain default
6111Alternatively, if `$*$@@' is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6112\dbm$*$@@\) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @@
6113character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @@ replaced
6114by $*$. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6115that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6116take place because there is no @@ in the key), `$*$' is looked up.
6117For example, a \%redirect%\ router might contain:
6118.display asis
6119data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mixed-aliases}}
6120.endd
4964e932 6121Suppose the address that is being processed is \*jane@@eyre.example*\. Exim
495ae4b0
PH
6122looks up these keys, in this order:
6123.display asis
6124jane@eyre.example
6125*@eyre.example
6126*
6127.endd
4964e932
PH
6128The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. \**Note**\: in an
6129\%lsearch%\ file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6130complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
495ae4b0
PH
6131Exim move on to try the next key.
6132
6133
6134.section Partial matching in single-key lookups
6135.rset SECTpartiallookup "~~chapter.~~section"
6136.index partial matching
6137.index wildcard lookups
6138.index lookup||partial matching
6139.index lookup||wildcard
6140.index asterisk||in search type
6141The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6142match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6143being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6144information in the file that has a key starting with `$*$.' is matched by any
6145domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6146a key in a DBM file is
6147.display
6148*.dates.fict.example
6149.endd
6150then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6151\*2001.dates.fict.example*\ and \*1984.dates.fict.example*\. It is also matched
6152by \*dates.fict.example*\, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6153file.
6154
4964e932 6155\**Note**\: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
495ae4b0
PH
6156also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6157~~SECTaddresslist).
6158
6159Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6160keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6161be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
4964e932 6162partial matching keys
495ae4b0
PH
6163beginning with a special prefix (default `$*$.') are included in the data file.
6164Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6165unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6166
6167Partial matching is requested by adding the string `partial-' to the front of
6168the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, \partial-dbm\. When this is
6169done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, `$*$.'
6170is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6171fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed
6172from the start of the subject key, one-by-one, and `$*$.' added on the front of
6173what remains.
6174
6175A minimum number of two non-$*$ components are required. This can be adjusted
6176by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6177\partial3-lsearch\ specifies a minimum of three non-$*$ components in the
6178modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to `partial2-'. If the subject
6179key is \*2250.dates.fict.example*\ then the following keys are looked up when
6180the minimum number of non-$*$ components is two:
6181.display asis
61822250.dates.fict.example
6183*.2250.dates.fict.example
6184*.dates.fict.example
6185*.fict.example
6186.endd
6187As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
4964e932 6188finishes.
495ae4b0
PH
6189
6190.index lookup||partial matching, changing prefix
6191.index prefix||for partial matching
4964e932 6192The use of `$*$.' as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
495ae4b0
PH
6193changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6194formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6195parentheses instead of the hyphen after `partial'. For example:
6196.display asis
6197domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6198.endd
6199In this example, if the domain is \*a.b.c*\, the sequence of lookups is
4964e932 6200\"a.b.c"\, \".a.b.c"\, and \".b.c"\ (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
495ae4b0
PH
6201components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6202other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6203.display asis
6204domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6205.endd
6206For this example, if the domain is \*a.b.c*\, the sequence of lookups is
6207\"a.b.c"\, \"b.c"\, and \"c"\.
6208
6209If `partial0' is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with just
6210one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right down
6211to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6212.numberpars $.
6213If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6214.nextp
6215If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6216example, the final lookup for `partial0(.)' is for \"."\ alone.
6217.nextp
6218Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
4964e932 6219remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
495ae4b0
PH
6220for `$*$' on its own.
6221.nextp
6222Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6223.endp
6224
6225If the search type ends in `$*$' or `$*$@@' (see section
6226~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups above), the search for an ultimate default that this
6227implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If `partial0' is
6228specified, adding `$*$' to the search type has no effect with the default
6229prefix, because the `$*$' key is already included in the sequence of partial
6230lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6231`partial0(.)lsearch$*$'.
6232
6233The use of `$*$' in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6234in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6235dot-separated components; a key such as \"*fict.example"\
6236in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6237subject key is always followed by a dot.
6238
6239
6240
6241.section Lookup caching
4964e932 6242.index lookup||caching
495ae4b0 6243.index caching||lookup data
d43194df
PH
6244.em
6245Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6246lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6247of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6248single Exim process. There is no inter-process caching facility.
6249
6250For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6251another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6252many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6253the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6254closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6255own internal limit, which can be changed via the \lookup@_open@_max\ option.
6256
6257The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6258strategic points during delivery -- for example, after all routing is complete.
6259.nem
495ae4b0
PH
6260
6261
6262.section Quoting lookup data
6263.index lookup||quoting
6264.index quoting||in lookups
6265When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6266is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6267the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6268.display asis
6269[name=$local_part]
6270.endd
6271will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6272For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6273.display asis
6274[name="$local_part"]
6275.endd
6276but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6277NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6278rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6279of the following form is provided:
6280.display
6281@$@{quote@_<<lookup-type>>:<<string>>@}
6282.endd
6283For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6284.display asis
6285[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6286.endd
6287See chapter ~~CHAPexpand for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6288operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6289lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6290
6291
6292
6293.section More about dnsdb
6294.rset SECTdnsdb "~~chapter.~~section"
6295.index dnsdb lookup
6296.index lookup||dnsdb
6297.index DNS||as a lookup type
d43194df
PH
6298The \%dnsdb%\ lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6299of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6300an expansion string could contain:
495ae4b0
PH
6301.display asis
6302${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6303.endd
d43194df
PH
6304The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6305when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6306configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6307.em
6308the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6309\in-addr.arpa\ or \ip6.arpa\ happens automatically. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
6310.display asis
6311${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6312.endd
d43194df
PH
6313If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6314altered and nothing is added.
6315
6316For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6317single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6318concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6319depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6320between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6321by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6322.display asis
6323${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6324.endd
6325It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6326whitespace is ignored.
495ae4b0 6327
495ae4b0 6328.index SRV record||in \%dnsdb%\ lookup
d43194df
PH
6329For SRV records, the priority, weight, port, and host name are returned for
6330each record, separated by spaces.
6331
6332.index MX record||in \%dnsdb%\ lookup
6333For MX records, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6334each record, separated by a space. However, if you want only host names, you
6335can use the pseudo-type MXH:
6336.display asis
6337${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6338.endd
6339In this case, the preference values are omitted.
495ae4b0 6340
d43194df
PH
6341.index name server||for enclosing domain
6342Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for `zone NS'). It performs a lookup for NS
6343records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6344component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6345records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6346error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6347but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6348top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6349.display asis
6350${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6351${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6352.endd
6353Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6354the first returns the name servers for \quercite.com\, and the second returns
6355the name servers for \edu\.
6356
6357You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6358top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6359sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6360given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6361for the high-level domains such as \com\ or \co.uk\ are not going to be on such
6362a list.
6363
6364.nem
495ae4b0 6365
d43194df
PH
6366.em
6367.section Multiple dnsdb lookups
6368In the previous section, \%dnsdb%\ lookups for a single domain are described.
6369However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6370\%dnsdb%\ lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6371the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6372.display asis
6373${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6374${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6375${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6376.endd
6377In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6378the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6379to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6380case, it does not treat it as a list.
6381
6382The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6383in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6384different separator can be specified, as described above.
6385
6386The \%dnsdb%\ lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6387temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6388an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6389type. The possible keywords are `defer@_strict', `defer@_never', and
6390`defer@_lax'. With `strict' behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6391whole lookup to defer. With `never' behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6392ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6393With `lax' behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6394error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6395succeed. The default is `lax', so the following lookups are equivalent:
6396.display asis
6397${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6398${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6399.endd
6400Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6401yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6402.nem
495ae4b0
PH
6403
6404
6405.section More about LDAP
6406.rset SECTldap "~~chapter.~~section"
6407.index LDAP lookup
6408.index lookup||LDAP
6409.index Solaris||LDAP
6410The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6411become `Open LDAP', and there are now two different releases. Another
6412implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6413contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6414the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6415it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6416indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6417your \(Local/Makefile)\:
6418.display asis
6419LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6420LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6421LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6422LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6423LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6424.endd
6425If \\LDAP@_LIB@_TYPE\\ is not set, Exim assumes \"OPENLDAP1"\, which has the
6426same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6427
6428There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6429the way they handle the results of a query:
6430.numberpars $.
6431\%ldap%\ requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6432gives an error.
6433.nextp
6434\%ldapdn%\ also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6435Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6436.nextp
6437\%ldapm%\ permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes from
6438all of them are returned.
6439.endp
6440
6441For \%ldap%\ and \%ldapm%\, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6442Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6443the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6444First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6445
6446.section Format of LDAP queries
6447.rset SECTforldaque "~~chapter.~~section"
6448.index LDAP||query format
6449An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6450the configuration of a \%redirect%\ router one might have this setting:
6451.display asis
6452data = ${lookup ldap \
6453 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6454 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6455.endd
6456.index LDAP||with TLS
6457The URL may begin with \"ldap"\ or \"ldaps"\ if your LDAP library supports
6458secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6459encrypted TLS connection is used.
6460
6461.section LDAP quoting
6462.index LDAP||quoting
6463Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6464and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
4964e932 6465within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
495ae4b0
PH
6466reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6467
6468The \quote@_ldap\ operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6469filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6470the string:
6471.display asis
6472* => \2A
6473( => \28
6474) => \29
6475\ => \5C
6476.endd
6477in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6478to the rules for URLs, that is, all characters except
6479.display asis
6480! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6481.endd
6482are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6483.display asis
6484${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6485.endd
6486yields
6487.display asis
6488%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6489.endd
6490Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6491.display asis
6492a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6493.endd
6494
6495The \quote@_ldap@_dn\ operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6496base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6497by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6498.display asis
6499, + " \ < > ;
6500.endd
6501It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or @# characters, and
6502before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6503is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6504.display asis
4964e932 6505${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
495ae4b0
PH
6506.endd
6507yields
6508.display asis
6509%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6510.endd
6511Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6512.display asis
6513\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6514.endd
4964e932 6515There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
495ae4b0
PH
6516authentication below.
6517
6518.section LDAP connections
6519.index LDAP||connections
6520The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6521is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6522an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6523by starting it with
6524.display
6525ldap://<<hostname>>:<<port>>/...
6526.endd
6527If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6528used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6529taken from the \ldap@_default@_servers\ configuration option. This supplies a
6530colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6531handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6532returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6533are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6534Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6535failures, and timeouts.
6536
6537For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6538of specifing a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6539\ldap@_default@_servers\ is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6540doubled. For example
6541.display asis
6542ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6543.endd
6544If \ldap@_default@_servers\ is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6545to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6546the local host) is used.
6547
6548If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6549a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6550\"ldapi"\ instead of \"ldap"\ in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6551to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6552not available.
6553
6554For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6555for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6556can be specified either as an item in \ldap@_default@_servers\, or inline in
6557the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6558.display asis
6559ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6560.endd
6561When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6562\"%2F"\ to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6563.display asis
6564${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6565.endd
6566When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the `hostname' is really
6567a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6568specifies \"ldap"\ or \"ldaps"\. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6569socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6570\ldap@_default@_servers\ such as in the example above with traditional \"ldap"\
6571or \"ldaps"\ queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6572the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6573backup host.
6574
6575If an explicit \"ldapi"\ type is given in a query when a host name is
6576specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6577\ldap@_default@_servers\, they are tried. In other words:
6578.numberpars $.
6579Using a pathname with \"ldap"\ or \"ldaps"\ forces the use of the Unix domain
6580interface.
6581.nextp
4964e932 6582Using \"ldapi"\ with a host name causes an error.
495ae4b0
PH
6583.endp
6584
6585Using \"ldapi"\ with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6586\ldap@_default@_servers\, does whatever the library does by default.
6587
6588
6589.section LDAP authentication and control information
6590.index LDAP||authentication
6591The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6592information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6593be preceded by any number of `<<name>>=<<value>>' settings, separated by
6594spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6595when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
d43194df 6596them. The following names are recognized:
495ae4b0 6597.display
495ae4b0 6598DEREFERENCE $rm{set the dereferencing parameter}
d43194df
PH
6599.newline
6600.em
6601NETTIME $rm{set a timeout for a network operation}
6602.nem
6603.newline
495ae4b0
PH
6604USER $rm{set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind}
6605PASS $rm{set the password, likewise}
6606SIZE $rm{set the limit for the number of entries returned}
6607TIME $rm{set the maximum waiting time for a query}
6608.endd
4964e932 6609The value of the \\DEREFERENCE\\ parameter must be one of the words `never',
495ae4b0
PH
6610`searching', `finding', or `always'.
6611
d43194df
PH
6612.em
6613The name \\CONNECT\\ is an obsolete name for \\NETTIME\\, retained for
6614backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6615enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6616network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6617\*ldap@_result()*\ function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6618\\LDAP@_OPT@_NETWORK@_TIMEOUT\\ is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6619if \\LDAP@_X@_OPT@_CONNECT@_TIMEOUT\\ is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6620SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of `no timeout' for
6621Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6622
6623The \\TIME\\ parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6624set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6625.nem
6626
495ae4b0
PH
6627Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6628values. This is a single line, folded for ease of reading:
6629.display asis
6630.indent 0
6631${lookup ldap
6632 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6633 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6634 {$value}fail}
6635.endd
6636The encoding of spaces as %20 is a URL thing which should not be done for any
6637of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups which
6638contain password information should be preceded by `hide' to prevent non-admin
6639users from using the \-bP-\ option to see their values.
6640
6641The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6642connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6643on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6644
495ae4b0
PH
6645When a DN is quoted in the \\USER=\\ setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6646removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6647some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6648quoting has two advantages:
6649.numberpars $.
6650It makes it possible to use the same \quote@_ldap@_dn\ expansion for \\USER=\\
6651DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6652.nextp
4964e932 6653It permits spaces inside \\USER=\\ DNs.
495ae4b0
PH
6654.endp
6655For example, a setting such as
6656.display asis
6657USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
6658.endd
6659should work even if \$1$\ contains spaces.
6660
4964e932
PH
6661Expanded data for the \\PASS=\\ value should be quoted using the \quote\
6662expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
6663field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
495ae4b0
PH
6664does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
6665.display asis
6666PASS=${quote:$3}
6667.endd
6668
6669The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
6670SMTP authentication. See the \ldapauth\ expansion string condition in chapter
6671~~CHAPexpand.
6672
6673
6674.section Format of data returned by LDAP
6675.index LDAP||returned data formats
6676The \%ldapdn%\ lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry as
6677a sequence of values, for example
6678.display asis
6679cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
6680.endd
6681
6682The \%ldap%\ lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
d43194df
PH
6683search filter, whereas \%ldapm%\ permits this case, and inserts a newline in
6684the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
6685values to be returned for both \%ldap%\ and \%ldapm%\, but in the former case
6686you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
495ae4b0
PH
6687directory.
6688
6689In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
6690result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
6691has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
6692
6693If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
6694strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
6695quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
6696backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
6697Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
6698output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
6699same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
6700
6701Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
6702LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
6703\attr1\ has two values, whereas \attr2\ has only one value:
6704.display asis
6705ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
6706value1.1, value1.2
6707
6708ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
6709value two
6710
6711ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
6712attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
6713
6714ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
6715objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
6716.endd
6717The \extract\ operator in string expansions can be used to pick out individual
6718fields from data that consists of $it{key}=$it{value} pairs. You can make use
6719of Exim's \-be-\ option to run expansion tests and thereby check the results of
6720LDAP lookups.
6721
6722
6723
6724.section More about NIS+
6725.rset SECTnisplus "~~chapter.~~section"
6726.index NIS@+ lookup type
6727.index lookup||NIS+
6728NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ \*indexed name*\ followed by an optional colon
6729and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
6730contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
6731of \*field-name=field-value*\ pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
6732values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
6733.display asis
6734[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
6735.endd
6736might return the string
6737.display asis
6738name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
6739home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
6740.endd
6741(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
6742.display asis
6743[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
6744.endd
6745would just return
6746.display asis
6747Martin Guerre
6748.endd
6749with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
6750for the given indexed key. The effect of the \quote@_nisplus\ expansion
6751operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
6752
6753
6754.section More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and Interbase
6755.rset SECTsql "~~chapter.~~section"
6756.index MySQL||lookup type
6757.index PostgreSQL lookup type
6758.index lookup||MySQL
6759.index lookup||PostgreSQL
6760.index Oracle||lookup type
6761.index lookup||Oracle
6762.index Interbase lookup type
6763.index lookup||Interbase
6764If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or Interbase lookups are used, the
6765\mysql@_servers\, \pgsql@_servers\, \oracle@_servers\, or \ibase@_servers\
6766option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
6767information. Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four items:
6768host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of Oracle, the
6769host name field is used for the `service name', and the database name field is
6770not used and should be empty. For example:
6771.display asis
6772hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//ph10/abcdwxyz
6773.endd
6774Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
6775`hide', to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the \-bP-\
6776option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
6777.display asis
6778hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
6779 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
6780.endd
6781For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <<name>>:<<port>> but
6782because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled.
6783
6784For each query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection
6785and a query succeeds. Queries for these databases are SQL statements, so an
6786example might be
6787.display asis
6788.indent 0
6789${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='ph10'}{$value}fail}
6790.endd
6791If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for
6792each field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result
6793of
6794.display asis
6795.indent 0
6796${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='ph10'}{$value}}
6797.endd
6798might be
6799.display asis
6800home=/home/ph10 name="Philip Hazel"
6801.endd
6802Values containing spaces and empty values are double quoted, with embedded
6803quotes escaped by a backslash.
6804
6805If the result of the query contains just one field, the value is passed back
6806verbatim, without a field name, for example:
6807.display asis
6808Philip Hazel
6809.endd
6810If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
6811with a newline between the data for each row.
6812
6813The \quote@_mysql\, \quote@_pgsql\, and \quote@_oracle\ expansion operators
6814convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to @\n, @\t, @\r, and @\b
6815respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
6816itself are escaped with backslashes. The \quote@_pgsql\ expansion operator, in
6817addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
6818for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
6819characters are not special.
6820
6821
6822.section Special MySQL features
6823For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of `localhost' in \mysql@_servers\
6824causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
6825socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
6826each item in \mysql@_servers\ is:
6827.display
6828<<hostname>>@:@:<<port>>(<<socket name>>)/<<database>>/<<user>>/<<password>>
6829.endd
6830Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
6831the local host it can be left blank or set to just `localhost'.
6832
6833No database need be supplied -- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
6834the queries.
6835
6836If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
6837or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
d43194df
PH
6838.em
6839\**Warning**\: this can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
6840anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
6841is zero because no rows are affected.
6842.nem
495ae4b0
PH
6843
6844
6845.section Special PostgreSQL features
6846PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
6847This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
6848However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
6849database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
6850looks like this:
6851.display asis
6852hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
6853.endd
6854In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
6855given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
6856visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
6857
6858If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
6859update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
6860affected.
6861
6862
6863
6864
6865.
6866.
6867.
6868.
6869. ============================================================================
6870.chapter Domain, host, address, and local part lists
6871.set runningfoot "domain, host, and address lists"
6872.rset CHAPdomhosaddlists "~~chapter"
6873.index list||of domains, hosts, etc.
6874A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
6875email addresses, or local parts. For example, the \hold@_domains\ option
6876contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
6877are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter ~~CHAPACL).
6878
6879Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
6880host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
6881different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
6882general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
6883
6884
6885.section Expansion of lists
6886.index expansion||of lists
d43194df
PH
6887.em
6888Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
6889expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
6890into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
6891but this can be varied if necessary. See sections ~~SECTlistconstruct and
6892~~SECTempitelis for details of the list syntax; the second of these discusses
6893the way you specify empty list items.
6894.nem
6895
6896If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
6897testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
6898expansion failures cause temporary errors.
495ae4b0
PH
6899
6900If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
6901other special characters in the expression must be protected against
6902misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
6903the \"@\N"\ expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
6904expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
6905.display asis
6906deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N :
6907 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
6908.endd
6909The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
6910\"@\N"\, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
6911senders based on the receiving domain.
6912
495ae4b0
PH
6913
6914
6915.section Negated items in lists
6916.index list||negation
6917.index negation in lists
6918Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
6919leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
6920defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
6921it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
6922(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
6923
6924The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
6925subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
6926subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
6927subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
6928was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
6929.display asis
6930domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
6931.endd
6932matches any domain ending in \*.b.c*\ except for \*a.b.c*\. Domains that match
6933neither \*a.b.c*\ nor \*@*.b.c*\ do not match, because the last item in the
6934list is positive. However, if the setting were
6935.display asis
6936domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
6937.endd
6938then all domains other than \*a.b.c*\ would match because the last item in the
6939list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
6940as if it had an extra item \":*"\ on the end.
6941
4964e932
PH
6942Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
6943the connector as `or' after a positive item and as `and' after a negative
6944item.
495ae4b0
PH
6945
6946
6947.section File names in lists
6948.rset SECTfilnamlis "~~chapter.~~section"
6949.index list||file name in
6950If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
6951name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
6952processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
6953file names are not allowed,
6954and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
6955Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
6956lines:
6957.numberpars $.
6958For domain and host lists, if a @# character appears anywhere in a line of the
6959file, it and all following characters are ignored.
6960.nextp
6961Because local parts may legitimately contain @# characters, a comment in an
6962address list or local part list file is recognized only if @# is preceded by
6963white space or the start of the line. For example:
6964.display asis
6965not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
6966.endd
6967.endp
6968Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
6969file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
6970is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
6971so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
6972
6973If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
6974within the file is inverted. For example, if
6975.display asis
6976hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
6977.endd
6978and the file contains the lines
6979.display asis
6980!a.b.c
6981*.b.c
6982.endd
6983then \*a.b.c*\ is in the set of domains defined by \hold@_domains\, whereas any
6984domain matching \"*.b.c"\ is not.
6985
6986
6987.section An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list
6988As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
6989to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
6990confusion about the way \%lsearch%\ lookups work in lists. Because
6991an \%lsearch%\ file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
6992sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
6993non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an \%lsearch%\ file are
6994always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
6995
4964e932 6996If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
495ae4b0
PH
6997list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
6998in the previous section.
6999
7000
7001
7002.section Named lists
7003.rset SECTnamedlists "~~chapter.~~section"
7004.index named lists
7005.index list||named
7006A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7007which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7008particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7009places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7010the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7011a domain list called \*local@_domains*\ for all the domains that are handled
7012locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7013.display asis
7014domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7015.endd
7016Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7017for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7018configured with the line
7019.display asis
7020domains = +local_domains
7021.endd
7022The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7023except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7024.display asis
7025dnslookup:
7026 driver = dnslookup
7027 domains = ! +local_domains
7028 transport = remote_smtp
7029 no_more
7030.endd
7031The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7032the words \domainlist\, \hostlist\, \addresslist\, or \localpartlist\,
7033respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7034equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7035.display asis
7036hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7037addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7038.endd
7039A named list may refer to other named lists:
7040.display asis
7041domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7042domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7043domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7044.endd
7045
7046\**Warning**\: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7047effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7048out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7049.display asis
7050domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7051domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7052.endd
7053The second list specifies `either in the \dom1\ list or \*@*.b*\'. The first
7054list specifies just `not \*a.b*\', so the domain \*x.y*\ matches it. That means
7055it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7056.display asis
7057domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7058.endd
4964e932 7059where \*x.y*\ does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
495ae4b0
PH
7060referenced lists if you can.
7061
7062Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7063address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7064lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7065.display asis
7066domains = +local_domains
7067.endd
7068on several of your routers
4964e932 7069or in several ACL statements,
495ae4b0
PH
7070the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7071if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7072references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7073the same each time they are referenced.
7074
7075By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7076extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7077is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7078hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7079
7080
7081.section Named lists compared with macros
7082.index list||named compared with macro
7083.index macro||compared with named list
7084At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7085configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7086write
7087.display asis
7088ALIST = host1 : host2
7089auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7090.endd
7091it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7092.display asis
7093auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7094.endd
7095Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7096list, and write
7097.display asis
7098hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7099auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7100.endd
7101the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7102.display asis
7103auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7104.endd
7105
7106
495ae4b0
PH
7107.section Named list caching
7108.index list||caching of named
7109.index caching||named lists
7110While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7111it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7112the cache operates only if the list contains no @$ characters, which guarantees
7113that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7114an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7115message. For example:
7116.display asis
7117domainlist special_domains = \
7118 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7119.endd
7120This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7121address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7122in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7123cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7124same list each time.
7125
7126By appending \"@_cache"\ to \"domainlist"\ you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7127cache the result anyway. For example:
7128.display asis
7129domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7130.endd
7131If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7132the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
495ae4b0
PH
7133
7134
7135.section Domain lists
7136.rset SECTdomainlist "~~chapter.~~section"
7137.index domain list||patterns for
7138.index list||domain list
7139Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7140The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7141.numberpars $.
7142.index primary host name
4964e932 7143.index host||name, matched in domain list
495ae4b0
PH
7144.index \primary@_hostname\
7145.index domain list||matching primary host name
7146.index @@ in a domain list
7147If a pattern consists of a single @@ character, it matches the local host name,
7148as set by the \primary@_hostname\ option (or defaulted). This makes it possible
7149to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that differ only
7150in their names.
7151.nextp
7152.index @@[] in a domain list
7153.index domain list||matching local IP interfaces
7154.index domain literal
7155If a pattern consists of the string \"@@[]"\ it matches any local IP interface
7156address, enclosed in square brackets, as in an email address that contains a
4964e932 7157domain literal.
495ae4b0 7158In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
495ae4b0
PH
7159.nextp
7160.index @@mx@_any
7161.index @@mx@_primary
7162.index @@mx@_secondary
7163.index domain list||matching MX pointers to local host
7164If a pattern consists of the string \"@@mx@_any"\ it matches any domain that
7165has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7166.index \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\
7167\hosts@_treat@_as@_local\. The items \"@@mx@_primary"\ and \"@@mx@_secondary"\
7168are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7169local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7170but a secondary MX target is. `Primary' means an MX record with the lowest
7171preference value -- there may of course be more than one of them.
7172
4964e932
PH
7173The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7174performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7175example, a single-component domain will \*not*\ be expanded by adding the
7176resolver's default domain. See the \qualify@_single\ and \search@_parents\
495ae4b0
PH
7177options of the \%dnslookup%\ router for a discussion of domain widening.
7178
7179Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7180patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with \"/ignore=<<ip
7181list>>"\, where <<ip list>> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
4964e932 7182ignored when processing the pattern (compare the \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option
495ae4b0
PH
7183on a router). For example:
7184.display asis
7185domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7186.endd
7187This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7188the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7189
4964e932
PH
7190The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7191host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
495ae4b0
PH
7192contain negative items.
7193
7194Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7195be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7196list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7197.display asis
7198domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7199 an.other.domain : ...
7200.endd
7201so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7202involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7203.display asis
7204domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7205 an.other.domain ? ...
7206.endd
495ae4b0
PH
7207
7208.nextp
7209.index asterisk||in domain list
7210.index domain list||asterisk in
7211.index domain list||matching `ends with'
7212If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7213are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of `$*$' in
7214domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7215list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7216matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7217list item such as \"*key.ex"\ matches \*donkey.ex*\ as well as
7218\*cipher.key.ex*\.
7219.nextp
7220.index regular expressions||in domain list
7221.index domain list||matching regular expression
7222If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7223expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7224function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7225References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions are given in
7226chapter ~~CHAPregexp.
7227
7228\**Warning**\: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7229must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7230use the special \"@\N"\ sequence (see chapter ~~CHAPexpand) to specify that it
7231is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular expression
7232by expansion, of course).
7233.nextp
7234.index lookup||in domain list
7235.index domain list||matching by lookup
7236If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7237semicolon (for example, `dbm;' or `lsearch;'), the remainder of the pattern
7238must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7239`cdb;' it must be an absolute path:
7240.display asis
7241domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7242.endd
7243The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7244key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7245only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7246is used for the \domains\ option on a router
7247or a \domains\ condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7248\$domain@_data$\ variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7249other statements in the same ACL.
7250.nextp
7251Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by `partial<<n>>-',
7252where the <<n>> is optional, for example,
7253.display asis
7254domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7255.endd
7256This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7257works is given in section ~~SECTpartiallookup.
7258.nextp
7259.index asterisk||in lookup type
7260Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7261a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7262original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7263select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7264value if the result of the lookup is being used via the \$domain@_data$\
7265expansion variable.
7266.nextp
7267If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7268semicolon (for example, `nisplus;' or `ldap;'), the remainder of the pattern
7269must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in chapter
7270~~CHAPfdlookup. For example:
7271.display asis
7272hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7273 where domain = '$domain';
7274.endd
7275In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7276example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7277whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7278\domains\ option on a router, the data is preserved in the \$domain@_data$\
7279variable and can be referred to in other options.
7280.nextp
7281.index domain list||matching literal domain name
7282If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made between
7283the pattern and the domain.
7284.endp
7285
7286Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7287.display asis
7288domainlist funny_domains = \
7289 @ : \
7290 lib.unseen.edu : \
7291 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7292 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7293 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7294 nis;domains.byname : \
7295 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7296.endd
7297There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7298an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7299explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7300but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7301patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7302patterns earlier.
7303
7304
7305.section Host lists
7306.rset SECThostlist "~~chapter.~~section"
7307.index host list||patterns in
7308.index list||host list
7309Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7310example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7311may be permitted to use the SMTP \\ETRN\\ command. Hosts can be identified in
7312two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7313pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7314You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7315involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7316
7317.section Special host list patterns
7318.index empty item in hosts list
7319.index host list||empty string in
7320If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7321involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7322process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7323not used.
7324
7325.index asterisk||in host list
7326The special pattern `$*$' in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7327the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7328
7329
7330.section Host list patterns that match by IP address
7331.rset SECThoslispatip "~~chapter.~~section"
7332.index host list||matching IP addresses
7333If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7334the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7335`@:@:$tt{ffff}:<<v4address>>'. When such an address is tested against a host
7336list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7337systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7338concerns.)
7339
7340The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7341inspecting its IP address:
7342.numberpars $.
7343If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7344with $*$, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7345to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7346\*getipnodebyname()*\ function when available, otherwise \*gethostbyname()*\.
7347This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7348with the IP address of the subject host.
7349
495ae4b0 7350If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
4964e932 7351lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
495ae4b0
PH
7352ACL condition, the ACL gives a `defer' response, usually leading to a temporary
7353SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name, what happens
7354is described in section ~~SECTbehipnot below.
495ae4b0
PH
7355
7356.nextp
7357.index @@ in a host list
7358If the pattern is `@@', the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7359domain name, as just described.
7360.nextp
7361If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7362subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal `dotted-quad' notation.
7363IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7364be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7365separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7366without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7367IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7368that can never match a client host.
7369.nextp
7370.index @@[] in a host list
7371If the pattern is `@@[]', it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7372the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7373interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7374.display asis
7375accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7376accept hosts = @[]
7377.endd
7378.nextp
7379If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7380example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7381host under the given mask.
7382This allows, an entire network of hosts to be included (or excluded) by a
7383single item.
4964e932 7384.index CIDR notation
495ae4b0
PH
7385The mask uses CIDR notation; it specifies the number of address bits that must
7386match, starting from the most significant end of the address.
7387
7388\**Note**\: the mask is \*not*\ a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7389of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7390address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7391addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7392.display asis
7393192.168.23.236/31
7394.endd
4964e932
PH
7395matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
739632 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
495ae4b0
PH
7397matches.
7398
7399Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7400.display asis
7401recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7402 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7403.endd
7404The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7405appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7406For example,
7407.display asis
7408recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7409.endd
7410could make use of a file containing
7411.display asis
7412172.16.0.0/12
74133ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7414.endd
7415to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7416addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7417changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7418.display asis
7419recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7420 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7421.endd
7422The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading `<;' at the start of the
7423list.
7424.endp
7425
7426
7427.section Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address
7428.rset SECThoslispatsikey "~~chapter.~~section"
7429.index host list||lookup of IP address
7430When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7431address, the pattern takes this form:
7432.display
7433net-<<single-key-search-type>>;<<search-data>>
7434.endd
7435For example:
7436.display asis
7437hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7438.endd
7439The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7440IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7441letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7442\%lsearch%\ files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in \%lsearch%\ files by
7443quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7444returned by the lookup is not used.
7445
7446.index IP address||masking
7447.index host list||masked IP address
7448Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7449patterns of this form:
7450.display
7451net<<number>>-<<single-key-search-type>>;<<search-data>>
7452.endd
7453For example:
7454.display asis
7455net24-dbm;/networks.db
7456.endd
7457The IP address of the subject host is masked using <<number>> as the mask
7458length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7459mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7460is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7461`192.168.34.0/24'. IPv6 addresses are converted to a text value using lower
7462case letters and dots as separators instead of the more usual colon, because
7463colon is the key terminator in \%lsearch%\ files. Full, unabbreviated IPv6
7464addresses are always used.
7465
7466\**Warning**\: Specifing \net32@-\ (for an IPv4 address) or \net128@-\ (for an
7467IPv6 address) is not the same as specifing just \net@-\ without a number. In
7468the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7469case the IP address is used on its own.
7470
7471
7472.section Host list patterns that match by host name
7473.rset SECThoslispatnam "~~chapter.~~section"
7474.index host||lookup failures
7475.index unknown host name
4964e932 7476.index host list||matching host name
495ae4b0
PH
7477There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7478remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7479complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7480address to match against, as described in the section ~~SECThoslispatip above.)
7481
7482If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
4964e932 7483patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
495ae4b0
PH
7484Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7485DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7486Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7487effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7488Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7489
7490Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7491against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7492
7493By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7494if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (\*gethostbyaddr()*\ or
7495\*getipnodebyaddr()*\ if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7496are done can be changed by setting the \host@_lookup@_order\ option.
7497
7498There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7499found. These are described in section ~~SECTbehipnot below.
495ae4b0
PH
7500
7501
7502.index host||alias for
7503.index alias for host
7504As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7505of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7506.numberpars $.
7507.index asterisk||in host list
7508If a pattern starts with `$*$' the remainder of the item must match the end of
7509the host name. For example, \"*.b.c"\ matches all hosts whose names end in
7510\*.b.c*\. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7511requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7512expression.
7513.nextp
7514.index regular expressions||in host list
7515.index host list||regular expression in
7516If the item starts with `@^' it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7517matched against the host name. For example,
7518.display asis
7519^(a|b)\.c\.d$
7520.endd
7521is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts \*a.c.d*\ or
7522\*b.c.d*\. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7523that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7524string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use \"@\N"\ to mark that
7525part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7526.display asis
7527sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7528.endd
4964e932
PH
7529\**Warning**\: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7530\"@$"\ terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7531example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
495ae4b0 7532required.
495ae4b0
PH
7533.endp
7534
7535
495ae4b0
PH
7536.section Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found
7537.rset SECTbehipnot "~~chapter.~~section"
7538.index host||lookup failures
4964e932
PH
7539While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
7540name (see section ~~SECThoslispatip), or it may need to look up a host name
7541from an IP address (see section ~~SECThoslispatnam). In either case, the
495ae4b0
PH
7542behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
7543
7544.index \"+include@_unknown"\
7545.index \"+ignore@_unknown"\
7546By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
7547always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
7548items \"+include@_unknown"\ or \"+ignore@_unknown"\ may appear in the list (at
7549top level -- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
7550.numberpars $.
7551If any item that follows \"+include@_unknown"\ requires information that
7552cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
7553.display asis
7554host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
7555.endd
7556rejects connections from any host whose name matches \"*.enemy.ex"\, and also
7557any hosts whose name it cannot find.
7558.nextp
4964e932
PH
7559If any item that follows \"+ignore@_unknown"\ requires information that cannot
7560be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
495ae4b0
PH
7561example:
7562.display asis
7563accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
7564 192.168.4.5
7565.endd
4964e932
PH
7566accepts from any host whose name is \*friend.example*\ and from 192.168.4.5,
7567whether or not its host name can be found. Without \"+ignore@_unknown"\, if no
495ae4b0
PH
7568name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
7569.endp
7570Both \"+include@_unknown"\ and \"+ignore@_unknown"\ may appear in the same
4964e932 7571list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
495ae4b0
PH
7572list.
7573
7574\**Note**\: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does \*not*\
7575apply to temporary DNS errors. They always cause a defer action.
495ae4b0
PH
7576
7577
7578.section Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name
7579.rset SECThoslispatnamsk "~~chapter.~~section"
7580.index host||lookup failures
7581.index unknown host name
7582.index host list||matching host name
7583If a pattern is of the form
7584.display
7585<<single-key-search-type>>;<<search-data>>
7586.endd
7587for example
7588.display asis
7589dbm;/host/accept/list
7590.endd
7591a single-key lookup is performend, using the host name as its key. If the
7592lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
7593is not used.
7594
7595\**Reminder**\: With this kind of pattern, you must have host $it{names} as
7596keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
7597addresses, you must precede the search type with `net-' (see section
7598~~SECThoslispatsikey). There is, however, no reason why you could not use two
7599items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
7600lookup, both using the same file.
7601
7602
7603.section Host list patterns for query-style lookups
7604If a pattern is of the form
7605.display
7606<<query-style-search-type>>;<<query>>
7607.endd
7608the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
7609data that is looked up is not used. The variables \$sender@_host@_address$\ and
7610\$sender@_host@_name$\ can be used in the query. For example:
7611.display asis
7612hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
7613 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
7614.endd
d43194df
PH
7615The value of \$sender@_host@_address$\ for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
7616can use the \sg\ expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
7617use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the \mask\ expansion
7618operator.
495ae4b0 7619
4964e932 7620If the query contains a reference to \$sender@_host@_name$\, Exim automatically
495ae4b0
PH
7621looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
7622~~SECThoslispatnam for comments on finding host names.)
7623
4964e932 7624Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
495ae4b0 7625host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
4964e932 7626\"net-"\. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, \"net-"\ is
495ae4b0 7627still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
d43194df
PH
7628effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, \"net-"\ $it{is} important.
7629See section ~~SECThoslispatsikey.)
495ae4b0
PH
7630
7631
7632.section Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists
7633.rset SECTmixwilhos "~~chapter.~~section"
7634.index host list||mixing names and addresses in
7635If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
7636host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
7637ACL you could have:
7638.display asis
7639accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
7640.endd
7641The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
7642It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
7643item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
7644compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
7645\accept\ statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
7646IP address is 10.9.8.7.
7647
7648If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
7649address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
7650.display asis
7651accept hosts = *.friend.example
7652accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
7653.endd
7654If the first \accept\ fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
7655~~CHAPACL for details of ACLs.
7656
7657
7658
7659
7660.section Address lists
7661.index list||address list
7662.index address list||empty item
7663.index address list||patterns
7664.rset SECTaddresslist "~~chapter.~~section"
7665Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
7666is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
7667always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
7668list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
7669using this option setting:
7670.display asis
7671senders = :
7672.endd
7673The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
7674data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
d43194df
PH
7675detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
7676.em
7677and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when \$sender@_address$\ is empty.
495ae4b0 7678
d43194df
PH
7679The following kinds of address list pattern can match any address, including
7680the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message senders:
7681.nem
495ae4b0 7682.numberpars $.
d43194df
PH
7683.em
7684As explained above, if a pattern item is empty, it matches the empty address
7685(and no others).
7686.nem
7687.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
7688.index regular expressions||in address list
7689.index address list||regular expression in
7690If (after expansion) a pattern starts with `@^', a regular expression match is
7691done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
7692You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
7693as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use \"@\N"\
7694to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7695.display asis
7696deny senders = \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
7697.endd
7698The \"@\N"\ sequences are removed by the expansion, so the item does start
7699with `@^' by the time it is being interpreted as an address pattern.
7700.nextp
d43194df
PH
7701.index address list||lookup for complete address
7702Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
7703lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
7704example:
495ae4b0 7705.display asis
d43194df
PH
7706deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
7707 mysql;select address from blocked where \
7708 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
495ae4b0 7709.endd
d43194df
PH
7710.em
7711Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
7712lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
7713not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
7714always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
7715
7716.nem
7717Partial matching for single-key lookups (section ~~SECTpartiallookup) cannot be
7718used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the panic
7719log.
7720.index @*@@ with single-key lookup
7721However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
7722~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups, but this is useful only for the `$*$@@' type of
7723default. For example, with this lookup:
495ae4b0 7724.display asis
d43194df 7725accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
495ae4b0 7726.endd
d43194df 7727the file could contains lines like this:
495ae4b0 7728.display asis
d43194df
PH
7729user1@domain1.example
7730*@domain2.example
495ae4b0 7731.endd
d43194df
PH
7732and for the sender address \*nimrod@@jaeger.example*\, the sequence of keys
7733that are tried is:
7734.display asis
7735nimrod@jaeger.example
7736*@jaeger.example
7737*
7738.endd
7739\**Warning 1**\: Do not include a line keyed by `$*$' in the file, because that
7740would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
7741
7742\**Warning 2**\: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
7743.display asis
7744deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
7745deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
7746.endd
7747The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
7748because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
7749domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
7750.endp
7751
7752
7753.em
7754The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
7755If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
7756always fails.
7757.nem
7758
7759.numberpars $.
7760.index @@@@ with single-key lookup
7761.index address list||@@@@ lookup type
7762.index address list||split local part and domain
7763If a pattern starts with `@@@@' followed by a single-key lookup item
7764(for example, \"@@@@lsearch;/some/file"\), the address that is being checked is
7765split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
7766it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
7767from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
7768of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
7769
7770.index asterisk||in address list
7771The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
7772keyed by `$*$' (see section ~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups). The local part patterns
7773that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with `$*$', or even be
7774further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example, with
7775.display asis
7776deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
7777.endd
7778the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
7779.display asis
7780baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
7781.endd
7782to reject all senders except \postmaster\ from that domain.
7783.index local part||starting with !
7784If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
7785has to be specified using a regular expression. In \%lsearch%\ files, an entry
7786may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
7787but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
7788surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
7789.display asis
7790aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
7791 spammer3 : spammer4
7792.endd
7793As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
7794doubling.
495ae4b0
PH
7795
7796If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
7797of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
7798list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
7799might have entries like
7800.display asis
7801aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
7802xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
7803*: ^\d{8}$
7804.endd
7805in a file that was searched with \@@@@dbm$*$\, to specify a match for 8-digit
7806local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
7807each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
7808chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
7809.index loop||in lookups
7810It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
7811them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
7812.nextp
4964e932
PH
7813The @@@@<<lookup>> style of item can also be used with a query-style
7814lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
495ae4b0
PH
7815can only return a single list of local parts.
7816.nextp
d43194df
PH
7817If a pattern contains an @@ character, but is not a regular expression and does
7818not begin with a lookup type as described above, the local part of the subject
7819address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start with an
7820asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly the same
7821way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
7822wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
495ae4b0
PH
7823.display asis
7824deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
7825 *@+hostile_domains:\
7826 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
7827.newline
7828 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
7829.endd
7830.index local part||starting with !
7831.index address list||local part starting with !
7832If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
7833specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
7834treated as a sign of negation.
7835.nextp
d43194df
PH
7836If a pattern is not one of the above syntax forms, that is, if a
7837.em
7838non-empty
7839.nem
7840pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not contain an @@
7841character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject address. The
7842only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal domain, or a domain
7843pattern that starts with $*$. In both these cases, the effect is the same as if
7844\"*@@"\ preceded the pattern.
495ae4b0
PH
7845.endp
7846
7847\**Warning**\: there is an important difference between the address list items
7848in these two examples:
7849.display asis
7850senders = +my_list
7851senders = *@+my_list
7852.endd
7853In the first one, \"my@_list"\ is a named address list, whereas in the second
7854example it is a named domain list.
7855
7856
7857
7858.section Case of letters in address lists
7859.rset SECTcasletadd "~~chapter.~~section"
7860.index case of local parts
7861.index address list||case forcing
7862.index case forcing in address lists
7863Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
7864case may be significant on some systems (see \caseful@_local@_part\ for how
7865Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 ($it{Anti-Spam
7866Recommendations for SMTP MTAs}) suggests that matching of addresses to blocking
7867lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address lists in
7868Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by default.
7869
7870The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
7871address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
7872comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
7873the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
7874that is looked up using the `@@@@' mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
7875keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than \%lsearch%\ (which
7876works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
7877case-independent.
7878
7879.index \"+caseful"\
7880To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
7881an address list is the string `+caseful', the original case of the local
7882part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
7883longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
7884lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
7885performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
7886become case-sensitive after `+caseful' has been seen.
7887
7888
7889.section Local part lists
7890.rset SECTlocparlis "~~chapter.~~section"
7891.index list||local part list
7892.index local part||list
7893Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
7894lists, as just described. The `+caseful' item can be used if required. In a
7895setting of the \local@_parts\ option in a router with \caseful@_local@_part\
7896set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
7897case-insensitive. In this case, `+caseful' will restore case-sensitive matching
7898in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
7899\caseful@_local@_part\ is set true in a router, matching in the \local@_parts\
7900option is case-sensitive from the start.
7901
7902If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section ~~SECTfilnamlis),
7903comments are handled in the same way as address lists -- they are recognized
7904only if the @# is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
7905Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
7906that the special items that refer to the local host (\"@@"\, \"@@[]"\,
7907\"@@mx@_any"\, \"@@mx@_primary"\, and \"@@mx@_secondary"\) are not recognized.
7908Refer to section ~~SECTdomainlist for details of the other available item
7909types.
7910
7911
7912
7913.
7914.
7915.
7916.
7917. ============================================================================
7918.chapter String expansions
7919.set runningfoot "string expansions"
7920.rset CHAPexpand ~~chapter
7921.index expansion||of strings
7922Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
7923them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
7924
7925When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
7926when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
7927start of a portion of the string which is interpreted and replaced as described
4964e932 7928below in section ~~SECTexpansionitems onwards. Backslash is used as an escape
495ae4b0
PH
7929character, as described in the following section.
7930
7931
7932.section Literal text in expanded strings
7933.rset SECTlittext "~~chapter.~~section"
7934.index expansion||including literal text
7935An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
7936backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
7937character being treated specially in an expansion, including itself. If the
7938string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
7939required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
7940the string is read in (see section ~~SECTstrings).
7941
7942.index expansion||non-expandable substrings
7943A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
7944two occurrences of \"@\N"\. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
7945expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
7946.display asis
7947deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
7948.endd
7949On encountering the first \"@\N"\, the expander copies subsequent characters
7950without interpretation until it reaches the next \"@\N"\ or the end of the
7951string.
7952
7953
7954.section Character escape sequences in expanded strings
7955.index expansion||escape sequences
7956A backslash followed by one of the letters `n', `r', or `t' in an expanded
7957string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline, carriage
7958return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three octal digits
7959is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a backslash
7960followed by `x' and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal encoding.
7961
7962These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
7963in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
7964and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
7965
7966.section Testing string expansions
7967.index expansion||testing
7968.index testing||string expansion
7969.index \-be-\ option
7970Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the \-be-\ option. This takes
7971the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
7972arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
7973to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
7974since no message is being processed, variables such as \$local@_part$\ have no
7975value. Nevertheless the \-be-\ option can be useful for checking out file and
7976database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as \sg\, \substr\ and
7977\nhash\.
7978
7979Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the \-be-\ option, and
7980instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
7981using \-be-\ for reading files to which they do not have access.
7982
7983
d43194df
PH
7984.em
7985.section Forced expansion failure
7986.rset SECTforexpfai "~~chapter.~~section"
7987.index expansion||forced failure
7988A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
7989alternative `true' and `false' substrings, enclosed in curly brackets. Which
7990one is used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the
7991expansion. If, instead of a `false' substring, the word `fail' is used (not in
7992curly brackets), the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be
7993detected by the code that requested the expansion. This is called `forced
7994expansion failure', and its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some
7995cases it is no different from any other expansion failure, but in others a
7996different action may be taken. Such variations are mentioned in the
7997documentation of the option that is being expanded.
7998.nem
7999
8000
495ae4b0
PH
8001.section Expansion items
8002.rset SECTexpansionitems "~~chapter.~~section"
8003The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8004between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8005outer set of braces, to improve readability. \**Warning**\: Within braces,
8006white space is significant.
8007
8008.startitems
8009
8010.item "@$<<variable name>>#$rm{or}#@$@{<<variable name>>@}"
8011.index expansion||variables
8012Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example
8013.display asis
8014$local_part
8015${domain}
8016.endd
8017The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8018characters. This form (using curly brackets) is available only for variables;
8019it does $it{not} apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given
8020in section ~~SECTexpvar below. If the name of a non-existent variable is given,
8021the expansion fails.
8022
8023.item "@$@{<<op>>:<<string>>@}"
8024.index expansion||operators
8025The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by <<op>>
8026is applied to it. For example,
8027.display asis
8028${lc:$local_part}
8029.endd
8030The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8031leading white space. A list of operators is given in section ~~SECTexpop below.
8032The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just one
8033argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8034string easier to understand.
8035
8036.item "@$@{extract@{<<key>>@}@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8037.index expansion||extracting substrings by key
4964e932
PH
8038The key and <<string1>> are first expanded separately.
8039Leading and trailing whitespace is removed from the key (but not from any of
495ae4b0
PH
8040the strings).
8041The key must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <<string1>> must be
8042of the form:
8043.display
8044<<key1>> = <<value1>> <<key2>> = <<value2>> ...
8045.endd
8046where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8047values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8048values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8049described in section ~~SECTstrings. The expanded <<string1>> is searched for
8050the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If the
8051key is found, <<string2>> is expanded, and replaces the whole item; otherwise
8052<<string3>> is used. During the expansion of <<string2>> the variable \$value$\
8053contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it is restored to any
8054previous value it might have had.
8055
8056If @{<<string3>>@} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8057key is not found. If @{<<string2>>@} is also omitted, the value that was
8058extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8059yield `2001':
8060.display
8061@$@{extract@{gid@}{uid=1984 gid=2001@}@}
8062@$@{extract@{gid@}{uid=1984 gid=2001@}@{@$value@}@}
8063.endd
8064Instead of @{<<string3>>@} the word `fail' (not in curly brackets) can appear,
8065for example:
8066.display
8067@$@{extract@{Z@}@{A=... B=...@}@{@$value@} fail @}
8068.endd
d43194df
PH
8069This forces an expansion failure (see section ~~SECTforexpfai); @{<<string2>>@}
8070must be present for `fail' to be recognized.
495ae4b0
PH
8071
8072
8073.item "@$@{extract@{<<number>>@}@{<<separators>>@}@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8074.index expansion||extracting substrings by number
8075The <<number>> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
4964e932 8076apart from leading and trailing whitespace, which is ignored.
495ae4b0
PH
8077This is what distinguishes this form of \extract\ from the previous kind. It
8078behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8079extracts from <<string1>> the field whose number is given as the first
8080argument. You can use \$value$\ in <<string2>> or \"fail"\ instead of
8081<<string3>> as before.
8082
8083The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8084separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8085The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8086counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8087number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8088number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8089expansion of <<string3>>, or the empty string if <<string3>> is not provided.
8090For example:
8091.display asis
8092${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8093.endd
8094yields `42', and
8095.display asis
8096${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8097.endd
8098yields `99'. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8099empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8100
8101
8102.item "@$@{hash@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8103.index hash function||textual
8104.index expansion||textual hash
4964e932
PH
8105This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8106early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
495ae4b0
PH
8107(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8108
4964e932
PH
8109The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <<m>> and
8110<<n>>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if <<string1>>
495ae4b0
PH
8111and <<string2>> do not change when they are expanded, you can use the
8112simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8113.display
8114@$@{hash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}
8115.endd
8116The second number is optional (in both notations).
8117
4964e932 8118If <<n>> is greater than or equal to the length of the string, the expansion
495ae4b0
PH
8119item returns the string. Otherwise it computes a new string of length <<n>> by
8120applying a hashing function to the string. The new string consists of
8121characters taken from the first <<m>> characters of the string
8122.display asis
8123abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8124.endd
8125If <<m>> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8126letters appear. For example:
8127.display
4964e932
PH
8128@$@{hash@{3@}@{monty@}@} $rm{yields} \"jmg"\
8129@$@{hash@{5@}@{monty@}@} $rm{yields} \"monty"\
8130@$@{hash@{4@}@{62@}@{monty python@}@} $rm{yields} \"fbWx"\
495ae4b0
PH
8131.endd
8132
8133
8134.item "@$header@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$h@_<<header name>>:"
8135.item "@$bheader@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$bh@_<<header name>>:"
8136.item "@$rheader@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$rh@_<<header name>>:"
8137.index expansion||header insertion
8138.index \$header@_$\
8139.index \$bheader@_$\
8140.index \$rheader@_$\
8141.index header lines||in expansion strings
8142.index header lines||character sets
8143.index header lines||decoding
8144Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8145.display asis
8146$header_reply-to:
8147.endd
8148The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8149internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
4964e932 8150lines) may be present.
495ae4b0 8151
4964e932
PH
8152The difference between \rheader\, \bheader\, and \header\ is in the way the
8153data in the header line is interpreted.
495ae4b0 8154.numberpars $.
d43194df 8155.index whitespace||in header lines
495ae4b0
PH
8156\rheader\ gives the original `raw' content of the header line, with no
8157processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing whitespace.
8158.nextp
8159.index base64 encoding||in header lines
8160\bheader\ removes leading and trailing whitespace, and then decodes base64 or
8161quoted-printable MIME `words' within the header text, but does no character
8162set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME `word'
4964e932 8163fails, the raw string is returned.
495ae4b0
PH
8164.index binary zero||in header line
8165If decoding produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark
8166-- this is what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header
8167lines.
8168.nextp
8169\header\ tries to translate the string as decoded by \bheader\ to a standard
8170character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would be
8171displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the \bheader\ string is
8172returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8173\*iconv()*\ function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro
8174\\HAVE@_ICONV\\ in a system Makefile or in \(Local/Makefile)\.
8175.endp
8176
8177In a filter file, the target character set for \header\ can be specified by a
8178command of the following form:
8179.display asis
8180headers charset "UTF-8"
8181.endd
8182This command affects all references to \$h@_$\ (or \$header@_$\) expansions in
8183subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8184character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the \headers@_charset\
8185option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8186value of \\HEADERS@_CHARSET\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The ultimate default is
8187ISO-8859-1.
8188
8189Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8190any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8191$it{do not} terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8192if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8193
8194Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8195this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
4964e932 8196message, and any that are added by
495ae4b0
PH
8197an ACL \warn\ statement or by
8198a system filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message
8199by a router or transport are not accessible.
8200
8201For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8202before the \\DATA\\ ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8203message is received. Header lines that are added by \warn\ statements in a
8204\\RCPT\\ ACL (for example) are saved until the message's incoming header lines
8205are available, at which point they are added. When a \\DATA\\ ACL is running,
8206however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
8207
8208Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8209following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8210this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8211white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8212If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8213replaced by an empty string. (See the \def\ condition in section ~~SECTexpcond
4964e932 8214for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
495ae4b0
PH
8215
8216If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8217to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. A newline
8218character is inserted between each line.
8219For the \header\ expansion, for those headers that contain lists of addresses,
8220a comma is also inserted at the junctions between lines. This does not happen
8221for the \rheader\ expansion.
8222
8223
8224
8225.item "@$@{hmac@{<<hashname>>@}@{<<secret>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}"
8226.index expansion||hmac hashing
8227This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8228shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
4964e932 8229RFC 2104.
495ae4b0 8230This differs from \"@$@{md5:secret@_text...@}"\ or
4964e932
PH
8231\"@$@{sha1:secret@_text...@}"\ in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8232cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
495ae4b0
PH
8233or SHA-1 alone.
8234The hash name must expand to either \"md5"\ or \"sha1"\ at present. For
8235example:
8236.display asis
8237${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8238.endd
8239For the hostname \*mail.example.com*\ and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8240produces:
8241.display asis
8242dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8243.endd
8244As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8245an Exim configuration:
8246.display asis
8247SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8248.endd
8249In a router or a transport you could then have:
8250.display asis
8251headers_add = \
8252 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_id} \
8253 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8254 {${primary_hostname},${message_id},$h_message-id:}}
8255.endd
8256Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
4964e932
PH
8257::X-Spam-Scanned:: header line. If you know the secret, you can check that this
8258header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the host
495ae4b0
PH
8259name, message ID and the ::Message-id:: header line. This can be done using
8260Exim's \-be-\ option, or by other means, for example by using the
8261\*hmac@_md5@_hex()*\ function in Perl.
8262
8263
495ae4b0
PH
8264.item "@${if <<condition>> @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@}"
8265.index expansion||conditional
8266If <<condition>> is true, <<string1>> is expanded and replaces the whole item;
d43194df
PH
8267otherwise <<string2>> is used. The available conditions are described in
8268section ~~SECTexpcond below. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
8269.display asis
8270${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8271.endd
8272The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8273true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word `fail' may be
8274present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
d43194df
PH
8275case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8276~~SECTforexpfai).
8277
8278.em
8279If both strings are omitted, the result is the string \"true"\ if the condition
8280is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8281cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8282.display asis
8283condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8284.endd
8285you can use
8286.display asis
8287condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8288.endd
8289.nem
495ae4b0
PH
8290
8291
8292.item "@$@{length@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@}"
8293.index expansion||string truncation
4964e932 8294The \length\ item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
495ae4b0
PH
8295strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <<n>>, say. If you
8296are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <<string1>> does not change
8297when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of
8298the braces:
8299.display
8300@$@{length@_<<n>>:<<string>>@}
8301.endd
8302The result of this item is either the first <<n>> characters or the whole
4964e932 8303of <<string2>>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse \length\ with
495ae4b0
PH
8304\strlen\, which gives the length of a string.
8305
8306
8307.item "@${lookup@{<<key>>@} <<search type>> @{<<file>>@} @{<<string1>>@} @{<<string2>>@}@}"
8308.item "@${lookup <<search type>> @{<<query>>@} @{<<string1>>@} @{<<string2>>@}@}"
8309.index expansion||lookup in
8310.index file||lookup
8311.index lookup||in expanded string
8312These items specify data lookups in files and databases, as discussed in
8313chapter ~~CHAPfdlookup. The first form is used for single-key lookups, and the
8314second is used for query-style lookups. The <<key>>, <<file>>, and <<query>>
8315strings are expanded before use.
8316
8317If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8318a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the \%manualroute%\ router, or any
8319other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8320in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8321out by the system administrator.
8322
8323.index \$value$\
8324If the lookup succeeds, <<string1>> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8325During its expansion, the variable \$value$\ contains the data returned by the
8326lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8327level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <<string2>> is expanded and replaces
d43194df
PH
8328the entire item. If @{<<string2>>@} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8329string on failure. If <<string2>> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8330lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8331original lookup fails.
495ae4b0
PH
8332
8333If a nested lookup is used as part of <<string1>>, \$value$\ contains the data
8334for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are expanded,
8335and also while <<string2>> of the second lookup is expanded, should the second
8336lookup fail.
8337
8338Instead of @{<<string2>>@} the word `fail' can appear, and in this case, if the
d43194df
PH
8339lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced to fail (see section
8340~~SECTforexpfai). If both @{<<string1>>@} and @{<<string2>>@} are omitted, the
8341result is the looked up value in the case of a successful lookup, and nothing
8342in the case of failure.
495ae4b0
PH
8343
8344For single-key lookups, the string `partial' is permitted to precede the
8345search type in order to do partial matching, and $*$ or $*$@@ may follow a
8346search type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8347~~SECTdefaultvaluelookups and ~~SECTpartiallookup for details).
8348
8349.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in lookup expansion
8350If a partial search is used, the variables \$1$\ and \$2$\ contain the wild
8351and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8352They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8353
8354This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8355.display asis
8356${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8357.endd
8358This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8359the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8360.display asis
8361${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8362 {$value}fail}
8363.endd
8364
8365
8366.item "@$@{nhash@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8367.index expansion||numeric hash
8368.index hash function||numeric
8369The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8370<<n>> and <<m>>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8371<<string1>> and <<string2>> do not change when they are expanded, you can use
8372the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8373.display
8374@$@{nhash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}
8375.endd
8376The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8377the result is a number in the range 0--<<n>>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8378processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8379slash, in the ranges 0 to <<n>>-1 and 0 to <<m>>-1, respectively. For example,
8380.display asis
8381${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8382.endd
8383returns the string `6/33'.
8384
8385
8386
8387.item "@$@{perl@{<<subroutine>>@}@{<<arg>>@}@{<<arg>>@}...@}"
8388.index Perl||use in expanded string
8389.index expansion||calling Perl from
8390This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8391interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8392expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
4964e932 8393additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
495ae4b0
PH
8394name of the subroutine, is nine.
8395
8396The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8397the return value is \undef\. In that case, the expansion fails in the same way
4964e932
PH
8398as an explicit `fail' on a lookup item.
8399The return value is a scalar. Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar
495ae4b0
PH
8400context. For example, if you return the name of a Perl vector, the
8401return value is the size of the vector, not its contents.
8402
8403If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's \die\ function, the expansion fails
8404with the error message that was passed to \die\. More details of the embedded
8405Perl facility are given in chapter ~~CHAPperl.
8406
8407The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_perl\ which locks
8408out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8409
8410
8411.item "@$@{readfile@{<<file name>>@}@{<<eol string>>@}@}"
8412.index expansion||inserting an entire file
8413.index file||inserting into expansion
8414The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
8415then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
8416the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
8417newlines are left in the string.
4964e932
PH
8418String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
8419you must wrap the item in an \expand\ operator. If the file cannot be read, the
495ae4b0
PH
8420string expansion fails.
8421
8422The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_readfile\ which
8423locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8424
8425
8426
8427.item "@$@{readsocket@{<<name>>@}@{<<request>>@}@{<<timeout>>@}@{<<eol string>>@}@{<<fail string>>@}@}"
8428.index expansion||inserting from a socket
8429.index socket, use of in expansion
8430This item inserts data that is read from a Unix domain socket into the expanded
8431string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments:
8432.display asis
8433${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
8434.endd
8435Exim connects to the socket, writes the request string (unless it is an
8436empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file is read. A timeout
8437of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments extend what can be
8438done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
8439.display asis
8440${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}}
8441.endd
8442A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
8443that is read, in the same way as for \readfile\ (see above). This example turns
8444them into spaces:
8445.display asis
8446${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}{ }}
8447.endd
8448As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
8449happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
8450addition, the following errors can occur:
8451.numberpars $.
8452Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
8453.nextp
8454Failure to connect the socket;
8455.nextp
8456Failure to write the request-string;
8457.nextp
8458Timeout on reading from the socket.
8459.endp
8460By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
8461you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
8462errors occurs. For example:
8463.display asis
8464${readsocket{/socket/name}{request-string}{3s}{\n}\
8465 {socket failure}}
8466.endd
8467You can test for the existence of the socket by wrapping this expansion in
8468\"@$@{if exists"\, but there is a race condition between that test and the
8469actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument if you
8470want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a non-existent
8471socket.
8472
8473The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_readsocket\ which
8474locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8475
8476.item "@$rheader@_<<header name>>:#$rm{or}#@$rh@_<<header name>>:"
4964e932 8477This item inserts `raw' header lines. It is described with the \header\
495ae4b0
PH
8478expansion item above.
8479
8480
8481
8482.item "@$@{run@{<<command>> <<args>>@}@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@}"
8483.index expansion||running a command
8484The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
8485command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
8486other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
8487a shell, you must explicitly code it.
8488.index return code||from \run\ expansion
8489If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <<string1>> is expanded and
8490replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output from the
8491command is in the variable \$value$\. If the command fails, <<string2>>, if
8492present, is expanded. If it is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively,
8493<<string2>> can be the word `fail' (not in braces) to force expansion failure
8494if the command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is the
8495standard output on success, and nothing on failure.
8496
8497The return code from the command is put in the variable \$runrc$\, and this
8498remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
8499.display asis
8500if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
8501 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
8502 ...
8503endif
8504.endd
8505If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
4964e932 8506the return code is 127 -- the same code that shells use for non-existent
495ae4b0
PH
8507commands.
8508
4964e932
PH
8509\**Warning**\: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
8510option values are expanded, except for those pre-conditions whose order of
8511testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set \$runrc$\
495ae4b0
PH
8512by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
8513
8514The \%redirect%\ router has an option called \forbid@_filter@_run\ which locks
8515out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8516
8517
8518.item "@$@{sg@{<<subject>>@}@{<<regex>>@}@{<<replacement>>@}@}"
8519.index expansion||string substitution
8520This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
8521option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
8522modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
8523into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
8524a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example
8525.display asis
8526${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
8527.endd
8528yields `xyzdefxyzdef'. Because all three arguments are expanded before use, if
8529any @$ or @\ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
8530substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example
8531.display asis
8532${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
8533.endd
8534yields `defabc', and
8535.display asis
8536${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
8537.endd
8538yields `K1=A K4=D K3=C'.
4964e932 8539Note the use of \"@\N"\ to protect the contents of the regular expression from
495ae4b0
PH
8540string expansion.
8541
8542
8543
8544.item "@$@{substr@{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}@{<<string3>>@}@}"
8545.index \substr\
8546.index substring extraction
8547.index expansion||substring extraction
8548The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8549<<n>> and <<m>>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8550<<string1>> and <<string2>> do not change when they are expanded, you can use
8551the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8552.display
8553@$@{substr@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}
8554.endd
8555The second number is optional (in both notations).
d43194df
PH
8556.em
8557If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
8558omitted.
8559.nem
495ae4b0
PH
8560
8561The \substr\ item can be used to extract more general substrings than \length\.
8562The first number, <<n>>, is a starting offset, and <<m>> is the length
8563required. For example
8564.display asis
8565${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
8566.endd
8567If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the null
8568string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string length,
8569the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the given
8570offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
8571
8572The \substr\ expansion item can take negative offset values to count
8573from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
8574second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
8575.display asis
8576${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
8577.endd
8578yields `34'. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
8579length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
8580the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
8581.display asis
8582${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
8583.endd
8584yields an empty string, but
8585.display asis
8586${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
8587.endd
8588yields `1'.
8589
d43194df
PH
8590When the second number is omitted from \substr\, the remainder of the string is
8591taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
495ae4b0 8592string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
d43194df
PH
8593no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
8594.display asis
8595${substr_-1:abcde}
8596${substr{-1}{abcde}}
8597.endd
8598yields all but the last character of the string, that is, `abcd'.
495ae4b0
PH
8599
8600
8601
8602.item "@$@{tr@{<<subject>>@}@{<<characters>>@}@{<<replacements>>@}@}"
8603.index expansion||character translation
8604This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
8605argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
8606matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
8607replacement list. For example
8608.display asis
8609${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
8610.endd
8611yields `1b3de1'. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
8612last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
8613last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
8614place.
8615
8616.enditems
8617
8618
8619.section Expansion operators
8620.rset SECTexpop "~~chapter.~~section"
8621.index expansion||operators
8622For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
8623the `operator' notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
8624The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
8625following operations can be performed:
8626
8627.startitems
8628
8629.item "@$@{address:<<string>>@}"
8630.index expansion||RFC 2822 address handling
8631The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
8632header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
8633not parse successfully, the result is empty.
8634
8635
8636.item "@$@{base62:<<digits>>@}"
8637.index base62
8638.index expansion||conversion to base 62
8639The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
8640base 62 (sic) and output as a string of six characters, including leading
8641zeros. \**Note**\: Just to be absolutely clear: this is \*not*\ base64
8642encoding.
8643
495ae4b0
PH
8644.item "@$@{base62d:<<base-62 digits>>@}"
8645.index base62
8646.index expansion||conversion to base 62
8647The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits. The number is converted to
8648decimal and output as a string.
495ae4b0
PH
8649
8650
8651.item "@$@{domain:<<string>>@}"
8652.index domain||extraction
8653.index expansion||domain extraction
8654The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
8655from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
8656
8657
8658.item "@$@{escape:<<string>>@}"
8659.index expansion||escaping non-printing characters
8660If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
8661escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
8662significant bit set (so-called `8-bit characters') count as printing or not is
8663controlled by the \print@_topbitchars\ option.
8664
8665
495ae4b0
PH
8666.item "@$@{eval:<<string>>@}"
8667.item "@$@{eval10:<<string>>@}"
8668.index expansion||expression evaluation
8669.index expansion||arithmetic expression
8670These items supports simple arithmetic in expansion strings. The string (after
8671expansion) must be a conventional arithmetic expression, but it is limited to
8672the four basic operators (plus, minus, times, divide) and parentheses. All
8673operations are carried out using integer arithmetic. Plus and minus have a
8674lower priority than times and divide; operators with the same priority are
4964e932 8675evaluated from left to right.
495ae4b0
PH
8676
8677For \eval\, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with `0') or hexadecimal
8678(starting with `0x'). For \eval10\, all numbers are taken as decimal, even if
8679they start with a leading zero. This can be useful when processing numbers
8680extracted from dates or times, which often do have leading zeros.
495ae4b0
PH
8681
8682A number may be followed by `K' or `M' to multiply it by 1024 or 1024$*$1024,
8683respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
8684a decimal representation of the answer (without `K' or `M'). For example:
8685.display
8686 @$@{eval:1+1@} $rm{yields} 2
8687 @$@{eval:1+2*3@} $rm{yields} 7
8688 @$@{eval:(1+2)*3@} $rm{yields} 9
8689.endd
8690As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
8691.display asis
8692deny message = Too many bad recipients
8693 condition = \
8694 ${if and { \
8695 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
8696 { \
8697 < \
8698 {$recipients_count} \
8699 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
8700 } \
8701 }{yes}{no}}
8702.endd
8703The condition is true if there have been more than 10 \\RCPT\\ commands and
8704fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
8705
8706
8707.item "@$@{expand:<<string>>@}"
8708.index expansion||re-expansion of substring
8709The \expand\ operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
8710example,
8711.display asis
8712${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
8713.endd
8714first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for \expand\, and
8715then re-expands what it has found.
8716
8717
8718.item "@$@{from@_utf8:<<string>>@}"
8719.index Unicode
8720.index UTF-8||conversion from
8721.index expansion||UTF-8 conversion
8722The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
8723email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
8724to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
8725UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
8726converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
8727the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
8728
8729Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
8730ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
4964e932 8731For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
495ae4b0
PH
8732way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
8733characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
4964e932 8734single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
495ae4b0
PH
8735translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
8736
8737
8738.item "@$@{hash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}"
8739.index hash function||textual
8740.index expansion||textual hash
4964e932
PH
8741The \hash\ operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can be
8742used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
495ae4b0
PH
8743change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8744.display
8745@$@{hash@{<<n>>@}@{<<m>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8746.endd
8747See the description of the general \hash\ item above for details. The
8748abbreviation \h\ can be used when \hash\ is used as an operator.
8749
8750
8751
8752.item "@$@{hex2b64:<<hexstring>>@}"
8753.index base64 encoding||conversion from hex
8754.index expansion||hex to base64
4964e932 8755This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
495ae4b0
PH
8756be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
8757
8758
8759.item "@$@{lc:<<string>>@}"
8760.index case forcing in strings
8761.index string||case forcing
8762.index lower casing
8763.index expansion||case forcing
8764This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
8765.display asis
8766${lc:$local_part}
8767.endd
8768
8769
8770.item "@$@{length@_<<number>>:<<string>>@}"
8771.index expansion||string truncation
8772The \length\ operator is a simpler interface to the \length\ function that can
8773be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
8774changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
8775.display
8776@$@{length@{<<number>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8777.endd
4964e932 8778See the description of the general \length\ item above for details. Note that
495ae4b0
PH
8779\length\ is not the same as \strlen\. The abbreviation \l\ can be used when
8780\length\ is used as an operator.
8781
8782
8783.item "@$@{local@_part:<<string>>@}"
8784.index expansion||local part extraction
8785The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
8786extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
8787empty.
8788
8789
8790.item "@$@{mask:<<IP address>>/<<bit count>>@}"
8791.index masked IP address
8792.index IP address||masking
8793.index CIDR notation
8794.index expansion||IP address masking
8795If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
8796slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
8797expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
8798masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
8799the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
8800.display asis
8801${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
8802.endd
8803returns the string `10.111.131.192/28'. Since this operation is expected to be
8804mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
8805address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
8806terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
8807.display asis
8808${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
8809.endd
8810returns the string
8811.display asis
88123ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
8813.endd
8814Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
8815
8816
8817.item "@$@{md5:<<string>>@}"
8818.index MD5 hash
8819.index expansion||MD5 hash
8820The \md5\ operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it as
8821a 32-digit hexadecimal number,
8822in which any letters are in lower case.
8823
8824
8825.item "@$@{nhash@_<<n>>@_<<m>>:<<string>>@}"
8826.index expansion||numeric hash
8827.index hash function||numeric
8828The \nhash\ operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
8829that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
8830strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8831.display
8832@$@{nhash@{<<n>>@}@{<<m>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8833.endd
8834See the description of the general \nhash\ item above for details.
8835
8836
8837.item "@$@{quote:<<string>>@}"
8838.index quoting||in string expansions
8839.index expansion||quoting
4964e932 8840The \quote\ operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
495ae4b0
PH
8841is an empty string or
8842contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
8843Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
8844Newlines and carriage returns are converted to \"@\n"\ and \"@\r"\,
8845respectively For example,
8846.display asis
8847${quote:ab"*"cd}
8848.endd
8849becomes
8850.display asis
8851"ab\"*\"cd"
8852.endd
8853The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
8854variable or a message header.
8855
8856.item "@$@{quote@_local@_part:<<string>>@}"
4964e932
PH
8857This operator is like \quote\, except that it quotes the string only if
8858required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
495ae4b0
PH
8859example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for \quote\).
8860If you are creating a new email address from the contents of \$local@_part$\
8861(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
8862
8863
8864.item "@$@{quote@_<<lookup-type>>:<<string>>@}"
8865.index quoting||lookup-specific
8866This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
8867query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
8868the lookups in chapter ~~CHAPfdlookup. For example,
8869.display asis
8870${quote_ldap:two * two}
8871.endd
4964e932 8872returns
495ae4b0
PH
8873.display asis
8874two%20%5C2A%20two
8875.endd
8876For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
8877yields an unchanged string.
8878
8879
8880.item "@$@{rxquote:<<string>>@}"
8881.index quoting||in regular expressions
8882.index regular expressions||quoting
8883The \rxquote\ operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
8884characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
8885variables or headers inside regular expressions.
8886
8887
8888.item "@$@{rfc2047:<<string>>@}"
8889.index expansion||RFC 2047
8890This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
8891encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
8892assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
d43194df
PH
8893\headers@_charset\ option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string contains
8894only characters in the range 33--126, and no instances of the characters
495ae4b0 8895.display asis
4964e932 8896? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
495ae4b0 8897.endd
d43194df
PH
8898it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
8899string,
8900.em
8901using as many `coded words' as necessary to encode all the characters.
8902.nem
495ae4b0
PH
8903
8904
8905.item "@$@{sha1:<<string>>@}"
8906.index SHA-1 hash
8907.index expansion||SHA-1 hashing
8908The \sha1\ operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns it
8909as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
8910
8911
8912.item "@$@{stat:<<string>>@}"
8913.index expansion||statting a file
8914.index file||extracting characteristics
8915The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the \*stat()*\
8916function is made for this path. If \*stat()*\ fails, an error occurs and the
8917expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
4964e932 8918series of <<name>>=<<value>> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
495ae4b0
PH
8919except for the value of `smode'. The names are: `mode' (giving the mode as a
89204-digit octal number), `smode' (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
892110-character string, as for the \*ls*\ command), `inode', `device', `links',
8922`uid', `gid', `size', `atime', `mtime', and `ctime'. You can extract individual
8923fields using the \extract\ expansion item. \**Warning**\: The file size may be
8924incorrect on 32-bit systems for files larger than 2GB.
8925
8926
d43194df
PH
8927.em
8928.item "@$@{str2b64:<<string>>@}"
8929.index expansion||base64 encoding
8930.index base64 encoding||in string expansion
8931This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
8932.nem
8933
8934
495ae4b0
PH
8935.item "@$@{strlen:<<string>>@}"
8936.index expansion||string length
8937.index string||length in expansion
4964e932 8938The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
495ae4b0
PH
8939decimal number. \**Note**\: Do not confuse \strlen\ with \length\.
8940
8941
8942.item "@$@{substr@_<<start>>@_<<length>>:<<string>>@}"
8943.index \substr\
8944.index substring extraction
8945.index expansion||substring expansion
8946The \substr\ operator is a simpler interface to the \substr\ function that can
8947be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
8948change when expanded). The effect is the same as
8949.display
8950@$@{substr@{<<start>>@}@{<<length>>@}@{<<string>>@}@}
8951.endd
8952See the description of the general \substr\ item above for details. The
8953abbreviation \s\ can be used when \substr\ is used as an operator.
8954
495ae4b0
PH
8955.item "@$@{time@_interval:<<string>>@}"
8956.index \time@_interval\
8957.index time interval||formatting
8958The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
8959represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
8960number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
8961\"1w3d4h2m6s"\.
495ae4b0
PH
8962
8963.item "@$@{uc:<<string>>@}"
8964.index case forcing in strings
8965.index string||case forcing
8966.index upper casing
8967.index expansion||case forcing
8968This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
8969
8970.enditems
8971
8972
8973
8974.section Expansion conditions
8975.rset SECTexpcond "~~chapter.~~section"
8976.index expansion||conditions
8977The following conditions are available for testing by the \@$@{if\ construct
8978while expanding strings:
8979
8980.startitems
8981
8982.item "!<<condition>>"
8983.index expansion||negating a condition
8984Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
8985condition.
8986
8987.item "<<symbolic operator>> @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
8988.index numeric comparison
8989.index expansion||numeric comparison
8990There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
8991are:
8992.display
8993.tabs 8
8994= $t $rm{equal}
8995== $t $rm{equal}
8996> $t $rm{greater}
8997>= $t $rm{greater or equal}
8998< $t $rm{less}
8999<= $t $rm{less or equal}
9000.endd
9001For example,
9002.display asis
9003${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9004.endd
9005Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9006two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9007optionally followed by one of the letters `K' or `M' (in either upper or lower
9008case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024$*$1024, respectively.
9009
9010.item "crypteq @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9011.index expansion||encrypted comparison
9012.index encrypted strings, comparing
9013This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9014authentication mechanisms (see chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH). Otherwise, it is
9015necessary to define \\SUPPORT@_CRYPTEQ\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ to get \crypteq\
9016included in the binary.
9017
9018The \crypteq\ condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and compared
9019against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may be in the
9020LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the encryption type
9021in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string does not begin
9022with `{' it is assumed to be encrypted with \*crypt()*\
9023or \*crypt16()*\ (see below),
9024since such strings cannot begin with `{'. Typically this will be a field from a
9025password file.
9026
9027An example of an encrypted string in LDAP form is:
9028.display asis
9029{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9030.endd
9031If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9032be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9033.display asis
9034${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9035.endd
4964e932 9036The following encryption types
495ae4b0
PH
9037(whose names are matched case-independently)
9038are supported:
9039.numberpars $.
9040.index MD5 hash
9041.index base64 encoding||in encrypted password
9042\@{md5@}\ computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9043printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9044length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9045(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9046hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9047comparison fails.
9048.nextp
9049.index SHA-1 hash
4964e932
PH
9050\@{sha1@}\ computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9051printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9052length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9053If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
495ae4b0
PH
9054SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9055.nextp
9056.index \*crypt()*\
d43194df
PH
9057\@{crypt@}\ calls the \*crypt()*\ function,
9058.em
9059which traditionally used to use only the first eight characters of the
9060password. However, in modern operating systems this is no longer true, and in
9061many cases the entire password is used, whatever its length.
9062.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9063.nextp
9064.index \*crypt16()*\
9065\@{crypt16@}\ calls the \*crypt16()*\ function (also known as \*bigcrypt()*\),
d43194df
PH
9066which
9067.em
9068was orginally created to use up to 16 characters of the password. Again, in
9069modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9070.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9071.endp
9072Exim has its own version of \*crypt16()*\ (which is just a double call to
9073\*crypt()*\). For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9074\\HAVE@_CRYPT16\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ when building Exim causes it to use the
4964e932
PH
9075operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9076the OS-dependent \(Makefile)\ for those operating systems that are known to
495ae4b0
PH
9077support \*crypt16()*\.
9078
9079If you do not put any curly bracket encryption type in a \crypteq\ comparison,
9080the default is either \"@{crypt@}"\ or \"@{crypt16@}"\, as determined by the
9081setting of \\DEFAULT@_CRYPT\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The default default is
9082\"@{crypt@}"\. Whatever the default, you can always use either function by
9083specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9084
9085Note that if a password is no longer than 8 characters, the results of
9086encrypting it with \*crypt()*\ and \*crypt16()*\ are identical. That means that
9087\*crypt16()*\ is backwards compatible, as long as nobody feeds it a password
9088longer than 8 characters.
9089
9090
9091.item "def:<<variable name>>"
9092.index expansion||checking for empty variable
9093The \def\ condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9094variables defined in section ~~SECTexpvar. The condition is true if the named
9095expansion variable does not contain the empty string, for example
9096.display asis
9097${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9098.endd
9099Note that the variable name is given without a leading \@$\ character. If the
9100variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9101
9102.item "def:header@_<<header name>>:##or##def:h@_<<header name>>:"
9103.index expansion||checking header line existence
9104This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9105exists in the message. For example,
9106.display asis
9107${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9108.endd
9109Note that no \@$\ appears before \header@_\ or \h@_\ in the condition,
9110and that header names must be terminated by colons if white space does not
9111follow.
9112
9113.item "eq @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9114.item "eqi @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9115.index string||comparison
9116.index expansion||string comparison
9117The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
4964e932 9118resulting strings are identical: for \eq\ the comparison includes the case of
495ae4b0
PH
9119letters, whereas for \eqi\ the comparison is case-independent.
9120
9121.item "exists @{<<file name>>@}"
9122.index expansion||file existence test
9123.index file||existence test
9124The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9125condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9126is done by calling the \*stat()*\ function. The use of the \exists\ test in
9127users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9128
9129.item "first@_delivery"
9130.index delivery||first
9131.index first delivery
9132.index expansion||first delivery test
9133This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9134attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9135
495ae4b0
PH
9136.item "ge @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9137.item "gei @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9138.index string||comparison
9139.index expansion||string comparison
9140The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9141string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string: for \ge\ the
9142comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for \gei\ the comparison is
9143case-independent.
9144
9145.item "gt @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9146.item "gti @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9147.index string||comparison
9148.index expansion||string comparison
9149The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9150string is lexically greater than the second string: for \gt\ the comparison
9151includes the case of letters, whereas for \gti\ the comparison is
9152case-independent.
495ae4b0
PH
9153
9154.item "isip @{<<string>>@}" 8
9155.item "isip4 @{<<string>>@}"
9156.item "isip6 @{<<string>>@}"
9157.index IP address||testing string format
9158.index string||testing for IP address
4964e932
PH
9159The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9160an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for \isip\, whereas
9161\isip4\ and \isip6\ test just for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses, respectively. For
495ae4b0 9162example, you could use
4964e932 9163.display asis
495ae4b0
PH
9164${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9165.endd
9166to test which version of IP an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9167
9168
9169.item "ldapauth @{<<ldap query>>@}"
9170.index LDAP||use for authentication
9171.index expansion||LDAP authentication test
9172This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section ~~SECTldap
9173for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of queries. For this
9174use, the query must contain a user name and password. The query itself is not
9175used, and can be empty. The condition is true if
9176the password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the
4964e932 9177LDAP server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP
495ae4b0
PH
9178binds with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of
9179the username, and will succeed in most configurations.
9180See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for details of SMTP authentication, and chapter
9181~~CHAPplaintext for an example of how this can be used.
9182
9183
495ae4b0
PH
9184.item "le @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9185.item "lei @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9186.index string||comparison
9187.index expansion||string comparison
9188The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9189string is lexically less than or equal to the second string: for \le\ the
9190comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for \lei\ the comparison is
9191case-independent.
9192
9193.item "lt @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9194.item "lti @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9195.index string||comparison
9196.index expansion||string comparison
9197The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9198string is lexically less than the second string: for \lt\ the comparison
9199includes the case of letters, whereas for \lti\ the comparison is
9200case-independent.
495ae4b0
PH
9201
9202
9203.item "match @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9204.index expansion||regular expression comparison
9205.index regular expressions||match in expanded string
9206The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
9207expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
9208regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
9209escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
9210(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
9211premature termination of <<string2>>. The easiest approach is to use the
9212\"@\N"\ feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
9213For example,
9214.display asis
9215${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
9216.endd
9217If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
9218backslashes is also required.
9219
4964e932
PH
9220The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
9221The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
495ae4b0 9222metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
4964e932
PH
9223and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
9224the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the \"@$"\
495ae4b0 9225metacharacter at an appropriate point.
495ae4b0
PH
9226
9227.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \if\ expansion
9228At the start of an \if\ expansion the values of the numeric variable
9229substitutions \$1$\ etc. are remembered. Obeying a \match\ condition that
9230succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
9231will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
9232of the \if\ expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
9233combination of conditions using \or\, the subsequent values of the numeric
9234variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
9235
495ae4b0
PH
9236.item "match@_domain @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9237.item "match@_address @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9238.item "match@_local@_part @{<<string1>>@}@{<<string2>>@}"
9239.index domain list||in expansion condition
9240.index address list||in expansion condition
9241.index local part list||in expansion condition
9242These conditions make it possible to test domain, address, and local
9243part lists within expansions. Each condition requires two arguments: an item
9244and a list to match. A trivial example is:
9245.display asis
9246${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
9247.endd
9248In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
9249list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
9250expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
9251Thus, you can use conditions like this:
9252.display asis
9253${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
9254.endd
9255.index \"+caseful"\
9256For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the \"+caseful"\
9257item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
9258have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
9259caselessly.
9260
9261\**Note**\: Host lists are \*not*\ supported in this way. This is because
9262hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
9263how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. At least, I haven't come
9264up with anything yet.
495ae4b0
PH
9265
9266.item "pam {<<string1>>:<<string2>>:...@}"
9267.index PAM authentication
9268.index \\AUTH\\||with PAM
9269.index Solaris||PAM support
9270.index expansion||PAM authentication test
9271\*Pluggable Authentication Modules*\
9272(\?http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/?\)
9273are a facility which is available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some
9274GNU/Linux distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in
9275conjunction with the SMTP \\AUTH\\ command, is available only if Exim is
9276compiled with
9277.display asis
9278SUPPORT_PAM=yes
9279.endd
9280in \(Local/Makefile)\. You probably need to add \-lpam-\ to \\EXTRALIBS\\, and
9281in some releases of GNU/Linux \-ldl-\ is also needed.
9282
9283The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a colon-separated
4964e932 9284list of strings.
495ae4b0
PH
9285Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9286The PAM module is initialized with the service name `exim' and the user name
9287taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<<string1>>). The
9288remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests from
9289the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one request,
9290for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
9291
9292There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
9293characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
9294separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the \sg\ expansion
9295item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
9296of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
9297.display asis
9298server_condition = ${if pam{$1:${sg{$2}{:}{::}}}{yes}{no}}
9299.endd
9300For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
9301.display asis
9302server_condition = ${if pam{$2:${sg{$3}{:}{::}}}{yes}{no}}
9303.endd
9304In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
9305running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
9306messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
9307A patched version of the \*pam@_unix*\ module that comes with the
9308Linux PAM package is available from \?http:@/@/www.e-admin.de/pam@_exim/?\.
9309The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
9310to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
9311group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
9312
9313
9314.item "pwcheck {<<string1>>:<<string2>>@}"
9315.index \*pwcheck*\ daemon
9316.index Cyrus
9317.index expansion||\*pwcheck*\ authentication test
9318This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus \*pwcheck*\ daemon.
9319This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
9320that is not running as root.
9321\**Note:**\ The use of \*pwcheck*\ is now deprecated. Its replacement is
9322\*saslauthd*\ (see below).
9323
9324The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
9325the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in \(Local/Makefile)\ before
9326building Exim. For example:
9327.display asis
9328CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
9329.endd
9330You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
9331the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
9332from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that \*exim*\ is the only user that has
9333access to the \(/var/pwcheck)\ directory.
9334
9335The \pwcheck\ condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
9336password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
9337configuration, you might have this:
9338.display asis
9339server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$1:$2}{1}{0}}
9340.endd
9341
9342.item "queue@_running"
9343.index queue runner||detecting when delivering from
9344.index expansion||queue runner test
9345This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
9346initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
9347
9348
9349.item "radius {<<authentication string>>@}"
9350.index Radius
9351.index expansion||Radius authentication
9352Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
9353set \\RADIUS@_CONFIG@_FILE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ to specify the location of
9354the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
4964e932 9355support.
d43194df
PH
9356.em
9357With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the \radiusclient\
9358library. You can also link Exim with the \libradius\ library that comes with
9359FreeBSD. To do this, set
9360.display asis
9361RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
9362.endd
9363in \(Local/Makefile)\, in addition to setting \\RADIUS@_CONFIGURE@_FILE\\.
9364.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9365You may also have to supply a suitable setting in \\EXTRALIBS\\ so that the
9366Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
d43194df 9367
495ae4b0
PH
9368The string specified by \\RADIUS@_CONFIG@_FILE\\ is expanded and passed to the
9369Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
9370the authentication is successful. For example
9371.display
9372server@_condition = @$@{if radius@{<<arguments>>@}@{yes@}@{no@}@}
9373.endd
9374
9375
9376
9377.item "saslauthd @{@{<<user>>@}@{<<password>>@}@{<<service>>@}@{<<realm>>@}@}"
9378.index \*saslauthd*\ daemon
9379.index Cyrus
9380.index expansion||\*saslauthd*\ authentication test
9381This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus \*saslauthd*\
9382daemon. This replaces the older \*pwcheck*\ daemon, which is now deprecated.
9383Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
9384by a process that is not running as root.
9385
9386The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
9387the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in \(Local/Makefile)\ before
9388building Exim. For example:
9389.display asis
9390CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
9391.endd
9392You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
9393the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
9394from the Cyrus SASL library.
9395
9396Up to four arguments can be supplied to the \saslauthd\ condition, but only two
9397are mandatory. For example:
9398.display asis
9399server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$1}{$2}}{1}{0}}
9400.endd
9401The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
9402in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
9403realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
9404
9405.enditems
9406
9407
9408
9409.section Combining expansion conditions
9410.index expansion||combining conditions
9411Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the \and\ and
9412\or\ combination conditions. Note that \and\ and \or\ are complete conditions
9413on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each sub-condition
9414must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain the list. No
9415repetition of \if\ is used.
9416
9417.startitems
9418
9419.item "or @{@{<<cond1>>@}@{<<cond2>>@}...@}"
9420.index `or' expansion condition
9421.index expansion||`or' of conditions
9422The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
9423any one of the sub-conditions is true.
9424For example,
9425.display asis
9426${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
9427.endd
9428When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
9429evaluated. If there are several `match' sub-conditions the values of the
9430numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
9431
9432.item "and @{@{<<cond1>>@}@{<<cond2>>@}...@}"
9433.index `and' expansion condition
9434.index expansion||`and' of conditions
9435The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
9436all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several `match'
9437sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
9438the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
9439parsed but not evaluated.
9440
9441.enditems
9442
9443
9444
9445.section Expansion variables
9446.rset SECTexpvar "~~chapter.~~section"
9447.index expansion||variables, list of
9448
d43194df
PH
9449.em
9450This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
9451of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
9452support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
9453.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9454
9455.push
9456.indent 2em
495ae4b0 9457.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)
d43194df 9458.tempindent 0
495ae4b0
PH
9459\$0$\, \$1$\, etc: When a \match\ expansion condition succeeds, these
9460variables contain the captured substrings identified by the regular expression
9461during subsequent processing of the success string of the containing \if\
9462expansion item. They may also be set externally by some other matching process
9463which precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available
9464in Exim filter files include an \if\ command with its own regular expression
9465matching condition.
9466
9467.tempindent 0
4964e932 9468\$acl@_c0$\ -- \$acl@_c9$\: Values can be placed in these variables by the
495ae4b0
PH
9469\set\ modifier in an ACL. The values persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP
9470connection. They can be used to pass information between ACLs and different
4964e932 9471invocations of the same ACL.
495ae4b0 9472When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the
4964e932 9473message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during
495ae4b0
PH
9474subsequent delivery.
9475
9476.tempindent 0
9477\$acl@_m0$\ -- \$acl@_m9$\: Values can be placed in these variables by the
9478\set\ modifier in an ACL. They retain their values while a message is being
9479received, but are reset afterwards. They are also reset by \\MAIL\\, \\RSET\\,
9480\\EHLO\\, \\HELO\\, and after starting a TLS session.
9481When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the
9482message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during
9483subsequent delivery.
9484
9485
9486.tempindent 0
4964e932 9487\$acl@_verify@_message$\: During the expansion of the \message\ and
495ae4b0
PH
9488\log@_message\ modifiers in an ACL statement after an address verification has
9489failed, this variable contains the original failure message that will be
9490overridden by the expanded string.
9491
9492.tempindent 0
9493\$address@_data$\: This variable is set by means of the \address@_data\
9494option in routers. The value then remains with the address while it is
9495processed by subsequent routers and eventually a transport. If the transport is
9496handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used. See
d43194df
PH
9497chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric for more details. \**Note**\: the contents of
9498\$address@_data$\ are visible in user filter files.
9499
9500.em
9501If \$address@_data$\ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
9502a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
9503conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
9504to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
9505of the verification, and in this case the final value of \$address@_data$\ is
9506from the child's routing.
9507
9508If \$address@_data$\ is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
9509sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
9510\$sender@_address@_data$\, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
9511address.
495ae4b0 9512
d43194df
PH
9513In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
9514after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
9515these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
9516.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9517
9518.tempindent 0
9519\$address@_file$\: When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a
9520message is directed to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the
9521file when the transport is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For
9522example, using the default configuration, if user \r2d2\ has a \(.forward)\
9523file containing
9524.display asis
9525/home/r2d2/savemail
9526.endd
9527then when the \%address@_file%\ transport is running, \$address@_file$\
9528contains `/home/r2d2/savemail'.
9529.index Sieve filter||value of \$address@_file$\
4964e932
PH
9530For Sieve filters, the value may be `inbox' or a relative folder name. It is
9531then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
495ae4b0
PH
9532to the relevant file.
9533
9534
9535.tempindent 0
9536\$address@_pipe$\: When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is
9537directed to a pipe, this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is
9538running.
9539
9540.index authentication||id
9541.tempindent 0
9542\$authenticated@_id$\: When a server successfully authenticates a client it may
9543be configured to preserve some of the authentication information in the
9544variable \$authenticated@_id$\ (see chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH). For example, a
9545user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
9546in the routers. When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP
9547connection), the value of \$authenticated@_id$\ is the login name of the
9548calling process.
9549
9550.index sender||authenticated
9551.index authentication||sender
9552.index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
9553.tempindent 0
9554\$authenticated@_sender$\:
495ae4b0
PH
9555When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the \\AUTH=\\ parameter on an
9556incoming SMTP \\MAIL\\ command
495ae4b0
PH
9557if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as described in section
9558~~SECTauthparamail. Unless the data is the string `@<@>', it is set as the
9559authenticated sender of the message, and the value is available during delivery
9560in the \$authenticated@_sender$\ variable. If the sender is not trusted, Exim
9561accepts the syntax of \\AUTH=\\, but ignores the data.
9562
9563When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
9564value of \$authenticated@_sender$\ is an address constructed from the login
9565name of the calling process and \$qualify@_domain$\.
9566
9567
9568.index authentication||failure
9569.tempindent 0
4964e932 9570\$authentication@_failed$\:
495ae4b0
PH
9571This variable is set to `1' in an Exim server if a client issues an \\AUTH\\
9572command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to `0'. This makes it
9573possible to distinguish between `did not try to authenticate'
9574(\$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ is empty and \$authentication__failed$\ is set
9575to `0') and `tried to authenticate but failed' (\$sender@_host@_authenticated$\
9576is empty and \$authentication@_failed$\ is set to `1'). Failure includes any
9577negative response to an \\AUTH\\ command, including (for example) an attempt to
9578use an undefined mechanism.
9579
9580
9581.index message||body, line count
9582.index body of message||line count
9583.tempindent 0
9584\$body@_linecount$\:
9585When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
9586number of lines in the message's body.
9587
9588.index message||body, binary zero count
9589.index body of message||binary zero count
9590.index binary zero||in message body
9591.tempindent 0
495ae4b0
PH
9592\$body@_zerocount$\:
9593When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
9594number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
495ae4b0
PH
9595
9596.tempindent 0
9597\$bounce@_recipient$\:
9598This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
9599it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
9600chapter ~~CHAPemsgcust).
9601
9602.tempindent 0
9603\$bounce@_return@_size@_limit$\: This contains the value set in the
9604\bounce@_return@_size@_limit\ option, rounded up to a multiple of 1000. It is
9605useful when a customized error message text file is in use (see chapter
9606~~CHAPemsgcust).
9607
9608.index gid (group id)||caller
9609.tempindent 0
4964e932
PH
9610\$caller@_gid$\: The
9611real
495ae4b0
PH
9612group id under which the process that called Exim was
9613running. This is not the same as the group id of the originator of a message
9614(see \$originator@_gid$\). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
9615incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
9616
9617.index uid (user id)||caller
9618.tempindent 0
4964e932 9619\$caller@_uid$\: The
495ae4b0 9620real
495ae4b0
PH
9621user id under which the process that called Exim was
9622running. This is not the same as the user id of the originator of a message
9623(see \$originator@_uid$\). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
9624incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
9625
9626.tempindent 0
9627\$compile@_date$\: The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
9628
9629.tempindent 0
9630\$compile@_number$\: The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
9631of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
9632compilations of the same version of the program.
9633
d43194df
PH
9634.em
9635.tempindent 0
9636\$demime@_$\\*xxx*\: Two variables whose names start with \$demime$\ are
9637available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension and the
9638obsolete \demime\ condition. For details, see section ~~SECTdemimecond.
9639.nem
9640
495ae4b0
PH
9641.index black list (DNS)
9642.tempindent 0
9643\$dnslist@_domain$\: When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
9644the list's domain name is put into this variable so that it can be included in
9645the rejection message.
9646
9647.tempindent 0
9648\$dnslist@_text$\: When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list, the
9649contents of any associated TXT record are placed in this variable.
9650
9651.tempindent 0
9652\$dnslist@_value$\: When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
9653the IP address from the resource record is placed in this variable.
4964e932 9654If there are multiple records, all the addresses are included, comma-space
495ae4b0
PH
9655separated.
9656
9657.tempindent 0
9658\$domain$\: When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
9659variable contains the domain. Global address rewriting happens when a message
9660is received, so the value of \$domain$\ during routing and delivery is the
9661value after rewriting. \$domain$\ is set during user filtering, but not during
9662system filtering, because a message may have many recipients and the system
9663filter is called just once.
9664
9665When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
9666\\RCPT\\ commands in one SMTP delivery), \$domain$\ is set only if they all
9667have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
9668at a time if the value of \$domain$\ is required at transport time -- this is
9669the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
9670which local transports are run, see chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
9671
9672.index \delay@_warning@_condition\
9673At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
9674set in \$domain$\ during the expansion of \delay@_warning@_condition\.
9675
9676The \$domain$\ variable is also used in some other circumstances:
9677.numberpars $.
9678When an ACL is running for a \\RCPT\\ command, \$domain$\ contains the domain
9679of the recipient address.
4964e932
PH
9680\**Note:**\ the domain of the sender address is in \$sender@_address@_domain$\
9681at \\MAIL\\ time and at \\RCPT\\ time. \$domain$\ is not set for the \\MAIL\\
495ae4b0
PH
9682ACL.
9683.nextp
9684When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter ~~CHAPrewrite), \$domain$\
9685contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten; it can be
9686used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to rewrite
9687domains by file lookup.
9688.nextp
9689With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
9690\$domain$\ contains the subject domain. \**Exception**\: When a domain list in
9691a \sender@_domains\ condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
9692is in \$sender@_address@_domain$\ and not in \$domain$\. It works this way so
9693that, in a \\RCPT\\ ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
9694recipient domain (which is what is in \$domain$\ at this time).
9695.nextp
9696.index \\ETRN\\||value of \$domain$\
9697.index \smtp@_etrn@_command\
9698When the \smtp@_etrn@_command\ option is being expanded, \$domain$\ contains
9699the complete argument of the \\ETRN\\ command (see section ~~SECTETRN).
9700.endp
9701
9702.tempindent 0
9703\$domain@_data$\: When the \domains\ option on a router matches a domain by
9704means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
9705of the router as \$domain@_data$\. In addition, if the driver routes the
9706address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
9707transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
4964e932 9708used.
495ae4b0 9709
4964e932
PH
9710\$domain@_data$\ is also set when the \domains\ condition in an ACL matches a
9711domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
495ae4b0
PH
9712the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
9713to nothing.
9714
495ae4b0
PH
9715.tempindent 0
9716\$exim@_gid$\: This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
9717
9718.tempindent 0
9719\$exim@_path$\: This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
9720
9721.tempindent 0
9722\$exim@_uid$\: This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
495ae4b0 9723
d43194df
PH
9724.em
9725.tempindent 0
9726\$found@_extension$\: This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9727content-scanning extension and the obsolete \demime\ condition. For details,
9728see section ~~SECTdemimecond.
9729.nem
9730
495ae4b0
PH
9731.tempindent 0
9732\$header@_<<name>>$\: This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is
9733expansion syntax for inserting the message header line with the given name.
9734Note that the name must be terminated by colon or white space, because it may
9735contain a wide variety of characters.
9736Note also that braces must \*not*\ be used.
9737
9738.tempindent 0
9739\$home$\:
9740When the \check@_local@_user\ option is set for a router, the user's home
9741directory is placed in \$home$\ when the check succeeds. In particular, this
9742means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
9743explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
9744by a setting on the transport itself.
9745
9746When running a filter test via the \-bf-\ option, \$home$\ is set to the value
9747of the environment variable \\HOME\\.
9748
9749.tempindent 0
9750\$host$\:
9751When the \%smtp%\ transport is expanding its options for encryption using TLS,
9752\$host$\ contains the name of the host to which it is connected. Likewise, when
9753used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
9754~~CHAPSMTPAUTH), \$host$\ contains the name of the server to which the client
9755is connected.
9756.index transport||filter
9757.index filter||transport filter
9758When used in a transport filter (see chapter ~~CHAPtransportgeneric) \$host$\
9759refers to the host involved in the current connection. When a local transport
9760is run as a result of a router that sets up a host list, \$host$\ contains the
9761name of the first host.
9762
9763.tempindent 0
9764\$host@_address$\:
9765This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever \$host$\ is set
9766for a remote connection.
d43194df
PH
9767.em
9768It is also set to the IP address that is being checked when the
9769\ignore@_target@_hosts\ option is being processed.
9770.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9771
9772.tempindent 0
9773\$host@_data$\:
9774If a \hosts\ condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
9775of the lookup is made available in the \$host@_data$\ variable. This
9776allows you, for example, to do things like this:
9777.display asis
9778deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
9779 message = $host_data
9780.endd
9781
d43194df 9782.em
495ae4b0
PH
9783.index host||name lookup, failure of
9784.tempindent 0
d43194df
PH
9785\$host@_lookup@_deferred$\:
9786This variable normally contains `0', as does \$host@_lookup@_failed$\. When a
9787message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
9788name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
9789variables is set to `1'.
9790.numberpars $.
9791If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
9792succeeded, but no records were found), \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to `1'.
9793.nextp
9794If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
9795tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
9796lookup), \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\ is set to `1'.
9797.endp
9798Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
9799single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
9800names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
9801is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
9802\$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to `1'. Thus, being able to find a name from an
9803IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
9804sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
9805lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
9806the result, the name is not accepted, and \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\ is set to
9807`1'. See also \$sender@_host@_name$\.
9808
9809.tempindent 0
9810\$host@_lookup@_failed$\: See \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\.
9811.nem
495ae4b0
PH
9812
9813.tempindent 0
9814\$inode$\:
9815The only time this variable is set is while expanding the \directory@_file\
9816option in the \%appendfile%\ transport. The variable contains the inode number
9817of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
9818a unique name for the file.
9819
9820.tempindent 0
9821\$interface@_address$\:
9822When a message is received over a TCP/IP connection, this variable contains the
9823address of the local IP interface. See also the \-oMi-\ command line option.
4964e932 9824This variable can be used in ACLs and also, for example, to make the file name
495ae4b0
PH
9825for a TLS certificate depend on which interface is being used.
9826
9827.tempindent 0
9828\$interface@_port$\:
9829When a message is received over a TCP/IP connection, this variable contains the
9830local port number. See also the \-oMi-\ command line option.
4964e932 9831This variable can be used in ACLs and also, for example, to make the file name
495ae4b0
PH
9832for a TLS certificate depend on which port is being used.
9833
9834.tempindent 0
9835\$ldap@_dn$\:
4964e932
PH
9836This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
9837contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
495ae4b0
PH
9838lookup.
9839
495ae4b0
PH
9840.tempindent 0
9841\$load@_average$\:
4964e932
PH
9842This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 to that it
9843is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
495ae4b0
PH
9844variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
9845
9846.tempindent 0
9847\$local@_part$\: When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
9848variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
9849delivered together (for example, multiple \\RCPT\\ commands in an SMTP
9850session), \$local@_part$\ is not set.
9851
9852Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
9853\$local@_part$\ during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
9854\$local@_part$\ is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
9855because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
9856once.
9857
9858If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
9859value of \$local@_part$\ during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
9860any prefix or suffix are in \$local@_part@_prefix$\ and
9861\$local@_part@_suffix$\, respectively.
9862
9863When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
9864result of aliasing or forwarding, \$local@_part$\ is set to the local part of
9865the parent address, not to the file name or command (see \$address@_file$\ and
9866\$address@_pipe$\).
9867
9868When an ACL is running for a \\RCPT\\ command, \$local@_part$\ contains the
9869local part of the recipient address.
9870
9871When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter ~~CHAPrewrite),
9872\$local@_part$\ contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
9873it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
9874
9875In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
9876the addresses
9877.display asis
9878"abc:xyz"@test.example
9879abc\:xyz@test.example
9880.endd
9881the value of \$local@_part$\ is
9882.display asis
9883abc:xyz
9884.endd
9885If you use \$local@_part$\ to create another address, you should always wrap it
9886inside a quoting operator. For example, in a \%redirect%\ router you could have:
9887.display asis
9888data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
9889.endd
4964e932
PH
9890\**Note**\: The value of \$local@_part$\ is normally lower cased. If you want
9891to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
495ae4b0 9892\caseful@_local@_part\ option (see chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric).
495ae4b0
PH
9893
9894.tempindent 0
9895\$local@_part@_data$\:
9896When the \local@_parts\ option on a router matches a local part by means of a
9897lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
9898router as \$local@_part@_data$\. In addition, if the driver routes the address
9899to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
9900handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
9901
9902\$local@_part@_data$\ is also set when the \local@_parts\ condition in an ACL
9903matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
9904available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
9905variable expands to nothing.
9906
9907.tempindent 0
9908\$local@_part@_prefix$\: When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
9909specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
9910variable, having been removed from \$local@_part$\.
9911
9912.tempindent 0
9913\$local@_part@_suffix$\: When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
9914specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
9915variable, having been removed from \$local@_part$\.
9916
9917.tempindent 0
9918\$local@_scan@_data$\: This variable contains the text returned by the
9919\*local@_scan()*\ function when a message is received. See chapter
9920~~CHAPlocalscan for more details.
9921
9922.tempindent 0
9923\$local@_user@_gid$\: See \$local@_user@_uid$\.
9924
9925.tempindent 0
9926\$local@_user@_uid$\: This variable and \$local@_user@_gid$\ are set to
9927the uid and gid after the \check__local__user\ router precondition succeeds.
9928This means that their values are available for the remaining preconditions
9929(\senders\, \require@_files\, and \condition\), for the \address@_data\
9930expansion, and for any router-specific expansions. At all other times, the
9931values in these variables are \"(uid@_t)(-1)"\ and \"(gid@_t)(-1)"\,
9932respectively.
9933
495ae4b0
PH
9934.tempindent 0
9935\$localhost@_number$\: This contains the expanded value of the
9936\localhost@_number\ option. The expansion happens after the main options have
9937been read.
9938
d43194df
PH
9939.em
9940.tempindent 0
9941\$log@_inodes$\: The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
9942log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
9943referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
9944the value of is -1. See also the \check@_log@_inodes\ option.
9945
9946.tempindent 0
9947\$log@_space$\: The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
9948partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
9949whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
9950ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
9951the space value is -1. See also the \check@_log@_space\ option.
9952.nem
9953
495ae4b0 9954.tempindent 0
4964e932
PH
9955\$mailstore@_basename$\: This variable is set only when doing deliveries in
9956`mailstore' format in the \%appendfile%\ transport. During the expansion of the
9957\mailstore@_prefix\, \mailstore@_suffix\, \message__prefix\, and
495ae4b0
PH
9958\message@_suffix\ options, it contains the basename of the files that are being
9959written, that is, the name without the `.tmp', `.env', or `.msg' suffix. At all
9960other times, this variable is empty.
9961
d43194df
PH
9962.em
9963.tempindent 0
9964\$malware@_name$\: This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
9965content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
9966when the ACL \malware\ condition is true (see section ~~SECTscanvirus).
9967.nem
9968
495ae4b0
PH
9969.index message||age of
9970.tempindent 0
9971\$message@_age$\: This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to
9972contain the number of seconds since the message was received. It does not
9973change during a single delivery attempt.
9974
9975.index body of message||expansion variable
9976.index message||body, in expansion
9977.index binary zero||in message body
9978.tempindent 0
9979\$message@_body$\: This variable contains the initial portion of a message's
9980body while it is being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter
9981files. The maximum number of characters of the body that are put into the
9982variable is set by the \message@_body@_visible\ configuration option; the
9983default is 500. Newlines are converted into spaces to make it easier to search
9984for phrases that might be split over a line break.
9985Binary zeros are also converted into spaces.
9986
9987.index body of message||expansion variable
9988.index message||body, in expansion
9989.tempindent 0
9990\$message@_body@_end$\: This variable contains the final portion of a message's
9991body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
9992\$message@_body$\.
9993
9994.index body of message||size
9995.index message||body, size
9996.tempindent 0
d43194df 9997\$message@_body@_size$\: When a message is being delivered, this variable
495ae4b0
PH
9998contains the size of the body in bytes. The count starts from the character
9999after the blank line that separates the body from the header. Newlines are
d43194df
PH
10000included in the count. See also \$message@_size$\, \$body@_linecount$\, and
10001\$body@_zerocount$\.
495ae4b0
PH
10002
10003.tempindent 0
10004\$message@_headers$\:
10005This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10006is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10007lines are separated by newline characters.
10008
10009.tempindent 0
4964e932 10010\$message@_id$\:
495ae4b0
PH
10011When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10012unique message id that is used by Exim to identify the message.
4964e932 10013An id is not created for a message until after its header has been
495ae4b0 10014successfully received.
4964e932
PH
10015\**Note**\: This is \*not*\ the contents of the ::Message-ID:: header line; it
10016is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
495ae4b0 10017\"1BXTIK-0001yO-VA"\.
495ae4b0
PH
10018
10019.index size||of message
10020.index message||size
10021.tempindent 0
4964e932 10022\$message@_size$\:
495ae4b0
PH
10023When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
10024most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
10025message, but not those (such as ::Envelope-to::) that are added to individual
10026deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
10027expansion of the \maildir@_tag\ option in the \%appendfile%\ transport while
10028doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of \$message@_size$\ is the
10029precise size of the file that has been written. See also
d43194df 10030\$message@_body@_size$\, \$body@_linecount$\, and \$body@_zerocount$\.
495ae4b0
PH
10031
10032.index \\RCPT\\||value of \$message@_size$\
10033While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP \\RCPT\\ command, \$message@_size$\
4964e932 10034contains the size supplied on the \\MAIL\\ command, or
495ae4b0
PH
10035-1
10036if no size was given. The value may not, of course, be truthful.
10037
d43194df
PH
10038.em
10039.tempindent 0
10040\$mime@_$\\*xxx*\:
10041A number of variables whose names start with \$mime$\ are available when Exim
10042is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
10043~~SECTscanmimepart.
10044.nem
10045
495ae4b0
PH
10046.tempindent 0
10047\$n0$\ -- \$n9$\: These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
10048of the \add\ command in filter files.
10049
10050.tempindent 0
10051\$original@_domain$\: When a top-level address is being processed for delivery,
10052this contains the same value as \$domain$\. However, if a `child' address (for
10053example, generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed,
10054this variable contains the domain of the original address. This differs from
10055\$parent@_domain$\ only when there is more than one level of aliasing or
10056forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a single transport
10057run, \$original@_domain$\ is not set.
10058
10059If new an address is created by means of a \deliver\ command in a system
10060filter, it is set up with an artificial `parent' address. This has the local
10061part \*system-filter*\ and the default qualify domain.
10062
10063.tempindent 0
10064\$original@_local@_part$\: When a top-level address is being processed for
10065delivery, this contains the same value as \$local@_part$\, unless a prefix or
d43194df
PH
10066suffix was removed from the local part, because \$original@_local@_part$\
10067always contains the full local part. When a `child' address (for example,
10068generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
10069variable contains the full local part of the original address.
10070
10071If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
10072case-insensitively, the value in \$original@_local@_part$\ is in lower case.
10073This variable differs from \$parent@_local@_part$\ only when there is more than
10074one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
10075delivered in a single transport run, \$original@_local@_part$\ is not set.
495ae4b0
PH
10076
10077If new an address is created by means of a \deliver\ command in a system
10078filter, it is set up with an artificial `parent' address. This has the local
10079part \*system-filter*\ and the default qualify domain.
10080
10081
10082.index gid (group id)||of originating user
10083.index sender||gid
10084.tempindent 0
10085\$originator@_gid$\: The value of \$caller@_gid$\ that was set when the message
10086was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the gid of
10087the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally
10088the gid of the Exim user.
10089
10090.index uid (user id)||of originating user
10091.index sender||uid
10092.tempindent 0
10093\$originator@_uid$\: The value of \$caller@_uid$\ that was set when the message
10094was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the uid of
10095the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally
10096the uid of the Exim user.
10097
10098.tempindent 0
10099\$parent@_domain$\: This variable is similar to \$original@_domain$\ (see
10100above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
10101
10102.tempindent 0
10103\$parent@_local@_part$\: This variable is similar to \$original@_local@_part$\
10104(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
10105
10106.index pid (process id)||of current process
10107.tempindent 0
10108\$pid$\: This variable contains the current process id.
10109
10110.index filter||transport filter
10111.index transport||filter
10112.tempindent 0
10113\$pipe@_addresses$\: This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here
10114because the string `@$pipe@_addresses' is handled specially in the command
10115specification for the \%pipe%\ transport (chapter ~~CHAPpipetransport) and in
10116transport filters (described under \transport@_filter\ in chapter
10117~~CHAPtransportgeneric). It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and
10118provokes an `unknown variable' error if encountered.
10119
10120.tempindent 0
10121\$primary@_hostname$\: The value set in the configuration file, or read by the
10122\*uname()*\ function. If \*uname()*\ returns a single-component name, Exim
10123calls \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ where available) in an
10124attempt to acquire a fully qualified host name.
495ae4b0 10125See also \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\.
495ae4b0
PH
10126
10127.tempindent 0
10128\$qualify@_domain$\: The value set for this option in the configuration file.
10129
10130.tempindent 0
10131\$qualify@_recipient$\: The value set for this option in the configuration file,
10132or if not set, the value of \$qualify@_domain$\.
10133
10134.tempindent 0
4964e932 10135\$rcpt@_count$\: When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
495ae4b0
PH
10136contains the number of \\RCPT\\ commands received for the current message. If
10137this variable is used in a \\RCPT\\ ACL, its value includes the current
10138command.
10139
10140.tempindent 0
4964e932 10141\$rcpt@_defer@_count$\: When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
495ae4b0
PH
10142contains the number of \\RCPT\\ commands in the current message that have
10143previously been rejected with a temporary (4\*xx*\) response.
10144
10145.tempindent 0
10146\$rcpt@_fail@_count$\: When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable
10147contains the number of \\RCPT\\ commands in the current message that have
10148previously been rejected with a permanent (5\*xx*\) response.
10149
10150.tempindent 0
10151\$received@_count$\: This variable contains the number of ::Received:: header
10152lines in the message, including the one added by Exim (so its value is always
10153greater than zero). It is available in the \\DATA\\ ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and
10154while routing and delivering.
10155
10156.tempindent 0
10157\$received@_for$\: If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming
10158message, this variable contains that address when the ::Received:: header line
10159is being built.
495ae4b0
PH
10160The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before the
10161\*local@_scan()*\ function is run.
495ae4b0
PH
10162
10163.tempindent 0
10164\$received@_protocol$\: When a message is being processed, this variable
d43194df
PH
10165contains the name of the protocol by which it was received.
10166.em
10167Most of the names used by Exim are defined by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They
10168start with `smtp' (the client used \\HELO\\) or `esmtp' (the client used
10169\\EHLO\\). This can be followed by `s' for secure (encrypted) and/or `a' for
10170authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol is set to `esmtpsa', the
10171message was received over an encrypted SMTP connection and the client was
10172successfully authenticated.
10173
10174Exim also uses the protocol name `smtps' for the rare situation where the
10175client initially used \\EHLO\\, set up an encrypted connection using
10176\\STARTTLS\\, and then used \\HELO\\ afterwards to initiate the encrypted
10177session.
10178
10179The \-oMr-\ option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
10180messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
10181identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
10182.nem
495ae4b0 10183
495ae4b0
PH
10184.tempindent 0
10185\$recipient@_data$\: This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in
10186an ACL \recipients\ condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
10187value remains set until the next \recipients\ test. Thus, you can do things
10188like this:
10189.display
10190require recipients = cdb*@@;/some/file
10191deny \*some further test involving*\ @$recipient@_data
10192.endd
4964e932 10193\**Warning**\: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
495ae4b0
PH
10194method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
10195The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
10196expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
495ae4b0 10197
d43194df
PH
10198.em
10199.tempindent 0
10200\$recipient@_verify@_failure$\: In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails,
10201this variable contains information about the failure. It is set to one of the
10202following words:
10203.numberpars " "
10204`qualify': The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
10205was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
10206.nextp
10207`route': Routing failed.
10208.nextp
10209`mail': Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
10210or before the \\MAIL\\ command (that is, on initial connection, \\HELO\\, or
10211\\MAIL\\).
10212.nextp
10213`recipient': The \\RCPT\\ command in a callout was rejected.
10214.nextp
10215`postmaster': The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
10216.endp
10217The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
10218rejections of \\MAIL\\ and rejections of \\RCPT\\.
10219.nem
10220
495ae4b0
PH
10221.tempindent 0
10222\$recipients$\: This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a
10223message. A comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
10224However, the variable is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc
10225recipients in unprivileged users' filter files. You can use \$recipients$\ only
d43194df 10226in these two cases:
495ae4b0
PH
10227.numberpars
10228In a system filter file.
10229.nextp
d43194df
PH
10230.em
10231In the ACLs associated with the \\DATA\\ command, that is, the ACLs defined by
10232\acl@_smtp@_predata\ and \acl@_smtp@_data\.
10233.nem
495ae4b0
PH
10234.endp
10235
10236.tempindent 0
10237\$recipients@_count$\: When a message is being processed, this variable
10238contains the number of envelope recipients that came with the message.
10239Duplicates are not excluded from the count. While a message is being received
10240over SMTP, the number increases for each accepted recipient. It can be
10241referenced in an ACL.
10242
10243.tempindent 0
10244\$reply@_address$\: When a message is being processed, this variable contains
10245the contents of the ::Reply-To:: header line if one exists
10246and it is not empty,
10247or otherwise the contents of the ::From:: header line.
10248
10249.tempindent 0
10250\$return@_path$\: When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the
10251return path -- the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It
4964e932
PH
10252is not enclosed in @<@> characters.
10253At the start of routing an address,
495ae4b0
PH
10254\$return@_path$\ has the same value as \$sender@_address$\, but if, for
10255example, an incoming message to a mailing list has been expanded by a router
10256which specifies a different address for bounce messages, \$return@_path$\
10257subsequently contains the new bounce address, whereas \$sender@_address$\
10258always contains the original sender address that was received with the message.
4964e932 10259In other words, \$sender@_address$\ contains the incoming envelope sender, and
495ae4b0
PH
10260\$return@_path$\ contains the outgoing envelope sender.
10261
10262.tempindent 0
10263\$return@_size@_limit$\: This is an obsolete name for
10264\$bounce@_return@_size@_limit$\.
10265
10266.index return code||from \run\ expansion
10267.tempindent 0
10268\$runrc$\: This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by
10269the \@$@{run...@}\ expansion item.
4964e932
PH
10270\**Warning**\: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10271option values are expanded, except for those pre-conditions whose order of
10272testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set \$runrc$\
495ae4b0
PH
10273by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10274
10275.tempindent 0
10276\$self@_hostname$\: When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that
4964e932 10277turns out to be the local host, what happens is controlled by the
495ae4b0
PH
10278.index \self\ option||value of host name
10279\self\ generic router option. One of its values causes the address to be passed
10280to another router. When this happens, \$self@_hostname$\ is set to the name of
10281the local host that the original router encountered. In other circumstances its
10282contents are null.
10283
10284.tempindent 0
10285\$sender@_address$\: When a message is being processed, this variable contains
10286the sender's address that was received in the message's envelope. For bounce
10287messages, the value of this variable is the empty string.
10288See also \$return@_path$\.
10289
d43194df
PH
10290.em
10291.tempindent 0
10292\$sender@_address@_data$\: If \$address@_data$\ is set when the routers are
10293called from an ACL to verify a sender address, the final value is preserved in
10294\$sender@_address@_data$\, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10295address. The value does not persist after the end of the current ACL statement.
10296If you want to preserve it for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
10297.nem
10298
495ae4b0
PH
10299.tempindent 0
10300\$sender@_address@_domain$\: The domain portion of \$sender@_address$\.
10301
10302.tempindent 0
10303\$sender@_address@_local@_part$\: The local part portion of \$sender@_address$\.
10304
495ae4b0 10305.tempindent 0
4964e932 10306\$sender@_data$\: This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL
495ae4b0
PH
10307\senders\ condition or in a router \senders\ option. It contains the data from
10308the lookup, and the value remains set until the next \senders\ test. Thus, you
10309can do things like this:
10310.display
10311require senders = cdb*@@;/some/file
10312deny \*some further test involving*\ @$sender@_data
10313.endd
4964e932 10314\**Warning**\: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
495ae4b0
PH
10315method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
10316The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
10317expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
495ae4b0
PH
10318
10319.tempindent 0
10320\$sender@_fullhost$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10321variable contains the host name and IP address in a single string. It ends
10322with the IP address in square brackets, followed by a colon and a port number
10323if the logging of ports is enabled. The format of the rest of the string
10324depends on whether the host issued a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ SMTP command, and
10325whether the host name was verified by looking up its IP address. (Looking up
10326the IP address can be forced by the \host@_lookup\ option, independent of
10327verification.) A plain host name at the start of the string is a verified host
10328name; if this is not present, verification either failed or was not requested.
10329A host name in parentheses is the argument of a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command.
10330This is omitted if it is identical to the verified host name or to the host's
10331IP address in square brackets.
10332
10333.tempindent 0
10334\$sender@_helo@_name$\: When a message is received from a remote host that has
10335issued a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command, the argument of that command is placed
10336in this variable. It is also set if \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ is used when a message
10337is received using SMTP locally via the \-bs-\ or \-bS-\ options.
10338
10339.tempindent 0
10340\$sender@_host@_address$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10341variable contains that host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is
10342empty.
10343
10344.tempindent 0
10345\$sender@_host@_authenticated$\: This variable contains the name (not the
10346public name) of the authenticator driver which successfully authenticated the
10347client from which the message was received. It is empty if there was no
10348successful authentication.
10349
10350.tempindent 0
10351\$sender@_host@_name$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
4964e932 10352variable contains the host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address.
495ae4b0
PH
10353For messages received by other means, this variable is empty.
10354
10355If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
4964e932 10356\$sender@_host@_name$\ triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
495ae4b0 10357A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
d43194df
PH
10358via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails
10359.em
10360to find any data,
10361.nem
10362or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
495ae4b0
PH
10363\$sender@_host@_name$\ remains empty, and \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to
10364`1'.
d43194df
PH
10365.em
10366However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
10367DNS timeout), \$host@_lookup@_deferred$\ is set to `1', and
10368\$host@_lookup@_failed$\ remains set to `0'.
10369
10370Once \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to `1', Exim does not try to look up the
10371host name again if there is a subsequent reference to \$sender@_host@_name$\
10372in the same Exim process, but it does try again if \$sender@_host@_deferred$\
10373is set to `1'.
10374.nem
495ae4b0
PH
10375
10376Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
10377maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
10378these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
10379following are true:
10380.numberpars
10381A string containing \$sender@_host@_name$\ is expanded.
10382.nextp
4964e932 10383The calling host matches the list in \host@_lookup\. In the default
495ae4b0
PH
10384configuration, this option is set to $*$, so it must be changed if lookups are
10385to be avoided. (In the code, the default for \host@_lookup\ is unset.)
10386.nextp
10387Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
10388that require this are described in sections ~~SECThoslispatnam and
10389~~SECThoslispatnamsk.
10390.nextp
4964e932
PH
10391The calling host matches \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ or \helo@_verify@_hosts\.
10392In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
495ae4b0
PH
10393\\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ commands that the client issues.
10394.nextp
4964e932
PH
10395The remote host issues a \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ command that quotes one of the
10396domains in \helo@_lookup@_domains\. The default value of this option is
495ae4b0
PH
10397.display asis
10398helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
10399.endd
4964e932 10400which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
495ae4b0
PH
10401IP address in an \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ command.
10402.endp
10403
10404.tempindent 0
10405\$sender@_host@_port$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this
10406variable contains the port number that was used on the remote host.
10407
10408.tempindent 0
10409\$sender@_ident$\: When a message is received from a remote host, this variable
10410contains the identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a
10411message has been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the
10412user that called Exim.
10413
10414.tempindent 0
10415\$sender@_rcvhost$\: This is provided specifically for use in ::Received::
10416headers. It starts with either the verified host name (as obtained from a
10417.index DNS||reverse lookup
10418.index reverse DNS lookup
10419reverse DNS lookup) or, if there is no verified host name, the IP address in
10420square brackets. After that there may be text in parentheses. When the first
10421item is a verified host name, the first thing in the parentheses is the IP
10422address in square brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if port
10423logging is enabled. When the first item is an IP address, the port is recorded
10424as `port=$it{xxxx}' inside the parentheses.
10425
10426There may also be items of the form `helo=$it{xxxx}' if \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\
10427was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
10428address, and `ident=$it{xxxx}' if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If all
10429three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted into
10430the string, to improve the formatting of the ::Received:: header.
10431
d43194df
PH
10432.em
10433.tempindent 0
10434\$sender@_verify@_failure$\: In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this
10435variable contains information about the failure. The details are the same as
10436for \$recipient@_verify@_failure$\.
10437
10438.tempindent 0
10439\$smtp@_active@_hostname$\: During an SMTP session, this variable contains the
10440value of the active host name, as specified by the \smtp@_active@_hostname\
10441option. The value of \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\ is saved with any message that
10442is received, so its value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
10443.nem
10444
495ae4b0
PH
10445.index \\AUTH\\||argument
10446.index \\EXPN\\||argument
10447.index \\ETRN\\||argument
10448.index \\VRFY\\||argument
10449.tempindent 0
10450\$smtp@_command@_argument$\: While an ACL is running to check an \\AUTH\\,
10451\\EHLO\\, \\EXPN\\, \\ETRN\\, \\HELO\\, or \\VRFY\\ command, this variable
10452contains the argument for the SMTP command.
10453
10454.tempindent 0
10455\$sn0$\ -- \$sn9$\: These variables are copies of the values of the \$n0$\
10456-- \$n9$\ accumulators that were current at the end of the system filter file.
10457This allows a system filter file to set values that can be tested in users'
10458filter files. For example, a system filter could set a value indicating how
10459likely it is that a message is junk mail.
10460
d43194df
PH
10461.em
10462.tempindent 0
10463\$spam@_$\\*xxx*\: A number of variables whose names start with \$spam$\ are
10464available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
10465details, see section ~~SECTscanspamass.
10466.nem
10467
495ae4b0
PH
10468.tempindent 0
10469\$spool@_directory$\: The name of Exim's spool directory.
10470
d43194df
PH
10471.em
10472.tempindent 0
10473\$spool@_inodes$\: The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10474spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable
10475is referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10476the value of is -1.
10477See also the \check@_spool@_inodes\ option.
10478
10479.tempindent 0
10480\$spool@_space$\: The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the
10481disk partition where Exim's spool files are being written. The value is
10482recalculated whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does
10483not have the ability to find the amount of free space (only true for
10484experimental systems), the space value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL
10485that there is at least 50 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
10486.display asis
10487condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
10488.endd
10489See also the \check@_spool@_space\ option.
10490.nem
10491
495ae4b0
PH
10492.tempindent 0
10493\$thisaddress$\: This variable is set only during the processing of the
10494\foranyaddress\ command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the
10495description of that command.
10496
10497.tempindent 0
10498\$tls@_certificate@_verified$\:
10499This variable is set to `1' if a TLS certificate was verified when the message
10500was received, and `0' otherwise.
10501
10502.tempindent 0
10503\$tls@_cipher$\: When a message is received from a remote host over an
10504encrypted SMTP connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was
4964e932
PH
10505negotiated, for example DES-CBC3-SHA.
10506In other circumstances, in particular, for message received over unencrypted
495ae4b0
PH
10507connections, the variable is empty.
10508See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS support.
10509
10510.tempindent 0
10511\$tls@_peerdn$\: When a message is received from a remote host over an
4964e932 10512encrypted SMTP connection,
495ae4b0
PH
10513and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
10514the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
10515\$tls@_peerdn$\ during subsequent processing.
10516
10517.tempindent 0
10518\$tod@_bsdinbox$\: The time of day and date, in the format required for
10519BSD-style mailbox files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
10520
10521.tempindent 0
10522\$tod@_epoch$\: The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the
10523Unix epoch.
10524
10525.tempindent 0
10526\$tod@_full$\: A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct
105271995 09:51:40 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from
4964e932 10528UTC, with positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and
495ae4b0
PH
10529negative values for those that are behind (west).
10530
10531.tempindent 0
10532\$tod@_log$\: The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log
10533files, for example: 1995-10-12 15:32:29,
10534but without a timezone.
10535
10536.tempindent 0
10537\$tod@_logfile$\:
10538This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
10539is used for datestamping log files when \log@_file@_path\ contains the \"%D"\
10540flag.
10541
10542.tempindent 0
10543\$tod@_zone$\: This variable contains the numerical value of the local
10544timezone, for example: -0500.
10545
10546.tempindent 0
10547\$tod@_zulu$\:
10548This variable contains the UTC date and time in `Zulu' format, as specified by
10549ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
10550
10551.index \$value$\
10552.tempindent 0
10553\$value$\: This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction
10554operation, or external command, as described above.
10555
10556.tempindent 0
10557\$version@_number$\: The version number of Exim.
10558
10559.tempindent 0
10560\$warn@_message@_delay$\: This variable is set only during the creation of a
10561message warning about a delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in
10562section ~~SECTcustwarn.
10563
10564.tempindent 0
10565\$warn@_message@_recipients$\: This variable is set only during the creation of
10566a message warning about a delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in
10567section ~~SECTcustwarn.
10568.pop
10569
10570
10571
10572.
10573.
10574. ============================================================================
10575.chapter Embedded Perl
10576.set runningfoot "embedded Perl"
10577.rset CHAPperl "~~chapter"
10578.index Perl||calling from Exim
10579
10580Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
10581Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
10582use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
10583your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
10584the line
10585.display asis
10586EXIM_PERL = perl.o
10587.endd
10588in your \(Local/Makefile)\ and then build Exim in the normal way.
10589
d43194df 10590.section Setting up so Perl can be used
495ae4b0
PH
10591Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
10592.index \perl@_startup\
10593\perl@_startup\ and an expansion string operator \@$@{perl ...@}\. If there is
10594no \perl@_startup\ option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
10595interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
10596the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a \perl@_startup\
10597option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
10598a newly created Perl interpreter.
10599
10600The value of \perl@_startup\ is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
10601need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
10602should usually be something like
10603.display asis
10604perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
10605.endd
10606where \(/etc/exim.pl)\ is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
10607use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
10608soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
10609the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
10610its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
10611fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
10612necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
10613the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
10614two ways:
10615.numberpars $.
10616.index \perl@_at@_start\
10617Setting \perl@_at@_start\ (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
10618a startup when Exim is entered.
10619.nextp
10620The command line option \-ps-\ also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
10621overriding the setting of \perl@_at@_start\.
10622.endp
10623There is also a command line option \-pd-\ (for delay) which suppresses the
10624initial startup, even if \perl@_at@_start\ is set.
10625
d43194df 10626.section Calling Perl subroutines
495ae4b0
PH
10627When the configuration file includes a \perl@_startup\ option you can make use
10628of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
10629by the \perl@_startup\ code. The operator is used in any of the following
10630forms:
10631.display asis
10632${perl{foo}}
10633${perl{foo}{argument}}
10634${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
10635.endd
10636which calls the subroutine \foo\ with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
10637arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
10638with an error message of the form
10639.display asis
10640Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
10641.endd
10642The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
10643it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
d43194df
PH
10644return value is \*undef*\, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
10645an explicit `fail' on an \@$@{if ...@}\ or \@$@{lookup...@}\ item. If the
10646subroutine aborts by obeying Perl's \die\ function, the expansion fails with
10647the error message that was passed to \die\.
495ae4b0 10648
d43194df 10649.section Calling Exim functions from Perl
495ae4b0
PH
10650Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function \*Exim@:@:expand@_string*\
10651is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
10652the Perl code
10653.display asis
10654my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
10655.endd
10656makes the current Exim \$local@_part$\ available in the Perl variable \$lp$\.
10657Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
10658\$local@_part$\ being interpolated as a Perl variable.
10659
10660If the string expansion is forced to fail by a `fail' item, the result of
10661\*Exim@:@:expand@_string*\ is \undef\. If there is a syntax error in the
10662expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
10663an appropriate error message, in the same way as if \die\ were used.
10664
10665.index debugging||from embedded Perl
10666.index log||writing from embedded Perl
10667Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
10668\*Exim@:@:debug@_write(<<string>>)*\ writes the string to the standard error
10669stream if Exim's debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you
10670must supply it. \*Exim@:@:log@_write(<<string>>)*\ writes the string to Exim's
10671main log, adding a leading timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a
10672terminating newline.
10673
d43194df
PH
10674.em
10675.section Use of standard output and error by Perl
10676You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
10677Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim up to
10678at least 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
10679SMTP connection during message reception. Writing to this stream is likely to
10680cause chaos. Something may be done about this in later releases.
10681
10682Unfortunately, the Perl \warn\ statment writes to the standard error stream,
10683and this may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which you have
10684no control. One way round this is to ensure that the following Perl magic is
10685obeyed before \warn\ is used:
10686.display asis
10687$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { Exim::log_write($_[0]) };
10688.endd
10689This causes the output of the \warn\ statement to be written to Exim's log
10690file.
10691.nem
495ae4b0
PH
10692
10693
10694.
10695.
10696.
10697.
10698. ============================================================================
10699.chapter Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces
10700.set runningfoot "starting the daemon"
10701.rset CHAPinterfaces "~~chapter"
10702.index daemon||starting
10703.index interface||listening
10704.index network interface
10705.index interface||network
10706.index IP address||for listening
10707.index daemon||listening IP addresses
10708.index TCP/IP||setting listening interfaces
10709.index TCP/IP||setting listening ports
10710
10711A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
10712hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
10713or more `logical' interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
10714works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
10715In addition, TCP/IP software supports `loopback' interfaces (127.0.0.1 in IPv4
10716and @:@:1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
10717knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
10718.numberpars
10719When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
10720and ports to listen on.
10721.nextp
10722When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
10723are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
10724processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
10725same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
10726when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
10727local host. Unless the \self\ router option or the \allow@_localhost\
10728option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
10729as an error situation.
10730.nextp
10731When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
10732for the outgoing connection.
10733.endp
10734
10735Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
10736of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
10737addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
10738standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
10739rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
10740
4964e932 10741In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
495ae4b0
PH
10742interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
10743options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
10744chapter describes how they operate.
10745
10746When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
10747actually used are set in \$interface@_address$\ and \$interface@_port$\.
10748
10749
10750.section Starting a listening daemon
10751When a listening daemon is started (by means of the \-bd-\ command line
10752option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
10753following options:
10754.numberpars $.
10755\daemon@_smtp@_ports\ contains a list of default ports. (For backward
10756compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
10757.nextp
10758\local@_interfaces\ contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
10759listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
10760.endp
10761The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
10762described in section ~~SECTlistconstruct. When IPv6 addresses are involved, it
10763is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
10764colons. For example:
10765.display asis
10766local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
10767 192.168.23.65 ; \
10768 ::1 ; \
10769 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
4964e932 10770.endd
495ae4b0
PH
10771There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
10772in \local@_interfaces\:
10773.numberpars
4964e932 10774The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
495ae4b0
PH
10775on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
10776.display asis
10777local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
10778 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
4964e932 10779.endd
495ae4b0
PH
10780.nextp
10781The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
10782with a colon separator, for example:
10783.display asis
10784local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
10785 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
4964e932 10786.endd
495ae4b0
PH
10787.endp
10788When a port is not specified, the value of \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ is used. The
10789default setting contains just one port:
10790.display asis
10791daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
10792.endd
10793If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
10794specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
10795\daemon@_smtp@_ports\ can be identified either by name (defined in
10796\(/etc/services)\) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
10797IP addresses in \local@_interfaces\, only numbers (not names) can be used.
10798
10799
4964e932 10800.section Special IP listening addresses
495ae4b0
PH
10801The addresses 0.0.0.0 and @:@:0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
10802as `all IPv4 interfaces' and `all IPv6 interfaces', respectively. In each
10803case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to `listen on all IPv\*x*\ interfaces'
10804instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
10805default value of \local@_interfaces\ is
10806.display asis
10807local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
10808.endd
10809when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
10810.display asis
10811local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10812.endd
10813Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
10814
10815
10816.section Overriding local@_interfaces and daemon@_smtp@_ports
10817The \-oX-\ command line option can be used to override the values of
10818\daemon@_smtp@_ports\ and/or \local@_interfaces\ for a particular daemon
10819instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the \-D-\
10820option. However, \-oX-\ can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
10821the runtime configuration by \-D-\ is allowed only when the caller is root or
10822exim.
10823
10824The value of \-oX-\ is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
10825changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
10826contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
10827\daemon@_smtp@_ports\ is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
10828items that do contain dots or colons, the value of \local@_interfaces\ is
10829replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
10830.display asis
10831-oX 1225
10832.endd
10833overrides \daemon@_smtp@_ports\, but leaves \local@_interfaces\ unchanged,
10834whereas
10835.display asis
10836-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
10837.endd
10838overrides \local@_interfaces\, leaving \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ unchanged.
10839(However, since \local@_interfaces\ now contains no items without ports, the
10840value of \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ is no longer relevant in this example.)
10841
10842
d43194df
PH
10843.em
10844.section Support for the obsolete SSMTP protocol
10845.rset SECTsupobssmt "~~chapter.~~section"
10846.index ssmtp protocol
10847.index SMTP||ssmtp protocol
10848Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol that was used before the \\STARTTLS\\
10849command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients still use this protocol.
10850If the \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ option is set to a list of port numbers,
10851connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most common use of this option
10852is expected to be
10853.display asis
10854tls_on_connect_ports = 465
10855.endd
10856because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
10857a command line option \-tls-on-connect-\, which forces all ports to behave in
10858this way when a daemon is started.
10859
10860\**Warning**\: Setting \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ does not of itself cause the
10861daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
10862\daemon@_smtp@_ports\, \local@_interfaces\, or the \-oX-\ option. (This is
10863because \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ applies to \inetd\ connections as well as to
10864connections via the daemon.)
10865.nem
10866
10867
495ae4b0
PH
10868.section IPv6 address scopes
10869IPv6 addresses have `scopes', and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
10870can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
10871interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
10872address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
10873percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
10874adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
10875.display asis
d43194df 10876fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
495ae4b0
PH
10877.endd
10878To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
10879allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls \*getaddrinfo()*\
10880to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
10881percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
10882address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
10883\*getaddrinfo()*\. If
10884.display asis
10885IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
10886.endd
10887is set in \(Local/Makefile)\ (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
10888Exim uses \*inet@_pton()*\ to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
10889instead of \*getaddrinfo()*\. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
10890function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
10891\*getaddrinfo()*\ -- recognizing scoped addresses -- is lost.
10892
10893
10894.section Examples of starting a listening daemon
10895The default case in an IPv6 environment is
10896.display asis
d43194df 10897daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
495ae4b0
PH
10898local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10899.endd
10900This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
10901Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
10902the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
10903read the comments in the \(daemon.c)\ source file.)
10904
10905To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
10906.display asis
10907daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
10908.endd
10909(leaving \local@_interfaces\ at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
10910.display asis
10911local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
10912 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
10913.endd
10914To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
10915IPv4 loopback address only:
10916.display asis
10917local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
10918.endd
10919To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
10920.display asis
10921local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
10922.endd
d43194df 10923\**Warning**\: such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
495ae4b0
PH
10924
10925
10926.section Recognising the local host
10927.rset SECTreclocipadd "~~chapter.~~section"
10928The \local@_interfaces\ option is also used when Exim needs to determine
10929whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
10930addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
10931treated as local.
10932
10933For this usage, port numbers in \local@_interfaces\ are ignored. If either of
10934the items 0.0.0.0 or @:@:0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
10935available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
10936(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
10937
10938Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
10939many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
10940email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
10941interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
10942\extra@_local@_interfaces\ to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
10943`all' wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
10944used for listening. Consider this example:
10945.display asis
10946local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
10947 192.168.53.235 ; \
10948 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
10949
10950extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
10951.endd
10952The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
10953address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
10954Exim is routing.
10955
4964e932
PH
10956In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
10957address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
495ae4b0
PH
10958desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
10959these cases can be handled by setting the \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\ option.
10960This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
10961during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
10962host if its name matches \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\, or if any of its IP
10963addresses match \local@_interfaces\ or \extra@_local@_interfaces\.
10964
10965
10966.section Delivering to a remote host
10967Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
10968allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
10969there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
10970\interface\ option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
10971description of the smtp transport in chapter ~~CHAPsmtptrans for more details.
10972
10973
10974
10975
495ae4b0
PH
10976.
10977.
10978.
10979.
10980. ============================================================================
10981.chapter Main configuration
10982.set runningfoot "main configuration"
10983.rset CHAPmainconfig "~~chapter"
10984.index configuration file||main section
10985.index main configuration
10986The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
10987.numberpars $.
10988Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
10989~~SECTmacrodefs for details of macro processing.
10990.nextp
10991Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words `domainlist',
10992`hostlist', `addresslist', or `localpartlist'. Their use is described in
10993section ~~SECTnamedlists.
10994.nextp
10995Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
10996(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
10997`hide', the \-bP-\ command line option displays its value to admin users only.
10998See section ~~SECTcos for a description of the syntax of these option settings.
10999.endp
11000This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
11001types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
11002in alphabetical order in section ~~SECTalomo below. However, because there are
11003now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as an
d43194df
PH
11004aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
11005listed in more than one group.
495ae4b0
PH
11006
11007.set savedisplayflowcheck ~~displayflowcheck
11008.set displayflowcheck 0
11009
11010.section Miscellaneous
11011.display flow rm
11012.tabs 31
11013\bi@_command\ $t$rm{to run for \-bi-\ command line option}
11014\keep@_malformed\ $t$rm{for broken files -- should not happen}
11015\localhost@_number\ $t$rm{for unique message ids in clusters}
11016\message@_body@_visible\ $t$rm{how much to show in \$message@_body$\}
d43194df
PH
11017.newline
11018.em
11019\mua@_wrapper\ $t$rm{run in `MUA wrapper' mode}
11020.nem
11021.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11022\print@_topbitchars\ $t$rm{top-bit characters are printing}
11023\timezone\ $t$rm{force time zone}
11024.endd
11025
11026.section Exim parameters
11027.display flow rm
11028.tabs 31
11029\exim@_group\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11030\exim@_path\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11031\exim@_user\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11032\primary@_hostname\ $t$rm{default from \*uname()*\}
11033\split@_spool@_directory\ $t$rm{use multiple directories}
11034\spool@_directory\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11035.endd
11036
11037.section Privilege controls
11038.display flow rm
11039.tabs 31
11040\admin@_groups\ $t$rm{groups that are Exim admin users}
11041\deliver@_drop@_privilege\ $t$rm{drop root for delivery processes}
11042\local@_from@_check\ $t$rm{insert ::Sender:: if necessary}
11043\local@_from@_prefix\ $t$rm{for testing ::From:: for local sender}
11044\local@_from@_suffix\ $t$rm{for testing ::From:: for local sender}
11045\local@_sender@_retain\ $t$rm{keep ::Sender:: from untrusted user}
11046\never@_users\ $t$rm{do not run deliveries as these}
11047\prod@_requires@_admin\ $t$rm{forced delivery requires admin user}
11048\queue@_list@_requires@_admin\ $t$rm{queue listing requires admin user}
11049\trusted@_groups\ $t$rm{groups that are trusted}
11050\trusted@_users\ $t$rm{users that are trusted}
11051.endd
11052
11053.section Logging
11054.display flow rm
11055.tabs 31
d43194df
PH
11056.em
11057\hosts@_connection@_nolog\ $t$rm{exemption from connect logging}
11058.nem
11059.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11060\log@_file@_path\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
11061\log@_selector\ $t$rm{set/unset optional logging}
11062\log@_timezone\ $t$rm{add timezone to log lines}
11063\message@_logs\ $t$rm{create per-message logs}
4964e932 11064\preserve@_message@_logs\ $t$rm{after message completion}
495ae4b0
PH
11065\process@_log@_path\ $t$rm{for SIGUSR1 and \*exiwhat*\}
11066\syslog@_duplication\ $t$rm{controls duplicate log lines on syslog }
11067\syslog@_facility\ $t$rm{set syslog `facility' field}
11068\syslog@_processname\ $t$rm{set syslog `ident' field}
11069\syslog@_timestamp\ $t$rm{timestamp syslog lines}
11070.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11071\write@_rejectlog\ $t$rm{control use of message log}
11072.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11073.endd
11074
11075.section Frozen messages
11076.display flow rm
11077.tabs 31
11078\auto@_thaw\ $t$rm{sets time for retrying frozen messages}
11079\freeze@_tell\ $t$rm{send message when freezing}
11080\move@_frozen@_messages\ $t$rm{to another directory}
11081\timeout@_frozen@_after\ $t$rm{keep frozen messages only so long}
11082.endd
11083
11084.section Data lookups
11085.display flow rm
11086.tabs 31
11087\ldap@_default@_servers\ $t$rm{used if no server in query}
11088\ldap@_version\ $t$rm{set protocol version}
11089\lookup@_open@_max\ $t$rm{lookup files held open}
11090\mysql@_servers\ $t$rm{as it says}
11091\oracle@_servers\ $t$rm{as it says}
11092\pgsql@_servers\ $t$rm{as it says}
11093.endd
11094
11095.section Message ids
11096.display flow rm
11097.tabs 31
11098\message@_id@_header@_domain\ $t$rm{used to build ::Message-ID:: header}
11099\message@_id@_header@_text\ $t$rm{ditto}
11100.endd
11101
11102.section Embedded Perl Startup
11103.display flow rm
11104.tabs 31
11105\perl@_at@_start\ $t$rm{always start the interpreter}
11106\perl@_startup\ $t$rm{code to obey when starting Perl}
11107.endd
11108
11109.section Daemon
11110.display flow rm
11111.tabs 31
11112\daemon@_smtp@_ports\ $t$rm{default ports}
11113\extra@_local@_interfaces\ $t$rm{not necessarily listened on}
11114\local@_interfaces\ $t$rm{on which to listen, with optional ports}
11115\pid@_file@_path\ $t$rm{override compiled-in value}
4964e932 11116\queue@_run@_max\ $t$rm{maximum simultaneous queue runners}
495ae4b0
PH
11117.endd
11118
11119.section Resource control
11120.display flow rm
11121.tabs 31
11122\check@_log@_inodes\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11123\check@_log@_space\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11124\check@_spool@_inodes\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11125\check@_spool@_space\ $t$rm{before accepting a message}
11126\deliver@_queue@_load@_max\ $t$rm{no queue deliveries if load high}
11127\queue@_only@_load\ $t$rm{queue incoming if load high}
4964e932 11128\queue@_run@_max\ $t$rm{maximum simultaneous queue runners}
495ae4b0
PH
11129\remote@_max@_parallel\ $t$rm{parallel SMTP delivery per message}
11130\smtp@_accept@_max\ $t$rm{simultaneous incoming connections}
11131\smtp@_accept@_max@_nommail\ $t$rm{non-mail commands}
11132\smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\ $t$rm{hosts to which the limit applies}
11133\smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{messages per connection}
11134\smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ $t$rm{connections from one host}
11135\smtp@_accept@_queue\ $t$rm{queue mail if more connections}
11136\smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{queue if more messages per connection}
11137\smtp@_accept@_reserve\ $t$rm{only reserve hosts if more connections}
11138\smtp@_check@_spool@_space\ $t$rm{from \\SIZE\\ on \\MAIL\\ command}
11139\smtp@_connect@_backlog\ $t$rm{passed to TCP/IP stack}
11140\smtp@_load@_reserve\ $t$rm{SMTP from reserved hosts if load high}
11141\smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ $t$rm{these are the reserve hosts}
11142.endd
11143
11144.section Policy controls
11145.display flow rm
11146.tabs 31
11147\acl@_not@_smtp\ $t$rm{set ACL for non-SMTP messages}
11148\acl@_smtp@_auth\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\AUTH\\}
11149\acl@_smtp@_connect\ $t$rm{set ACL for connection}
11150\acl@_smtp@_data\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\DATA\\}
11151\acl@_smtp@_etrn\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\ETRN\\}
11152\acl@_smtp@_expn\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\EXPN\\}
11153\acl@_smtp@_helo\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\}
11154\acl@_smtp@_mail\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\MAIL\\}
11155\acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\AUTH\\ on \\MAIL\\ command}
d43194df
PH
11156.newline
11157.em
11158\acl@_smtp@_mime\ $t$rm{set ACL for MIME parts}
11159\acl@_smtp@_predata\ $t$rm{set ACL for start of data}
11160\acl@_smtp@_quit\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\QUIT\\}
11161.nem
11162.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11163\acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\RCPT\\}
11164\acl@_smtp@_starttls\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\STARTTLS\\}
11165\acl@_smtp@_vrfy\ $t$rm{set ACL for \\VRFY\\}
d43194df
PH
11166.newline
11167.em
11168\av@_scanner\ $t$rm{specify virus scanner}
11169.nem
11170.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11171\header@_maxsize\ $t$rm{total size of message header}
11172\header@_line@_maxsize\ $t$rm{individual header line limit}
11173\helo@_accept@_junk@_hosts\ $t$rm{allow syntactic junk from these hosts}
11174\helo@_allow@_chars\ $t$rm{allow illegal chars in \\HELO\\ names}
11175\helo@_lookup@_domains\ $t$rm{lookup hostname for these \\HELO\\ names}
11176\helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{\\HELO\\ soft-checked for these hosts}
11177\helo@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{\\HELO\\ hard-checked for these hosts}
11178\host@_lookup\ $t$rm{host name looked up for these hosts}
11179\host@_lookup@_order\ $t$rm{order of DNS and local name lookups}
11180\host@_reject@_connection\ $t$rm{reject connection from these hosts}
11181\hosts@_treat@_as@_local\ $t$rm{useful in some cluster configurations}
11182\local@_scan@_timeout\ $t$rm{timeout for \*local@_scan()*\}
11183\message@_size@_limit\ $t$rm{for all messages}
11184\percent@_hack@_domains\ $t$rm{recognize %-hack for these domains}
d43194df
PH
11185.newline
11186.em
11187\spamd@_address\ $t$rm{set interface to SpamAssassin}
11188.nem
11189.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11190.endd
11191
11192.section Callout cache
11193.display flow rm
11194.tabs 31
11195\callout@_domain@_negative@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for negative domain cache item}
11196\callout@_domain@_positive@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for positive domain cache item}
11197\callout@_negative@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for negative address cache item}
11198\callout@_positive@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for positive address cache item}
11199\callout@_random@_local@_part\ $t$rm{string to use for `random' testing}
11200.endd
11201
11202.section TLS
11203.display flow rm
11204.tabs 31
11205\tls@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise TLS to these hosts}
11206\tls@_certificate\ $t$rm{location of server certificate}
495ae4b0 11207\tls@_crl\ $t$rm{certificate revocation list}
495ae4b0 11208\tls@_dhparam\ $t$rm{DH parameters for server}
d43194df
PH
11209.newline
11210.em
11211\tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ $t$rm{specify SSMTP ports}
11212.nem
11213.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11214\tls@_privatekey\ $t$rm{location of server private key}
11215\tls@_remember@_esmtp\ $t$rm{don't reset after starting TLS}
495ae4b0 11216\tls@_require@_ciphers\ $t$rm{specify acceptable cipers}
495ae4b0
PH
11217\tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{try to verify client certificate}
11218\tls@_verify@_certificates\ $t$rm{expected client certificates}
11219\tls@_verify@_hosts\ $t$rm{insist on client certificate verify}
11220.endd
11221
4964e932 11222.section Local user handling
495ae4b0
PH
11223.display flow rm
11224.tabs 31
11225\finduser@_retries\ $t$rm{useful in NIS environments}
11226\gecos@_name\ $t$rm{used when creating ::Sender::}
11227\gecos@_pattern\ $t$rm{ditto}
11228\max@_username@_length\ $t$rm{for systems that truncate}
11229\unknown@_login\ $t$rm{used when no login name found}
11230\unknown@_username\ $t$rm{ditto}
11231\uucp@_from@_pattern\ $t$rm{for recognizing `From ' lines}
11232\uucp@_from@_sender\ $t$rm{ditto}
11233.endd
11234
11235.section All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)
11236.display flow rm
11237.tabs 31
11238\header@_maxsize\ $t$rm{total size of message header}
11239\header@_line@_maxsize\ $t$rm{individual header line limit}
11240\message@_size@_limit\ $t$rm{applies to all messages}
11241\percent@_hack@_domains\ $t$rm{recognize %-hack for these domains}
11242\received@_header@_text\ $t$rm{expanded to make ::Received::}
11243\received@_headers@_max\ $t$rm{for mail loop detection}
11244\recipients@_max\ $t$rm{limit per message}
11245\recipients@_max@_reject\ $t$rm{permanently reject excess}
11246.endd
11247
11248
11249.section Non-SMTP incoming messages
11250.display rm
11251.tabs 31
11252\receive@_timeout\ $t$rm{for non-SMTP messages}
11253.endd
11254
11255
11256
11257.section Incoming SMTP messages
11258See also the \*Policy controls*\ section above.
11259.display flow rm
11260.tabs 31
11261\host@_lookup\ $t$rm{host name looked up for these hosts}
11262\host@_lookup@_order\ $t$rm{order of DNS and local name lookups}
11263\recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\ $t$rm{may send unqualified recipients}
11264\rfc1413@_hosts\ $t$rm{make ident calls to these hosts}
11265\rfc1413@_query@_timeout\ $t$rm{zero disables ident calls}
11266\sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ $t$rm{may send unqualified senders}
11267\smtp@_accept@_keepalive\ $t$rm{some TCP/IP magic}
11268\smtp@_accept@_max\ $t$rm{simultaneous incoming connections}
11269\smtp@_accept@_max@_nommail\ $t$rm{non-mail commands}
11270\smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\ $t$rm{hosts to which the limit applies}
11271\smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{messages per connection}
11272\smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ $t$rm{connections from one host}
11273\smtp@_accept@_queue\ $t$rm{queue mail if more connections}
11274\smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection\ $t$rm{queue if more messages per connection}
11275\smtp@_accept@_reserve\ $t$rm{only reserve hosts if more connections}
11276.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11277\smtp@_active@_hostname\ $t$rm{host name to use in messages}
11278.newline
495ae4b0
PH
11279\smtp@_banner\ $t$rm{text for welcome banner}
11280\smtp@_check@_spool@_space\ $t$rm{from \\SIZE\\ on \\MAIL\\ command}
11281\smtp@_connect@_backlog\ $t$rm{passed to TCP/IP stack}
11282\smtp@_enforce@_sync\ $t$rm{of SMTP command/responses}
11283\smtp@_etrn@_command\ $t$rm{what to run for \\ETRN\\}
11284\smtp@_etrn@_serialize\ $t$rm{only one at once}
11285\smtp@_load@_reserve\ $t$rm{only reserve hosts if this load}
11286\smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands\ $t$rm{before dropping connection}
11287\smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ $t$rm{apply ratelimiting to these hosts}
11288\smtp@_ratelimit@_mail\ $t$rm{ratelimit for \\MAIL\\ commands}
11289\smtp@_ratelimit@_rcpt\ $t$rm{ratelimit for \\RCPT\\ commands}
11290\smtp@_receive@_timeout\ $t$rm{per command or data line}
11291\smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ $t$rm{these are the reserve hosts}
11292\smtp@_return@_error@_details\ $t$rm{give detail on rejections}
11293.endd
11294
11295.section SMTP extensions
11296.display flow rm
11297.tabs 31
11298\accept@_8bitmime\ $t$rm{advertise \\8BITMIME\\}
11299\auth@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise \\AUTH\\ to these hosts}
11300\ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ $t$rm{allow `From ' from these hosts}
11301\ignore@_fromline@_local\ $t$rm{allow `From ' from local SMTP}
11302\pipelining@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise pipelining to these hosts}
11303\tls@_advertise@_hosts\ $t$rm{advertise TLS to these hosts}
11304.endd
11305
11306.section Processing messages
11307.display flow rm
11308.tabs 31
11309\allow@_domain@_literals\ $t$rm{recognize domain literal syntax}
11310\allow@_mx@_to@_ip\ $t$rm{allow MX to point to IP address}
11311\allow@_utf8@_domains\ $t$rm{in addresses}
11312\delivery@_date@_remove\ $t$rm{from incoming messages}
11313\envelope@_to@_remote\ $t$rm{from incoming messages}
11314\extract@_addresses@_remove@_arguments\ $t$rm{affects \-t-\ processing}
11315\headers@_charset\ $t$rm{default for translations}
11316\qualify@_domain\ $t$rm{default for senders}
11317\qualify@_recipient\ $t$rm{default for recipients}
11318\return@_path@_remove\ $t$rm{from incoming messages}
11319\strip@_excess@_angle@_brackets\ $t$rm{in addresses}
11320\strip@_trailing@_dot\ $t$rm{at end of addresses}
11321\untrusted@_set@_sender\ $t$rm{untrusted can set envelope sender}
11322.endd
11323
11324.section System filter
11325.display flow rm
11326.tabs 31
11327\system@_filter\ $t$rm{locate system filter}
11328\system@_filter@_directory@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for delivery to a directory}
11329\system@_filter@_file@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for delivery to a file}
11330\system@_filter@_group\ $t$rm{group for filter running}
11331\system@_filter@_pipe@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for delivery to a pipe}
11332\system@_filter@_reply@_transport\ $t$rm{transport for autoreply delivery}
11333\system@_filter@_user\ $t$rm{user for filter running}
11334.endd
11335
11336.section Routing and delivery
11337.display flow rm
11338.tabs 31
11339\dns@_again@_means@_nonexist\ $t$rm{for broken domains}
11340\dns@_check@_names@_pattern\ $t$rm{pre-DNS syntax check}
11341\dns@_ipv4@_lookup\ $t$rm{only v4 lookup for these domains}
11342\dns@_retrans\ $t$rm{parameter for resolver}
11343\dns@_retry\ $t$rm{parameter for resolver}
11344\hold@_domains\ $t$rm{hold delivery for these domains}
11345\local@_interfaces\ $t$rm{for routing checks}
11346\queue@_domains\ $t$rm{no immediate delivery for these}
11347\queue@_only\ $t$rm{no immediate delivery at all}
11348\queue@_only@_file\ $t$rm{no immediate deliveryif file exists}
11349\queue@_only@_load\ $t$rm{no immediate delivery if load is high}
11350\queue@_only@_override\ $t$rm{allow command line to override}
11351\queue@_run@_in@_order\ $t$rm{order of arrival}
11352\queue@_run@_max\ $t$rm{of simultaneous queue runners}
11353\queue@_smtp@_domains\ $t$rm{no immediate SMTP delivery for these}
4964e932 11354\remote@_max@_parallel\ $t$rm{parallel SMTP delivery per message}
495ae4b0
PH
11355\remote@_sort@_domains\ $t$rm{order of remote deliveries}
11356\retry@_data@_expire\ $t$rm{timeout for retry data}
11357\retry@_interval@_max\ $t$rm{safety net for retry rules}
11358.endd
11359
11360.section Bounce and warning messages
11361.display flow rm
11362.tabs 31
11363\bounce@_message@_file\ $t$rm{content of bounce}
11364\bounce@_message@_text\ $t$rm{content of bounce}
11365\bounce@_return@_body\ $t$rm{include body if returning message}
11366\bounce@_return@_message\ $t$rm{include original message in bounce}
11367\bounce@_return@_size@_limit\ $t$rm{limit on returned message}
11368\bounce@_sender@_authentication\ $t$rm{send authenticated sender with bounce}
11369\errors@_copy\ $t$rm{copy bounce messages}
11370\errors@_reply@_to\ $t$rm{::Reply-to:: in bounces}
11371\delay@_warning\ $t$rm{time schedule}
11372\delay@_warning@_condition\ $t$rm{condition for warning messages}
11373\ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\ $t$rm{discard undeliverable bounces}
11374\warn@_message@_file\ $t$rm{content of warning message}
11375.endd
11376
11377.set displayflowcheck ~~savedisplayflowcheck
11378
11379.section Alphabetical list of main options
11380.rset SECTalomo "~~chapter.~~section"
11381.if ~~sgcal
11382Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with $**$.
11383.fi
11384
d43194df 11385.startconf main
495ae4b0
PH
11386
11387.index \\8BITMIME\\
11388.index 8-bit characters
11389.conf accept@_8bitmime boolean false
11390This option causes Exim to send \\8BITMIME\\ in its response to an SMTP
11391\\EHLO\\ command, and to accept the \\BODY=\\ parameter on \\MAIL\\ commands.
11392However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
11393takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
11394Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
11395
11396.index ~~ACL||for non-SMTP messages
11397.index non-SMTP messages, ACL for
11398.conf acl@_not@_smtp string$**$ unset
4964e932 11399This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message is on the point
495ae4b0
PH
11400of being accepted. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11401
4964e932 11402.index ~~ACL||on SMTP connection
495ae4b0
PH
11403.conf acl@_smtp@_connect string$**$ unset
11404This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
11405See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11406
11407.index ~~ACL||setting up for SMTP commands
11408.index \\AUTH\\||ACL for
11409.conf acl@_smtp@_auth string$**$ unset
11410This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\AUTH\\ command is
11411received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11412
11413.index \\DATA\\, ACL for
11414.conf acl@_smtp@_data string$**$ unset
11415This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP \\DATA\\ command has been
11416processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
11417acknowledgement is sent. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11418
11419.index \\ETRN\\||ACL for
11420.conf acl@_smtp@_etrn string$**$ unset
11421This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\ETRN\\ command is
11422received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11423
11424.index \\EXPN\\||ACL for
11425.conf acl@_smtp@_expn string$**$ unset
11426This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\EXPN\\ command is
11427received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11428
11429.index \\EHLO\\||ACL for
11430.index \\HELO\\||ACL for
11431.conf acl@_smtp@_helo string$**$ unset
11432This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\
11433command is received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11434
11435.index \\MAIL\\||ACL for
11436.conf acl@_smtp@_mail string$**$ unset
11437This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\MAIL\\ command is
11438received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11439
11440.index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
11441.conf acl@_smtp@_mailauth string$**$ unset
4964e932 11442This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an \\AUTH\\ parameter on
495ae4b0
PH
11443a \\MAIL\\ command. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for details of ACLs, and chapter
11444~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for details of authentication.
11445
d43194df
PH
11446.em
11447.index MIME content scanning||ACL for
11448.conf acl@_smtp@_mime string$**$ unset
11449This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
11450extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
11451section ~~SECTscanmimepart for details.
11452
11453.conf acl@_smtp@_predata string$**$ unset
11454This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\DATA\\ command is
11455received, before the message itself is received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for
11456further details.
11457
11458.index \\QUIT\\||ACL for
11459.conf acl@_smtp@_quit string$**$ unset
11460This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\QUIT\\ command is
11461received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11462.nem
11463
11464.index \\RCPT\\||ACL for
11465.conf acl@_smtp@_rcpt string$**$ unset
495ae4b0
PH
11466This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\RCPT\\ command is
11467received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11468
11469.index \\STARTTLS\\, ACL for
11470.conf acl@_smtp@_starttls string$**$ unset
11471This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\STARTTLS\\ command is
11472received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11473
11474.index \\VRFY\\||ACL for
11475.conf acl@_smtp@_vrfy string$**$ unset
11476This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP \\VRFY\\ command is
11477received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for further details.
11478
11479.conf admin@_groups "string list" unset
11480.index admin user
11481If the current group or any of the supplementary groups of the caller is in
11482this colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
11483programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
11484admin privileges by putting that group in \admin@_groups\. However, this does
11485not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
11486To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
11487
11488.conf allow@_domain@_literals boolean false
11489.index domain literal
11490If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
11491email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
11492format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
11493has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
11494
4964e932
PH
11495Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
11496format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
11497addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
11498\allow@_domain@_literals\ true, and also to add \"@@[]"\ to the list of local
11499domains (defined in the named domain list \local@_domains\ in the default
11500configuration). This `magic string' matches the domain literal form of all the
495ae4b0
PH
11501local host's IP addresses.
11502
11503.conf allow@_mx@_to@_ip boolean false
11504.index MX record||pointing to IP address
11505It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
11506and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
11507MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
11508that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
11509practice, so to avoid `Why can't Exim do this?' complaints, \allow@_mx@_to@_ip\
11510exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not recommended, except
11511when you have no other choice.
11512
11513.index domain||UTF-8 characters in
11514.index UTF-8||in domain name
11515.conf allow@_utf8@_domains boolean false
11516Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
11517camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
4964e932 11518that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
495ae4b0
PH
11519experiment if they wish.
11520
11521If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
11522UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
11523letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
11524enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
11525adjust the value of \dns@_check@_names@_pattern\ to match the extended form. A
11526suitable setting is:
11527.display asis
11528dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
11529 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
11530.endd
11531Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
11532.display asis
11533dns_check_names_pattern =
11534.endd
11535That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
11536
11537.conf auth@_advertise@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
11538.index authentication||advertising
11539.index \\AUTH\\||advertising
11540If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
11541response to an \\EHLO\\ command only if the calling host matches this list.
11542Otherwise, Exim does not advertise \\AUTH\\.
4964e932
PH
11543Exim does not accept \\AUTH\\ commands from clients to which it has not
11544advertised the availability of \\AUTH\\. The advertising of individual
495ae4b0 11545authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
4964e932 11546\server@_advertise@_condition\ generic authenticator option on the individual
495ae4b0
PH
11547authenticators. See chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for further details.
11548
11549Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
11550and password for authentication if \\AUTH\\ is advertised, even though it may
11551not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
11552authentication, for example). The \auth@_advertise@_hosts\ option can be used
11553to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
11554which Exim advertises \\AUTH\\.
11555
11556.index \\AUTH\\||advertising when encrypted
11557If you want to advertise the availability of \\AUTH\\ only when the connection
11558is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
11559option is expanded, with a setting like this:
11560.display asis
11561auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
11562.endd
4964e932
PH
11563If \$tls@_cipher$\ is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
11564the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
495ae4b0
PH
11565expansion is $*$, which matches all hosts.
11566
11567.conf auto@_thaw time 0s
11568.index thawing messages
11569.index unfreezing messages
11570If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
11571new delivery attempt on any frozen message if this much time has passed since
11572it was frozen. This may result in the message being re-frozen if nothing has
11573changed since the last attempt. It is a way of saying `keep on trying, even
11574though there are big problems'. See also \timeout@_frozen@_after\ and
11575\ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\.
11576
d43194df
PH
11577.em
11578.conf av@_scanner string "see below"
11579This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
11580It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
11581.display asis
11582sophie:/var/run/sophie
11583.endd
11584If the value of \av@_scanner\ starts with dollar character, it is expanded
11585before use. See section ~~SECTscanvirus for further details.
11586.nem
11587
495ae4b0
PH
11588.conf bi@_command string unset
11589.index \-bi-\ option
11590This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
11591the \-bi-\ option (see chapter ~~CHAPcommandline). The string value is just the
11592command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is required, it
11593must come from the \-oA-\ command line option.
11594
11595.conf bounce@_message@_file string unset
11596.index bounce message||customizing
11597.index customizing||bounce message
11598This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
11599for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
11600chapter ~~CHAPemsgcust. See also \warn@_message@_file\.
11601
11602.conf bounce@_message@_text string unset
11603When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
11604message immediately after `This message was created automatically by mail
11605delivery software.' It is not used if \bounce@_message@_file\ is set.
11606
11607.index bounce message||including body
11608.conf bounce@_return@_body boolean true
4964e932
PH
11609This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
11610bounce message when \bounce@_return@_message\ is true. If it is not set, only
495ae4b0
PH
11611the message header is included.
11612
11613.index bounce message||including original
11614.conf bounce@_return@_message boolean true
11615If this option is set false, the original message is not included in bounce
11616messages generated by Exim. See also \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\.
11617
11618.conf bounce@_return@_size@_limit integer 100K
11619.index size||of bounce, limit
11620.index bounce message||size limit
11621.index limit||bounce message size
11622This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
11623senders as part of bounce messages when \bounce@_return@_message\ is true. The
11624limit should be less than the value of the global \message@_size@_limit\ and of
11625any \message@_size@_limit\ settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
11626that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
11627
11628When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
11629greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
11630added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
11631to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
11632size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
11633messages.
11634
11635.index bounce message||sender authentication
11636.index authentication||bounce message
11637.index \\AUTH\\||on bounce message
11638.conf bounce@_sender@_authentication string unset
11639This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
11640bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
11641connection. A typical setting might be:
11642.display asis
11643bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
11644.endd
11645which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
11646.display asis
11647MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
11648.endd
11649The value of \bounce@_sender@_authentication\ must always be a complete email
11650address.
11651
11652.index caching||callout, timeouts
11653.index callout||caching timeouts
11654.conf callout@_domain@_negative@_expire time 3h
11655This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
11656domain. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11657section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11658
11659.conf callout@_domain@_positive@_expire time 7d
11660This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
11661domain. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11662section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11663
11664.conf callout@_negative@_expire time 2h
11665This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
11666address. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11667section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11668
11669.conf callout@_positive@_expire time 24h
11670This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
11671address. See section ~~SECTcallver for details of callout verification, and
11672section ~~SECTcallvercache for details of the caching.
11673
11674.conf callout@_random@_local@_part string$**$ "see below"
4964e932 11675This option defines the `random' local part that can be used as part of callout
495ae4b0
PH
11676verification. The default value is
11677.display asis
11678$primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
11679.endd
11680See section ~~CALLaddparcall for details of how this value is used.
11681
11682.conf check@_log@_inodes integer 0
11683See \check@_spool@_space\ below.
11684
11685.conf check@_log@_space integer 0
11686See \check@_spool@_space\ below.
11687
11688.conf check@_spool@_inodes integer 0
11689See \check@_spool@_space\ below.
11690
11691.conf check@_spool@_space integer 0
11692.index checking disk space
11693.index disk space, checking
11694.index spool directory||checking space
11695The four \check@_...\ options allow for checking of disk resources before a
d43194df
PH
11696message is accepted.
11697.em
11698When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
11699want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so
11700by testing the the variables \$log@_inodes$\, \$log@_space$\,
11701\$spool@_inodes$\, and \$spool@_space$\ in an ACL with appropriate additional
11702conditions.
11703.nem
11704
11705\check@_spool@_space\ and \check@_spool@_inodes\ check the spool partition if
11706either value is greater than zero, for example:
495ae4b0
PH
11707.display asis
11708check_spool_space = 10M
11709check_spool_inodes = 100
11710.endd
d43194df 11711The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
495ae4b0
PH
11712\\SPOOL@_DIRECTORY\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. It is used for holding messages in
11713transit.
11714
11715\check@_log@_space\ and \check@_log@_inodes\ check the partition in which log
11716files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
11717\log@_file@_path\ and \spool@_directory\ refer to different partitions.
11718
11719If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
11720incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
11721error response to the \\MAIL\\ command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
11722\\SIZE\\ parameter on the \\MAIL\\ command, its value is added to the
11723\check@_spool@_space\ value, and the check is performed even if
11724\check@_spool@_space\ is zero, unless \no@_smtp@_check@_spool@_space\ is set.
11725
11726The values for \check@_spool@_space\ and \check@_log@_space\ are held as a
11727number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
11728
11729For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
11730failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
11731it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
11732
11733.index port||for daemon
11734.index TCP/IP||setting listening ports
11735.conf daemon@_smtp@_ports string "$tt{smtp}"
11736This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
4964e932 11737listens. See chapter ~~CHAPinterfaces for details of how it is used. For
495ae4b0
PH
11738backward compatibility, \daemon@_smtp@_port\ (singular) is a synonym.
11739
11740.conf delay@_warning "time list" 24h
11741.index warning of delay
11742.index delay warning, specifying
11743When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
d43194df
PH
11744intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
11745after which to send warning messages.
11746.em
11747If the value of the option is an empty string or a zero time, no warnings are
11748sent.
11749.nem
11750Up to 10 times may be given. If a message has been on the queue for longer than
11751the last time, the last interval between the times is used to compute
11752subsequent warning times. For example, with
495ae4b0
PH
11753.display asis
11754delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
11755.endd
11756the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
4964e932
PH
11757the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
11758because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
495ae4b0
PH
11759just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
11760.display asis
11761delay_warning = 6h
11762.endd
11763messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
11764a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
11765.display asis
11766delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
11767.endd
11768
11769.conf delay@_warning@_condition string$**$ "see below"
11770The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
11771deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in \$domain$\ during the
11772expansion. Otherwise \$domain$\ is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
11773forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of `0', `no' or
11774`false' (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is not
11775sent. The default is
11776.display asis
11777delay_warning_condition = \
11778 ${if match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk}{no}{yes}}
11779.endd
11780which suppresses the sending of warnings about messages that have `bulk',
11781`list' or `junk' in a ::Precedence:: header.
11782
11783.index unprivileged delivery
11784.index delivery||unprivileged
11785.conf deliver@_drop@_privilege boolean false
11786If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
11787delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
11788the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
11789of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
11790chapter ~~CHAPsecurity.
11791
11792.index load average
11793.index queue runner||abandoning
11794.conf deliver@_queue@_load@_max fixed-point unset
11795When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
11796becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
11797ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
11798See also \queue@_only@_load\ and \smtp@_load@_reserve\.
11799
11800.conf delivery@_date@_remove boolean true
11801.index ::Delivery-date:: header line
11802Exim's transports have an option for adding a ::Delivery-date:: header to a
11803message when it is delivered -- in exactly the same way as ::Return-path:: is
11804handled. ::Delivery-date:: records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
11805should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
11806removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
11807occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
11808
11809.index DNS||`try again' response, overriding
11810.conf dns@_again@_means@_nonexist "domain list$**$" unset
11811DNS lookups give a `try again' response for the DNS errors `non-authoritative
11812host not found' and `\\SERVERFAIL\\'. This can cause Exim to keep trying to
11813deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to incoming mail.
11814Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and may persist
11815for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches anything in
11816\dns__again__means__nonexist\, it is treated as if it did not exist. This
11817option should be used with care.
495ae4b0
PH
11818You can make it apply to reverse lookups by a setting such as this:
11819.display asis
11820dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
11821.endd
d43194df
PH
11822.em
11823This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. The \%dnslookup%\ router
11824has some options of its own for controlling what happens when lookups for MX or
11825SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific options are applied
11826after the global option.
11827.nem
495ae4b0
PH
11828
11829.index DNS||pre-check of name syntax
11830.conf dns@_check@_names@_pattern string "see below"
11831When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
11832names for illegal characters before handing them to the DNS resolver, because
11833some resolvers give temporary errors for malformed names. If a domain name
11834contains any illegal characters, a `not found' result is forced, and the
11835resolver is not called. The check is done by matching the domain name against a
11836regular expression, which is the value of this option. The default pattern is
11837.display asis
11838dns_check_names_pattern = \
11839 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9-]*[^\W_])?)+$
11840.endd
11841which permits only letters, digits, and hyphens in components, but they may not
11842start or end with a hyphen.
4964e932 11843If you set \allow@_utf8@_domains\, you must modify this pattern, or set the
495ae4b0
PH
11844option to an empty string.
11845
11846.conf dns@_ipv4@_lookup "domain list$**$" unset
11847.index IPv6||DNS lookup for AAAA records
11848.index DNS||IPv6 lookup for AAAA records
11849When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, it looks for IPv6 address records
11850(AAAA and, if configured, A6) as well as IPv4 address records when trying to
11851find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's domain matches this list.
11852
11853This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
11854not work for the new IPv6 record types. If Exim is handed an IPv6 address
11855record as a result of an MX lookup, it always recognizes it, and may as a
11856result make an outgoing IPv6 connection. All this option does is to make Exim
11857look only for IPv4-style A records when it needs to find an IP address for a
11858host name. In due course, when the world's name servers have all been upgraded,
11859there should be no need for this option.
11860
11861.conf dns@_retrans time 0s
11862.index DNS||resolver options
11863The options \dns@_retrans\ and \dns@_retry\ can be used to set the
11864retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
11865defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
11866time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
11867totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
11868take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
11869parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
11870but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
11871to set in them.
11872
11873.conf dns@_retry integer 0
11874See \dns@_retrans\ above.
11875
11876.conf drop@_cr boolean false
4964e932
PH
11877This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
11878handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
495ae4b0
PH
11879described in section ~~SECTlineendings.
11880
11881.conf envelope@_to@_remove boolean true
11882.index ::Envelope-to:: header line
11883Exim's transports have an option for adding an ::Envelope-to:: header to a
11884message when it is delivered -- in exactly the same way as ::Return-path:: is
11885handled. ::Envelope-to:: records the original recipient address from the
11886messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
11887be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
11888the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
11889delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
11890
11891.conf errors@_copy "string list$**$" unset
11892.index bounce message||copy to other address
11893.index copy of bounce message
11894Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
11895generates to other addresses. \**Note**\: this does not apply to bounce messages
11896coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
11897items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
11898a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
11899must be enclosed in double quotes.
11900
11901Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
11902(see section ~~SECTaddresslist). When a pattern matches the recipient of the
11903bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The items
11904are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items are
11905examined. For example:
11906.display asis
11907errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
11908 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
11909 postmaster@mydomain.example
11910.endd
11911The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables
11912\$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ are set from the original recipient of the error
11913message, and if there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
4964e932 11914.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \errors@_copy\
495ae4b0
PH
11915variables \$0$\, \$1$\, etc. are set in the normal way.
11916
11917.conf errors@_reply@_to string unset
11918.index bounce message||::Reply-to:: in
11919Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
11920.display
11921From: Mail Delivery System @<Mailer-Daemon@@<<qualify-domain>>@>
11922.endd
4964e932 11923where <<qualify-domain>> is the value of the \qualify@_domain\ option.
495ae4b0
PH
11924Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
11925\errors@_reply@_to\ option is set, a ::Reply-To:: header is added to bounce and
11926warning messages. For example:
11927.display asis
11928errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
11929.endd
11930The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
11931address.
11932
11933.conf exim@_group string "compile-time configured"
11934.index gid (group id)||Exim's own
11935.index Exim group
11936This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
11937privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
11938option is used only when \exim@_user\ is also set. Unless it consists entirely
11939of digits, the string is looked up using \*getgrnam()*\, and failure causes a
11940configuration error. See chapter ~~CHAPsecurity for a discussion of security
11941issues.
11942
11943.conf exim@_path string "see below"
11944.index Exim binary, path name
11945This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
11946needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file \*exim*\ in
11947the directory configured at compile time by the \\BIN@_DIRECTORY\\ setting. It
11948is necessary to change \exim@_path\ if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
11949other place.
4964e932
PH
11950\**Warning**\: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
11951you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
11952where the binary is. (They then use the \-bP-\ option to extract option
495ae4b0
PH
11953settings such as the value of \spool@_directory\.)
11954
11955.conf exim@_user string "compile-time configured"
11956.index uid (user id)||Exim's own
11957.index Exim user
11958This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
11959privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
11960time configuration file and the use of the \-C-\ and \-D-\ command line options
11961is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
11962
11963Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
11964\*getpwnam()*\, and failure causes a configuration error. If \exim@_group\ is
11965not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of \*getpwnam()*\ if it is
11966used. See chapter ~~CHAPsecurity for a discussion of security issues.
11967
11968.conf extra@_local@_interfaces "string list" unset
4964e932
PH
11969.index
11970This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
11971routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
495ae4b0
PH
11972~~SECTreclocipadd for details.
11973
11974.conf extract@_addresses@_remove@_arguments boolean true
11975.index \-t-\ option
11976.index command line||addresses with \-t-\
11977.index Sendmail compatibility||\-t-\ option
11978According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
11979are present on the command line when the \-t-\ option is used to build an
11980envelope from a message's ::To::, ::Cc:: and ::Bcc:: headers, the command line
11981addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail behaves.
11982However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that command
11983line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
d43194df 11984\extract__addresses__remove__arguments\ is true (the default), Exim subtracts
495ae4b0
PH
11985argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
11986addresses.
11987
11988.conf finduser@_retries integer 0
11989.index NIS, looking up users, retrying
11990On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
11991distributed from a remote system, there can be times when \*getpwnam()*\ and
11992related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
11993Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine `not found'
11994errors. If \finduser@_retries\ is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
11995many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
11996retries.
11997
d43194df
PH
11998.index \(/etc/passwd)\, multiple reading of
11999.em
12000You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
12001a traditional \(/etc/passwd)\ file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
12002search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
12003.nem
12004
495ae4b0
PH
12005.conf freeze@_tell "string list, comma separated" unset
12006.index freezing messages||sending a message when freezing
12007On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
12008or in an ACL,
12009Exim freezes a message. This means that no further delivery attempts take place
12010until an administrator (or the \auto@_thaw\ feature) thaws the message. If
12011\freeze@_tell\ is set, Exim generates a warning message whenever it freezes
4964e932 12012something, unless the message it is freezing is a
495ae4b0
PH
12013locally-generated
12014bounce message. (Without this exception there is the possibility of looping.)
12015The warning message is sent to the addresses supplied as the comma-separated
12016value of this option. If several of the message's addresses cause freezing,
4964e932 12017only a single message is sent.
495ae4b0 12018If the freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the
4964e932 12019message log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for
495ae4b0
PH
12020any logging that you require.
12021
12022.conf gecos@_name string$**$ unset
12023.index HP-UX
12024.index `gecos' field, parsing
12025Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the `gecos' field in the system
12026password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
12027looks up this field for use when it is creating ::Sender:: or ::From:: headers.
12028If either \gecos@_pattern\ or \gecos@_name\ are unset, the contents of the
12029field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered, it is
12030replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
12031upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
12032
12033When these options are set, \gecos@_pattern\ is treated as a regular expression
12034that is to be applied to the field (again with & replaced by the login name),
12035and if it matches, \gecos@_name\ is expanded and used as the user's name.
4964e932 12036.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \gecos@_name\
495ae4b0
PH
12037Numeric variables such as \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. can be used in the expansion to
12038pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
12039name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
12040.display asis
12041gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
12042gecos_name = $1
12043.endd
12044
12045.conf gecos@_pattern string unset
12046See \gecos@_name\ above.
12047
12048.conf headers@_charset string "see below"
12049This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
12050`words' in header lines, when referenced by an \$h@_xxx$\ expansion item. The
12051default is the value of \\HEADERS@_CHARSET\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. The
12052ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
12053insertions in section ~~SECTexpansionitems.
12054
12055
12056.conf header@_maxsize integer "see below"
12057.index header section||maximum size of
12058.index limit||size of message header section
12059This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
12060section. The default is the value of \\HEADER@_MAXSIZE\\ in
4964e932 12061\(Local/Makefile)\; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
495ae4b0
PH
12062sections are rejected.
12063
12064.conf header@_line@_maxsize integer 0
4964e932 12065.index header lines||maximum size of
495ae4b0
PH
12066.index limit||size of one header line
12067This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
12068all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
12069header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
12070zero means `no limit'.
12071
12072
12073
12074.conf helo@_accept@_junk@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12075.index \\HELO\\||accepting junk data
12076.index \\EHLO\\||accepting junk data
12077Exim checks the syntax of \\HELO\\ and \\EHLO\\ commands for incoming SMTP
12078mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
12079some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
12080this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See \helo@_verify@_hosts\
12081if you want to do semantic checking.
4964e932 12082See also \helo@_allow@_chars\ for a way of extending the permitted character
495ae4b0
PH
12083set.
12084
12085.conf helo@_allow@_chars string unset
12086.index \\HELO\\||underscores in
12087.index \\EHLO\\||underscores in
12088.index underscore in \\EHLO\\/\\HELO\\
12089This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
12090all \\EHLO\\ and \\HELO\\ names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
12091hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
12092.display asis
12093helo_allow_chars = _
12094.endd
12095Note that the value is one string, not a list.
12096
12097.conf helo@_lookup@_domains "domain list$**$" "$tt{@@:@@[]}"
12098.index \\HELO\\||forcing reverse lookup
12099.index \\EHLO\\||forcing reverse lookup
12100If the domain given by a client in a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command matches this
12101list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
12102default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
12103its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
12104do.
12105
12106.conf helo@_try@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12107.index \\HELO\\||verifying, optional
12108.index \\EHLO\\||verifying, optional
12109The RFCs mandate that a server must not reject a message because it doesn't
12110like the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command. By default, Exim just checks the syntax
12111of these commands (see \helo__accept__junk__hosts\ and \helo@_allow@_chars\
12112above). However, some sites like to be stricter. If the calling host matches
12113\helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\, Exim checks that the host name given in the \\HELO\\
12114or \\EHLO\\ command either:
12115.numberpars $.
12116is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host (the RFCs
12117specifically allow this), or
12118.nextp
12119.index DNS||reverse lookup
12120.index reverse DNS lookup
12121matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
12122calling host address, or
12123.nextp
12124when looked up using \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when
12125available) yields the calling host address.
12126.endp
4964e932 12127However, the \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\ command is not rejected if any of the checks
495ae4b0
PH
12128fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
12129be detected later in an ACL by the \"verify = helo"\ condition. If you want
12130verification failure to cause rejection of \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\, use
12131\helo@_verify@_hosts\ instead.
12132
12133
12134.conf helo@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12135.index \\HELO\\||verifying, mandatory
12136.index \\EHLO\\||verifying, mandatory
12137For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host name given in the
12138\\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ in the same way as for \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\. If the
12139check fails, the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command is rejected with a 550 error, and
12140entries are written to the main and reject logs. If a \\MAIL\\ command is
4964e932
PH
12141received before \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\, it is rejected with a
12142503
495ae4b0
PH
12143error.
12144
12145.conf hold@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12146.index domain||delaying delivery
12147.index delivery||delaying certain domains
12148This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
12149manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
12150\-M-\, \-qf-\, \-Rf-\ or \-Sf-\ options, and also while testing or verifying
12151addresses using \-bt-\ or \-bv-\. Otherwise, if a domain matches an item in
12152\hold@_domains\, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and it is
12153deferred every time the message is looked at.
12154
12155This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
12156delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
12157configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
12158domains until a queue run occurs, you should use \queue@_domains\ or
12159\queue@_smtp@_domains\, not \hold@_domains\.
12160
12161A setting of \hold@_domains\ does not override Exim's code for removing
12162messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
12163time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
12164retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
12165
12166.conf host@_lookup "host list$**$" unset
12167.index host||name lookup, forcing
12168Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
12169is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
12170\helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ or \helo@_verify@_hosts\, or the host matches this
12171option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
12172default configuration file contains
12173.display asis
12174host_lookup = *
12175.endd
12176which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
12177is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
12178
12179After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
12180has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
12181this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
12182
12183After any kind of failure, the host name (in \$sender@_host@_name$\) remains
12184unset, and \$host@_lookup@_failed$\ is set to the string `1'. See also
12185\dns@_again@_means@_nonexist\, \helo__lookup__domains\, and \"verify =
12186reverse@_host@_lookup"\ in ACLs.
12187
12188.conf host@_lookup@_order "string list" $tt{bydns:byaddr}
12189This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
4964e932 12190to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
495ae4b0
PH
12191first, and then to try a local lookup (using \*gethostbyaddr()*\ or equivalent)
12192if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
12193if you want.
12194
12195\**Warning**\: the `byaddr' method does not always yield aliases when there are
4964e932 12196multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
495ae4b0
PH
12197\(/etc/hosts)\. Different operating systems give different results in this
12198case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
12199
12200
12201.conf host@_reject@_connection "host list$**$" unset
12202.index host||rejecting connections from
12203If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
4964e932 12204as soon as the connection is made.
495ae4b0
PH
12205This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
12206nowadays the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_connect\ can also reject incoming
12207connections immediately.
12208
12209The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
12210ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
12211sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
12212incoming messages at a later stage, such as after \\RCPT\\ commands. See
12213chapter ~~CHAPACL.
12214
d43194df
PH
12215.em
12216.conf hosts@_connection@_nolog "host list$**$" unset
12217.index host||not logging connections from
12218This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
12219happen, even though the \smtp@_connection\ log selector is set. For example,
12220you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
12221127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
12222the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
12223list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
12224local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
12225.display asis
12226hosts_connection_nolog = :
12227.endd
12228If the \smtp@_connection\ log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
12229.nem
12230
495ae4b0
PH
12231.conf hosts@_treat@_as@_local "domain list$**$" unset
12232.index local host||domains treated as
12233.index host||treated as local
12234If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
12235if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
12236records
12237or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
12238host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
12239
12240This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
12241\"@@mx@_any"\, \"@@mx@_primary"\, and \"@@mx@_secondary"\ in a domain list (see
12242section ~~SECTdomainlist), and when checking the \hosts\ option in the \%smtp%\
12243transport for the local host (see the \allow@_localhost\ option in that
12244transport).
4964e932
PH
12245See also \local@_interfaces\, \extra@_local@_interfaces\, and chapter
12246~~CHAPinterfaces, which contains a discussion about local network interfaces
495ae4b0
PH
12247and recognising the local host.
12248
12249.conf ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after time 10w
12250.index bounce message||discarding
12251.index discarding bounce message
4964e932
PH
12252This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
12253that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
495ae4b0
PH
12254suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
12255
12256After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
12257because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
12258message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
12259the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
12260again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
12261bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
12262for frozen messages. For example,
12263.display asis
12264ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
12265.endd
12266retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
12267failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
12268failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
12269value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
12270dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see \auto@_thaw\ and
12271\timeout@_frozen@_after\.
12272
12273.conf ignore@_fromline@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12274.index `From' line
12275.index UUCP||`From' line
12276Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like `From' line before the
12277headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the message's
12278body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as such. Exim
12279can be made to ignore it by setting \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ to match those
12280hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local process
12281rather than a remote host, and is using \-bs-\ to inject the messages,
12282\ignore__fromline__local\ must be set to achieve this effect.
12283
12284.conf ignore@_fromline@_local boolean false
12285See \ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ above.
12286
12287.conf keep@_malformed time 4d
12288This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
12289have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
12290next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
12291logged.
12292
12293.conf ldap@_default@_servers "string list" unset
12294.index LDAP||default servers
12295This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
12296LDAP query does not contain a server. See section ~~SECTforldaque for details
12297of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built with
12298LDAP support.
12299
12300.conf ldap@_version integer unset
12301.index LDAP||protocol version, forcing
12302This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
12303LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the \-bP-\ command line option as
12304-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if \\LDAP@_VERSION3\\ is defined in
12305the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
12306has been built with LDAP support.
12307
12308
12309.conf local@_from@_check boolean true
12310.index ::Sender:: header line||disabling addition of
12311.index ::From:: header line||disabling checking of
12312When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
12313an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing ::Sender:: header line, and checks
d43194df
PH
12314that the ::From:: header line matches
12315.em
12316the login of the calling user and the domain specified by \qualify@_domain\.
12317
12318\**Note**\: An unqualified address (no domain) in the ::From:: header in a
12319locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
12320\-bnq-\ command line option is used.
12321.nem
12322
12323You can use \local@_from@_prefix\ and \local@_from@_suffix\ to permit affixes
12324on the local part. If the ::From:: header line does not match, Exim adds a
12325::Sender:: header with an address constructed from the calling user's login and
12326the default qualify domain.
495ae4b0
PH
12327
12328If \local@_from@_check\ is set false, the ::From:: header check is disabled,
12329and no ::Sender:: header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
12330::Sender:: header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
12331\local@_sender@_retain\ to be true.
12332
12333.index envelope sender
12334These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
12335is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
12336\untrusted@_set@_sender\ permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
d43194df
PH
12337
12338.em
12339For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify `submission mode' to
12340request similar header line checking. See section ~~SECTthesenhea, which has
12341more details about ::Sender:: processing.
12342.nem
495ae4b0
PH
12343
12344
12345.conf local@_from@_prefix string unset
12346When Exim checks the ::From:: header line of locally submitted messages for
12347matching the login id (see \local@_from@_check\ above), it can be configured to
12348ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
12349done by setting \local@_from@_prefix\ and/or \local@_from@_suffix\ to
12350appropriate lists, in the same form as the \local@_part@_prefix\ and
12351\local@_part@_suffix\ router options (see chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric). For
12352example, if
12353.display asis
12354local_from_prefix = *-
12355.endd
12356is set, a ::From:: line containing
12357.display asis
12358From: anything-user@your.domain.example
12359.endd
12360will not cause a ::Sender:: header to be added if \*user@@your.domain.example*\
12361matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
12362qualify domain.
12363
12364.conf local@_from@_suffix string unset
12365See \local@_from@_prefix\ above.
12366
12367.conf local@_interfaces "string list" "see below"
4964e932
PH
12368This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
12369listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
12370~~CHAPinterfaces contains a full description of this option and the related
d43194df
PH
12371options
12372.em
12373\daemon@_smtp@_ports\, \extra@_local@_interfaces\, \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\,
12374and \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\.
12375.nem
12376The default value for \local@_interfaces\ is
495ae4b0
PH
12377.display asis
12378local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12379.endd
12380when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
12381.display asis
12382local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12383.endd
12384
12385.conf local@_scan@_timeout time 5m
12386.index timeout||for \*local@_scan()*\ function
12387.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||timeout
12388This timeout applies to the \*local@_scan()*\ function (see chapter
12389~~CHAPlocalscan). Zero means `no timeout'. If the timeout is exceeded, the
12390incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
12391For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
12392code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
12393
12394
12395.conf local@_sender@_retain boolean false
12396.index ::Sender:: header line||retaining from local submission
12397When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
12398an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing ::Sender:: header line. If you
12399do not want this to happen, you must set \local@_sender@_retain\, and you must
12400also set \local@_from@_check\ to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
12401Section ~~SECTthesenhea has more details about ::Sender:: processing.
12402
12403
12404
12405.conf localhost@_number string$**$ unset
12406.index host||locally unique number for
12407.index message||ids, with multiple hosts
12408Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
12409uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
12410value for the \localhost@_number\ option. The string is expanded immediately
12411after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
12412host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
12413range 0--16 (or 0--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file systems).
12414This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
12415\$localhost@_number$\. When \localhost@_number is set\, the final two
12416characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
12417time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
12418section ~~SECTmessiden.
12419
12420
12421.conf log@_file@_path "string list$**$" "set at compile time"
12422.index log||file path for
12423This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
12424files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
12425when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
12426name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
12427are written in a sub-directory called \(log)\ in Exim's spool directory.
12428Chapter ~~CHAPlog contains further details about Exim's logging, and section
12429~~SECTwhelogwri describes how the contents of \log@_file@_path\ are used. If
12430this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion variables) it
12431is recommended that you do not set this option in the configuration file, but
12432instead supply the path using \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ so that
12433it is available to Exim for logging errors detected early on -- in particular,
12434failure to read the configuration file.
12435
12436.conf log@_selector string unset
12437.index log||selectors
12438This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
12439writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
12440minus characters. For example:
12441.display asis
12442log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
12443.endd
12444A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
12445logging, in section ~~SECTlogselector.
12446
12447.conf log@_timezone boolean false
12448.index log||timezone for entries
12449By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
12450timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
12451in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
12452avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
12453\log@_timezone\ true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
12454timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
12455of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
12456\$tod@_log$\ variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
12457another variable called \$tod@_zone$\ that contains just the timezone offset.
12458
12459.conf lookup@_open@_max integer 25
12460.index too many open files
12461.index open files, too many
12462.index file||too many open
12463.index lookup||maximum open files
12464.index limit||open files for lookups
12465This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
12466lookups that use regular files (that is, \%lsearch%\, \%dbm%\, and \%cdb%\). Exim
12467normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same file is
12468required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least recently
12469used file. Note that if you are using the \*ndbm*\ library, it actually opens
12470two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts as one for the
12471purposes of \lookup@_open@_max\. If you are getting `too many open files'
12472errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of \lookup@_open@_max\.
12473
12474.conf max@_username@_length integer 0
12475.index length of login name
12476.index user name||maximum length
12477.index limit||user name length
12478Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
12479\*getpwnam()*\ to eight characters, instead of returning `no such user'. If
12480this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call \*getpwnam()*\ with
12481an argument that is longer behaves as if \*getpwnam()*\ failed.
12482
12483
12484.conf message@_body@_visible integer 500
12485.index body of message||visible size
12486.index message||body, visible size
12487This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
12488\$message@_body$\ and \$message@_body@_end$\ expansion variables.
12489
12490.conf message@_id@_header@_domain string$**$ unset
12491.index ::Message-ID:: header line
12492If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
12493(domain) of the ::Message-ID:: header that Exim creates if a
12494locally-originated incoming message does not have one. `Locally-originated'
12495means `not received over TCP/IP.'
12496Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
12497Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
12498replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
12499empty string, the option is ignored.
12500
12501.conf message@_id@_header@_text string$**$ unset
12502If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
12503the ::Message-id:: header that Exim creates if a
12504locally-originated
12505incoming message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC
125062822 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message
12507id as the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option
12508is set, it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and
12509does not yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header
12510immediately before the @@, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any
12511characters that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into
12512hyphens. This means that variables such as \$tod@_log$\ can be used, because
12513the spaces and colons will become hyphens.
12514
12515.conf message@_logs boolean true
12516.index message||log, disabling
12517.index log||message log, disabling
12518If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
12519\(msglog)\ spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
12520Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
12521minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
12522per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
12523which is not affected by this option.
12524
12525.conf message@_size@_limit string$**$ 50M
12526.index message||size limit
12527.index limit||message size
12528.index size||of message, limit
12529This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
4964e932 12530value is expanded for each incoming
495ae4b0
PH
12531connection so, for example, it can be made to depend on the IP address of the
12532remote host for messages arriving via TCP/IP. \**Note**\: This limit cannot be
12533made to depend on a message's sender or any other properties of an individual
12534message, because it has to be advertised in the server's response to \\EHLO\\.
12535String expansion failure causes a temporary error. A value of zero means no
12536limit, but its use is not recommended. See also \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\.
12537
12538Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
12539exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
12540failure message to the sender, depending on the \-oe-\ setting. Rejection of an
12541oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also the
12542generic transport option \message@_size@_limit\, which limits the size of
12543message that an individual transport can process.
12544
12545.conf move@_frozen@_messages boolean false
12546.index frozen messages||moving
12547This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
12548.display asis
12549SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
12550.endd
12551in \(Local/Makefile)\, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
12552moved from the \(input)\ and \(msglog)\ directories on the spool to \(Finput)\
12553and \(Fmsglog)\, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
12554standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
12555lists generated by \-bp-\ or by the Exim monitor.
12556
d43194df
PH
12557.em
12558.conf mua@_wrapper boolean false
12559Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
12560it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter ~~CHAPnonqueueing
12561contains a full description of this facility.
12562.nem
12563
495ae4b0
PH
12564.conf mysql@_servers "string list" unset
12565.index MySQL||server list
12566This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
12567be used in conjunction with \%mysql%\ lookups (see section ~~SECTsql). The
12568option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
12569
12570.conf never@_users "string list" unset
12571Local message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
12572recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
12573It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
12574safety precaution.
4964e932
PH
12575
12576When Exim is built, an option called \\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ can be set to a
12577list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
12578the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
12579contains just the single user name `root'. The \never@_users\ runtime option
495ae4b0
PH
12580can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
12581
12582If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
12583\never@_users\ list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
12584example is
12585.display
12586never@_users = root:daemon:bin
12587.endd
12588Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
12589harm.
12590This option overrides the \pipe@_as@_creator\ option of the \%pipe%\ transport
12591driver.
12592
12593.conf oracle@_servers "string list" unset
12594.index Oracle||server list
12595This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
12596to be used in conjunction with \%oracle%\ lookups (see section ~~SECTsql). The
12597option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
12598
12599.conf percent@_hack@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12600.index `percent hack'
12601.index source routing||in email address
12602.index address||source-routed
12603The `percent hack' is the convention whereby a local part containing a percent
12604sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent replaced by @@.
12605This is sometimes called `source routing', though that term is also applied to
12606RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @@ character. If this option is set, Exim
12607implements the percent facility for those domains listed, but no others. This
12608happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against an ACL.
12609
12610\**Warning**\: The `percent hack' has often been abused by people who are
12611trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
12612if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
12613implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
12614routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
12615a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
12616local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
12617
12618.conf perl@_at@_start boolean false
12619This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
12620interpreter. See chapter ~~CHAPperl for details of its use.
12621
12622.conf perl@_startup string unset
12623This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
12624interpreter. See chapter ~~CHAPperl for details of its use.
12625
12626.conf pgsql@_servers "string list" unset
12627.index PostgreSQL lookup type||server list
12628This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
12629data, to be used in conjunction with \%pgsql%\ lookups (see section ~~SECTsql).
12630The option is available only if Exim has been built with PostgreSQL support.
12631
12632.conf pid@_file@_path string$**$ "set at compile time"
12633.index daemon||pid file path
12634.index pid file, path for
12635This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
12636process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
12637to the host name:
12638.display asis
12639pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
12640.endd
12641If no path is set, the pid is written to the file \(exim-daemon.pid)\ in Exim's
12642spool directory.
4964e932
PH
12643The value set by the option can be overridden by the \-oP-\ command line
12644option. A pid file is not written if a `non-standard' daemon is run by means of
495ae4b0
PH
12645the \-oX-\ option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by \-oP-\.
12646
12647.conf pipelining@_advertise@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
12648.index \\PIPELINING\\||advertising, suppressing
12649This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
12650\\PIPELINING\\ extension to specific hosts. When \\PIPELINING\\ is not
12651advertised and \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ is true, an Exim server enforces strict
12652synchronization for each SMTP command and response.
495ae4b0 12653When \\PIPELINING\\ is advertised, Exim assumes that clients will use it; `out
4964e932 12654of order' commands that are `expected' do not count as protocol errors (see
495ae4b0 12655\smtp@_max@_synprot@_errors\).
495ae4b0
PH
12656
12657.conf preserve@_message@_logs boolean false
12658.index message logs, preserving
12659If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
12660completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
12661called \(msglog.OLD)\, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
12662purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
12663volume of mail. Use with care!
12664
12665.conf primary@_hostname string "see below"
12666.index name||of local host
12667.index host||name of local
12668.index local host||name of
495ae4b0
PH
12669This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default \\EHLO\\
12670or \\HELO\\ command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the \helo@_data\
12671option in the \%smtp%\ transport),
495ae4b0
PH
12672and as the default for \qualify@_domain\. If it is not set, Exim calls
12673\*uname()*\ to find it. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name
12674returned by \*uname()*\ contains only one component, Exim passes it to
12675\*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available) in order to
12676obtain the fully qualified version.
12677
495ae4b0
PH
12678The value of \$primary@_hostname$\ is also used by default in some SMTP
12679response messages from an Exim server. This can be changed dynamically by
12680setting \smtp@_active@_hostname\.
495ae4b0
PH
12681
12682.conf print@_topbitchars boolean false
12683.index printing characters
12684.index 8-bit characters
12685By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1268632--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
12687when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
12688sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If \print@_topbitchars\ is
12689set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
12690characters.
12691
12692.conf process@_log@_path string unset
12693.index process log path
4964e932 12694.index log||process log
495ae4b0
PH
12695.index \*exiwhat*\
12696This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
12697`process log' when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the \*exiwhat*\ utility
12698script. If this option is unset, the file called \(exim-process.info)\ in
12699Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly can
12700be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
12701different spool directories.
12702
12703.conf prod@_requires@_admin boolean true
12704.index \-M-\ option
12705.index \-R-\ option
12706.index \-q-\ option
12707The \-M-\, \-R-\, and \-q-\ command-line options require the caller to be an
12708admin user unless \prod@_requires@_admin\ is set false. See also
12709\queue@_list@_requires@_admin\.
12710
12711.conf qualify@_domain string "see below"
12712.index domain||for qualifying addresses
12713.index address||qualification
d43194df
PH
12714This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
12715addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
12716recipient addresses if \qualify@_recipient\ is not set.
12717.em
12718Unqualified addresses are accepted by default only for locally-generated
12719messages.
12720
12721Qualification is also applied to addresses in header lines such as ::From:: and
12722::To:: for locally-generated messages, unless the \-bnq-\ command line option
12723is used.
12724.nem
12725
12726Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
12727unless the sending host matches \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ or
12728\recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\ (as appropriate), in which case incoming
12729addresses are qualified with \qualify@_domain\ or \qualify@_recipient\ as
12730necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
12731addresses. If \qualify@_domain\ is not set, it defaults to the
12732\primary@_hostname\ value.
495ae4b0
PH
12733
12734.conf qualify@_recipient string "see below"
d43194df
PH
12735.em
12736This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
12737addresses to the one that is used for senders. See \qualify@_domain\ above.
12738.nem
495ae4b0
PH
12739
12740.conf queue@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12741.index domain||specifying non-immediate delivery
12742.index queueing incoming messages
12743.index message||queueing certain domains
12744This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
12745A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
12746domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
12747next queue run. See also \hold@_domains\ and \queue@_smtp@_domains\.
12748
12749.conf queue@_list@_requires@_admin boolean true
12750.index \-bp-\ option
12751The \-bp-\ command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the queue,
12752requires the caller to be an admin user unless \queue__list__requires__admin\
12753is set false. See also \prod@_requires@_admin\.
12754
12755.conf queue@_only boolean false
12756.index queueing incoming messages
12757.index message||queueing unconditionally
12758If \queue@_only\ is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
12759whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
12760next queue run. Even if \queue@_only\ is false, incoming messages may not get
12761delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
12762
12763The \-odq-\ command line has the same effect as \queue@_only\. The \-odb-\ and
12764\-odi-\ command line options override \queue@_only\ unless
12765\queue@_only@_override\ is set false. See also \queue@_only@_file\,
12766\queue@_only@_load\, and \smtp@_accept@_queue\.
12767
12768.conf queue@_only@_file string unset
12769.index queueing incoming messages
12770.index message||queueing by file existence
12771This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
12772one optionally preceded by `smtp'. When Exim is receiving a message,
12773it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to \*stat()*\. For
12774each path that exists, the corresponding queuing option is set.
12775For paths with no prefix, \queue@_only\ is set; for paths prefixed by `smtp',
12776\queue@_smtp@_domains\ is set to match all domains. So, for example,
12777.display asis
12778queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
12779.endd
12780causes Exim to behave as if \queue@_smtp@_domains\ were set to `$*$' whenever
12781\(/some/file)\ exists.
12782
12783.conf queue@_only@_load fixed-point unset
12784.index load average
12785.index queueing incoming messages
12786.index message||queueing by load
12787If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
12788all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
12789happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages on the same
12790connection are queued. Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue
12791runner processes. This option has no effect on ancient operating systems on
12792which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
12793\deliver@_queue@_load@_max\ and \smtp@_load@_reserve\.
12794
12795.conf queue@_only@_override boolean true
12796.index queueing incoming messages
12797When this option is true, the \-od\*x*\-\ command line options override the
12798setting of \queue@_only\ or \queue@_only@_file\ in the configuration file. If
12799\queue@_only@_override\ is set false, the \-od\*x*\-\ options cannot be used to
12800override; they are accepted, but ignored.
12801
12802.conf queue@_run@_in@_order boolean false
12803.index queue runner||processing messages in order
12804If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
12805in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
12806must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all in a single
12807directory (the default), this happens anyway, but if \split@_spool@_directory\
12808is set it does not -- for delivery in random order, the sub-directories are
12809processed one at a time (in random order), to avoid setting up one huge list.
12810Thus, setting \queue@_run@_in@_order\ with \split@_spool@_directory\ may
12811degrade performance when the queue is large. In most situations,
12812\queue@_run@_in@_order\ should not be set.
12813
12814.conf queue@_run@_max integer 5
12815.index queue runner||maximum number of
12816This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
12817can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
12818but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
12819start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
12820very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
12821however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
12822started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
12823
12824.conf queue@_smtp@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12825.index queueing incoming messages
12826.index message||queueing remote deliveries
12827When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
12828received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
12829However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
12830\queue@_smtp@_domains\, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
12831message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
12832has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
12833when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
12834over a single SMTP connection. The \-odqs-\ command line option causes all SMTP
12835deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
12836\queue@_smtp@_domains\ to `$*$'. See also \hold@_domains\ and \queue@_domains\.
12837
12838.conf receive@_timeout time 0s
12839.index timeout||for non-SMTP input
12840This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
12841maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
12842the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
12843\-or-\ command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
12844controlled by \smtp@_receive@_timeout\.
12845
12846.index customizing|| ::Received:: header
12847.index ::Received:: header line||customizing
12848.conf received@_header@_text string$**$ "see below"
12849This string defines the contents of the ::Received:: message header that is
12850added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
12851on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
12852used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no ::Received:: header line is
12853added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
12854`Received:' and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for ::Received:: header
12855lines. The default setting is:
12856.display asis
12857received_header_text = Received: \
12858 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
12859 {${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident }}\
12860 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
12861 by $primary_hostname \
12862 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
12863 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
12864 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
12865 id $message_id\
12866 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
12867.endd
12868Note the use of quotes, to allow the sequences \"@\n"\ and \"@\t"\ to be used
12869for newlines and tabs, respectively. The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted
12870when Exim is built without TLS support. The use of conditional expansions
12871ensures that this works for both locally generated messages and messages
12872received from remote hosts, giving header lines such as the following:
12873.display asis
12874Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
12875 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
12876 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
12877 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
12878Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
12879 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
12880.endd
4964e932
PH
12881Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
12882the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
12883checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
495ae4b0 12884message was accepted.
495ae4b0
PH
12885
12886.conf received@_headers@_max integer 30
12887.index loop||prevention
12888.index mail loop prevention
12889.index ::Received:: header line||counting
12890When a message is to be delivered, the number of ::Received:: headers is
12891counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
12892have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
12893This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
12894
12895.conf recipient@_unqualified@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
12896.index unqualified addresses
12897.index host||unqualified addresses from
12898This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
12899recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
12900qualified by the addition of the \qualify@_recipient\ value. This option also
12901affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
12902addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
12903host that matches \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\,
495ae4b0
PH
12904or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the \-bnq-\
12905option was not set.
495ae4b0
PH
12906
12907.conf recipients@_max integer 0
12908.index limit||number of recipients
4964e932 12909.index recipient||maximum number
495ae4b0
PH
12910If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
12911original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
12912by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
12913all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
12914Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
12915done.
12916.index \\RCPT\\||maximum number of incoming
12917Note that the RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
12918\\RCPT\\ commands in a single message.
12919
12920.conf recipients@_max@_reject boolean false
12921If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
12922recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus \\RCPT\\ commands, and a 554
12923error to the eventual \\DATA\\ command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
12924error to the surplus \\RCPT\\ commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
12925initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
12926for the remaining recipients at a later time.
12927
12928.conf remote@_max@_parallel integer 2
12929.index delivery||parallelism for remote
12930This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
12931hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
12932does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
12933message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
12934have to be sent to the same remote host, up to \remote@_max@_parallel\
12935deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than \remote@_max@_parallel\
12936deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
12937each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
12938same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
12939\remote@_sort@_domains\ option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
12940with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
12941tagged with its process id.
12942
12943This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
12944message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
12945manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
12946deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
12947is received.
12948.index number of deliveries
12949.index delivery||maximum number of
12950If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
12951need to set the \queue@_only\ option. This ensures that all incoming messages
12952are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
12953daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
12954fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
12955runners by setting the \queue__run__max\ parameter. Because each queue runner
12956delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
12957then take place at once is \queue@_run@_max\ multiplied by
12958\remote@_max@_parallel\.
12959
d43194df
PH
12960If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
12961\queue@_smtp@_domains\ instead of \queue@_only\. This has the added benefit of
12962doing the SMTP routing before queuing, so that several messages for the same
12963host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
495ae4b0
PH
12964
12965.conf remote@_sort@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
12966.index sorting remote deliveries
12967.index delivery||sorting remote
12968When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
12969domain into the order given by this list. For example,
12970.display asis
12971remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
12972.endd
12973would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the \*cam.ac.uk*\ domain first, then
12974to those in the \uk\ domain, then to any others.
12975
12976.conf retry@_data@_expire time 7d
12977.index hints database||data expiry
12978This option sets a `use before' time on retry information in Exim's hints
12979database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
12980host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
12981past failures.
12982
12983.conf retry@_interval@_max time 24h
12984.index retry||limit on interval
12985.index limit||on retry interval
12986Chapter ~~CHAPretry describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the intervals
12987between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered straight away.
12988This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between retries.
12989
12990.conf return@_path@_remove boolean true
12991.index ::Return-path:: header line||removing
12992RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a ::Return-path::
12993header line into a message when it makes a `final delivery'. The ::Return-path::
12994header preserves the sender address as received in the \\MAIL\\ command. This
12995description implies that this header should not be present in an incoming
12996message. If \return@_path@_remove\ is true, any existing ::Return-path::
12997headers are removed from messages at the time they are received. Exim's
12998transports have options for adding ::Return-path:: headers at the time of
12999delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
13000
13001.conf return@_size@_limit integer 100K
13002This option is an obsolete synonym for \bounce@_return@_size@_limit\.
13003
13004.conf rfc1413@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
13005.index RFC 1413
13006.index host||for RFC 1413 calls
13007RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
13008in the list.
13009
13010.conf rfc1413@_query@_timeout time 30s
13011.index RFC 1413||query timeout
13012.index timeout||for RFC 1413 call
13013This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
13014no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
13015
13016.conf sender@_unqualified@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13017.index unqualified addresses
13018.index host||unqualified addresses from
13019This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
13020sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
13021\qualify@_domain\. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does not
13022reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but it
13023qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
13024\sender@_unqualified@_hosts\,
495ae4b0
PH
13025or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the \-bnq-\
13026option was not set.
495ae4b0
PH
13027
13028.conf smtp@_accept@_keepalive boolean true
13029.index keepalive||on incoming connection
13030This option controls the setting of the \\SO@_KEEPALIVE\\ option on incoming
13031TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
13032connections periodically, by sending packets with `old' sequence numbers. The
13033other end of the connection should send an acknowledgement if the connection is
13034still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
13035this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
13036connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
13037tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
13038hours to detect unreachable hosts.
13039
13040
13041.conf smtp@_accept@_max integer 20
13042.index limit||incoming SMTP connections
13043.index SMTP||incoming connection count
13044.index inetd
13045This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
13046that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
13047control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by \*inetd*\. If the value
13048is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be non-zero if
13049either \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ or \smtp@_accept@_queue\ is set. See also
13050\smtp@_accept@_reserve\.
13051
13052
13053.conf smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail integer 10
13054.index limit||non-mail SMTP commands
13055.index SMTP||limiting non-mail commands
13056Exim counts the number of `non-mail' commands in an SMTP session, and drops the
13057connection if there are too many. This option defines `too many'. The check
13058catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing \\AUTH\\s, or a mad
4964e932 13059client looping sending \\EHLO\\, for example. The check is applied only if the
495ae4b0
PH
13060client host matches \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\.
13061
13062When a new message is expected, one occurrence of \\RSET\\ is not counted. This
13063allows a client to send one \\RSET\\ between messages (this is not necessary,
13064but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of \\HELO\\
13065or \\EHLO\\, and one occurrence of \\STARTTLS\\ between messages. After
13066starting up a TLS session, another \\EHLO\\ is expected, and so it too is not
13067counted. The first occurrence of \\AUTH\\ in a connection, or immediately
13068following \\STARTTLS\\ is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
13069\\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and \\QUIT\\ are counted.
13070
13071.conf smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts "host list$**$" $*$
13072You can control which hosts are subject to the \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail\
13073check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
13074changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
13075live with.
13076
13077
13078.conf smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_connection integer 1000
13079.index SMTP||incoming message count, limiting
13080.index limit||messages per SMTP connection
13081The value of this option limits the number of \\MAIL\\ commands that Exim is
13082prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
13083results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
13084response is given to subsequent \\MAIL\\ commands. This limit is a safety
13085precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
13086seen).
13087
13088.conf smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host string$**$ unset
13089.index limit||SMTP connections from one host
13090.index host||limiting SMTP connections from
13091This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
13092host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
13093expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
13094reference to \$sender@_host@_address$\. Once the limit is reached, additional
13095connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. The
13096default value of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set, it is required
13097that \smtp@_accept@_max\ be non-zero.
13098
13099\**Warning**\: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
13100constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
13101happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
13102without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
13103could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
13104doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
13105
13106
13107.conf smtp@_accept@_queue integer 0
13108.index SMTP||incoming connection count
13109.index queueing incoming messages
13110.index message||queueing by SMTP connection count
13111If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls handled via the listening
13112daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed on the
13113queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. A value of zero implies
13114no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only if it is less than the
13115\smtp@_accept@_max\ value (unless that is zero). See also \queue@_only\,
13116\queue@_only@_load\, \queue@_smtp@_domains\, and the various \-od-\ command
13117line options.
13118
13119.conf smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection integer 10
13120.index queueing incoming messages
13121.index message||queueing by message count
13122This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
13123automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
13124the use of \-bs-\ or \-bS-\. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
13125and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
13126number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
13127are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
13128restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
13129systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
13130dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
13131
13132.conf smtp@_accept@_reserve integer 0
13133.index SMTP||incoming call count
13134.index host||reserved
13135When \smtp@_accept@_max\ is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
13136number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
13137that are specified in \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\. The value set in
13138\smtp@_accept@_max\ includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
13139restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
13140of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that that group
13141of hosts can always get at least \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ connections.
13142
13143For example, if \smtp@_accept@_max\ is set to 50 and \smtp@_accept@_reserve\ is
13144set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
13145connections are accepted only from hosts listed in \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\.
13146See also \smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\.
13147
495ae4b0
PH
13148.conf smtp@_active@_hostname string$**$ unset
13149.index host||name in SMTP responses
13150.index SMTP||host name in responses
13151This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
13152several different hosts. At the start of an SMTP connection, its value is
13153expanded and used instead of the value of \$primary@_hostname$\ in SMTP
13154responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
d43194df
PH
13155incoming \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command.
13156.em
13157The active hostname is placed in the \$smtp__active__hostname$\ variable, which
13158is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
13159in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
13160.nem
13161
13162If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
13163expansion results in an empty string, the value of \$primary@_hostname$\ is
13164used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
13165panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
13166value of \smtp@_active@_hostname\ depends on the incoming interface address.
13167For example:
495ae4b0
PH
13168.display asis
13169smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$interface_address}{10.0.0.1}\
13170 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
13171.endd
495ae4b0
PH
13172
13173.conf smtp@_banner string$**$ "see below"
13174.index SMTP||welcome banner
13175.index banner for SMTP
13176.index welcome banner for SMTP
13177.index customizing||SMTP banner
13178This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
13179positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
13180.display asis
d43194df
PH
13181.em
13182smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
13183 $version_number $tod_full
13184.nem
495ae4b0
PH
13185.endd
13186Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
13187multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use `@\n' in the string at
13188appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
13189in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
13190multiline response).
13191
13192.conf smtp@_check@_spool@_space boolean true
13193.index checking disk space
13194.index disk space, checking
13195.index spool directory||checking space
13196When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the \\SIZE\\
13197option on a \\MAIL\\ command, it checks that there is enough space in the
13198spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
13199leaving free the amount specified by \check@_spool@_space\ (even if that value
13200is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
13201
13202.conf smtp@_connect@_backlog integer 20
13203.index connection backlog
13204.index SMTP||connection backlog
13205.index backlog of connections
13206This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
13207this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
13208of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
13209attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
13210say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
13211out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
13212value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
13213attacks by SYN flooding.
13214
13215.conf smtp@_enforce@_sync boolean true
13216.index SMTP||synchronization checking
13217.index synchronization checking in SMTP
13218The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
13219the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without \\PIPELINING\\ these
13220synchronization points are after every command; with \\PIPELINING\\ they are
d43194df
PH
13221fewer, but they still exist.
13222
13223Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
13224for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
13225client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response `554
13226SMTP synchronization error' is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing for
13227this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected input
13228may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it does
13229detect many instances.
13230
13231.em
13232The check can be globally disabled by setting \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ false.
13233If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
13234hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a \control\ modifier in an ACL
13235(see section ~~SECTcontrols). See also \pipelining@_advertise@_hosts\.
13236.nem
495ae4b0
PH
13237
13238.conf smtp@_etrn@_command string$**$ unset
13239.index \\ETRN\\||command to be run
13240If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP \\ETRN\\
13241command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
13242chapter ~~CHAPACL). The string is split up into separate arguments which are
13243independently expanded. The expansion variable \$domain$\ is set to the
13244argument of the \\ETRN\\ command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
13245example:
13246.display asis
13247smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain $sender_host_address
13248.endd
13249A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
13250complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
13251run, a line is written to the panic log, but the \\ETRN\\ caller still receives
13252a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
13253receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
13254the command.
13255
13256.conf smtp@_etrn@_serialize boolean true
13257.index \\ETRN\\||serializing
13258When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
13259one identical command as a result of \\ETRN\\ in an SMTP connection. See
13260section ~~SECTETRN for details.
13261
13262.conf smtp@_load@_reserve fixed-point unset
13263.index load average
13264If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
13265accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\.
13266If \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
13267the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
13268systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
13269\deliver@_queue@_load@_max\ and \queue@_only@_load\.
13270
13271
13272.conf smtp@_max@_synprot@_errors integer 3
13273.index SMTP||limiting syntax and protocol errors
13274.index limit||SMTP syntax and protocol errors
4964e932 13275Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
495ae4b0
PH
13276particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
13277.display asis
13278RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
13279.endd
13280causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
13281(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
13282example of a protocol error is receiving \\RCPT\\ before \\MAIL\\. If there are
13283too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
13284dropped. The limit is set by this option.
13285
495ae4b0 13286.index \\PIPELINING\\||expected errors
4964e932
PH
13287When the \\PIPELINING\\ extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
13288`expected', for instance, a \\RCPT\\ command after a rejected \\MAIL\\ command.
13289Exim assumes that \\PIPELINING\\ will be used if it advertises it (see
13290\pipelining@_advertise@_hosts\), and in this situation, `expected' errors do
495ae4b0 13291not count towards the limit.
495ae4b0
PH
13292
13293
13294.conf smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands integer 3
13295.index SMTP||limiting unknown commands
13296.index limit||unknown SMTP commands
4964e932
PH
13297If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
13298Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
13299that subvert web
13300clients
495ae4b0
PH
13301into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
13302non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
13303
13304
13305.conf smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13306.index SMTP||rate limiting
13307.index limit||rate of message arrival
13308.index \\RCPT\\||rate limiting
13309Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
13310can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
13311recipients. When a host matches \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\, the values of
13312\smtp@_ratelimit@_mail\ and \smtp@_ratelimit@_rcpt\ are used to control the
13313rate of acceptance of \\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\ commands in a single SMTP session,
13314respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
13315values:
13316.numberpars $.
13317A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
13318.nextp
13319An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
13320fractional parts are allowed here.
13321.nextp
13322A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
13323.nextp
13324A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
13325because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
13326.endp
13327For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
13328first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
13329.display asis
13330smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
13331smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
13332.endd
13333The first setting specifies delays that are applied to \\MAIL\\ commands after
13334two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
13335seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
13336delays to \\RCPT\\ commands when more than four occur in a single message.
13337
4964e932 13338It is also possible to configure delays explicitly in ACLs. See section
495ae4b0
PH
13339~~SECTACLmodi for details.
13340
13341
13342.conf smtp@_ratelimit@_mail string unset
13343See \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ above.
13344
13345.conf smtp@_ratelimit@_rcpt string unset
13346See \smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ above.
13347
13348.conf smtp@_receive@_timeout time 5m
13349.index timeout||for SMTP input
13350.index SMTP||timeout, input
13351This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
13352input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
13353data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
4964e932 13354the message is abandoned.
495ae4b0
PH
13355A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
13356.display asis
13357SMTP command timeout on connection from...
13358SMTP data timeout on connection from...
13359.endd
4964e932 13360The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
495ae4b0
PH
13361means that it was in the \\DATA\\ phase, reading the contents of a message.
13362
13363
13364.index \-os-\ option
13365The value set by this option can be overridden by the
13366\-os-\ command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
13367this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
13368of local input using \-bs-\ or \-bS-\.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
13369timeout is controlled by \receive@_timeout\ and \-or-\.
13370
13371.conf smtp@_reserve@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13372This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
13373\smtp@_accept@_reserve\ and \smtp@_load@_reserve\ above.
13374
13375.conf smtp@_return@_error@_details boolean false
13376.index SMTP||details policy failures
13377.index policy control||rejection, returning details
13378In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
13379`Administrative prohibition' when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
13380reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
13381to spammers. However, some other syadmins who are applying strict checking
13382policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
13383\smtp@_return@_error@_details\ true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
13384example, instead of `Administrative prohibition', it might give:
13385.display asis
13386550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
13387550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
13388.endd
13389
d43194df
PH
13390.em
13391.conf spamd@_address string "$tt{127.0.0.1 783}"
13392This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
13393extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's \spamd\ daemon. See
13394section ~~SECTscanspamass for more details.
13395.nem
13396
495ae4b0
PH
13397.conf split@_spool@_directory boolean false
13398.index multiple spool directories
13399.index spool directory||split
13400.index directories, multiple
13401If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
13402subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
13403sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
13404subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
13405arrival of the message.
13406
13407Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
13408where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
13409directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
13410directory; however, if \preserve@_message@_logs\ is set, all old msglog files
13411are still placed in the single directory \(msglog.OLD)\.
13412
13413It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
13414changing \split@_spool@_directory\. Exim notices messages that are in the
13415`wrong' place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off after
13416a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
13417automatically deleted.
13418
13419When \split@_spool@_directory\ is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
13420changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
13421trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
13422sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
13423sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
13424spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
13425particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
13426if \queue@_run@_in@_order\ is set, none of this new processing happens. The
13427entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
13428
13429.conf spool@_directory string$**$ "set at compile time"
13430.index spool directory||path to
13431This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
13432it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
13433configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
13434string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
13435\$primary@_hostname$\.
13436
13437If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
13438that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
13439log files are being written to the spool directory (see \log@_file@_path\).
13440Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
13441as failures in the configuration file.
13442
13443By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
13444tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
13445
13446.conf strip@_excess@_angle@_brackets boolean false
13447.index angle brackets, excess
13448If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round `route-addr'
13449items in addresses are stripped. For example, \*@<@<xxx@@a.b.c.d@>@>*\ is treated
13450as \*@<xxx@@a.b.c.d@>*\. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on
13451to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this option is
13452not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
13453
13454.conf strip@_trailing@_dot boolean false
13455.index trailing dot on domain
13456.index dot||trailing on domain
13457If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
13458ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
13459MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
13460domain causes a syntax error.
4964e932 13461However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
495ae4b0 13462syntax checking.
495ae4b0
PH
13463
13464.conf syslog@_duplication boolean true
13465.index syslog||duplicate log lines, suppressing
13466When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
13467separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
13468be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
13469separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
13470nuisance. If \syslog@_duplication\ is set false, only one copy of any
13471particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
13472both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
13473containing message header lines) is written, at \\LOG@_NOTICE\\ priority.
13474Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
13475the \\LOG@_ALERT\\ priority.
13476
13477.conf syslog@_facility string unset
13478.index syslog||facility, setting
4964e932 13479This option sets the syslog `facility' name, used when Exim is logging to
495ae4b0 13480syslog. The value must be one of the strings `mail', `user', `news', `uucp',
4964e932 13481`daemon', or `local\*x*\' where \*x*\ is a digit between 0 and 7. If this
495ae4b0
PH
13482option is unset, `mail' is used. See chapter ~~CHAPlog for details of Exim's
13483logging.
13484
13485
13486.conf syslog@_processname string "$tt{exim}"
13487.index syslog||process name, setting
13488This option sets the syslog `ident' name, used when Exim is logging to syslog.
13489The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter ~~CHAPlog for
13490details of Exim's logging.
13491
13492
13493.conf syslog@_timestamp boolean true
13494.index syslog||timestamps
13495If \syslog@_timestamp\ is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
13496omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter ~~CHAPlog for
13497details of Exim's logging.
13498
13499.conf system@_filter string$**$ unset
13500.index filter||system filter
13501.index system filter||specifying
13502.index Sieve filter||not available for system filter
13503This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
13504the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
13505must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
13506generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
13507appropriate \system@_filter@_...@_transport\ option(s) must be set, to define
13508which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
13509~~CHAPsystemfilter.
13510
13511.conf system@_filter@_directory@_transport string$**$ unset
13512This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
13513\save\ command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in `/',
13514implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
13515During the delivery, the variable \$address@_file$\ contains the path name.
13516
13517.conf system@_filter@_file@_transport string$**$ unset
13518.index file||transport for system filter
13519This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the \save\
13520command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in `/'. During
13521the delivery, the variable \$address@_file$\ contains the path name.
13522
13523.index gid (group id)||system filter
13524.conf system@_filter@_group string unset
13525This option is used only when \system@_filter@_user\ is also set. It sets the
13526gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
13527with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
13528
13529.conf system@_filter@_pipe@_transport string$**$ unset 7
13530.index \%pipe%\ transport||for system filter
13531This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a \pipe\ command is
13532used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable \$address@_pipe$\
13533contains the pipe command.
13534
13535.conf system@_filter@_reply@_transport string$**$ unset
13536.index \%autoreply%\ transport||for system filter
13537This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a \mail\ command is
13538used in a system filter.
13539
13540.index uid (user id)||system filter
13541.conf system@_filter@_user string unset
13542If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
13543process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
13544process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
13545is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
13546configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
13547specified by \system@_filter@_group\. When the uid is specified numerically,
13548\system@_filter@_group\ is required to be set.
13549
13550If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
13551under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
13552transport option overrides.
13553Normally you should set \system@_filter@_user\ if your system filter generates
13554these kinds of delivery.
13555
13556.conf tcp@_nodelay boolean true
13557.index daemon||\\TCP@_NODELAY\\ on sockets
13558.index Nagle algorithm
13559.index \\TCP@_NODELAY\\ on listening sockets
13560If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
13561\\TCP@_NODELAY\\ option on its listening sockets. Setting \\TCP@_NODELAY\\
13562turns off the `Nagle algorithm', which is a way of improving network
13563performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
13564should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
13565However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
13566this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
13567daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
13568\\TCP@_NODELAY\\.
13569
13570.conf timeout@_frozen@_after time 0s
13571.index frozen messages||timing out
13572.index timeout||frozen messages
13573If \timeout@_frozen@_after\ is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
13574message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given
13575time is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If it is a bounce
13576message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the sender, in a
13577similar manner to cancellation by the \-Mg-\ command line option. If you want
13578to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of frozen message,
13579see \ignore@_bounce@_errors@_after\.
13580
13581.conf timezone string unset
13582.index timezone, setting
13583The value of \timezone\ is used to set the environment variable \\TZ\\ while
13584running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
13585created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
13586to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
13587.display asis
13588timezone = UTC
13589.endd
13590The default value is taken from \\TIMEZONE@_DEFAULT\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\,
13591or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
13592is built. If \timezone\ is set to the empty string, either at build or run
13593time, any existing \\TZ\\ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
13594runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
13595unfortunately not all, operating systems.
13596
13597.conf tls@_advertise@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13598.index TLS||advertising
13599.index encryption||on SMTP connection
13600.index SMTP||encrypted connection
13601When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
13602of the \\STARTTLS\\ command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
13603response to \\EHLO\\ only to those client hosts that match this option. See
13604chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of Exim's support for TLS.
13605
13606.conf tls@_certificate string$**$ unset
13607.index TLS||server certificate, location of
13608.index certificate||for server, location of
13609The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
13610file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
13611assumed to be in this file if \tls@_privatekey\ is unset. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS
13612for further details.
13613
4964e932 13614\**Note**\: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
495ae4b0
PH
13615receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
13616use when sending messages as a client, you must set the \tls@_certificate\
13617option in the relevant \%smtp%\ transport.
13618
495ae4b0
PH
13619.conf tls@_crl string$**$ unset
13620.index TLS||server certificate revocation list
13621.index certificate||revocation list for server
13622This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
13623be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
495ae4b0
PH
13624
13625.conf tls@_dhparam string$**$ unset
13626.index TLS||D-H parameters for server
13627The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
13628a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
4964e932 13629This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
495ae4b0
PH
13630ignored. See section ~~SECTopenvsgnu for further details.
13631
d43194df
PH
13632.em
13633.conf tls@_on@_connect@_ports "string list" unset
13634This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP ports that should operate the
13635obsolete SSMTP protocol, where a TLS session is immediately set up without
13636waiting for the client to issue a \\STARTTLS\\ command. For further details,
13637see section ~~SECTsupobssmt.
13638.nem
13639
495ae4b0
PH
13640.conf tls@_privatekey string$**$ unset
13641.index TLS||server private key, location of
d43194df
PH
13642The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
13643file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, the
13644private key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See
13645chapter ~~CHAPTLS for further details.
495ae4b0
PH
13646
13647.conf tls@_remember@_esmtp boolean false
13648.index TLS||esmtp state, remembering
13649.index TLS||broken clients
13650If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
13651`esmtp' state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
13652support for broken clients that fail to send a new \\EHLO\\ after starting a
13653TLS session.
13654
495ae4b0
PH
13655.conf tls@_require@_ciphers string$**$ unset
13656.index TLS||requiring specific ciphers
13657.index cipher||requiring specific
13658This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
d43194df
PH
13659The \%smtp%\ transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
13660connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
495ae4b0
PH
13661different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
13662permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
d43194df
PH
13663in somewhat different ways.
13664.em
13665If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the preference order of the
13666available ciphers.
13667.nem
13668Details are given in sections ~~SECTreqciphssl and ~~SECTreqciphgnu.
495ae4b0
PH
13669
13670.conf tls@_try@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13671.index TLS||client certificate verification
13672.index certificate||verification of client
13673See \tls@_verify@_hosts\ below.
13674
13675.conf tls@_verify@_certificates string$**$ unset
13676.index TLS||client certificate verification
13677.index certificate||verification of client
13678The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
13679a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
13680match \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\. Alternatively, if you
13681are using OpenSSL, you can set \tls@_verify@_certificates\ to the name of a
13682directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
13683option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
13684
13685.conf tls@_verify@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
13686.index TLS||client certificate verification
13687.index certificate||verification of client
13688This option, along with \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\, controls the checking of
4964e932
PH
13689certificates from clients.
13690The expected certificates are defined by \tls@_verify@_certificates\, which
13691must be set. A configuration error occurs if either \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or
495ae4b0
PH
13692\tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ is set and \tls@_verify@_certificates\ is not set.
13693
13694Any client that matches \tls@_verify@_hosts\ is constrained by
13695\tls@_verify@_certificates\. The client must present one of the listed
13696certificates. If it does not, the connection is aborted.
13697
13698A weaker form of checking is provided by \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\. If a client
13699matches this option (but not \tls@_verify@_hosts\), Exim requests a
13700certificate and checks it against \tls@_verify@_certificates\, but does not
13701abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
13702state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
13703such as `accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received, but
13704accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified certificate'.
13705
13706Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
13707certificates.
13708
13709.conf trusted@_groups "string list" unset
13710.index trusted group
13711.index group||trusted
13712If this option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups,
4964e932 13713or which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted.
495ae4b0
PH
13714The groups can be specified numerically or by name.
13715See section ~~SECTtrustedadmin for details of what trusted callers are
13716permitted to do. If neither \trusted@_groups\ nor \trusted@_users\ is set, only
13717root and the Exim user are trusted.
13718
13719.conf trusted@_users "string list" unset
13720.index trusted user
13721.index user||trusted
13722If this option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users
4964e932 13723is trusted.
495ae4b0
PH
13724The users can be specified numerically or by name.
13725See section ~~SECTtrustedadmin for details of what trusted callers are
13726permitted to do. If neither \trusted@_groups\ nor \trusted@_users\ is set, only
13727root and the Exim user are trusted.
13728
13729.index uid (user id)||unknown caller
13730.conf unknown@_login string$**$ unset
13731This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
13732the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using \*getpwuid()*\, Exim
13733gives up. The \unknown@_login\ option can be used to set a login name to be
13734used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like \user@$caller@_uid\
13735can be set. When \unknown@_login\ is used, the value of \unknown@_username\ is
13736used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
13737\-F-\ option.
13738
13739.conf unknown@_username string unset
13740See \unknown@_login\.
13741
13742.conf untrusted@_set@_sender "address list$**$" unset
13743.index trusted user
13744.index sender||setting by untrusted user
13745.index untrusted user, setting sender
13746.index user||untrusted setting sender
13747.index envelope sender
13748When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
13749normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
13750default qualification domain. Data from the \-f-\ option (for setting envelope
13751senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP \\MAIL\\ command (if \-bs-\ or \-bS-\
13752is used) is ignored.
13753
13754However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
13755to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
13756.display asis
13757exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
13758.endd
13759The \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
13760other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
13761users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
13762patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
13763identity of the user is in \$sender@_ident$\, so you can, for example, restrict
4964e932 13764users to setting senders that start with their login ids
495ae4b0
PH
13765followed by a hyphen
13766by a setting like this:
13767.display asis
13768untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
13769.endd
13770If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
13771restriction, you can use
13772.display asis
13773untrusted_set_sender = *
13774.endd
13775The \untrusted@_set@_sender\ option applies to all forms of local input, but
13776only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
13777to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
13778parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
13779::Sender:: header in the message, or from adding a ::Sender:: header if
13780necessary. See \local__sender__retain\ and \local@_from@_check\ for ways of
13781overriding these actions. The handling of the ::Sender:: header is also
13782described in section ~~SECTthesenhea.
13783
13784The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following `<='.
13785For local messages, the user's login always follows, after `U='. In \-bp-\
13786displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an envelope sender
13787address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the sender address.
13788
13789.conf uucp@_from@_pattern string "see below"
13790.index `From' line
13791.index UUCP||`From' line
13792Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
13793an initial line starting with `From' to pass the envelope sender. In
13794particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
13795of a regular expression that is set in \uucp@_from@_pattern\. When the pattern
13796matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
13797\uucp@_from@_sender\, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
13798default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
13799.display asis
13800 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
13801 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
13802.endd
13803The pattern can be seen by running
13804.display asis
13805exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
13806.endd
13807It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
13808year in the second case. The first word after `From' is matched in the regular
13809expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
13810\uucp@_from@_sender\ is `$1', which therefore just uses this first word (`ph10'
13811in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
13812\ignore@_fromline@_hosts\.
13813
13814.conf uucp@_from@_sender string$**$ "$tt{@$1}"
13815See \uucp@_from@_pattern\ above.
13816
13817.conf warn@_message@_file string unset
13818.index warning of delay||customizing the message
13819.index customizing||warning message
13820This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13821for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
13822been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
13823\delay@_warning\. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
13824~~CHAPemsgcust. See also \bounce@_message@_file\.
13825
495ae4b0
PH
13826.conf write@_rejectlog boolean true
13827.index reject log||disabling
13828If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
13829See chapter ~~CHAPlog for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
495ae4b0
PH
13830
13831.endconf
13832
13833
13834
13835.
13836.
13837.
13838.
13839. ============================================================================
13840.chapter Generic options for routers
13841.rset CHAProutergeneric "~~chapter"
13842.set runningfoot "generic router options"
13843.index options||generic, for routers
13844.index generic options||router
13845
4964e932 13846This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers,
495ae4b0 13847identifying those that are preconditions. For a general description of how a
d43194df
PH
13848router operates, see sections ~~SECTrunindrou and ~~SECTrouprecon. The latter
13849specifies the order in which the preconditions are tested. The order of
13850expansion of the options that provide data for a transport is: \errors@_to\,
13851\headers@_add\, \headers@_remove\, \transport\.
495ae4b0 13852
d43194df 13853.startconf routers
495ae4b0
PH
13854
13855.conf address@_data string$**$ unset
13856.index router||data attached to address
13857The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
13858precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
13859router declines. Other expansion failures cause delivery of the address to be
13860deferred.
13861
13862When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
13863accessed using the variable \$address@_data$\ in the current router, subsequent
4964e932 13864routers, and the eventual transport.
495ae4b0 13865
4964e932 13866\**Warning**\: if the current or any subsequent router is a \%redirect%\ router
495ae4b0
PH
13867that runs a user's filter file, the contents of \$address@_data$\ are
13868accessible in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is
4964e932
PH
13869usually either not confidential or it `belongs' to the current user, but if you
13870do put confidential data into \$address@_data$\ you need to remember this
495ae4b0
PH
13871point.
13872
13873Even if the router declines or passes, the value of \$address@_data$\ remains
13874with the address, though it can be changed by another \address@_data\ setting
13875on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
13876\$address@_data$\ propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
13877`child' that is generated by a router with the \unseen\ option.
13878
13879The idea of \address@_data\ is that you can use it to look up a lot of data for
13880the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example, you
13881could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
13882.display asis
13883uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
13884.endd
13885In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
13886.display asis
13887file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
13888.endd
13889This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
d43194df 13890lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
495ae4b0 13891
4964e932 13892The \address@_data\ facility is also useful as a means of passing information
d43194df
PH
13893from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
13894.em
13895\$address@_data$\ is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
13896ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
13897verifying a sender, the value is transferred to \$sender@_address@_data$\.
13898.nem
495ae4b0
PH
13899
13900
13901.conf address@_test "boolean (precondition)" true
13902.index \-bt-\ option
13903.index router||skipping when address testing
13904If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
13905by means of the \-bt-\ command line option. This can be a convenience when your
4964e932
PH
13906first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
13907having to set the `already scanned' indicator when testing real address
495ae4b0
PH
13908routing.
13909
13910
13911.conf cannot@_route@_message string$**$ unset
13912.index router||customizing `cannot route' message
13913.index customizing||`cannot route' message
13914This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
13915routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is `Unrouteable
13916address'. This option is useful only on routers that have \more\ set false, or
13917on the very last router in a configuration, because the value that is used is
13918taken from the last router that inspects an address. For example, using the
13919default configuration, you could put:
13920.display asis
13921cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
13922.endd
13923on the first (\%dnslookup%\) router, and
13924.display asis
13925cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
13926.endd
4964e932 13927on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails, the
495ae4b0
PH
13928default message is used.
13929Unless the expansion failure was explicitly forced, a message about the failure
13930is written to the main and panic logs, in addition to the normal message about
13931the routing failure.
13932
13933.conf caseful@_local@_part boolean false
13934.index case of local parts
13935.index router||case of local parts
13936By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
13937manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
13938If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
13939this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
13940part lists (for example, \local@_parts\), case-sensitive matching can be turned
13941on by `+caseful' as a list item. See section ~~SECTcasletadd for more details.
13942
d43194df
PH
13943.em
13944The value of the \$local@_part$\ variable is forced to lower case while a
13945router is running unless \caseful@_local@_part\ is set. When a router assigns
13946an address to a transport, the value of \$local@_part$\ when the transport runs
13947is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
13948addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of \$original@_local@_part$\
13949and \$parent@_local@_part$\ are those that were used by the redirecting router.
13950
13951This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
13952recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate \control\
13953modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
13954(see section ~~SECTcontrols).
13955.nem
495ae4b0
PH
13956
13957.conf check@_local@_user "boolean (precondition)" false
13958.index local user, checking in router
13959.index router||checking for local user
d43194df 13960.index \(/etc/passwd)\
495ae4b0
PH
13961When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
13962address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
13963local system. The check is done by calling the \*getpwnam()*\ function rather
13964than trying to read \(/etc/passwd)\ directly. This means that other methods of
13965holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
13966user, \$home$\ is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
d43194df
PH
13967preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
13968given in section ~~SECTrouprecon). However, the value of \$home$\ can be
13969overridden by \router@_home@_directory\. If the local part is not a local user,
13970the router is skipped.
495ae4b0
PH
13971
13972If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
4964e932
PH
13973or matches something else, you cannot combine \check@_local@_user\ with a
13974setting of \local@_parts\, because that specifies the logical \*and*\ of the
13975two conditions. However, you can use a \%passwd%\ lookup in a \local@_parts\
495ae4b0
PH
13976setting to achieve this. For example:
13977.display asis
13978local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
13979.endd
13980Note, however, that the side effects of \check@_local@_user\ (such as setting
13981up a home directory) do not occur when a \%passwd%\ lookup is used in a
13982\local@_parts\ (or any other) precondition.
13983
d43194df 13984
495ae4b0
PH
13985.conf condition "string$**$ (precondition)" unset
13986.index router||customized precondition
13987This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
d43194df
PH
13988router to be called. The \condition\ option is the last precondition to be
13989evaluated (see section ~~SECTrouprecon). The string is expanded, and if the
13990result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings `0' or
13991`no' or `false' (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the router
13992is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
13993.em
13994If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
13995precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
13996
13997The \condition\ option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
13998running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
13999the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
14000.display asis
14001condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
14002.endd
14003Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
14004.display asis
14005condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
14006.endd
14007.nem
495ae4b0
PH
14008
14009If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
d43194df
PH
14010of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
14011be specified using \condition\.
495ae4b0
PH
14012
14013
14014.conf debug@_print string$**$ unset
14015.index testing||variables in drivers
14016If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the \-d-\ command line
4964e932
PH
14017option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
14018If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
495ae4b0
PH
14019output, and Exim carries on processing.
14020This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
14021so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a \condition\
14022option appears not to be working, \debug@_print\ can be used to output the
14023variables it references. The output happens after checks for \domains\,
14024\local@_parts\, and \check@_local@_user\ but before any other preconditions are
14025tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
14026
14027
14028.conf disable@_logging boolean false
14029If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
495ae4b0
PH
14030or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
14031unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
14032transport option of the same name.
495ae4b0
PH
14033
14034.conf domains "domain list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14035.index router||restricting to specific domains
14036If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
14037the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
14038lookup returned for the domain is placed in \$domain@_data$\ for use in string
14039expansions of the driver's private options.
4964e932 14040See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
495ae4b0
PH
14041are evaluated.
14042
14043
14044.conf driver string unset
14045This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
14046to be used.
14047
14048
14049.conf errors@_to string$**$ unset
14050.index envelope sender
14051.index router||changing address for errors
14052If a router successfully handles an address, it may queue the address for
14053delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if there is a
14054delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce message is sent
14055to the address that results from expanding this string, provided that the
4964e932
PH
14056address verifies successfully.
14057\errors@_to\ is expanded before \headers@_add\, \headers@_remove\, and
495ae4b0
PH
14058\transport\.
14059
14060If the option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
14061the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
14062address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
14063expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
14064
14065If an address for which \errors@_to\ has been set ends up being delivered over
14066SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the \errors@_to\ value, so that
14067any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
14068sent there. The most common use of \errors@_to\ is probably to direct mailing
14069list bounces to the manager of the list, as described in section
14070~~SECTmailinglists.
14071
14072The \errors@_to\ setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
14073subsequently passes through other routers that have their own \errors@_to\
14074settings,
14075or if it is delivered by a transport with a \return@_path\ setting.
14076
14077You can set \errors@_to\ to the empty string by either of these settings:
14078.display asis
14079errors_to =
14080errors_to = ""
14081.endd
14082An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
14083this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
14084no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
14085address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to \"<>"\, unless
14086overridden by the \return@_path\ option on the transport.
14087
14088If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
14089\\MAIL\\ command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
14090path in \$address@_data$\ in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
14091setting \return@_path\.
14092
14093
14094.conf expn "boolean (precondition)" true
14095.index address||testing
14096.index testing||addresses
14097.index \\EXPN\\||router skipping
14098.index router||skipping for \\EXPN\\
14099If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
14100as a result of processing an SMTP \\EXPN\\ command. You might, for example,
14101want to turn it off on a router for users' \(.forward)\ files, while leaving it
4964e932
PH
14102on for the system alias file.
14103See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
495ae4b0
PH
14104are evaluated.
14105
14106The use of the SMTP \\EXPN\\ command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
14107~~CHAPACL). When Exim is running an \\EXPN\\ command, it is similar to testing
14108an address with \-bt-\. Compare \\VRFY\\, whose counterpart is \-bv-\.
14109
14110
14111.conf fail@_verify boolean false
14112.index router||forcing verification failure
14113Setting this option has the effect of setting both \fail@_verify@_sender\ and
14114\fail@_verify@_recipient\ to the same value.
14115
14116
14117.conf fail@_verify@_recipient boolean false
14118If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
14119verifying a recipient, verification fails.
14120
14121
14122.conf fail@_verify@_sender boolean false
14123If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
14124verifying a sender, verification fails.
14125
14126
14127.conf fallback@_hosts "string list" unset
14128.index router||fallback hosts
14129.index fallback||hosts specified on router
14130String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
14131colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. If a router queues an
14132address for a remote transport, this host list is associated with the address,
14133and used instead of the transport's fallback host list. If \hosts@_randomize\
14134is set on the transport, the order of the list is randomized for each use. See
14135the \fallback@_hosts\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport for further details.
14136
14137.conf group string$**$ "see below"
14138.index gid (group id)||local delivery
14139.index local transports||uid and gid
14140.index transport||local
14141.index router||setting group
14142When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
14143specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
4964e932
PH
14144process.
14145The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
495ae4b0
PH
14146error is logged and delivery is deferred.
14147The default is unset, unless \check@_local@_user\ is set, when the default
14148is taken from the password information. See also \initgroups\ and \user\ and
14149the discussion in chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
14150
14151
14152.conf headers@_add string$**$ unset
14153.index header lines||adding
14154.index router||adding header lines
d43194df 14155.em
495ae4b0 14156This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
d43194df
PH
14157associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
14158option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
14159the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
14160~~SECTheadersaddrem.
495ae4b0
PH
14161
14162The \headers@_add\ option is expanded after \errors@_to\, but before
d43194df
PH
14163\headers@_remove\ and \transport\. If the expanded string is empty, or if the
14164expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion failures
14165are treated as configuration errors.
495ae4b0 14166
d43194df
PH
14167\**Warning**\: The \headers@_add\ option cannot be used for a \%redirect%\
14168router that has the \one@_time\ option set.
14169.nem
495ae4b0
PH
14170
14171
14172.conf headers@_remove string$**$ unset
14173.index header lines||removing
14174.index router||removing header lines
d43194df
PH
14175.em
14176This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
14177associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
14178option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
14179the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
14180section ~~SECTheadersaddrem.
14181
14182The \headers@_remove\ option is expanded after \errors@_to\ and \headers@_add\,
14183but before \transport\. If the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no
14184effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration errors.
14185
14186\**Warning**\: The \headers@_remove\ option cannot be used for a \%redirect%\
14187router that has the \one@_time\ option set.
14188.nem
14189
495ae4b0
PH
14190
14191.conf ignore@_target@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
14192.index IP address||discarding
14193.index router||discarding IP addresses
14194Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
14195entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
14196IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
14197address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
14198like
14199.display asis
14200remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
14201.endd
14202by setting
14203.display asis
14204ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
14205.endd
d43194df
PH
14206on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a \%dnslookup%\ router are
14207discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
14208attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the `unrouteable
14209domain' error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
495ae4b0
PH
14210
14211Similarly, if \ignore@_target@_hosts\ is set on an \%ipliteral%\ router, the
14212router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
495ae4b0
PH
14213
14214This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
14215addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of \ignore@_target@_hosts\
14216is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
14217domain that is being routed.
d43194df
PH
14218.em
14219During its expansion, \$host@_address$\ is set to the IP address that is being
14220checked.
14221.nem
495ae4b0
PH
14222
14223
14224
14225.index additional groups
14226.index groups, additional
14227.index local transports||uid and gid
14228.index transport||local
14229.conf initgroups boolean false
14230If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
14231the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
14232\*initgroups()*\ function is called when running the transport to ensure that
14233any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also \group\ and
14234\user\ and the discussion in chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
14235
14236
14237.conf local@_part@_prefix "string list (precondition)" unset
14238.index router||prefix for local part
14239.index prefix||for local part, used in router
14240If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part
14241starts with one of the given strings, or \local@_part@_prefix@_optional\ is
14242true.
14243See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14244are evaluated.
14245
14246The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
14247used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
14248asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
14249the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
14250some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
14251.index multiple mailboxes
14252.index mailbox||multiple
14253Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
14254section ~~SECTmulbox.
14255
14256During the testing of the \local@_parts\ option, and while the router is
14257running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
14258expansion variable \$local@_part@_prefix$\. If the router accepts the address,
14259this remains true during subsequent delivery.
4964e932
PH
14260In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the \\RCPT\\ command
14261for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default. This
14262behaviour can be overridden by setting \rcpt@_include@_affixes\ true on the
495ae4b0
PH
14263relevant transport.
14264
14265The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
14266\owner-something\. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
14267\real-username\ to bypass a user's \(.forward)\ file -- helpful when trying to
14268tell a user their forwarding is broken -- by placing a router like this one
14269immediately before the router that handles \(.forward)\ files:
14270.display asis
14271real_localuser:
14272 driver = accept
14273 local_part_prefix = real-
14274 check_local_user
14275 transport = local_delivery
14276.endd
14277If both \local@_part@_prefix\ and \local@_part@_suffix\ are set for a router,
14278both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
14279are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
14280separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
14281
14282.conf local@_part@_prefix@_optional boolean false
14283See \local@_part@_prefix\ above.
14284
14285
14286.conf local@_part@_suffix "string list (precondition)" unset
14287.index router||suffix for local part
14288.index suffix for local part, used in router
14289This option operates in the same way as \local@_part@_prefix\, except that the
14290local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
14291\local@_part@_suffix@_optional\ option determines whether the suffix is
14292mandatory, and the wildcard $*$ character, if present, must be the last
14293character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
14294parts of the form \something-request\ and multiple user mailboxes of the form
14295\username-foo\.
14296
14297.conf local@_part@_suffix@_optional boolean false
14298See \local@_part@_suffix\ above.
14299
14300
14301.conf local@_parts "local part list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14302.index router||restricting to specific local parts
14303.index local part||checking in router
14304The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
4964e932 14305See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
495ae4b0
PH
14306are evaluated, and
14307section ~~SECTlocparlis for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
14308string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
14309example:
14310.display asis
14311local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
14312.endd
14313If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
14314for the local part is placed in the variable \$local@_part@_data$\ for use in
14315expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
14316example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
14317send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
14318each virtual domain:
14319.display asis
14320postmaster:
14321 driver = redirect
14322 local_parts = postmaster
14323 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
14324.endd
14325
14326
14327.conf log@_as@_local boolean "see below"
14328.index log||delivery line
14329.index delivery||log line format
14330Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
14331deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the `local' style, the
14332recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
14333this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the \%accept%\
14334router, and false for all the others.
14335
14336
14337.conf more boolean$**$ true
14338The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
14339that is, one of the strings `yes', `no', `true', or `false'. Any other result
14340causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to fail,
14341the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause delivery
14342to be deferred.
14343
14344If this option is set false, and the router is run, but declines to handle the
14345address, no further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is
14346bounced.
14347.index \self\ option
14348However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
14349means of the setting
14350.display asis
14351self = pass
14352.endd
14353or otherwise, the setting of \more\ is ignored. Also, the setting of \more\
14354does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
14355case, the address is always passed to the next router.
14356
14357
14358.conf pass@_on@_timeout boolean false
14359.index timeout||of router
14360.index router||timeout
14361If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
14362address. If \pass@_on@_timeout\ is set, the address is passed on to the next
14363router, overriding \no@_more\. This may be helpful for systems that are
14364intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
14365host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
14366
14367There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
14368lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
14369applies to all of them.
14370
14371
14372.conf pass@_router string unset
14373.index router||go to after `pass'
14374When a router returns `pass', the address is normally handed on to the next
14375router in sequence. This can be changed by setting \pass@_router\ to the name
14376of another router. However (unlike \redirect@_router\) the named router must be
14377below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only to
14378the special case of `pass'. It does not apply when a router returns `decline'.
14379
14380
14381.conf redirect@_router string unset
14382.index router||start at after redirection
14383Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
14384generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
14385example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
14386point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
14387
14388The \redirect@_router\ option can be set to the name of any router instance. It
14389causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
14390instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
14391which it is set does not generate new addresses.
14392
14393
14394.conf require@_files "string list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14395.index file||requiring for router
14396.index router||requiring file existence
14397This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
14398router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
14399Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
4964e932 14400through the \require@_files\ list, expanding each item separately.
495ae4b0
PH
14401
14402Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
14403be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
4964e932 14404If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
495ae4b0
PH
14405failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
14406
14407If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
14408below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
14409`!'. The paths are passed to the \*stat()*\ function to test for the existence
14410of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not preceded by
14411`!' do not exist, or if any paths preceded by `!' do exist.
14412
14413.index NFS
14414If \*stat()*\ cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
14415the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
14416unavailable.
14417
14418This option is checked after the \domains\, \local@_parts\, and \senders\
14419options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
14420look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a
14421full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
14422these options are all expanded, you can use the \exists\ expansion condition to
14423make such tests. The \require@_files\ option is intended for checking files
14424that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
14425transport (for example \(.procmailrc)\).
14426
14427During delivery, the \*stat()*\ function is run as root, but there is a
4964e932 14428facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
495ae4b0
PH
14429This is not a proper permissions check, but just a `rough' check that
14430operates as follows:
14431
14432If an item in a \require@_files\ list does not contain any forward slash
14433characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
14434comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
14435but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
14436used. For example:
14437.display asis
14438require_files = mail:/some/file
14439require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
14440.endd
14441If a user or group name in a \require@_files\ list does not exist, the
14442\require@_files\ condition fails.
14443
14444Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
14445checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for `x' access on
14446directories, and `r' access on the final file. Note that this means that file
14447access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
14448
14449\**Warning 1**\: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
14450incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
14451may affect the result of a \require@_files\ check. In particular, \*stat()*\
14452may yield the error \\EACCES\\ (`Permission denied'). This means that the Exim
14453user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
14454
4964e932 14455\**Warning 2**\: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
d43194df 14456\*stat()*\ can yield \\EACCES\\ for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
495ae4b0 14457without root access.
d43194df
PH
14458.em
14459In this case, if a check for access by a particular user is requested, Exim
14460creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the check again in that
14461process.
495ae4b0 14462
d43194df
PH
14463The default action for handling an unresolved \\EACCES\\ is to consider it to
14464be caused by a configuration error,
14465.nem
14466and routing is deferred because the existence or non-existence of the file
14467cannot be determined. However, in some circumstances it may be desirable to
14468treat this condition as if the file did not exist. If the file name (or the
14469exclamation mark that precedes the file name for non-existence) is preceded by
14470a plus sign, the \\EACCES\\ error is treated as if the file did not exist. For
14471example:
495ae4b0
PH
14472.display asis
14473require_files = +/some/file
14474.endd
14475If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
4964e932 14476handles users' \(.forward)\ files), another solution is to set the \verify\
495ae4b0
PH
14477option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
14478
14479
14480.conf retry@_use@_local@_part boolean "see below"
14481.index hints database||retry keys
14482.index local part||in retry keys
14483When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
14484in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
14485domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
14486other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
14487Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
14488latter kind.
14489
14490This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
14491hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
14492router. The default value is true for any router that has \check@_local@_user\
14493set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
14494for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
14495same name.
14496
4964e932
PH
14497The setting of \retry@_use@_local@_part\ applies only to the router on which it
14498appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
495ae4b0 14499independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
495ae4b0
PH
14500
14501
14502.conf router@_home@_directory string$**$ unset
14503.index router||home directory for
14504.index home directory||for router
14505This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
14506\transport__home@_directory\, which sets a home directory for later
14507transporting.) In particular, if used on a \%redirect%\ router, this option
14508sets a value for \$home$\ while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
14509forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored -- other failures
14510cause the router to defer.
14511
14512Expansion of \router@_home@_directory\ happens immediately after the
14513\check@_local@_user\ test (if configured), before any further expansions take
4964e932 14514place.
495ae4b0
PH
14515(See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
14516are evaluated.)
14517While the router is running, \router__home@_directory\ overrides the value of
14518\$home$\ that came from \check@_local@_user\.
14519
14520When a router accepts an address and routes it to a transport (including the
14521cases when a redirect router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply delivery),
14522the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first of these
14523values that is set:
14524.numberpars $.
14525The \home@_directory\ option on the transport;
14526.nextp
14527The \transport@_home@_directory\ option on the router;
14528.nextp
14529The password data if \check@_local@_user\ is set on the router;
14530.nextp
14531The \router@_home@_directory\ option on the router.
14532.endp
14533In other words, \router@_home@_directory\ overrides the password data for the
14534router, but not for the transport.
14535
14536
14537.conf self string "freeze"
14538.index MX record||pointing to local host
14539.index local host||MX pointing to
14540This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
14541list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the \%dnslookup%\, \%ipliteral%\,
4964e932 14542and \%manualroute%\ routers.
495ae4b0
PH
14543Certain configurations of the \%queryprogram%\ router can also specify a list
14544of remote hosts.
14545Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
14546\%smtp%\ transport. The \self\ option specifies what happens when the first
14547host on the list turns out to be the local host.
14548The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
14549~~SECTreclocipadd.
14550
14551Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
14552example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
14553error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
14554reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
14555freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
14556cases:
14557.numberpars $.
14558\defer\
14559.newline
14560Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
14561.nextp
14562\reroute: <<domain>>\
14563.newline
14564The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
14565be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
14566behaviour is essentially a redirection.
14567.nextp
14568\reroute: rewrite: <<domain>>\
14569.newline
14570The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
14571reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
14572rewritten.
14573.nextp
14574\pass\
14575.newline
14576The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
14577\pass@_router\ option if it is set.
14578.index \more\ option
14579This overrides \no@_more\.
14580
14581During subsequent routing and delivery, the variable
14582\$self@_hostname$\ contains the name of the local host that the router
14583encountered. This can be used to distinguish between different cases for hosts
14584with multiple names. The combination
14585.display asis
14586self = pass
14587no_more
14588.endd
14589ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
14590Without \no@_more\, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
14591be passed to the next router.
14592.nextp
14593\fail\
14594.newline
14595Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
14596.nextp
14597\send\
14598.newline
14599.index local host||sending to
14600The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
14601setting should be used with extreme caution. For an \%smtp%\ transport, it makes
14602sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port is not
14603this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
14604different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
14605.endp
14606
14607.conf senders "address list$**$ (precondition)" unset
14608.index router||checking senders
14609If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
4964e932
PH
14610address matches something on the list.
14611See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
495ae4b0
PH
14612are evaluated.
14613
14614There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
14615dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an \errors@_to\
14616setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the \-bt-\ option to
14617check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the \-f-\ option to set
14618an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when verifying
14619the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the SMTP
14620\\VRFY\\ command is enabled, it must be used after \\MAIL\\ if the sender
14621address matters.
14622
14623.conf translate@_ip@_address string$**$ unset
14624.index IP address||translating
14625.index packet radio
14626.index router||IP address translation
14627There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
14628it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
14629mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
14630routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
14631is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
14632code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
14633\\SUPPORT__TRANSLATE__IP__ADDRESS\\=yes is set in \(Local/Makefile)\.
14634
14635The \translate@_ip@_address\ string is expanded for every IP address generated
14636by the router, with the generated address set in \$host@_address$\. If the
4964e932 14637expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
495ae4b0
PH
14638For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
14639If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
14640address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name -- this is looked up
14641using \*gethostbyname()*\ (or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available) to produce
14642one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP addresses
14643in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
14644.display
14645$smc{translate@_ip@_address = @\
14646 @$@{lookup@{@$@{mask:@$host@_address/26@}@}lsearch@{/some/file@}@{@$value@}fail@}}
14647.endd
14648The file would contain lines like
14649.display asis
1465010.2.3.128/26 some.host
1465110.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
14652.endd
14653You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
14654are doing.
14655
14656
14657.conf transport string$**$ unset
14658This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
14659and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
4964e932 14660only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
d43194df
PH
14661after the expansion of \errors@_to\, \headers@_add\, and \headers@_remove\, and
14662result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
14663delivery is deferred.
495ae4b0
PH
14664
14665The \transport\ option is not used by the \%redirect%\ router, but it does have
14666some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries (see
14667chapter ~~CHAPredirect).
14668
14669
14670.conf transport@_current@_directory string$**$ unset
14671.index current directory for local transport
14672This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
14673to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
14674explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
14675file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
14676option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
14677overridden by a setting on the transport.
14678If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
14679logged, and delivery is deferred.
14680See chapter ~~CHAPenvironment for details of the local delivery environment.
14681
14682
14683
14684.conf transport@_home@_directory string$**$ "see below"
14685.index home directory||for local transport
14686This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
14687local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
14688configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
14689pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
14690string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
14691setting of \home@_directory\ on the transport.
14692If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
14693logged, and delivery is deferred.
14694
14695If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
14696\transport@_home@_directory\ is not set for the router, the home directory for
14697the tranport is taken from the password data if \check@_local@_user\ is set for
14698the router. Otherwise it is taken from \router@_home@_directory\ if that option
4964e932 14699is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
495ae4b0
PH
14700
14701See chapter ~~CHAPenvironment for further details of the local delivery
14702environment.
14703
14704
14705
14706.conf unseen boolean$**$ false
14707.index router||carrying on after success
14708The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
14709that is, one of the strings `yes', `no', `true', or `false'. Any other result
14710causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to fail,
14711the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause delivery
14712to be deferred.
14713
14714When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
14715address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
4964e932
PH
14716overriding a false setting of \more\. There is little point in setting \more\
14717false if \unseen\ is always true, but it may be useful in cases when the value
495ae4b0
PH
14718of \unseen\ contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is sometimes
14719true and sometimes false).
14720
14721The \unseen\ option can be used to cause
14722.index copy of message (\unseen\ option)
14723copies of messages to be delivered to some other destination, while also
4964e932
PH
14724carrying out a normal delivery. In effect, the current address is made into a
14725`parent' that has two children -- one that is delivered as specified by this
495ae4b0
PH
14726router, and a clone that goes on to be routed further.
14727
14728Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by this router or
14729by previous routers affect the `unseen' copy of the message only. The clone
4964e932 14730that continues to be processed by further routers starts with no added headers
495ae4b0
PH
14731and none specified for removal.
14732
14733However, any data that was set by the \address@_data\ option in the current or
14734previous routers is passed on. Setting this option has a similar effect to the
14735\unseen\ command qualifier in filter files.
14736
14737
14738.conf user string$**$ "see below"
14739.index uid (user id)||local delivery
14740.index local transports||uid and gid
14741.index transport||local
14742.index router||user for filter processing
14743.index filter||user for processing
14744When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
14745specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
4964e932 14746The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
495ae4b0
PH
14747error is logged and delivery is deferred.
14748This user is also used by the \%redirect%\ router when running a filter file.
14749The default is unset, except when \check@_local@_user\ is set. In this case,
14750the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
14751a name, and \group\ is not set, the group associated with the user is used. See
14752also \initgroups\ and \group\ and the discussion in chapter ~~CHAPenvironment.
14753
14754
14755.conf verify "boolean (precondition)" true
14756Setting this option has the effect of setting \verify@_sender\ and
14757\verify@_recipient\ to the same value.
14758
14759.conf verify@_only "boolean (precondition)" false
14760.index \\EXPN\\||with \verify@_only\
14761.index \-bv-\ option
14762.index router||used only when verifying
14763If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
14764testing with the \-bv-\ option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
14765with the \-bt-\ option, or running the SMTP \\EXPN\\ command. It can be further
14766restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of \verify@_sender\
14767and \verify@_recipient\.
14768
14769\**Warning**\: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
4964e932
PH
14770SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
14771accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
495ae4b0
PH
14772user or group.
14773
14774.conf verify@_recipient "boolean (precondition)" true
14775If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
14776addresses
14777or testing recipient verification using \-bv-\.
4964e932 14778See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
495ae4b0
PH
14779are evaluated.
14780
14781.conf verify@_sender "boolean (precondition)" true
14782If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
14783or testing sender verification using \-bvs-\.
4964e932 14784See section ~~SECTrouprecon for a list of the order in which preconditions
495ae4b0
PH
14785are evaluated.
14786
14787.endconf
14788
14789
14790
14791
14792
14793.
14794.
14795.
14796.
14797. ============================================================================
14798.chapter The accept router
14799.set runningfoot "accept router"
14800.index \%accept%\ router
14801.index routers||\%accept%\
14802The \%accept%\ router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being used
14803purely for verification (see \verify@_only\) a transport is required to be
14804defined by the generic \transport\ option. If the preconditions that are
14805specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
14806it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
14807up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
14808.display asis
14809localusers:
14810 driver = accept
14811 domains = mydomain.example
14812 check_local_user
14813 transport = local_delivery
14814.endd
14815The \domains\ condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
14816\check@_local@_user\ checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
14817When both preconditions are met, the \%accept%\ router runs, and queues the
14818address for the \%local@_delivery%\ transport.
14819
14820
14821
14822
14823
14824
14825.
14826.
14827.
14828.
14829. ============================================================================
14830.chapter The dnslookup router
14831.rset CHAPdnslookup "~~chapter"
14832.set runningfoot "dnslookup router"
14833.index \%dnslookup%\ router
14834.index routers||\%dnslookup%\
d43194df
PH
14835The \%dnslookup%\ router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
14836recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
14837unless \verify@_only\ is set.
495ae4b0 14838
4964e932 14839If SRV support is configured (see \check@_srv\ below), Exim first searches for
495ae4b0
PH
14840SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
14841MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
14842However, \mx@_domains\ can be set to disable the direct use of address records.
14843
14844MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
14845looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
14846When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
14847except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
14848IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the \ignore@_target@_hosts\
14849generic option, the router declines.
14850
14851Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
14852to the local host, or to any host name that matches \hosts__treat__as__local\,
14853are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
495ae4b0
PH
14854
14855.index MX record||pointing to local host
14856.index local host||MX pointing to
14857.index \self\ option||in \%dnslookup%\ router
14858If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
14859address record, is the local host, or matches \hosts__treat__as__local\, what
14860happens is controlled by the generic \self\ option.
14861
d43194df
PH
14862.em
14863.section Problems with DNS lookups
14864.rset SECTprowitdnsloo "~~chapter.~~section"
14865There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
14866Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
14867SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
14868MX records. The global \dns@_again@_means@_nonexist\ option can help with this
14869problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
14870
14871For this reason, there are two options, \srv@_fail@_domains\ and
14872\mx@_fail@_domains\, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
14873\%dnslookup%\ router results in a DNS failure or a `try again' response. If an
14874attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
14875domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded `no
14876such record'. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router proceeds
14877to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to look for A
14878or AAAA records, unless the domain matches \mx@_domains\, in which case routing
14879fails.
14880.nem
14881
495ae4b0 14882
d43194df
PH
14883.section Private options for dnslookup
14884The private options for the \%dnslookup%\ router are as follows:
14885
14886
14887.startconf dnslookup
495ae4b0 14888
495ae4b0
PH
14889.index options||\%dnslookup%\ router
14890.conf check@_secondary@_mx boolean false
14891.index MX record||checking for secondary
14892If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
14893(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
14894process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
14895differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
14896the local host is described in section ~~SECTreclocipadd.
14897
495ae4b0
PH
14898.conf check@_srv string$**$ unset
14899.index SRV record||enabling use of
d43194df 14900The \%dnslookup%\ router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
495ae4b0
PH
14901addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
14902enable SRV support, set the \check@_srv\ option to the name of the service
14903required. For example,
14904.display asis
14905check_srv = smtp
14906.endd
14907looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
14908expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
14909to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
14910submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the \check@_srv\
14911option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
14912normal way.
14913
14914When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
d43194df
PH
14915the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
14916host name that consists of just a single dot indicates `no such service for
14917this domain'; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
14918SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
14919according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
14920
14921When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
14922the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
14923records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
14924this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
14925defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
14926and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
14927have an additional `weight' feature which some people might find useful when
14928trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
14929
14930.em
14931See section ~~SECTprowitdnsloo above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour when
14932there is a DNS lookup error.
14933.nem
495ae4b0
PH
14934
14935.conf mx@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
14936.index MX record||required to exist
14937.index SRV record||required to exist
495ae4b0
PH
14938A domain that matches \mx@_domains\ is required to have either an MX or an SRV
14939record in order to be recognised. (The name of this option could be improved.)
495ae4b0
PH
14940For example, if all the mail hosts in \*fict.example*\ are known to have MX
14941records, except for those in \*discworld.fict.example*\, you could use this
14942setting:
14943.display asis
14944mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
14945.endd
14946This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
14947has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
14948the address record.
14949
d43194df
PH
14950.em
14951.conf mx@_fail@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
14952If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
14953DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
14954~~SECTprowitdnsloo for more discussion.
14955.nem
14956
14957
495ae4b0
PH
14958.conf qualify@_single boolean true
14959.index DNS||resolver options
14960.index DNS||qualifying single-component names
14961When this option is true, the resolver option \\RES@_DEFNAMES\\ is set for DNS
14962lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
14963single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
14964called \*dictionary.ref.example*\, the domain \*thesaurus*\ would be changed to
14965\*thesaurus.ref.example*\ inside the resolver. For details of what your resolver
14966actually does, consult your man pages for \*resolver*\ and \*resolv.conf*\.
14967
14968
14969.conf rewrite@_headers boolean true
14970.index rewriting||header lines
14971.index header lines||rewriting
14972If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
14973qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
14974an address is specified as \*dormouse@@teaparty*\, the domain might be
14975expanded to \*teaparty.wonderland.fict.example*\. Domain expansion can also
14976occur as a result of setting the \widen@_domains\ option. If \rewrite@_headers\
14977is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in any ::Bcc::, ::Cc::,
14978::From::, ::Reply-to::, ::Sender::, and ::To:: header lines of the message are
14979rewritten with the full domain name.
14980
14981This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
14982ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
14983sense.
14984
14985When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
14986servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
14987making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
14988some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
14989name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
14990header rewriting.
14991
14992.conf same@_domain@_copy@_routing boolean false
14993.index address||copying routing
14994Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the \%dnslookup%\ router
14995to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
14996options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
14997default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
14998servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
14999any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
15000
15001If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
15002domain, and you are using a \%dnslookup%\ router which is independent of the
15003local part, you can set \same__domain__copy@_routing\ to bypass repeated DNS
15004lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when \%dnslookup%\
15005routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
15006message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
15007without processing them independently,
15008provided the following conditions are met:
15009.numberpars $.
4964e932 15010No router that processed the address specified \headers@_add\ or
495ae4b0
PH
15011\headers@_remove\.
15012.nextp
4964e932 15013The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by `widening'
495ae4b0
PH
15014the domain.
15015.endp
15016
15017
15018.conf search@_parents boolean false
15019.index DNS||resolver options
15020When this option is true, the resolver option \\RES@_DNSRCH\\ is set for DNS
15021lookups. This is different from the \qualify@_single\ option in that it applies
15022to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes the
15023resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent domains.
15024For example, on a machine in the \*fict.example*\ domain, if looking up
15025\*teaparty.wonderland*\ failed, the resolver would try
15026\*teaparty.wonderland.fict.example*\. For details of what your resolver
15027actually does, consult your man pages for \*resolver*\ and \*resolv.conf*\.
15028
15029Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
15030record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
15031local wildcard.
15032
d43194df
PH
15033
15034.em
15035.conf srv@_fail@_domains "domain list$**$" unset
15036If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
15037DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
15038~~SECTprowitdnsloo for more discussion.
15039.nem
15040
15041
495ae4b0
PH
15042.conf widen@_domains "string list" unset
15043.index domain||partial, widening
15044If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
15045added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
15046if
15047.display asis
15048widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
15049.endd
15050is set and a lookup of \*klingon.dictionary*\ fails,
15051\*klingon.dictionary.fict.example*\ is looked up, and if this fails,
15052\*klingon.dictionary.ref.example*\ is tried. Note that the \qualify@_single\
15053and \search@_parents\ options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
15054the DNS resolver.
15055
15056.endconf
15057
495ae4b0 15058.section Effect of qualify@_single and search@_parents
4964e932 15059When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
495ae4b0
PH
15060of the \qualify@_single\ or \search@_parents\ options, Exim rewrites the
15061corresponding address in the message's header lines unless \rewrite@_headers\
15062is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
15063
15064These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
15065for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
15066such as that implied by
15067.display asis
15068domains = @mx_any
15069.endd
15070that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
15071entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
495ae4b0
PH
15072
15073
15074
15075
15076
15077
15078
15079
15080
15081.
15082.
15083.
15084.
15085. ============================================================================
15086.chapter The ipliteral router
15087.set runningfoot "ipliteral router"
15088.index \%ipliteral%\ router
4964e932 15089.index domain literal||routing
495ae4b0
PH
15090.index routers||\%ipliteral%\
15091This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
15092verification (see \verify@_only\) a transport is required to be defined by the
15093generic \transport\ option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
15094takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal, that is, an IP address enclosed
15095in square brackets. For example, this router handles the address
15096.display asis
15097root@[192.168.1.1]
15098.endd
4964e932 15099by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address.
495ae4b0 15100
4964e932 15101If the IP address matches something in \ignore@_target@_hosts\, the router
495ae4b0 15102declines.
495ae4b0
PH
15103.index \self\ option||in \%ipliteral%\ router
15104If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic \self\
4964e932 15105option determines what happens.
495ae4b0
PH
15106
15107The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
15108controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
15109also set the main configuration option \allow@_domain@_literals\. Otherwise,
15110Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
15111
15112
15113
15114.
15115.
15116.
15117.
15118. ============================================================================
15119.chapter The iplookup router
15120.set runningfoot "iplookup router"
15121.index \%iplookup%\ router
15122.index routers||\%iplookup%\
15123The \%iplookup%\ router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
d43194df
PH
15124Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
15125not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
15126must set
495ae4b0
PH
15127.display asis
15128ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
15129.endd
15130in your \(Local/Makefile)\ configuration file.
15131
15132The \%iplookup%\ router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
15133connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
15134a different address -- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
15135message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers.
15136
15137
15138If this process fails, the address can be passed on to
15139other routers, or delivery can be deferred.
15140
15141Background, for those that are interested: We have an Oracle database of all
15142Cambridge users, and one of the items of data it maintains for each user is
15143where to send mail addressed to \*user@@cam.ac.uk*\. The MX records for
15144\*cam.ac.uk*\ point to a central machine that has a large alias list that is
15145abstracted from the database. Mail from outside is switched by this system, and
15146originally internal mail was also done this way. However, this resulted in a
15147fair number of messages travelling from some of our larger systems to the
15148switch and back again. The Oracle machine now runs a UDP service that can be
15149called by the \%iplookup%\ router in Exim to find out where \*user@@cam.ac.uk*\
15150addresses really have to go; this saves passing through the central switch, and
15151in many cases saves doing any remote delivery at all.
15152
15153Since \%iplookup%\ is just a rewriting router, a transport must not be
15154specified for it.
15155
d43194df 15156.startconf iplookup
495ae4b0
PH
15157.index options||\%iplookup%\ router
15158
15159.conf hosts string unset
15160This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
4964e932 15161names. The hosts are looked up using \*gethostbyname()*\
495ae4b0
PH
15162(or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available)
15163and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
15164happens is controlled by \optional\.
15165
15166.conf optional boolean false
15167If \optional\ is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address is
15168passed to the next router, overriding \no@_more\. If \optional\ is false,
15169delivery to the address is deferred.
15170
15171.conf port integer 0
15172.index port||\%iplookup%\ router
15173This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
15174call.
15175
15176.conf protocol string "udp"
15177This option can be set to `udp' or `tcp' to specify which of the two protocols
15178is to be used.
15179
15180.conf query string$**$ "$tt{@$local@_part@@@$domain @$local@_part@@@$domain}"
15181This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
15182repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct query
15183in the default case (see \response@_pattern\ below).
15184
15185.conf reroute string$**$ unset
15186If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
15187returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
15188string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
15189in the response by \response@_pattern\ by means of numeric variables such as
15190\$1$\, \$2$\, etc. The variable \$0$\ refers to the entire input string,
15191whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
15192up in the form \*local@_part@@domain*\.
15193
15194.conf response@_pattern string unset
15195This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
15196returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
15197router declines. If \response@_pattern\ is not set, no checking of the response
15198is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a check that
15199the text returned after the first white space is the original address. This
15200checks that the answer that has been received is in response to the correct
15201question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the following
15202could be used:
15203.display asis
15204response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
15205reroute = $local_part@$1
15206.endd
15207
15208.conf timeout time 5s
15209This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
15210machine. The same timeout is used for the \*connect()*\ function for a TCP
15211call. It does not apply to UDP.
15212
15213.endconf
15214
15215
15216
15217
15218.
15219.
15220.
15221.
15222. ============================================================================
15223.chapter The manualroute router
15224.set runningfoot "manualroute router"
15225.index \%manualroute%\ router
15226.index routers||\%manualroute%\
15227.index domain||manually routing
15228The \%manualroute%\ router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
15229routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
15230route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
15231normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, \%manualroute%\ can also
15232route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
15233messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
15234
15235The \%manualroute%\ router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain it
15236is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern has
15237associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
15238include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
15239`routing rule'. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
15240generic \transport\ option must specify a transport, unless the router is being
15241used purely for verification (see \verify@_only\).
15242
15243In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
15244router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
15245an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
15246transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
15247with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
15248passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
15249host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in \$host$\ as a single
15250text string.
15251
15252The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in \route@_list\,
15253or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file or database by
15254setting \route@_data\. Only one of these settings may appear in any one
15255instance of \%manualroute%\. The format of routing rules is described below,
15256following the list of private options.
15257
15258.section Private options for manualroute
15259.rset SECTprioptman "~~chapter.~~section"
15260
15261The private options for the \%manualroute%\ router are as follows:
15262
d43194df 15263.startconf manualroute
495ae4b0
PH
15264.index options||\%manualroute%\ router
15265
15266.conf host@_find@_failed string "freeze"
15267This option controls what happens when \%manualroute%\ tries to find an IP
15268address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
15269of
15270.display asis
15271decline
15272defer
15273fail
15274freeze
15275pass
15276.endd
15277The default assumes that this state is a serious configuration error. The
15278difference between `pass' and `decline' is that the former forces the address
15279to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by \pass@_router\),
15280.index \more\ option
15281overriding \no@_more\, whereas the latter passes the address to the next router
15282only if \more\ is true.
15283
15284This option applies only to a definite `does not exist' state; if a host lookup
15285gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the generic
15286\pass@_on@_timeout\ option is set.
15287
15288.conf hosts@_randomize boolean false
15289.index randomized host list
15290.index host||list of, randomized
15291If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
15292is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
15293overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
15294crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
15295same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
15296(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
15297deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
15298
15299When \hosts@_randomize\ is true, a host list may be split
15300into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
15301set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
15302item that is just \"+"\ in the host list. For example:
15303.display asis
15304route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
15305.endd
15306The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
15307randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
15308If \hosts@_randomize\ is not set, a \"+"\ item in the list is ignored. If a
15309randomized host list is passed to an \%smtp%\ transport that also has
15310\hosts@_randomize set\, the list is not re-randomized.
15311
15312.conf route@_data string$**$ unset
15313If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
15314Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
15315example:
15316.display asis
15317route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
15318.endd
15319If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
15320router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
15321deferred.
15322
15323.conf route@_list "string list, semicolon-separated" unset
15324This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
15325unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
15326that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
15327
15328.conf same@_domain@_copy@_routing boolean false
15329.index address||copying routing
15330Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the \%manualroute%\ router
15331to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
15332options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
15333default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
15334servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
15335any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
15336
15337If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
15338domain, and you are using a \%manualroute%\ router which is independent of the
15339local part, you can set \same@_domain@_copy@_routing\ to bypass repeated DNS
15340lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when \%manualroute%\
15341routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
15342message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
15343without processing them independently. However, this is only done if
15344\headers@_add\ and \headers@_remove\ are unset.
15345
15346.endconf
15347
15348
15349.section Routing rules in route@_list
15350The value of \route@_list\ is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
15351rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
15352entered as two semicolons. Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
15353.display
15354<<domain pattern>> <<list of hosts>> <<options>>
15355.endd
15356The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
15357no options:
15358.display asis
15359route_list = \
15360 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
15361 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
15362.endd
4964e932 15363The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
495ae4b0
PH
15364list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
15365usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a \route@_list\ must start with a
15366single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
15367pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
4964e932 15368~~SECTdomainlist),
495ae4b0
PH
15369except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
15370That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
15371lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
15372in a \route@_list\).
15373
15374The rules in \route@_list\ are searched in order until one of the patterns
15375matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
15376then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
15377\route@_list\ is set, \route@_data\ must not be set.
15378
15379
15380.section Routing rules in route@_data
15381The use of \route@_list\ is convenient when there are only a small number of
15382routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
15383hold the routing information, and use the \route@_data\ option instead.
15384The value of \route@_data\ is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
15385Most commonly, \route@_data\ is set as a string that contains an
15386expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
15387like this:
15388.display asis
15389dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
15390thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
15391.endd
15392This data can be accessed by setting
15393.display asis
15394route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
15395.endd
15396Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
15397decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in \route@_data\. The only
15398requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
15399possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
15400be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
15401
15402
15403
15404.section Format of the list of hosts
15405A list of hosts, whether obtained via \route@_data\ or \route@_list\, is always
15406separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router declines.
15407The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names and/or
15408IP addresses. IP addresses are not enclosed in brackets.
15409
15410If the list of hosts was obtained from a \route@_list\ item, the following
15411variables are set during its expansion:
15412.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%manualroute%\ router
15413.numberpars $.
15414If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
15415\$1$\, \$2$\, etc. may be set.
15416.nextp
15417\$0$\ is always set to the entire domain.
15418.nextp
15419\$1$\ is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
15420.nextp
15421.index \$value$\
15422If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
15423looked up is available in the expansion variable \$value$\.
15424.endp
15425
15426
495ae4b0 15427.section How the list of hosts is used
4964e932 15428When an address is routed to an \%smtp%\ transport by \%manualroute%\, each of
495ae4b0
PH
15429the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
15430delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the \hosts@_randomize\
15431option, either on the router (see section ~~SECTprioptman above), or on the
15432transport.
15433
15434Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
15435hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by \"/MX"\ is
15436interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
15437records in the DNS. For example:
15438.display asis
15439route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
15440.endd
15441If the \hosts@_randomize\ option is set, the order of the items in the list is
4964e932
PH
15442randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
15443that is not followed by \"/MX"\ it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
495ae4b0
PH
15444be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
15445Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
4964e932 15446happens is controlled by the
495ae4b0
PH
15447.index \self\ option||in \%manualroute%\ router
15448\self\ option of the router.
15449
15450A name on the list that is followed by \"/MX"\ is replaced with the list of
15451hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
15452lookup; the \bydns\ and \byname\ options (see section ~~SECThowoptused below)
15453are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the preference
15454values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because randomizing
15455happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is defined by
15456MX preferences.
495ae4b0
PH
15457
15458If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
15459not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
15460preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
15461
15462If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
15463depends on where in the original list of hosts the \"/MX"\ item appears. If it
15464is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
15465Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
15466
15467If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
15468most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the \self\ option of the
15469router.
15470
15471DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
15472failures when looking up IP addresses: \pass@_on@_timeout\ and
15473\host@_find@_failed\ are used when relevant.
15474
495ae4b0
PH
15475The generic \ignore@_target@_hosts\ option applies to all hosts in the list,
15476whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
495ae4b0
PH
15477
15478
15479.section How the options are used
15480.rset SECThowoptused "~~chapter.~~section"
15481The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
15482present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
15483\transport\ option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
15484other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
15485per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
15486routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
15487.numberpars $.
4964e932 15488\randomize\: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
495ae4b0
PH
15489setting of \hosts@_randomize\ for this routing rule only.
15490.nextp
15491\no@_randomize\: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
15492overriding the setting of \hosts@_randomize\ for this routing rule only.
15493.nextp
15494\byname\: use \*getipnodebyname()*\ (\*gethostbyname()*\ on older systems) to
15495find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
15496also look in \(/etc/hosts)\ or other sources of information.
15497.nextp
15498\bydns\: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
4964e932
PH
15499no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
15500timeout), delivery is deferred.
495ae4b0
PH
15501.endp
15502For example:
15503.display asis
15504route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
15505 domain2 host4:host5
15506.endd
15507If neither \byname\ nor \bydns\ is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a DNS
15508lookup is done. If this yields anything other than \\HOST@_NOT@_FOUND\\, that
15509result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to \*getipnodebyname()*\
15510or \*gethostbyname()*\, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
15511call.
15512
15513\**Warning**\: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
15514called via \*getipnodebyname()*\ times out, \\HOST@_NOT@_FOUND\\ is returned
15515instead of \\TRY@_AGAIN\\. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
15516lookup first. Only if that gives a definite `no such host' is the local
15517function called.
15518
15519
15520
15521If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
15522\host@_find@_failed\ option.
15523
15524When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
15525The host list is passed to the transport in the \$host$\ variable.
15526
15527
15528.section Manualroute examples
15529In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the \remote@_smtp\
15530transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
15531
15532.numberpars $.
15533.index smart host||example router
15534The \%manualroute%\ router can be used to forward all external mail to a
15535\*smart host*\. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
15536named domain list that contains your local domains, for example,
15537.display asis
15538domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
15539.endd
15540you can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
15541your first router something like this:
15542.display asis
15543smart_route:
15544 driver = manualroute
15545 domains = !+local_domains
15546 transport = remote_smtp
15547 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
15548.endd
15549This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
15550\*smarthost.ref.example*\. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
15551they are tried in order
15552(but you can use \hosts@_randomize\ to vary the order each time).
15553Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
15554.display asis
15555smart_route:
15556 driver = manualroute
15557 transport = remote_smtp
15558 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
15559.endd
15560There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
15561However, they behave differently if \no@_more\ is added to them. In the first
15562example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the \domains\
15563precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
15564always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, \no@_more\ would
15565have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it always
15566runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
15567\no@_more\ would prevent subsequent routers from running.
15568
15569.nextp
15570.index mail hub example
15571A \*mail hub*\ is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
15572records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
15573the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
15574machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
15575\%manualroute%\ router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
15576to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
15577using the \route@_list\ option, but for a larger number a file or database
15578lookup is easier to manage.
15579
15580If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
15581to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
15582example,
15583.display asis
15584hub_route:
15585 driver = manualroute
15586 transport = remote_smtp
15587 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
15588.endd
15589This configuration routes domains that match \"*.rhodes.tvs.example"\ to hosts
15590whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
15591if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
15592that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
15593domain can be used to find the host:
15594.display asis
15595through_firewall:
15596 driver = manualroute
15597 transport = remote_smtp
15598 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
15599.endd
15600The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
15601hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
15602data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
15603next router.
15604
15605.nextp
15606.index batched SMTP output example
15607.index SMTP||batched outgoing, example
15608You can use \%manualroute%\ to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
15609SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
15610storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
15611can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
15612.display asis
15613save_in_file:
15614 driver = manualroute
15615 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
15616 route_list = saved.domain.example
15617.endd
15618though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
15619several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
15620different transports can be listed in the routing information:
15621.display asis
15622save_in_file:
15623 driver = manualroute
15624 route_list = \
15625 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
15626 *.saved.domain2.example \
15627 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
15628 batch_pipe
15629.endd
15630The first of these just passes the domain in the \$host$\ variable, which
15631doesn't achieve much (since it is also in \$domain$\), but the second does a
15632file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
15633the address if the lookup fails.
15634.nextp
15635.index UUCP||example of router for
15636Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
15637\%manualroute%\ in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
15638one way it can be done:
15639.display asis
15640# Transport
15641uucp:
15642 driver = pipe
15643 user = nobody
15644 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
15645 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
15646 return_fail_output = true
15647.endd
15648.display asis
15649# Router
15650uucphost:
15651 transport = uucp
15652 driver = manualroute
15653 route_data = \
15654 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
15655.endd
15656The file \(/usr/local/exim/uucphosts)\ contains entries like
15657.display asis
15658darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
15659.endd
15660It can be set up more simply without adding and removing `.UUCP' but this way
15661makes clear the distinction between the domain name
15662\*darksite.ethereal.example*\ and the UUCP host name \*darksite*\.
15663.endp
15664
15665
15666
15667
15668
15669
15670.
15671.
15672.
15673.
15674. ============================================================================
15675.chapter The queryprogram router
15676.set runningfoot "queryprogram router"
15677.rset CHAPdriverlast "~~chapter"
15678.index \%queryprogram%\ router
15679.index routers||\%queryprogram%\
15680.index routing||by external program
15681The \%queryprogram%\ router routes an address by running an external command and
15682acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended mainly
15683for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments. However, if
15684it is possible to use the precondition options (\domains\, \local@_parts\,
15685etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly be used in
15686special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private options:
15687
d43194df 15688.startconf queryprogram
495ae4b0
PH
15689.index options||\%queryprogram%\ router
15690.conf command string$**$ unset
15691This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
15692command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
15693expanded separately (exactly as for a \%pipe%\ transport, described in chapter
15694~~CHAPpipetransport).
15695
15696.conf command@_group string unset
15697.index gid (group id)||in \%queryprogram%\ router
15698This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command. It must be set
15699if \command@_user\ specifies a numerical uid. If it begins with a digit, it is
15700interpreted as the numerical value of the gid. Otherwise it is looked up using
15701\*getgrnam()*\.
15702
15703.conf command@_user string unset
15704.index uid (user id)||for \%queryprogram%\
15705This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
15706command. If it begins with a digit it is interpreted as the numerical value of
15707the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up using \*getpwnam()*\ to obtain a value for
15708the uid and, if \command@_group\ is not set, a value for the gid also.
15709
15710.conf current@_directory string /
15711This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
15712before running the command.
15713
15714.conf timeout time 1h
15715If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
15716is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
15717timeout.
15718
15719.endconf
15720
15721The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
15722the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
d43194df
PH
15723containing up to five fields, separated by white space.
15724.em
15725The maximum length of the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently
15726truncated.
15727.nem
15728The first field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
495ae4b0
PH
15729.numberpars $.
15730\*Accept*\: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
15731below).
15732.nextp
15733\*Decline*\: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
15734\no@_more\ is set.
15735.nextp
15736\*Fail*\: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
15737subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
15738of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
15739included in the SMTP response.
15740.nextp
15741\*Defer*\: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
15742subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
15743included in any SMTP response.
15744.nextp
15745\*Freeze*\: the same as \*defer*\, except that the message is frozen.
15746.nextp
15747\*Pass*\: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
15748\pass@_router\), overriding \no@_more\.
15749.nextp
15750\*Redirect*\: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
15751new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
15752or the router specified by \redirect@_router\, if set.
15753.endp
15754When the first word is \*accept*\, the remainder of the line consists of a
15755number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
15756the page):
15757.display
15758ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<<transport>> HOSTS=<<list of hosts>>
15759 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<<text>>
15760.endd
15761The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
15762is included, the transport specified by the generic \transport\ option is used.
15763The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is an
15764\%smtp%\ transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
15765
4964e932 15766The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the \%manualroute%\ router.
495ae4b0
PH
15767As well as host names and IP addresses, it may contain names followed by
15768\"/MX"\ to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX
15769records.
15770
4964e932 15771If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
495ae4b0
PH
15772find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
15773anything other than \\HOST@_NOT@_FOUND\\, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
15774goes on to try a call to \*getipnodebyname()*\ or \*gethostbyname()*\, and the
15775result of the lookup is the result of that call.
15776
15777If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the \$address@_data$\
15778variable. For example, this return line
15779.display asis
15780accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
15781.endd
d43194df
PH
15782routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
15783the transport runs, the string `rule1' is in \$address@_data$\.
495ae4b0
PH
15784
15785
15786
15787.
15788.
15789.
15790.
15791. ============================================================================
15792.chapter The redirect router
15793.set runningfoot "redirect router"
15794.rset CHAPredirect "~~chapter"
15795.index \%redirect%\ router
15796.index routers||\%redirect%\
15797.index alias file||in a \%redirect%\ router
15798.index address redirection||\%redirect%\ router
15799The \%redirect%\ router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
15800common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
15801(usually called \(/etc/aliases)\) and for handling users' personal \(.forward)\
15802files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
15803redirected in several different ways:
15804.numberpars $.
15805It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
15806independently.
15807.nextp
15808It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
15809.nextp
15810It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
15811.nextp
15812It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
15813.nextp
15814It can be forced to fail, with a custom error message.
15815.nextp
15816It can be temporarily deferred.
15817.nextp
15818It can be discarded.
15819.endp
15820The generic \transport\ option must not be set for \%redirect%\ routers.
15821However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
15822files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the \file@_transport\,
15823\pipe@_transport\ and \reply@_transport\ descriptions below.
15824
15825
15826.section Redirection data
15827The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
15828expanding the contents of the \data\ option, or by reading the entire contents
15829of a file whose name is given in the \file\ option. These two options are
15830mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system aliases, in
15831a configuration like this:
15832.display asis
15833system_aliases:
15834 driver = redirect
15835 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
15836.endd
4964e932 15837If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
495ae4b0
PH
15838expansion of \data\ results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
15839expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
15840cause delivery to be deferred.
495ae4b0
PH
15841
15842A configuration using \file\ is commonly used for handling users' \(.forward)\
15843files, like this:
15844.display asis
15845userforward:
15846 driver = redirect
15847 check_local_user
15848 file = $home/.forward
15849 no_verify
15850.endd
15851If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
15852empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. \**Warning**\: This
15853is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
15854yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
15855comments.
15856
15857
15858.section Forward files and address verification
15859.index address redirection||while verifying
15860It is usual to set \no@_verify\ on \%redirect%\ routers which handle users'
15861\(.forward)\ files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
15862.numberpars $.
15863When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
4964e932
PH
15864running under the Exim uid, not as root.
15865No additional groups are set up, even if the Exim uid is a member of other
495ae4b0
PH
15866groups (that is, the \*initgroups()*\ function is not run).
15867Exim is unable to change uid to read the file as the user, and it may not be
15868able to read it as the Exim user. So in practice the router may not be able to
15869operate.
15870.nextp
15871However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a \(.forward)\ file
15872is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
15873local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
15874saves some resources.
15875.endp
15876
15877
15878
15879
15880.section Interpreting redirection data
15881.index Sieve filter||specifying in redirection data
15882.index filter||specifying in redirection data
15883The contents of the data string, whether obtained from \data\ or \file\, can be
15884interpreted in two different ways:
15885.numberpars $.
15886If the \allow@_filter\ option is set true, and the data begins with the text
15887`@#Exim filter' or `@#Sieve filter', it is interpreted as a list of
15888\*filtering*\ instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
15889respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
15890in a separate document entitled \*Exim's interfaces to mail filtering*\; this
15891document is intended for use by end users.
15892.nextp
15893Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
15894described in the next section.
15895.endp
4964e932
PH
15896When a message is redirected to a file (a `mail folder'), the file name given
15897in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
15898generate a relative path -- how this is handled depends on the transport's
15899configuration. See section ~~SECTfildiropt for a discussion of this issue for
495ae4b0
PH
15900the \%appendfile%\ transport.
15901
15902
15903.section Items in a non-filter redirection list
15904.rset SECTitenonfilred "~~chapter.~~section"
15905.index address redirection||non-filter list items
15906When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
15907comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
15908addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
15909~~SECTspecitredli below). The special items can be individually enabled or
15910disabled by means of options whose names begin with \allow@_\ or \forbid@_\,
15911depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
15912commas or newlines.
15913If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
15914quotes.
15915
15916Lines starting with a @# character are comments, and are ignored, and @# may
15917also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the @# and the
15918next newline character is ignored.
15919
15920If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
15921double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
15922(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description, `item'
15923refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been removed.
15924
4964e932
PH
15925\**Warning**\: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
15926and the expansion contains a reference to \$local@_part$\, you should make use
15927of the \quote\ expansion operator, in case the local part contains special
15928characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
15929\*obsolete.example*\, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
495ae4b0
PH
15930setting:
15931.display asis
15932data = ${quote:$local_part}@newdomain.example
15933.endd
15934
15935
15936.section Redirecting to a local mailbox
15937.rset SECTredlocmai "~~chapter.~~section"
15938.index routing||loops in
15939.index loop||while routing, avoidance of
15940.index address redirection||to local mailbox
15941A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
15942consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
15943automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
4964e932 15944is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
495ae4b0
PH
15945Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
15946as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
15947complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
15948
15949.index address redirection||local part without domain
15950Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
15951filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
15952mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
15953\*cleo*\ might have a \(.forward)\ file containing this:
15954.display asis
15955cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
15956.endd
15957.index backslash in alias file
15958.index alias file||backslash in
15959For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
15960preceeded by `@\', but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
15961it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
15962synonymously.
15963
15964If an item begins with `@\' and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC 2822
15965address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the domain
15966of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading `@\', unqualified
15967addresses are qualified using the value in \qualify@_recipient\, but you can
15968force the incoming domain to be used by setting \qualify__preserve@_domain\.
15969
4964e932 15970Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
495ae4b0
PH
15971Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
15972contains:
15973.display asis
15974Sam.Reman: spqr
15975.endd
15976Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is \*spqr*\) wants to save copies of
4964e932 15977messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
495ae4b0
PH
15978this forward file:
15979.display asis
15980Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
15981.endd
15982With these settings, an incoming message addressed to \*Sam.Reman*\ fails. The
15983\%redirect%\ router for system aliases does not process \*Sam.Reman*\ the
4964e932 15984second time round, because it has previously routed it,
495ae4b0
PH
15985and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
15986should really contain
15987.display asis
15988spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
15989.endd
15990but because this is such a common error, the \check@_ancestor\ option (see
15991below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
15992\%redirect%\ router that is handling users' \(.forward)\ files.
15993
15994
15995.section Special items in redirection lists
15996.rset SECTspecitredli "~~chapter.~~section"
15997In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
15998lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
15999
16000.numberpars $.
16001.index pipe||in redirection list
16002.index address redirection||to pipe
16003An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with `|' and does not parse
16004as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
4964e932 16005command must be specified by the \pipe@_transport\ option.
495ae4b0
PH
16006Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
16007which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
495ae4b0
PH
16008
16009Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
16010the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
16011the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
16012in double quotes, for example:
16013.display asis
16014"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
16015.endd
16016since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
16017quote just the command. An item such as
16018.display asis
16019|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
16020.endd
16021is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
16022.nextp
16023.index file||in redirection list
16024.index address redirection||to file
16025An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with `/' and does not parse
16026as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
16027.display asis
16028/home/world/minbari
16029.endd
16030is treated as a file name, but
16031.display asis
16032/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
16033.endd
16034is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
16035the \file@_transport\ option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
16036forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
16037file name, and \directory@_transport\ is used instead.
16038
495ae4b0
PH
16039Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
16040which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
16041.index \(/dev/null)\
16042However, if a redirection item is the path \(/dev/null)\, delivery to it is
16043bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows `$*$$*$bypassed$*$$*$'
16044instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
495ae4b0
PH
16045.nextp
16046.index included address list
16047.index address redirection||included external list
16048If an item is of the form
16049.display
16050:include:<<path name>>
16051.endd
16052a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
4964e932
PH
16053point.
16054\**Note**\: such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an out-of-line
495ae4b0
PH
16055addition to the list.
16056The items in the included list are separated by commas or newlines and are not
16057subject to expansion. If this is the first item in an alias list in an
16058\%lsearch%\ file, a colon must be used to terminate the alias name. This
16059example is incorrect:
16060.display asis
16061list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
16062.endd
16063It must be given as
16064.display asis
16065list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
16066.endd
16067.nextp
16068.index address redirection||to black hole
16069Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
16070\data\ option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes the
16071router to decline. Instead, the alias item
16072.index black hole
16073.index abandoning mail
16074.display
16075:blackhole:
16076.endd
16077can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is done, and no error
16078message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing \(/dev/null)\, but
16079can be independently disabled.
16080
4964e932
PH
16081\**Warning**\: If \":blackhole:"\ appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
16082delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
16083are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
16084database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
495ae4b0
PH
16085\(/dev/null)\.
16086
16087.nextp
16088.index delivery||forcing failure
16089.index delivery||forcing deferral
16090.index failing delivery||forcing
16091.index deferred delivery, forcing
16092.index customizing||failure message
16093An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
16094redirection items of the form
16095.display
16096:defer:
16097$rm{or}
16098:fail:
16099.endd
16100respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
16101entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (:::blackhole:: is
16102different). Any text following :::fail:: or :::defer:: is placed in the error
16103text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
16104.display asis
16105X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
16106.endd
16107In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
4964e932 16108of a \\VRFY\\ command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
495ae4b0
PH
16109default. In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but
16110the default message is available in the variable \$acl@_verify@_message$\ and
16111can therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired. Exim sends a
16112451 SMTP code for a :::defer::, and 550 for :::fail::. In non-SMTP cases the
16113text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
16114
16115
16116
16117Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list -- a comma does not
16118terminate it -- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
16119normally present in alias expansions. In \%lsearch%\ lookups they are removed as
16120part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of lookup
16121and in :::include:: files.
16122
16123During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
16124containing :::fail:: causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
16125whereas :::defer:: causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
16126subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
16127deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
16128rules still apply.
16129.nextp
16130.index alias file||exception to default
16131Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
16132chapter ~~CHAPfdlookup) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need for
16133exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
16134.display asis
16135:unknown:
16136.endd
16137This differs from :::fail:: in that it causes the \%redirect%\ router to decline,
16138whereas :::fail:: forces routing to fail. A lookup which results in an empty
16139redirection list has the same effect.
16140.endp
16141
16142.section Duplicate addresses
16143.index duplicate addresses
16144.index address||duplicate, discarding
16145.index pipe||duplicated
16146Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
16147to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
16148routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
16149aliasing scheme of the type
16150.display asis
16151pipe: |/some/command $local_part
16152localpart1: pipe
16153localpart2: pipe
16154.endd
16155does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
16156when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part `pipe' it gets
16157discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
16158such as
16159.display asis
16160localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
16161localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
16162.endd
16163does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
16164the pipes are distinct.
16165
16166
16167.section Repeated redirection expansion
16168.index repeated redirection expansion
16169.index address redirection||repeated for each delivery attempt
16170When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
16171leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
16172afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
16173delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
16174members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The \one@_time\ option
16175can be used to avoid this.
16176
16177.section Errors in redirection lists
16178.index address redirection||errors
16179If \skip@_syntax@_errors\ is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
16180error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
16181for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
16182detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
16183deferred. See also \syntax@_errors@_to\.
16184
16185
16186.section Private options for the redirect router
16187
16188The private options for the \%redirect%\ router are as follows:
16189
d43194df 16190.startconf redirect
495ae4b0
PH
16191.index options||\%redirect%\ router
16192
16193.conf allow@_defer boolean false
16194Setting this option allows the use of :::defer:: in non-filter redirection
16195data,
16196or the \defer\ command in an Exim filter file.
16197
16198.conf allow@_fail boolean false
16199.index failing delivery||from filter
16200If this option is true, the :::fail:: item can be used in a redirection list,
16201and the \fail\ command may be used in a filter file.
16202
16203.conf allow@_filter boolean false
16204.index filter||enabling use of
16205.index Sieve filter||enabling use of
16206Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
16207`@#Exim filter' or `@#Sieve filter' as a set of filtering instructions. There
16208are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
d43194df
PH
16209lock out; see the \forbid@_filter@_xxx\ options below.
16210.em
16211It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
16212the other type; see \forbid@_exim@_filter\ and \forbid@_sieve@_filter\.
16213.nem
16214
16215The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic \user\ and \group\
16216options. These take their defaults from the password data if
16217\check@_local@_user\ is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
16218files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When \allow@_filter\ is set
16219true, Exim insists that either \check@_local@_user\ or \user\ is set.
495ae4b0
PH
16220
16221
16222.conf allow@_freeze boolean false
16223.index freezing messages||allowing in filter
16224Setting this option allows the use of the \freeze\ command in an Exim filter.
16225This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
16226default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
16227let ordinary users do.
16228
16229
16230.conf check@_ancestor boolean false
16231This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
16232as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
16233Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
16234configuration file for handling users' \(.forward)\ files. It is recommended
16235for this use of the \%redirect%\ router.
16236
495ae4b0
PH
16237When \check@_ancestor\ is set, if a generated address (including the domain) is
16238the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
16239the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
4964e932 16240and B has a \(.forward)\ file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
495ae4b0
PH
16241domain, the local part `Joe.Bloggs' is aliased to `jb' and \(@~jb/.forward)\
16242contains:
495ae4b0
PH
16243.display
16244@\Joe.Bloggs, <<other item(s)>>
16245.endd
16246Without the \check@_ancestor\ setting, either local part (`jb' or `joe.bloggs')
16247gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was originally. If `jb'
16248is the real mailbox name, mail to `jb' gets delivered (having been turned into
16249`joe.bloggs' by the \(.forward)\ file and back to `jb' by the alias), but mail
16250to `joe.bloggs' fails. Setting \check@_ancestor\ on the \%redirect%\ router that
16251handles the \(.forward)\ file prevents it from turning `jb' back into
16252`joe.bloggs' when that was the original address. See also the \repeat@_use\
16253option below.
16254
16255.conf check@_group boolean "see below"
16256When the \file\ option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
16257when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
16258\owngroups\ option, together with the user's default group if
16259\check@_local@_user\ is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
16260deferred. The default setting for this option is true if \check@_local@_user\
16261is set and the \modemask\ option permits the group write bit, or if the
16262\owngroups\ option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
16263
16264
16265.conf check@_owner boolean "see below"
16266When the \file\ option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when this
16267option is set. If \check@_local@_user\ is set, the local user is permitted;
16268otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the \owners\ option. The
16269default value for this option is true if \check@_local@_user\ or \owners\ is
16270set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
16271
16272.conf data string$**$ unset
16273This option is mutually exclusive with \file\. One or other of them must be
16274set, but not both. The contents of \data\ are expanded, and then used as the
16275list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
16276expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
16277has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
16278
16279When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with `@#Exim
16280filter', and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
16281terminated with newline characters. For example:
16282.display asis
16283data = #Exim filter\n\
16284 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
16285.endd
16286If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
16287you can use the \$@{sg@}$\ expansion item to turn the escape string of your
16288choice into a newline.
16289
16290.conf directory@_transport string$**$ unset
16291A \%redirect%\ router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
16292ending with a slash is specified as a new `address'. The transport used is
16293specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
16294configured transport. This should normally be an \%appendfile%\ transport.
16295
16296.conf file string$**$ unset
16297This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
16298is mutually exclusive with the \data\ option. The string is expanded before
16299use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
16300failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
16301must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
16302data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
16303entirely of comments), the router declines.
16304
16305.index NFS||checking for file existence
16306If the attempt to open the file fails with a `does not exist' error, Exim
16307runs a check on the containing directory,
16308unless \ignore@_enotdir\ is true (see below).
16309If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
16310happen when users' \(.forward)\ files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
16311is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
16312not, the router declines.
16313
16314.conf file@_transport string$**$ unset
16315A \%redirect%\ router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
16316ending in a slash is specified as a new `address'. The transport used is
16317specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
4964e932 16318configured transport.
495ae4b0
PH
16319This should normally be an \%appendfile%\ transport.
16320When it is running, the file name is in \$address@_file$\.
16321
16322.conf forbid@_blackhole boolean false
16323If this option is true, the :::blackhole:: item may not appear in a redirection
16324list.
16325
d43194df
PH
16326.em
16327.conf forbid@_exim@_filter boolean false
16328If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
16329\allow@_filter\ is true.
16330.nem
16331
16332
495ae4b0
PH
16333.conf forbid@_file boolean false
16334.index delivery||to file, forbidding
16335.index Sieve filter||forbidding delivery to a file
16336.index Sieve filter||`keep' facility, disabling
16337If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
16338specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
16339conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if \one@_time\ is
16340set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
16341locks out the Sieve's `keep' facility.
16342
16343.conf forbid@_filter@_existstest boolean false
16344.index filter||locking out certain features
16345If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
16346make use of the \exists\ condition.
16347
16348.conf forbid@_filter@_logwrite boolean false
16349If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
16350permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
16351under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
16352\(.forward)\ files).
16353
16354.conf forbid@_filter@_lookup boolean false
16355If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16356to make use of \lookup\ items.
16357
16358.conf forbid@_filter@_perl boolean false
16359This option is available only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
16360it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
16361of the embedded Perl support.
16362
16363.conf forbid@_filter@_readfile boolean false
16364If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16365to make use of \readfile\ items.
16366
16367.conf forbid@_filter@_readsocket boolean false
16368If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16369to make use of \readsocket\ items.
16370
16371.conf forbid@_filter@_reply boolean false
16372If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
d43194df
PH
16373message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim
16374.em
16375or Sieve filter files, not from traditional forward files.
16376.nem
16377This option is forced to be true if \one@_time\ is set.
495ae4b0
PH
16378
16379.conf forbid@_filter@_run boolean false
16380If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
16381to make use of \run\ items.
16382
16383.conf forbid@_include boolean false
16384If this option is true, items of the form
16385.display
16386:include:<<path name>>
16387.endd
16388are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
16389
16390.conf forbid@_pipe boolean false
16391.index delivery||to pipe, forbidding
16392If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
16393specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
16394forward file. This option is forced to be true if \one@_time\ is set.
16395
d43194df
PH
16396.em
16397.conf forbid@_sieve@_filter boolean false
16398If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
16399\allow@_filter\ is true.
16400.nem
16401
16402
495ae4b0
PH
16403.conf hide@_child@_in@_errmsg boolean false
16404.index bounce message||redirection details, suppressing
16405If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
16406generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says `an address
16407generated from <<the top level address>>'. Of course, this applies only to
16408bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, $it{its}
16409bounce may well quote the generated address.
16410
16411.conf ignore@_eacces boolean false
16412.index \\EACCES\\
16413If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
16414\\EACCES\\ error (permission denied), the \%redirect%\ router behaves as if the
16415file did not exist.
16416
16417.conf ignore@_enotdir boolean false
16418.index \\ENOTDIR\\
16419If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
16420\\ENOTDIR\\ error (something on the path is not a directory), the \%redirect%\
16421router behaves as if the file did not exist.
16422
16423Setting \ignore@_enotdir\ has another effect as well: When a \%redirect%\
16424router that has the \file\ option set discovers that the file does not exist
16425(the \\ENOENT\\ error), it tries to \*stat()*\ the parent directory, as a check
16426against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
16427is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when \ignore@_enotdir\ is
16428set, because that option tells Exim to ignore `something on the path is not a
16429directory' (the \\ENOTDIR\\ error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
16430that some operating systems give \\ENOENT\\ where others give \\ENOTDIR\\.
16431
16432
16433.conf include@_directory string unset
16434If this option is set, the path names of any :::include:: items in a redirection
16435list must start with this directory.
16436
16437.conf modemask "octal integer" 022
16438This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
16439\file\ option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
16440
16441.conf one@_time boolean false
16442.index one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion
16443.index alias file||one-time expansion
16444.index forward file||one-time expansion
16445.index mailing lists||one-time expansion
16446.index address redirection||one-time expansion
16447Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
16448files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem
4964e932
PH
16449when one or more of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first
16450attempt. The problem is not one of duplicate delivery -- Exim is clever enough
495ae4b0
PH
16451to handle that -- but of what happens when the redirection list changes during
16452the time that the message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the
16453case of mailing lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages
16454that were posted before they subscribed.
16455
16456If \one@_time\ is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
16457deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
16458`top level' addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
16459`delivered'. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next
16460delivery attempt.
16461
16462\**Warning 1**\: This means that any header line addition or removal that is
16463specified by this router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the
16464first attempt. For this reason, the \headers@_add\ and \headers@_remove\
16465generic options are not permitted when \one@_time\ is set.
16466
16467\**Warning 2**\: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
16468to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) \forbid@_file\, \forbid@_pipe\,
16469and \forbid@_filter@_reply\ are forced to be true when \one@_time\ is set.
16470
16471The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
16472addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
16473addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
16474\all__parents\ log selector is set. It is expected that \one@_time\ will
16475typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
16476expansion.
16477
16478.conf owners "string list" unset
16479.index ownership||alias file
16480.index ownership||forward file
16481.index alias file||ownership
16482.index forward file||ownership
16483This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by \file\.
16484This list is in addition to the local user when \check@_local@_user\ is set.
16485See \check@_owner\ above.
16486
16487.conf owngroups "string list" unset
16488This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by \file\. The
16489list is in addition to the local user's primary group when \check@_local@_user\
16490is set. See \check@_group\ above.
16491
495ae4b0
PH
16492.conf pipe@_transport string$**$ unset
16493A \%redirect%\ router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string starting
16494with a vertical bar character is specified as a new `address'. The transport
16495used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
4964e932 16496configured transport.
495ae4b0
PH
16497This should normally be a \%pipe%\ transport.
16498When the transport is run, the pipe command is in \$address@_pipe$\.
16499
d43194df
PH
16500.conf qualify@_domain string$**$ unset
16501If this option is set and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
16502generated, it is qualified with the domain specified by expanding this string,
16503instead of the global setting in \qualify@_recipient\. If the expansion fails,
16504the router declines. If you want to revert to the default, you can have the
16505expansion generate \$qualify@_recipient$\.
16506
495ae4b0
PH
16507.conf qualify@_preserve@_domain boolean false
16508.index domain||in redirection, preserving
16509.index preserving domain in redirection
16510.index address redirection||domain, preserving
16511If this is set and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is generated,
4964e932 16512it is qualified with the domain of the
495ae4b0
PH
16513parent address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the local
16514\qualify@_domain\ or global \qualify@_recipient\ value.
495ae4b0
PH
16515
16516.conf repeat@_use boolean true
16517If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
16518any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
16519the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
16520only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
16521\check@_ancestor\ above and the generic \redirect@_router\ option.
16522
16523.conf reply@_transport string$**$ unset
16524A \%redirect%\ router sets up an automatic reply when a \mail\ or \vacation\
16525command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified by this
16526option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured transport.
4964e932 16527This should normally be an \%autoreply%\ transport. Other transports are
495ae4b0
PH
16528unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
16529
16530.conf rewrite boolean true
16531.index address redirection||disabling rewriting
16532If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
16533subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
16534and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
16535
d43194df
PH
16536
16537.em
16538.conf sieve@_vacation@_directory string$**$ unset
16539.index Sieve filter||vacation directory
16540To enable the `vacation' extension for Sieve filters, you must set
16541\sieve@_vacation@_directory\ to the directory where vacation databases are held
16542(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
16543\reply@_transport\ option refers to an \%autoreply%\ transport.
16544.nem
16545
16546
495ae4b0
PH
16547.conf skip@_syntax@_errors boolean false
16548.index forward file||broken
16549.index address redirection||broken files
16550.index alias file||broken
16551.index broken alias or forward files
16552.index ignoring faulty addresses
16553.index skipping faulty addresses
16554.index error||skipping bad syntax
16555If \skip@_syntax@_errors\ is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
16556non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
16557\syntax@_errors@_to\ is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
16558giving details of the failures. If \syntax@_errors@_text\ is set, its contents
16559are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
16560\syntax@_errors@_to\. Usually it is appropriate to set \syntax@_errors@_to\ to
16561be the same address as the generic \errors@_to\ option. The
16562\skip@_syntax@_errors\ option is often used when handling mailing lists.
16563
16564If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
16565errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
16566the following routers.
16567
16568If \skip@_syntax@_errors\ is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
16569error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
16570taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
16571so it is passed to the following routers.
16572
16573.index Sieve filter||syntax errors in
d43194df
PH
16574.em
16575Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the `keep' action to
16576occur. This action is specified by RFC 3028.
16577.nem
16578The values of \skip@_syntax@_errors\, \syntax@_errors@_to\, and
495ae4b0
PH
16579\syntax@_errors@_text\ are not used.
16580
16581\skip@_syntax@_errors\ can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
16582lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The \syntax@_errors@_to\
16583option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
16584notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
16585.display flow asis
16586userforward:
16587 driver = redirect
16588 allow_filter
16589 check_local_user
16590 file = $home/.forward
16591 file_transport = address_file
16592 pipe_transport = address_pipe
16593 reply_transport = address_reply
16594 no_verify
16595 skip_syntax_errors
16596 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
16597 syntax_errors_text = \
16598 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
16599 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
16600 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
16601 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
16602 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
16603 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
16604 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
16605 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
16606 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
16607 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
16608.endd
16609You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
16610\"real-"\ are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
16611put this immediately before the \%userforward%\ router:
16612.display asis
16613real_localuser:
16614 driver = accept
16615 check_local_user
16616 local_part_prefix = real-
16617 transport = local_delivery
16618.endd
16619
16620.conf syntax@_errors@_text string$**$ unset
16621See \skip@_syntax@_errors\ above.
16622
16623.conf syntax@_errors@_to string unset
16624See \skip@_syntax@_errors\ above.
16625
16626.endconf
16627
16628
16629
16630
16631
16632.
16633.
16634.
16635. ============================================================================
16636.chapter Environment for running local transports
16637.rset CHAPenvironment "~~chapter"
16638.set runningfoot "local transport environment"
16639.index local transports||environment for
16640.index environment for local transports
16641.index transport||local, environment for
16642Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The \%autoreply%\
16643transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
16644in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
16645mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
16646
16647Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
16648some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The \%pipe%\
d43194df 16649transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
495ae4b0
PH
16650~~SECTpipeenv for details.
16651
16652The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
16653different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
16654settings with that address as a result of its \check@_local@_user\, \group\, or
16655\user\ options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
16656configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
16657
d43194df
PH
16658
16659.em
16660.section Concurrent deliveries
16661.index concurrent deliveries
16662.index simultaneous deliveries
16663If two different messages for the same local recpient arrive more or less
16664simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
16665the \%appendfile%\ transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
16666rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
16667time.
16668
16669However, when you use a \%pipe%\ transport, it is up to you to arrange any
16670locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
16671.display asis
16672my_transport:
16673 driver = pipe
16674 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
16675.endd
16676This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
16677messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
16678\exim@_lock\ utility program (see section ~~SECTmailboxmaint) to lock a file
16679using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
16680.nem
16681
16682
495ae4b0
PH
16683.section Uids and gids
16684.rset SECTenvuidgid "~~chapter.~~section"
16685.index local transports||uid and gid
16686.index transport||local, uid and gid
16687All transports have the options \group\ and \user\. If \group\ is set, it
16688overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if \user\ is not
16689set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
16690delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
16691group (set by the transport). For example:
16692.display asis
16693# Routers ...
16694# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
16695local_users:
16696 driver = accept
16697 check_local_user
4964e932 16698 transport = group_delivery
495ae4b0
PH
16699
16700# Transports ...
16701# This transport overrides the group
16702group_delivery:
16703 driver = appendfile
16704 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
16705 group = mail
16706.endd
16707If \user\ is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
16708address. If \user\ is non-numeric and \group\ is not set, the gid associated
16709with the user is used. If \user\ is numeric, \group\ must be set.
16710
16711.index \initgroups\ option
16712When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the \*initgroups()*\
16713function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the \initgroups\
16714option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified by the
16715transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option for
16716calling \*initgroups()*\ is taken from the router configuration.
16717
16718.index \%pipe%\ transport||uid for
16719The \%pipe%\ transport contains the special option \pipe@_as@_creator\. If this
16720is set and \user\ is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
16721receive the message is used, and if \group\ is not set, the corresponding
16722original gid is also used.
16723
16724
16725.section Current and home directories
16726.index current directory for local transport
16727.index home directory||for local transport
16728.index transport||local, home directory for
16729.index transport||local, current directory for
16730Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
16731the \transport__current@_directory\ and \transport@_home@_directory\ options.
16732However, if the transport's \current__directory\ or \home@_directory\ options
16733are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
16734for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
16735.numberpars $.
16736The \home@_directory\ option on the transport;
16737.nextp
16738The \transport@_home@_directory\ option on the router;
16739.nextp
16740The password data if \check@_local@_user\ is set on the router;
16741.nextp
16742The \router@_home@_directory\ option on the router.
16743.endp
16744The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
16745.numberpars $.
16746The \current@_directory\ option on the transport;
16747.nextp
16748The \transport@_current@_directory\ option on the router.
16749.endp
16750
16751If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
16752value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
16753directory to \(/)\ before running a local transport.
16754
16755
16756.section Expansion variables derived from the address
16757Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
16758variables such as \$domain$\ and \$local@_part$\ are set during local
16759deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
16760at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
16761other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
16762never set, \$domain$\ is set only if all the addresses have the same
16763domain, and \$original@_domain$\ is never set.
16764
16765
16766
16767
16768
16769
16770
16771.
16772.
16773.
16774. ============================================================================
16775.chapter Generic options for transports
16776.rset CHAPtransportgeneric "~~chapter"
16777.set runningfoot "generic transport options"
16778
16779.index generic options||transport
16780.index options||generic, for transports
16781.index transport||generic options for
16782The following generic options apply to all transports:
16783
d43194df 16784.startconf transports
495ae4b0
PH
16785.conf body@_only boolean false
16786.index transport||body only
16787.index message||transporting body only
16788.index body of message||transporting
16789If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
16790mutually exclusive with \headers@_only\. If it is used with the \%appendfile%\ or
16791\%pipe%\ transports, the settings of \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\
16792should be checked, because this option does not automatically suppress them.
16793
16794.conf current@_directory string$**$ unset
16795.index transport||current directory for
16796This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
16797transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
16798If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16799logged, and delivery is deferred.
16800
16801.conf disable@_logging boolean false
4964e932
PH
16802If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
16803deliveries by the transport or for any
495ae4b0
PH
16804transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
16805what you are doing.
16806
16807.conf debug@_print string$**$ unset
16808.index testing||variables in drivers
16809If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the \-d-\ command line
16810option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
4964e932
PH
16811transport is run.
16812If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
495ae4b0
PH
16813output, and Exim carries on processing.
16814This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16815so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a \headers@_add\
16816option is not working properly, \debug@_print\ could be used to output the
16817variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
16818one.
16819
16820.conf delivery@_date@_add boolean false
16821.index ::Delivery-date:: header line
16822If this option is true, a ::Delivery-date:: header is added to the message. This
16823gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard header,
16824Exim has a configuration option (\delivery@_date@_remove\) which requests its
16825removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent
16826to other recipients.
16827
16828.conf driver string unset
16829This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
16830There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
16831
16832.conf envelope@_to@_add boolean false
16833.index ::Envelope-to:: header line
16834If this option is true, an ::Envelope-to:: header is added to the message. This
16835gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
16836delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
16837configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
16838address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
16839header, Exim has a configuration option (\envelope@_to@_remove\) which requests
16840its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
16841resent to other recipients.
16842
16843.conf group string$**$ "Exim group"
16844.index transport||group, specifying
16845This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
16846value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
16847\user\ (see below).
16848
16849.conf headers@_add string$**$ unset
16850.index header lines||adding in transport
16851.index transport||header lines, adding
d43194df
PH
16852.em
16853This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
16854portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
16855~~SECTheadersaddrem. Additional header lines can also be specified by routers.
16856If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion is
16857forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
16858errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
16859.nem
495ae4b0
PH
16860
16861.conf headers@_only boolean false
16862.index transport||header lines only
16863.index message||transporting headers only
16864.index header lines||transporting
16865If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
16866exclusive with \body@_only\. If it is used with the \%appendfile%\ or \%pipe%\
16867transports, the settings of \message@_prefix\ and \message__suffix\ should be
16868checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
16869
16870.conf headers@_remove string$**$ unset
16871.index header lines||removing
16872.index transport||header lines, removing
d43194df
PH
16873.em
16874This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
16875these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
16876in section ~~SECTheadersaddrem. Header removal can also be specified by
16877routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
16878is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
495ae4b0 16879errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
d43194df 16880.nem
495ae4b0
PH
16881
16882.conf headers@_rewrite string unset
16883.index transport||header lines, rewriting
16884.index rewriting||at transport time
16885This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
16886that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
16887option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
16888the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
16889message is received. These are described in chapter ~~CHAPrewrite. For example,
16890.display asis
16891headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
16892 x@y w@z
16893.endd
16894changes \a@@b\ into \c@@d\ in ::From:: header lines, and \x@@y\ into \w@@z\ in
16895all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the header lines
16896just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect only those
16897copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only the
16898message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system filter,
16899are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are
16900not affected by this option. These rewriting rules are $it{not} applied to the
16901envelope. You can change the return path using \return@_path\, but you cannot
16902change envelope recipients at this time.
16903
16904.conf home@_directory string$**$ unset
16905.index transport||home directory for
16906This option specifies a home directory setting for the transport, overriding
16907any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is placed in
16908\$home$\ while expanding the transport's private options. It is also used as
16909the current directory if no current directory is set by the
16910\current__directory\ option on the transport or the
16911\transport__current__directory\ option on the router.
16912If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16913logged, and delivery is deferred.
16914
16915
16916.index additional groups
16917.index groups, additional
16918.index transport||group, additional
16919.conf initgroups boolean false
16920If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
16921transport, the \*initgroups()*\ function is called when running the transport
16922to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
16923
16924.conf message@_size@_limit string$**$ 0
16925.index limit||message size per transport
16926.index size||of message, limit
16927.index transport||message size, limiting
16928This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
16929expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of digits,
16930optionally followed by K or M.
4964e932 16931If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, or if the
495ae4b0
PH
16932result is not of the required form, delivery is deferred.
16933If the value is greater than zero and the size of a message exceeds this
16934limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that the resulting bounce
16935message could be routed to the same transport, you should ensure that
16936\return@_size@_limit\ is less than the transport's \message@_size@_limit\, as
16937otherwise the bounce message will fail to get delivered.
16938
16939
16940.conf rcpt@_include@_affixes boolean false
16941.index prefix||for local part, including in envelope
16942.index suffix||for local part, including in envelope
16943.index local part||prefix
16944.index local part||suffix
16945When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
16946affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
16947form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
16948that contains
16949.display asis
16950local_part_prefix = *-
16951.endd
16952routes the address \*abc-xyz@@some.domain*\ to an SMTP transport, the envelope
16953is delivered with
16954.display asis
16955RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
16956.endd
16957If \rcpt@_include@_affixes\ is set true, the whole local part is included in
16958the \\RCPT\\ command. This option applies to BSMTP deliveries by the
16959\%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports as well as to the \%lmtp%\ and \%smtp%\
16960transports.
16961
16962.conf retry@_use@_local@_part boolean "see below"
16963.index hints database||retry keys
16964When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
16965in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
16966is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
16967deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
16968part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
16969temporary failure -- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
16970deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
16971
16972However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
16973as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
16974(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
16975this by setting \retry@_use@_local@_part\ false.
16976
16977For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
16978the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
16979on a remote transport in the current implementation.
16980
16981.conf return@_path string$**$ unset
16982.index envelope sender
16983.index transport||return path, changing
16984.index return path||changing in transport
16985If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
16986the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
16987that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
16988designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
16989SMTP \\MAIL\\ command. If you set \return@_path\ for a local transport, the
16990only effect is to change the address that is placed in the ::Return-path::
16991header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
16992
16993The expansion can refer to the existing value via \$return@_path$\. This is
16994either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
16995\errors@_to\ option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
16996replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
16997option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) -- see
16998chapter ~~CHAPSMTP.
16999
4964e932 17000\**Note**\: If a delivery error is detected locally,
495ae4b0
PH
17001including the case when a remote server rejects a message at SMTP time,
17002the bounce message is not sent to the value of this option, but to the
17003previously set errors address (which defaults to the incoming sender address).
495ae4b0
PH
17004
17005
17006.conf return@_path@_add boolean false
17007.index ::Return-path:: header line
17008If this option is true, a ::Return-path:: header is added to the message.
17009Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
17010mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
17011have easy access to it.
17012
17013RFC 2821 states that the ::Return-path:: header is added to a message `when the
17014delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery'. This implies that this header
17015should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration option,
17016\return@_path@_remove\, which requests removal of this header from incoming
17017messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other recipients.
17018
17019.conf shadow@_condition string$**$ unset
17020See \shadow@_transport\ below.
17021
17022.conf shadow@_transport string unset
17023.index shadow transport
17024.index transport||shadow
17025A local transport may set the \shadow@_transport\ option to the name of another
17026local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
17027
17028Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
17029\shadow@_condition\ is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
17030string or one of the strings `0' or `no' or `false', the message is also passed
17031to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses.
4964e932 17032If expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion
495ae4b0
PH
17033failures cause a log line to be written.
17034
17035The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
17036subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
17037provided; the \shadow@_transport\ option is ignored on any transport when it is
17038running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also ignored.
17039
17040The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the
17041form
17042.display
17043ST=<<shadow transport name>>
17044.endd
17045If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
17046parentheses afterwards.
17047
17048Shadow transports can be used for a number of different purposes, including
17049keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally provides, and
17050implementing automatic acknowledgement policies based on message headers that
17051some sites insist on.
17052
17053.conf transport@_filter string$**$ unset
17054.index transport||filter
17055.index filter||transport filter
17056This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
17057at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
17058individual users or via a system filter.
17059
17060When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
17061\transport@_filter\ is started up in a separate process, and the entire
17062message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard input
17063(this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
17064The command must be specified as an absolute path.
17065
d43194df
PH
17066.em
17067The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
17068terminated by newline (`@\n').
17069.nem
495ae4b0
PH
17070The message is passed to the filter before any SMTP-specific processing, such
17071as turning `@\n' into `@\r@\n' and escaping lines beginning with a dot, and
17072also before any processing implied by the settings of \check@_string\ and
17073\escape@_string\ in the \%appendfile%\ or \%pipe%\ transports.
17074
d43194df
PH
17075.em
17076The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
17077standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
17078destination.
17079.nem
495ae4b0
PH
17080The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
17081care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
17082\(util/transport-filter.pl)\; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
17083show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
17084final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
17085with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
17086
17087.index SMTP||\\SIZE\\
17088A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
17089being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
17090support for the \\SIZE\\ parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
17091at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
17092more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
17093the \size@_addition\ option on the \%smtp%\ transport, either to allow for
17094additions to the message, or to disable the use of \\SIZE\\ altogether.
17095
d43194df
PH
17096The value of the \transport@_filter\ option is the command string for starting
17097the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
17098parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the \%pipe%\ transport:
17099Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately. The
17100special argument \$pipe@_addresses$\ is replaced by a number of arguments, one
17101for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't an ideal name for
17102this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the \%pipe%\
17103transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
495ae4b0
PH
17104
17105.index \$host$\
17106.index \$host@_address$\
17107The expansion variables \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are available when the
17108transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
17109which the message is being sent. For example:
17110.display asis
17111transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
17112 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
17113.endd
17114The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
17115For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default.
d43194df
PH
17116.em
17117The command should normally yield a zero return code. A non-zero code is taken
17118to mean that the transport filter failed in some way. Delivery of the message
17119is deferred. It is not possible to cause a message to be bounced from a
17120transport filter.
17121.nem
495ae4b0
PH
17122
17123If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
17124passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
17125message, which happens if the \return@_message\ option is set.
17126
17127.conf transport@_filter@_timeout time 5m
17128.index transport||filter, timeout
4964e932
PH
17129When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
17130that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is treated as a
495ae4b0
PH
17131temporary delivery failure.
17132
17133
17134.conf user string$**$ "Exim user"
17135.index uid (user id)||local delivery
17136.index transport||user, specifying
17137This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
17138run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
17139given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
17140associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the \group\
17141option is not set.
17142
495ae4b0
PH
17143For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
17144specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
17145\check@_local@_user\) by the router or transport.
495ae4b0
PH
17146
17147.index hints database||access by remote transport
17148For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
17149sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
17150to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
17151retry data.
17152
17153.endconf
17154
17155
17156
17157
17158
17159.
17160.
17161.
17162. ============================================================================
17163.chapter Address batching in local transports
17164.set runningfoot "address batching"
17165.rset CHAPbatching ~~chapter
17166.index transport||local, address batching in
17167The only remote transport (\%smtp%\) is normally configured to handle more than
17168one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
17169remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
17170normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
17171transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
17172copy of the message is delivered each time.
17173
17174.index batched local delivery
17175.index \batch@_max\
17176.index \batch@_id\
17177In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
17178local transport, for example:
17179.numberpars $.
17180In an \%appendfile%\ transport, when storing messages in files for later
17181delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
17182recipients saves space.
17183.nextp
17184In an \%lmtp%\ transport, when delivering over `local SMTP' to some process,
17185a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
17186.nextp
4964e932
PH
17187In a \%pipe%\ transport, when passing the message
17188to a scanner program or
495ae4b0
PH
17189to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
17190acceptable.
17191.endp
17192The three local transports (\%appendfile%\, \%lmtp%\, and \%pipe%\) all have
17193the same options for controlling multiple (`batched') deliveries, namely
17194\batch@_max\ and \batch@_id\. To save repeating the information for each
17195transport, these options are described here.
17196
17197The \batch@_max\ option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
17198delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one.
17199When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a \batch@_max\
17200value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch (that is, in a
17201single run of the transport), subject to certain conditions:
17202.numberpars $.
17203If any of the transport's options contain a reference to \$local@_part$\, no
17204batching is possible.
17205.nextp
17206If any of the transport's options contain a reference to \$domain$\, only
17207addresses with the same domain are batched.
17208.nextp
17209.index customizing||batching condition
17210If \batch@_id\ is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
17211addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
17212customized batching conditions.
4964e932
PH
17213Failure of the expansion for any reason, including forced failure, disables
17214batching, but it does not stop the delivery from taking place.
495ae4b0
PH
17215.nextp
17216Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
17217delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
17218group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
17219be the same.
17220.endp
17221.index ::Envelope-to:: header line
17222If the generic \envelope@_to@_add\ option is set for the transport, the
17223::Envelope-to:: header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
17224that are batched together.
17225
17226The \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports have an option called \use@_bsmtp\,
17227which causes them to deliver the message in `batched SMTP' format, with the
17228envelope represented as SMTP commands. The \check@_string\ and \escape@_string\
17229options are forced to the values
17230.display asis
17231check_string = "."
17232escape_string = ".."
17233.endd
17234when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
17235given in section ~~SECTbatchSMTP. The \%lmtp%\ transport does not have a
17236\use@_bsmtp\ option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
17237
17238.index \%pipe%\ transport||with multiple addresses
4964e932
PH
17239If you are not using BSMTP, but are using a \%pipe%\ transport, you can include
17240\$pipe@_addresses$\ as part of the command. This is not a true variable; it is
17241a bit of magic that causes each of the recipient addresses to be inserted into
17242the command as a separate argument. This provides a way of accessing all the
495ae4b0
PH
17243addresses that are being delivered in the batch.
17244
17245If you are using a batching \%appendfile%\ transport without \use@_bsmtp\, the
17246only way to preserve the recipient addresses is to set the \envelope@_to@_add\
4964e932 17247option. This causes an ::Envelope-to:: header line to be added to the message,
495ae4b0
PH
17248containing all the recipients.
17249
17250
17251
17252.
17253.
17254.
17255. ============================================================================
17256.chapter The appendfile transport
17257.set runningfoot "appendfile transport"
17258.rset CHAPappendfile ~~chapter
17259.index \%appendfile%\ transport
17260.index transports||\%appendfile%\
17261.index directory creation
17262.index creating directories
17263The \%appendfile%\ transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
17264file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
17265files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
17266format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
17267University of Washington IMAP daemon, $it{inter alia}. When each message is
17268being delivered as a separate file, `maildir' format can optionally be used to
17269give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
17270delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as `mailstore' is also
17271supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
17272directory as necessary, provided that \create@_directory\ is set.
17273
17274The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
17275default. It is necessary to set \\SUPPORT@_MBX\\, \\SUPPORT@_MAILDIR\\ and/or
17276\\SUPPORT@_MAILSTORE\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\ to have the appropriate code
17277included.
17278
17279.index quota||system
17280Exim recognises system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
17281also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
17282system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
17283
17284If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
17285partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
17286modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
17287creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
17288
17289Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
17290file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
17291private options.
17292
17293\%appendfile%\ is most commonly used for local deliveries to users' mailboxes.
17294However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for putting messages
17295into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim. `Batch SMTP'
4964e932 17296format is often used in this case (see the \use@_bsmtp\ option).
495ae4b0
PH
17297
17298
17299.section The file and directory options
17300.rset SECTfildiropt "~~chapter.~~section"
4964e932
PH
17301The \file\ option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
17302the \directory\ option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
495ae4b0
PH
17303the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
17304normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them \*must*\ be set.
17305
17306However, \%appendfile%\ is also used for delivering messages to files or
17307directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
17308forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a \save\ command in a user's
17309Exim filter). When such a transport is running, \$local@_part$\ contains the
17310local part that was aliased or forwarded, and \$address@_file$\ contains the
17311name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
17312operation. There are two cases:
17313.numberpars $.
17314If neither \file\ nor \directory\ is set, the redirection operation
4964e932
PH
17315must specify an absolute path (one that begins with \"/"\). This is the most
17316common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
495ae4b0
PH
17317different folders. See for example, the \%address@_file%\ transport in the
17318default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
4964e932 17319name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
495ae4b0
PH
17320\maildir@_format\ or \mailstore@_format\.
17321.nextp
17322If \file\ or \directory\ is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is used
17323to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
4964e932 17324contents of \$address@_file$\ are used in some way in the string expansion.
495ae4b0
PH
17325.endp
17326
17327.index Sieve filter||configuring \%appendfile%\
17328.index Sieve filter||relative mailbox path handling
17329As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
17330have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
17331form:
17332.display asis
17333save folder23
17334.endd
17335or Sieve filter commands of the form:
17336.display asis
4964e932 17337require "fileinto";
495ae4b0
PH
17338fileinto "folder23";
17339.endd
17340In this situation, the expansion of \file\ or \directory\ in the transport must
4964e932
PH
17341transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the case
17342of Sieve filters, the name \*inbox*\ must be handled. It is the name that is
17343used as a result of a `keep' action in the filter. This example shows one way
495ae4b0
PH
17344of handling this requirement:
17345.display asis
17346file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
17347 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
17348 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
17349 {$address_file} \
17350 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
17351 }} \
17352 }
17353.endd
4964e932 17354With this setting of \file\, \*inbox*\ refers to the standard mailbox location,
495ae4b0
PH
17355absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the \(mail)\
17356directory within the home directory.
17357
17358\**Note 1**\: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
17359\(folder23)\ is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
17360the router. In particular, this is the case if \check@_local@_user\ is set. If
17361you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
17362\router@_home@_directory\ empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
17363path to the transport.
17364
17365\**Note 2**\: An absolute path in \$address@_file$\ is not treated specially;
17366the \file\ or \directory\ option is still used if it is set.
17367
17368
17369
17370.section Private options for appendfile
17371.index options||\%appendfile%\ transport
17372
d43194df 17373.startconf appendfile
495ae4b0
PH
17374
17375.conf allow@_fifo boolean false
17376.index fifo (named pipe)
17377.index named pipe (fifo)
17378.index pipe||named (fifo)
17379Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
17380regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
17381delivery is deferred.
17382
17383.conf allow@_symlink boolean false
17384.index symbolic link||to mailbox
17385.index mailbox||symbolic link
17386By default, \%appendfile%\ will not deliver if the path name for the file is
17387that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
17388are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
17389what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
17390are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
17391
17392.conf batch@_id string$**$ unset
17393See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
4964e932
PH
17394However, batching is automatically disabled for \%appendfile%\ deliveries that
17395happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
495ae4b0
PH
17396file.
17397
17398.conf batch@_max integer 1
17399See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
17400
17401.conf check@_group boolean false
17402When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the \file\
17403option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
17404delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
17405file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
17406
17407.conf check@_owner boolean true
17408When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the \file\ option is
17409checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
17410process is running.
17411
17412.conf check@_string string "see below"
17413.index `From' line
17414As \%appendfile%\ writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
17415matching \check@_string\, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
17416replaced by the contents of \escape@_string\. The value of \check@_string\ is a
17417literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
17418contains is significant.
17419
17420If \use@_bsmtp\ is set the values of \check@_string\ and \escape@_string\ are
17421forced to `.' and `..' respectively, and any settings in the configuration are
17422ignored. Otherwise, they default to `From ' and `>From ' when the \file\ option
4964e932 17423is set, and unset when
495ae4b0
PH
17424any of the \directory\, \maildir\, or \mailstore\ options are set.
17425
17426The default settings, along with \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\, are
17427suitable for traditional `BSD' mailboxes, where a line beginning with `From '
17428indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing if another
17429format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
17430.index MMDF format mailbox
17431.index mailbox||MMDF format
17432.display asis
17433check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
17434escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
17435message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
17436message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
17437.endd
17438
17439.index directory creation
17440.conf create@_directory boolean true
17441When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
17442directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
17443is given by the \directory@_mode\ option.
d43194df
PH
17444.em
17445The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
17446operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
17447example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
17448is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
17449in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
17450.nem
495ae4b0
PH
17451
17452.conf create@_file string "anywhere"
17453This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
17454by this transport. It applies to files defined by the \file\ option and
17455directories defined by the \directory\ option. In the case of maildir delivery,
17456it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories beneath.
17457
17458The option must be set to one of the words `anywhere', `inhome', or
17459`belowhome'. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been set
17460for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
17461given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
17462names are generated from users' \(.forward)\ files. These are usually handled
17463by an \%appendfile%\ transport called \address@_file\. See also
17464\file@_must@_exist\.
17465
17466.conf directory string$**$ unset
17467This option is mutually exclusive with the \file\ option, but one of \file\ or
17468\directory\ must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
17469redirection (see section ~~SECTfildiropt).
17470
17471When \directory\ is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
17472into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
17473appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
17474(see \maildir@_format\ and \mailstore@_format\), and see section ~~SECTopdir
17475for further details of this form of delivery.
17476
17477.conf directory@_file string$**$ "$tt{q@$@{base62:@$tod@_epoch@}-@$inode}"
17478.index base62
17479When \directory\ is set, but neither \maildir@_format\ nor \mailstore@_format\
17480is set, \%appendfile%\ delivers each message into a file whose name is obtained
17481by expanding this string. The default value generates a unique name from the
17482current time, in base 62 form, and the inode of the file. The variable
17483\$inode$\ is available only when expanding this option.
17484
17485.conf directory@_mode "octal integer" 0700
17486If \%appendfile%\ creates any directories as a result of the \create@_directory\
17487option, their mode is specified by this option.
17488
17489.conf escape@_string string "see description"
17490See \check@_string\ above.
17491
17492.conf file string$**$ unset
17493This option is mutually exclusive with the \directory\ option, but one of
17494\file\ or \directory\ must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of
17495a redirection (see section ~~SECTfildiropt). The \file\ option specifies a
17496single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
17497\use@_fcntl@_lock\, \use@_flock@_lock\, or \use@_lockfile\ must be set with
17498\file\.
17499.index NFS||lock file
17500.index locking files
17501.index lock files
17502If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
17503mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
17504
17505The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
17506path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
17507examples:
17508.display asis
17509file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
17510file = /home/$local_part/inbox
17511file = $home/inbox
17512.endd
17513.index `sticky' bit
17514In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
17515is configured to use lock files (see \use@_lockfile\ below) it must be able to
17516create a file in the directory, so the `sticky' bit must be turned on for
17517deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the \group\ option can be used to
17518run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
17519
17520
17521.conf file@_format string unset
17522.index file||mailbox, checking existing format
17523This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
17524before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
17525start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
17526colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
17527second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
17528string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
17529transport. For example, suppose the standard \%local@_delivery%\ transport has
17530this added to it:
17531.display asis
17532file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
17533 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
17534.endd
17535Mailboxes that begin with `From' are still handled by this transport, but if a
17536mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
17537to a transport called \local__mmdf__delivery\, which presumably is configured
17538to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
17539is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
17540match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
17541delivery is deferred.
17542
17543.conf file@_must@_exist boolean false
17544If this option is true, the file specified by the \file\ option must exist, and
17545an error occurs if it does not. Otherwise, it is created if it does not exist.
17546
17547.conf lock@_fcntl@_timeout time 0s
17548.index timeout||mailbox locking
17549.index mailbox locking||blocking and non-blocking
17550.index locking files
17551By default, the \%appendfile%\ transport uses non-blocking calls to \*fcntl()*\
17552when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
17553sleeps for \lock@_interval\ and tries again, up to \lock@_retries\ times.
17554Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
17555for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
17556deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
17557mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
17558misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
17559
17560On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
17561not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
17562is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
17563and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
17564
17565If \lock@_fcntl@_timeout\ is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
17566timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
17567retries is
17568.display asis
17569(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
17570.endd
17571rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
17572which \%appendfile%\ is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
17573\lock@_fcntl@_timeout\ is set very large.
17574
17575You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
17576local deliveries because of errors of the form
17577.display asis
17578failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
17579.endd
17580
17581.conf lock@_flock@_timeout time 0s
17582This timeout applies to file locking when using \*flock()*\ (see \use@_flock\);
17583the timeout operates in a similar manner to \lock@_fcntl@_timeout\.
17584
17585.conf lock@_interval time 3s
17586This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
17587for details of locking.
17588
17589.conf lock@_retries integer 10
17590This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
17591is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
17592
17593.conf lockfile@_mode "octal integer" 0600
17594This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
17595used (see \use@_lockfile\).
17596
17597.conf lockfile@_timeout time 30m
17598.index timeout||mailbox locking
17599When a lock file is being used (see \use@_lockfile\), if a lock file already
17600exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
17601accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
17602
d43194df
PH
17603.em
17604.conf mailbox@_filecount string$**$ unset
17605.index mailbox||specifying size of
17606.index size||of mailbox
17607If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
17608number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
17609followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
17610external source that maintains the data.
17611
17612.conf mailbox@_size string$**$ unset
17613.index mailbox||specifying size of
17614.index size||of mailbox
17615If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
17616size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
17617This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
17618maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
17619it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
17620.nem
17621
495ae4b0
PH
17622.conf maildir@_format boolean false
17623.index maildir format||specifying
17624If this option is set with the \directory\ option, the delivery is into a new
17625file, in the `maildir' format that is used by other mail software. When the
17626transport is activated directly from a \%redirect%\ router (for example, the
17627\%address@_file%\ transport in the default configuration), setting
17628\maildir@_format\ causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
17629directory, whether or not it ends with \"/"\. This option is available only if
17630\\SUPPORT@_MAILDIR\\ is present in \(Local/Makefile)\. See section
17631~~SECTmaildirdelivery below for further details.
17632
495ae4b0
PH
17633.conf maildir@_quota@_directory@_regex string "See below"
17634.index maildir format||quota, directories included in
17635.index quota||maildir, directories included in
17636This option is relevant only when \maildir@_use@_size@_file\ is set. It defines
17637a regular expression for specifying directories that should be included in the
17638quota calculation. The default value is
17639.display asis
17640maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
17641.endd
17642which includes the \(cur)\ and \(new)\ directories, and any maildir++ folders
4964e932 17643(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
495ae4b0
PH
17644\(Trash)\
17645folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
17646.display asis
17647maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
17648.endd
17649This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
17650directory whose name is \(.Trash)\.
495ae4b0
PH
17651
17652.conf maildir@_retries integer 10
17653This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
17654`maildir' format. See section ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below.
17655
17656.conf maildir@_tag string$**$ unset
17657This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
17658section ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below.
17659
17660.conf maildir@_use@_size@_file boolean false
17661.index maildir format||\(maildirsize)\ file
17662Setting this option true enables support for \(maildirsize)\ files. Exim
17663creates a \(maildirsize)\ file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
17664quota from the \quota\ option of the transport. If \quota\ is unset, the value
17665is zero. See section ~~SECTmaildirdelivery below for further details.
17666
17667.conf mailstore@_format boolean false
17668.index mailstore format||specifying
17669If this option is set with the \directory\ option, the delivery is into two new
17670files in `mailstore' format. The option is available only if
17671\\SUPPORT@_MAILSTORE\\ is present in \(Local/Makefile)\. See section
17672~~SECTopdir below for further details.
17673
17674.conf mailstore@_prefix string$**$ unset
17675This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
17676section ~~SECTopdir below.
17677
17678.conf mailstore@_suffix string$**$ unset
17679This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
17680section ~~SECTopdir below.
17681
17682.conf mbx@_format boolean false
17683.index locking files
17684.index file||locking
17685.index file||MBX format
17686.index MBX format, specifying
17687This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with \\SUPPORT@_MBX\\
17688set in \(Local/Makefile)\. If \mbx@_format\ is set with the \file\ option,
17689the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
17690traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
17691IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the \*c-client*\ library that they all use.
17692
17693\**Note**\: The \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\ options are not
17694automatically changed by the use of \mbx@_format\. They should normally be set
4964e932 17695empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
495ae4b0
PH
17696combination:
17697.display asis
17698mbx_format = true
17699message_prefix =
17700message_suffix =
17701.endd
17702
17703If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
17704\use@_mbx@_lock\ is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
17705is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with \mbx@_format\, but
17706\use@_fcntl@_lock\ and \use@_mbx@_lock\ are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
17707interworks with \*c-client*\, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
17708should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
17709going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
17710mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
17711
17712If you set \use@_fcntl@_lock\ with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
17713the standard version of \*c-client*\, because as long as it has a mailbox open
17714(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
17715append messages to it.
17716
17717.conf message@_prefix string$**$ "see below"
17718.index `From' line
17719The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
17720The default is unset unless \file\ is specified and \use@_bsmtp\ is not set, in
17721which case it is:
17722.display asis
17723message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
17724 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
17725.endd
17726
17727.conf message@_suffix string$**$ "see below"
17728The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
17729The default is unset unless \file\ is specified and \use@_bsmtp\ is not set, in
17730which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
17731setting
17732.display asis
17733message_suffix =
17734.endd
17735
17736.conf mode "octal integer" 0600
17737If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
17738has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
17739permissions, an error occurs unless \mode__fail__narrower\ is false. However,
17740if the delivery is the result of a \save\ command in a filter file specifing a
17741particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
17742value, and this option is ignored.
17743
17744.conf mode@_fail@_narrower boolean true
17745This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
17746mode than that specified by the \mode\ option. If \mode@_fail@_narrower\ is
17747true, the delivery is deferred (`mailbox has the wrong mode'); otherwise Exim
17748continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
17749
17750.conf notify@_comsat boolean false
17751If this option is true, the \*comsat*\ daemon is notified after every successful
17752delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged on users
17753about incoming mail.
17754
17755.conf quota string$**$ unset
17756.index quota||imposed by Exim
17757This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
17758or to the total space used in the directory tree when the \directory\ option is
17759set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
17760all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
4964e932 17761individually inspected and their sizes summed.
495ae4b0
PH
17762(See \quota@_size@_regex\ and \maildir@_use@_size@_file\ for ways to avoid this
17763in environments where users have no shell access to their mailboxes).
17764
17765As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
17766multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
17767For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
495ae4b0
PH
17768
17769A file's size is taken as its \*used*\ value. Because of blocking effects, this
17770may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
17771If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
17772become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
17773Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the \*used*\ figure, because this is
17774the obvious value which users understand most easily.
17775
17776The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
17777(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K or M. The
17778expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for the
17779delivery. This means that files which are inaccessible to the end user can be
17780used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
17781fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
17782system quota failures.
17783
4964e932 17784\**Note**\: A value of zero is interpreted as `no quota'.
495ae4b0
PH
17785
17786By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
17787mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
17788last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
17789during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
17790refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
17791message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
17792changed by setting \quota@_is@_inclusive\ false. When this is done, the check
17793for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
17794continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
17795delivered. See also \quota@_warn@_threshold\.
17796
17797.conf quota@_directory string$**$ unset
17798This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
17799into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
17800called \(maildirfolder)\ exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
17801delivery directory.
17802
17803.conf quota@_filecount string$**$ 0
17804This option applies when the \directory\ option is set. It limits the total
17805number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
17806can only be used if \quota\ is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
17807failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17808
17809.conf quota@_is@_inclusive boolean true
17810See \quota\ above.
17811
17812.conf quota@_size@_regex string unset
17813This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
17814for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
17815these files in order to test the quota, it first checks \quota@_size@_regex\.
17816If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
17817captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
17818file's size. The value of \quota@_size@_regex\ is not expanded.
17819
17820This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
17821-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
17822facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting \maildir@_tag\ to add
17823the file length to the file name. For example:
17824.display asis
17825maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
17826quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
17827.endd
4964e932
PH
17828The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
17829file name (even though \maildir@_tag\ puts it there) because maildir MUAs
495ae4b0
PH
17830sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
17831
17832.conf quota@_warn@_message string$**$ "see below"
17833See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
17834\quota@_warn@_threshold\ is set, it defaults to
17835.display asis
17836quota_warn_message = "\
17837 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
17838 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
17839 This message is automatically created \
17840 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
17841 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
17842 a warning threshold that is\n\
17843 set by the system administrator.\n"
17844.endd
17845
17846.conf quota@_warn@_threshold string$**$ 0
17847.index quota||warning threshold
17848.index mailbox||size warning
17849.index size||of mailbox
17850This option is expanded in the same way as \quota\ (see above). If the
17851resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
17852size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
17853threshold, a warning message is sent. If \quota\ is also set, the threshold may
17854be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent sign.
17855For example:
17856.display asis
17857quota = 10M
17858quota_warn_threshold = 75%
17859.endd
17860If \quota\ is not set, a setting of \quota@_warn@_threshold\ that ends with a
17861percent sign is ignored.
17862
17863The warning message itself is specified by the \quota@_warn@_message\ option,
17864and it must start with a ::To:: header line containing the recipient(s). A
17865::Subject:: line should also normally be supplied. The \quota\ option does not
17866have to be set in order to use this option; they are independent of one
17867another except when the threshold is specified as a percentage.
17868
17869.conf use@_bsmtp boolean false
17870.index envelope sender
17871If this option is set true, \%appendfile%\ writes messages in `batch SMTP'
17872format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
17873you want to include a leading \\HELO\\ command with such messages, you can do
17874so by setting the \message@_prefix\ option. See section ~~SECTbatchSMTP for
17875details of batch SMTP.
17876
17877.conf use@_crlf boolean false
17878.index carriage return
17879.index linefeed
17880This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
17881(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
17882of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
17883of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
17884
17885The contents of the \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\ options are written
17886verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these are
17887needed. In cases where these options have non-empty defaults, the values end
4964e932 17888with a single linefeed, so they
495ae4b0
PH
17889must
17890be changed to end with \"@\r@\n"\ if \use@_crlf\ is set.
17891
17892.conf use@_fcntl@_lock boolean "see below"
17893This option controls the use of the \*fcntl()*\ function to lock a file for
17894exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
17895\use@_flock@_lock\ is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
17896that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and
17897\use@_flock@_lock\ are unset, \use@_lockfile\ must be set.
17898
17899.conf use@_flock@_lock boolean false
17900This option is provided to support the use of \*flock()*\ for file locking, for
17901the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
17902\*fcntl()*\ and \*lockf()*\ locking, and these two functions interwork with
17903each other. Exim uses \*fcntl()*\ locking by default.
17904
17905This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
17906\*flock()*\ is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
17907where \*flock()*\ does not correctly interwork with \*fcntl()*\. You can use
17908both \*fcntl()*\ and \*flock()*\ locking simultaneously if you want.
17909
17910.index Solaris||\*flock()*\ support
17911Not all operating systems provide \*flock()*\. Some versions of Solaris do not
17912have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
17913\*lockf()*\). If the OS does not have \*flock()*\, Exim will be built without
17914the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
17915error.
17916
17917\**Warning**\: \*flock()*\ locks do not work on NFS files (unless \*flock()*\
17918is just being mapped onto \*fcntl()*\ by the OS).
17919
17920.conf use@_lockfile boolean "see below"
17921If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
17922appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
17923\*fcntl()*\. You should only turn \use@_lockfile\ off if you are absolutely
17924sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
17925\*fcntl()*\ rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
17926delivering over NFS from more than one host.
17927
17928.index NFS||lock file
17929In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
17930necessary to take out a lock $it{before} opening the file, and the lock file
17931achieves this. Otherwise, even with \*fcntl()*\ locking, there is a risk of
17932file corruption.
17933
17934The \use@_lockfile\ option is set by default unless \use@_mbx@_lock\ is set. It
17935is not possible to turn both \use@_lockfile\ and \use@_fcntl@_lock\ off, except
17936when \mbx@_format\ is set.
17937
17938.conf use@_mbx@_lock boolean "see below"
17939This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with \\SUPPORT@_MBX\\
17940set in \(Local/Makefile)\. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
17941locking rules be used. It is set by default if \mbx@_format\ is set and none of
17942the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules are
17943the same as are used by the \*c-client*\ library that underlies Pine and the
17944IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The rules
17945allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking does not
17946work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
17947
17948You can set \use@_mbx@_lock\ with either (or both) of \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and
17949\use@_flock@_lock\ to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
17950MBX locking rules. The default is to use \*fcntl()*\ if \use@_mbx@_lock\ is set
17951without \use@_fcntl@_lock\ or \use@_flock@_lock\.
17952.endconf
17953
17954
17955.section Operational details for appending
17956.rset SECTopappend "~~chapter.~~section"
17957.index appending to a file
17958.index file||appending
17959Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
17960.numberpars $.
17961If the name of the file is \(/dev/null)\, no action is taken, and a success
17962return is given.
17963.nextp
17964.index directory creation
17965If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
17966\create@_directory\ option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
17967\directory@_mode\ option.
17968.nextp
17969If \file@_format\ is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
17970indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
17971transport.
17972.nextp
17973.index file||locking
17974.index locking files
17975.index NFS||lock file
17976If \use@_lockfile\ is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
17977reliably over NFS, as follows:
17978.numberpars $.
17979Create a `hitching post' file whose name is that of the lock file with the
17980current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
17981as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
17982.nextp
17983Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
17984.nextp
17985If the call to \*link()*\ succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
17986Unlink the hitching post name.
17987.nextp
17988Otherwise, use \*stat()*\ to get information about the hitching post file, and
17989then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
17990of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
17991restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the \*link()*\ call.
17992.nextp
17993If creation of the lock file failed, wait for \lock@_interval\ and try again,
17994up to \lock@_retries\ times. However, since any program that writes to a
17995mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
17996lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
17997existing lock file is older than \lockfile@_timeout\ Exim attempts to unlink it
17998before trying again.
17999.endp
18000.nextp
18001A call is made to \*lstat()*\ to discover whether the main file exists, and if
18002so, what its characteristics are. If \*lstat()*\ fails for any reason other
18003than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
18004.nextp
18005.index symbolic link||to mailbox
18006.index mailbox||symbolic link
18007If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
18008\allow@_symlink\ option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
18009checked, and then \*stat()*\ is called to find out about the real file, which
18010is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
18011ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
18012directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
18013idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
18014checked.
18015.nextp
18016If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
18017and group (if the group is being checked -- see \check@_group\ above) are
18018different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
18019delivery is deferred.
18020.nextp
18021If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
18022If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless \mode@_fail@_narrower\
18023is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
18024permissions.
18025.nextp
18026The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending. If
18027this fails because the file has vanished, \%appendfile%\ behaves as if it hadn't
18028existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
18029.nextp
18030If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
18031changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
18032have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
18033.nextp
18034If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the \file@_must@_exist\
18035option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
18036directory if the \create@_file\ option is set (deferring on failure), and then
18037open for writing as a new file, with the \\O@_EXCL\\ and \\O@_CREAT\\ options,
18038except when dealing with a symbolic link (the \allow@_symlink\ option must be
18039set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
18040the file is opened for writing using \\O@_CREAT\\ but not \\O@_EXCL\\, because
18041that prevents link following.
18042.nextp
18043.index loop||while file testing
18044If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
18045existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
18046being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
18047after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
18048.nextp
18049If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
18050.nextp
18051.index file||locking
18052.index locking files
18053Once the file is open, unless both \use@_fcntl@_lock\ and \use@_flock@_lock\
18054are false, it is locked using \*fcntl()*\ or \*flock()*\ or both. If
4964e932 18055\use@_mbx@_lock\ is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
495ae4b0
PH
18056However, if \use@_mbx@_lock\ is true,
18057Exim takes out a shared lock on the open file,
18058and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
18059.display
18060/tmp/.<<device-number>>.<<inode-number>>
18061.endd
18062using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
18063the MBX locking rules.
18064
18065If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
18066depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
18067\lock@_fcntl@_timeout\ or \lock@_flock@_timeout\, as appropriate.
18068
18069If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
18070\lock@_interval\, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
18071to lock it again. This happens up to \lock@_retries\ times, after which the
18072delivery is deferred.
18073
18074If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to \*fcntl()*\ or
18075\*flock()*\ are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
18076waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
18077immediately. It retries up to
18078.display
18079(lock@_retries * lock@_interval) / <<timeout>>
18080.endd
18081times (rounded up).
18082.endp
18083
18084At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the \*fcntl()*\
18085and/or \*flock()*\ locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
18086
18087.section Operational details for delivery to a new file
18088.rset SECTopdir "~~chapter.~~section"
18089.index delivery||to single file
18090.index `From' line
18091When the \directory\ option is set instead of \file\, each message is delivered
4964e932
PH
18092into a newly-created file or set of files. When \%appendfile%\ is activated
18093directly from a \%redirect%\ router, neither \file\ nor \directory\ is normally
18094set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the router. (See for example,
18095the \%address@_file%\ transport in the default configuration.) In this case,
18096delivery is to a new file if either the path name ends in \"/"\, or the
495ae4b0
PH
18097\maildir@_format\ or \mailstore@_format\ option is set.
18098
18099No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
18100locking options of the transport are ignored. The `From' line that by default
18101separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
18102of message lines that start with `From', and there is no need to ensure a
18103newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
18104\check@_string\, \message@_prefix\, and \message@_suffix\ are all unset when
18105any of \directory\, \maildir@_format\, or \mailstore@_format\ is set.
18106
4964e932
PH
18107If Exim is required to check a \quota\ setting, it adds up the sizes of all the
18108files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
18109different directory by setting \quota@_directory\. Also, for maildir deliveries
495ae4b0
PH
18110(see below) the \(maildirfolder)\ convention is honoured.
18111
18112
18113.index maildir format
18114.index mailstore format
18115There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
18116done, controlled by the settings of the \maildir@_format\ and
18117\mailstore@_format\ options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
18118formats is not included in the binary unless \\SUPPORT@_MAILDIR\\ or
18119\\SUPPORT@_MAILSTORE\\, respectively, is set in \(Local/Makefile)\.
18120
18121.index directory creation
18122In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
18123sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the \create@_directory\
18124option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
18125constrained by setting \create@_file\. A created directory's mode is given by
18126the \directory@_mode\ option. If creation fails, or if the \create@_directory\
18127option is not set when creation is required, delivery is deferred.
18128
18129
18130.section Maildir delivery
18131.rset SECTmaildirdelivery "~~chapter.~~section"
18132.index maildir format||description of
18133If the \maildir@_format\ option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
18134it to a file whose name is \(tmp/<<stime>>.H<<mtime>>P<<pid>>.<<host>>)\ in the
4964e932 18135given directory. If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
495ae4b0
PH
18136\(new)\ subdirectory.
18137
18138In the file name, <<stime>> is the current time of day in seconds, and
18139<<mtime>> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
18140Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
18141before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
18142file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls \*stat()*\ for the file before
18143opening it. If any response other than \\ENOENT\\ (does not exist) is given,
18144Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to \maildir@_retries\ times.
18145
18146.index quota||in maildir delivery
18147.index maildir++
18148If Exim is required to check a \quota\ setting before a maildir delivery, and
18149\quota@_directory\ is not set, it looks for a file called \(maildirfolder)\ in
18150the maildir directory (alongside \(new)\, \(cur)\, \(tmp)\). If this exists,
18151Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
18152down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
18153the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
18154amount of space used.
18155
d43194df
PH
18156.em
18157One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
18158computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
18159checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
18160needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
18161use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
18162of the \mailbox@_size\ option as a way of importing it into Exim.
18163.nem
18164
495ae4b0
PH
18165
18166.section Using tags to record message sizes
4964e932 18167If \maildir@_tag\ is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
495ae4b0
PH
18168When the maildir file is renamed into the \(new)\ sub-directory, the
18169tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
18170name to the point where the test \*stat()*\ call fails with \\ENAMETOOLONG\\,
4964e932 18171the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
495ae4b0
PH
18172
18173Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
4964e932 18174\quota@_size@_regex\ above for an example. The expansion of \maildir@_tag\
495ae4b0
PH
18175happens after the message has been written. The value of the \$message@_size$\
18176variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
18177forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
18178be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except `/'.
18179Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
18180empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
18181colon is inserted.
18182
18183
495ae4b0
PH
18184.section Using a maildirsize file
18185.index quota||in maildir delivery
18186.index maildir format||\(maildirsize)\ file
18187If \maildir@_use@_size@_file\ is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
18188storing quota and message size information in a file called \(maildirsize)\
18189within the maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim creates it,
18190setting the quota from the \quota\ option of the transport. If the maildir
18191directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt to write a
18192\(maildirsize)\ file.
18193
18194The \(maildirsize)\ file is used to hold information about the sizes of
18195messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
18196in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
18197value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
18198is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
18199need to know the quota.
18200
18201If the \quota\ option in the transport is unset or zero, the \(maildirsize)\
18202file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
18203
18204A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
4964e932 18205maildir participate in quota calculations. See the description of the
495ae4b0 18206\maildir@_quota@_directory@_regex\ option above for details.
495ae4b0
PH
18207
18208
18209.section Mailstore delivery
18210.index mailstore format||description of
18211If the \mailstore@_format\ option is true, each message is written as two files
18212in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the message id
18213and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use this base
18214name plus the suffixes \(.env)\ and \(.msg)\. The \(.env)\ file contains the
18215message's envelope, and the \(.msg)\ file contains the message itself.
18216
18217During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
18218\(.tmp)\. The \(.msg)\ file is then written, and when it is complete, the
18219\(.tmp)\ file is renamed as the \(.env)\ file. Programs that access messages in
18220mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a \(.msg)\ and a \(.env)\
18221file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
18222the absence of a \(.tmp)\ file.
18223
18224The envelope file starts with any text defined by the \mailstore@_prefix\
18225option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
18226the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
18227There can be more than one recipient only if the \batch@_max\ option is set
18228greater than one. Finally, \mailstore@_suffix\ is expanded and the result
18229appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
18230
18231If expansion of \mailstore@_prefix\ or \mailstore@_suffix\ ends with a forced
18232failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
18233configuration errors, and delivery is deferred.
18234
18235
18236.section Non-special new file delivery
18237If neither \maildir@_format\ nor \mailstore@_format\ is set, a single new file
18238is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
18239messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
18240section ~~SECTbatchSMTP), a setting such as
18241.display asis
18242directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
18243.endd
18244might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
18245then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
18246expanding the contents of the \directory@_file\ option.
18247
18248
18249
18250
18251
18252.
18253.
18254.
18255.
18256. ============================================================================
18257.chapter The autoreply transport
18258.set runningfoot "autoreply transport"
18259.index transports||\%autoreply%\
18260.index \%autoreply%\ transport
18261The \%autoreply%\ transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
d43194df
PH
18262the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message.
18263.em
18264If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
18265\unseen\ option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
18266delivered anywhere. However, when the \unseen\ option is set on the router that
18267passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
18268another router can set up a normal message delivery.
18269.nem
18270
18271The \%autoreply%\ transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
18272`vacation' message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
18273directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
18274message cascades, messages created by the \%autoreply%\ transport always have
18275empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
495ae4b0
PH
18276
18277The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
18278by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
18279passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
4964e932 18280transport is run as a consequence of a
495ae4b0
PH
18281\mail\
18282or \vacation\ command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
18283supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
18284that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
18285case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
18286is never built from a mixture of options. However, the \file@_optional\,
18287\mode\, and \return@_message\ options apply in all cases.
18288
18289\%Autoreply%\ is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
18290command in a user's filter file, \%autoreply%\ normally runs under the uid and
18291gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
18292~~CHAPenvironment).
18293
18294There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a \%pipe%\ transport
18295that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
18296\%autoreply%\ transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
18297address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
18298separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
18299the sender in a single message, whereas if \%autoreply%\ is used, a separate
18300message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
18301
18302Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
18303message that \%autoreply%\ creates, with the exception of newlines that are
4964e932 18304immediately followed by whitespace. If any non-printing characters are found,
495ae4b0
PH
18305the transport defers.
18306Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
18307controlled by the \print@_topbitchars\ global option.
18308
18309If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
18310\headers@_add\) are set on an \%autoreply%\ transport, they apply to the copy of
18311the original message that is included in the generated message when
18312\return@_message\ is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
18313
18314If the \%autoreply%\ transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
18315the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
18316as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to \$sender@_address$\ when this
18317is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
18318problems. They are just discarded.
18319
18320
18321.section Private options for autoreply
18322
d43194df 18323.startconf autoreply
495ae4b0
PH
18324.index options||\%autoreply%\ transport
18325.conf bcc string$**$ unset
18326This specifies the addresses that are to receive `blind carbon copies' of the
18327message when the message is specified by the transport.
18328
18329.conf cc string$**$ unset
18330This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the ::Cc:: header
18331when the message is specified by the transport.
18332
18333.conf file string$**$ unset
18334The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
18335is specified by the transport. If both \file\ and \text\ are set, the text
18336string comes first.
18337
18338.conf file@_expand boolean false
18339If this is set, the contents of the file named by the \file\ option are
18340subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
18341
18342.conf file@_optional boolean false
18343If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the \file\
18344option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
18345
18346.conf from string$**$ unset
18347This specifies the contents of the ::From:: header when the message is specified
18348by the transport.
18349
18350.conf headers string$**$ unset
18351This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message when
18352the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using `@\n'
18353to separate them. There is no check on the format.
18354
18355.conf log string$**$ unset
18356This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
18357the message is specified by the transport.
18358
18359.conf mode "octal integer" 0600
18360If either the log file or the `once' file has to be created, this mode is used.
18361
d43194df
PH
18362.em
18363.conf never@_mail "address list$**$" unset
18364If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
18365item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
18366discarded, no message is created.
18367.nem
18368
495ae4b0 18369.conf once string$**$ unset
4964e932 18370This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each
495ae4b0
PH
18371::To:: recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport.
18372\**Note**\: This does not apply to ::Cc:: or ::Bcc:: recipients.
18373If \once@_file@_size\ is not set, a DBM database is used, and it is allowed to
18374grow as large as necessary. If a potential recipient is already in the
18375database, no message is sent by default. However, if \once@_repeat\ specifies a
18376time greater than zero, the message is sent if that much time has elapsed since
18377a message was last sent to this recipient. If \once\ is unset, the message is
18378always sent.
18379
18380If \once@_file@_size\ is set greater than zero, it changes the way Exim
18381implements the \once\ option. Instead of using a DBM file to record every
18382recipient it sends to, it uses a regular file, whose size will never get larger
18383than the given value. In the file, it keeps a linear list of recipient
18384addresses and times at which they were sent messages. If the file is full when
18385a new address needs to be added, the oldest address is dropped. If
18386\once@_repeat\ is not set, this means that a given recipient may receive
18387multiple messages, but at unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of
18388turnover of addresses in the file. If \once@_repeat\ is set, it specifies a
18389maximum time between repeats.
18390
18391.conf once@_file@_size integer 0
18392See \once\ above.
18393
18394.conf once@_repeat time$**$ 0s
18395See \once\ above.
18396After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
18397
18398.conf reply@_to string$**$ unset
18399This specifies the contents of the ::Reply-To:: header when the message is
18400specified by the transport.
18401
18402.conf return@_message boolean false
18403If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
18404message, subject to the maximum size set in the \return@_size@_limit\ global
18405configuration option.
18406
18407.conf subject string$**$ unset
18408This specifies the contents of the ::Subject:: header when the message is
18409specified by the transport.
d43194df
PH
18410.em
18411It is tempting to quote the original subject in automatic responses. For
18412example:
18413.display asis
18414subject = Re: $h_subject:
18415.endd
18416There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
18417subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
18418bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
18419non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
18420small.
18421.nem
495ae4b0
PH
18422
18423.conf text string$**$ unset
18424This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
18425message is specified by the transport. If both \text\ and \file\ are set, the
18426text comes first.
18427
18428.conf to string$**$ unset
18429This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the ::To:: header
18430when the message is specified by the transport.
18431
18432.endconf
18433
18434
18435
18436.
18437.
18438.
18439.
18440. ============================================================================
18441.chapter The lmtp transport
18442.set runningfoot "lmtp transport"
18443.index transports||\%lmtp%\
18444.index \%lmtp%\ transport
18445.index LMTP||over a pipe
18446.index LMTP||over a socket
18447.rset CHAPLMTP "~~chapter"
18448The \%lmtp%\ transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
18449specified command
18450or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
18451This transport is something of a cross between the \%pipe%\ and \%smtp%\
18452transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
18453implemented as an option for the \%smtp%\ transport. Because LMTP is expected
18454to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in \(src/EDITME)\
18455has it commented out. You need to ensure that
18456.display asis
18457TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
18458.endd
18459is present in your \(Local/Makefile)\ in order to have the \%lmtp%\ transport
18460included in the Exim binary.
18461
18462The private options of the \%lmtp%\ transport are as follows:
18463
d43194df 18464.startconf lmtp
495ae4b0
PH
18465.index options||\%lmtp%\ transport
18466
18467.conf batch@_id string$**$ unset
18468See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18469
18470.conf batch@_max integer 1
18471This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
18472Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
18473good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
18474batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18475
18476.conf command string$**$ unset
18477This option must be set if \socket\ is not set.
18478The string is a command which is run in a separate process. It is split up into
18479a command name and list of arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so
18480expansion cannot change the number of arguments). The command is run directly,
18481not via a shell. The message is passed to the new process using the standard
18482input and output to operate the LMTP protocol.
18483
18484.conf socket string$**$ unset
4964e932
PH
18485This option must be set if \command\ is not set. The result of expansion must
18486be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
495ae4b0
PH
18487delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
18488
18489.conf timeout time 5m
4964e932 18490The transport is aborted if the created process
495ae4b0
PH
18491or Unix domain socket
18492does not respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout.
18493
18494.endconf
18495
18496Here is an example of a typical LMTP transport:
18497.display asis
18498lmtp:
18499 driver = lmtp
18500 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
18501 batch_max = 20
18502 user = exim
18503.endd
18504This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
18505necessary, running as the user \*exim*\.
18506
18507
18508
18509.
18510.
18511.
18512.
18513. ============================================================================
18514.chapter The pipe transport
18515.rset CHAPpipetransport "~~chapter"
18516.set runningfoot "pipe transport"
18517.index transports||\%pipe%\
18518.index \%pipe%\ transport
18519The \%pipe%\ transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
d43194df
PH
18520running in another process.
18521.em
18522One example is the
18523use of \%pipe%\ as a pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other
18524delivery mechanism (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to
18525automatically process their incoming messages. The \%pipe%\ transport can be
18526used in one of the following ways:
18527.nem
495ae4b0 18528.numberpars $.
d43194df 18529A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the transport
495ae4b0 18530is configured as a \%pipe%\ transport. In this case, \$local@_part$\ contains
d43194df
PH
18531the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run is
18532specified by the \command\ option on the transport.
18533.nextp
18534.em
18535If the \batch@_max\ option is set greater than 1 (the default), the transport
18536can be called upon to handle more than one address in a single run. In this
18537case, \$local@_part$\ is not set (because it is not unique). However, the
18538pseudo-variable \$pipe@_addresses$\ (described in section ~~SECThowcommandrun
18539below) contains all the addresses that are being handled.
18540.nem
495ae4b0
PH
18541.nextp
18542A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
18543alias or forward file). In this case, \$local@_part$\ contains the local part
18544that was redirected, and \$address@_pipe$\ contains the text of the pipe
18545command itself. The \command\ option on the transport is ignored.
18546.endp
18547
4964e932
PH
18548The \%pipe%\ transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
18549deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
495ae4b0
PH
18550implemented by the \%lmtp%\ transport.
18551
18552In the case when \%pipe%\ is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
18553\(.forward)\ file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
18554other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
18555transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and `home'
18556directories are also controllable. See chapter ~~CHAPenvironment for details of
18557the local delivery environment.
18558
d43194df
PH
18559
18560.em
18561.section Concurrent delivery
18562If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
18563delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
18564any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
18565write to a file, the \exim@_lock\ utility might be of use.
18566.nem
18567
18568
495ae4b0
PH
18569.section Returned status and data
18570.index \%pipe%\ transport||returned data
18571If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
18572have failed, unless either the \ignore@_status\ option is set (in which case
18573the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
18574in the \temp@_errors\ option, which are interpreted as meaning `try again
18575later'. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
18576logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
18577`local delivery failed'.
18578
18579If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
18580script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
18581value is the return code minus 128.
18582
4964e932
PH
18583If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if \*execve()*\ fails), the
18584return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
18585asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
495ae4b0
PH
18586a non-existent command may be the problem.
18587
18588The \return@_output\ option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
18589set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
18590error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
18591return code or if \ignore@_status\ is set. The output from the command is
18592included as part of the bounce message. The \return@_fail@_output\ option is
18593similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
18594failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
18595\temp@_errors\.
18596
18597
18598.section How the command is run
18599.rset SECThowcommandrun "~~chapter.~~section"
18600.index \%pipe%\ transport||path for command
18601The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
18602by the \%pipe%\ transport itself. The \allow@_commands\ and \restrict@_to@_path\
18603options can be used to restrict the commands that may be run.
18604.index quoting||in pipe command
18605Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
18606double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
18607way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
18608
18609String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
18610traditional \(.forward)\ file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
18611expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
18612For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
18613quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
18614.display asis
18615command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xxx}{yyy}}
18616.endd
18617will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
18618arguments. You have to write
18619.display asis
18620command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xxx}{yyy}}"
18621.endd
18622to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
18623argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
18624result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
18625interact with external quoting.
18626
18627.index transport||filter
18628.index filter||transport filter
18629Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
18630`$tt{@$pipe@_addresses}'. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
18631place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
18632transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
18633inserted in the argument list at that point $it{as a separate argument}. This
18634avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
18635\%pipe%\ transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
18636
18637After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
18638in a subprocess directly from the transport, $it{not} under a shell. The
18639message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
18640standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
18641read by Exim. The \max@_output\ option controls how much output the command may
18642produce, and the \return@_output\ and \return@_fail@_output\ options control
18643what is done with it.
18644
18645Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
18646in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
18647taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
18648explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
18649where existing commands (for example, in \(.forward)\ files) expect to be run
18650under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
18651an option called \use@_shell\, which changes the way the \%pipe%\ transport
18652works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
18653as a single string and passes the result to \(/bin/sh)\. The
18654\restrict@_to@_path\ option and the \$pipe@_addresses$\ facility cannot be used
18655with \use@_shell\, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
18656
18657
18658.section Environment variables
18659.rset SECTpipeenv "~~chapter.~~section"
18660.index \%pipe%\ transport||environment for command
18661.index environment for pipe transport
18662The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
18663This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
18664the \environment\ option can be used to add additional variables to this
18665environment.
18666.display flow
18667.tabs 20
18668DOMAIN $t $rm{the domain of the address}
18669HOME $t $rm{the home directory, if set}
18670HOST $t $rm{the host name when called from a router (see below)}
18671LOCAL@_PART $t $rm{see below}
18672LOCAL@_PART@_PREFIX $t $rm{see below}
18673LOCAL@_PART@_SUFFIX $t $rm{see below}
18674LOGNAME $t $rm{see below}
18675MESSAGE@_ID $t $rm{the message's id}
18676PATH $t $rm{as specified by the \path\ option below}
18677QUALIFY@_DOMAIN $t $rm{the sender qualification domain}
18678RECIPIENT $t $rm{the complete recipient address}
18679SENDER $t $rm{the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)}
18680SHELL $t `$tt{/bin/sh}'
18681TZ $t $rm{the value of the \timezone\ option, if set}
18682USER $t $rm{see below}
18683.endd
18684
18685When a \%pipe%\ transport is called directly from (for example) an \%accept%\
18686router, \\LOCAL@_PART\\ is set to the local part of the address. When it is
18687called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, \\LOCAL@_PART\\ is set to
18688the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
18689removed from the local part, and made available in \\LOCAL@_PART@_PREFIX\\ and
18690\\LOCAL@_PART@_SUFFIX\\, respectively. \\LOGNAME\\ and \\USER\\ are set to the
18691same value as \\LOCAL@_PART\\ for compatibility with other MTAs.
18692
18693.index \\HOST\\
18694\\HOST\\ is set only when a \%pipe%\ transport is called from a router that
18695associates hosts with an address, typically when using \%pipe%\ as a
18696pseudo-remote transport. \\HOST\\ is set to the first host name specified by
18697the router.
18698
18699.index \\HOME\\
18700If the transport's generic \home@_directory\ option is set, its value is used
18701for the \\HOME\\ environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
18702by the router's \transport@_home@_directory\ option, which defaults to the
18703user's home directory if \check@_local@_user\ is set.
18704
18705.section Private options for pipe
18706.index options||\%pipe%\ transport
d43194df
PH
18707
18708.startconf pipe
495ae4b0
PH
18709
18710.conf allow@_commands "string list$**$" unset
18711.index \%pipe%\ transport||permitted commands
18712The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
18713permitted commands. If \restrict@_to@_path\ is not set, the only commands
18714permitted are those in the \allow@_commands\ list. They need not be absolute
18715paths; the \path\ option is still used for relative paths. If
18716\restrict@_to@_path\ is set with \allow@_commands\, the command must either be
18717in the \allow@_commands\ list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
18718the path. In other words, if neither \allow@_commands\ nor \restrict@_to@_path\
18719is set, there is no restriction on the command, but otherwise only commands
18720that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For example, if
18721.display asis
18722allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
18723.endd
18724and \restrict@_to@_path\ is not set, the only permitted command is
18725\(/usr/bin/vacation)\. The \allow@_commands\ option may not be set if
18726\use@_shell\ is set.
18727
18728.conf batch@_id string$**$ unset
18729See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18730
18731.conf batch@_max integer 1
18732This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
18733See the description of local delivery batching in chapter ~~CHAPbatching.
18734
18735.conf check@_string string unset
18736As \%pipe%\ writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
18737\check@_string\, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
18738by the contents of \escape@_string\, provided both are set. The value of
18739\check@_string\ is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
18740any letters it contains is significant. When \use@_bsmtp\ is set, the contents
18741of \check@_string\ and \escape@_string\ are forced to values that implement the
18742SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
18743ignored.
18744
18745.conf command string$**$ unset
18746This option need not be set when \%pipe%\ is being used to deliver to pipes
18747obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
18748set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
18749the \path\ option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
18750Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
18751~~SECThowcommandrun above.
18752
18753.conf environment string$**$ unset
18754.index \%pipe%\ transport||environment for command
18755.index environment for \%pipe%\ transport
18756This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
18757command runs (see section ~~SECTpipeenv for the default list). Its value is a
18758string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
18759environment settings of the form `<<name>>=<<value>>'.
18760
18761.conf escape@_string string unset
18762See \check@_string\ above.
18763
18764.conf freeze@_exec@_fail boolean false
18765.index exec failure
18766.index failure of exec
18767.index \%pipe%\ transport||failure of exec
18768Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
18769any other failure while running the command. However, if \freeze@_exec@_fail\
18770is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
18771frozen, whatever the setting of \ignore@_status\.
18772
18773.conf ignore@_status boolean false
18774If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
18775run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
4964e932 18776Otherwise, a non-zero status
495ae4b0
PH
18777or termination by signal
18778causes an error return from the transport unless the status value is one of
18779those listed in \temp@_errors\; these cause the delivery to be deferred and
18780tried again later.
18781
18782.conf log@_defer@_output boolean false
18783.index \%pipe%\ transport||logging output
18784If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
18785one of the codes listed in \temp@_errors\ (that is, delivery was deferred),
18786and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
18787
18788.conf log@_fail@_output boolean false
18789If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
18790return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
18791\temp@_errors\ (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
18792written to the main log.
18793
18794.conf log@_output boolean false
18795If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
18796output is written to the main log, whatever the return code.
18797
18798.conf max@_output integer 20K
18799This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
18800standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
18801process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
18802catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
18803the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
18804\return@_output\). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
18805exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
18806
18807.conf message@_prefix string$**$ "see below"
18808The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
18809The default is unset if \use@_bsmtp\ is set. Otherwise it is
18810.display asis
18811message_prefix = \
18812 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
18813 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
18814.endd
18815.index Cyrus
18816.index \tmail\
18817.index `From' line
18818This is required by the commonly used \(/usr/bin/vacation)\ program.
18819However, it must $it{not} be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
18820or to the \tmail\ local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by setting
18821.display asis
18822message_prefix =
18823.endd
18824
18825.conf message@_suffix string$**$ "see below"
18826The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
18827The default is unset if \use@_bsmtp\ is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
18828The suffix can be suppressed by setting
18829.display asis
18830message_suffix =
18831.endd
18832
18833.conf path string $tt{/usr/bin}
18834This option specifies the string that is set up in the \\PATH\\ environment
18835variable of the subprocess. If the \command\ option does not yield an absolute
18836path name, the command is sought in the \\PATH\\ directories, in the usual way.
4964e932 18837\**Warning**\: This does not apply to a command specified as a transport
495ae4b0
PH
18838filter.
18839
18840.conf pipe@_as@_creator boolean false
18841.index uid (user id)||local delivery
18842If the generic \user\ option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
18843process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
18844to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
18845\group\ option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
18846accept the message is used.
18847
18848.conf restrict@_to@_path boolean false
18849When this option is set, any command name not listed in \allow@_commands\ must
18850contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
18851in the \path\ option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
18852command has been generated from a user's \(.forward)\ file. This is usually
18853handled by a \%pipe%\ transport called \address@_pipe\.
18854
18855.conf return@_fail@_output boolean false
18856If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
18857return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in \temp@_errors\ (that
18858is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
18859However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
18860message), output from the command is discarded.
18861
18862.conf return@_output boolean false
18863If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
18864deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
18865is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
18866However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
18867output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
18868option.
18869
18870.conf temp@_errors "string list" "see below"
18871.index \%pipe%\ transport||temporary failure
18872This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
4964e932 18873asterisk. If \ignore@_status\ is false
495ae4b0 18874and \return@_output\ is not set,
495ae4b0
PH
18875and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
18876temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
18877numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
18878codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
18879defined by \\EX@_TEMPFAIL\\ and \\EX@_CANTCREAT\\ in \(sysexits.h)\. If Exim is
18880compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
18881and 73, respectively.
18882
18883.conf timeout time 1h
18884If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
18885causes the delivery to fail. A zero time interval specifies no timeout. In
18886order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the command are also killed,
18887Exim makes the initial process a process group leader, and kills the whole
18888process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated if one of the
18889processes starts a new process group.
18890
18891.conf umask "octal integer" 022
18892This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
18893
18894.conf use@_bsmtp boolean false
18895.index envelope sender
18896If this option is set true, the \%pipe%\ transport writes messages in `batch
18897SMTP' format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
18898commands. If you want to include a leading \\HELO\\ command with such messages,
18899you can do so by setting the \message@_prefix\ option. See section
18900~~SECTbatchSMTP for details of batch SMTP.
18901
18902.conf use@_crlf boolean false
18903.index carriage return
18904.index linefeed
18905This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
18906(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
18907of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
18908of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
18909
18910The contents of the \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\ options are written
18911verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these are
18912needed. Since the default values for both \message@_prefix\ and
18913\message@_suffix\ end with a single linefeed, their values
18914must
18915be changed to end with \"@\r@\n"\ if \use@_crlf\ is set.
18916
18917.conf use@_shell boolean false
18918If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to \(/bin/sh)\
18919instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
18920~~SECThowcommandrun. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
18921where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
18922modified. The \allow@_commands\ and \restrict@_to@_path\ options, and the
18923`$tt{@$pipe@_addresses}' facility are incompatible with \use@_shell\. The
18924command is expanded as a single string, and handed to \(/bin/sh)\ as data for
18925its \-c-\ option.
18926
18927.endconf
18928
18929.section Using an external local delivery agent
18930.index local delivery||using an external agent
18931.index \*procmail*\
18932.index external local delivery
18933.index delivery||\*procmail*\
18934.index delivery||by external agent
18935The \%pipe%\ transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
18936delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as \procmail\. When doing
18937this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
18938uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
18939by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
18940necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
18941appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
18942configuration for \procmail\:
18943.display asis
18944# transport
18945procmail_pipe:
18946 driver = pipe
18947 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
18948 return_path_add
18949 delivery_date_add
18950 envelope_to_add
18951 check_string = "From "
18952 escape_string = ">From "
18953 user = $local_part
18954 group = mail
18955.endd
18956.display asis
18957# router
18958procmail:
18959 driver = accept
18960 check_local_user
18961 transport = procmail_pipe
18962.endd
18963
18964In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
18965\*mail*\. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as \*mail*\
18966or \*exim*\, but in this case you must arrange for \procmail\ to trust that
18967user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a \group\
18968or a \user\ option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The home
18969directory is the user's home directory by default.
18970
18971Note that the command that the pipe transport runs does $it{not} begin with
18972.display asis
18973IFS=" "
18974.endd
18975as shown in the \procmail\ documentation, because Exim does not by default use
18976a shell to run pipe commands.
18977
18978.index Cyrus
18979The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
18980deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
18981.display asis
18982# transport
18983local_delivery_cyrus:
18984 driver = pipe
18985 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
18986 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
18987 user = cyrus
18988 group = mail
18989 return_output
18990 log_output
18991 message_prefix =
18992 message_suffix =
18993.endd
18994.display asis
18995# router
18996local_user_cyrus:
18997 driver = accept
18998 check_local_user
18999 local_part_suffix = .*
19000 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
19001.endd
19002Note the unsetting of \message@_prefix\ and \message@_suffix\, and the use of
19003\return@_output\ to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
19004sender.
19005
19006
19007.
19008.
19009.
19010.
19011. ============================================================================
19012.chapter The smtp transport
19013.rset CHAPsmtptrans "~~chapter"
19014.set runningfoot "smtp transport"
19015.index transports||\%smtp%\
19016.index \%smtp%\ transport
19017The \%smtp%\ transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
19018or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
19019that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
19020explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
19021~~CHAPretry) is applied to each IP address independently.
19022
19023.section Multiple messages on a single connection
19024The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
19025two ways:
19026.numberpars $.
19027If a message contains more than \max@_rcpt\ (see below) addresses that are
19028routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
19029that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
19030the \%smtp%\ transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually does
19031when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the value
19032of the global \remote@_max@_parallel\ option. Details are given in section
19033~~SECToutSMTPTCP.)
19034.nextp
19035.index hints database||remembering routing
19036When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
19037looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
19038connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
19039for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
19040process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
19041process.
19042.endp
19043
19044For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
19045incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of \connection@_max@_messages\,
19046no further messages are sent over that connection.
19047
19048
19049.section Use of the @$host variable
19050.index \$host$\
19051.index \$host@_address$\
19052At the start of a run of the \%smtp%\ transport, the values of \$host$\ and
19053\$host@_address$\ are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
19054passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
19055specific host, and while it is connected to that host, \$host$\ and
19056\$host@_address$\ are set to the values for that host. These are the values
19057that are in force when the \helo@_data\, \hosts@_try@_auth\, \interface\,
19058\serialize@_hosts\, and the various TLS options are expanded.
19059
19060
19061.section Private options for smtp
19062The private options of the \%smtp%\ transport are as follows:
19063
19064.index options||\%smtp%\ transport
d43194df 19065.startconf smtp
495ae4b0
PH
19066.conf allow@_localhost boolean false
19067.index local host||sending to
19068.index fallback||hosts specified on transport
19069When a host specified in \hosts\ or \fallback@_hosts\ (see below) turns out to
19070be the local host, or is listed in \hosts@_treat@_as@_local\, delivery is
19071deferred by default. However, if \allow@_localhost\ is set, Exim goes on to do
19072the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
19073configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
19074configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
19075
19076.conf authenticated@_sender string$**$ unset
19077.index Cyrus
19078When Exim has authenticated as a client, this option sets a value for the
19079\\AUTH=\\ item on outgoing \\MAIL\\ commands, overriding any existing
19080authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is forced to fail, the
19081option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery to be deferred. If
19082the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also ignored.
19083
19084If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
19085\authenticated@_sender\ still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
19086deferred if it fails), but no \\AUTH=\\ item is added to \\MAIL\\ commands.
19087
19088This option allows you to use the \%smtp%\ transport in LMTP mode to
19089deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
19090`authenticated sender', via a setting such as:
19091.display asis
19092authenticated_sender = $local_part
19093.endd
19094This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
19095allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
19096
19097Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
19098domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
19099value.
19100
19101.conf command@_timeout time 5m
19102This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
19103sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
19104remote host. Its value must not be zero.
19105
19106.conf connect@_timeout time 5m
19107This sets a timeout for the \*connect()*\ function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
19108to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
19109several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
19110less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
19111systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
19112option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
19113
19114.index SMTP||passed connection
19115.index SMTP||multiple deliveries
19116.index multiple SMTP deliveries
19117.conf connection@_max@_messages integer 500
19118This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
19119over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
19120For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the \-oB-\ command line
19121option.
19122
19123.conf data@_timeout time 5m
19124This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
19125the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
19126of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also \final@_timeout\.
19127
19128.conf delay@_after@_cutoff boolean true
19129This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
19130domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
19131cutoff times.
19132
19133In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
19134them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
19135Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
19136retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
19137a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
19138unhappy at this prospect, so...
19139
19140If \delay@_after@_cutoff\ is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
19141addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
19142IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
19143none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
19144delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
19145addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
19146continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
19147\delay@_after@_cutoff\ means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
19148to them.
19149
19150.conf dns@_qualify@_single boolean true
19151If the \hosts\ or \fallback@_hosts\ option is being used,
19152and the \gethostbyname\ option is false,
19153the \\RES@_DEFNAMES\\ resolver option is set. See the \qualify@_single\ option
19154in chapter ~~CHAPdnslookup for more details.
19155
19156.conf dns@_search@_parents boolean false
19157.index \search@_parents\
19158If the \hosts\ or \fallback@_hosts\ option is being used, and the
19159\gethostbyname\ option is false, the \\RES@_DNSRCH\\ resolver option is set.
19160See the \search@_parents\ option in chapter ~~CHAPdnslookup for more details.
19161
19162
19163.conf fallback@_hosts "string list" unset
19164.index fallback||hosts specified on transport
19165String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19166colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. Fallback hosts can also be
19167specified on routers, which associate them with the addresses they process. As
19168for the \hosts\ option without \hosts@_override\, \fallback@_hosts\ specified
19169on the transport is used only if the address does not have its own associated
19170fallback host list. Unlike \hosts\, a setting of \fallback@_hosts\ on an
19171address is not overridden by \hosts@_override\. However, \hosts@_randomize\
19172does apply to fallback host lists.
19173
19174If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
19175the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
19176transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
19177address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
19178list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
19179
19180Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
19181re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
19182addresses have the same fallback hosts (and \max@_rcpt\ permits it), a single
19183copy of the message is sent.
19184
19185The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
19186\gethostbyname\ option, as for the \hosts\ option. Fallback hosts apply
19187both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
19188from \hosts\. This option provides a `use a smart host only if delivery fails'
19189facility.
19190
19191.conf final@_timeout time 10m
19192This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
19193line containing just `.' that terminates a message. Its value must not be zero.
19194
19195.conf gethostbyname boolean false
19196If this option is true when the \hosts\ and/or \fallback@_hosts\ options are
4964e932 19197being used, names are looked up using \*gethostbyname()*\
495ae4b0
PH
19198(or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available)
19199instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
19200it may also consult other sources of information such as \(/etc/hosts)\.
19201
19202.index \\HELO\\||argument, setting
19203.index \\EHLO\\||argument, setting
19204.conf helo@_data string$**$ $tt{@$primary@_hostname}
19205The value of this option is expanded, and used as the argument for the \\EHLO\\
19206or \\HELO\\ command that starts the outgoing SMTP session.
19207
19208.conf hosts "string list$**$" unset
19209Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as \%dnslookup%\, which
19210finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS. However, addresses
19211can be passed to the \%smtp%\ transport by any router, and not all of them can
19212provide an associated host list. The \hosts\ option specifies a list of hosts
19213which are used if the address being processed does not have any hosts
19214associated with it. The hosts specified by \hosts\ are also used, whether or
19215not the address has its own hosts, if \hosts@_override\ is set.
19216
19217The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
19218list of host names or IP addresses. If the expansion fails, delivery is
19219deferred. Unless the failure was caused by the inability to complete a lookup,
19220the error is logged to the panic log as well as the main log. Host names are
19221looked up either by searching directly for address records in the DNS or by
19222calling \*gethostbyname()*\
19223(or \*getipnodebyname()*\ when available),
19224depending on the setting of the \gethostbyname\ option. When Exim is compiled
19225with IPv6 support, if a host that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and
19226IPv6 addresses, both types of address are used.
19227
19228During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
19229unless \hosts@_randomize\ is set.
19230
19231.conf hosts@_avoid@_esmtp "host list$**$" unset
19232.index ESMTP, avoiding use of
19233.index \\HELO\\||forcing use of
19234.index \\EHLO\\||avoiding use of
19235.index \\PIPELINING\\||avoiding the use of
19236This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
19237example, \\PIPELINING\\) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
19238matches \hosts@_avoid@_esmtp\, Exim sends \\HELO\\ rather than \\EHLO\\ at the
19239start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
19240facilities such as \\AUTH\\, \\PIPELINING\\, \\SIZE\\, and \\STARTTLS\\.
19241
19242.conf hosts@_avoid@_tls "host list$**$" unset
19243.index TLS||avoiding for certain hosts
19244Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
19245matches this list. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19246
19247.conf hosts@_max@_try integer 5
19248.index host||maximum number to try
19249.index limit||number of hosts tried
19250.index limit||number of MX tried
19251.index MX record||maximum tried
19252This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
d43194df
PH
19253delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
19254~~SECTvalhosmax describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
19255
19256.em
19257.conf hosts@_max@_try@_hardlimit integer 50
19258This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
19259tries for any one delivery. Section ~~SECTvalhosmax describes its use and why
19260it exists.
19261.nem
495ae4b0
PH
19262
19263.conf hosts@_nopass@_tls "host list$**$" unset
19264.index TLS||passing connection
19265.index multiple SMTP deliveries
19266.index TLS||multiple message deliveries
19267For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
19268been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
19269message on the same connection. See section ~~SECTmulmessam for an explanation
19270of when this might be needed.
19271
19272.conf hosts@_override boolean false
19273If this option is set and the \hosts\ option is also set, any hosts that are
19274attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
19275\hosts\ option are always used. This option does not apply to
19276\fallback@_hosts\.
19277
19278.conf hosts@_randomize boolean false
19279.index randomized host list
19280.index host||list of, randomized
19281.index fallback||randomized hosts
19282If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
19283\hosts\ or the \fallback@_hosts\ option, or the hosts supplied by the router
19284were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
19285router), and were not randomizied by the router, the order of trying the hosts
19286is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
19287list can be used to do crude load sharing.
19288
19289When \hosts@_randomize\ is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
19290order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
19291behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
19292\"+"\ in the host list. For example:
19293.display asis
19294hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19295.endd
19296The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19297randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19298If \hosts@_randomize\ is not set, a \"+"\ item in the list is ignored.
19299
19300.index authentication||required by client
19301.conf hosts@_require@_auth "host list$**$" unset
19302This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
19303before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
19304servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
19305authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
19306temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
19307hard failure if required. See also \hosts@_try@_auth\, and chapter
19308~~CHAPSMTPAUTH for details of authentication.
19309
19310.conf hosts@_require@_tls "host list$**$" unset
19311.index TLS||requiring for certain servers
19312Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
19313matches this list. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
4964e932 19314\**Note**\: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
495ae4b0
PH
19315incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
19316
19317.index authentication||optional in client
19318.conf hosts@_try@_auth "host list$**$" unset
19319This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
19320authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
19321connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
19322unauthenticated. See also \hosts@_require@_auth\, and chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH
19323for details of authentication.
19324
19325.index bind IP address
19326.index IP address||binding
19327.conf interface "string list$**$" unset
19328This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
19329call. The variables \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ refer to the host to which a
19330connection is about to be made during the expansion of the string. Forced
19331expansion failure, or an empty string result causes the option to be ignored.
4964e932 19332Otherwise, after expansion,
495ae4b0
PH
19333the string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
19334separator can be changed in the usual way.
495ae4b0
PH
19335For example:
19336.display asis
19337interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
19338.endd
19339The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
19340connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
19341\interface\ is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
19342interface to use if the host has more than one.
19343
19344.conf keepalive boolean true
19345.index keepalive||on outgoing connection
19346This option controls the setting of \\SO@_KEEPALIVE\\ on outgoing TCP/IP socket
19347connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
19348periodically, by sending packets with `old' sequence numbers. The other end of
19349the connection should send a acknowledgement if the connection is still okay or
19350a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is that
19351it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection that can
19352get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the TCP/IP
19353call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
19354unreachable hosts.
19355
19356.conf max@_rcpt integer 100
19357.index \\RCPT\\||maximum number of outgoing
19358This option limits the number of \\RCPT\\ commands that are sent in a single
19359SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
19360so can cause parallel connections to the same host if \remote@_max@_parallel\
19361permits this.
19362
19363.conf multi@_domain boolean true
19364When this option is set, the \%smtp%\ transport can handle a number of addresses
19365containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve to the same
19366list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to handling only
19367one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use \$domain$\ in an
19368expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there is a single
19369domain involved in a remote delivery.
19370
19371.conf port string$**$ "see below"
19372.index port||sending TCP/IP
19373.index TCP/IP||setting outgoing port
19374This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects. If
19375it begins with a digit it is taken as a port number; otherwise it is looked up
19376using \*getservbyname()*\. The default value is normally `smtp', but if
19377\protocol\ is set to `lmtp', the default is `lmtp'.
4964e932 19378If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery is
495ae4b0
PH
19379deferred.
19380
19381
19382.conf protocol string "smtp"
19383.index LMTP||over TCP/IP
19384If this option is set to `lmtp' instead of `smtp', the default value for the
19385\port\ option changes to `lmtp', and the transport operates the LMTP protocol
19386(RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
19387deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
19388over a pipe to a local process -- see chapter ~~CHAPLMTP.
19389
19390.conf retry@_include@_ip@_address boolean true
19391Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
19392constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
19393means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
19394tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
19395addresses is not affected.
19396
19397However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
19398each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
19399the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
19400Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
19401instance of the \%smtp%\ transport, set up specially to handle the dialup hosts.
19402
19403.conf serialize@_hosts "host list$**$" unset
19404.index serializing connections
19405.index host||serializing connections
19406Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
19407host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
19408the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
19409slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
19410Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
19411\serialize@_hosts\ to match the relevant hosts.
19412
19413.index hints database||serializing deliveries to a host
19414Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
19415written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
19416is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
19417records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
19418guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
19419
19420If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
19421relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
19422start with \(misc)\ and they are kept in the \(spool/db)\ directory. There
19423may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
19424are used for ETRN serialization.
19425
19426.conf size@_addition integer 1024
19427.index SMTP||\\SIZE\\
19428.index message||size issue for transport filter
19429.index size||of message
19430.index transport||filter
19431.index filter||transport filter
19432If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the \\SIZE\\ option of the
19433\\MAIL\\ command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
19434an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of \size@_addition\ to the value it
19435sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
19436configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
19437this if a lot of text is added to messages.
19438
19439Alternatively, if the value of \size@_addition\ is set negative, it disables
19440the use of the \\SIZE\\ option altogether.
19441
19442.conf tls@_certificate string$**$ unset
19443.index TLS||client certificate, location of
19444.index certificate||for client, location of
19445The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
19446client's certificate, for use when sending a message over an encrypted
19447connection. The values of \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are set to the name
19448and address of the server during the expansion. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for
19449details of TLS.
19450
4964e932
PH
19451\**Note**\: This option must be set if you want Exim to use TLS when sending
19452messages as a client. The global option of the same name specifies the
19453certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically assumed that the same
495ae4b0
PH
19454certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a client.
19455
495ae4b0
PH
19456.conf tls@_crl string$**$ unset
19457.index TLS||client certificate revocation list
19458.index certificate||revocation list for client
19459This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
19460be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
495ae4b0
PH
19461
19462.conf tls@_privatekey string$**$ unset
19463.index TLS||client private key, location of
19464The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
19465client's private key, for use when sending a message over an encrypted
19466connection. The values of \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are set to the name
4964e932
PH
19467and address of the server during the expansion.
19468If this option is unset, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
495ae4b0
PH
19469the certificate.
19470See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19471
19472.conf tls@_require@_ciphers string$**$ unset
19473.index TLS||requiring specific ciphers
19474.index cipher||requiring specific
19475The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
d43194df
PH
19476when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
19477the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of \$host$\ and
19478\$host@_address$\ are set to the name and address of the server during the
19479expansion. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS; note that this option is
19480used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections ~~SECTreqciphssl and
19481~~SECTreqciphgnu).
19482.em
19483For GnuTLS, the order of the ciphers is a preference order.
19484.nem
495ae4b0
PH
19485
19486.conf tls@_tempfail@_tryclear boolean true
4964e932 19487When the server host is not in \hosts@_require@_tls\, and there is a problem in
495ae4b0
PH
19488setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
19489to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
19490current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
19491option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4\*xx*\
19492response to \\STARTTLS\\. Also, if \\STARTTLS\\ is accepted, but the subsequent
19493TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
19494unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
19495in clear.
19496
19497.conf tls@_verify@_certificates string$**$ unset
19498.index TLS||server certificate verification
19499.index certificate||verification of server
19500The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
19501permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
19502Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
19503\tls@_verify@_certificates\ to the name of a directory containing certificate
19504files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
19505single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of \$host$\ and
19506\$host@_address$\ are set to the name and address of the server during the
19507expansion of this option. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for details of TLS.
19508
19509.endconf
19510
19511
d43194df 19512.section How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used
495ae4b0
PH
19513.rset SECTvalhosmax "~~chapter.~~section"
19514.index host||maximum number to try
19515.index limit||hosts, maximum number tried
d43194df
PH
19516.em
19517There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
19518tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are \hosts@_max@_try\ and
19519\hosts@_max@_try@_hardlimit\.
19520.nem
19521
495ae4b0
PH
19522The \hosts@_max@_try\ option limits the number of hosts that are tried
19523for a single delivery. However, despite the term `host' in its name, the option
4964e932 19524actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a multihomed
495ae4b0
PH
19525host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for retrying.
19526
19527Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
19528multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
19529created as a result of routing one of these domains.
19530
19531Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
19532several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
19533problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
4964e932 19534\hosts@_max@_try\ is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
495ae4b0
PH
19535delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
19536
19537Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
19538arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
19539limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
19540some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
19541\hosts@_max@_retry\ may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
d43194df
PH
19542that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
19543see below for an exception).
495ae4b0
PH
19544
19545Secondly, when the \hosts@_max@_try\ limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
19546list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
d43194df
PH
19547If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
19548but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
19549that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
495ae4b0 19550
4964e932 19551Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
495ae4b0
PH
19552higher MX value. If \hosts@_max@_try\ is small (the default is 5) only a few
19553hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
19554which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
19555tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
19556reached their retry times.
19557
19558However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
19559large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
19560Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
19561of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
19562time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
d43194df
PH
19563without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried
19564.em
19565until all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days),
19566because there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry
19567times. With the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each
19568MX value at every delivery attempt, even if the \hosts@_max@_try\ limit has
19569already been reached.
19570
19571The above logic means that \hosts@_max@_try\ is not a hard limit, and in
19572particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
19573out an email address. When \hosts@_max@_try\ was implemented, this seemed a
19574reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
19575been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
19576take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
19577
19578The \hosts@_max@_try@_hardlimit\ option was added to help with this problem.
19579Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
19580and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
19581possible IP addresses have been tried.
19582.nem
495ae4b0
PH
19583
19584
19585
19586
19587.
19588.
19589.
19590.
19591. ============================================================================
19592.chapter Address rewriting
19593.set runningfoot "address rewriting"
19594.rset CHAPrewrite ~~chapter
19595.index rewriting||addresses
19596There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
19597addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
19598(referred to as an `unqualified address') or when an address contains an
19599abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
19600
19601Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
19602messages, or messages from hosts that match \sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ or
19603\recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\, respectively. Unqualified addresses in header
19604lines are qualified if they are in locally submitted messages, or messages from
19605hosts that are permitted to send unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise,
19606unqualified addresses in header lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
19607
19608One situation in which Exim does $it{not} automatically rewrite a domain is
19609when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
19610such a domain should be rewritten using the `canonical' name, and some MTAs do
19611this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
d43194df 19612
495ae4b0
PH
19613.section Explicitly configured address rewriting
19614This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
19615main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
19616\headers@_rewrite\ option that can be set on any transport.
19617
19618Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
19619Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
19620facility; you do not have to use it.
19621
495ae4b0
PH
19622The main rewriting rules that appear in the `rewrite' section of the
19623configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
19624addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
19625address to which it applies.
495ae4b0
PH
19626
19627Rewriting of addresses in header lines applies only to those headers that
19628were received with the message, and, in the case of transport rewriting, those
19629that were added by a system filter. That is, it applies only to those headers
19630that are common to all copies of the message. Header lines that are added by
19631individual routers or transports (and which are therefore specific to
19632individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten.
19633
19634In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
19635legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
19636in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
19637used sparingly, and mainly for `regularizing' addresses in your own domains.
19638Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
19639discouraged.
19640
19641There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
19642illustrated by these examples:
19643.numberpars $.
19644The company whose domain is \*hitch.fict.example*\ has a number of hosts that
19645exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
19646gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites \*@*.hitch.fict.example*\ as
19647\*hitch.fict.example*\ when sending mail off-site.
19648.nextp
19649A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
19650\*fp42@@hitch.fict.example*\ becomes \*Ford.Prefect@@hitch.fict.example*\.
19651.endp
19652
495ae4b0
PH
19653.section When does rewriting happen?
19654.index rewriting||timing of
19655.index ~~ACL||rewriting addresses in
19656Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
4964e932 19657message's processing.
495ae4b0 19658
4964e932 19659At the start of an ACL for \\MAIL\\, the sender address may have been rewritten
495ae4b0
PH
19660by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section ~~SECTrewriteS), but no
19661ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
19662is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
19663rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of \$sender@_address$\ is the
19664rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
19665\\RCPT\\ ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
19666rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
19667
19668Similarly, at the start of an ACL for \\RCPT\\, the current recipient's address
19669may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
19670rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
19671from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
19672for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
19673value of \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ after verification are always the same
4964e932 19674as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten -- except for
495ae4b0
PH
19675SMTP-time rewriting -- address).
19676
4964e932 19677Once a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope recipient
495ae4b0
PH
19678addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to the
19679addresses in the header lines (if configured).
19680.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||address rewriting, timing of
19681Thus, all the rewriting is completed before the \\DATA\\ ACL and
19682\*local@_scan()*\ functions are run.
19683
19684When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
19685rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
19686redirection, unless \no@_rewrite\ is set on the router.
495ae4b0
PH
19687
19688.index envelope sender, rewriting
19689.index rewriting||at transport time
19690At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
19691specified by setting the generic \headers@_rewrite\ option on a transport. This
19692option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
19693section of the configuration file. In addition, the outgoing envelope sender
19694can be rewritten by means of the \return@_path\ transport option. However, it
19695is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at transport time.
19696
19697
19698
19699.section Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input
19700.index rewriting||testing
19701.index testing||rewriting
19702Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
19703configuration file headed by `begin rewrite'. It can be tested by the \-brw-\
19704command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC 2822
19705address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
19706transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
19707appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
19708envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
19709.display asis
19710exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
19711.endd
19712might produce the output
19713.display asis
19714 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19715 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19716 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19717 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19718 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19719reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19720env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
19721 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
19722.endd
19723which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
19724the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
19725present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
19726set for a particular transport.
19727
19728.section Rewriting rules
19729.index rewriting||rules
19730The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
19731rules in the form
19732.display
19733<<source pattern>> <<replacement>> <<flags>>
19734.endd
19735Rewriting rules that are specified for the \headers@_rewrite\ generic transport
19736option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list takes the
19737same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration
19738(except that any colons must be doubled, of course).
19739
19740The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
19741Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
19742case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
19743characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
19744ignored.
19745
19746For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
19747order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
19748replaced by later rules (but see the `q' and `R' flags).
19749
19750The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
19751releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
19752received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
19753lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
19754address in ::To:: must not assume that the message's address in ::From:: has (or
19755has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of ::From:: may assume that
19756the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
19757
19758The variables \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ can be used in the replacement
19759string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
19760rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
19761.display asis
19762*@* ${lookup ...
19763.endd
19764where the lookup key uses \$1$\ and \$2$\ or \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ to
19765refer to the address that is being rewritten.
19766
19767.section Rewriting patterns
19768.index rewriting||patterns
19769.index address list||in a rewriting pattern
19770The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
19771address list (see section ~~SECTaddresslist). It is in fact processed as a
19772single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
19773against the address.
19774
4964e932
PH
19775Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
19776case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
495ae4b0
PH
19777can use a regular expression that starts with \"^(?i)"\.
19778
19779.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in rewriting rules
19780After matching, the numerical variables \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. may be set,
19781depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
19782replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. \$0$\ always
19783refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
19784numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
19785of pattern they are set as follows:
19786
19787.numberpars $.
19788If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
19789refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with \$1$\ associated with
19790the first asterisk, and \$2$\ with the second, if present. For example, if the
19791pattern
19792.display
19793*queen@@*.fict.example
19794.endd
19795is matched against the address \*hearts-queen@@wonderland.fict.example*\ then
19796.display asis
19797$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
19798$1 = hearts-
19799$2 = wonderland
19800.endd
19801Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
19802does, it is \$1$\ that contains the wild part of the domain.
19803.nextp
19804If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
19805of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
19806for example, that the address \*foo@@bar.baz.example*\ is processed by a
19807rewriting rule of the form
19808.display
19809*@@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file <<replacement string>>
19810.endd
19811and the key in the file that matches the domain is \"*.baz.example"\. Then
19812.display asis
19813$1 = foo
19814$2 = bar
19815$3 = baz.example
19816.endd
19817If the address \*foo@@baz.example*\ is looked up, this matches the same
19818wildcard file entry, and in this case \$2$\ is set to the empty string, but
19819\$3$\ is still set to \*baz.example*\. If a non-wild key is matched in a
19820partial lookup, \$2$\ is again set to the empty string and \$3$\ is set to the
19821whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
19822.endp
19823
19824.section Rewriting replacements
19825.index rewriting||replacements
19826If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
19827match the pattern and the flags are $it{not} rewritten, and no subsequent
19828rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
19829.display asis
19830hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
19831.endd
19832specifies that \*hatta@@lookingglass.fict.example*\ is never to be rewritten in
19833::From:: headers.
19834
19835If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
19836yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
19837\$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ refer to the address that is being rewritten.
19838Any letters they contain retain their original case -- they are not lower
19839cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
19840matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
19841the presence of `fail' in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
19842current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
19843expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
19844entry written to the panic log.
19845
19846
19847.section Rewriting flags
19848There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
19849.numberpars $.
19850Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
19851c, f, h, r, s, t.
19852.nextp
19853A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
19854.nextp
19855Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
19856.endp
19857For rules that are part of the \headers@_rewrite\ generic transport option,
19858E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
19859
19860
19861.section Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite
19862.index rewriting||flags
19863If none of the following flag letters, nor the `S' flag (see section
19864~~SECTrewriteS) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers and
19865to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
19866transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
19867rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
19868.display
19869E $rm{rewrite all envelope fields}
19870F $rm{rewrite the envelope From field}
19871T $rm{rewrite the envelope To field}
19872b $rm{rewrite the ::Bcc:: header}
19873c $rm{rewrite the ::Cc:: header}
19874f $rm{rewrite the ::From:: header}
19875h $rm{rewrite all headers}
19876r $rm{rewrite the ::Reply-To:: header}
19877s $rm{rewrite the ::Sender:: header}
19878t $rm{rewrite the ::To:: header}
19879.endd
19880You should be particularly careful about rewriting ::Sender:: headers, and
19881restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
19882
19883.section The SMTP-time rewriting flag
19884.rset SECTrewriteS "~~chapter.~~section"
19885.index SMTP||rewriting malformed addresses
19886.index \\RCPT\\||rewriting argument of
19887.index \\MAIL\\||rewriting argument of
19888The rewrite flag `S' specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at SMTP
19889time, as soon as an address is received in a \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ command, and
19890before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
19891required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
19892data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
19893
19894This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
19895compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, `bang paths' in batched SMTP
19896input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
19897the variables \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ are not available during the
19898expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
19899original address in the \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ command.
19900
19901.section Flags controlling the rewriting process
19902There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
19903take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
19904correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
19905.numberpars $.
19906If the `Q' flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
19907unqualified local part. It is qualified with \qualify@_recipient\. In the
19908absence of `Q' the rewritten address must always include a domain.
19909.nextp
19910If the `q' flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
19911even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a `fail' in the expansion.
19912The `q' flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type (does not
19913match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
19914.nextp
19915The `R' flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
19916address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the `q' flag, to stop
19917rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
19918.nextp
19919.index rewriting||whole addresses
19920When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
19921to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 `phrase'
19922left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
19923.display asis
19924From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
19925.endd
19926into
19927.display asis
19928From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
19929.endd
19930Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
19931done by adding the flag letter `w' to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
19932causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
19933replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
199342822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
19935brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
19936(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047.
19937The character set is taken from \headers@_charset\, which defaults to
19938ISO-8859-1.
19939
19940When the `w' flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
19941rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
19942.endp
19943
19944.section Rewriting examples
19945Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
19946.display asis
19947*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
19948*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
19949 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
19950.endd
19951Note the use of `fail' in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
19952the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
19953has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
19954consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the `q' flag is not
19955present in that rule. An alternative to `fail' would be to supply \$1$\
19956explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
19957at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
19958error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
19959
19960The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
19961domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
19962.display asis
19963root@*.hitch.fict.example *
19964.endd
19965were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
19966local part \*root*\ at any domain ending in \*hitch.fict.example*\.
19967
19968Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
19969\${if$\ in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
19970messages that originate outside the local host:
19971.display asis
19972*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
19973 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
19974.endd
19975The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
19976space.
19977
19978.index rewriting||bang paths
19979.index bang paths||rewriting
19980Exim does not handle addresses in the form of `bang paths'. If it sees such an
19981address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with the
19982local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
19983remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
19984sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
19985components. For example, the rule
19986.display asis
19987\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
19988.endd
19989rewrites a two-component bang path \*host.name!user*\ as the domain address
19990\*user@@host.name*\. However, there is a security implication in using this as
19991a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
19992method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
19993to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
19994use the `S' flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
19995can be done on the rewritten addresses.
19996
19997
19998
19999
20000
20001.
20002.
20003.
20004.
20005. ============================================================================
20006.chapter Retry configuration
20007.set runningfoot "retry configuration"
20008.rset CHAPretry ~~chapter
20009.index retry||configuration, description of
20010.index configuration file||retry section
20011The `retry' section of the run time configuration file contains a list of retry
20012rules which control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot be
20013delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules, temporary errors
20014are treated as permanent. The \-brt-\ command line option can be used to test
20015which retry rule will be used for a given address or domain.
20016
20017The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
20018host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
20019Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
20020address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
20021been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
20022tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the \retry@_defer\ log
20023selector is set, the message
20024.index retry||time not reached
20025`retry time not reached' is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
20026skipped for this reason. Section ~~SECToutSMTPerr contains more details of the
20027handling of errors during remote deliveries.
20028
20029Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
20030in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
20031actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
20032failures to route the domain \*snark.fict.example*\ and failures to deliver to
20033the host \*snark.fict.example*\. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
20034added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
20035same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
20036domain are maintained independently.
20037
20038When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
20039receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
20040always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
20041behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
20042quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
20043suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
20044subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
20045the local address is reached.
20046
20047
20048.section Retry rules
20049.index retry||rules
d43194df
PH
20050.em
20051Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
20052separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
20053addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
20054enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched in
20055order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
20056present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
20057message's sender, respectively.
20058.nem
495ae4b0
PH
20059
20060The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
20061~~SECTaddresslist). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list, which
20062means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that has
20063been delayed. Address list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were
20064preceded by `*@@', which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with
20065just a domain. For example,
20066.display asis
20067lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
20068.endd
20069provides a rule for any address in the \*lookingglass.fict.example*\ domain,
20070whereas
20071.display asis
20072alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
20073.endd
20074applies only to temporary failures involving the local part \alice\.
4964e932 20075In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
495ae4b0
PH
20076part.
20077
20078.index regular expressions||in retry rules
d43194df
PH
20079\**Warning**\: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
20080must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
20081expressions work in address lists.
495ae4b0
PH
20082.display
20083^@\Nxyz@\d+@\.abc@\.example@$@\N * G,1h,10m,2 \Wrong\
20084^@\N[^@@]+@@xyz@\d+@\.abc@\.example@$@\N * G,1h,10m,2 \Right\
20085.endd
20086
20087
20088.section Choosing which retry rule to use
20089When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
20090example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
20091against the complete address only if \retry__use@_local@_part\ is set for the
20092router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
20093regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with `*'. A
20094domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
20095`*@@'. By default, \retry@_use@_local@_part\ is true for routers where
20096\check@_local@_user\ is true, and false for other routers.
20097
20098Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
20099failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
20100configuration is tested against the complete address only if
20101\retry@_use@_local@_part\ is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
20102local transports).
20103
495ae4b0
PH
20104When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt has
20105failed, what happens depends on the type of failure. After a 4\*xx*\ SMTP
20106response for a recipient address, the whole address is used when searching the
4964e932 20107retry rules. The rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the
495ae4b0
PH
20108failing address.
20109
20110For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address,
495ae4b0
PH
20111(for example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is
20112checked twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name
20113(preceded by `*@@' when matching a regular expression). If this does not match
20114the line, the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For
20115example, suppose the MX records for \*a.b.c.example*\ are
20116.display asis
20117a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
20118 MX 6 p.q.r.example
20119 MX 7 m.n.o.example
20120.endd
20121and the retry rules are
20122.display asis
20123p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
20124a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
20125.endd
20126and a delivery to the host \*x.y.z.example*\ fails. The first rule matches
20127neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second rule. This does
20128not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used to calculate
20129the retry time for the host \*x.y.z.example*\. Meanwhile, Exim tries to deliver
20130to \*p.q.r.example*\. If this fails, the first retry rule is used, because it
20131matches the host.
20132
20133In other words, failures to deliver to host \*p.q.r.example*\ use the first
20134rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
20135\*a.b.c.example*\, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
20136routing to \*a.b.c.example*\ suffers a temporary failure.
20137
20138.section Retry rules for specific errors
20139.index retry||specific errors, specifying
20140The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
20141asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
d43194df
PH
20142.em
20143
20144.push
20145.indent 2em
20146.tempindent 0
20147\auth@_failed\: Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
20148\hosts@_require@_auth\ list in an \%smtp%\ transport.
20149
20150.tempindent 0
20151\rcpt@_4xx\: A 4\*xx*\ error was received for an outgoing \\RCPT\\ command.
20152Either the first or both of the x's can be given as specific digits, for
20153example: \"rcpt@_45x"\ or \"rcpt@_436"\. For example, to recognize 452 errors
20154given to \\RCPT\\ commands by a particular host, and have retries every ten
20155minutes and a one-hour timeout, you could set up a retry rule of this form:
20156.display asis
20157the.host.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
20158.endd
20159These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the \%smtp%\ transport) and outgoing
20160LMTP (either the \%lmtp%\ transport, or the \%smtp%\ transport in LMTP mode).
20161Note, however, that they apply only to responses to \\RCPT\\ commands.
20162
20163.tempindent 0
20164\refused@_MX\: A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
20165
20166.tempindent 0
20167\refused@_A\: A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was
20168refused.
20169
20170.tempindent 0
20171\refused\: A connection was refused.
20172
20173.tempindent 0
20174\timeout@_connect@_MX\: A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX
20175record timed out.
20176
20177.tempindent 0
20178\timeout@_connect@_A\: A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX
20179record timed out.
20180
20181.tempindent 0
20182\timeout@_connect\: A connection attempt timed out.
20183
20184.tempindent 0
20185\timeout@_MX\: There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session
20186with a host obtained from an MX record.
20187
20188.tempindent 0
20189\timeout@_A\: There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session
20190with a host not obtained from an MX record.
20191
20192.tempindent 0
20193\timeout\: There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
20194
20195.tempindent 0
20196\quota\: A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the
20197\%appendfile%\ transport.
20198
20199.index quota||error testing in retry rule
495ae4b0 20200.index retry||quota error testing
d43194df
PH
20201.tempindent 0
20202\quota@_\<<time>>: A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by
20203the \%appendfile%\ transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for
20204<<time>>. For example, \*quota@_4d*\ applies to a quota error when the mailbox
20205has not been accessed for four days.
20206
20207.pop
20208
495ae4b0 20209
495ae4b0 20210.index mailbox||time of last read
d43194df
PH
20211The idea of \quota@_\<<time>> is to make it possible to have shorter timeouts
20212when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally, it should
20213be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox. However, it is
20214not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following heuristic rules:
495ae4b0 20215.numberpars $.
d43194df
PH
20216If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the `atime') is used.
20217As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over quota),
20218Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
495ae4b0
PH
20219.nextp
20220.index maildir format||time of last read
4964e932 20221For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the \(new)\
d43194df
PH
20222subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
20223the \(new)\ subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
20224change to the \(new)\ subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
20225MUA moving a new message to the \(cur)\ directory when it is first read. The
20226time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
20227.nextp
20228For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
20229obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
495ae4b0 20230.endp
d43194df 20231.nem
495ae4b0
PH
20232The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
20233mechanism in the \%appendfile%\ transport. The \*quota*\ error also applies
20234when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the \\ENOSPC\\
20235error).
20236
20237
d43194df
PH
20238.em
20239.section Retry rules for specified senders
20240.index retry||rules, sender-specific
20241You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
20242specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
20243apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
20244form:
20245.display
20246senders=<<address list>>
20247.endd
20248The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
20249.display asis
20250* * senders=: F,1h,30m
20251.endd
20252matches all temporary errors for bounce messages sent to any host. If the
20253address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes. For example:
20254.display
20255a.domain timeout senders="x@b.dom : y@c.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
20256.endd
20257When testing retry rules using \-brt-\, you can supply a sender using the \-f-\
20258command line option, like this:
20259.display asis
20260exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
20261.endd
20262If you do not set \-f-\ with \-brt-\, a retry rule that contains a senders list
20263is never matched.
20264.nem
20265
20266
20267
20268.section Retry parameters
495ae4b0 20269.index retry||parameters in rules
d43194df
PH
20270The third
20271.em
20272(or fourth, if a senders list is present)
20273.nem
20274field in a retry rule is a sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by
20275semicolons. Each set consists of
495ae4b0
PH
20276.display
20277<<letter>>,<<cutoff time>>,<<arguments>>
20278.endd
20279The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
20280time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
20281arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
20282time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
20283relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
20284.index retry||algorithms
20285The available algorithms are:
20286.numberpars $.
d43194df
PH
20287\*F*\: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
20288the interval.
495ae4b0 20289.nextp
d43194df
PH
20290\*G*\: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
20291specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
20292is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
495ae4b0
PH
20293.endp
20294When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
20295order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
20296used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
20297case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
20298current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
20299computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
20300interval is found. The main configuration variable
20301.index limit||retry interval
20302.index retry||interval, maximum
20303.index \retry@_interval@_max\
20304\retry@_interval@_max\ limits the maximum interval between retries.
20305
20306A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
20307host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
20308basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
20309for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
20310generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
20311time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
20312time.
20313
20314.index hints database||use for retrying
20315Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
20316run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
20317starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
20318new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
20319If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
20320occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
20321messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
20322processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
20323your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
20324number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
20325sending everything to a smart host, for example).
20326
20327The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
20328\*exim@_dumpdb*\ or \*exim@_fixdb*\ utility programs (see chapter ~~CHAPutils). The
20329latter utility can also be used to change the data. The \*exinext*\ utility
20330script can be used to find out what the next retry times are for the hosts
20331associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local deliveries that
20332have been deferred.
20333
20334.section Retry rule examples
20335Here are some example retry rules:
20336.display asis
20337alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
20338wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
20339wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
20340lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
20341* refused_A F,2h,20m;
20342* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
20343.endd
20344The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
20345\*alice@@wonderland.fict.example*\ when there is an over-quota error and the
20346mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
20347hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
20348parts at \*wonderland.fict.example*\; the absence of a local part has the same
20349effect as supplying `$*$@@'. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
20350fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
20351days.
20352
20353The third rule handles all other errors at \*wonderland.fict.example*\; retries
20354happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
20355intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
20356first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
20357so on (this is a rather extreme example).
20358
20359The fourth rule controls retries for the domain \*lookingglass.fict.example*\.
20360They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
20361all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
20362were not obtained from an MX record.
20363
20364The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
20365first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
20366not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
20367hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
203681.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
20369
20370
20371.section Timeout of retry data
20372.index timeout||of retry data
20373.index \retry@_data@_expire\
20374.index hints database||data expiry
20375.index retry||timeout of data
20376Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
20377consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
20378set in \retry@_data@_expire\ (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
20379been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
20380arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
20381failing for the first time.
20382
20383This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
20384backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
20385Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
20386down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
20387
20388If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
20389every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. It there is a
20390message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
20391
20392
20393
20394.section Long-term failures
20395.index delivery||failure, long-term
20396.index retry||after long-term failure
20397Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
20398that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
20399default retry rule:
20400.display asis
20401* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
20402.endd
20403the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
20404long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
4964e932 20405failure for the recipient address that counts.
495ae4b0
PH
20406
20407When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
20408addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
20409causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
20410In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
20411time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
20412
20413For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
20414messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
20415post-cutoff retry time is not used.
20416
20417If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
20418.index \delay@_after@_cutoff\
20419\delay@_after@_cutoff\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport. The option is true by
20420default and in that case:
20421.numberpars " "
20422Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is reached,
20423the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery attempt
20424taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to those IP
20425addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails, the address
20426is bounced and new retry times are computed.
20427.endp
20428
20429In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
20430for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
20431times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
20432behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
20433to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
20434notice.
20435
20436If \delay@_after@_cutoff\ is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
20437addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
20438addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
20439no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
20440words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
20441addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
20442If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
20443\delay@_after@_cutoff\ false means that there will be many more attempts to
20444deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when \delay@_after@_cutoff\ is
20445true.
20446
20447.section Ultimate address timeout
20448.index retry||ultimate address timeout
20449An additional rule is needed to cope with cases where a host is intermittently
20450available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents its delivery when
20451others to the same address get through. In this situation, because some
20452messages are successfully delivered, the `retry clock' for the address keeps
20453getting restarted, and so a message could remain on the queue for ever. To
20454prevent this, if a message has been on the queue for longer than the cutoff
20455time of any applicable retry rule for a given address, a delivery is attempted
20456for that address, even if it is not yet time, and if this delivery fails, the
20457address is timed out. A new retry time is not computed in this case, so that
20458other messages for the same address are considered immediately.
20459
20460
20461
20462
20463
20464.
20465.
20466.
20467.
20468. ============================================================================
20469.chapter SMTP authentication
20470.set runningfoot "SMTP authentication"
20471.rset CHAPSMTPAUTH "~~chapter"
20472.index SMTP||authentication configuration
20473.index authentication
20474The `authenticators' section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned with
20475SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
20476described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
20477to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that
20478are permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to
20479the transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with
20480each other.
20481
20482.index \\AUTH\\||description of
20483Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
20484.numberpars $.
4964e932 20485The server advertises a number of authentication \*mechanisms*\ in response to
495ae4b0
PH
20486the client's \\EHLO\\ command.
20487.nextp
20488The client issues an \\AUTH\\ command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
20489may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
20490.nextp
20491The server may issue one or more \*challenges*\, to which the client must send
20492appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
20493just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
20494any challenges -- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
20495with the \\AUTH\\ command.
20496.nextp
20497The server either accepts or denies authentication.
20498.nextp
20499If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the \\AUTH\\
20500option on the \\MAIL\\ command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
20501mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
20502connection.
20503.nextp
20504If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
20505authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
20506unauthenticated connection.
20507.endp
20508If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
20509mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
20510SMTP port) on the server, and issue an \\EHLO\\ command. The response to this
20511includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
20512.display
20513@$ $cb{telnet server.example 25}
20514Trying 192.168.34.25...
20515Connected to server.example.
20516Escape character is '@^]'.
20517220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...
20518$cb{ehlo client.example}
20519250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]
20520250-SIZE 52428800
20521250-PIPELINING
20522250-AUTH PLAIN
20523250 HELP
20524.endd
20525The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
20526authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
20527mechanisms are configured by specifying \*authenticator*\ drivers. Like the
20528routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
20529controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
20530included by setting
20531.display asis
20532AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
20533AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
20534AUTH_SPA=yes
20535.endd
20536in \(Local/Makefile)\, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
20537authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second can be configured to
20538support the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism,
20539which is not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The third
20540authenticator supports Microsoft's \*Secure Password Authentication*\
20541mechanism.
20542
20543The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
20544section ~~SECTfordricon). If no authenticators are required, no authentication
20545section need be present in the configuration file. Each authenticator can in
20546principle have both server and client functions. When Exim is receiving SMTP
20547mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out messages over SMTP, it
20548is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration options are provided for use
20549in both these circumstances.
20550
20551To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
20552\server@_\ and \client@_\ are used on option names that are specific to either
20553the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client functions
20554are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is to be
20555used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using both sets
20556of options, is required. For example:
20557.display asis
20558cram:
20559 driver = cram_md5
20560 public_name = CRAM-MD5
20561 server_secret = ${if eq{$1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
20562 client_name = ph10
20563 client_secret = secret2
20564.endd
20565The \server@_\ option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
20566\client@_\ options when it is acting as a client.
20567
20568Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
20569The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
20570authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
20571in Exim.
20572
20573
20574.section Generic options for authenticators
20575.index authentication||generic options
20576
d43194df 20577.startconf authenticators
495ae4b0
PH
20578.index options||generic, for authenticators
20579
20580.conf driver string unset
20581This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
20582authenticators is to be used.
20583
20584.conf public@_name string unset
20585This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
20586implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
20587contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
20588but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If \public@_name\ is not set, it
20589defaults to the driver's instance name.
20590
20591.conf server@_advertise@_condition string$**$ unset
20592When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
20593is expanded. If it yields the empty string, `0', `no', or `false', the
4964e932
PH
20594mechanism is not advertised.
20595If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
495ae4b0
PH
20596forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
20597See section ~~SECTauthexiser below for further discussion.
20598
20599.conf server@_debug@_print string$**$ unset
20600If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the \-d-\
20601command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
20602output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
20603out the values of variables.
4964e932 20604If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
495ae4b0
PH
20605output, and Exim carries on processing.
20606
20607.conf server@_set@_id string$**$ unset
20608When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
20609expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
20610messages in the variable \$authenticated@_id$\. It is also included in the log
20611lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
20612configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
20613refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
20614If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
20615
20616.conf server@_mail@_auth@_condition string$**$ unset
20617This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
4964e932 20618as part of \\MAIL\\ commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
495ae4b0
PH
20619driver on which \server__mail__auth@_condition\ is set. The option is not used
20620as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
20621remembered for later use.
20622How it is used is described in the following section.
20623.endconf
20624
20625
20626
20627.section The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands
20628.rset SECTauthparamail "~~chapter.~~section"
20629.index authentication||sender, authenticated
20630.index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
4964e932 20631When a client supplied an \\AUTH=\\ item on a \\MAIL\\ command, Exim applies
495ae4b0
PH
20632the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
20633message:
20634.numberpars $.
4964e932 20635If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, \\HELO\\ was used rather
495ae4b0
PH
20636than \\EHLO\\), the use of \\AUTH=\\ is a syntax error.
20637.nextp
20638If the value of the \\AUTH=\\ parameter is `@<@>', it is ignored.
20639.nextp
20640If \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
20641running, the value of \$authenticated@_sender$\ is set to the value obtained
20642from the \\AUTH=\\ parameter. If the ACL does not yield `accept', the value of
20643\$authenticated@_sender$\ is deleted. The \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ ACL may not
20644return `drop' or `discard'. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is given
20645for the \\MAIL\\ command.
20646.nextp
20647If \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ is not defined, the value of the \\AUTH=\\ parameter
20648is accepted and placed in \$authenticated@_sender$\ only if the client has
20649authenticated.
20650.nextp
20651If the \\AUTH=\\ value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
20652the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
20653\server@_mail@_auth@_condition\, the condition is checked at this point. The
20654valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
20655fails, or yields an empty string, `0', `no', or `false', the value of
20656\$authenticated__sender$\ is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
20657the value of \$authenticated@_sender$\ is retained and passed on with the
20658message.
20659.endp
20660
20661When \$authenticated@_sender$\ is set for a message, it is passed on to other
20662hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
20663\$authenticated@_id$\, which is a string obtained from the authentication
20664process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
20665
20666Whenever an \\AUTH=\\ value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
20667\\MAIL\\, if defined, is run after \\AUTH=\\ is accepted or ignored. It can
20668therefore make use of \$authenticated@_sender$\. The converse is not true: the
20669value of \$sender@_address$\ is not yet set up when the \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\
20670ACL is run.
20671
20672
20673.section Authentication on an Exim server
20674.rset SECTauthexiser "~~chapter.~~section"
20675.index authentication||on an Exim server
4964e932
PH
20676When Exim receives an \\EHLO\\ command, it advertises the public names of those
20677authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
495ae4b0
PH
20678conditions:
20679.numberpars $.
20680The client host must match \auth@_advertise@_hosts\ (default $*$).
20681.nextp
4964e932 20682It the \server@_advertise@_condition\ option is set, its expansion must not
495ae4b0
PH
20683yield the empty string, `0', `no', or `false'.
20684.endp
4964e932 20685The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
495ae4b0
PH
20686the mechanisms are advertised.
20687
20688Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
20689provide a name and password for authentication whenever \\AUTH\\ is advertised,
20690even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
20691set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
20692You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising \\AUTH\\ to them.
20693For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
20694that runs for \\RCPT\\) to relay without authentication, you should set
20695.display asis
20696auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
20697.endd
20698so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
20699
20700The \server@_advertise@_condition\ controls the advertisement of individual
20701authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
20702advertisement of a patricular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
20703such as:
20704.display asis
20705server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
20706.endd
4964e932 20707If the session is encrypted, \$tls@_cipher$\ is not empty, and so the expansion
495ae4b0
PH
20708yields `yes', which allows the advertisement to happen.
20709
20710When an Exim server receives an \\AUTH\\ command from a client, it rejects it
20711immediately if \\AUTH\\ was not advertised in response to an earlier \\EHLO\\
20712command. This is the case if
20713.numberpars $.
20714The client host does not match \auth@_advertise@_hosts\; or
20715.nextp
20716No authenticators are configured with server options; or
20717.nextp
4964e932 20718Expansion of \server@_advertise@_condition\ blocked the advertising of all the
495ae4b0
PH
20719server authenticators.
20720.endp
20721
20722Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_auth\ in order
20723to decide whether to accept the command. If \acl@_smtp@_auth\ is not set,
4964e932 20724\\AUTH\\ is accepted from any client host.
495ae4b0
PH
20725
20726If \\AUTH\\ is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
4964e932 20727server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to \\EHLO\\ and
495ae4b0
PH
20728that matches the one named in the \\AUTH\\ command. If it finds one, it runs
20729the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
20730fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the \\AUTH\\ command is
20731rejected with a 504 error.
20732
20733When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
d43194df
PH
20734\$received@_protocol$\ is set to
20735.em
20736`esmtpa'
20737.nem
20738instead of `esmtp', and \$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ contains the name (not
20739the public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated
20740the client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there
20741was no successful authentication.
495ae4b0
PH
20742
20743
20744
20745.section Testing server authentication
20746.index authentication||testing a server
20747.index \\AUTH\\||testing a server
20748.index base64 encoding||creating authentication test data
20749Exim's \-bh-\ option can be useful for testing server authentication
20750configurations. The data for the \\AUTH\\ command has to be sent using base64
20751encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
20752script:
20753.display asis
20754use MIME::Base64;
20755printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
20756.endd
20757.index binary zero||in authentication data
20758This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
20759interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
20760some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
20761command line to run this script on such data might be
20762.display asis
20763encode '\0user\0password'
20764.endd
20765Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
20766backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
4964e932 20767whose code value is zero.
495ae4b0
PH
20768
20769\**Warning 1**\: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
20770digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
20771you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
20772interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
20773
4964e932
PH
20774\**Warning 2**\: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
20775specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
495ae4b0
PH
20776example, a command such as
20777.display asis
20778encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
20779.endd
20780gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped `@@' and `@$' characters.
20781
20782If you have the \mimencode\ command installed, another way to do produce
20783base64-encoded strings is to run the command
20784.display asis
20785echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
20786.endd
20787The \-e-\ option of \echo\ enables the interpretation of backslash escapes in
20788the argument, and the \-n-\ option specifies no newline at the end of its
20789output. However, not all versions of \echo\ recognize these options, so you
20790should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
20791
20792
20793.section Authentication by an Exim client
20794.index authentication||on an Exim client
20795The \%smtp%\ transport has two options called \hosts@_require@_auth\ and
20796\hosts@_try@_auth\. When the \%smtp%\ transport connects to a server that
20797announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
20798of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
20799.numberpars $.
20800For each authenticator that is configured as a client, it searches the
20801authentication mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name
20802matches the public name of the authenticator.
20803.nextp
20804When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code.
20805The variables \$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ are available for any string
20806expansions that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and
20807IP address. If any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt
20808is abandoned,
20809and Exim moves on to the next authenticator.
20810Otherwise an expansion failure causes delivery to be
20811deferred.
20812.nextp
20813If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
20814Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
20815try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
20816usual way.
20817.nextp
20818If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5xx code), Exim carries
20819on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if possible. If
20820all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are no attempts
20821because no mechanisms match
20822(or option expansions force failure),
20823what happens depends on whether the host matches \hosts@_require@_auth\ or
20824\hosts@_try@_auth\. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
20825delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
20826turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
20827deliver the message unauthenticated.
20828.endp
20829.index \\AUTH\\||on \\MAIL\\ command
20830When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the \\AUTH\\
20831parameter to the \\MAIL\\ commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender
4964e932
PH
20832for the message.
20833If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender is the one
20834that was receiving on an incoming \\MAIL\\ command, provided that the incoming
495ae4b0
PH
20835connection was authenticated and the \server@_mail@_auth\ condition allowed the
20836authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim to send a
20837message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
20838\qualify@_domain\ is treated as authenticated. However, if the
20839\authenticated@_sender\ option is set on the \%smtp%\ transport, it overrides
20840the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
20841
20842
20843
20844
20845
20846
20847.
20848.
20849.
20850.
20851. ============================================================================
20852.chapter The plaintext authenticator
20853.rset CHAPplaintext "~~chapter"
20854.set runningfoot "plaintext authenticator"
20855.index \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20856.index authenticators||\%plaintext%\
20857The \%plaintext%\ authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
20858LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
20859plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
20860security risk. If you use one of these mechanisms without also making use of
20861SMTP encryption (see chapter ~~CHAPTLS) you should not use the same passwords
20862for SMTP connections as you do for login accounts.
20863
20864.section Using plaintext in a server
20865When running as a server, \%plaintext%\ performs the authentication test by
20866expanding a string. It has the following options:
20867
d43194df 20868.startconf plaintext
495ae4b0
PH
20869.index options||\%plaintext%\ authenticator (server)
20870
20871.conf server@_prompts string$**$ unset
20872The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
20873prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
20874given.
20875
20876.conf server@_condition string$**$ unset
20877This option must be set in order to configure the driver as a server. Its use
20878is described below.
20879
20880.endconf
20881
20882.index \\AUTH\\||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20883.index binary zero||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20884.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20885.index base64 encoding||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20886The data sent by the client with the \\AUTH\\ command, or in response to
20887subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte values
20888when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as a
20889list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), which are placed in the
20890expansion variables \$1$\, \$2$\, etc. If there are more strings in
20891\server@_prompts\ than the number of strings supplied with the \\AUTH\\
20892command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more data. Each response from
20893the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
20894
20895Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
20896\server@_condition\ is expanded.
20897If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
20898failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
20899If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string, `0', `no', or
20900`false', authentication fails. If the result of the expansion is `1', `yes', or
20901`true', authentication succeeds and the generic \server@_set@_id\ option is
20902expanded and saved in \$authenticated@_id$\. For any other result, a temporary
20903error code is returned, with the expanded string as the error text.
20904
4964e932
PH
20905\**Warning**\: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
20906password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
495ae4b0
PH
20907There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
20908
20909
20910.section The PLAIN authentication mechanism
20911.index PLAIN authentication mechanism
20912.index authentication||PLAIN mechanism
20913.index binary zero||in \%plaintext%\ authenticator
20914The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
4964e932 20915sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
495ae4b0
PH
20916separators). The data is sent either as part of the \\AUTH\\ command, or
20917subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
20918
20919The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
20920Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
20921configured as follows:
20922.display asis
20923fixed_plain:
20924 driver = plaintext
20925 public_name = PLAIN
4964e932 20926 server_prompts = :
495ae4b0
PH
20927 server_condition = \
20928 ${if and {{eq{$2}{username}}{eq{$3}{mysecret}}}{yes}{no}}
20929 server_set_id = $2
20930.endd
20931The \server@_prompts\ setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
20932the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
20933\\AUTH\\ command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
20934authenticator is advertised in the response to \\EHLO\\ as
20935.display asis
20936250-AUTH PLAIN
20937.endd
20938and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
20939.display asis
20940AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
20941.endd
20942As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
20943data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
20944.display asis
20945AUTH PLAIN
20946.endd
4964e932 20947to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
495ae4b0
PH
20948prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
20949
495ae4b0
PH
20950The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
20951when decoded, is \"<<NUL>>username<<NUL>>mysecret"\, where <<NUL>> represents a
20952zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which is empty.
20953The \server@_condition\ option in the authenticator checks that the second two
20954are \"username"\ and \"mysecret"\ respectively.
20955
4964e932
PH
20956Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
20957realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
495ae4b0 20958authenticating clients it could make sense.
495ae4b0
PH
20959
20960A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
20961\$2$\ to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
20962comparison (see \crypteq\ in chapter ~~CHAPexpand). Here is a example of this
20963approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. \**Warning**\: This
20964is an incorrect example:
20965.display asis
20966server_condition = \
20967 ${if eq{$3}{${lookup{$2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}{yes}{no}}
20968.endd
20969The expansion uses the user name (\$2$\) as the key to look up a password,
20970which it then compares to the supplied password (\$3$\). Why is this example
20971incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
20972non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
4964e932
PH
20973strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
20974the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
495ae4b0
PH
20975name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
20976.display asis
20977server_condition = ${lookup{$2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
4964e932 20978 {${if eq{$value}{$3}{yes}{no}}}{no}}
495ae4b0
PH
20979.endd
20980In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
20981fails, authentication fails. If \crypteq\ is being used instead of \eq\, the
20982first example is in fact safe, because \crypteq\ always fails if its second
20983argument is empty. However, the second way of writing the test makes the logic
20984clearer.
20985
20986
20987.section The LOGIN authentication mechanism
20988.index LOGIN authentication mechanism
20989.index authentication||LOGIN mechanism
20990The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
20991in a number of programs. No data is sent with the \\AUTH\\ command. Instead, a
20992user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
20993plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
20994.display asis
20995fixed_login:
20996 driver = plaintext
20997 public_name = LOGIN
20998 server_prompts = User Name : Password
20999 server_condition = \
21000 ${if and {{eq{$1}{username}}{eq{$2}{mysecret}}}{yes}{no}}
21001 server_set_id = $1
21002.endd
21003Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
21004with the \\AUTH\\ command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
21005if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
21006strings are used to obtain two data items.
21007
21008Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
21009example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only `Username:' and
21010`Password:'. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator which uses those
21011strings, and which uses the \ldapauth\ expansion condition to check the user
21012name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
21013.display asis
21014login:
21015 driver = plaintext
21016 public_name = LOGIN
21017 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
21018 server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
4964e932 21019.newline
495ae4b0
PH
21020 {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
21021 pass=${quote:$2} \
4964e932 21022.newline
495ae4b0
PH
21023 ldap://ldap.example.org/}{yes}{no}}
21024 server_set_id = uid=$1,ou=people,o=example.org
21025.endd
21026Note the use of the \quote@_ldap@_dn\ operator to correctly quote the DN for
21027authentication. However, the basic \quote\ operator, rather than any of the
4964e932
PH
21028LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
21029quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
495ae4b0
PH
21030LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
21031
21032
4964e932 21033.section Support for different kinds of authentication
495ae4b0
PH
21034A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
21035interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
21036traditionally encrypted passwords from \(/etc/passwd)\ (or equivalent), PAM,
21037Radius, \ldapauth\, and \*pwcheck*\. For details see section ~~SECTexpcond.
21038
21039
21040
21041.section Using plaintext in a client
21042The \%plaintext%\ authenticator has just one client option:
21043
d43194df 21044.startconf plaintext
495ae4b0
PH
21045.index options||\%plaintext%\ authenticator (client)
21046
21047.conf client@_send string$**$ unset
21048The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
21049string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
21050string is sent with the \\AUTH\\ command; any more strings are sent in response
21051to prompts from the server.
21052
21053\**Note**\: you cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
21054splitting takes priority and happens first.
21055
21056Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
21057the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
21058there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
21059NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
21060the string.
21061
21062.endconf
21063
21064This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
21065authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
21066.display asis
21067fixed_plain:
21068 driver = plaintext
21069 public_name = PLAIN
21070 client_send = ^username^mysecret
21071.endd
21072The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the \\AUTH\\
21073command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
21074that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
21075.display asis
21076fixed_login:
21077 driver = plaintext
21078 public_name = LOGIN
21079 client_send = : username : mysecret
21080.endd
21081The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
21082the \\AUTH\\ command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
21083prompts.
21084
21085
21086
21087
21088.
21089.
21090.
21091.
21092. ============================================================================
21093.chapter The cram@_md5 authenticator
21094.set runningfoot "cram@_md5 authenticator"
21095.index \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator
21096.index authenticators||\%cram@_md5%\
21097.index CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism
21098.index authentication||CRAM-MD5 mechanism
21099The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
21100sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
21101name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
21102string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
21103is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
21104secure than \%plaintext%\. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
21105available in plain text at either end.
21106
21107.section Using cram@_md5 as a server
21108This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
21109authenticator as a server:
21110
d43194df 21111.startconf cram@_md5
495ae4b0
PH
21112.index options||\%cram@_md5%\ authenticator (server)
21113
21114.conf server@_secret string$**$ unset
21115.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator
21116When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
21117the expansion variable \$1$\, and \server@_secret\ is expanded to obtain the
21118password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest that the
21119client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct string. If the
21120expansion of \server@_secret\ is forced to fail, authentication fails. If the
21121expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is returned to
21122the client.
21123
21124.endconf
21125
21126For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
21127client is `ph10', and if so, uses `secret' as the password. For any other user
4964e932 21128name, authentication fails.
495ae4b0
PH
21129.display asis
21130fixed_cram:
21131 driver = cram_md5
21132 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21133 server_secret = ${if eq{$1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
21134 server_set_id = $1
21135.endd
21136If authentication succeeds, the setting of \server@_set@_id\ preserves the user
21137name in \$authenticated@_id$\.
21138A more tyical configuration might look up the secret string in a file, using
21139the user name as the key. For example:
21140.display asis
21141lookup_cram:
21142 driver = cram_md5
21143 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21144 server_secret = ${lookup{$1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}{$value}fail}
21145 server_set_id = $1
21146.endd
21147Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
21148because \$1$\ contains an unknown user name.
21149
21150.section Using cram@_md5 as a client
21151When used as a client, the \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator has two options:
21152
d43194df 21153.startconf cram@_md5
495ae4b0
PH
21154.index options||\%cram@_md5%\ authenticator (client)
21155
21156.conf client@_name string$**$ "the primary host name"
21157This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
21158computing the response to the server's challenge.
21159
21160.conf client@_secret string$**$ unset
21161This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
21162expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
21163
21164.endconf
21165
21166Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
21167to \$host$\ or \$host@_address$\ in the options.
21168
21169Forced failure of either expansion string is treated as an indication that this
21170authenticator is not prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next
21171configured client authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to
21172give up trying to send the message to the current server.
21173
21174A simple example configuration of a \%cram@_md5%\ authenticator, using fixed
21175strings, is:
21176.display asis
21177fixed_cram:
21178 driver = cram_md5
21179 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21180 client_name = ph10
21181 client_secret = secret
21182.endd
21183
21184
21185
21186
d43194df
PH
21187.
21188.
21189.
21190.
21191. ============================================================================
21192.chapter The cyrus@_sasl authenticator
21193.set runningfoot "cyrus@_sasl authenticator"
21194.index \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator
21195.index authenticators||\%cyrus@_sasl%\
21196.index Cyrus, SASL library
21197.em
21198The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
21199Digital Ltd (\?http://www.aldigital.co.uk?\).
21200
21201The \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
21202library implementation of the RFC 2222 (`Simple Authentication and Security
21203Layer'). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms, including
21204PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support directly.
21205The \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
21206the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
21207then so can the \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator. By default it uses the public
21208name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
21209
21210Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
21211or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the \*exim*\
21212user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
21213by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
21214depending on the driver you are using.
21215
21216.section Using cyrus@_sasl as a server
21217The \%cyrus@_sasl%\ authenticator has four private options. It puts the
21218username (on a successful authentication) into \$1$\.
21219
21220.startconf cyrus@_sasl
21221.conf server@_hostname string$**$ $tt{$primary@_hostname}
21222This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with
21223the library. It is up to the underlying SASL plug-in what it does with
21224this data.
21225
21226.conf server@_mech string $tt{public@_name}
21227This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should
21228use. It allows you to use a different underlying mechanism from the
21229advertised name. For example:
21230.display asis
21231sasl:
21232 driver = cyrus_sasl
21233 public_name = X-ANYTHING
21234 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
21235 server_set_id = $1
21236.endd
21237
21238.conf server@_realm string unset
21239This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
21240
21241.conf server@_service string $tt{smtp}
21242This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
21243
21244.endconf
21245
21246For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
21247private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
21248the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
21249PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
21250.display asis
21251sasl_cram_md5:
21252 driver = cyrus_sasl
21253 public_name = CRAM-MD5
21254 server_set_id = $1
21255
21256sasl_plain:
21257 driver = cyrus_sasl
21258 public_name = PLAIN
21259 server_set_id = $1
21260.endd
21261
21262Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
21263not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
21264but it is present in many binary distributions.
21265
21266.nem
21267
21268
495ae4b0
PH
21269
21270.
21271.
21272.
21273.
21274. ============================================================================
21275.chapter The spa authenticator
21276.set runningfoot "spa authenticator"
21277.index \%spa%\ authenticator
21278.index authenticators||\%spa%\
21279.index authentication||Microsoft Secure Password
21280.index authentication||NTLM
21281.index Microsoft Secure Password Authentication
21282.index NTLM authentication
21283The \%spa%\ authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's \*Secure
21284Password Authentication*\ mechanism,
21285which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
21286this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
21287taken from the Samba project (\?http://www.samba.org?\). The code for the
21288server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner.
21289
21290The mechanism works as follows:
21291.numberpars $.
21292After the \\AUTH\\ command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
21293authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
21294.nextp
21295The server sends back a challenge.
21296.nextp
21297The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
21298and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
21299.endp
21300Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
21301
21302
21303.section Using spa as a server
21304The \%spa%\ authenticator has just one server option:
21305
d43194df 21306.startconf spa
495ae4b0
PH
21307.index options||\%spa%\ authenticator (server)
21308
21309.conf server@_password string$**$ unset
21310.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in \%spa%\ authenticator
4964e932 21311This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
495ae4b0
PH
21312authenticating user, whose name is at this point in \$1$\. For example:
21313.display asis
21314spa:
21315 driver = spa
21316 public_name = NTLM
21317 server_password = ${lookup{$1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}}
21318.endd
4964e932 21319If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
495ae4b0
PH
21320failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
21321
21322.endconf
21323
21324
21325
21326.section Using spa as a client
21327The \%spa%\ authenticator has the following client options:
21328
d43194df 21329.startconf spa
495ae4b0
PH
21330.index options||\%spa%\ authenticator (client)
21331
21332.conf client@_domain string$**$ unset
21333This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
21334
21335.conf client@_password string$**$ unset
21336This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
21337
21338.conf client@_username string$**$ unset
21339This option specifies the user name, and must be set.
21340
21341.endconf
21342
21343Here is an example of a configuration of this authenticator for use with the
21344mail servers at \*msn.com*\:
21345.display asis
21346msn:
21347 driver = spa
21348 public_name = MSN
21349 client_username = msn/msn_username
21350 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
21351 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
21352.endd
21353
21354
21355
21356
21357
21358
21359.
21360.
21361.
21362.
21363. ============================================================================
21364.chapter Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL
21365.set runningfoot "TLS encryption"
21366.rset CHAPTLS "~~chapter"
21367.index encryption||on SMTP connection
21368.index SMTP||encryption
21369.index TLS||on SMTP connection
21370.index OpenSSL
21371.index GnuTLS
495ae4b0
PH
21372Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
21373Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
d43194df
PH
21374GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
21375cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
21376order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
21377version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section ~~SECTinctlsssl). You
21378also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial level,
21379and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and certificates are
21380used.
495ae4b0
PH
21381
21382RFC 2487 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
21383connection is established, the client issues a \\STARTTLS\\ command. If the
21384server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
21385mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
21386between them is encrypted.
21387
495ae4b0
PH
21388Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
21389and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
21390certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
21391possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
21392encryption state.
21393
21394\**Warning**\: certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
21395disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
21396in order to get TLS to work.
21397
21398
d43194df
PH
21399.em
21400.section Support for the legacy `ssmtp' protocol
21401.index ssmtp protocol
21402.index SMTP||ssmtp protocol
21403Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
21404SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
21405waiting for a \\STARTTLS\\ command from the client using the standard SMTP
21406port. The protocol was called `ssmtp' and port 465 was allocated for this
21407purpose.
21408
21409This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardised, but there are
21410still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
21411the \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ global option. Its value must be a list of port
21412numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
21413.display asis
21414tls_on_connect_ports = 465
21415.endd
21416The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
21417via the daemon and via \*inetd*\. You still need to specify all the ports that
21418the daemon uses (by setting \daemon@_smtp@_ports\ or \local@_interfaces\ or the
21419\-oX-\ command line option) because \tls@_on@_connect@_ports\ does not add an
21420extra port -- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
21421defined elsewhere.
21422
21423There is also a \-tls-on-connect-\ command line option. This overrides
21424\tls@_on@_connect@_ports\; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
21425.nem
21426
21427
21428
21429
495ae4b0
PH
21430.section OpenSSL vs GnuTLS
21431.index TLS||OpenSSL \*vs*\ GnuTLS
21432.rset SECTopenvsgnu "~~chapter.~~section"
21433The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
21434followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
21435to use GnuTLS, you need to set
21436.display asis
21437USE_GNUTLS=yes
21438.endd
21439in Local/Makefile, in addition to
21440.display asis
21441SUPPORT_TLS=yes
21442.endd
21443You must also set \\TLS@_LIBS\\ and \\TLS@_INCLUDE\\ appropriately, so that the
21444include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
21445
21446There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
21447.numberpars $.
4964e932 21448The \tls@_verify@_certificates\ option must contain the name of a file, not the
495ae4b0 21449name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
495ae4b0
PH
21450.nextp
21451The \tls@_dhparam\ option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
4964e932 21452facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
495ae4b0
PH
21453changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
21454.nextp
21455GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that take a substantial amount of
21456time to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS
21457session. Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool
21458directory, called \(gnutls-params)\. The file is owned by the Exim user and is
21459readable only by its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the
21460RSA and D-H parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first
21461Exim process that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file
21462which is renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim
21463processes do this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a
21464file is in place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
21465
21466For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
21467recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
21468Arranging this is easy; just delete the file when you want new values to be
21469computed.
21470.nextp
4964e932
PH
21471Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
21472separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
495ae4b0 21473affects the value of the \$tls@_peerdn$\ variable.
495ae4b0
PH
21474.nextp
21475OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
21476DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA@_ARCFOUR@_SHA. What is
21477more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
21478life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyhens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
21479underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
4964e932 21480\tls@_require@_ciphers\ options (the global option and the \%smtp%\ transport
495ae4b0 21481option).
495ae4b0 21482.nextp
495ae4b0 21483The \tls@_require@_ciphers\ options operate differently, as described in the
d43194df 21484following sections.
495ae4b0
PH
21485.endp
21486
d43194df
PH
21487.section Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL
21488.rset SECTreqciphssl "~~chapter.~~section"
21489.index TLS||requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)
21490.index \tls@_require@_ciphers\||OpenSSL
21491There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
21492suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
21493are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
495ae4b0 21494DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of \tls@_require@_ciphers\
d43194df
PH
21495directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
21496documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
495ae4b0
PH
21497.numberpars $.
21498It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
21499.nextp
21500It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
21501or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
21502ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
21503SSL v3 algorithms.
21504.nextp
21505Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
21506the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
21507SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
21508algorithms.
21509.nextp
21510Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by the characters \"!"\, \"-"\ or
21511\"+"\.
21512.numberpars " "
21513If \"!"\ is used then the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
21514ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
21515stated.
21516.nextp
21517If \"-"\ is used then the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
21518of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
21519.nextp
21520If \"+"\ is used then the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
21521option doesn't add any new ciphers it just moves matching existing ones.
21522.nextp
21523If none of these characters is present then the string is just interpreted as a
21524list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
21525includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
21526not moved to the end of the list.
21527.endp
21528.endp
21529
d43194df
PH
21530
21531.section Requiring specific ciphers in GnuTLS
21532.rset SECTreqciphgnu "~~chapter.~~section"
21533.index TLS||requiring specific ciphers (GnuTLS)
21534.index \tls@_require@_ciphers\||GnuTLS
495ae4b0
PH
21535The GnuTLS library does not have a combined function like OpenSSL. Instead,
21536it allows the caller to specify separate lists of key-exchange methods,
21537main cipher algorithms, and MAC algorithms. Unfortunately, these lists are
21538numerical, and the library does not have a function for turning names into
21539numbers. Consequently, the list of recognized names has to be built into
21540the application.
21541
21542At present, Exim permits only the list of main cipher algorithms to be
21543changed. The \tls@_require@_ciphers\ option is in the same format as for
21544OpenSSL. Exim searches each item for the name of available algorithm. For
d43194df 21545example, if the list contains RSA@_AES@_SHA then AES is recognized.
495ae4b0
PH
21546
21547The cipher algorithms list starts out with a default set of algorithms. If
21548the first item in \tls@_require@_ciphers\ does \*not*\ start with an
21549exclamation mark, all the default items are deleted. Thus, only those specified
21550can be used. If the first item in \tls@_require@_ciphers\ \*does*\ start with
21551an exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
21552
21553Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevent
21554algorithms to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start
21555with an exclamation mark causes the relevant algorithms to be added to the
21556list. Thus,
21557.display asis
21558tls_require_ciphers = !RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA
21559.endd
21560allows all the defaults except those that use ARCFOUR, whereas
21561.display asis
21562tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
21563.endd
21564allows only cipher suites that use AES and 3DES. The currently recognized
d43194df
PH
21565algorithms are:
21566.em
21567AES@_256, AES@_128, AES (both of the preceding), 3DES, and ARCFOUR@_128.
21568Unrecognized algorithms are ignored. In a server, the order of the list is
21569unimportant; the server will advertise the availability of all the relevant
21570cipher suites. However, in a client, the order of the list specifies a
21571preference order for the algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
21572also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
21573above.
21574.nem
495ae4b0
PH
21575
21576
21577.section Configuring an Exim server to use TLS
21578.index TLS||configuring an Exim server
21579When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
21580the \\STARTTLS\\ command to client hosts that match \tls@_advertise@_hosts\,
21581but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
21582that \\STARTTLS\\ is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
21583need to set some other options in order to make TLS avaliable, and also it is
21584sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
21585
21586If a client issues a \\STARTTLS\\ command and there is some configuration
21587problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
21588persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except \\QUIT\\ are rejected
21589with the error
21590.display asis
21591554 Security failure
21592.endd
21593If a \\STARTTLS\\ command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
21594rejected with a 554 error code.
21595
21596To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set \tls@_advertise@_hosts\ to
21597match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to $*$ to match all hosts.
21598However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
21599without some further configuration at the server end.
21600
21601It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
21602encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
21603.display asis
21604tls_certificate = /some/file/name
21605tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
21606.endd
21607The first file contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains
21608the private key that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim
21609user, and must always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if
21610both the certificate and the key are contained within it. If \tls@_privatekey\
21611is not set, this is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also
21612contain intermediate certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable
21613it to authenticate the server's certificate.
21614
21615If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
21616source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
21617few comments below in section ~~SECTcerandall.)
21618
4964e932
PH
21619\**Note**\: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client --
21620they apply only in the case of a server. For a client, you must set the options
495ae4b0
PH
21621of the same name in an \%smtp%\ transport.
21622
21623With just these options, Exim will work as a server with clients such as
21624Netscape. It does not require the client to have a certificate (but see below
21625for how to insist on this). There is one other option that may be needed in
21626other situations. If
21627.display asis
21628tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
21629.endd
21630is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
4964e932 21631with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
495ae4b0
PH
21632suites that the server supports. See the command
21633.display asis
21634openssl dhparam
21635.endd
21636for a way of generating this data.
4964e932 21637At present, \tls@_dhparam\ is used only when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is
495ae4b0
PH
21638ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
21639
21640The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
21641host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
21642for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
21643in \$sender@_host@_address$\ to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
21644forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
21645
21646.index cipher||logging
21647.index log||TLS cipher
21648The variable \$tls@_cipher$\ is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
21649an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the ::Received:: header of an
21650incoming message (by default -- you can, of course, change this), and it is
21651also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by `X=',
21652unless the \tls@_cipher\ log selector is turned off.
4964e932 21653The \encrypted\ condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in
495ae4b0
PH
21654ACLs.
21655
21656The ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can check the name of the cipher
21657suite and vary their actions accordingly. The cipher suite names are those used
21658by OpenSSL. These may differ from the names used elsewhere. For example,
21659OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other contexts
21660is known as TLS@_RSA@_WITH@_3DES@_EDE@_CBC@_SHA. Check the OpenSSL
21661documentation for more details.
21662
21663
21664.section Requesting and verifying client certificates
21665.index certificate||verification of client
21666.index TLS||client certificate verification
21667If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
21668session with a client, you must set either \tls@_verify@_hosts\ or
21669\tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\. You can, of course, set either of them to $*$ to
21670apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
21671Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
21672contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
21673expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
495ae4b0
PH
21674for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
21675\tls@_verify@_certificates\.
495ae4b0
PH
21676
21677A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
4964e932
PH
21678directory is used
21679(OpenSSL only),
495ae4b0
PH
21680each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
21681of the form <<hash>>.0, where <<hash>> is a hash value constructed from the
21682certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
21683.display asis
21684openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
21685.endd
21686where \(/cert/file)\ contains a single certificate.
21687
21688The difference between \tls@_verify@_hosts\ and \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ is
21689what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
21690does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
21691\tls@_verify@_certificates\. If the client matches \tls@_verify@_hosts\, the
21692attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
21693dropped. If the client matches \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\, the (encrypted) SMTP
21694session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
21695fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
21696example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
21697relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
21698
21699When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
21700the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
21701\$tls@_peerdn$\ during subsequent processing of the message.
21702.index log||distinguished name
21703Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
21704::Received:: header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
21705`DN=', by setting the \tls@_peerdn\ log selector, and you can use
21706\received@_header@_text\ to change the ::Received:: header. When no certificate
21707is supplied, \$tls@_peerdn$\ is empty.
21708
495ae4b0
PH
21709.section Revoked certificates
21710.index TLS||revoked certificates
21711.index revocation list
21712.index certificate||revocation list
21713Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
21714certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
21715server using the global option called \tls@_crl\ and to an Exim client using an
21716identically named option for the \%smtp%\ transport. In each case, the value of
21717the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a CRL
21718in PEM format.
495ae4b0
PH
21719
21720.section Configuring an Exim client to use TLS
21721.index cipher||logging
21722.index log||TLS cipher
21723.index log||distinguished name
21724.index TLS||configuring an Exim client
21725The \tls@_cipher\ and \tls@_peerdn\ log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
21726deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
21727server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
21728within the \%smtp%\ transport.
21729
21730It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the \%smtp%\
21731transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
21732server, the \%smtp%\ transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
21733this can be prevented by setting \hosts@_avoid@_tls\ (an option of the
21734transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
21735
21736If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
21737to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
21738\hosts@_require@_tls\ to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
21739those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
21740set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
21741usual way.
21742
21743When the server host is not in \hosts@_require@_tls\, Exim may try to deliver
21744the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to \\STARTTLS\\ is
21745a 5\*xx*\ code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
21746session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
21747\tls@_tempfail@_tryclear\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport. If it is false,
21748delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
21749it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4\*xx*\ response to
21750\\STARTTLS\\, and if \\STARTTLS\\ is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
21751negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21752unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21753unencrypted.
21754
21755
21756The \tls@_certificate\ and \tls@_privatekey\ options of the \%smtp%\ transport
21757provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server if it
21758requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
21759\tls@_verify@_hosts\ or \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ matches the client.
4964e932 21760\**Note**\: these options must be set in the \%smtp%\ transport for Exim to use
495ae4b0
PH
21761TLS when it is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server
21762certificate (set by the global options of the same name) should also be used
21763when operating as a client.
21764
21765If \tls@_verify@_certificates\ is set, it must name a file or,
495ae4b0
PH
21766for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
21767expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
21768against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
21769in the list defined by \tls@_crl\.
495ae4b0
PH
21770
21771If
21772\tls@_require@_ciphers\ is set on the \%smtp%\ transport, it must contain a
21773list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
21774the current host is abandoned, and the \%smtp%\ transport tries to deliver to
21775alternative hosts, if any.
21776
21777All the TLS options in the \%smtp%\ transport are expanded before use, with
21778\$host$\ and \$host@_address$\ containing the name and address of the server to
21779which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
21780behave as if the relevant option were unset.
21781
21782
21783.section Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection
21784.rset SECTmulmessam "~~chapter.~~section"
21785.index multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS
21786.index TLS||multiple message deliveries
21787Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
21788an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
21789one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
21790of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
21791connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
21792to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
21793session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
21794try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
21795if \\AUTH\\ is in use, before sending the next message.
21796
21797The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
4964e932 21798after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
495ae4b0
PH
21799just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
21800reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
21801successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
21802SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
21803should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
21804subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
21805and delay other deliveries to that host.
21806
21807To test for this case, Exim sends an \\EHLO\\ command to the server after
4964e932 21808closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
495ae4b0
PH
21809closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
21810information is recorded.
21811
4964e932
PH
21812There is also a manual override; you can set \hosts@_nopass@_tls\ on the
21813\%smtp%\ transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
495ae4b0
PH
21814connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
21815
21816
21817
21818.section Certificates and all that
21819.rset SECTcerandall "~~chapter.~~section"
21820.index certificate||references to discussion
21821In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
21822certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
21823place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
21824myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
21825to Apache, currently at
21826.display rm
21827\?http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl@_faq.html@#ToC24?\
21828.endd
21829Other parts of the \*modssl*\ documentation are also helpful, and have
21830links to further files.
21831Eric Rescorla's book, \*SSL and TLS*\, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
4964e932 218320-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
495ae4b0
PH
21833Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
21834.display rm
21835\?http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/?\
21836.endd
21837
21838.section Certificate chains
21839The file named by \tls@_certificate\ may contain more than one
21840certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
21841sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
21842not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
21843First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
21844certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
21845intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
21846certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
21847The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
21848validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
21849root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
21850install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
21851
21852.section Self-signed certificates
21853.index certificate||self-signed
21854You can create a self-signed certificate using the \*req*\ command provided
21855with OpenSSL, like this:
21856.display asis
21857openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
21858 -days 9999 -nodes
21859.endd
21860\(file1)\ and \(file2)\ can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
21861delimited and so can be identified independently. The \-days-\ option
21862specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The \-nodes-\ option is
21863important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
21864that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
21865prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
21866this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
21867
21868A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
21869may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
21870encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
21871
21872However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
21873user (also called `leaf' or `site') certificate, and not a self-signed
21874certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
21875must be installed on the client host as a trusted root \*certification
21876authority*\ (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
21877signed with that self-signed certificate.
21878
21879For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
21880user certificates, see the \*General implementation overview*\ chapter of the
21881Open-source PKI book, available online at \?http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/?\.
21882
21883
21884
21885.
21886.
21887.
21888.
21889. ============================================================================
21890.chapter Access control lists
21891.set runningfoot "ACL"
21892.rset CHAPACL "~~chapter"
21893.index ~~ACL||description
21894.index control of incoming mail
21895.index message||controlling incoming
21896.index policy control||access control lists
21897Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
21898configuration file, headed by `begin acl'. Each ACL definition starts with a
4964e932 21899name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
495ae4b0
PH
21900one very small ACL:
21901.display asis
21902begin acl
21903
21904small_acl:
21905 accept hosts = one.host.only
21906.endd
21907You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
21908which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
21909
21910The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
21911certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
4964e932
PH
21912when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the \-bs-\
21913option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
21914in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
21915local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
21916a realistic ACL for checking \\RCPT\\ commands. This is discussed in chapter
21917~~CHAPdefconfil.
495ae4b0
PH
21918
21919.section Testing ACLs
21920The \-bh-\ command line option provides a way of testing your ACL configuration
21921locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact. The host
21922\*relay-test.mail-abuse.org*\ provides a service for checking your relaying
21923configuration (see section ~~SECTcheralcon for more details).
21924
21925
21926.section Specifying when ACLs are used
21927.index ~~ACL||options for specifying
21928In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
21929options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
21930.index \\AUTH\\||ACL for
4964e932 21931.index \\DATA\\, ACLs for
495ae4b0
PH
21932.index \\ETRN\\||ACL for
21933.index \\EXPN\\||ACL for
21934.index \\HELO\\||ACL for
21935.index \\EHLO\\||ACL for
21936.index \\MAIL\\||ACL for
4964e932 21937.index \\QUIT\\, ACL for
495ae4b0
PH
21938.index \\RCPT\\||ACL for
21939.index \\STARTTLS\\, ACL for
21940.index \\VRFY\\||ACL for
4964e932
PH
21941.index SMTP||connection, ACL for
21942.index non-smtp message, ACL for
495ae4b0
PH
21943.display
21944.tabs 20
21945.if !~~sys.fancy
21946.tabs 24
21947.fi
21948\acl@_not@_smtp\ $t $rm{ACL for non-SMTP messages}
21949\acl@_smtp@_auth\ $t $rm{ACL for \\AUTH\\}
21950\acl@_smtp@_connect\ $t $rm{ACL for start of SMTP connection}
4964e932 21951\acl@_smtp@_data\ $t $rm{ACL after \\DATA\\ is complete}
495ae4b0
PH
21952\acl@_smtp@_etrn\ $t $rm{ACL for \\ETRN\\}
21953\acl@_smtp@_expn\ $t $rm{ACL for \\EXPN\\}
21954\acl@_smtp@_helo\ $t $rm{ACL for \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\}
21955\acl@_smtp@_mail\ $t $rm{ACL for \\MAIL\\}
495ae4b0
PH
21956\acl@_smtp@_mailauth\ $t $rm{ACL for the \\AUTH\\ parameter of \\MAIL\\}
21957.newline
4964e932
PH
21958.em
21959\acl@_smtp@_mime\ $t $rm{ACL for content-scanning MIME parts}
21960\acl@_smtp@_predata\ $t $rm{ACL at start of \\DATA\\ command}
21961\acl@_smtp@_quit\ $t $rm{ACL for \\QUIT\\}
21962.nem
21963.newline
495ae4b0
PH
21964\acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ $t $rm{ACL for \\RCPT\\}
21965\acl@_smtp@_starttls\ $t $rm{ACL for \\STARTTLS\\}
21966\acl@_smtp@_vrfy\ $t $rm{ACL for \\VRFY\\}
21967.endd
21968For example, if you set
21969.display asis
21970acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
21971.endd
21972the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a \\RCPT\\ command
21973in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
21974done when \\RCPT\\ commands arrive. A rejection of \\RCPT\\ should cause the
21975sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the \\RCPT\\
4964e932
PH
21976command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
21977trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
495ae4b0
PH
21978testing as possible at \\RCPT\\ time.
21979
d43194df
PH
21980.section The non-SMTP ACL
21981.index non-smtp message, ACL for
21982The non-SMTP ACL applies to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, it
21983applies to batch SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batch SMTP is not
21984really SMTP.) This ACL is run just before the \*local@_scan()*\ function. Any
21985kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
21986temporary error for these kinds of message. Many of the ACL conditions (for
21987example, host tests, and tests on the state of the SMTP connection such as
21988encryption and authentication) are not relevant and are forbidden in this ACL.
4964e932
PH
21989
21990.section The connect ACL
21991.index SMTP||connection, ACL for
21992The ACL test specified by \acl@_smtp@_connect\ happens after the test specified
495ae4b0
PH
21993by \host__reject__connection\ (which is now an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers
21994testing (if configured).
21995
4964e932 21996.em
d43194df
PH
21997.section The DATA ACLs
21998.index \\DATA\\, ACLs for
21999Two ACLs are associated with the \\DATA\\ command, because it is two-stage
22000command, with two responses being sent to the client.
22001When the \\DATA\\ command is received, the ACL defined by \acl@_smtp@_predata\
22002is obeyed. This gives you control after all the \\RCPT\\ commands, but before
22003the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
22004response to the \\DATA\\ command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
22005added by \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
22006are defined here are visible when the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL is run.
22007
22008You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
22009in the headers, at \\RCPT\\ time or when the \\DATA\\ command is received. Such
22010tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
22011received, before the final response to the \\DATA\\ command is sent. This is
22012the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\, which is the second ACL that is
22013associated with the \\DATA\\ command.
22014
22015For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
22016error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
22017MTAs do not treat hard (5$it{xx}) responses to the \\DATA\\ command (either
22018before or after the data) correctly -- they keep the message on their queues
22019and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
22020your resources.
22021
22022.section The MIME ACL
22023The \acl@_smtp@_mime\ option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
22024content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22025
4964e932
PH
22026.section The QUIT ACL
22027.rset SECTQUITACL "~~chapter.~~section"
22028.index \\QUIT\\, ACL for
22029The ACL for the SMTP \\QUIT\\ command is anomalous, in that the
22030outcome of the ACL does not affect the response code to \\QUIT\\,
22031which is always 221. Thus, the ACL does not in fact control any access.
22032For this reason, the only verbs that are permitted are \accept\ and \warn\.
22033
22034This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
22035session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
22036messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at \\QUIT\\ time using one or
22037more \logwrite\ modifiers on a \warn\ verb.
22038
22039You do not need to have a final \accept\, but if you do, you can use a
22040\message\ modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
22041response to \\QUIT\\.
22042
22043This ACL is run only for a `normal' \\QUIT\\. For certain kinds of disastrous
22044failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
22045because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
22046client are given temporary error responses until \\QUIT\\ is received or the
22047connection is closed. In these special cases, the \\QUIT\\ ACL does not run.
22048.nem
22049
4964e932
PH
22050.section Finding an ACL to use
22051.index ~~ACL||finding which to use
22052The value of an \acl@_smtp@_$it{xxx}\ option is expanded before use, so you can
22053use different ACLs in different circumstances. The resulting string does not
22054have to be the name of an ACL in the configuration file; there are other
22055possibilities. Having expanded the string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
22056.numberpars $.
22057If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
22058contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
22059Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
22060lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is `@#'.
22061If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
22062causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
22063.display asis
22064acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
22065 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
22066 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
22067.endd
22068This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
22069back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
22070file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
22071can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
22072.nextp
22073If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
22074Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
22075matches the string.
22076.nextp
22077If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
22078the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
22079want to have something like
22080.display asis
22081acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
22082.endd
22083in order to allow free use of the \\VRFY\\ command. Such a string may contain
22084newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
22085.endp
22086
22087
495ae4b0
PH
22088.section ACL return codes
22089.index ~~ACL||return codes
4964e932
PH
22090.em
22091Except for the \\QUIT\\ ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
22092section ~~SECTQUITACL above), the
22093.nem
22094result of running an ACL is either `accept' or `deny', or, if some test
495ae4b0
PH
22095cannot be completed (for example, if a database is down), `defer'. These
22096results cause 2$it{xx}, 5$it{xx}, and 4$it{xx} return codes, respectively, to
22097be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return, `error', occurs when there is an
22098error such as invalid syntax in the ACL. This also causes a 4$it{xx} return
22099code.
22100
4964e932
PH
22101.em
22102For the non-SMTP ACL, `defer' and `error' are treated in the same way as
22103`deny', because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
22104submitters of non-SMTP messages.
22105.nem
22106
22107ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return `discard'. This
495ae4b0
PH
22108has the effect of `accept', but causes either the entire message or an
22109individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
4964e932 22110blackholing facility. Use it with care.
495ae4b0
PH
22111
22112If the ACL for \\MAIL\\ returns `discard', all recipients are discarded, and no
22113ACL is run for subsequent \\RCPT\\ commands. The effect of `discard' in a
4964e932
PH
22114\\RCPT\\ ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
22115recipients left when the message's data is received, the \\DATA\\ ACL is not
22116run. A `discard' return from the \\DATA\\ or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
495ae4b0 22117remaining recipients.
4964e932
PH
22118.em
22119The `discard' return is not permitted for the \acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACL.
22120.nem
495ae4b0 22121
4964e932
PH
22122.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||when all recipients discarded
22123The \*local@_scan()*\ function is always run, even if there are no remaining
495ae4b0
PH
22124recipients; it may create new recipients.
22125
22126
22127.section Unset ACL options
22128.index ~~ACL||unset options
495ae4b0
PH
22129The default actions when any of the \acl@_$it{xxx}\ options are unset are not
22130all the same. \**Note**\: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
4964e932 22131not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control reaches
495ae4b0 22132the end of the ACL statements is `deny'.
495ae4b0
PH
22133
22134For \acl@_not@_smtp\, \acl@_smtp@_auth\, \acl@_smtp@_connect\,
22135\acl@_smtp@_data\, \acl@_smtp@_helo\, \acl__smtp__mail\, \acl@_smtp@_mailauth\,
495ae4b0 22136.em
d43194df 22137\acl@_smtp@_mime\, \acl@_smtp@_predata\, \acl@_smtp@_quit\,
4964e932 22138.nem
d43194df 22139and \acl__smtp__starttls\, the action when the ACL is not defined is `accept'.
495ae4b0
PH
22140
22141For the others (\acl@_smtp@_etrn\, \acl@_smtp@_expn\, \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\, and
22142\acl@_smtp@_vrfy\), the action when the ACL is not defined is `deny'.
495ae4b0
PH
22143This means that \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\ must be defined in order to receive any
22144messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
22145configuration file.
22146
22147
22148
22149.section Data for message ACLs
22150.index ~~ACL||data for message ACL
d43194df
PH
22151.em
22152When a \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ ACL, or either of the \\DATA\\ ACLs, is running,
22153the variables that contain information about the host and the message's sender
22154(for example, \$sender@_host@_address$\ and \$sender@_address$\) are set, and
22155can be used in ACL statements. In the case of \\RCPT\\ (but not \\MAIL\\ or
22156\\DATA\\), \$domain$\ and \$local@_part$\ are set from the argument address.
495ae4b0 22157
d43194df 22158When an ACL for the \\AUTH\\ parameter of \\MAIL\\ is running, the variables
4964e932 22159that contain information about the host are set, but \$sender@_address$\ is not
d43194df 22160yet set. Section ~~SECTauthparamail contains a discussion of this parameter and
4964e932 22161how it is used.
495ae4b0
PH
22162
22163The \$message@_size$\ variable is set to the value of the \\SIZE\\ parameter on
d43194df
PH
22164the \\MAIL\\ command at \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\ and pre-data time, or to -1 if
22165that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
22166the time the final \\DATA\\ ACL is run (after the message data has been
22167received).
495ae4b0
PH
22168
22169The \$rcpt@_count$\ variable increases by one for each \\RCPT\\ command
22170received. The \$recipients@_count$\ variable increases by one each time a
22171\\RCPT\\ command is accepted, so while an ACL for \\RCPT\\ is being processed,
d43194df
PH
22172it contains the number of previously accepted recipients. At \\DATA\\ time (for
22173both the \\DATA\\ ACLs), \$rcpt@_count$\ contains the total number of \\RCPT\\
22174commands, and \$recipients@_count$\ contains the total number of accepted
22175recipients.
22176.nem
495ae4b0
PH
22177
22178
22179
22180.section Data for non-message ACLs
22181.rset SECTdatfornon "~~chapter.~~section"
22182.index ~~ACL||data for non-message ACL
4964e932
PH
22183.em
22184When an ACL is being run for \\AUTH\\, \\EHLO\\, \\ETRN\\, \\EXPN\\, \\HELO\\,
22185.nem
22186\\STARTTLS\\, or \\VRFY\\, the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in
495ae4b0
PH
22187\$smtp@_command@_argument$\. This can be tested using a \condition\ condition.
22188For example, here is an ACL for use with \\AUTH\\, which insists that either
22189the session is encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In
22190other words, it does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext
22191passwords on unencrypted connections.
22192.display asis
22193acl_check_auth:
22194 accept encrypted = *
4964e932
PH
22195.newline
22196.em
495ae4b0 22197 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
4964e932
PH
22198 {CRAM-MD5}}
22199.nem
22200.newline
495ae4b0
PH
22201 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
22202.endd
4964e932
PH
22203(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
22204that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
22205encrypted. You can use the generic \server@_advertise@_condition\ authenticator
495ae4b0
PH
22206option to do this.)
22207
22208
495ae4b0
PH
22209.section Format of an ACL
22210.index ~~ACL||format of
22211.index ~~ACL||verbs, definition of
22212An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
4964e932
PH
22213with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and `modifiers'.
22214.em
22215Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
22216set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
22217.nem
22218
22219If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
22220used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
22221provides a means of specifying an `and' conjunction between conditions. For
22222example:
495ae4b0
PH
22223.display asis
22224deny dnslists = list1.example
22225 dnslists = list2.example
22226.endd
4964e932
PH
22227If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed.
22228.em
22229Exim stops evaluating the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition
22230that fails. What happens then
22231.nem
22232depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not all the
22233conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot test a
22234sender address in the ACL that is run for a \\VRFY\\ command.
495ae4b0 22235
4964e932
PH
22236.section ACL verbs
22237The ACL verbs are as follows:
495ae4b0
PH
22238.numberpars $.
22239\accept\: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns `accept'. If any of
22240the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether \endpass\ appears
4964e932
PH
22241among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition is before
22242\endpass\, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is after
495ae4b0
PH
22243\endpass\, the ACL returns `deny'. Consider this statement, used to check a
22244\\RCPT\\ command:
22245.display asis
22246accept domains = +local_domains
22247 endpass
22248 verify = recipient
22249.endd
22250If the recipient domain does not match the \domains\ condition, control passes
22251to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and the
22252command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification fails,
22253the ACL yields `deny', because the failing condition is after \endpass\.
22254.nextp
4964e932
PH
22255\defer\: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns `defer' which, in an
22256SMTP session, causes a 4\*xx*\ response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
495ae4b0
PH
22257\defer\ is the same as \deny\, because there is no way of sending a temporary
22258error. For a \\RCPT\\ command, \defer\ is much the same as using a
22259\%redirect%\ router and \":defer:"\ while verifying, but the \defer\ verb can
22260be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
22261.nextp
22262\deny\: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns `deny'. If any of the
22263conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
22264example,
22265.display asis
22266deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
22267.endd
22268rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
22269.nextp
4964e932 22270\discard\: This verb behaves like \accept\, except that it returns `discard'
495ae4b0
PH
22271from the ACL instead of `accept'. It is permitted only on ACLs that are
22272concerned with receiving messages, and it causes recipients to be discarded.
4964e932
PH
22273If the \log@_message\ modifier is set when \discard\ operates, its contents are
22274added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
495ae4b0
PH
22275
22276If \discard\ is used in an ACL for \\RCPT\\, just the one recipient is
22277discarded; if used for \\MAIL\\, \\DATA\\ or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
22278message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before
22279\\DATA\\ do not appear in the log line when the \log@_recipients\ log selector
22280is set.
22281.nextp
22282\drop\: This verb behaves like \deny\, except that an SMTP connection is
22283forcibly closed after the 5\*xx*\ error message has been sent. For example:
22284.display asis
22285drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
4964e932
PH
22286.newline
22287.em
22288 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
22289.nem
495ae4b0
PH
22290.endd
22291There is no difference between \deny\ and \drop\ for the connect-time ACL. The
22292connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
22293.nextp
22294\require\: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
22295statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns `deny'. For
22296example, when checking a \\RCPT\\ command,
22297.display asis
22298require verify = sender
22299.endd
22300passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
22301verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command.
22302.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
22303\warn\: If all the conditions are met, a header line is added to an incoming
22304message and/or a line is written to Exim's main log. In all cases, control
22305passes to the next ACL statement. The text of the added header line and the log
22306line are specified by modifiers; if they are not present, a \warn\ verb just
22307checks its conditions and obeys any `immediate' modifiers such as \set\ and
22308\logwrite\.
4964e932
PH
22309.em
22310There is more about adding header lines in section ~~SECTaddheadwarn.
22311.nem
495ae4b0
PH
22312
22313If any condition on a \warn\ statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
4964e932
PH
22314some sort of defer), no header lines are added and the configured log line is
22315not written. No further conditions or modifiers in the \warn\ statement are
495ae4b0
PH
22316processed. The incident is logged, but the ACL continues to be processed, from
22317the next statement onwards.
22318
4964e932 22319If a \message\ modifier is present on a \warn\ verb in an ACL that is not
495ae4b0
PH
22320testing an incoming message, it is ignored, and the incident is logged.
22321
4964e932
PH
22322A \warn\ statement may use the \log@_message\ modifier to cause a line to be
22323written to the main log when the statement's conditions are true.
22324If an identical log line is requested several times in the same message, only
22325one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force duplicates to be
22326written, use the \logwrite\ modifier instead.
495ae4b0
PH
22327
22328When one of the \warn\ conditions is an address verification that fails, the
22329text of the verification failure message is in \$acl@_verify@_message$\. If you
22330want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
22331.display asis
22332warn !verify = sender
22333 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
22334.endd
22335.endp
22336
22337At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional \deny\.
22338
22339As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
22340written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
22341subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
4964e932
PH
22342continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
22343mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
495ae4b0
PH
22344
22345
22346.section ACL variables
22347.rset SECTaclvariables "~~chapter.~~section"
22348.index ~~ACL||variables
22349There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
4964e932
PH
22350can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
22351of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
22352transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. There are two sets
22353of these variables:
495ae4b0
PH
22354.numberpars $.
22355The values of \$acl@_c0$\ to \$acl@_c9$\ persist throughout an SMTP connection.
4964e932 22356They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set while receiving one message is
495ae4b0
PH
22357still available when receiving the next message on the same SMTP connection.
22358.nextp
22359The values of \$acl@_m0$\ to \$acl@_m9$\ persist only while a message is being
22360received. They are reset afterwards. They are also reset by \\MAIL\\, \\RSET\\,
22361\\EHLO\\, \\HELO\\, and after starting up a TLS session.
22362.endp
4964e932 22363When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
495ae4b0 22364preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
4964e932 22365time. The ACL variables are set by modifier called \set\. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
22366.display asis
22367accept hosts = whatever
22368 set acl_m4 = some value
22369.endd
4964e932 22370\**Note**\: a leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
495ae4b0 22371be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
4964e932 22372\warn\ verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
495ae4b0
PH
22373
22374
22375.section Condition and modifier processing
22376.index ~~ACL||conditions, processing
22377.index ~~ACL||modifiers, processing
22378An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example,
22379.display asis
22380deny domains = *.dom.example
22381 !verify = recipient
22382.endd
22383causes the ACL to return `deny' if the recipient domain ends in
4964e932 22384\*dom.example*\ and the recipient address cannot be verified.
495ae4b0
PH
22385
22386The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
22387of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
22388condition is true. Consider these two statements:
22389.display asis
22390accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
22391 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
22392accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
22393 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
22394.endd
22395Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
22396the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
22397different in the two cases. The \fail\ in the first statement causes the
22398condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The \accept\ verb
22399therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
22400the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
22401and therefore the \accept\ also fails.
22402
22403ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
22404specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
22405others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
22406warning is generated.
4964e932
PH
22407.em
22408The \control\ modifier affects the way an incoming message is handled.
22409.nem
495ae4b0
PH
22410
22411The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
22412processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
4964e932
PH
22413modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
22414consider this use of the \message\ modifier:
495ae4b0
PH
22415.display asis
22416require message = Can't verify sender
22417 verify = sender
22418 message = Can't verify recipient
22419 verify = recipient
22420 message = This message cannot be used
22421.endd
4964e932
PH
22422If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
22423`deny', so it goes no further. The first \message\ modifier has been seen, so
495ae4b0
PH
22424its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
22425recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
22426verification succeeds, the third message becomes `current', but is never used
22427because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
22428
22429For the \deny\ verb, on the other hand, it is always the last \message\
4964e932
PH
22430modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
22431happen. Specifying more than one \message\ modifier does not make sense, and
495ae4b0
PH
22432the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
22433.display asis
22434deny hosts = ...
22435 !senders = *@my.domain.example
22436 message = Invalid sender from client host
22437.endd
4964e932 22438The `deny' result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached, by
495ae4b0
PH
22439which time Exim has set up the message.
22440
22441
22442.section ACL modifiers
22443.rset SECTACLmodi "~~chapter.~~section"
22444.index ~~ACL||modifiers, list of
22445The ACL modifiers are as follows:
22446
22447.startitems
22448
22449.item "control = <<text>>"
495ae4b0 22450.em
4964e932 22451This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
d43194df
PH
22452incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
22453lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
22454lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
22455controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
22456even if the \control\ modifier appears in a \\RCPT\\ ACL.
22457
22458As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
22459separately in section ~~SECTcontrols.
495ae4b0 22460.nem
d43194df 22461The \control\ modifier can be used in several different ways. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
22462.numberpars $.
22463It can be at the end of an \accept\ statement:
22464.display asis
4964e932 22465accept ...some conditions
495ae4b0
PH
22466 control = queue_only
22467.endd
4964e932
PH
22468In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields `accept', in
22469other words, when the conditions are all true.
495ae4b0
PH
22470.nextp
22471It can be in the middle of an \accept\ statement:
22472.display asis
22473accept ...some conditions...
22474 control = queue_only
22475 ...some more conditions...
22476.endd
4964e932 22477If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
495ae4b0
PH
22478statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
22479In this case, some subsequent statement must yield `accept' for the control to
22480be relevant.
22481.nextp
22482It can be used with \warn\ to apply the control, leaving the
22483decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
22484example:
22485.display asis
22486warn ...some conditions...
22487 control = freeze
22488accept ...
22489.endd
495ae4b0
PH
22490This example of \warn\ does not contain \message\, \log@_message\, or
22491\logwrite\, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a log
22492entry.
d43194df
PH
22493.nextp
22494.em
22495If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a \require\
22496verb. For example:
22497.display asis
22498require control = no_multiline_response
22499.nem
22500.endd
495ae4b0
PH
22501.endp
22502
22503.item "delay = <<time>>"
22504.index \-bh-\ option
22505This modifier causes Exim to wait for the time interval before proceeding. The
22506time is given in the usual Exim notation. This modifier may appear in any ACL.
4964e932
PH
22507The delay happens as soon as the modifier is processed. However, when testing
22508Exim using the \-bh-\ option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate
22509message is output instead).
495ae4b0
PH
22510
22511Like \control\, \delay\ can be used with \accept\ or
22512\deny\, for example:
22513.display asis
22514deny ...some conditions...
22515 delay = 30s
22516.endd
4964e932 22517The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
495ae4b0
PH
22518`deny'. Compare this with:
22519.display asis
22520deny delay = 30s
22521 ...some conditions...
22522.endd
22523which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The \delay\ modifier can
22524also be used with \warn\ and together with \control\:
22525.display
22526warn ...some conditions...
22527 delay = 2m
22528 control = freeze
22529accept ...
22530.endd
22531
22532.item endpass
22533This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in \accept\
22534statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose failure causes
22535control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose failure causes
22536the ACL to return `deny'. See the description of \accept\ above.
22537
22538.item "log@_message = <<text>>"
22539This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
4964e932 22540ACL denies access or a \warn\ statement's conditions are true. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
22541.display asis
22542require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
22543 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
22544.endd
22545\log@_message\ adds to any underlying error message that may exist because of
22546the condition failure. For example, while verifying a recipient address, a
22547:::fail:: redirection might have already set up a message. Although the message
22548is usually defined before the conditions to which it applies, the expansion
22549does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be denied. This means that
22550any variables that are set by the condition are available for inclusion in the
22551message. For example, the \$dnslist@_<<xxx>>$\ variables are set after a DNS
4964e932 22552black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of \log@_message\ fails, or if the
495ae4b0
PH
22553result is an empty string, the modifier is ignored.
22554
22555If you want to use a \warn\ statement to log the result of an address
22556verification, you can use \$acl__verify__message$\ to include the verification
22557error message.
22558
495ae4b0
PH
22559If \log@_message\ is used with a \warn\ statement, `Warning:' is added to the
22560start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested more
22561than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is actually
22562logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use \logwrite\ instead of
22563\log@_message\. In the absence of \log@_message\ and \logwrite\, nothing is
22564logged for a succesful \warn\ statement.
495ae4b0
PH
22565
22566If \log@_message\ is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
22567example, from the failure of address verification), but \message\ is present,
22568the \message\ text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
22569logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
22570both \log@_message\ and \message\, a default built-in message is used for
22571logging rejections.
22572
22573.item "logwrite = <<text>>"
22574.index log||in ACL, immediate
22575This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
4964e932
PH
22576processing an ACL. (Compare \log@_message\, which, except in the case of
22577\warn\, is used only if the ACL statement denies access.) The \logwrite\
22578modifier can be used to log special incidents in ACLs. For example:
22579.display
495ae4b0
PH
22580accept <<some special conditions>>
22581 control = freeze
22582 logwrite = froze message because ...
22583.endd
22584By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
22585with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
22586another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
22587example:
22588.display asis
22589logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
22590logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
22591.endd
22592
22593.item "message = <<text>>"
22594This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as an error
4964e932
PH
22595message if the current statement causes the ACL to deny access. The expansion
22596happens at the time Exim decides that access is to be denied, not at the time
495ae4b0
PH
22597it processes \message\. If the expansion fails, or generates an empty string,
22598the modifier is ignored. For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the
22599message is returned as part of the SMTP error response.
22600
22601The \message\ modifier is also used with the \warn\ verb to specify one or more
4964e932
PH
22602header lines to be added to an incoming message when all the conditions are
22603true. See section ~~SECTaddheadwarn for more details. If \message\ is used with
22604\warn\ in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
22605effect.
495ae4b0
PH
22606
22607The text is literal; any quotes are taken as literals, but because the string
22608is expanded, backslash escapes are processed anyway. If the message contains
22609newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP response. Like \log@_message\,
22610the contents of \message\ are not expanded until after a condition has failed.
22611
4964e932
PH
22612If \message\ is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
22613specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
495ae4b0
PH
22614However, the original message is available in the variable
22615\$acl@_verify@_message$\, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
22616wish. In particular, if you want the text from \:fail:\ items in \%redirect%\
22617routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
22618use a \message\ modifier, or make use of \$acl@_verify@_message$\.
22619
22620.item "set <<acl@_name>> = <<value>>"
4964e932 22621This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
495ae4b0
PH
22622~~SECTaclvariables).
22623
22624.enditems
22625
22626
4964e932
PH
22627.em
22628.section Use of the control modifier
22629.rset SECTcontrols "~~chapter.~~section"
22630.index \control\ modifier
22631The \control\ modifier supports the following settings:
22632
22633.startitems
22634
22635.item "control = caseful@_local@_part"
22636.item "control = caselower@_local@_part"
22637.index ~~ACL||case of local part in
22638.index case of local parts
22639These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_rcpt\
22640(that is, during \\RCPT\\ processing). By default, the contents of
22641\$local@_part$\ are lower cased before ACL processing. If
22642`caseful@_local@_part' is specified, any uppercase letters in the original
22643local part are restored in \$local@_part$\ for the rest of the ACL, or until a
d43194df
PH
22644control that sets `caselower@_local@_part' is encountered.
22645
22646This control affects only the current recipient. Moreover, it applies only to
22647local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
22648in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
22649handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
22650configuration (see the \caseful@_local@_part\ generic router option).
4964e932
PH
22651
22652This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
22653containing upper case letters. For example, using \$acl@_m4$\ to accumulate the
22654spam score:
22655.display asis
22656warn control = caseful_local_part
22657 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
22658 $acl_m4 + \
22659 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
22660 }
22661 control = caselower_local_part
22662.endd
22663Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
22664is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
22665
22666.item "control = enforce@_sync"
22667.item "control = no@_enforce@_sync"
22668.index SMTP||synchronization checking
22669.index synchronization checking in SMTP
22670These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
22671is enforced. The global option \smtp@_enforce@_sync\ specifies the initial
22672state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
22673in chapter ~~CHAPmainconfig for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
22674
d43194df
PH
22675The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22676connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
4964e932
PH
22677messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
22678\acl@_smtp@_connect\, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
22679before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
22680synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
22681work with.
22682
22683.item "control = fakereject/<<message>>"
22684.index fake rejection
22685.index rejection, fake
22686This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and \\DATA\\ ACLs,
22687in other words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts
22688the message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
d43194df
PH
22689However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
22690only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
22691the same SMTP connection.
4964e932
PH
22692
22693The text for the 550 response is taken from the \control\ modifier. If no
22694message is supplied, the following is used:
22695.display asis
22696550-Your message has been rejected but is being
22697550-kept for evaluation.
d43194df 22698550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
4964e932
PH
22699550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
22700.endd
22701This facilty should be used with extreme caution.
22702
22703
22704.item "control = freeze"
22705.index frozen messages||forcing in ACL
22706This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and
22707non-SMTP ACLs, in other words, only when a message is being received. If the
d43194df
PH
22708message is accepted, it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control
22709applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be
22710received in the same SMTP connection.
22711
22712
22713.item "control = no@_mbox@_unspool"
22714This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
22715extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
22716of it, to be written in `mbox format' to a spool file, for passing to a virus
22717or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
22718needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control
22719applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be
22720received in the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and
22721is unlikely to be useful in production.
4964e932
PH
22722
22723
22724.item "control = no@_multiline@_response"
22725.index multiline responses, suppressing
22726This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
22727It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
22728SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
22729
22730If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
22731suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
22732one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
22733(`use multiline responses for more' it says -- ha!), and some of the responses
22734might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a sop to
22735broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
22736.numberpars
d43194df
PH
22737Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
22738sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically `sender
22739verification failed') is sent.
4964e932
PH
22740.nextp
22741If a \message\ modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
22742line is output.
22743.endp
22744The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
d43194df 22745calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
4964e932
PH
22746
22747
22748.item "control = queue@_only"
22749.index \queue@_only\
22750.index queueing incoming messages
22751This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and
22752non-SMTP ACLs, in other words, only when a message is being received. If the
22753message is accepted, it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery
22754by a subsequent queue runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In
d43194df
PH
22755other words, it has the effect as the \queue@_only\ global option. However, the
22756control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
22757may be received in the same SMTP connection.
4964e932
PH
22758
22759
22760.item "control = submission/<<options>>"
22761.index message||submission
22762.index submission mode
22763This control is permitted only for the \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and start of data
22764ACLs (the latter is the one defined by \acl@_smtp@_predata\). Setting it tells
d43194df
PH
22765Exim that the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case,
22766Exim operates in `submission mode', and applies certain fixups to the message
22767if necessary. For example, it add a ::Date:: header line if one is not present.
22768This control is not permitted in the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL, because that is too
22769late (the message has already been created).
4964e932
PH
22770
22771Chapter ~~CHAPmsgproc describes the processing that Exim applies to messages.
22772Section ~~SECTsubmodnon covers the processing that happens in submission mode;
d43194df
PH
22773the available options for this control are described there. The control applies
22774only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
22775the same SMTP connection.
4964e932
PH
22776
22777.enditems
22778.nem
22779
22780
22781.em
22782.section Adding header lines with the warn verb
22783.rset SECTaddheadwarn "~~chapter.~~section"
22784.index header lines||adding in an ACL
22785.index header lines||position of added lines
22786The \message\ modifier can be used on a \warn\ statement to add an extra header
22787line to an incoming message, as in this example:
22788.display asis
22789warn message = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
22790 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
22791 dialup.mail-abuse.org
22792.endd
22793If an identical header line is requested several times (provoked, for example,
22794by multiple \\RCPT\\ commands), only one copy is actually added to the message.
22795If the text of the \message\ modifier contains one or more newlines that are
22796not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
22797lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; \"X-ACL-Warn:"\ is added to the
22798front of any line that is not a valid header line.
22799
22800By default, new lines are added at the end of the existing header lines.
22801However, you can specify that any particular header line should be added right
22802at the start (before all the ::Received:: lines), immediately after the first
22803block of ::Received:: lines, or immediately before any line that is not a
22804::Received:: or ::Resent-something:: header.
22805
22806This is done by specifying `:at@_start:', `:after@_received:', or
22807`:at@_start@_rfc:' (or, for completeness, `:at@_end:') before the text of the
22808header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
22809to be a header name first.) For example:
22810.display asis
22811warn message = :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
22812.endd
22813
22814If more than one header is supplied in a single warn statement, each one is
22815treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If you add
22816more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they will
22817end up in reverse order.
22818
22819\**Warning**\: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
22820added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
22821system filter or in a router or transport.
22822
22823.index header lines||added, visibility of
22824Header lines that are added by an ACL at \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ time are not
22825visible in string expansions in ACLs for subsequent \\RCPT\\ commands or in the
22826\acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACL. However, they are visible in string expansions in the
22827ACL that is run after \\DATA\\ is complete (the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL). This is
22828also true for header lines that are added in the \acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACL.
22829If a message is rejected after \\DATA\\, all added header lines are included in
22830the entry that is written to the reject log.
22831
22832If you want to preserve data between \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and the
22833\acl@_smtp@_predata\ ACLs, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
22834~~SECTaclvariables.
22835.nem
22836
495ae4b0
PH
22837
22838
22839.section ACL conditions
22840.rset SECTaclconditions "~~chapter.~~section"
22841.index ~~ACL||conditions, list of
4964e932
PH
22842.em
22843Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
22844compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
22845for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
22846content scanning in chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22847.nem
22848
495ae4b0
PH
22849Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
22850senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
22851result of the arrival of an \\ETRN\\ command, and checks on message headers can
4964e932
PH
22852be done only in the ACLs specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\ and \acl__not__smtp\.
22853You can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in
22854the same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an `and' conjunction.
495ae4b0
PH
22855The conditions are as follows:
22856
22857.startitems
22858
22859.item "acl = <<name of acl or ACL string or file name >>"
22860.index ~~ACL||nested
22861.index ~~ACL||indirect
22862The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
22863\acl@_smtp@_$it{xxx}\ options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
4964e932
PH
22864`accept' the condition is true; if it returns `deny' the condition is false. If
22865it returns `defer', the current ACL returns `defer'
22866.em
22867unless the condition is on a \warn\ verb. In that case, a `defer' return makes
22868the condition false. This means that further processing of the \warn\ verb
22869ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
22870.nem
22871
22872If the nested \acl\ returns `drop' and the outer condition denies access,
22873the connection is dropped. If it returns `discard', the verb must be \accept\
22874or \discard\, and the action is taken immediately -- no further conditions are
22875tested.
495ae4b0
PH
22876
22877ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
4964e932 22878loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
495ae4b0
PH
22879circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle \\RCPT\\
22880commands for different local users or different local domains.
22881
22882.item "authenticated = <<string list>>"
22883.index authentication||ACL checking
22884.index ~~ACL||testing for authentication
22885If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
22886the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
22887authentication by any authenticator, you can set
22888.display asis
22889authenticated = *
22890.endd
22891
22892.item "condition = <<string>>"
22893.index customizing||ACL condition
22894.index ~~ACL||customized test
d43194df 22895.index ~~ACL||testing, customized
495ae4b0
PH
22896This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
22897expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
22898`no' or `false', the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero number,
22899or one of the strings `yes' or `true', the condition is true. For any other
22900values, some error is assumed to have occured, and the ACL returns `defer'.
22901
4964e932
PH
22902
22903.em
22904.item "decode = <<location>>"
22905This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
22906content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only the the ACL defined by
22907\acl@_smtp@_mime\. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
22908For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22909.nem
22910
22911
495ae4b0
PH
22912.item "dnslists = <<list of domain names and other data>>"
22913.index DNS list||in ACL
22914.index black list (DNS)
22915.index ~~ACL||testing a DNS list
22916This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
22917`RBL lists', after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the use
4964e932
PH
22918of the lists at \*mail-abuse.org*\ now carries a charge.
22919There are too many different variants of this condition to describe briefly
495ae4b0
PH
22920here. See sections ~~SECTmorednslists--~~SECTmorednslistslast for details.
22921
22922.item "domains = <<domain list>>"
22923.index domain||ACL checking
22924.index ~~ACL||testing a recipient domain
22925This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It checks that the
22926domain of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack
22927processing is enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check
22928succeeds with a lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in \$domain@_data$\
22929until the next \domains\ test.
22930
22931.item "encrypted = <<string list>>"
22932.index encryption||checking in an ACL
22933.index ~~ACL||testing for encryption
22934If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
22935name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
22936encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
22937.display asis
22938encrypted = *
22939.endd
22940
22941.item "hosts = << host list>>"
22942.index host||ACL checking
22943.index ~~ACL||testing the client host
22944This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
22945name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
22946you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
22947.display asis
22948accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
22949.endd
22950The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
22951It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
22952item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
22953compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
22954\accept\ statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
22955IP address is 10.9.8.7.
22956
22957If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
22958address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
22959.display asis
22960accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
22961accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
22962.endd
22963The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
22964is not in the list, so the first \accept\ statement fails. The second statement
22965can then check the IP address.
22966
22967If a \hosts\ condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
22968of the lookup is made available in the \$host@_data$\ variable. This
22969allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
22970.display asis
22971deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
22972 message = $host_data
22973.endd
22974which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
22975
22976.item "local@_parts = <<local part list>>"
22977.index local part||ACL checking
22978.index ~~ACL||testing a local part
22979This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It checks that the
22980local part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing
22981is enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup,
22982the result of the lookup is placed in \$local@_part@_data$\ until the next
22983\local@_parts\ test.
22984
4964e932
PH
22985
22986.em
22987.item "malware = <<option>>"
d43194df
PH
22988.index ~~ACL||virus scanning
22989.index ~~ACL||scanning for viruses
4964e932
PH
22990This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
22991content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
22992viruses. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
22993.nem
22994
22995
22996.em
22997.item "mime@_regex = <<list of regular expressions>>"
d43194df 22998.index ~~ACL||testing by regex matching
4964e932
PH
22999This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23000content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only the the ACL defined by
23001\acl@_smtp@_mime\. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
23002with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
23003.nem
23004
23005
495ae4b0
PH
23006.item "recipients = <<address list>>"
23007.index recipient||ACL checking
23008.index ~~ACL||testing a recipient
23009This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It checks the entire
23010recipient address against a list of recipients.
23011
4964e932
PH
23012
23013.em
23014.item "regex = <<list of regular expressions>>"
d43194df 23015.index ~~ACL||testing by regex matching
4964e932
PH
23016This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23017content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned
23018for a match with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
23019~~CHAPexiscan.
23020.nem
23021
23022
495ae4b0
PH
23023.item "sender@_domains = <<domain list>>"
23024.index sender||ACL checking
23025.index ~~ACL||testing a sender domain
23026This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
23027domain list.
23028\**Note**\: the domain of the sender address is in
4964e932
PH
23029\$sender@_address@_domain$\. It is \*not*\ put in \$domain$\ during the testing
23030of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing
23031domain lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an
495ae4b0
PH
23032ACL for a \\RCPT\\ command, the recipient's domain (which is in \$domain$\) can
23033be used to influence the sender checking.
23034
23035.item "senders = <<address list>>"
23036.index sender||ACL checking
23037.index ~~ACL||testing a sender
23038This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
23039for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
23040.display asis
23041senders = :
23042.endd
23043
4964e932
PH
23044
23045.em
23046.item "spam = <<username>>"
d43194df 23047.index ~~ACL||scanning for spam
4964e932
PH
23048This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
23049content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
23050SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter ~~CHAPexiscan.
23051.nem
23052
23053
495ae4b0
PH
23054.item "verify = certificate"
23055.index TLS||client certificate verification
23056.index certificate||verification of client
23057.index ~~ACL||certificate verification
d43194df 23058.index ~~ACL||testing a TLS certificate
495ae4b0
PH
23059This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
23060certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
23061server requests a certificate only if the client matches \tls@_verify@_hosts\
23062or \tls@_try@_verify@_hosts\ (see chapter ~~CHAPTLS).
23063
23064.item "verify = header@_sender/<<options>>"
23065.index ~~ACL||verifying sender in the header
23066.index header lines||verifying the sender in
23067.index sender||verifying in header
23068.index verifying||sender in header
23069This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
4964e932
PH
23070received, that is, in an ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\
23071.em
23072or \acl@_not@_smtp\. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least
23073one of the ::Sender::, ::Reply-To::, or ::From:: header lines. Such an address
23074is loosely thought of as a `sender' address (hence the name of the test).
23075However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
23076that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
23077to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
23078might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the \\MAIL\\ command.
23079.nem
23080
23081Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
23082section ~~SECTaddressverification (callouts are described in section
23083~~SECTcallver). You can combine this condition with the \senders\ condition to
23084restrict it to bounce messages only:
495ae4b0
PH
23085.display asis
23086deny senders = :
23087 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
23088 !verify = header_sender
23089.endd
23090
23091.item "verify = header@_syntax"
23092.index ~~ACL||verifying header syntax
23093.index header lines||verifying syntax
23094.index verifying||header syntax
23095This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
23096received, that is, in an ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_data\
23097or \acl@_not@_smtp\.
23098It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain lists of addresses
4964e932 23099(::Sender::, ::From::, ::Reply-To::, ::To::, ::Cc::, and ::Bcc::).
495ae4b0
PH
23100Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are permitted only in
23101locally generated messages and from hosts that match
23102\sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ or \recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\, as
23103appropriate.
23104
23105Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
23106ploy is to send syntactically invalid headers such as
23107.display asis
23108To: @
23109.endd
23110and this condition can be used to reject such messages.
23111
23112.item "verify = helo"
23113.index ~~ACL||verifying HELO/EHLO
23114.index \\HELO\\||verifying
23115.index \\EHLO\\||verifying
23116.index verifying||\\EHLO\\
23117.index verifying||\\HELO\\
23118This condition is true if a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command has been received from
23119the client host, and its contents have been verified. Verification of these
23120commands does not happen by default. See the description of the
23121\helo@_verify@_hosts\ and \helo@_try@_verify@_hosts\ options for details of how
23122to request it.
23123
23124.item "verify = recipient/<<options>>"
23125.index ~~ACL||verifying recipient
23126.index recipient||verifying
23127.index verifying||recipient
23128This condition is relevant only after a \\RCPT\\ command. It verifies the
23129current recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at
23130section ~~SECTaddressverification. After a recipient has been verified, the
23131value of \$address@_data$\ is the last value that was set while routing the
23132address. This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is
23133being verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with
23134the new address, and in that case, the subsequent value of \$address@_data$\ is
23135the value for the child address.
23136
23137
23138.item "verify = reverse@_host@_lookup"
23139.index ~~ACL||verifying host reverse lookup
23140.index host||verifying reverse lookup
23141This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
23142address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
23143was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched \host@_lookup\.)
23144Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
23145one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
23146original IP address.
23147
4964e932 23148If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
495ae4b0
PH
23149is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
23150
23151
23152.item "verify = sender/<<options>>"
23153.index ~~ACL||verifying sender
23154.index sender||verifying
23155.index verifying||sender
d43194df
PH
23156This condition is relevant only after a \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ command, or after
23157a message has been received (the \acl@_smtp@_data\ or \acl@_not@_smtp\ ACLs).
495ae4b0 23158If the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
d43194df
PH
23159condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
23160.em
23161If there is data in the \$address@_data$\ variable at the end of routing, its
23162value is placed in \$sender__address__data$\ at the end of verification. This
23163value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
23164statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
23165want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
23166
23167Details of verification are given later, starting at section
23168~~SECTaddressverification. Exim caches the result of sender verification, to
23169avoid doing it more than once per message.
495ae4b0
PH
23170
23171.item "verify = sender=address/<<options>>"
23172This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
23173verified as a sender.
23174
23175.enditems
23176
23177
23178
23179.section Using DNS lists
23180.rset SECTmorednslists "~~chapter.~~section"
23181.index DNS list||in ACL
23182.index black list (DNS)
23183.index ~~ACL||testing a DNS list
23184In its simplest form, the \dnslists\ condition tests whether the calling host
4964e932
PH
23185is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
23186address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
23187address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
495ae4b0
PH
23188.display asis
23189deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
23190 dialups.mail-abuse.org
23191.endd
4964e932 23192the following records are looked up:
495ae4b0
PH
23193.display asis
2319443.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
4964e932
PH
2319543.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
23196.endd
23197.em
23198As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
23199Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an `or' conjunction. If you want to
23200test that a host is on more than one list (an `and' conjunction), you can use
23201two separate conditions:
23202.display asis
23203deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23204 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
495ae4b0 23205.endd
4964e932 23206.nem
495ae4b0 23207If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
4964e932
PH
23208behaves as if the host
23209.em
23210does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS record does not exist. If
23211there are further items in the DNS list, they are processed.
23212.nem
23213This is usually the required action when \dnslists\ is used with \deny\ (which
23214is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from blocking
23215mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the following
23216special items in the list:
495ae4b0
PH
23217.index \"+include@_unknown"\
23218.index \"+exclude@_unknown"\
23219.index \"+defer@_unknown"\
23220.display
23221+include@_unknown $rm{behave as if the item is on the list}
23222+exclude@_unknown $rm{behave as if the item is not on the list (default)}
23223+defer@_unknown $rm{give a temporary error}
23224.endd
23225Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
23226.display asis
23227deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
23228.endd
23229
23230Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
23231warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
23232.display asis
23233deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23234warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
23235 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
23236.endd
23237
23238DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
23239so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
23240connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
23241connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
23242
23243
4964e932
PH
23244.em
23245.section Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup
23246.index DNS list||keyed by explicit IP address
23247By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
23248of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
23249after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
23250.display asis
23251deny dnslists = black.list.tls/192.168.1.2
23252.endd
23253This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
23254use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
23255MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
23256~~SECTmulkeyfor below.
23257.nem
23258
23259
495ae4b0 23260.section DNS lists keyed on domain names
4964e932 23261.index DNS list||keyed by domain name
495ae4b0
PH
23262There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
23263addresses (see for example the \*domain based zones*\ link at
4964e932
PH
23264\?http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/?\). No reversing of components is used with
23265these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by listing
23266it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
495ae4b0
PH
23267.display asis
23268deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
23269 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
23270.endd
23271This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
23272\\RCPT\\ or \\DATA\\ commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
23273example) the message's sender is \*user@@tld.example*\ the name that is looked
23274up by this example is
23275.display asis
23276tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
23277.endd
4964e932
PH
23278.em
23279A single \dnslists\ condition can contain entries for both names and IP
23280addresses. For example:
23281.display asis
23282deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
23283 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
23284.endd
23285The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
23286name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
23287.nem
23288
23289
23290.em
23291.section Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list
23292.rset SECTmulkeyfor "~~chapter.~~section"
23293.index DNS list||multiple keys for
23294The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
23295names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
23296name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
23297As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
23298this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
23299either to double the separators like this:
23300.display asis
23301dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
23302.endd
23303or to change the separator character, like this:
23304.display asis
23305dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
23306.endd
23307If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
23308blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
23309occurs. Consider this condition:
23310.display asis
23311dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
23312.endd
23313The DNS lookups that occur are:
23314.display asis
233152.1.168.192.black.list.tld
23316a.domain.black.list.tld
23317.endd
23318Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
23319address, if specified -- see section ~~SECTaddmatcon), no further lookups are
23320done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains or
23321IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
23322only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
23323successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
23324error for a previous item.
23325
23326The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
23327syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
23328.display asis
23329dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
23330dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
23331.endd
23332However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
23333is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
23334.display asis
23335deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
23336 $sender_address_domain \
23337 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
23338 see $dnslist_text.
23339 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
23340 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
23341 $sender_address_domain} }} }
23342.endd
23343Note the use of \">|"\ in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
23344multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
23345and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
23346of expanding the condition might be something like this:
23347.display asis
23348dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
23349.endd
23350Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
23351domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
23352.nem
23353
23354
495ae4b0
PH
23355
23356.section Data returned by DNS lists
4964e932 23357.index DNS list||data returned from
495ae4b0
PH
23358DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
23359just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
23360RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
23361The values used on the RBL+ list are:
23362.display rm
23363.tabs 12
23364127.1.0.1 $t RBL
23365127.1.0.2 $t DUL
23366127.1.0.3 $t DUL and RBL
23367127.1.0.4 $t RSS
23368127.1.0.5 $t RSS and RBL
23369127.1.0.6 $t RSS and DUL
23370127.1.0.7 $t RSS and DUL and RBL
23371.endd
23372Some DNS lists may return more than one address record.
23373
23374.section Variables set from DNS lists
4964e932 23375.index DNS list||variables set from
495ae4b0
PH
23376When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable \$dnslist@_domain$\
23377contains the name of the domain that matched, \$dnslist@_value$\ contains the
23378data from the entry, and \$dnslist@_text$\ contains the contents of any
23379associated TXT record. If more than one address record is returned by the DNS
23380lookup, all the IP addresses are included in \$dnslist@_value$\, separated by
23381commas and spaces.
23382
23383You can use these variables in \message\ or \log@_message\ modifiers --
23384although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not expanded
23385until after it has failed. For example:
23386.display asis
23387deny hosts = !+local_networks
23388 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
23389 at $dnslist_domain
23390 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
23391.endd
23392
23393
23394.section Additional matching conditions for DNS lists
4964e932
PH
23395.rset SECTaddmatcon "~~chapter.~~section"
23396.index DNS list||matching specific returned data
23397You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a \dnslists\ domain name in
23398order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
23399For example,
495ae4b0
PH
23400.display asis
23401deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
23402.endd
23403rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
23404any address record is considered to be a match. If more than one address record
23405is found on the list, they are all checked for a matching right-hand side.
23406
495ae4b0
PH
23407More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
23408separator. These are alternatives -- if any one of them matches, the \dnslists\
23409condition is true. For example:
23410.display asis
23411deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23412.endd
23413
4964e932
PH
23414If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
23415addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
23416first. For example:
23417.display asis
23418deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
23419 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
23420.endd
23421
495ae4b0
PH
23422If the character `&' is used instead of `=', the comparison for each listed
23423IP address is done by a bitwise `and' instead of by an equality test. In
23424other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
23425true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
23426tested. For example:
23427.display asis
23428dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
23429.endd
23430matches if the address is \*x.x.x.*\3, \*x.x.x.*\7, \*x.x.x.*\11, etc. If you
23431want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
23432being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
23433.display asis
23434dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
23435.endd
23436matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
23437an odd number.
23438
23439
23440.section Negated DNS matching conditions
23441You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a \dnslists\
23442condition. Whereas
23443.display asis
23444deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23445.endd
23446means `deny if the host is in the black list at the domain \*a.b.c*\ and the IP
23447address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3',
23448.display asis
23449deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23450.endd
23451means `deny if the host is in the black list at the domain \*a.b.c*\ and the IP
23452address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3'. In other
23453words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
23454the `=' (or the `&') sign.
23455
23456\**Note**\: this kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
23457host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
23458
23459If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
23460previous example is precisely equivalent to
23461.display asis
23462deny dnslists = a.b.c
23463 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
23464.endd
23465However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
23466Consider this example:
23467.display asis
23468deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
23469 list.dsbl.org : \
23470 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
23471 relays.ordb.org
23472.endd
23473Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
23474.display asis
23475deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
23476 list.dsbl.org
23477deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
23478 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
23479deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
23480.endd
23481which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
23482
23483
23484
23485.section DNS lists and IPv6
23486.rset SECTmorednslistslast "~~chapter.~~section"
4964e932
PH
23487.index IPv6||DNS black lists
23488.index DNS list||IPv6 usage
23489If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
495ae4b0
PH
23490nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
234913ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
23492.display asis
234931.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
23494 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
23495.endd
23496(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
23497lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
23498IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
23499.display asis
23500*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
23501.endd
4964e932
PH
23502is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
23503Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3@:@:/4 IPv6 network.
495ae4b0 23504
4964e932 23505You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
495ae4b0
PH
23506\condition\ condition, as in this example:
23507.display asis
4964e932
PH
23508.newline
23509.em
23510deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
23511.nem
23512.newline
23513 dnslists = some.list.example
495ae4b0
PH
23514.endd
23515
23516
23517.section Address verification
23518.rset SECTaddressverification "~~chapter.~~section"
23519.index verifying||address, options for
23520.index policy control||address verification
23521Several of the \verify\ conditions described in section ~~SECTaclconditions
23522cause addresses to be verified. These conditions can be followed by options
23523that modify the verification process. The options are separated from the
23524keyword and from each other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters.
23525For example:
23526.display asis
23527verify = sender/callout
23528verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
23529.endd
4964e932
PH
23530.em
23531The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
23532address through the routers, in `verify mode'. Routers can detect the
23533difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
23534be varied by a number of generic options such as \verify\ and \verify@_only\
23535(see chapter ~~CHAProutergeneric). If routing fails, verification fails.
23536The available options are as follows:
23537.numberpars $.
23538If the \callout\ option is specified, successful routing to one or more remote
23539hosts is followed by a `callout' to those hosts as an additional check.
23540Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
23541.nextp
23542If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
495ae4b0 23543normally returns `defer'. However, if you include \defer@_ok\ in the options,
4964e932
PH
23544the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
23545verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
23546.nextp
23547The \no@_details\ option is covered in section ~~SECTsenaddver, which discusses
23548the reporting of sender address verification failures.
23549.endp
23550
23551.index verifying||address, differentiating failures
23552After an address verification failure, \$sender@_verify@_failure$\ or
23553\$recipient@_verify@_failure$\ (as appropriate) contains one of the following
23554words:
23555.numberpars $.
23556\qualify\: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
23557was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
23558.nextp
23559\route\: Routing failed.
23560.nextp
23561\mail\: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
23562occurred at or before the \\MAIL\\ command (that is, on initial
23563connection, \\HELO\\, or \\MAIL\\).
23564.nextp
23565\recipient\: The \\RCPT\\ command in a callout was rejected.
23566.nextp
23567\postmaster\: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
23568.endp
23569
23570The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
23571rejections of \\MAIL\\ and rejections of \\RCPT\\ in callouts.
23572
23573.nem
23574
495ae4b0
PH
23575
23576.section Callout verification
23577.rset SECTcallver "~~chapter.~~section"
23578.index verifying||address, by callout
23579.index callout||verification
23580.index SMTP||callout verification
23581For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
23582checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
23583the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
23584\*callback*\ to the sending host (for a sender address) or a \*callforward*\ to
23585a subsequent host (for a recipient address), to see if the host accepts the
23586address. We use the term \*callout*\ to cover both cases. This facility should
23587be used with care, because it can add a lot of resource usage to the cost of
23588verifying an address. However, Exim does cache the results of callouts, which
23589helps to reduce the cost. Details of caching are in the next section.
23590
4964e932
PH
23591Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
23592the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
495ae4b0 23593callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver.
4964e932
PH
23594A successful callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address
23595would succeed; on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that
495ae4b0
PH
23596a delivery would fail.
23597
23598If the \callout\ option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
23599second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
23600one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a \%dnslookup%\ or a
4964e932
PH
23601\%manualroute%\ router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
23602router that does not set up hosts routes to an \%smtp%\ transport with a
495ae4b0
PH
23603\hosts\ setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an \%smtp%\ transport has
23604\hosts@_override\ set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
23605supplies a host list.
23606
23607The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
23608remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
4964e932
PH
23609specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
23610specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
495ae4b0
PH
23611specified.
23612
23613For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
23614test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
23615following SMTP commands are sent:
23616.display
4964e932
PH
23617.newline
23618.em
23619HELO <<smtp active host name>>
23620.nem
23621.newline
495ae4b0
PH
23622MAIL FROM:@<@>
23623RCPT TO:<<the address to be tested>>
23624QUIT
23625.endd
23626\\LHLO\\ is used instead of \\HELO\\ if the transport's \protocol\ option is
4964e932 23627set to `lmtp'.
495ae4b0 23628
4964e932
PH
23629A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
23630for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
23631the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
23632that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
23633do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
23634\use@_sender\ and \use@_postmaster\ options, described in the next section.
495ae4b0
PH
23635
23636If the response to the \\RCPT\\ command is a 2$it{xx} code, the verification
23637succeeds. If it is 5$it{xx}, the verification fails. For any other condition,
23638Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
23639hosts, the ACL yields `defer', unless the \defer@_ok\ parameter of the
23640\callout\ option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
23641
23642
4964e932
PH
23643
23644
495ae4b0
PH
23645.section Additional parameters for callouts
23646.rset CALLaddparcall "~~chapter.~~section"
4964e932 23647.index callout||additional parameters for
495ae4b0
PH
23648The \callout\ option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of optional
23649parameters, separated by commas. For example:
23650.display asis
23651verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
23652.endd
23653The old syntax, which had \callout@_defer@_ok\ and \check@_postmaster\ as
23654separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
23655deprecated. The additional parameters for \callout\ are as follows:
23656
4964e932
PH
23657.startitems
23658
23659.item "<<a time interval>>"
23660.index callout||timeout, specifying
23661This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
23662For example:
495ae4b0
PH
23663.display asis
23664verify = sender/callout=5s
23665.endd
23666The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
23667remote host.
4964e932
PH
23668.em
23669It is also used for the intial connection, unless overridden by the \connect\
23670parameter.
23671.nem
23672
23673.em
23674.item "connect = <<time interval>>"
23675.index callout||connection timeout, specifying
23676This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually
23677smaller) timeout for making the SMTP connection.
23678For example:
23679.display asis
23680verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
23681.endd
23682If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
23683.nem
23684
23685.item "defer@_ok"
495ae4b0 23686.index callout||defer, action on
4964e932
PH
23687When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
23688of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
23689updated in this circumstance.
23690
23691.em
23692.item "mailfrom = <<email address>>"
23693.index callout||sender when verifying header
23694When verifying addresses in header lines using the \header@_sender\
23695verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
23696sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
23697whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
23698\\MAIL\\ command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be
23699used as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce
23700messages (empty senders). The \mailfrom\ callout parameter allows you to
23701specify what address to use in the \\MAIL\\ command. For example:
23702.display asis
23703require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
23704.endd
23705This parameter is available only for the \header@_sender\ verification option.
23706.nem
23707
23708.em
23709.item "maxwait = <<time interval>>"
23710.index callout||overall timeout, specifying
23711This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
23712For example:
23713.display asis
23714verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
23715.endd
23716This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
23717commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
23718be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
23719very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
23720(for example, when network connections are timing out).
23721.nem
23722
23723.item "no@_cache"
495ae4b0
PH
23724.index callout||cache, suppressing
23725.index caching||callout, suppressing
4964e932
PH
23726When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
23727
23728.item "postmaster"
495ae4b0 23729.index callout||postmaster, checking
4964e932
PH
23730When this parameter is set, a sucessful callout check is followed by a similar
23731check for the local part \*postmaster*\ at the same domain. If this address is
23732rejected, the callout fails. The result of the postmaster check is recorded in
23733a cache record; if it is a failure, this is used to fail subsequent callouts
23734for the domain without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
23735
23736.em
23737.item "postmaster@_mailfrom = <<email address>>"
23738The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the \\MAIL\\ command by default.
23739You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
23740For example:
23741.display asis
23742require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
23743.endd
23744If both \postmaster\ and \postmaster@_mailfrom\ are present, the rightmost one
23745overrides. The \postmaster\ parameter is equivalent to this example:
23746.display asis
23747require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
23748.endd
23749\**Warning**\: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
23750account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
23751a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
23752postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
23753.nem
23754
23755.item "random"
495ae4b0 23756.index callout||`random' check
4964e932 23757When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
495ae4b0
PH
23758check for a `random' local part at the same domain. The local part is not
23759really random -- it is defined by the expansion of the option
23760\callout@_random@_local@_part\, which defaults to
23761.display asis
23762$primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
23763.endd
23764The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
23765parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
23766specific local parts. If the `random' check succeeds, the result is saved in
23767a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
23768succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
4964e932
PH
23769
23770.item "use@_postmaster"
495ae4b0 23771.index callout||sender for recipient check
4964e932 23772This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
23773.display asis
23774deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
23775.endd
23776It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the \\MAIL\\ command
23777when performing the callout. The local part of the address is \"postmaster"\
23778and the domain is the contents of \$qualify@_domain$\.
4964e932
PH
23779
23780.item "use@_sender"
23781This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
495ae4b0
PH
23782.display asis
23783require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
23784.endd
23785It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the \\MAIL\\
4964e932
PH
23786command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
23787need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
23788sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
23789usefulness of callout caching.
23790
23791.enditems
23792
23793.em
23794If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the \\MAIL\\
23795command (\mailfrom\, \postmaster@_mailfrom\, \use@_postmaster\, or
23796\use@_sender\), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
23797usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
23798that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
23799Therefore, it is normally safe to use \use@_postmaster\ or \use@_sender\ in
23800these circumstances.
23801
23802However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
23803host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
23804callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
23805sender, it is likely to use an empty address in \\MAIL\\, thus avoiding a
23806callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
23807own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
23808is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
23809
23810Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
23811caching. When you set \mailfrom\ or \use@_sender\, the cache record is keyed by
23812the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
23813actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
23814
495ae4b0 23815.nem
495ae4b0
PH
23816
23817
23818.section Callout caching
23819.rset SECTcallvercache "~~chapter.~~section"
23820.index hints database||callout cache
23821.index callout||caching
23822.index caching||callout
4964e932 23823Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
495ae4b0 23824used, unless you specify the \no@_cache\ parameter with the \callout\ option.
4964e932
PH
23825A hints database called `callout' is used for the cache. Two different record
23826types are used: one records the result of a callout check for a specific
495ae4b0
PH
23827address, and the other records information that applies to the entire domain
23828(for example, that it accepts the local part \*postmaster*\).
23829
23830When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
23831the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
23832is not available.
23833
23834The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
23835independent, and can be set by the global options \callout@_negative@_expire\
23836(default 2h) and \callout@_positive@_expire\ (default 24h), respectively.
23837
23838If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
4964e932 23839commands up to and including
495ae4b0
PH
23840.display asis
23841MAIL FROM:<>
23842.endd
495ae4b0 23843(but not including the \\MAIL\\ command with a non-empty address),
495ae4b0
PH
23844any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
23845domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
23846making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
23847separate expiry times for domain cache records:
23848\callout@_domain@_negative@_expire\ (default 3h) and
23849\callout__domain__positive@_expire\ (default 7d).
23850
23851Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
23852cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
23853Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
23854ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting `random' local parts
23855will eventually be noticed.
23856
4964e932
PH
23857The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
23858being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
23859behaviour will be the same.
495ae4b0
PH
23860
23861
23862.section Sender address verification reporting
4964e932 23863.rset SECTsenaddver "~~chapter.~~section"
495ae4b0
PH
23864.index verifying||suppressing error details
23865When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the failure are
23866given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the relevant
23867SMTP command (\\RCPT\\ or \\DATA\\). For example, if sender callout is in use,
23868you might see:
23869.display asis
23870MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
23871250 OK
23872RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
23873550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
23874550-Called: 192.168.34.43
23875550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
23876550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
23877550 Sender verification failed
23878.endd
23879If more than one \\RCPT\\ command fails in the same way, the details are given
23880only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
23881out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
23882`/no@_details' to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
23883example:
23884.display asis
23885verify = sender/no_details
23886.endd
23887
23888
23889.section Redirection while verifying
23890.index verifying||redirection while
23891.index address redirection||while verifying
23892A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
23893during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
23894or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
23895it? Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
23896.numberpars $.
23897When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
23898continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
23899verification also fails.
23900.nextp
23901When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
23902verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
23903.endp
23904This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
23905way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
23906example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
23907.display asis
23908A.Wol: aw123
23909aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
23910.endd
4964e932
PH
23911work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
23912redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
23913mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
23914verification to succeed.
23915
23916
23917.section Using an ACL to control relaying
23918.rset SECTrelaycontrol "~~chapter.~~section"
23919.index ~~ACL||relay control
23920.index relaying||control by ACL
23921.index policy control||relay control
23922An MTA is said to \*relay*\ a message if it receives it from some host and
23923delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
23924within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
23925passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
23926.index `percent hack'
23927but a redirection as a result of the `percent hack' is.
23928
23929Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed `incoming' and `outgoing'. A host
23930which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
23931relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
23932a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
23933with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
23934same host is fulfilling both functions, as illustrated in the diagram below,
23935but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
23936not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
23937system to arbitrary domains.
23938.if ~~sys.fancy
23939.figure "Controlled relaying" rm
23940.indent 0
23941.call aspic -sgcal -nv
23942centre ~~sys.linelength;
23943magnify 0.8;
23944boundingbox 30;
23945textdepth 16;
23946 boxwidth 120;
23947 boxdepth 44;
23948A: box "Arbitrary" "remote hosts";
23949C: ibox;
23950D: box "Arbitrary" "domains";
23951 iline down 50 from bottom of C;
23952H: box width 180 "Local host";
23953 iline down 50;
23954E: ibox;
23955SH: box "Specific" "hosts";
23956SD: box join right to E "Specific" "domains";
23957 arcarrow clockwise from top of SH to bottom of D plus (-10,-4)
23958 via right of H plus (-20,0);
23959 arcarrow clockwise from bottom of A to top of SD plus (10,4)
23960 via left of H plus (20,0);
23961
23962 ibox join left to right of H "$it{Outgoing}";
23963 goto H;
23964 ibox join right to left of H "$it{Incoming}";
23965
23966L: line dashed from right of A to top of H plus (-15,0);
23967 arc dashed to top of H plus (15,0);
23968 arrow dashed to left of D plus (-2,0);
23969
23970 arrow dashed back up 72 right 32 from middle of L plus (8,0);
23971 text at end plus (0, 4) "$it{Not wanted}";
23972.endcall
23973.endfigure
23974.elif !~~html
23975.display asis
23976 -------------- -----------
23977 | Arbitrary | |Arbitrary|
23978 |remote hosts| | domains |
23979 -------------- -----------
23980 I v ^ O
23981 n v ^ u
23982 c ---v----------------^--- t
23983 o | v Local ^ | g
23984 m | v host ^ | o
23985 i ---v----------------^--- i
23986 n v ^ n
23987 g v ^ g
23988 Specific Specific
23989 domains hosts
23990.endd
23991.else
23992[(IMG SRC="relaying.gif" alt="Controlled relaying")][(br)]
23993.fi
23994
23995You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
23996runs for each \\RCPT\\ command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
23997Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
23998example, suppose you want to do the following:
23999.numberpars $.
24000Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
24001locally in some other way). Let's say these are \*my.dom1.example*\ and
24002\*my.dom2.example*\.
24003.nextp
24004Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
24005These might be \*friend1.example*\ and \*friend2.example*\.
24006.nextp
24007Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
24008Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
24009.endp
24010In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
24011.display asis
24012domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
24013domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
24014hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
24015.endd
24016Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every \\RCPT\\
24017command:
24018.display asis
24019acl_check_rcpt:
24020 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
24021 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
24022.endd
24023The first statement accepts any \\RCPT\\ command that contains an address in
24024the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
24025statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
24026hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
24027than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
24028default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
24029in chapter ~~CHAPdefconfil.
24030
24031
24032.section Checking a relay configuration
24033.rset SECTcheralcon "~~chapter.~~section"
24034.index relaying||checking control of
24035You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
24036that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
24037the \-bh-\ option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24038
24039For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
24040\*relay-test.mail-abuse.org*\ provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
24041host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
24042will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
24043patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
24044trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
24045results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
24046
24047
24048
24049
24050.
24051.
24052.
24053.
24054. ============================================================================
d43194df 24055.chapter Content scanning
4964e932
PH
24056.set runningfoot "content scanning"
24057.rset CHAPexiscan "~~chapter"
24058.index content scanning
24059.em
d43194df
PH
24060The content-scanning extension of Exim, formerly known as `exiscan', was
24061originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code was integrated into
24062the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to maintain it. Most
24063of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's specification.
4964e932
PH
24064
24065If you want to include the content-scanning features when you compile Exim, you
24066need to arrange for \\WITH@_CONTENT@_SCAN\\ to be defined in your
24067\(Local/Makefile)\. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
24068.numberpars $.
24069An additional ACL (\acl@_smtp@_mime\) that is run for all MIME parts.
24070.nextp
24071Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: \decode\, \malware\, \mime@_regex\,
24072\regex\, and \spam\. These can be used in the ACL that is run at the end of
24073message reception (the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL).
24074.nextp
d43194df
PH
24075An additional control feature (`no@_mbox@_unspool') that saves spooled copies
24076of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
24077.nextp
4964e932
PH
24078Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
24079conditions.
24080.nextp
24081Two new main configuration options: \av@_scanner\ and \spamd@_address\.
24082.endp
24083There is another content-scanning configuration option for \(Local/Makefile)\,
24084called \\WITH@_OLD@_DEMIME\\. If this is set, the old, deprecated \demime\ ACL
24085condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
24086
24087Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
24088added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
24089changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
24090\\EXPERIMENTAL@_\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\. Such features are not documented in
24091this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
24092\(doc/experimental.txt)\.
24093
24094All the content-scanning facilites work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
24095temporarily created in a file called:
24096.display
24097<<spool@_directory>>/scan/<<message@_id>>/<<message@_id>>.eml
24098.endd
24099The \(.eml)\ extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
24100expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
9cc891cb
TK
24101first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
24102scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
d43194df
PH
24103removed when the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL has finished running, unless
24104.display asis
24105control = no_mbox_unspool
24106.endd
24107has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
24108same directory by default.
4964e932
PH
24109
24110
24111.section Scanning for viruses
24112.rset SECTscanvirus "~~chapter.~~section"
24113.index virus scanning
24114.index content scanning||for viruses
24115.index content scanning||the \malware\ condition
24116The \malware\ ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim. It
24117supports a `generic' interface to scanners called via the shell, and
24118specialized interfaces for `daemon' type virus scanners, which are resident in
24119memory and thus are much faster.
24120
24121.index \av@_scanner\
24122You can set the \av@_scanner\ option in first part of the Exim configuration
24123file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
24124are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
24125.display
24126av@_scanner = <<scanner-type>>:<<option1>>:<<option2>>:[...]
24127.endd
24128If you do not set \av@_scanner\, it defaults to
24129.display asis
24130av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
24131.endd
24132If the value of \av@_scanner\ starts with dollar character, it is expanded
24133before use.
24134
24135The following scanner types are supported in this release:
24136.numberpars $.
24137.index virus scanners||Kaspersky
24138\aveserver\: This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a
24139trial version at \?http://www.kaspersky.com?\. This scanner type takes one
24140option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in
24141this example:
24142.display asis
24143av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
24144.endd
24145
24146.nextp
24147.index virus scanners||clamd
24148\clamd\: This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
d43194df
PH
24149\?http://www.clamav.net/?\. Clamd does not seem to unpack MIME containers, so
24150it is recommended to unpack MIME attachments in the MIME ACL. It takes one
24151option: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
24152number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
4964e932
PH
24153.display asis
24154av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
24155av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
24156.endd
d43194df
PH
24157If the option is unset, the default is \(/tmp/clamd)\. Thanks to David Saez for
24158contributing the code for this scanner.
4964e932
PH
24159
24160.nextp
24161.index virus scanners||command line interface
24162\cmdline\: This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface.
24163It can be used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This
24164scanner type takes 3 mantadory options:
24165.numberpars
24166The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
24167and a placeholder (%s) for the directory to scan.
24168.nextp
24169A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the virus
24170scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make absolutely
24171sure that this expression matches on `virus found'. This is called the
24172`trigger' expression.
24173.nextp
d43194df
PH
24174Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
24175match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
24176`name' expression.
4964e932
PH
24177.endp
24178For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
24179.display asis
24180Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
24181.endd
24182For the trigger expression, we can just match the word `found'. For the name
24183expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match for
24184the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
24185configuration setting:
24186.display asis
24187av_scanner = cmdline:\
24188 /path/to/sweep -all -rec -archive %s:\
24189 found:'(.+)'
24190.endd
24191
24192.nextp
24193.index virus scanners||DrWeb
24194\drweb\: The DrWeb daemon scanner (\?http://www.sald.com/?\) interface
24195takes one argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and
24196port separated by whitespace, as in these examples:
24197.display asis
24198av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
24199av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
24200.endd
24201If you omit the argument, the default path \(/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock)\
24202is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
24203
24204.nextp
24205.index virus scanners||F-Secure
24206\fsecure\: The F-Secure daemon scanner (\?http://www.f-secure.com?\) takes one
24207argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
24208.display asis
24209av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
24210.endd
24211If no argument is given, the default is \(/var/run/.fsav)\. Thanks to Johan
24212Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
24213
24214.nextp
24215.index virus scanners||Kaspersky
24216\kavdaemon\: This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of
24217the Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see \aveserver\ above). This
24218scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
24219For example:
24220.display asis
24221av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
24222.endd
24223The default path is \(/var/run/AvpCtl)\.
24224
24225.nextp
24226.index virus scanners||mksd
24227\mksd\: This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
24228though some parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it
24229at \?http://linux.mks.com.pl/?\. The only option for this scanner type is the
24230maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
24231provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
24232been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
24233.display asis
24234av_scanner = mksd:2
24235.endd
24236You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
24237
24238.nextp
24239.index virus scanners||Sophos and Sophie
24240\sophie\: Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' \libsavi\ library to scan for
24241viruses. You can get Sophie at \?http://www.vanja.com/tools/sophie/?\. The only
24242option for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses
24243for client communication. For example:
24244.display asis
24245av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
24246.endd
24247The default path is \(/var/run/sophie)\, so if you are using this, you can omit
24248the option.
24249.endp
24250
9cc891cb 24251When \av@_scanner\ is correctly set, you can use the \malware\ condition in the
d43194df
PH
24252\\DATA\\ ACL. The \av@_scanner\ option is expanded each time \malware\ is
24253called. This makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for
24254an example. The \malware\ condition caches its results, so when you use it
24255multiple times for the same message, the actual scanning process is only
24256carried out once. However, using expandable items in \av@_scanner\ disables
24257this caching, in which case each use of the \malware\ condition causes a new
24258scan of the message.
24259
24260The \malware\ condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
4964e932
PH
24261use. It can then be one of
24262.numberpars $.
24263`true', `*', or `1', in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
24264condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
24265recommended usage.
24266.nextp
24267`false' or `0', in which case no scanning is done and the condition fails
24268immediately.
24269.nextp
24270A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
24271condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
24272expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
24273.endp
24274You can append \"/defer@_ok"\ to the \malware\ condition to accept messages even
24275if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
24276
24277.index \$malware@_name$\
24278When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
24279\$malware@_name$\ that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
24280\message\ modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
24281logging data.
24282
4964e932
PH
24283If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
24284use the \demime\ condition (see section ~~SECTdemimecond) before the \malware\
24285condition.
24286
24287Here is a very simple scanning example:
24288.display asis
24289deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24290 demime = *
24291 malware = *
24292.endd
24293The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
24294.display asis
24295deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24296 demime = *
24297 malware = */defer_ok
24298.endd
24299The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
24300aveserver. It assumes you have set:
24301.display asis
24302av_scanner = $acl_m0
24303.endd
24304in the main Exim configuration.
24305.display asis
24306deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24307 set acl_m0 = sophie
24308 malware = *
24309
24310deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
24311 set acl_m0 = aveserver
24312 malware = *
24313.endd
4964e932
PH
24314
24315
24316.section Scanning with SpamAssassin
24317.rset SECTscanspamass "~~chapter.~~section"
24318.index content scanning||for spam
24319.index spam scanning
24320.index SpamAssassin, scanning with
24321The \spam\ ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's \spamd\ daemon to get a spam
24322score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
24323\?http://www.spamassassin.org?\, or, if you have a working Perl installation,
24324you can use CPAN by running:
24325.display asis
24326perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
24327.endd
24328SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
24329documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
24330nicely, however.
24331
24332.index \spamd@_address\
24333After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the \spamd\ daemon.
24334By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
24335port for \spamd\, you must set the \spamd@_address\ option in the global part
24336of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
24337.display asis
24338spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
24339.endd
24340You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
24341\spamd\ also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
24342these, supply \spamd@_address\ with an absolute file name instead of a
24343address/port pair:
24344.display asis
24345spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
24346.endd
24347
24348You can have multiple \spamd\ servers to improve scalability. These can reside
24349on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple \spamd\
24350servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the \spamd@_address\ option,
24351separated with colons:
24352.display asis
24353spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
24354 192.168.2.11 783 : \
24355 192.168.2.12 783
24356.endd
24357Up to 32 \spamd\ servers are supported. The servers are
24358queried in a random fashion. When a server fails to respond
24359to the connection attempt, all other servers are tried
24360until one succeeds. If no server responds, the \spam\
24361condition defers.
24362
24363\**Warning**\: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
24364multiple \spamd\ servers.
24365
24366Here is a simple example of the use of the \spam\ condition in a DATA ACL:
24367.display asis
24368deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
24369 spam = joe
24370.endd
24371The right-hand side of the \spam\ condition specifies the username that
24372SpamAssassin should scan for. If you do not want to scan for a particular user,
24373but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide default profile, you can scan for
24374an unknown user, or simply use `nobody'. However, you must put something on the
24375right-hand side.
24376
24377The username allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles. The
24378right-hand side is expanded before being used, so you can put lookups or
24379conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to `0' or `false', no
24380scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
24381
24382The \spam\ condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
24383SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
24384\spam\ condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
24385it always return `true' by appending \":true"\ to the username.
24386
24387.index spam scanning||returned variables
24388When the \spam\ condition is run, it sets up the following expansion
24389variables:
24390
24391.push
24392.indent 2em
24393
24394.tempindent 0
24395\$spam@_score$\: The spam score of the message, for example `3.4' or `30.5'.
24396This is useful for inclusion in log or reject messages.
24397
24398.tempindent 0
24399\$spam@_score@_int$\: The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an
24400integer value. For example `34' or `305'. This is useful for numeric
24401comparisons in conditions. This variable is special; it is saved with the
24402message, and written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used
d43194df 24403during the whole life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in
4964e932
PH
24404routers or transports during the later delivery phase.
24405
24406.tempindent 0
24407\$spam@_bar$\: A string consisting of a number of `+' or `@-' characters,
24408representing the integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4
24409would have a \$spam@_bar$\ value of `++++'. This is useful for inclusion in
24410warning headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
24411
24412.tempindent 0
24413\$spam@_report$\: A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin
24414report for the message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
24415
24416.pop
24417
24418The \spam\ condition caches its results. If you call it again with the same user
24419name, it does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
24420
24421The \spam\ condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running the
24422message through SpamAssassin. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to
24423the next ACL statement block), append \"/defer@_ok"\ to the right-hand side of
24424the spam condition, like this:
24425.display asis
24426deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
24427 spam = joe/defer_ok
24428.endd
24429This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a
24430problem with \spamd\.
24431
24432Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the \spam\
24433condition:
24434.display asis
24435# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
24436warn message = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
24437 spam = nobody:true
24438warn message = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
24439 spam = nobody:true
24440
24441# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
24442# is over threshold
24443warn message = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
24444 spam = nobody
24445
24446# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
24447deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
24448 spam = nobody:true
24449 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
24450.endd
24451
24452
24453
24454.section Scanning MIME parts
24455.rset SECTscanmimepart "~~chapter.~~section"
24456.index content scanning||MIME parts
24457.index MIME content scanning
24458.index \acl@_smtp@_mime\
24459The \acl@_smtp@_mime\ global option defines an ACL that is called once for each
24460MIME part of a message, including multipart types, in the sequence of their
24461position in the message.
24462
24463This ACL is called (possibly many times) just before the \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL,
24464but only if the message has a ::MIME-Version:: header. When a call to the MIME
24465ACL does not yield `accept', ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
24466result code is sent to the remote client. The \acl@_smtp@_data\ ACL is not
24467called in this circumstance.
24468
24469At the start of the MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
24470information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
24471of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
24472parts whose content-type is `message/rfc822'. If you want to decode a MIME part
24473into a disk file, you can use the \decode\ modifier. The general syntax is:
24474.display
24475decode = [/<<path>>/]<<filename>>
24476.endd
24477The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
24478the value can be:
24479.numberpars
24480`0' or `false', in which case no decoding is done.
24481.nextp
24482The string `default'. In that case, the file is put in the temporary `default'
24483directory \(<<spool@_directory>>/scan/<<message@_id>>/)\ with a sequential file
24484name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The full path and name
24485is available in \$mime@_decoded@_filename$\ after decoding.
24486.nextp
24487A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
24488directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
24489is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
24490the full path and file name.
24491.nextp
24492If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
24493filename, and the default path is then used.
24494.endp
24495You can easily decode a file with its original, proposed
24496filename using
24497.display asis
24498decode = $mime_filename
24499.endd
24500However, you should keep in mind that \$mime@_filename$\ might contain
24501anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
24502automatically unlinked.
24503
24504For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
24505content-type of `message/rfc822'), the ACL is called again in the same manner
24506as for the primary message, only that the \$mime@_is@_rfc822$\ expansion
24507variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
24508before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
24509
24510The MIME ACL supports the \regex\ and \mime@_regex\ conditions. These can be
24511used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
24512respectively. They are described in section ~~SECTscanregex.
24513
24514.index MIME content scanning||returned variables
24515The following list describes all expansion variables that are
24516available in the MIME ACL:
24517
24518.push
24519.indent 2em
24520
24521.tempindent 0
24522\$mime@_boundary$\:
24523If the current part is a multipart (see \$mime@_is@_multipart$\) below, it
24524should have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current
24525part has no boundary parameter in the ::Content-Type:: header, this variable
24526contains the empty string.
24527
24528.tempindent 0
24529\$mime@_charset$\:
24530This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
24531::Content-Type:: header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
24532.display asis
24533us-ascii
24534gb2312 (Chinese)
24535iso-8859-1
24536.endd
24537Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
24538case-insensitively.
495ae4b0 24539
4964e932
PH
24540.tempindent 0
24541\$mime@_content@_description$\:
24542This variable contains the normalized content of the ::Content-Description::
24543header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
24544implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are
24545usually only used for display purposes.
495ae4b0 24546
4964e932
PH
24547.tempindent 0
24548\$mime@_content@_disposition$\:
24549This variable contains the normalized content of the ::Content-Disposition::
24550header. You can expect strings like `attachment' or `inline' here.
495ae4b0 24551
4964e932
PH
24552.tempindent 0
24553\$mime@_content@_id$\:
24554This variable contains the normalized content of the ::Content-ID:: header.
24555This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
495ae4b0 24556
4964e932
PH
24557.tempindent 0
24558\$mime@_content@_size$\:
24559This variable is set only after the \decode\ modifier (see above) has been
24560successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
24561size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
24562has a \$mime@_content@_size$\ of zero.
495ae4b0 24563
4964e932
PH
24564.tempindent 0
24565\$mime@_content@_transfer@_encoding$\:
24566This variable contains the normalized content of the
24567::Content-transfer-encoding:: header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
24568type. Typical values are `base64' and `quoted-printable'.
495ae4b0 24569
4964e932
PH
24570.tempindent 0
24571\$mime@_content@_type$\: If the MIME part has a ::Content-Type:: header, this
24572variable contains its value, lowercased, and without any options (like `name'
24573or `charset'). Here are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear
24574in this variable:
495ae4b0 24575.display asis
4964e932
PH
24576text/plain
24577text/html
24578application/octet-stream
24579image/jpeg
24580audio/midi
495ae4b0 24581.endd
4964e932
PH
24582If the MIME part has no ::Content-Type:: header, this variable contains the
24583empty string.
495ae4b0 24584
4964e932
PH
24585.tempindent 0
24586\$mime@_decoded@_filename$\:
24587This variable is set only after the \decode\ modifier (see above) has been
24588successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
24589containing the decoded data.
24590
24591.tempindent 0
24592\$mime@_filename$\: This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables.
24593It contains a proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either
24594the ::Content-Type:: or ::Content-Disposition:: headers. The filename will be
24595RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
24596found, this variable contains the empty string.
24597
24598.tempindent 0
24599\$mime@_is@_coverletter$\:
24600This variable attempts to differentiate the `cover letter' of an e-mail from
24601attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unneccessarily encoded
24602content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
24603
24604The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
24605cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
24606follows:
24607.numberpars
d43194df 24608The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
495ae4b0 24609.nextp
4964e932
PH
24610If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter, so
24611are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
495ae4b0 24612.nextp
4964e932
PH
24613If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
24614and the rest are attachments.
24615.nextp
24616All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
495ae4b0 24617.endp
4964e932
PH
24618
24619As an example, the following will ban `HTML mail' (including that sent with
9cc891cb
TK
24620alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
24621coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
495ae4b0 24622.display asis
4964e932 24623deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
9cc891cb 24624 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
4964e932
PH
24625 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
24626 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
495ae4b0 24627.endd
4964e932 24628
9cc891cb 24629
4964e932
PH
24630.tempindent 0
24631\$mime@_is@_multipart$\:
24632This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
24633`multipart', for example `multipart/alternative' or `multipart/mixed'. Since
24634multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not want
24635to carry out specific actions on them.
24636
24637.tempindent 0
24638\$mime@_is@_rfc822$\:
24639This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
24640checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
24641decoding is fully recursive.
24642
24643.tempindent 0
24644\$mime@_part@_count$\:
24645This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
24646starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
24647counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
24648\$mime@_is@_rfc822$\). The counter stays set after \acl@_smtp@_mime\ is
24649complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
24650parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
24651
24652.pop
24653
24654
4964e932
PH
24655.section Scanning with regular expressions
24656.rset SECTscanregex "~~chapter.~~section"
24657.index content scanning||with regular expressions
24658.index regular expressions||content scanning with
24659You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
24660the message, or on individual MIME parts.
24661
24662The \regex\ condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
24663matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
24664MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The \regex\ condition matches
24665linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
24666have multiline matches with the \regex\ condition.
24667
24668The \mime@_regex\ condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
24669to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
24670part has not been decoded with the \decode\ modifier earlier in the ACL, it is
24671decoded automatically when \mime@_regex\ is executed (using default path and
24672filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first 32K
24673characters are checked.
24674
24675The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
24676literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
24677expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
24678with more backslashes, or use the \"@\N"\ facility to disable expansion.
24679Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
495ae4b0 24680.display asis
4964e932
PH
24681deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
24682 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
495ae4b0 24683.endd
4964e932
PH
24684The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
24685\$regex@_match@_string$\ expansion variable is then set up and contains the
24686matching regular expression.
495ae4b0 24687
4964e932
PH
24688\**Warning**\: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
24689CPU-intensive.
495ae4b0 24690
495ae4b0 24691
495ae4b0 24692
4964e932
PH
24693.section The demime condition
24694.rset SECTdemimecond "~~chapter.~~section"
24695.index content scanning||MIME checking
24696.index MIME content scanning
24697The \demime\ ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
24698extension blocking. It uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
9cc891cb
TK
24699ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
24700condition is deprecated and kept only for for backward compatibility. You must
d43194df
PH
24701set the \\WITH@_OLD@_DEMIME\\ option in \(Local/Makefile)\ at build time to be
24702able to use the \demime\ condition.
4964e932
PH
24703
24704The \demime\ condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
24705errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
24706against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
24707parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
24708scanning, it is recommened that you use the \demime\ condition before the
24709antivirus (\malware\) condition.
24710
24711On the right-hand side of the \demime\ condition you can pass a colon-separated
24712list of file extensions that it should match against. For example:
24713.display asis
24714deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
24715 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
24716.endd
24717If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
24718false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, `disk
24719full'), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
24720the condition is on a \warn\ verb).
24721
24722The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
24723conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, `false', or
24724zero (`0'), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
24725
24726The \demime\ condition set the following variables:
24727
24728.push
24729.indent 2em
24730
24731.tempindent 0
24732\$demime@_errorlevel$\: When an error is detected in a MIME container, this
24733variable contains the severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher
24734the value, the more severe the error. If this variable is unset or zero, no
24735error occurred.
24736
24737.tempindent 0
24738\$demime@_reason$\: When \$demime@_errorlevel$\ is greater than zero, this
24739variable contains a human-readable text string describing the MIME error that
24740occurred.
24741
24742.tempindent 0
24743\$found@_extension$\: When the \demime\ condition is true, this variable
24744contains the file extension it found.
24745
24746.pop
24747
24748Both \$demime@_errorlevel$\ and \$demime@_reason$\ are set by the first call of
24749the \demime\ condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
24750
24751If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the \demime\
24752condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass `*' as the
24753right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
24754facility:
24755.display asis
24756# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
24757deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
24758 demime = *
24759 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
24760
24761# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
24762# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
24763deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
24764 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
24765
24766# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
24767# examine them and eventually thaw them.
24768deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
24769 demime = exe:doc
24770 control = freeze
24771.endd
24772
24773
24774.nem
495ae4b0
PH
24775
24776
24777
24778.
24779.
24780.
24781.
24782. ============================================================================
24783.chapter Adding a local scan function to Exim
24784.set runningfoot "local scan function"
24785.rset CHAPlocalscan "~~chapter"
24786.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||description of
24787.index customizing||input scan using C function
24788.index policy control||by local scan function
24789
24790In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
d43194df
PH
24791want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
24792.em
24793The content scanning extension (chapter ~~CHAPexiscan) has facilities for
24794passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
24795.nem
24796a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the \condition\
24797condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP \\DATA\\ command or the ACL for
24798non-SMTP messages (see chapter ~~CHAPACL), but this has its limitations.
495ae4b0 24799
d43194df
PH
24800To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
24801possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
24802in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
24803can of course use a little C stub to call it.
495ae4b0 24804
4964e932 24805The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
495ae4b0
PH
24806when Exim is just about to accept the message.
24807It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
24808well as messages arriving via SMTP.
24809
24810Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
24811option called \local@_scan@_timeout\ for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
4964e932 24812Zero means `no timeout'.
495ae4b0
PH
24813Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
24814before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
24815are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
24816incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
24817For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
24818code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
24819
24820
24821.section Building Exim to use a local scan function
24822.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||building Exim to use
24823To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
24824function is before building Exim, by setting \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_SOURCE\\ in your
24825\(Local/Makefile)\. A recommended place to put it is in the \(Local)\
24826directory, so you might set
24827.display asis
24828LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
24829.endd
24830for example. The function must be called \*local@_scan()*\. It is called by
24831Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
24832be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
24833function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
24834commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
24835\(src/local@_scan.c)\.
24836
4964e932 24837If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
495ae4b0
PH
24838for your \*local@_scan()*\ function, you must also set
24839.display asis
24840LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
24841.endd
24842in \(Local/Makefile)\ (see section ~~SECTconoptloc below).
24843
24844
24845
24846.section API for local@_scan()
24847.rset SECTapiforloc "~~chapter.~~section"
24848.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||API description
24849You must include this line near the start of your code:
24850.display asis
24851#include "local_scan.h"
24852.endd
24853This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
24854prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
24855almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
4964e932
PH
24856for \"unsigned char"\ called \"uschar"\.
24857It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
495ae4b0
PH
24858strings and pointers to character strings:
24859.display asis
24860#define CS (char *)
24861#define CCS (const char *)
24862#define CSS (char **)
24863#define US (unsigned char *)
24864#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
24865#define USS (unsigned char **)
24866.endd
24867
24868The function prototype for \*local@_scan()*\ is:
24869.display asis
24870extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
24871.endd
24872The arguments are as follows:
24873.numberpars $.
24874\fd\ is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
4964e932 24875(the -D file).
495ae4b0
PH
24876The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not recommended.
24877\**Warning**\: You must \*not*\ close this file descriptor.
24878
24879The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
24880character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
24881id followed by \"-D"\ and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
24882macro \\SPOOL@_DATA@_START@_OFFSET\\ to reset to the start of the data, just in
24883case this changes in some future version.
24884
24885.nextp
24886\return@_text\ is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
24887string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
24888.endp
24889The function must return an \int\ value which is one of the following macros:
24890.numberpars $.
24891\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT"\
24892
24893The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
24894the message, and made available in the variable \$local@_scan@_data$\. No
24895newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
24896maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
24897.nextp
24898\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT@_FREEZE"\
24899
4964e932 24900This behaves as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT\\, except that the accepted message is
495ae4b0
PH
24901queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
24902.nextp
24903\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT@_QUEUE"\
24904
4964e932 24905This behaves as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT\\, except that the accepted message is
495ae4b0
PH
24906queued without immediate delivery.
24907.nextp
24908\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT"\
24909
24910The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
24911passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted --
24912they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
24913\"@\n"\ in log lines.
24914If no message is given, `Administrative prohibition' is used.
24915.nextp
24916\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT"\
24917
24918The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
24919message as for \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\. If no message is given, `Temporary
24920local problem' is used.
24921.nextp
24922\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT@_NOLOGHDR"\
24923
24924This behaves as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\, except that the header of the rejected
24925message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
24926\rejected@_header\ log selector for just this rejection. If \rejected@_header\
24927is already unset (see the discussion of the \log@_selection\ option in section
24928~~SECTlogselector), this code is the same as \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\.
24929
24930.nextp
24931\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT@_NOLOGHDR"\
24932
24933This code is a variation of \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT\\ in the same way that
24934\\LOCAL__SCAN__REJECT__NOLOGHDR\\ is a variation of \\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\.
24935.endp
24936
24937If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
24938reported by writing to \stderr\ or by sending an email, as configured by the
24939\-oe-\ command line options.
24940
24941
24942.section Configuration options for local@_scan()
24943.rset SECTconoptloc "~~chapter.~~section"
24944.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||configuration options
24945It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
24946that set values in static variables in the \*local@_scan()*\ module. If you
24947want to do this, you must have the line
24948.display asis
24949LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
24950.endd
24951in your \(Local/Makefile)\ when you build Exim. (This line is in
24952\(OS/Makefile-Default)\, commented out). Then, in the \*local@_scan()*\ source
24953file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table to
4964e932 24954define them.
495ae4b0
PH
24955
24956The table must be a vector called \local@_scan@_options\, of type
24957\"optionlist"\. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
24958and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
24959alphabetical order. Following \local@_scan@_options\ you must also define a
24960variable called \local@_scan@_options@_count\ that contains the number of
24961entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
24962.display asis
24963static int my_integer_option = 42;
24964static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
24965
24966optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
24967 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
24968 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
24969};
24970int local_scan_options_count =
24971 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
24972.endd
24973The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
24974configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
24975.display asis
24976begin local_scan
24977my_integer = 99
24978my_string = some string of text...
24979.endd
24980The available types of option data are as follows:
24981
24982.startitems
24983
24984.item opt@_bool
24985This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to
4964e932 24986a variable of type \"BOOL"\, which will be set to \\TRUE\\ or \\FALSE\\, which
495ae4b0
PH
24987are macros that are defined as `1' and `0', respectively. If you want to detect
24988whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
24989\\TRUE@_UNSET\\. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than
24990two values.)
24991
24992.item "opt@_fixed"
24993This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
24994The address should point to a variable of type \"int"\. The value is stored
24995multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
24996
24997.item "opt@_int"
4964e932 24998This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
495ae4b0
PH
24999\"int"\. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
25000Exim.
25001
25002.item "opt@_mkint"
25003This is the same as \opt@_int\, except that when such a value is output in a
25004\-bP-\ listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
25005printed with the suffix K or M.
25006
25007.item "opt@_octint"
25008This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpeted as an
25009octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
25010always output in octal.
25011
25012.item "opt@_stringptr"
25013This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
25014variable that points to a string (for example, of type \"uschar $*$"\).
25015
25016.item "opt@_time"
25017This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
25018type \"int"\. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
25019
25020.enditems
25021
25022If the \-bP-\ command line option is followed by \"local@_scan"\, Exim prints
25023out the values of all the \*local@_scan()*\ options.
25024
25025
25026.section Available Exim variables
25027.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||available Exim variables
25028The header \(local@_scan.h)\ gives you access to a number of C variables.
25029These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
25030release. Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim variable by
25031calling \*expand@_string()*\. The exported variables are as follows:
25032
25033.startitems
25034
25035.item "unsigned int debug@_selector"
25036This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
25037is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
25038\*local@_scan()*\; they are defined as macros:
25039.numberpars $.
25040The \"D@_v"\ bit is set when \-v-\ was present on the command line. This is a
25041testing option that is not privileged -- any caller may set it. All the
25042other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
25043.nextp
25044The \"D@_local@_scan"\ bit is provided for use by \*local@_scan()*\; it is set
25045by the \"+local@_scan"\ debug selector. It is not included in the default set
25046of debugging bits.
25047.endp
25048Thus, to write to the debugging output only when \"+local@_scan"\ has been
25049selected, you should use code like this:
25050.display asis
4964e932 25051if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
495ae4b0
PH
25052 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
25053.endd
25054
25055.item "uschar *expand@_string@_message"
25056After a failing call to \*expand@_string()*\ (returned value NULL), the
25057variable \expand__string__message\ contains the error message, zero-terminated.
25058
25059.item "header@_line *header@_list"
25060A pointer to a chain of header lines. The \header@_line\ structure is discussed
25061below.
25062
25063.item "header@_line *header@_last"
25064A pointer to the last of the header lines.
25065
25066.item "uschar *headers@_charset"
25067The value of the \headers@_charset\ configuration option.
25068
25069.item "BOOL host@_checking"
4964e932 25070This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
495ae4b0
PH
25071\-bh-\ command line option.
25072
25073.item "uschar *interface@_address"
25074The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
25075is NULL for locally submitted messages.
25076
25077.item "int interface@_port"
25078The port on which this message was received.
25079
25080.item "uschar *message@_id"
4964e932 25081This variable contains the message id for the incoming message as a
495ae4b0
PH
25082zero-terminated string.
25083
25084
25085.item "uschar *received@_protocol"
25086The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
25087
25088.item "int recipients@_count"
25089The number of accepted recipients.
25090
25091.item "recipient@_item *recipients@_list"
25092.index recipient||adding in local scan
25093.index recipient||removing in local scan
25094The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
25095\recipients@_count\. The \recipient@_item\ structure is discussed below. You
25096can add additional recipients by calling \*receive@_add@_recipient()*\ (see
25097below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and adusting
25098the value in \recipients@_count\. In particular, by setting \recipients@_count\
25099to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the value
25100\"LOCAL@_SCAN@_ACCEPT"\, the message is accepted, but immediately blackholed.
4964e932 25101To replace the recipients, set \recipients@_count\ to zero and then call
495ae4b0
PH
25102\*receive@_add@_recipient()*\ as often as needed.
25103
25104.item "uschar *sender@_address"
25105The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
25106
25107.item "uschar *sender@_host@_address"
25108The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
25109locally-submitted messages.
25110
25111.item "uschar *sender@_host@_authenticated"
25112The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
25113was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
25114
25115.item "uschar *sender@_host@_name"
25116The name of the sending host, if known.
25117
25118.item "int sender@_host@_port"
25119The port on the sending host.
25120
25121.item "BOOL smtp@_input"
25122This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
25123
25124.item "BOOL smtp@_batched@_input"
25125This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
25126
25127.item "int store@_pool"
4964e932 25128The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
495ae4b0
PH
25129requests. See section ~~SECTmemhanloc for details.
25130
25131.enditems
25132
25133
25134.section Structure of header lines
25135The \header@_line\ structure contains the members listed below.
25136You can add additional header lines by calling the \*header@_add()*\ function
25137(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
25138their type to $*$.
25139
25140.startitems
25141
25142.item "struct header@_line *next"
25143A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
25144
25145.item "int type"
25146A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
25147characters, and are documented in chapter ~~CHAPspool of this manual. Notice in
25148particular that any header line whose type is $*$ is not transmitted with the
25149message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been rewritten, or
25150are to be removed (for example, ::Envelope-sender:: header lines.) Effectively,
25151$*$ means `deleted'.
25152
25153.item "int slen"
25154The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
25155internal newlines.
25156
25157.item "uschar *text"
25158A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
25159a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
25160
25161.enditems
25162
25163
25164
25165.section Structure of recipient items
25166The \recipient@_item\ structure contains these members:
25167
25168.startitems
25169
25170.item "uschar *address"
25171This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
25172
25173.item "int pno"
25174This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created
25175by the \one@_time\ option. It is not relevant at the time \*local@_scan()*\ is
4964e932 25176run and
495ae4b0
PH
25177must always contain -1 at this stage.
25178
25179.item "uschar *errors@_to"
4964e932 25180If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
495ae4b0
PH
25181recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
25182envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the \errors@_to\ generic
4964e932 25183router option.)
495ae4b0
PH
25184If a \*local@_scan()*\ function sets an \errors@_to\ field to an unqualified
25185address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from \qualify@_recipient\.
25186When \*local@_scan()*\ is called, the \errors@_to\ field is NULL for all
25187recipients.
25188.enditems
25189
25190
25191.section Available Exim functions
25192.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||available Exim functions
25193The header \(local@_scan.h)\ gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
25194These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
25195release:
25196
25197.startitems
25198
25199.item "pid@_t child@_open(uschar **argv, uschar **envp, int newumask, int *infdptr, int *outfdptr, BOOL make@_leader)"
25200This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
4964e932 25201\argv\. The environment for the process is specified by \envp\, which can be
495ae4b0
PH
25202NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied for
25203the process in \newumask\.
25204
25205Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
25206and returned to the caller via the \infdptr\ and \outfdptr\ arguments. The
25207standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
4964e932 25208descriptors `in the way' in the new process, they are closed. If the final
495ae4b0
PH
25209argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
25210
25211The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
25212
25213
25214.item "int child@_close(pid@_t pid, int timeout)"
25215This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
25216seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
25217return value is as follows:
25218.numberpars $.
25219>= 0
25220
25221The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process ending
25222status.
25223.nextp
25224< 0 and > --256
25225
25226The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
25227signal number.
25228.nextp
25229--256
25230
25231The process timed out.
25232.nextp
25233--257
25234
25235The was some other error in wait(); \errno\ is still set.
25236.endp
25237
25238
25239.item "pid@_t child@_open@_exim(int *fd)"
25240This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
25241Exim. (Of course, you can also call \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ yourself if you
25242want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
25243forks a subprocess that is running
25244.display asis
25245exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
25246.endd
25247and returns to you (via the \"int *"\ argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
25248that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
25249of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
4964e932 25250recipients in ::To::, ::Cc::, and/or ::Bcc:: header lines.
495ae4b0
PH
25251
25252When you have finished, call \*child@_close()*\ to wait for the process to
25253finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
25254fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
25255addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
25256
25257.item "void debug@_printf(char *, ...)"
4964e932 25258This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for \*(printf()*\. The
495ae4b0 25259output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
4964e932 25260calls to \*debug@_printf()*\ have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
495ae4b0
PH
25261conditional on the \"local@_scan"\ debug selector by coding like this:
25262.display asis
4964e932 25263if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
495ae4b0
PH
25264 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
25265.endd
25266
25267.item "uschar *expand@_string(uschar *string)"
25268This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
25269expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
4964e932
PH
25270The C variable \expand@_string@_message\ contains an error message after an
25271expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
495ae4b0
PH
25272the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
25273block of memory that was obtained by a call to \*store@_get()*\. See section
25274~~SECTmemhanloc below for a discussion of memory handling.
25275
25276.item "void header@_add(int type, char *format, ...)"
d43194df
PH
25277.em
25278This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
25279existing ones.
25280.nem
25281The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space character. The
25282second argument is a format string and any number of substitution arguments as
25283for \*sprintf()*\. You may include internal newlines if you want, and you must
25284ensure that the string ends with a newline.
25285
25286.em
25287.item "void header@_add@_at@_position(BOOL after, uschar *name, BOOL topnot, int type, char *$nh{format}, ...)"
25288This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
25289chain. The header itself is specified as for \*header@_add()*\.
25290
25291If \name\ is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if \after\
25292is true, or at the start if \after\ is false. If \name\ is not NULL, the header
25293lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that matches the name. If
25294one is found, the new header is added before it if \after\ is false. If \after\
25295is true, the new header is added after the found header and any adjacent
25296subsequent ones with the same name (even if marked `deleted'). If no matching
25297non-deleted header is found, the \topnot\ option controls where the header is
25298added. If it is true, addition is at the top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to
25299add a header after all the ::Received:: headers, or at the top if there are no
25300::Received:: headers, you could use
25301.display asis
25302header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
25303 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
25304.endd
25305Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted ::Received:: header, but
25306there may not be if \received@_header@_text\ expands to an empty string.
25307
25308
25309.item "void header@_remove(int occurrence, uschar *name)"
25310This function removes header lines. If \occurrence\ is zero or negative, all
25311occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
25312particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
25313match the specification, the function does nothing.
25314
25315
25316.item "BOOL header@_testname(header@_line *hdr, uschar *name, int length, BOOL notdel)"
25317This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
25318a string comparison, because whitespace is permitted between the name and the
25319colon. If the \notdel\ argument is true, a false return is forced for all
25320`deleted' headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
25321.display asis
25322if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
25323.endd
25324.nem
25325
495ae4b0
PH
25326
25327.item "uschar *lss@_b64encode(uschar *cleartext, int length)"
25328.index base64 encoding||functions for \*local@_scan()*\ use
25329This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
25330The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
25331back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling \*store@_get()*\. It is
25332zero-terminated.
25333
25334.item "int lss@_b64decode(uschar *codetext, uschar **cleartext)"
25335This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
25336zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
25337to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the
25338decoded string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64
25339data, the yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to
25340make it easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its
25341own). The added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
25342
25343.item "int lss@_match@_domain(uschar *domain, uschar *list)"
25344This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
25345matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
25346.display
25347OK $rm{match succeeded}
25348FAIL $rm{match failed}
25349DEFER $rm{match deferred}
25350.endd
25351DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
25352inability to contact a database.
25353
25354.item "int lss@_match@_local@_part(uschar *localpart, uschar *list, BOOL caseless)"
25355This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
4964e932 25356controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
495ae4b0
PH
25357\*lss@_match@_domain()*\.
25358
25359.item "int lss@_match@_address(uschar *address, uschar *list, BOOL caseless)"
25360This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
25361controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
25362matched caselessly. The return values are as for \*lss@_match@_domain()*\.
25363
25364.item "int lss@_match@_host(uschar *host@_name, uschar *host@_address, uschar *list)"
25365This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
25366expected to be
25367.display asis
25368lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
25369.endd
25370An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the
25371host name is NULL, the name corresponding to \$sender@_host@_address$\ is
25372automatically looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the
25373list. The return values are as for \*lss@_match@_domain()*\, but in addition,
25374\*lss@_match@_host()*\ returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host
25375name, but the lookup failed.
25376
25377.item "void log@_write(unsigned int selector, int which, char *format, ...)"
25378This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
25379is concerned with \log@_selector\). The second argument can be \"LOG@_MAIN"\ or
4964e932 25380\"LOG@_REJECT"\ or
495ae4b0
PH
25381\"LOG@_PANIC"\ or the inclusive `or' of any combination of them. It specifies
25382to which log or logs the message is written.
25383The remaining arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The
25384string should not contain any newlines, not even at the end.
25385
25386
25387.item "void receive@_add@_recipient(uschar *address, int pno)"
25388This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
25389is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
25390with the \qualify@_recipient\ domain. The second argument must always be -1.
25391
4964e932
PH
25392This function does not allow you to specify a private \errors@_to\ address (as
25393described with the structure of \recipient@_item\ above), because it pre-dates
25394the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
495ae4b0
PH
25395value afterwards. For example:
25396.display asis
25397receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
4964e932 25398recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
495ae4b0
PH
25399 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
25400.endd
25401
d43194df
PH
25402.em
25403.item "BOOL receive@_remove@_recipient(uschar *recipient)"
25404This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the
25405list of recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and
25406false if no matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a
25407complete email address.
25408.nem
25409
25410
495ae4b0
PH
25411.item "uschar *rfc2047@_decode(uschar *string, BOOL lencheck, uschar *target, int zeroval, int *lenptr, uschar **error)"
25412This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
25413these are the contents of header lines. First, each encoded `word' is decoded
25414from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
25415a charset encoding, and if the \*iconv()*\ function is available, an attempt is
25416made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
25417binary string is returned with an error message.
25418
4964e932
PH
25419The first argument is the string to be decoded. If \lencheck\ is TRUE, the
25420maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
495ae4b0 25421encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
4964e932 25422
495ae4b0
PH
25423.index binary zero||in RFC 2047 decoding
25424If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
25425contents of the \zeroval\ argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
25426not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
25427
25428The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
25429\lenptr\ is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to which
25430it points. When \zeroval\ is 0, \lenptr\ should not be NULL.
25431
4964e932
PH
25432If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the \error\
25433argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by \error\ is set
25434to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
25435returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
495ae4b0
PH
25436with translation.
25437
25438
25439.item "int smtp@_fflush(void)"
4964e932 25440This function is used in conjunction with \*smtp@_printf()*\, as described
495ae4b0
PH
25441below.
25442
25443.item "void smtp@_printf(char *, ...)"
25444The arguments of this function are like \*printf()*\; it writes to the SMTP
25445output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
25446stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
25447SMTP. This is the case when \smtp@_input\ is TRUE and \smtp@_batched@_input\ is
25448FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
25449opposed to a local process that used the \-bs-\ command line option), you can
25450test the value of \sender@_host@_address\, which is non-NULL when a remote host
25451is involved.
25452
25453If an SMTP TLS connection is established, \*smtp@_printf()*\ uses the TLS
25454output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
25455
25456Strings that are written by \*smtp@_printf()*\ from within \*local@_scan()*\
25457must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
25458\\LOCAL@_SCAN@_REJECT\\, 451 if you are going to return
25459\\LOCAL@_SCAN@_TEMPREJECT\\, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
25460initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
25461to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
25462that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
25463.display asis
25464smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
25465return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
25466.endd
25467Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
25468the data returned via the \return@_text\ argument. The added value of using
25469\*smtp@_printf()*\ is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
25470multiple output lines.
25471
25472The \*smtp@_printf()*\ function does not return any error indication, because it
25473does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
25474the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
25475detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
25476you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
25477dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call \*smtp@_fflush()*\, which has no
25478arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
25479is an error.
25480
25481.item "void *store@_get(int)"
25482This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
25483chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
25484runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
25485
25486.item "void *store@_get@_perm(int)"
4964e932 25487This function is like \*store@_get()*\, but it always gets memory from the
495ae4b0
PH
25488permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
25489
25490.item "uschar *string@_copy(uschar *string)"
25491.item "uschar *string@_copyn(uschar *string, int length)" 0
25492.item "uschar *string@_sprintf(char *format, ...)" 0
25493These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
25494The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
25495number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
25496and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
25497pointer to a new string
25498in the current memory pool. See the next section for more discussion.
25499
25500.enditems
25501
25502
25503
25504.section More about Exim's memory handling
25505.rset SECTmemhanloc "~~chapter.~~section"
25506.index \*local@_scan()*\ function||memory handling
4964e932 25507No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
495ae4b0 25508The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
4964e932
PH
25509recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
25510to incoming SMTP connections -- other input methods can supply only one message
495ae4b0
PH
25511at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process terminates.
25512
25513Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
25514data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
25515connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
25516one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
25517
4964e932 25518If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
495ae4b0
PH
25519in the same SMTP connection, you should set
25520.display asis
25521store_pool = POOL_PERM
25522.endd
4964e932
PH
25523before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
25524restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
495ae4b0
PH
25525the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of \store@_pool\ or
25526set it explicitly to \\POOL@_MAIN\\.
25527
25528The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
25529\*expand@_string()*\, \*store@_get()*\, and the \*string@_xxx()*\ functions.
d43194df 25530There is also a convenience function called \*store__get__perm()*\ that gets a
495ae4b0
PH
25531block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
25532\store@_pool\.
25533
25534
25535
25536
25537
25538.
25539.
25540.
25541.
25542. ============================================================================
25543.chapter System-wide message filtering
25544.set runningfoot "system filtering"
25545.rset CHAPsystemfilter "~~chapter"
25546.index filter||system filter
25547.index filtering all mail
25548.index system filter
25549The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
25550that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
25551also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
25552they are delivered. This is called the $it{system filter}.
25553
25554The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
4964e932
PH
25555is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
25556It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because \deliver\
495ae4b0
PH
25557commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
25558The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
25559
25560The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
25561is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
25562the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
25563If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
4964e932 25564of the \first@_delivery\ condition in an \if\ command in the filter to prevent
495ae4b0
PH
25565it happening on retries.
25566
25567\**Warning**\: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
25568specific to individual recipient addresses, such as \$local@_part$\ and
25569\$domain$\, are not set, and the `personal' condition is not meaningful. If you
25570want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
25571independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable \%redirect%\ router, as
25572described in section ~~SECTperaddfil below.
25573
25574.section Specifying a system filter
25575.index uid (user id)||system filter
25576.index gid (group id)||system filter
25577The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
25578setting \system@_filter\. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
25579other than root, you must also set \system@_filter@_user\ and
25580\system@_filter@_group\ as appropriate. For example:
25581.display asis
25582system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
25583system_filter_user = exim
25584.endd
25585If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
25586\save\ or \pipe\ commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
25587specified by setting \system@_filter@_file@_transport\ and
25588\system@_filter@_pipe@_transport\, respectively. Similarly,
25589\system@_filter@_reply@_transport\ must be set to handle any messages generated
25590by the \reply\ command.
25591
25592.section Testing a system filter
25593You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
25594filter, but you should use \-bF-\ rather than \-bf-\, so that features that
25595are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
d43194df
PH
25596.em
25597If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
25598you can use both \-bF-\ and \-bf-\ on the same command line.
25599.nem
495ae4b0
PH
25600
25601.section Contents of a system filter
25602The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
25603files. It is described in the separate end-user document \*Exim's interface to
25604mail filtering*\. However, there are some additional features that are
25605available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
25606If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with \-bf-\,
25607they cause errors.
25608
25609.index frozen messages||manual thaw, testing in filter
25610There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
25611files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition \first@_delivery\
25612is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
25613\manually@_thawed\ is true only if the message has been frozen, and
25614subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
25615manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the \auto__thaw\ setting does not.
25616
25617\**Warning**\: If a system filter uses the \first@_delivery\ condition to
25618specify an `unseen' (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
25619succeed, it will not be tried again.
4964e932 25620If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
495ae4b0
PH
25621arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
25622
25623When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables \$n0$\ --
25624\$n9$\ are copied into \$sn0$\ -- \$sn9$\ and are thereby made available to
25625users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up `scores' to
25626which users' filter files can refer.
25627
25628
25629.section Additional variable for system filters
25630The expansion variable \$recipients$\, containing a list of all the recipients
25631of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
25632filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
25633
25634
25635.section Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters
25636.index freezing messages
25637.index message||freezing
25638.index message||forced failure
25639.index \fail\||in system filter
25640.index \freeze\ in system filter
25641.index \defer\ in system filter
25642There are three extra commands (\defer\, \freeze\ and \fail\) which are always
25643available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users' filters.
4964e932 25644(See the \allow@_defer\,
495ae4b0
PH
25645\allow@_freeze\ and \allow@_fail\ options for the \%redirect%\ router.) These
25646commands can optionally be followed by the word \text\ and a string containing
25647an error message, for example:
25648.display asis
25649fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
25650.endd
4964e932 25651The keyword \text\ is optional if the next character is a double quote.
495ae4b0 25652
4964e932 25653The \defer\ command defers delivery of the original recipients of the message.
495ae4b0
PH
25654The \fail\ command causes all the original recipients to be failed, and a
25655bounce message to be created. The \freeze\ command suspends all delivery
25656attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries that are
25657specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has run.
25658
25659The \freeze\ command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
25660not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
25661filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
25662is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
25663
25664.index log||\fail\ command log line
25665.index \fail\||log line, reducing
25666The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
25667well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
25668up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
25669log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
25670two characters \"@<@<"\ and contains \"@>@>"\ later. The text between these two
25671strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
25672message. For example:
25673.display asis
25674fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
25675 because it contains attachments that we are \
25676 not prepared to receive."
25677.endd
25678
25679.index loop||caused by \fail\
25680Take great care with the \fail\ command when basing the decision to fail on the
25681contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include the
25682contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the \fail\ command
25683again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this. Testing the
25684\error@_message\ condition is one way to prevent this. You could use, for
25685example
25686.display asis
25687if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
25688 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
25689.endd
25690though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
25691alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
25692generated by the filter.
25693
4964e932
PH
25694The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
25695\defer\,
495ae4b0
PH
25696\freeze\, or \fail\ command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were set up
25697earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such as
25698.display asis
25699mail ...
25700freeze
25701.endd
4964e932 25702to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
495ae4b0
PH
25703failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
25704take place.
25705
25706
25707.section Adding and removing headers in a system filter
d43194df
PH
25708.rset SECTaddremheasys "~~chapter.~~section"
25709.index header lines||adding, in system filter
25710.index header lines||removing, in system filter
495ae4b0
PH
25711.index filter||header lines, adding/removing
25712Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
d43194df 25713.display
495ae4b0
PH
25714headers add <<string>>
25715headers remove <<string>>
25716.endd
d43194df 25717The argument for the \headers add\ is a string that is expanded and then added
495ae4b0
PH
25718to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the filter
25719maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white space is
25720ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is forced to
25721fail, the command has no effect.
25722
495ae4b0
PH
25723You can use `@\n' within the string, followed by white space, to specify
25724continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
25725including `@\n' within the string without any following white space. For
25726example:
25727.display asis
25728headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
25729 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
25730 X-header-2: ...."
25731.endd
25732Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
4964e932 25733be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
495ae4b0
PH
25734space after input continuations is ignored.
25735
495ae4b0
PH
25736The argument for \headers remove\ is a colon-separated list of header names.
25737This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
25738those that are added at delivery time (such as ::Envelope-To:: and
d43194df
PH
25739::Return-Path::) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
25740header with the same name, they are all removed.
25741
25742.em
25743The \headers\ command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
25744of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
25745from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
25746modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
25747Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
25748used for all recipients of the message.
25749
25750During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
25751header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
25752that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
25753routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
25754routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
25755until the message is actually being written (see section ~~SECTheadersaddrem).
25756
25757If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
25758added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
25759present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
25760present, but marked `deleted' so that they are not transported with the
25761message. For this reason, it is usual to make the \headers\ command conditional
25762on \first@_delivery\ so that the set of header lines is not modified more than
25763once.
25764
25765Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
25766use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
25767For example:
25768.display asis
25769headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
25770headers remove "Subject"
25771headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
25772headers remove "Old-Subject"
25773.endd
25774.nem
25775
495ae4b0
PH
25776
25777
25778.section Setting an errors address in a system filter
25779.index envelope sender
25780In a system filter, if a \deliver\ command is followed by
25781.display
25782errors@_to <<some address>>
25783.endd
25784in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
25785delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
25786user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
25787might use
25788.display asis
25789unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
25790.endd
25791to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
25792address if its delivery failed.
25793
25794
25795.section Per-address filtering
25796.rset SECTperaddfil "~~chapter.~~section"
25797In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
25798delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
25799operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
25800such as \$local@_part$\ and \$domain$\ can be used, and indeed, the choice of
25801filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
25802which implements such a filter:
25803.display asis
25804central_filter:
25805.newline
495ae4b0
PH
25806 check_local_user
25807.newline
495ae4b0
PH
25808 driver = redirect
25809 domains = +local_domains
25810 file = /central/filters/$local_part
25811 no_verify
25812 allow_filter
25813 allow_freeze
25814.endd
495ae4b0 25815The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
4964e932
PH
25816\check@_local@_user\ must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
25817the local user, or the \user\ option must be used to specify which user to use.
495ae4b0 25818If both are set, \user\ overrides.
495ae4b0
PH
25819
25820Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
25821specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
25822its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
25823address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
25824normal way.
25825
25826
25827
25828
25829
d43194df 25830
495ae4b0
PH
25831.
25832.
25833.
25834.
25835. ============================================================================
d43194df
PH
25836.chapter Message processing
25837.set runningfoot "message processing"
25838.rset CHAPmsgproc "~~chapter"
25839.index message||general processing
25840Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
25841all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
25842these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
25843this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
25844removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
25845before it is placed on Exim's queue.
495ae4b0 25846
d43194df
PH
25847Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
25848`locally-originated' messages. This adjective is used to describe messages that
25849are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on its
25850standard input. This includes the interactive `local SMTP' case that is set up
25851by the \-bs-\ command line option.
25852
25853\**Note**\: messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
25854or @:@:1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
25855loopback interface specially in any way.
25856.em
25857If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
25858that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
25859.nem
25860
25861
25862.section Submission mode for non-local messages
25863.rset SECTsubmodnon "~~chapter.~~section"
25864.index message||submission
25865.index submission mode
25866.em
25867Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages can also
25868be requested for other messages. The term `submission mode' is used to describe
25869this state. Submisssion mode is set by the modifier
495ae4b0 25870.display asis
d43194df 25871control = submission
495ae4b0 25872.endd
d43194df
PH
25873in a \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, or pre-data ACL for an incoming SMTP message (see
25874sections ~~SECTACLmodi and ~~SECTcontrols). This makes Exim treat the message
25875as a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
25876known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
25877example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
25878interface, you could include the following in the \\MAIL\\ ACL:
25879.display asis
25880warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
25881 control = submission
25882.endd
25883There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
25884is used to separate options. For example:
25885.display asis
25886control = submission/sender_retain
25887.endd
25888Specifying \sender@_retain\ has the effect of setting \local@_sender@_retain\
25889true and \local@_from@_check\ false for the current incoming message. The first
25890of these allows an existing ::Sender:: header in the message to remain, and the
25891second suppresses the check to ensure that ::From:: matches the authenticated
25892sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding ::Date:: and
25893::Message-ID:: header lines if they are missing, but makes no attempt to check
25894sender authenticity in header lines.
495ae4b0 25895
d43194df
PH
25896A submission mode setting may also specify a domain to be used when generating
25897a ::From:: or ::Sender:: header. For example:
25898.display asis
25899control = submission/domain=some.domain
25900.endd
25901The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
25902~~SECTthefrohea and ~~SECTthesenhea.
25903.nem
495ae4b0 25904
495ae4b0 25905
495ae4b0 25906
d43194df
PH
25907.section Line endings
25908.rset SECTlineendings "~~chapter.~~section"
25909.index line endings
25910.index carriage return
25911.index linefeed
25912RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
25913linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
25914SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
25915conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
25916use CRLF or just CR.
25917
25918Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
25919using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
25920receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
25921Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
25922MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
25923has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
25924that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
25925other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
25926follows:
495ae4b0 25927.numberpars $.
d43194df 25928LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
495ae4b0 25929.nextp
d43194df
PH
25930CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
25931is ignored.
495ae4b0 25932.nextp
d43194df
PH
25933The sequence `CR, dot, CR' does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
25934nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
25935terminator.
495ae4b0 25936.nextp
d43194df
PH
25937If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
25938the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
25939is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
25940people trying to play silly games.
495ae4b0 25941.nextp
d43194df
PH
25942If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
25943bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
25944line.
495ae4b0 25945.endp
495ae4b0 25946
495ae4b0 25947
495ae4b0 25948
d43194df
PH
25949.section Unqualified addresses
25950.index unqualified addresses
25951.index address||qualification
25952By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
25953host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
25954SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
25955messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
25956requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
495ae4b0 25957
d43194df
PH
25958Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
25959sender or receipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
25960\sender__unqualified__hosts\ and \recipient__unqualified__hosts\. In both
25961cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
25962value of \qualify__domain\ or \qualify__recipient\, as appropriate.
25963.index \qualify@_domain\
25964.index \qualify@_recipient\
495ae4b0 25965
d43194df
PH
25966.em
25967Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
25968that are locally originated, unless the \-bnq-\ option is given on the command
25969line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
25970are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
25971other words, such qualification is also controlled by
25972\sender__unqualified__hosts\ and \recipient__unqualified__hosts\,
25973.nem
495ae4b0 25974
495ae4b0 25975
d43194df
PH
25976.section The UUCP From line
25977.index `From' line
25978.index UUCP||`From' line
25979.index sender||address
25980.index \uucp@_from@_pattern\
25981.index \uucp@_from@_sender\
25982.index envelope sender
25983.index Sendmail compatibility||`From' line
25984Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
25985with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
25986`From'. Examples of two common formats are:
25987.display asis
25988From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
25989From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
25990.endd
25991This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
25992Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
25993via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
25994such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
25995\ignore@_fromline@_hosts\ or the \-bs-\ option was used for a local message and
25996\ignore@_fromline@_local\ is set. The recognition is controlled by a regular
25997expression that is defined by the \uucp@_from@_pattern\ option, whose default
25998value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address that
25999follows `From' into \$1$\.
495ae4b0 26000
d43194df
PH
26001.index numerical variables (\$1$\, \$2$\, etc)||in `From ' line handling
26002When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a `From' line is a
26003trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
26004contents of \uucp@_sender@_address\, whose default value is `@$1'. This is then
26005parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
26006qualified with \qualify@_domain\ unless it is the empty string. However, if the
26007command line \-f-\ option is used, it overrides the `From' line.
495ae4b0 26008
d43194df
PH
26009If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the `From' line is recognized, but the
26010sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
26011that are permitted to contain `From' lines.
26012
26013Only one `From' line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
26014treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
26015as a header line. This also happens if a `From' line is present in an incoming
26016SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
495ae4b0
PH
26017
26018
d43194df
PH
26019.section Resent- header lines
26020.index \Resent@-\ header lines
26021RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
26022\"Resent-"\ to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
26023recipient to somebody else. These headers are ::Resent-Date::, ::Resent-From::,
26024::Resent-Sender::, ::Resent-To::, ::Resent-Cc::, ::Resent-Bcc:: and
26025::Resent-Message-ID::. The RFC says:
495ae4b0 26026
d43194df
PH
26027\*Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
26028processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.*\
495ae4b0 26029
d43194df
PH
26030This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
26031address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats \Resent@-\ header lines as
26032follows:
26033.numberpars $.
26034A ::Resent-From:: line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
26035is automatically rewritten in the same way as ::From:: (see below).
26036.nextp
26037If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
26038\Resent@-\ header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
26039::From:: also rewrites ::Resent-From::.
26040.nextp
26041For local messages, if ::Sender:: is removed on input, ::Resent-Sender:: is also
26042removed.
26043.nextp
26044For a locally-submitted message,
26045if there are any \Resent@-\ header lines but no ::Resent-Date::,
26046::Resent-From::, or ::Resent-Message-Id::, they are added as necessary. It is
26047the contents of ::Resent-Message-Id:: (rather than ::Message-Id::) which are
26048included in log lines in this case.
26049.nextp
26050The logic for adding ::Sender:: is duplicated for ::Resent-Sender:: when any
26051\Resent@-\ header lines are present.
26052.endp
495ae4b0
PH
26053
26054
d43194df
PH
26055.section The Auto-Submitted: header line
26056Whenever Exim generates a bounce or a delay warning message, it includes the
26057header line
495ae4b0 26058.display asis
d43194df 26059Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
495ae4b0 26060.endd
495ae4b0
PH
26061
26062
d43194df
PH
26063.section The Bcc: header line
26064.index ::Bcc:: header line
26065If Exim is called with the \-t-\ option, to take recipient addresses from a
26066message's header, it removes any ::Bcc:: header line that may exist (after
26067extracting its addresses). If \-t-\ is not present on the command line, any
26068existing ::Bcc:: is not removed.
495ae4b0 26069
d43194df
PH
26070.section The Date: header line
26071.index ::Date:: header line
26072If a locally-generated
26073or submission-mode
26074message has no ::Date:: header line, Exim adds one, using the current date and
26075time.
495ae4b0 26076
d43194df
PH
26077.section The Delivery-date: header line
26078.index ::Delivery-date:: header line
26079.index \delivery@_date@_remove\
26080::Delivery-date:: header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
26081set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
26082the generic \delivery@_date@_add\ transport option.) They should not be present
26083in messages in transit. If the \delivery@_date@_remove\ configuration option is
26084set (the default), Exim removes ::Delivery-date:: header lines from incoming
26085messages.
495ae4b0 26086
d43194df
PH
26087.section The Envelope-to: header line
26088.index ::Envelope-to:: header line
26089.index \envelope@_to@_remove\
26090::Envelope-to:: header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
26091Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
26092generic \envelope@_to@_add\ transport option.) They should not be present in
26093messages in transit. If the \envelope@_to@_remove\ configuration option is set
26094(the default), Exim removes ::Envelope-to:: header lines from incoming
26095messages.
495ae4b0 26096
d43194df
PH
26097.section The From: header line
26098.rset SECTthefrohea "~~chapter.~~section"
26099.index ::From:: header line
26100.index Sendmail compatibility||`From' line
26101.index message||submission
26102.index submission mode
26103If a submission-mode message does not contain a ::From:: header line, Exim adds
26104one if either of the following conditions is true:
26105.numberpars $.
26106The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
26107message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
26108.nextp
26109The SMTP session is authenticated and \$authenticated@_id$\ is not empty.
26110.em
26111.numberpars alpha
26112If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26113\$authenticated@_id$\ and the domain is \$qualify@_domain$\.
26114.nextp
26115If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26116\$authenticated@_id$\, and the the domain is the specified domain.
26117.nextp
26118If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
26119\$authenticated@_id$\ is assumed to be the complete address.
26120.endp
26121.nem
26122.endp
26123A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
495ae4b0 26124
d43194df
PH
26125If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a ::From:: header
26126line, Exim adds one containing the sender's address. The calling user's login
26127name and full name are used to construct the address, as described in section
26128~~SECTconstr. They are obtained from the password data by calling
26129\*getpwuid()*\ (but see the \unknown@_login\ configuration option). The address
26130is qualified with \qualify@_domain\.
495ae4b0 26131
d43194df
PH
26132For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
26133::From:: header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
26134user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
26135name as described in section ~~SECTconstr.
495ae4b0 26136
d43194df
PH
26137.section The Message-ID: header line
26138.index ::Message-ID:: header line
26139.index message||submission
26140If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
26141::Message-ID:: or ::Resent-Message-ID:: header line, Exim adds one to the
26142message. If there are any ::Resent-:: headers in the message, it creates
26143::Resent-Message-ID::. The id is constructed from Exim's internal message id,
26144preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and followed by @@
26145and the primary host name. Additional information can be included in this
26146header line by setting the
26147.index \message@_id@_header@_text\
26148\message@_id@_header@_text\ and/or \message__id__header__domain\ options.
495ae4b0 26149
495ae4b0 26150
d43194df
PH
26151.section The Received: header line
26152.index ::Received:: header line
26153A ::Received:: header line is added at the start of every message. The contents
26154are defined by the \received@_header@_text\ configuration option, and Exim
26155automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
495ae4b0 26156
d43194df
PH
26157The ::Received:: header is generated as soon as the message's header lines have
26158been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the ::Received:: header line is
26159the time that the message started to be received. This is the value that is
26160seen by the \\DATA\\ ACL and by the \*local@_scan()*\ function.
495ae4b0 26161
d43194df
PH
26162Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the ::Received:: header line is
26163changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
26164-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
495ae4b0 26165
495ae4b0 26166
d43194df
PH
26167.section The Return-path: header line
26168.index ::Return-path:: header line
26169.index \return@_path@_remove\
26170::Return-path:: header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
26171it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic \return@_path@_add\
26172transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
26173transit. If the \return@_path@_remove\ configuration option is set (the
26174default), Exim removes ::Return-path:: header lines from incoming messages.
495ae4b0 26175
495ae4b0 26176
d43194df
PH
26177.section The Sender: header line
26178.rset SECTthesenhea "~~chapter.~~section"
26179.index ::Sender:: header line
26180.index message||submission
26181For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
26182existing ::Sender:: header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify these
26183actions by setting \local@_sender@_retain\ true or \local@_from@_check\ false.
495ae4b0 26184
d43194df
PH
26185When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
26186\local@_from@_check\ is true (the default), a check is made to see if the
26187address given in the ::From:: header line is the correct (local) sender of the
26188message. The address that is expected has the login name as the local part and
26189the value of \qualify@_domain\ as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the
26190local part can be permitted by setting \local@_from@_prefix\ and
26191\local@_from@_suffix\ appropriately. If ::From:: does not contain the correct
26192sender, a ::Sender:: line is added to the message.
495ae4b0 26193
d43194df
PH
26194If you set \local@_from@_check\ false, this checking does not occur. However,
26195the removal of an existing ::Sender:: line still happens, unless you also set
26196\local@_sender@_retain\ to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
26197options true at the same time.
495ae4b0 26198
d43194df
PH
26199.em
26200.index submission mode
26201By default, no processing of ::Sender:: header lines is done for messages
26202received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
26203a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and \sender@_retain\ is
26204not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
495ae4b0 26205
d43194df
PH
26206First, any existing ::Sender:: lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
26207authenticated, and \$authenticated@_id$\ is not empty, a sender address is
26208created as follows:
495ae4b0 26209.numberpars $.
d43194df
PH
26210If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26211\$authenticated@_id$\ and the domain is \$qualify@_domain$\.
495ae4b0 26212.nextp
d43194df
PH
26213If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
26214\$authenticated@_id$\, and the the domain is the specified domain.
26215.nextp
26216If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
26217\$authenticated@_id$\ is assumed to be the complete address.
495ae4b0 26218.endp
d43194df
PH
26219This address is compared with the address in the ::From:: header line. If they
26220are different, a ::Sender:: header line containing the created address is
26221added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in ::From:: can be permitted by
26222setting \local@_from@_prefix\ and \local@_from@_suffix\ appropriately.
26223.nem
26224
26225
26226.section Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports
26227.index header lines||adding, in router or transport
26228.index header lines||removing, in router or transport
26229.rset SECTheadersaddrem "~~chapter.~~section"
26230.em
26231When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
26232specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
26233process the message. Section ~~SECTaddremheasys contains details about
26234modifying headers in a system filter.
26235
26236In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
26237specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
26238addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
26239changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
26240transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
26241they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
26242
26243For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a \headers@_add\
26244option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
26245newlines (coded as `@\n'). For example:
495ae4b0 26246.display asis
d43194df
PH
26247headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
26248 X-added-second: another added header line
495ae4b0 26249.endd
d43194df 26250Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
495ae4b0 26251
d43194df
PH
26252The result of expanding \headers@_remove\ must consist of a colon-separated
26253list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
26254often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
26255not part of the names. For example:
495ae4b0 26256.display asis
d43194df 26257headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
495ae4b0 26258.endd
d43194df
PH
26259
26260When \headers@_add\ or \headers@_remove\ is specified on a router, its value is
26261expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
26262accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
26263an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
26264forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
26265.index \unseen\ option
26266However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
26267the \unseen\ option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
26268`unseen' router or its predecessors apply only to the `unseen' delivery.
26269
26270Addresses that end up with different \headers@_add\ or \headers@_remove\
26271settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
26272dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
26273requirements.
26274
26275The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
26276with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
26277these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
26278recipient address(es) by \headers@_remove\ options in routers, and it also
26279consults the transport's own \headers@_remove\ option. Header lines whose names
26280are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
26281instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
26282
26283After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
26284lines that were specified by routers' \headers@_add\ options are written, in
26285the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
26286header lines specified by the transport's \headers@_add\ option.
26287
26288This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
26289the following consequences:
26290.numberpars $.
26291The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
26292remains `visible', in the sense that the \$header@_$\\*xxx*\ variables refer to
26293it, at all times.
26294.nextp
26295Header lines that are added by a router's
26296\headers@_add\ option are not accessible by means of the \$header@_$\\*xxx*\
26297expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
26298.nextp
26299Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by \headers@_remove\ in
26300a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
26301.nextp
26302Headers added to an address by \headers@_add\ in a router cannot be removed by
26303a later router or by a transport.
26304.nextp
26305An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
26306removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
495ae4b0 26307.display asis
d43194df
PH
26308headers_remove = subject
26309headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
495ae4b0 26310.endd
d43194df 26311.endp
495ae4b0 26312
d43194df
PH
26313\**Warning**\: The \headers@_add\ and \headers@_remove\ options cannot be used
26314for a \%redirect%\ router that has the \one@_time\ option set.
26315.nem
495ae4b0
PH
26316
26317
d43194df
PH
26318
26319.section Constructed addresses
26320.rset SECTconstr "~~chapter.~~section"
26321.index address||constructed
26322.index constructed address
26323When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
26324the form
26325.display
26326<<user name>> <$$<<login>>@@<<qualify@_domain>>$$>
495ae4b0 26327.endd
d43194df 26328For example:
495ae4b0 26329.display asis
d43194df 26330Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
495ae4b0 26331.endd
d43194df
PH
26332The user name is obtained from the \-F-\ command line option if set, or
26333otherwise by looking up the calling user by \*getpwuid()*\ and extracting the
26334`gecos' field from the password entry. If the `gecos' field contains an
26335ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
26336upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
26337\gecos@_name\ option for a way to tailor the handling of the `gecos' field. The
26338\unknown@_username\ option can be used to specify user names in cases when
26339there is no password file entry.
495ae4b0 26340
d43194df
PH
26341In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
26342parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
26343characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
26344including non-ASCII characters in header lines.
26345The value of the \headers@_charset\ option specifies the name of the encoding
26346that is used (the characters are assumed to be in this encoding).
26347The setting of \print@_topbitchars\ controls whether characters with the top
26348bit set (that is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or
26349not.
495ae4b0
PH
26350
26351
d43194df
PH
26352.section Case of local parts
26353.index case of local parts
26354.index local part||case of
26355RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
26356be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
26357addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
26358because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
26359routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
26360original case for local parts by setting the \caseful@_local@_part\ generic
26361router option.
26362
26363.index mixed-case login names
26364If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
26365assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
26366your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
26367correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
495ae4b0 26368.display asis
d43194df
PH
26369correct_case:
26370 driver = redirect
26371 domains = +local_domains
26372 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
26373 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
26374 @$domain
495ae4b0 26375.endd
d43194df
PH
26376For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
26377(\caseful@_local@_part\ is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
26378up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set \caseful@_local@_part\
26379on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
26380local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
495ae4b0 26381
495ae4b0 26382
d43194df
PH
26383.section Dots in local parts
26384.index dot||in local part
26385.index local part||dots in
26386RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
26387part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
26388middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
26389empty components for compatibility.
495ae4b0 26390
495ae4b0 26391
d43194df
PH
26392.section Rewriting addresses
26393.index rewriting||addresses
26394Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
26395happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
26396in chapter ~~CHAPrewrite. The headers that may be affected by this are ::Bcc::,
26397::Cc::, ::From::, ::Reply-To::, ::Sender::, and ::To::.
495ae4b0 26398
d43194df
PH
26399Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
26400in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
26401routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
26402example, a header such as
26403.display asis
26404To: hare@teaparty
26405.endd
26406might get rewritten as
26407.display asis
26408To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
26409.endd
26410Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
26411does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
26412been routed.
495ae4b0 26413
d43194df
PH
26414Strictly, one should not do $it{any} deliveries of a message until all its
26415addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
26416result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
26417deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
26418immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
26419routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
495ae4b0
PH
26420
26421
26422.
26423.
26424.
26425.
26426. ============================================================================
26427.chapter SMTP processing
26428.set runningfoot "smtp processing"
26429.rset CHAPSMTP ~~chapter
26430.index SMTP||processing details
26431.index LMTP||processing details
26432Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
26433LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
26434closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
26435processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
26436.numberpars $.
26437SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or \*inetd*\);
26438.nextp
26439SMTP over the standard input and output (the \-bs-\ option);
26440.nextp
26441Batched SMTP on the standard input (the \-bS-\ option).
26442.endp
26443For mail delivery, the following are available:
26444.numberpars $.
26445SMTP over TCP/IP (the \%smtp%\ transport);
26446.nextp
26447LMTP over TCP/IP (the \%smtp%\ transport with the \protocol\ option set to
26448`lmtp');
26449.nextp
26450LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the \%lmtp%\
26451transport);
26452.nextp
26453Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports with
26454the \use@_bsmtp\ option set).
26455.endp
26456\*Batched SMTP*\ is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
26457stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
26458used to contain the envelope information.
26459
26460
26461.section Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP
26462.rset SECToutSMTPTCP "~~chapter.~~section"
26463.index SMTP||outgoing over TCP/IP
26464.index outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP
26465.index LMTP||over TCP/IP
26466.index outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP
26467.index \\EHLO\\
26468.index \\HELO\\
26469.index \\SIZE\\ option on \\MAIL\\ command
26470Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the \%smtp%\ transport.
26471The \protocol\ option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
26472processing is the same in both cases.
26473
26474If, in response to its \\EHLO\\ command, Exim is told that the \\SIZE\\
26475parameter is supported, it adds \\SIZE\\=<<n>> to each subsequent \\MAIL\\
26476command. The value of <<n>> is the message size plus the value of the
26477\size@_addition\ option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
26478such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
26479.index transport||filter
26480.index filter||transport filter
26481transport filter. If \size@_addition\ is set negative, the use of \\SIZE\\ is
26482suppressed.
26483
26484If the remote server advertises support for \\PIPELINING\\, Exim uses the
26485pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
26486required for the transaction.
26487
26488If the remote server advertises support for the \\STARTTLS\\ command, and Exim
26489was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
26490server matches \hosts@_avoid@_tls\. See chapter ~~CHAPTLS for more details.
26491
26492If the remote server advertises support for the \\AUTH\\ command, Exim scans
26493the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
26494in chapter ~~CHAPSMTPAUTH.
26495
26496.index carriage return
26497.index linefeed
26498Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
26499LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
26500order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
26501line terminator.
26502
26503If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
26504characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
26505same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
26506even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
26507of the \max@_rcpts\ option in the \%smtp%\ transport allows, in which case they
26508are split into groups containing no more than \max@_rcpts\ addresses each. If
26509\remote@_max@_parallel\ is greater than one, such groups may be sent in
26510parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
26511significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
26512
26513When the \%smtp%\ transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
26514message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
26515records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
26516particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
26517.index hints database||retry keys
26518Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
26519a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
26520See the next section for more detail about error handling.
26521
26522.index SMTP||passed connection
26523.index SMTP||batching over TCP/IP
26524When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
26525looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
26526messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
26527creates a new Exim process using the \-MC-\ option (which can only be used by a
26528process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it so
26529that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process does
26530only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in turn
26531pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
26532
26533The \connection@_max@_messages\ option of the \%smtp%\ transport can be used to
26534limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
26535.index asterisk||after IP address
26536The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
26537identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
26538square bracket of the IP address.
26539
26540
26541
26542.section Errors in outgoing SMTP
26543.rset SECToutSMTPerr "~~chapter.~~section"
26544.index error||in outgoing SMTP
26545.index SMTP||errors in outgoing
26546.index host||error
26547Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
26548message errors, and recipient errors.
26549.numberpars
26550A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
26551particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
26552.numberpars $.
26553Connection refused or timed out,
26554.nextp
26555Any error response code on connection,
26556.nextp
26557Any error response code to \\EHLO\\ or \\HELO\\,
26558.nextp
26559Loss of connection at any time, except after `.',
26560.nextp
26561I/O errors at any time,
26562.nextp
26563Timeouts during the session, other than in response to \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\ or
26564the `.' at the end of the data.
26565.endp
26566For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
26567\\EHLO\\, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
26568error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
26569host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
26570the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
26571alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
26572host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
26573made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
26574.nextp
26575.index message||error
26576A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
26577particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
26578message errors are:
26579.numberpars $.
26580Any error response code to \\MAIL\\, \\DATA\\, or the `.' that terminates
26581the data,
26582.nextp
26583Timeout after \\MAIL\\,
26584.nextp
26585Timeout
26586or loss of connection after the `.' that terminates the data. A timeout after
26587the \\DATA\\ command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
26588connection at any other time.
26589.endp
26590For a message error, a permanent error response (5$it{xx}) causes all addresses
26591to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
26592temporary error response (4$it{xx}), or one of the timeouts, causes all
26593addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
26594a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
26595message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
26596that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
26597time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
26598affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
26599it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
26600
26601If the remote host specified support for the \\SIZE\\ parameter in its response
26602to \\EHLO\\, Exim adds SIZE=$it{nnn} to the \\MAIL\\ command, so an
26603over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
26604response to \\MAIL\\.
26605.nextp
26606.index recipient||error
26607A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
26608recipient errors are:
26609.numberpars $.
26610Any error response to \\RCPT\\,
26611.nextp
26612Timeout after \\RCPT\\.
26613.endp
26614For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5$it{xx}) causes the
26615recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
26616sender. A temporary error response (4$it{xx}) or a timeout causes the failing
26617address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
26618used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
26619routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
26620operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
26621to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
26622if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
26623(`message too big for this recipient' is a possible example), other messages
26624have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
26625the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
26626the retry clock is reset.
26627
26628The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
26629host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
26630other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
26631in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
26632proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
26633than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
26634if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
26635through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
26636recipient's retry time.
26637.endp
26638
26639In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
26640current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
26641tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
26642own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
26643until the next delivery attempt.
26644
26645Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
26646\\MAIL\\ command at certain times (`insufficient space' has been seen). It
26647would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
26648host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
26649What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
26650is created.
26651
26652The reason that timeouts after \\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\ are treated specially is
26653that these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
26654procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
26655response had been received. A timeout after `.' is treated specially because it
26656is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
26657message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
26658helpful to treat this case as a message error.
26659
26660Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
26661host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\,
26662or `.' is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
26663the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
26664then to be treated as a host error.
26665
26666There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
26667terminating `.' if they do not like the contents of the message for some
26668reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5$it{xx} response
26669should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
26670host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
26671
26672
26673
26674
26675.section Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)
26676.index VERP
26677.index Variable Envelope Return Paths
26678.index envelope sender
26679Variable Envelope Return Paths -- see
26680\?ftp://koobera.math.uic.edu/www/proto/verp.txt?\ -- can be supported in Exim
26681by using the \return@_path\ generic transport option to rewrite the return path
26682at transport time. For example, the following could be used on an \%smtp%\
26683transport:
26684.display asis
26685return_path = \
26686 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
26687 {$1-request=$local_part%$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
26688.endd
26689This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on all
26690outgoing SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
26691`-request', and the domain is \*your.dom.example*\. The rewriting inserts the
26692local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
26693example, that a message whose return path has been set to
26694\*somelist-request@@your.dom.example*\ is sent to
26695\*subscriber@@other.dom.example*\. In the transport, the return path is
26696rewritten as
26697.display asis
26698somelist-request=subscriber%other.dom.example@your.dom.example
26699.endd
26700For this to work, you must arrange for outgoing messages that have `-request'
26701in their return paths to have just a single recipient. This can be done by
26702setting
26703.display asis
26704max_rcpt = 1
26705.endd
26706in the \%smtp%\ transport. Otherwise a single copy of a message might be
26707addressed to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
26708\$local@_part$\ is not available (because it is not unique). Of course, if you
26709do start sending out messages with this kind of return path, you must also
26710configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
26711Typically this would be done by setting an \local@_part@_suffix\ option for a
26712suitable router.
26713
26714The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
26715message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
26716host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
26717a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
26718a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
26719than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
26720used).
26721
26722
26723.section Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP
26724.index SMTP||incoming over TCP/IP
26725.index incoming SMTP over TCP/IP
26726.index inetd
26727.index daemon
26728Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
26729listening daemon, or by using \*inetd*\. In the latter case, the entry in
26730\(/etc/inetd.conf)\ should be like this:
26731.display asis
26732smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
26733.endd
26734Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
26735agent using the \-bs-\ option by checking whether or not the standard input is
26736a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
26737the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
26738with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
26739stream and exits with an error code.
26740
26741By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
26742disconnects (either via the daemon or \*inetd*\), unless the disconnection is
26743unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
26744\smtp@_connection\ log selector.
26745
26746.index carriage return
26747.index linefeed
26748Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
26749LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
26750order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
26751line terminator.
26752Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
26753sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
26754sequence `CR, dot, CR' does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
26755
26756.index \\EHLO\\||invalid data
26757.index \\HELO\\||invalid data
26758One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the \\EHLO\\ or
26759\\HELO\\ commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
26760commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
26761the data that is sent, so \helo@_verify@_hosts\ is not relevant.) You can tell
26762Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting \helo@_accept@_junk@_hosts\ to
26763match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
26764
26765.index \\SIZE\\ option on \\MAIL\\ command
26766.index \\MAIL\\||\\SIZE\\ option
26767The amount of disk space available is checked whenever \\SIZE\\ is received on
26768a \\MAIL\\ command, independently of whether \message@_size@_limit\ or
26769\check@_spool@_space\ is configured, unless \smtp__check__spool__space\ is set
26770false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
26771\check@_spool@_space\ is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
26772value given with \\SIZE\\, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
26773message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
26774
26775When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
26776its response to the final `.' that terminates the data. If the remote host logs
26777this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
26778
26779The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
26780prepared to handle (see the \smtp@_accept@_max\ option). It can also limit the
26781number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
26782\smtp@_accept@_max@_per@_host\ option). Additional connection attempts are
26783rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
26784
26785The Exim daemon does not rely on the \\SIGCHLD\\ signal to detect when a
26786subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
26787for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
26788things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
26789processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
26790sometimes see a `defunct' Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem; it
26791will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
26792
26793When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
26794and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
26795high system load -- for details see the \smtp@_accept@_reserve\,
26796\smtp@_load@_reserve\, and \smtp@_reserve@_hosts\ options. The load check
26797applies in both the daemon and \*inetd*\ cases.
26798
26799Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
26800can be varied by means of the \-odq-\ command line option and the
26801\queue@_only\, \queue@_only@_file\, and \queue@_only@_load\ options. The number
26802of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from SMTP
26803input can be limited by the \smtp__accept__queue\ and
26804\smtp__accept__queue__per__connection\ options. When either limit is reached,
26805subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
26806a delivery process.
26807
26808The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (\smtp@_accept@_max\,
26809\smtp@_accept@_queue\, \smtp__accept__reserve\) are not available when Exim is
26810started up from the \*inetd*\ daemon, because in that case each connection is
26811handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
26812however, available with \*inetd*\.
26813
26814Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
26815are received. See chapter ~~CHAPACL for details. It can also be configured to
26816rewrite addresses at this time -- before any syntax checking is done. See
26817section ~~SECTrewriteS.
26818
26819Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
26820\\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\ commands in a single SMTP session. See the
26821\smtp@_ratelimit@_hosts\ option.
26822
26823
26824.section Unrecognized SMTP commands
26825.index SMTP||unrecognized commands
26826If Exim receives more than \smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands\ unrecognized SMTP
26827commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
26828the error response to the last command. The default value for
26829\smtp@_max@_unknown@_commands\ is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
26830abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
26831circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
26832
26833.section Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands
26834.index SMTP||syntax errors
26835.index SMTP||protocol errors
4964e932 26836A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
495ae4b0
PH
26837something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
26838address in a \\RCPT\\ command. Protocol errors include invalid command
4964e932
PH
26839sequencing such as \\RCPT\\ before \\MAIL\\. If Exim receives more than
26840\smtp@_max@_synprot@_errors\ such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
26841drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
26842default value for \smtp__max__synprot__errors\ is 3. This is a defence against
495ae4b0
PH
26843broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
26844
26845
26846.section Use of non-mail SMTP commands
26847.index SMTP||non-mail commands
26848The `non-mail' SMTP commands are those other than \\MAIL\\, \\RCPT\\, and
26849\\DATA\\. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
26850many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
26851denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing \\AUTH\\s, or a mad
26852client looping sending \\EHLO\\. The global option \smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail\
26853defines what `too many' means. Its default value is 10.
26854
26855When a new message is expected, one occurrence of \\RSET\\ is not counted. This
26856allows a client to send one \\RSET\\ between messages (this is not necessary,
26857but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of \\HELO\\
26858or \\EHLO\\, and one occurrence of \\STARTTLS\\ between messages. After
26859starting up a TLS session, another \\EHLO\\ is expected, and so it too is not
26860counted.
26861
26862The first occurrence of \\AUTH\\ in a connection, or immediately following
26863\\STARTTLS\\ is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than \\MAIL\\,
26864\\RCPT\\, \\DATA\\, and \\QUIT\\ are counted.
26865
26866You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
26867\smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail\ by setting
4964e932 26868\smtp@_accept@_max@_nonmail@_hosts\. The default value is \"$*$"\, which makes
495ae4b0
PH
26869the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
26870specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
26871
26872
26873
26874.section The \\VRFY\\ and \\EXPN\\ commands
26875When Exim receives a \\VRFY\\ or \\EXPN\\ command on a TCP/IP connection, it
26876runs the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_vrfy\ or \acl@_smtp@_expn\ (as
26877appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
26878If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
26879
26880.index \\VRFY\\||processing
26881When \\VRFY\\ is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
26882called with the \-bv-\ option.
26883.index \\EXPN\\||processing
26884When \\EXPN\\ is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
26885\\EXPN\\ is treated as an `address test' (similar to the \-bt-\ option) rather
26886than a verification (the \-bv-\ option). If an unqualified local part is given
26887as the argument to \\EXPN\\, it is qualified with \qualify@_domain\. Rejections
26888of \\VRFY\\ and \\EXPN\\ commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
26889\\VRFY\\ verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
26890\\RCPT\\ failures.
26891
26892
26893.section The \\ETRN\\ command
26894.rset SECTETRN "~~chapter.~~section"
26895.index \\ETRN\\||processing
26896RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called \\ETRN\\ that is designed to
26897overcome the security problems of the \\TURN\\ command (which has fallen into
26898disuse). When Exim receives an \\ETRN\\ command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
26899the ACL specified by \acl@_smtp@_etrn\ in order to decide whether the command
26900should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
26901
26902The \\ETRN\\ command is concerned with `releasing' messages that are awaiting
26903delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
26904the only form of \\ETRN\\ that is supported by default is the one where the
26905text starts with the `@#' prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
26906specific to the SMTP server. A valid \\ETRN\\ command causes a run of Exim with
26907the \-R-\ option to happen, with the remainder of the \\ETRN\\ text as its
26908argument. For example,
26909.display asis
26910ETRN #brigadoon
26911.endd
26912runs the command
26913.display asis
26914exim -R brigadoon
26915.endd
26916which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
26917containing the text `brigadoon'. When \smtp@_etrn@_serialize\ is set (the
26918default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
26919for the same argument string as a result of an \\ETRN\\ command. This stops
26920a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
26921
26922.index hints database||\\ETRN\\ serialization
26923Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
26924record is written whenever a process is started by \\ETRN\\, and deleted when
26925the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
26926the \\ETRN\\ process to complete. Once \\ETRN\\ is accepted, the client is sent
26927a `success' return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get left
26928lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this, Exim
26929ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26930
26931.index \smtp@_etrn@_command\
26932For more control over what \\ETRN\\ does, the \smtp@_etrn@_command\ option can
26933used. This specifies a command that is run whenever \\ETRN\\ is received,
26934whatever the form of its argument. For
26935example:
26936.display asis
26937smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain $sender_host_address
26938.endd
26939The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
26940expansion variable \$domain$\ is set to the argument of the \\ETRN\\ command,
26941and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
26942wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
26943under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
26944for it to change them before running the command.
26945
26946
26947.section Incoming local SMTP
26948.index SMTP||local incoming
26949Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
26950standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
26951line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
26952\-bs-\ option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
26953messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
26954sender given in a \\MAIL\\ command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
26955an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
26956identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
26957runs for \\RCPT\\ commands:
26958.display asis
26959accept hosts = :
26960.endd
26961This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
26962
26963
26964.section Outgoing batched SMTP
26965.rset SECTbatchSMTP "~~chapter.~~section"
26966.index SMTP||batched outgoing
26967.index batched SMTP output
26968Both the \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ transports can be used for handling batched
26969SMTP. Each has an option called \use@_bsmtp\ which causes messages to be output
26970in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of delivery. All
26971it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the envelope along
26972with the message.
26973
26974The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
26975\\MAIL\\ and \\RCPT\\, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
26976the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
26977\\HELO\\ is not normally used. If it is required, the \message@_prefix\ option
26978can be used to specify it.
26979
26980Because \%appendfile%\ and \%pipe%\ are both local transports, they accept only
26981one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
26982to handle several addresses at once by setting the \batch@_max\ option. When
26983this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple \\RCPT\\ commands. See
26984chapter ~~CHAPbatching for more details.
26985
26986When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
26987sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
26988transport in the variable \$host$\. Here is an example of such a transport and
26989router:
26990.display asis
26991begin routers
26992route_append:
26993 driver = manualroute
26994 transport = smtp_appendfile
26995 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
26996
26997begin transports
26998smtp_appendfile:
26999 driver = appendfile
27000 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
27001 batch_max = 1000
27002 use_bsmtp
27003 user = exim
27004.endd
27005This causes messages addressed to \*domain.example*\ to be written in BSMTP
27006format to \(/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example)\, with only a single copy of each
27007message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
27008
27009
27010.section Incoming batched SMTP
27011.rset SECTincomingbatchedSMTP "~~chapter.~~section"
27012.index SMTP||batched incoming
27013.index batched SMTP input
27014The \-bS-\ command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
27015reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
27016is trusted, the senders in the \\MAIL\\ commands are believed; otherwise the
27017sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
27018rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. \\HELO\\
27019and \\EHLO\\ act as \\RSET\\; \\VRFY\\, \\EXPN\\, \\ETRN\\ and \\HELP\\, act
27020as \\NOOP\\; \\QUIT\\ quits.
27021
27022No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
27023In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
27024
27025If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing `.' at
27026the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
27027standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
27028make some use of automatically, for example:
27029.display asis
27030554 Unexpected end of file
27031Transaction started in line 10
27032Error detected in line 14
27033.endd
27034It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
27035file, for example:
27036.display asis
27037An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
27038The error message was:
27039
27040 501 '>' missing at end of address
27041
27042The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
27043The error was detected in line 12.
27044The SMTP command at fault was:
27045
27046 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
27047
270481 previous message was successfully processed.
27049The rest of the batch was abandoned.
27050.endd
27051The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
27052messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
27053accepted.
27054
27055
27056
495ae4b0
PH
27057.
27058.
27059.
27060.
27061. ============================================================================
d43194df
PH
27062.chapter Customizing bounce and warning messages
27063.set runningfoot "customizing messages"
27064.rset CHAPemsgcust "~~chapter"
27065When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
27066configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
27067to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
27068the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
27069string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
495ae4b0 27070
d43194df
PH
27071The ::From:: and ::To:: header lines are automatically generated; you can cause
27072a ::Reply-To:: line to be added by setting the \errors@_reply@_to\ option. Exim
27073also adds the line
495ae4b0 27074.display asis
d43194df 27075Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
495ae4b0 27076.endd
d43194df 27077to all warning and bounce messages,
495ae4b0 27078
d43194df
PH
27079.section Customizing bounce messages
27080.index customizing||bounce message
27081.index bounce message||customizing
27082If \bounce@_message@_text\ is set, its contents are included in the default
27083message immediately after `This message was created automatically by mail
27084delivery software.' The string is not expanded. It is not used if
27085\bounce@_message@_file\ is set.
495ae4b0 27086
d43194df
PH
27087When \bounce@_message@_file\ is set, it must point to a template file for
27088constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
27089separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
27090opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
27091logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
27092item.
495ae4b0 27093
d43194df
PH
27094Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
27095expansion variables which can be of use here: \$bounce@_recipient$\ is set to
27096the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
27097\$return@_size@_limit$\ contains the value of the \return@_size@_limit\ option,
27098rounded to a whole number.
495ae4b0 27099
d43194df 27100The items must appear in the file in the following order:
495ae4b0 27101.numberpars $.
d43194df
PH
27102The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
27103::Subject:: header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
495ae4b0 27104.nextp
d43194df
PH
27105The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
27106failing addresses with their error messages.
495ae4b0 27107.nextp
d43194df
PH
27108The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
27109returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
495ae4b0 27110.nextp
d43194df
PH
27111The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
27112as part of the error report.
495ae4b0 27113.nextp
d43194df
PH
27114The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
27115truncated because it is bigger than \return@_size@_limit\.
27116.nextp
27117The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
495ae4b0 27118.endp
d43194df
PH
27119The default state (\bounce@_message@_file\ unset) is equivalent to the
27120following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The ::Subject:: line has been
27121split into two here in order to fit it on the page:
27122.if ~~sys.fancy
27123.display flow asis
27124.fontgroup 0
27125.font 54
27126.else
27127.rule
27128.display flow asis
27129.linelength 80em
27130.indent 0
27131.fi
27132Subject: Mail delivery failed
27133 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}{: returning message to sender}}
27134****
27135This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
495ae4b0 27136
d43194df 27137A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}{that you sent }{sent by
495ae4b0 27138
d43194df 27139 <$sender_address>
495ae4b0 27140
d43194df
PH
27141}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
27142The following address(es) failed:
27143****
27144The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
27145****
27146------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers. ------
27147****
27148------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long; only the first
27149------ $return_size_limit or so are included here.
27150****
27151.endd
27152.if !~~sys.fancy
27153.rule
27154.fi
495ae4b0 27155
d43194df
PH
27156.section Customizing warning messages
27157.rset SECTcustwarn "~~chapter.~~section"
27158.index customizing||warning message
27159.index warning of delay||customizing the message
27160The option
27161\warn@_message@_file\
27162can be pointed at a template file for use when
27163warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
27164text sections:
27165.numberpars $.
27166The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
27167::Subject:: header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
27168.nextp
27169The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
27170the delayed addresses.
27171.nextp
27172The third item then ends the message.
27173.endp
27174The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that the line
27175starting `A message' has been split here, in order to fit it on the page:
27176.if ~~sys.fancy
495ae4b0 27177.display asis
d43194df
PH
27178.fontgroup 0
27179.font 54
27180.else
27181.rule
27182.display asis
27183.linelength 80em
27184.indent 0
27185.fi
27186.newline
27187Subject: Warning: message $message_id delayed $warn_message_delay
27188****
27189This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
495ae4b0 27190
d43194df
PH
27191A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
27192 {that you sent }{sent by
495ae4b0 27193
d43194df 27194 <$sender_address>
495ae4b0 27195
d43194df
PH
27196}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
27197more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
27198.newline
495ae4b0 27199
d43194df
PH
27200The message identifier is: $message_id
27201The subject of the message is: $h_subject
27202The date of the message is: $h_date
495ae4b0 27203
d43194df
PH
27204The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
27205****
27206No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will continue for
27207some time, and this warning may be repeated at intervals if the message
27208remains undelivered. Eventually the mail delivery software will give up,
27209and when that happens, the message will be returned to you.
27210.endd
27211.if !~~sys.fancy
27212.rule
27213.fi
27214except that in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
27215appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
27216\$warn@_message@_delay$\
27217is set to the delay time in one of the forms `<<n>> minutes'
27218or `<<n>> hours', and
27219\$warn@_message@_recipients$\
27220contains a list of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than
27221one if there are multiple addresses with different \errors@_to\ settings on the
27222routers that handled them.
495ae4b0 27223
495ae4b0 27224
495ae4b0
PH
27225
27226
d43194df
PH
27227.
27228.
27229.
27230. ============================================================================
27231.chapter Some common configuration requirements
27232.set runningfoot "common configuration requirements"
27233.rset CHAPcomconreq "~~chapter"
27234This chapter discusses some configuration requirements that seem to be fairly
27235common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
27236
27237
27238.section Sending mail to a smart host
27239.index smart host||example router
27240If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a `smart host', you
27241should replace the default \%dnslookup%\ router with a router which does the
27242routing explicitly:
495ae4b0 27243.display asis
d43194df
PH
27244send_to_smart_host:
27245 driver = manualroute
27246 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
27247 transport = remote_smtp
495ae4b0 27248.endd
d43194df
PH
27249You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
27250.em
27251If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
27252receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
27253synchronously by setting the \mua@_wrapper\ option (see chapter
27254~~CHAPnonqueueing).
27255.nem
495ae4b0
PH
27256
27257
d43194df
PH
27258.section Using Exim to handle mailing lists
27259.rset SECTmailinglists "~~chapter.~~section"
27260.index mailing lists
27261Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
27262requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
27263Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
495ae4b0 27264
d43194df
PH
27265The \%redirect%\ router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
27266is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
27267independent manager. The \domains\ router option can be used to run these
27268lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
27269.display asis
27270lists:
27271 driver = redirect
27272 domains = lists.example
27273 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
27274 forbid_pipe
27275 forbid_file
27276 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
27277 no_more
27278.endd
27279This router is skipped for domains other than \*lists.example*\. For addresses
27280in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
27281such file, the router declines, but because \no@_more\ is set, no subsequent
27282routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
495ae4b0 27283
d43194df
PH
27284The \forbid@_pipe\ and \forbid@_file\ options prevent a local part from being
27285expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
27286a mailing list.
495ae4b0 27287
d43194df
PH
27288.index \errors@_to\
27289The \errors@_to\ option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
27290taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
27291original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
27292the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
495ae4b0 27293
d43194df
PH
27294For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
27295\*dicts@@lists.example*\ is passed on to those addresses contained in
27296\(/usr/lists/dicts)\, with error reports directed to
27297\*dicts-request@@lists.example*\, provided that this address can be verified.
27298There could be a file called \(/usr/lists/dicts-request)\ containing
27299the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
27300such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the \local@_part@_prefix\
27301or \local@_part@_suffix\ options) to handle addresses of the form \owner-xxx\
27302or \xxx-request\, are also possible.
495ae4b0 27303
495ae4b0 27304
d43194df
PH
27305.section Syntax errors in mailing lists
27306.index mailing lists||syntax errors in
27307If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
27308delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
27309list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
27310list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
27311addresses are not rigorously checked.
495ae4b0 27312
d43194df
PH
27313If the \skip@_syntax@_errors\ option is set, the \%redirect%\ router just skips
27314entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
27315\syntax@_errors@_to\ is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
27316whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
27317\syntax@_errors@_to\ to the same address as \errors@_to\.
495ae4b0
PH
27318
27319
d43194df
PH
27320.section Re-expansion of mailing lists
27321.index mailing lists||re-expansion of
27322Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
27323in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
27324recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
27325cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
27326delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
27327account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
27328the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
27329message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
495ae4b0 27330
d43194df
PH
27331If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the \one@_time\ option can be set
27332on the \%redirect%\ router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
27333router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
27334`top level' addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
27335`delivered'. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
27336subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
27337failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
27338pre-existing messages.
495ae4b0 27339
d43194df
PH
27340The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
27341addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
27342addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
27343\all@_parents\ selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
27344one level of expansion anyway.
495ae4b0
PH
27345
27346
d43194df
PH
27347.section Closed mailing lists
27348.index mailing lists||closed
27349The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
27350send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
27351from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
27352\senders\ option to restrict the router that handles the list.
495ae4b0 27353
d43194df
PH
27354The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
27355of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
27356.display asis
27357lists_request:
27358 driver = redirect
27359 domains = lists.example
27360 local_part_suffix = -request
27361 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
27362 no_more
495ae4b0 27363
d43194df
PH
27364lists_post:
27365 driver = redirect
27366 domains = lists.example
27367 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
27368 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
27369 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
27370 forbid_pipe
27371 forbid_file
27372 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
27373 no_more
495ae4b0 27374
d43194df
PH
27375lists_closed:
27376 driver = redirect
27377 domains = lists.example
27378 allow_fail
27379 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
27380.endd
27381All three routers have the same \domains\ setting, so for any other domains,
27382they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
27383\@-request\. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
27384mailing list.
27385
27386The second router runs only if the \senders\ precondition is satisfied. It
27387checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
27388checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
27389necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
27390because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
27391not exist, the expansion of \senders\ is $*$, which matches all senders. This
27392means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
27393\no@_more\ ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
27394`unrouteable address' error.
27395
27396The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
27397a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
27398the address, giving a suitable error message.
27399
27400
27401
27402.section Virtual domains
27403.rset SECTvirtualdomains "~~chapter.~~section"
27404.index virtual domains
27405.index domain||virtual
27406The phrase \*virtual domain*\ is unfortunately used with two rather different
27407meanings:
27408.numberpars $.
27409A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
27410aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
27411top-level domains and `vanity' domains.
27412.nextp
27413One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
27414with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
27415have login accounts on that host.
27416.endp
27417The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more `virtual' than the
27418second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
27419aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
27420virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
27421whether the domain exists. The \%dsearch%\ lookup type is useful here, leading
27422to a router of this form:
27423.display asis
27424virtual:
27425 driver = redirect
27426 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
27427 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
27428 no_more
27429.endd
27430The \domains\ option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
27431is a file in the \(/etc/mail/virtual)\ directory whose name is the same as the
27432domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
27433part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The \no@_more\
27434setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to \data\ being an empty
27435string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
27436
27437This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
27438follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
27439can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
27440a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
27441
27442The other kind of `virtual' domain can also be handled in a straightforward
27443way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
27444valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
27445.display asis
27446my_domains:
27447 driver = accept
27448 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
27449 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
27450 transport = my_mailboxes
27451.endd
27452The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
27453can be found in the file. The \domains\ option is used to check for the file's
27454existence because \domains\ is tested before the \local@_parts\ option (see
27455section ~~SECTrouprecon). You can't use \require@_files\, because that option
27456is tested after \local@_parts\. The transport is as follows:
27457.display asis
27458my_mailboxes:
27459 driver = appendfile
27460 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
27461 user = mail
27462.endd
27463This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The \user\ setting is
27464required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
27465
27466The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
27467requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
27468up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
27469information about the domains.
27470
27471
27472.section Multiple user mailboxes
27473.rset SECTmulbox "~~chapter.~~section"
27474.index multiple mailboxes
27475.index mailbox||multiple
27476.index local part||prefix
27477.index local part||suffix
27478Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
27479incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
27480allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
27481identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
27482parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
27483\local@_part@_prefix\ and \local@_part@_suffix\ can be used for this. For
27484example, consider this router:
27485.display asis
27486userforward:
27487 driver = redirect
27488 check_local_user
27489 file = $home/.forward
27490 local_part_suffix = -*
27491 local_part_suffix_optional
27492 allow_filter
27493.endd
27494It runs a user's \(.forward)\ file for all local parts of the form
27495\*username-$*$*\. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
27496cases by testing the variable \$local@_part@_suffix$\. For example:
27497.display asis
27498if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
27499 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
27500endif
27501.endd
27502If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
27503fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
27504\local@_part@_suffix\ option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
27505control over which suffixes are valid.
27506
27507Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
27508\(.forward)\ file -- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
27509another MTA:
27510.display asis
27511userforward:
27512 driver = redirect
27513 check_local_user
27514 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
27515 local_part_suffix = -*
27516 local_part_suffix_optional
27517 allow_filter
27518.endd
27519If there is no suffix, \(.forward)\ is used; if the suffix is \*-special*\, for
27520example, \(.forward-special)\ is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
27521does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
27522subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
27523\(.forward)\ file to use as a default.
27524
27525
27526.section Simplified vacation processing
27527.index vacation processing
27528The traditional way of running the \*vacation*\ program is for a user to set up
27529a pipe command in a \(.forward)\ file
27530(see section ~~SECTspecitredli for syntax details).
27531This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
27532that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
27533.numberpars $.
27534A local part prefix such as `vacation-' can be specified on a router which
27535can cause the message to be delivered directly to the \*vacation*\ program, or
27536alternatively can use Exim's \%autoreply%\ transport. The contents of a user's
27537\(.forward)\ file are then much simpler. For example:
27538.display asis
27539spqr, vacation-spqr
27540.endd
27541.nextp
27542The \require@_files\ generic router option can be used to trigger a
27543vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
27544user's home directory. The \unseen\ generic option should also be used, to
27545ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
27546to do is to create a file called, say, \(.vacation)\, containing a vacation
27547message.
27548.endp
27549Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
27550use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
495ae4b0 27551
495ae4b0 27552
d43194df
PH
27553.section Taking copies of mail
27554.index message||copying every
27555Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
27556be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
27557command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
27558each day's messages.
495ae4b0 27559
d43194df
PH
27560There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
27561messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
27562delivery. This could be used, $it{inter alia}, to implement automatic
27563notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
495ae4b0
PH
27564
27565
d43194df
PH
27566.section Intermittently connected hosts
27567.index intermittently connected hosts
27568It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
27569Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
27570arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
27571permanently connected.
495ae4b0 27572
d43194df
PH
27573Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
27574particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
27575Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
495ae4b0 27576
d43194df
PH
27577.section Exim on the upstream server host
27578It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
27579host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
27580approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
27581being mixed up in the same queue -- those that cannot be delivered because of
27582some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
27583to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
27584resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
495ae4b0 27585
d43194df
PH
27586A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
27587intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
27588into local files in batch SMTP, `mailstore', or other envelope-preserving
27589format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
27590destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
27591in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
27592if required.
495ae4b0 27593
d43194df
PH
27594On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
27595you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
27596intermittent host. For example:
27597.display
27598cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
495ae4b0 27599.endd
d43194df
PH
27600This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
27601which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
27602online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the \-M-\ or \-R-\
27603options, or by using the \\ETRN\\ SMTP command (see section ~~SECTETRN)
27604causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
27605connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
27606immediately.
495ae4b0 27607
d43194df
PH
27608If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
27609issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
27610mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
27611used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
27612avoided by unsetting \retry__include__ip__address\ on the \%smtp%\ transport.
27613Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
27614arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
495ae4b0
PH
27615
27616
d43194df
PH
27617.section Exim on the intermittently connected client host
27618The value of \smtp@_accept@_queue@_per@_connection\ should probably be
27619increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
27620connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
27621delivered immediately.
495ae4b0 27622
d43194df
PH
27623.index SMTP||passed connection
27624.index SMTP||multiple deliveries
27625.index multiple SMTP deliveries
27626Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
27627not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
27628possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
27629each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
27630avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
27631\-qq-\ instead of \-q-\. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the first
27632pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a normal
27633queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those destined
27634for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a single
27635SMTP connection.
495ae4b0 27636
495ae4b0
PH
27637
27638
d43194df
PH
27639.
27640.
27641.
27642.
27643. ============================================================================
27644.chapter Using Exim as a non-queueing client
27645.set runningfoot "non-queueing client"
27646.rset CHAPnonqueueing "~~chapter"
27647.index client, non-queueing
27648.index smart host||queueing, suppressing
27649.em
27650On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
27651email to be sent to a `smart host'. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
27652configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
27653However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
27654configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
27655\(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\. Furthermore, utility programs such as \*cron*\ submit
27656messages this way.
27657
27658If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
27659run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
27660any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
27661continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
27662email is not desirable.
27663
27664There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
27665\(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\ interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
27666any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
27667host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
27668informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
27669to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
27670to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
27671
27672There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called \*ssmtp*\)
27673that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
27674ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
27675before sending a message to the smart host.
27676
27677Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
27678tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
27679overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
27680
27681.index \mua@_wrapper\
27682There is a Boolean global option called \mua@_wrapper\, defaulting false.
27683Setting \mua@_wrapper\ true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
27684assumes that it is being used to `wrap' a command-line MUA in the manner
27685just described. As well as setting \mua@_wrapper\, you also need to provide a
27686compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
27687router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
27688
27689When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
27690following ways:
27691.numberpars alpha
27692A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from \*inetd*\.
27693In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
27694.nextp
27695Each message is synchonously delivered as soon as it is received (\-odi-\ is
27696assumed). All queueing options (\queue@_only\, \queue@_smtp@_domains\,
27697\control\ in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process does
27698not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
27699successful, a zero return code is given.
27700.nextp
27701Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
27702be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
27703the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
27704must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
27705deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
27706are.
27707.nextp
27708If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a failure
27709or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
27710successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
27711.nextp
27712Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there is
27713no distinction between 4\*xx*\ and 5\*xx*\ SMTP response codes from the smart
27714host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to the
27715caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
27716there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
27717.nextp
27718If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
27719connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
27720failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
27721.nextp
27722When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
27723(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
27724value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
27725are ever generated.
27726.nextp
27727No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
27728.nextp
27729A number of Exim options are overridden: \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ is forced
27730true, \max@_rcpt\ in the smtp transport is forced to `unlimited',
27731\remote@_max@_parallel\ is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
27732.endp
27733The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
27734the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
27735deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
27736privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to \*exim*\ instead of setuid
27737to \*root*\. See section ~~SECTrunexiwitpri for a general discussion about the
27738advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
27739.nem
495ae4b0
PH
27740
27741
27742
27743.
27744.
27745.
27746.
27747. ============================================================================
27748.chapter Log files
27749.set runningfoot "log files"
27750.rset CHAPlog "~~chapter"
27751.index log||types of
27752.index log||general description
27753Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
27754and the panic log:
27755.numberpars $.
27756.index main log
27757The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
27758line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
27759down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
27760out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
27761them are optional, in which case the \log@_selector\ option controls whether
27762they are included or not. A Perl script called \*eximstats*\, which does simple
27763analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
27764~~SECTmailstat).
27765.nextp
27766.index reject log
27767The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
4964e932 27768of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
495ae4b0
PH
27769The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
27770the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
27771is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
27772lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
27773reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
27774host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
27775can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting \write@_rejectlog\ false.
495ae4b0
PH
27776.nextp
27777.index panic log
27778.index system log
27779When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
27780error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
27781are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
27782other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
27783therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a \*cron*\ script check it)
27784regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
27785panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
27786is opened with LOG@_PID+LOG@_CONS and the facility code of LOG@_MAIL. The
27787message itself is written at priority LOG@_CRIT.
27788.endp
27789Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in this example:
27790.display asis
277912001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed by QUIT
27792.endd
4964e932 27793By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
495ae4b0
PH
27794ways of changing this:
27795.numberpars $.
27796You can set the \timezone\ option to a different time zone; in particular, if
27797you set
27798.display asis
27799timezone = UTC
27800.endd
27801the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
27802.nextp
4964e932 27803If you set \log@_timezone\ true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
495ae4b0
PH
27804example:
27805.display asis
278062003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
27807.endd
27808.endp
27809
27810
27811
27812.section Where the logs are written
27813.rset SECTwhelogwri "~~chapter.~~section"
27814.index log||destination
27815.index log||to file
27816.index log||to syslog
27817.index syslog
27818The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
27819should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
27820are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
27821arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
27822It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
27823need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write -- on Linux
27824this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
27825
27826The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ in
27827\(Local/Makefile)\ or by setting \log@_file@_path\ in the run time
27828configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
27829references to the host name:
27830.display asis
27831log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
27832.endd
27833It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in \(Local/Makefile)\
27834rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
27835start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
27836before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
27837configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
27838log at all.
27839
27840The value of \\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ or \log@_file@_path\ is a colon-separated
27841list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
27842facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
27843colon-separated. If an item in the list is `syslog' then syslog is used;
27844otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing \"%s"\ at the
27845point where `main', `reject', or `panic' is to be inserted, or be empty,
27846implying the use of a default path.
27847
27848When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
27849\\LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
27850`syslog'. This means that an empty item in \log@_file@_path\ can be used to
27851mean `use the path specified at build time'. It no such item exists, log files
27852are written in the \(log)\ subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
27853equivalent to the setting:
27854.display asis
27855log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
27856.endd
4964e932 27857If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
495ae4b0
PH
27858logs are written.
27859
27860A log file path may also contain \"%D"\ if datestamped log file names are in
27861use -- see section ~~SECTdatlogfil below.
27862
27863Here are some examples of possible settings:
27864.display
27865.tabs 42
27866LOG@_FILE@_PATH=syslog $t $rm{syslog only}
27867LOG@_FILE@_PATH=:syslog $t $rm{syslog and default path}
27868LOG@_FILE@_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim@_%s $t $rm{syslog and specified path}
27869LOG@_FILE@_PATH=/usr/log/exim@_%s $t $rm{specified path only}
27870.endd
27871If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
27872error is logged.
27873
27874
27875.section Logging to local files that are periodically `cycled'
27876.index log||cycling local files
27877.index cycling logs
27878.index \*exicyclog*\
27879.index log||local files, writing to
27880Some operating systems provide centralized and standardised methods for cycling
27881log files. For those that do not, a utility script called \*exicyclog*\ is
27882provided (see section ~~SECTcyclogfil). This renames and compresses the main
27883and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to keep
27884can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily \*cron*\ job.
27885
27886An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
27887and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required -- for
27888example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
27889message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
27890that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if \*exicyclog*\ or
27891something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
27892ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
27893\*stat()*\ on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
27894does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
27895tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
27896for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
27897renamed.
27898
27899
27900.section Datestamped log files
27901.rset SECTdatlogfil "~~chapter.~~section"
27902.index log||datestamped files
27903Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
27904periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
27905for example, \(mainlog-20031225)\. The datestamp is in the form \(yyyymmdd)\.
27906Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
27907\log@_file@_path\ option to a path that includes \"%D"\ at the point where the
27908datestamp is required. For example:
27909.display asis
27910log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
27911log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
27912log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
27913.endd
27914As before, \"%s"\ is replaced by `main' or `reject'; the following are examples
27915of names generated by the above examples:
27916.display asis
27917/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
27918/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
27919/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
27920.endd
27921When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
27922files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
27923will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
27924run \*exicyclog*\ with this form of logging.
27925
27926The location of the panic log is also determined by \log@_file@_path\, but it
27927is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
27928When generating the name of the panic log, \"%D"\ is removed from the string.
27929In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
27930character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
27931removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
27932.display asis
27933/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
27934/var/log/exim-panic.log
27935/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
27936.endd
27937
27938
27939.section Logging to syslog
27940.index log||syslog, writing to
27941The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
27942except in one respect. If \syslog@_timestamp\ is set false, the timestamps on
27943Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
27944that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
27945`facility' is set to \\LOG@_MAIL\\, and the program name to `exim'
27946by default, but you can change these by setting the \syslog@_facility\ and
27947\syslog@_processname\ options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
4964e932 27948\\SYSLOG@_LOG@_PID\\ set in \(Local/Makefile)\ (this is the default in
495ae4b0
PH
27949\(src/EDITME)\), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
27950\\LOG@_PID\\ flag is set so that the \*syslog()*\ call adds the pid as well as
27951the time and host name to each line.
27952The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
27953.numberpars " "
27954\*mainlog*\ is mapped to \\LOG@_INFO\\
27955.nextp
27956\*rejectlog*\ is mapped to \\LOG@_NOTICE\\
27957.nextp
27958\*paniclog*\ is mapped to \\LOG@_ALERT\\
27959.endp
4964e932 27960Many log lines are written to both \*mainlog*\ and \*rejectlog*\, and some are
495ae4b0 27961written to both \*mainlog*\ and \*paniclog*\, so there will be duplicates if
4964e932 27962these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
495ae4b0
PH
27963by setting \syslog@_duplication\ false.
27964
27965Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its \*rejectlog*\
27966entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
27967these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate \*syslog()*\
4964e932 27968calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
495ae4b0
PH
27969870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
27970additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
27971replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
27972RFC 3164, you should set
27973.display asis
27974SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
27975.endd
4964e932 27976in \(Local/Makefile)\ before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
495ae4b0
PH
27977lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in \*reject*\ log entries.
27978
27979To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
27980entry starts with a string of the form `[<<n>>/<<m>>]' or `[<<n>>@\<<m>>]'
27981where <<n>> is the component number and <<m>> is the total number of components
27982in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split because it was
27983too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the @\ delimiter is
27984used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 70 instead of 1000, the
27985following would be the result of a typical rejection message to \*mainlog*\
27986(LOG@_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host name, and
27987pid as added by syslog:
27988.display
27989.indent 0
27990$smc{[1/3] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from [127.0.0.1] (ph10):
27991[2/3] syntax error in 'From' header when scanning for sender: missing or ma
27992[3/3] lformed local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@@cam.example>)}
27993.endd
27994The same error might cause the following lines to be written to `rejectlog'
27995(LOG@_NOTICE):
27996.display flow
27997.indent 0
27998$smc{[1/14] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from [127.0.0.1] (ph10):
27999[2/14] syntax error in 'From' header when scanning for sender: missing or ma
28000[3@\14] lformed local part in "@<@>" (envelope sender is <ph10@@cam.example>)
28001[4@\14] Recipients: ph10@@some.domain.cam.example
28002[5@\14] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
28003[6@\14] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
28004[7@\14] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
28005[8@\14] for ph10@@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
28006[9@\14] F From: @<@>
28007[10@\14] Subject: this is a test header
28008[11@\14] X-something: this is another header
28009[12@\14] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@@xxxxx.cam.example>
28010[13@\14] B Bcc:
28011[14/14] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100}
28012.endd
28013Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
28014without modification.
28015
28016If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
28017display, unless syslog is routing \*mainlog*\ to a file on the local host and
28018the environment variable \\EXIMON@_LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ is set to tell the monitor
28019where it is.
28020
28021
28022.section Log line flags
28023One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
28024successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
28025picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
28026timestamp. The flags are:
28027.display
28028.tabs 6
28029<= $t $rm{message arrival}
28030=> $t $rm{normal message delivery}
28031-> $t $rm{additional address in same delivery}
28032*> $t $rm{delivery suppressed by \-N-\}
28033** $t $rm{delivery failed; address bounced}
28034== $t $rm{delivery deferred; temporary problem}
28035.endd
28036
28037
28038.section Logging message reception
28039.index log||reception line
28040The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
28041message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
28042several lines in order to fit it on the page:
28043.display
28044.indent 0
280452002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@@dwarf.fict.example
28046 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
28047 P=smtp S=5678 id=<<incoming message id>>
28048.endd
28049The address immediately following `<=' is the envelope sender address. A bounce
28050message is shown with the sender address `<>', and if it is locally generated,
28051this is followed by an item of the form
28052.display
28053R=<<message id>>
28054.endd
28055which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
28056
28057.index \\HELO\\
28058.index \\EHLO\\
28059For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
28060record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
28061received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
28062host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
28063above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
28064\host@_lookup\ option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
28065by the remote host in the SMTP \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command, and has not been
28066verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for \\HELO\\ or
28067\\EHLO\\, the verified name appears first, followed by the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\
28068name in parentheses.
28069
28070Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
28071without brackets, in the \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command, leading to entries in
28072the log containing text like these examples:
28073.display
28074H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
28075H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
28076.endd
28077This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
28078on.
28079
28080For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
28081the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
28082of Exim.
28083
28084.index authentication||logging
28085.index \\AUTH\\||logging
28086For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
d43194df
PH
28087message. This is set to
28088.em
28089`esmtpa'
28090.nem
28091for messages received from hosts that have authenticated themselves using the
28092SMTP \\AUTH\\ command. In this case there is an additional item A= followed by
28093the name of the authenticator that was used. If an authenticated identification
28094was set up by the authenticator's \server@_set@_id\ option, this is logged too,
28095separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
495ae4b0
PH
28096
28097The id field records the existing message id, if present.
28098.index size||of message
28099The size of the received message is given by the S field. When the message is
28100delivered, headers may get removed or added, so that the size of delivered
28101copies of the message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be
28102different to each other).
28103
28104The \log@_selector\ option can be used to request the logging of additional
28105data when a message is received. See section ~~SECTlogselector below.
28106
28107
28108.section Logging deliveries
28109.index log||delivery line
28110The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
28111delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote deliveries,
28112respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order to fit
28113it on the page:
28114.display
28115.indent 0
281162002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv <marv@@hitch.fict.example>
28117 R=localuser T=local@_delivery
281182002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => monk@@holistic.fict.example
28119 R=dnslookup T=remote@_smtp H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
28120.endd
28121For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
28122after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
28123intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
28124last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
28125fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
28126
28127If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
28128for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
28129.display
28130ST=<<shadow transport name>>
28131.endd
28132If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
28133parentheses afterwards.
28134
28135When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
28136SMTP \\RCPT\\ commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent
28137addresses are flagged with `$tt{@-@>}' instead of `$tt{@=@>}'. When two or more
28138messages are delivered down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
28139IP address in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
28140
28141The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a `delivery'
28142to the addressee, preceded by `>'.
28143
28144The \log@_selector\ option can be used to request the logging of additional
28145data when a message is delivered. See section ~~SECTlogselector below.
28146
28147
28148.section Discarded deliveries
28149.index discarded messages
28150.index message||discarded
28151.index delivery||discarded, logging
28152When a message is discarded as a result of the command `seen finish' being
28153obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
28154.display
281552002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
28156 <low.club@@bridge.example> R=userforward
28157.endd
28158is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
28159because it is aliased to `:blackhole:' the log line is like this:
28160.display asis
281611999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
28162 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
28163.endd
28164
28165
28166.section Deferred deliveries
28167When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
28168.display
28169.indent 0
281702002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@@endrest.example
28171 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
28172.endd
28173In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
28174last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
28175written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
28176.display
28177.indent 0
281782002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
28179 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
28180.endd
28181When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
28182a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
28183appropriate value in \log@_selector\.
28184
28185
28186.section Delivery failures
28187.index delivery||failure, logging
28188If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
28189following form is logged:
28190.display asis
28191.indent 0
281921995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
28193 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
28194.endd
4964e932 28195If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
495ae4b0
PH
28196the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
28197.display asis
28198.indent 0
281992002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example R=dnslookup
28200.newline
495ae4b0
PH
28201 T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer after pipelined
28202.newline
4964e932
PH
28203 RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host pbmail3.py.example
28204 [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0 <ace400@pb.example>...
495ae4b0
PH
28205 Addressee unknown
28206.endd
4964e932
PH
28207The word `pipelined' indicates that the SMTP \\PIPELINING\\ extension was being
28208used. See \hosts@_avoid@_esmtp\ in the \%smtp%\ transport for a way of
495ae4b0 28209disabling \\PIPELINING\\.
495ae4b0
PH
28210
28211The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are flagged with \"**"\.
28212
28213
28214.section Fake deliveries
28215.index delivery||fake, logging
28216If a delivery does not actually take place because the \-N-\ option has been
28217used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
28218`=>' is replaced by `$*$>'.
28219
28220
28221.section Completion
28222A line of the form
28223.display
282242002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
28225.endd
28226is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
28227at the end of its processing.
28228
28229
28230
28231.section Summary of Fields in Log Lines
28232.index log||summary of fields
28233A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
28234the following table:
28235.display flow
28236.tabs 8
28237A $t $rm{authenticator name (and optional id)}
28238C $t $rm{SMTP confirmation on delivery}
495ae4b0
PH
28239CV $t $rm{certificate verification status}
28240DN $t $rm{distinguished name from peer certificate}
d43194df
PH
28241.newline
28242.em
28243DT $t $rm{on \"=>"\ lines: time taken for a delivery}
28244.nem
495ae4b0 28245.newline
495ae4b0
PH
28246F $t $rm{sender address (on delivery lines)}
28247H $t $rm{host name and IP address}
495ae4b0 28248I $t $rm{local interface used}
495ae4b0
PH
28249id $t $rm{message id for incoming message}
28250P $t $rm{on \"<="\ lines: protocol used}
28251.newline
d43194df
PH
28252.em
28253 $t $rm{on \"=>"\ and \"**"\ lines: return path}
28254QT $t $rm{on \"=>"\ lines: time spent on queue so far}
28255 $t $rm{on `Completed' lines: time spent on queue}
28256.nem
28257.newline
495ae4b0 28258R $t $rm{on \"<="\ lines: reference for local bounce}
d43194df
PH
28259.newline
28260.em
28261 $t $rm{on \"=>"\ \"**"\ and \"=="\ lines: router name}
28262.nem
28263.newline
495ae4b0
PH
28264S $t $rm{size of message}
28265ST $t $rm{shadow transport name}
28266T $t $rm{on \"<="\ lines: message subject (topic)}
d43194df
PH
28267.newline
28268.em
28269 $t $rm{on \"=>"\ \"**"\ and \"=="\ lines: transport name}
28270.nem
28271.newline
495ae4b0
PH
28272U $t $rm{local user or RFC 1413 identity}
28273X $t $rm{TLS cipher suite}
28274.endd
28275
28276
28277.section Other log entries
28278Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
28279self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
28280.numberpars $.
28281.index retry||time not reached
28282\*retry time not reached*\##An address previously suffered a temporary error
28283during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
28284This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
28285during the first delivery attempt.
28286.nextp
28287\*retry time not reached for any host*\##An address previously suffered
28288temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
28289for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
28290.nextp
28291.index spool directory||file locked
28292\*spool file locked*\##An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
28293some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
28294common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
28295\*exiwhat*\ utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
28296doing.
28297.nextp
495ae4b0 28298.index error||ignored
4964e932 28299\*error ignored*\##There are several circumstances that give rise to this
495ae4b0
PH
28300message:
28301.numberpars " "
4964e932 28302Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
495ae4b0
PH
28303\ignore__bounce__errors__after\. The bounce was discarded.
28304.nextp
4964e932 28305A filter file set up a delivery using the `noerror' option, and the delivery
495ae4b0
PH
28306failed. The delivery was discarded.
28307.nextp
4964e932 28308A delivery set up by a router configured with
495ae4b0
PH
28309.display asis
28310errors_to = <>
28311.endd
28312failed. The delivery was discarded.
4964e932 28313.endp
495ae4b0
PH
28314.endp
28315
28316
28317
28318.section Reducing or increasing what is logged
28319.rset SECTlogselector "~~chapter.~~section"
28320.index log||selectors
28321By setting the \log@_selector\ global option, you can disable some of Exim's
28322default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
28323\log@_selector\ is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
28324example:
28325.display asis
28326log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
28327.endd
28328The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
28329selection marked by asterisks:
28330.display flow
28331.tabs 32
28332 address@_rewrite $t $rm{address rewriting}
28333 all@_parents $t $rm{all parents in => lines}
28334 arguments $t $rm{command line arguments}
28335*connection@_reject $t $rm{connection rejections}
4964e932 28336*delay@_delivery $t $rm{immediate delivery delayed}
495ae4b0 28337 deliver@_time $t $rm{time taken to perform delivery}
495ae4b0
PH
28338 delivery@_size $t $rm{add S=nnn to => lines}
28339*dnslist@_defer $t $rm{defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups}
28340*etrn $t $rm{ETRN commands}
28341*host@_lookup@_failed $t $rm{as it says}
495ae4b0 28342 ident@_timeout $t $rm{timeout for ident connection}
495ae4b0
PH
28343 incoming@_interface $t $rm{incoming interface on <= lines}
28344 incoming@_port $t $rm{incoming port on <= lines}
28345*lost@_incoming@_connection $t $rm{as it says (includes timeouts)}
495ae4b0 28346 outgoing@_port $t $rm{add remote port to => lines}
495ae4b0
PH
28347*queue@_run $t $rm{start and end queue runs}
28348.newline
d43194df
PH
28349.em
28350 queue@_time $t $rm{time on queue for one recipient}
28351 queue@_time@_overall $t $rm{time on queue for whole message}
28352.nem
495ae4b0 28353.newline
495ae4b0
PH
28354 received@_recipients $t $rm{recipients on <= lines}
28355 received@_sender $t $rm{sender on <= lines}
28356*rejected@_header $t $rm{header contents on reject log}
28357*retry@_defer $t $rm{`retry time not reached'}
495ae4b0 28358 return@_path@_on@_delivery $t $rm{put return path on => and ** lines}
495ae4b0
PH
28359 sender@_on@_delivery $t $rm{add sender to => lines}
28360*size@_reject $t $rm{rejection because too big}
4964e932 28361*skip@_delivery $t $rm{delivery skipped in a queue run}
495ae4b0 28362 smtp@_confirmation $t $rm{SMTP confirmation on => lines}
495ae4b0
PH
28363 smtp@_connection $t $rm{SMTP connections}
28364 smtp@_incomplete@_transaction $t $rm{incomplete SMTP transactions}
28365 smtp@_protocol@_error $t $rm{SMTP protocol errors}
28366 smtp@_syntax@_error $t $rm{SMTP syntax errors}
28367 subject $t $rm{contents of ::Subject:: on <= lines}
495ae4b0 28368 tls@_certificate@_verified $t $rm{certificate verification status}
495ae4b0
PH
28369*tls@_cipher $t $rm{TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines}
28370 tls@_peerdn $t $rm{TLS peer DN on <= and => lines}
28371
28372 all $t $rm{all of the above}
28373.endd
28374More details on each of these items follows:
28375.numberpars $.
28376.index log||rewriting
28377.index rewriting||logging
28378\address@_rewrite\: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
28379rewrites,
4964e932 28380but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because such users
495ae4b0 28381cannot access the log).
495ae4b0
PH
28382.nextp
28383.index log||full parentage
28384\all@_parents\: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
28385delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
28386parentheses between them.
28387.nextp
28388.index log||Exim arguments
28389.index Exim arguments, logging
28390\arguments\: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
28391to the main log,
28392preceded by the current working directory.
28393This is a debugging feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain
28394MUAs call \(/usr/sbin/sendmail)\. The logging does not happen if Exim has given
4964e932
PH
28395up root privilege because it was called with the \-C-\ or \-D-\ options.
28396Arguments that are empty or that contain whitespace are quoted. Non-printing
495ae4b0
PH
28397characters are shown as escape sequences.
28398This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments, because the arguments are
28399checked before the configuration file is read. The only way to log such cases
28400is to interpose a script such as \(util/logargs.sh)\ between the caller and
28401Exim.
28402.nextp
28403.index log||connection rejections
28404\connection@_reject\: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
28405connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
28406.nextp
28407.index log||delayed delivery
28408.index delayed delivery, logging
28409\delay@_delivery\: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
28410started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
28411messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
28412process is started because \queue@_only\ is set or \-odq-\ was used.
28413.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
28414.index log||delivery duration
28415\deliver@_time\: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
28416perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<<time>>, for example, \"DT=1s"\.
495ae4b0
PH
28417.nextp
28418.index log||message size on delivery
28419.index size||of message
28420\delivery@_size\: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
28421the `=>' line, tagged with S=.
28422.nextp
28423.index log||dnslist defer
28424.index DNS list||logging defer
28425.index black list (DNS)
28426\dnslist@_defer\: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
28427DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
28428.nextp
28429.index log||ETRN commands
28430.index \\ETRN\\||logging
28431\etrn\: Every legal ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL is
28432run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
28433command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
28434selector (see \smtp@_syntax@_error\ and \smtp@_protocol@_error\).
28435.nextp
28436.index log||host lookup failure
28437\host@_lookup@_failed\: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
28438any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
28439log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
28440routing email addresses, but it does apply to `byname' lookups.
28441.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
28442.index log||ident timeout
28443.index RFC 1413||logging timeout
28444\ident@_timeout\: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
28445client's ident port times out.
495ae4b0
PH
28446.nextp
28447.index log||incoming interface
28448.index interface||logging
28449\incoming@_interface\: The interface on which a message was received is added
28450to the `<=' line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and followed
28451by a colon and the port number.
495ae4b0
PH
28452The local interface and port are also added to other SMTP log
28453lines, for example `SMTP connection from', and to rejection lines.
495ae4b0
PH
28454.nextp
28455.index log||incoming remote port
28456.index port||logging remote
28457.index TCP/IP||logging incoming remote port
28458\incoming@_port\: The remote port number from which a message was received is
28459added to log entries and ::Received:: header lines, following the IP address in
28460square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
28461changing the value that is put in the \$sender@_fullhost$\ and
28462\$sender@_rcvhost$\ variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
28463important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
28464.nextp
28465.index log||dropped connection
28466\lost@_incoming@_connection\: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
28467connection is unexpectedly dropped.
28468.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
28469.index log||outgoing remote port
28470.index port||logging outgoint remote
28471.index TCP/IP||logging ougtoing remote port
28472\outgoing@_port\: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
28473containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
28474the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
28475number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
495ae4b0
PH
28476.nextp
28477.index log||queue run
28478.index queue runner||logging
28479\queue@_run\: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
28480.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
28481.index log||queue time
28482\queue@_time\: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
d43194df
PH
28483local host is logged as QT=<<time>>
28484.em
28485on delivery (\"=>"\) lines, for example, \"QT=3m45s"\. The clock starts when
28486Exim starts to receive the message, so it includes reception time as well as
28487the delivery time for the current address. This means that it may be longer
28488than the difference between the arrival and delivery log line times, because
28489the arrival log line is not written until the message has been successfully
28490received.
28491.nem
28492
28493.nextp
28494.em
28495\queue@_time@_overall\: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
28496the local host is logged as QT=<<time>> on `Completed' lines, for
28497example, \"QT=3m45s"\. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
28498message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
28499.nem
495ae4b0
PH
28500.nextp
28501.index log||recipients
28502\received@_recipients\: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
28503as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
28504that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word `for'. The
28505addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
28506has taken place.
28507Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for \\MAIL\\ or \\RCPT\\ do not appear
28508in the list.
28509.nextp
28510.index log||sender reception
28511\received@_sender\: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
28512the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
28513`from' (before the recipients if \received@_recipients\ is also set).
28514.nextp
28515.index log||header lines for rejection
28516\rejected@_header\: If a message's header has been received at the time a
28517rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
28518log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
28519rejected by the \*local@_scan()*\ function (see section ~~SECTapiforloc).
28520.nextp
28521.index log||retry defer
28522\retry@_defer\: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a retry
28523time has not yet been reached. However, this `retry time not reached' message
28524is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
28525attempt.
28526.nextp
28527.index log||return path
4964e932 28528\return@_path@_on@_delivery\: The return path that is being transmitted with
495ae4b0 28529the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
d43194df
PH
28530.em
28531This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
28532or if delivery is to \(/dev/null)\ or to \":blackhole:"\.
28533.nem
495ae4b0
PH
28534.nextp
28535.index log||sender on delivery
28536\sender@_on@_delivery\: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
28537and bounce line, tagged by F= (for `from').
4964e932 28538This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
495ae4b0 28539necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
495ae4b0
PH
28540.nextp
28541.index log||size rejection
28542\size@_reject\: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because it
28543is too big.
28544.nextp
28545.index log||frozen messages, skipped
28546.index frozen messages||logging skipping
28547\skip@_delivery\: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
28548queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
28549it.
d43194df
PH
28550.em
28551.index `spool file is locked'
28552The message that is written is `spool file is locked'.
28553.nem
495ae4b0
PH
28554.nextp
28555.index log||smtp confirmation
28556.index SMTP||logging confirmation
28557\smtp@_confirmation\: The response to the final `.' in the SMTP dialogue for
28558outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form `C="<<text>>"'. A
28559number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this response.
28560.nextp
28561.index log||SMTP connections
28562.index SMTP||logging connections
28563\smtp@_connection\: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
d43194df
PH
28564established or closed,
28565.em
28566unless the connection is from a host that matches \hosts@_connection@_nolog\.
28567.nem
28568(In contrast, \lost__incoming__connection\ applies only when the closure is
28569unexpected.) This applies to connections from local processes that use \-bs-\
28570as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is dropped in the middle of a
28571message, a log line is always written, whether or not this selector is set, but
28572otherwise nothing is written at the start and end of connections unless this
28573selector is enabled.
495ae4b0
PH
28574
28575For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
28576included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
28577reset if the daemon is restarted.
4964e932
PH
28578Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
28579subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
28580whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
28581match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
495ae4b0
PH
28582logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
28583.nextp
28584.index log||SMTP transaction, incomplete
28585.index SMTP||logging incomplete transactions
28586\smtp@_incomplete@_transaction\: When a mail transaction is aborted by
28587\\RSET\\, \\QUIT\\, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
28588and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
28589line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
28590.nextp
28591.index log||SMTP protocol error
28592.index SMTP||logging protocol error
28593\smtp@_protocol@_error\: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
28594encountered.
4964e932
PH
28595Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors because of
28596transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If \\PIPELINING\\ has been
28597advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use it, and
495ae4b0
PH
28598therefore it does not count `expected' errors (for example, \\RCPT\\ received
28599after rejecting \\MAIL\\) as protocol errors.
495ae4b0
PH
28600.nextp
28601.index SMTP||logging syntax errors
28602.index SMTP||syntax errors, logging
28603.index SMTP||unknown command, logging
28604.index log||unknown SMTP command
28605.index log||SMTP syntax error
28606\smtp@_syntax@_error\: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
28607encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
28608external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
28609using \-bs-\ the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
28610.nextp
28611.index log||subject
28612.index subject, logging
28613\subject\: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
28614preceded by `T=' (T for `topic', since S is already used for `size').
4964e932
PH
28615Any MIME `words' in the subject are decoded. The \print@_topbitchars\ option
28616specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
495ae4b0
PH
28617unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
28618.nextp
28619.index log||certificate verification
495ae4b0
PH
28620\tls@_certificate@_verified\: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
28621when TLS is in use. The item is \"CV=yes"\ if the peer's certificate was
28622verified, and \"CV=no"\ if not.
495ae4b0
PH
28623.nextp
28624.index log||TLS cipher
28625.index TLS||logging cipher
28626\tls@_cipher\: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted connection,
28627the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
28628.nextp
28629.index log||TLS peer DN
28630.index TLS||logging peer DN
28631\tls@_peerdn\: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted connection,
28632and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is added to the
28633log line, preceded by DN=.
28634.endp
28635
28636.section Message log
28637.index message||log file for
4964e932 28638.index log||message log, description of
495ae4b0
PH
28639In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
28640that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
28641.index \(msglog)\ directory
28642they are kept in the \(msglog)\ sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
28643message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
28644makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
28645to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
28646is complete,
28647.index \preserve@_message@_logs\
28648unless \preserve__message__logs\ is set, but this should be used only with
28649great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
28650
4964e932
PH
28651On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
28652per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
495ae4b0
PH
28653\message@_logs\ option false.
28654
28655
28656
28657.
28658.
28659.
28660. ============================================================================
28661.chapter Exim utilities
28662.set runningfoot "utilities"
28663.rset CHAPutils ~~chapter
28664.index utilities
28665A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
28666described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
28667the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
28668
28669. This duplication seems to be the only way to arrange that the cross-
28670. references are omitted in the Texinfo version. They look horribly ugly.
28671
28672.if ~~texinfo
28673.display rm
28674.tabs 22
28675\*exiwhat*\ $t $rm{list what Exim processes are doing}
28676.newline
28677\*exiqgrep*\ $t $rm{grep the queue}
28678.newline
28679\*exiqsumm*\ $t $rm{summarize the queue}
28680\*exigrep*\ $t $rm{search the main log}
28681\*exipick*\ $t $rm{select messages on various criteria}
28682\*exicyclog*\ $t $rm{cycle (rotate) log files}
28683\*eximstats*\ $t $rm{extract statistics from the log}
28684\*exim@_checkaccess*\ $t $rm{check address acceptance from given IP}
28685\*exim@_dbmbuild*\ $t $rm{build a DBM file}
28686\*exinext*\ $t $rm{extract retry information}
28687\*exim@_dumpdb*\ $t $rm{dump a hints database}
28688\*exim@_tidydb*\ $t $rm{clean up a hints database}
28689\*exim@_fixdb*\ $t $rm{patch a hints database}
28690\*exim@_lock*\ $t $rm{lock a mailbox file}
28691.endd
28692.
28693.else
28694.
28695.display rm
28696.tabs 22
28697~~SECTfinoutwha \*exiwhat*\ $t $rm{list what Exim processes are doing}
495ae4b0 28698~~SECTgreptheque \*exiqgrep*\ $t $rm{grep the queue}
495ae4b0
PH
28699~~SECTsumtheque \*exiqsumm*\ $t $rm{summarize the queue}
28700~~SECTextspeinf \*exigrep*\ $t $rm{search the main log}
495ae4b0 28701~~SECTexipick \*exipick*\ $t $rm{select messages on various criteria}
495ae4b0
PH
28702~~SECTcyclogfil \*exicyclog*\ $t $rm{cycle (rotate) log files}
28703~~SECTmailstat \*eximstats*\ $t $rm{extract statistics from the log}
28704~~SECTcheckaccess \*exim@_checkaccess*\ $t $rm{check address acceptance from given IP}
28705~~SECTdbmbuild \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ $t $rm{build a DBM file}
28706~~SECTfinindret \*exinext*\ $t $rm{extract retry information}
28707~~SECThindatmai \*exim@_dumpdb*\ $t $rm{dump a hints database}
28708~~SECThindatmai \*exim@_tidydb*\ $t $rm{clean up a hints database}
28709~~SECThindatmai \*exim@_fixdb*\ $t $rm{patch a hints database}
28710~~SECTmailboxmaint \*exim@_lock*\ $t $rm{lock a mailbox file}
28711.endd
28712.fi
28713
28714.section Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)
28715.rset SECTfinoutwha "~~chapter.~~section"
28716.index \*exiwhat*\
28717.index process, querying
28718.index \\SIGUSR1\\
28719On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
28720(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the \\SIGUSR1\\ signal by writing
28721a line describing what it is doing to the file \(exim-process.info)\ in the
28722Exim spool directory. The \*exiwhat*\ script sends the signal to all Exim
28723processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
d43194df
PH
28724second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
28725order to run \*exiwhat*\ successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
495ae4b0
PH
28726send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
28727
d43194df
PH
28728.em
28729\**Warning**\: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
28730use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
28731script that sends \\SIGUSR1\\ signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
28732.nem
28733
28734Unfortunately, the \*ps*\ command that \*exiwhat*\ uses to find Exim processes
495ae4b0
PH
28735varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
28736but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
28737system configuration options that configure exactly how \*exiwhat*\ works. If it
28738doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time options:
28739.display
28740EXIWHAT@_PS@_CMD $rm{the command for running \*ps*\}
28741EXIWHAT@_PS@_ARG $rm{the argument for \*ps*\}
28742EXIWHAT@_EGREP@_ARG $rm{the argument for \*egrep*\ to select from \*ps*\ output}
28743EXIWHAT@_KILL@_ARG $rm{the argument for the \*kill*\ command}
28744.endd
28745An example of typical output from \*exiwhat*\ is
28746.display
28747.indent 0
28748 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
2874910483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
2875010492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example [10.19.42.42]
28751 (editor@@ref.example)
2875210592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
2875310628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
28754.endd
28755The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
28756been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
28757
28758
28759.section Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)
28760.rset SECTgreptheque "~~chapter.~~section"
28761.index \*exiqgrep*\
28762.index queue||grepping
28763This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
28764.display asis
28765exim -bpu
28766.endd
4964e932
PH
28767to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
28768output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
495ae4b0
PH
28769options are available:
28770
28771.startoptions
28772
28773.option f <<regex>>
4964e932
PH
28774Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
28775brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
495ae4b0
PH
28776.display asis
28777exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
28778.endd
28779
28780.option r <<regex>>
4964e932 28781Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
495ae4b0
PH
28782brackets.
28783
28784.option s <<regex>>
28785Match against the size field.
28786
28787.option y <<seconds>>
28788Match messages that are younger than the given time.
28789
28790.option o <<seconds>>
28791Match messages that are older than the given time.
28792
28793.option z
28794Match only frozen messages.
28795
28796.option x
28797Match only non-frozen messages.
28798
28799.endoptions
28800
28801The following options control the format of the output:
28802
28803.startoptions
28804
28805.option c
28806Display only the count of matching messages.
28807
28808.option l
28809Long format -- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
28810the default.
28811
28812.option i
28813Display message ids only.
28814
28815.option b
28816Brief format -- one line per message.
28817
28818.option R
28819Display messages in reverse order.
28820
28821.endoptions
28822
28823There is one more option, \-h-\, which outputs a list of options.
28824
28825
28826.section Summarising the queue (exiqsumm)
28827.rset SECTsumtheque "~~chapter.~~section"
28828.index \*exiqsumm*\
28829.index queue||summary
28830The \*exiqsumm*\ utility is a Perl script which reads the output of \*exim
28831-bp*\ and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
28832running a command such as
28833.display asis
28834exim -bp | exiqsumm
28835.endd
28836The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
28837it, as in the following example:
28838.display asis
28839 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
28840.endd
4964e932 28841Each line lists the number of
495ae4b0 28842pending deliveries for a domain, their total volume, and the length of time
4964e932
PH
28843that the oldest and the newest messages have been waiting. Note that the number
28844of pending deliveries is greater than the number of messages when messages
495ae4b0
PH
28845have more than one recipient.
28846
28847A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
28848domain name, but \*exiqsumm*\ has the options \-a-\ and \-c-\, which cause the
28849output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages, respectively.
28850
28851The output of \*exim -bp*\ contains the original addresses in the message, so
28852this also applies to the output from \*exiqsumm*\. No domains from addresses
28853generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the \one@_time\ option
28854of the \%redirect%\ router has been used to convert them into `top level'
28855addresses).
28856
28857
28858
28859.section Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)
28860.rset SECTextspeinf "~~chapter.~~section"
28861.index \*exigrep*\
28862.index log||extracts, grepping for
28863The \*exigrep*\ utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
28864files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
28865extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
28866match the pattern. Thus, \*exigrep*\ can extract complete log entries for a
28867given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
28868
495ae4b0
PH
28869If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is always
28870included in \*exigrep*\'s output.
495ae4b0
PH
28871The usage is:
28872.display asis
28873exigrep [-l] [-t<n>] <pattern> [<log file>] ...
28874.endd
4964e932
PH
28875The \-t-\ argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
28876condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
495ae4b0
PH
28877they spent more than <<n>> seconds on the queue.
28878
28879The \-l-\ flag means `literal', that is, treat all characters in the
28880pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
28881regular expression. The pattern match is case-insensitive. If no file names are
28882given on the command line, the standard input is read.
28883
28884If the location of a \*zcat*\ command is known from the definition of
28885\\ZCAT@_COMMAND\\ in \(Local/Makefile)\, \*exigrep*\ automatically passes any
28886file whose name ends in \\COMPRESS@_SUFFIX\\ through \*zcat*\ as it searches
28887it.
28888
495ae4b0
PH
28889.section Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)
28890.rset SECTexipick "~~chapter.~~section"
28891.index \*exipick*\
28892John Jetmore's \*exipick*\ utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
28893lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details,
28894run:
28895.display asis
28896exipick --help
28897.endd
495ae4b0
PH
28898
28899
28900.section Cycling log files (exicyclog)
28901.rset SECTcyclogfil "~~chapter.~~section"
28902.index log||cycling local files
28903.index cycling logs
28904.index \*exicyclog*\
28905The \*exicyclog*\ script can be used to cycle (rotate) \*mainlog*\ and
d43194df
PH
28906\*rejectlog*\ files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
28907you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
28908~~SECTdatlogfil). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms for
28909log cycling, and these can be used instead of \*exicyclog*\ if preferred.
28910
28911Each time \*exicyclog*\ is run the file names get `shuffled down' by one. If
28912the main log file name is \(mainlog)\ (the default) then when \*exicyclog*\ is
28913run \(mainlog)\ becomes \(mainlog.01)\, the previous \(mainlog.01)\ becomes
495ae4b0 28914\(mainlog.02)\ and so on, up to a limit which is set in the script, and which
d43194df
PH
28915defaults to 10.
28916.em
28917Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded.
28918.nem
28919Reject logs are handled similarly.
28920
28921.em
28922If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
28923\(mainlog.001)\, \(mainlog.002)\, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
28924to one that is greater, or \*vice versa*\, you will have to fix the names of
28925any existing log files.
28926.nem
495ae4b0
PH
28927
28928If no \(mainlog)\ file exists, the script does nothing. Files that `drop off'
28929the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
28930using a compression command which is configured by the \\COMPRESS@_COMMAND\\
28931setting in \(Local/Makefile)\. It is usual to run \*exicyclog*\ daily from a
28932root \crontab\ entry of the form
28933.display
289341 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
28935.endd
28936assuming you have used the name `exim' for the Exim user. You can run
28937\*exicyclog*\ as root if you wish, but there is no need.
28938
28939
28940.section Mail statistics (eximstats)
28941.rset SECTmailstat "~~chapter.~~section"
28942.index statistics
28943.index \*eximstats*\
28944A Perl script called \*eximstats*\ is provided for extracting statistical
28945information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
4964e932 28946Exim log files are also suported by the \*Lire*\ system produced by the
495ae4b0
PH
28947LogReport Foundation (\?http://www.logreport.org?\).
28948
28949The \*eximstats*\ script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
28950latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
28951lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
28952various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
28953list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
28954.display asis
28955eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
28956.endd
28957By default, \*eximstats*\ extracts information about the number and volume of
28958messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
28959both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
28960are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
28961addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
28962options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
28963also produced per user.
28964
28965The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
28966histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
28967hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
28968example, an SMTP transaction with more than one \\RCPT\\ command) is counted
28969as a single delivery by \*eximstats*\.
28970
28971Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
28972have multiple recipients), it is possible for \*eximstats*\ to report more
28973messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
28974and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
28975recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
28976an entirely separate message.
28977
28978\*eximstats*\ always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
28979of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
28980each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
28981not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
28982least one address that failed.
28983
28984The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
28985or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
28986transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
28987(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
28988a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
28989senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
28990and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
28991
28992The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
28993came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
28994without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
28995
28996The options for \*eximstats*\ are as follows:
28997
28998.startoptions
28999.index \*eximstats*\||options
29000.option bydomain
29001The `league tables' are computed on the basis of the superior domains of the
29002sending hosts instead of the sending and receiving hosts. This option may be
29003combined with \-byhost-\ and/or \-byemail-\.
29004
29005.option byedomain
29006This is a synonym for \-byemaildomain-\.
29007
29008.option byemail
29009The `league tables' are computed on the basis of complete email addresses,
29010instead of sending and receiving hosts. This option may be combined with
29011\-byhost-\ and/or \-bydomain-\.
29012
29013.option byemaildomain
4964e932 29014The `league tables' are computed on the basis of the sender's email domain
495ae4b0
PH
29015instead of the sending and receiving hosts. This option may be combined with
29016\-byhost-\, \-bydomain-\, or \-byemail-\.
29017
29018.option byhost
29019The `league tables' are computed on the basis of sending and receiving hosts.
29020This is the default option. It may be combined with \-bydomain-\ and/or
29021\-byemail-\.
29022
29023.option cache
29024Cache results of \*timegm()*\ lookups. This results in a significant speedup
29025when processing hundreds of thousands of messages, at a cost of increasing the
29026memory utilisation.
29027
29028.option chartdir <<dir>>
29029When \-charts-\ is specified, create the charts in the directory <<dir>>.
29030
29031.option chartrel <<dir>>
29032When \-charts-\ is specified, this option specifies the relative directory for
29033the \"img src="\ tags from where to include the charts.
29034
29035.option charts
29036Create graphical charts to be displayed in HTML output. This requires the
29037\"GD"\, \"GDTextUtil"\, and \"GDGraph"\ Perl modules, which can be obtained
29038from \?http://www.cpan.org/modules/01modules.index.html?\.
29039
29040To install these, download and unpack them, then use the normal Perl
29041installation procedure:
29042.display asis
29043perl Makefile.PL
29044make
29045make test
29046make install
29047.endd
29048
29049.option d
29050This is a debug flag. It causes \*eximstats*\ to output the \*eval()*\'d parser
29051to the standard output, which makes it easier to trap errors in the eval
29052section. Remember to add one to the line numbers to allow for the title.
29053
29054
29055.option help
29056Show help information about \*eximstats*\' options.
29057
29058.option h <<n>>
29059This option controls the histograms of messages received and deliveries per
29060time interval. By default the time interval is one hour. If \-h0-\ is given,
29061the histograms are suppressed; otherwise the value of <<n>> gives the number of
29062divisions per hour. Valid values are 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15, 20, 30 or 60, so
29063\-h2-\ sets an interval of 30 minutes, and the default is equivalent to \-h1-\.
29064
29065.option html
29066Output the results in HTML instead of plain text.
29067
29068.option merge
29069This option causes \*eximstats*\ to merge old reports into a combined report.
4964e932 29070When this option is used, the input files must be outputs from previous calls
495ae4b0
PH
29071to \*eximstats*\, not raw log files. For example, you could produce a set of
29072daily reports and a weekly report by commands such as
29073.display asis
29074eximstats mainlog.sun > report.sun.txt
29075eximstats mainlog.mon > report.mon.txt
29076eximstats mainlog.tue > report.tue.txt
29077eximstats mainlog.wed > report.wed.txt
29078eximstats mainlog.thu > report.thu.txt
29079eximstats mainlog.fri > report.fri.txt
29080eximstats mainlog.sat > report.sat.txt
29081eximstats -merge -html report.*.txt > weekly_report.html
29082.endd
29083You can merge text or html reports and output the results as text or html. You
29084can use all the normal \*eximstats*\ output options, but only data included in
29085the original reports can be shown. When merging reports, some loss of accuracy
29086may occur in the `league tables', towards the ends of the lists. The order of
29087items in the `league tables' may vary when the data volumes round to the same
29088value.
29089
29090.option ne
29091Suppress the display of information about failed deliveries (errors).
29092
29093.option nr
29094Suppress information about messages relayed through this host.
29095
29096.option nr /pattern/
29097Suppress information about relayed messages that match the pattern, which is
29098matched against a string of the following form (split over two lines here in
29099order to fit it on the page):
29100.display asis
29101H=<host> [<ip address>] A=<sender address> =>
29102 H=<host> A=<recipient address>
29103.endd
29104for example
29105.display asis
29106H=in.host [1.2.3.4] A=from@some.where.example =>
29107 H=out.host A=to@else.where.example
29108.endd
29109The sending host name appears in parentheses if it has not been verified as
29110matching the IP address. The mail addresses are taken from the envelope, not
29111the headers. This option allows you to screen out hosts whom you are happy to
29112have using your host as a relay.
29113
29114.option nt
29115Suppress the statistics about delivery by transport.
29116
29117.option nt/<<pattern>>/
4964e932
PH
29118Suppress the statistics about delivery by any transport whose name matches the
29119pattern. If you are using one transport to send all messages to a scanning
29120mechanism before doing the real delivery, this feature can be used to omit that
495ae4b0
PH
29121transport from your normal statistics (on the grounds that it is of no
29122interest).
29123
29124
29125.option "pattern" "#<<description>>#/<<pattern>>/"
29126Count lines matching specified patterns and show them in
29127the results. For example:
29128.display asis
29129-pattern 'Refused connections' '/refused connection/'
29130.endd
4964e932 29131This option can be specified multiple times.
495ae4b0
PH
29132
29133.option q0
29134Suppress information about times messages spend on the queue.
29135
29136.option q <<n1>>...
29137This option sets an alternative list of time intervals for the queueing
29138information. The values are separated by commas and are in seconds, but can
29139involve arithmetic multipliers, so for example you can set 3$*$60 to specify 3
29140minutes. A setting such as
29141.display asis
29142-q60,5*60,10*60
29143.endd
29144causes \*eximstats*\ to give counts of messages that stayed on the queue for less
29145than one minute, less than five minutes, less than ten minutes, and over ten
29146minutes.
29147
29148.option t <<n>>
29149Sets the `top' count to <<n>>. This controls the listings of the `top <<n>>'
29150hosts and users by count and volume. The default is 50, and setting 0
29151suppresses the output altogether.
29152
29153.option tnl
29154Omit local information from the `top' listings.
29155
29156.option t@_remote@_users
29157Include remote users in the `top' listings.
29158
29159.endoptions
29160
29161
29162.section Checking access policy (exim@_checkaccess)
29163.rset SECTcheckaccess "~~chapter.~~section"
29164.index \*exim@_checkaccess*\
29165.index policy control||checking access
29166.index checking access
29167The \-bh-\ command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
29168debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
29169policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
29170familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of \-bh-\, and
29171sometimes you just want to answer the question \*Does this address have
29172access?*\ without bothering with any further details.
29173
29174The \*exim@_checkaccess*\ utility is a `packaged' version of \-bh-\. It takes
29175two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
29176.display asis
29177exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
29178.endd
29179The utility runs a call to Exim with the \-bh-\ option, to test whether the
29180given email address would be accepted in a \\RCPT\\ command in a TCP/IP
29181connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
29182is either the word `accepted', or the SMTP error response, for example:
29183.display asis
29184Rejected:
29185 550 Relay not permitted
29186.endd
29187When running this test, the utility uses \"<>"\ as the envelope sender address
29188for the \\MAIL\\ command, but you can change this by providing additional
29189options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
29190that the test is to be run with the sender address \*himself@@there.example*\
29191you can use:
29192.display asis
29193exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
29194 -f himself@there.example
29195.endd
29196Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
29197mandatory arguments.
29198
29199Because the \exim@_checkaccess\ uses \-bh-\, it does not perform callouts while
4964e932 29200running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using \-bhc-\,
495ae4b0
PH
29201but this is not yet available in a `packaged' form.
29202
29203
29204.section Making DBM files (exim@_dbmbuild)
29205.rset SECTdbmbuild "~~chapter.~~section"
29206.index DBM||building dbm files
29207.index building DBM files
29208.index \*exim@_dbmbuild*\
29209.index lower casing
29210.index binary zero||in lookup key
29211The \*exim@_dbmbuild*\ program reads an input file containing keys and data in
29212the format used by the \%lsearch%\ lookup (see section ~~SECTsinglekeylookups).
29213It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias names as keys and the
29214remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing can be prevented by
29215calling the program with the \-nolc-\ option.
29216
29217A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
29218the \%dbm%\ lookup type. However, if the option \-nozero-\ is given,
29219\*exim@_dbmbuild*\ creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
29220strings or the data strings. The \%dbmnz%\ lookup type can be used with such
29221files.
29222
29223The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
29224single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
29225It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
29226well.
29227.index \\USE@_DB\\
29228If the native DB interface is in use (\\USE@_DB\\ is set in a compile-time
29229configuration file -- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
29230names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
29231a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
29232.display asis
29233exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
29234.endd
29235reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
29236\(/etc/aliases.db)\.
29237
29238In systems that use the \*ndbm*\ routines (mostly proprietary versions of Unix),
29239two files are used, with the suffixes \(.dir)\ and \(.pag)\. In this
29240environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
29241\*exim@_dbmbuild*\, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
29242when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
29243recommended), because in that case it adds a \(.db)\ suffix to the file name.
29244
29245If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
29246finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the \-noduperr-\ option
29247is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used -- this
29248makes it compatible with \%lsearch%\ lookups. There is an option \-lastdup-\
29249which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead. There is also
29250an option \-nowarn-\, which stops it listing duplicate keys to \stderr\. For
29251other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the return code is 2.
29252
29253
29254
29255.section Finding individual retry times (exinext)
29256.rset SECTfinindret "~~chapter.~~section"
29257.index retry||times
29258.index \*exinext*\
29259A utility called \*exinext*\ (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to fish
29260specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
29261complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
29262information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
29263is obtained by running \*exim@_dumpdb*\ (see below) and post-processing the
29264output. For example:
29265.display asis
29266$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
29267kanga.milne.fict.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
29268 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
29269 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
29270 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
29271roo.milne.fict.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
29272 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
29273 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
29274 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
29275 past final cutoff time
29276.endd
29277You can also give \*exinext*\ a local part, without a domain, and it
29278will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
29279A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
29280message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
29281suffers a message-specific error (see section ~~SECToutSMTPerr). \*exinext*\ is
29282not particularly efficient, but then it isn't expected to be run very often.
29283
495ae4b0
PH
29284The \*exinext*\ utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
29285of the spool directory. The utility has \-C-\ and \-D-\ options, which are
29286passed on to the \*exim*\ commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
29287configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
29288file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
29289environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
495ae4b0
PH
29290
29291
29292
29293.section Hints database maintenance (exim@_dumpdb, exim@_fixdb, exim@_tidydb)
29294.rset SECThindatmai "~~chapter.~~section"
29295.index hints database||maintenance
29296.index maintaining Exim's hints database
29297Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
29298uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
29299arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
29300second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as
29301follows:
29302.numberpars $.
29303\*retry*\: the database of retry information
29304.nextp
29305\*wait-*\<<transport name>>: databases of information about messages waiting
29306for remote hosts
29307.nextp
495ae4b0 29308\*callout*\: the callout cache
495ae4b0 29309.nextp
4964e932 29310\*misc*\: other hints data
495ae4b0 29311.endp
495ae4b0
PH
29312The \*misc*\ database is used for
29313.numberpars alpha
29314Serializing \\ETRN\\ runs (when \smtp@_etrn@_serialize\ is set)
29315.nextp
4964e932 29316Serializing delivery to a specific host (when \serialize@_hosts\ is set in an
495ae4b0
PH
29317\%smtp%\ transport)
29318.endp
d43194df
PH
29319
29320.section exim@_dumpdb
495ae4b0
PH
29321.index \*exim@_dumpdb*\
29322The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
29323\*exim@_dumpdb*\ program, which has no options or arguments other than the
29324spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
29325.display asis
29326exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
29327.endd
29328Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
29329.display
29330 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
2933131-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
29332.endd
29333The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
29334of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
29335transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
29336a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
29337address (unless \no@_retry@_include@_ip@_address\ is set on the \%smtp%\
d43194df
PH
29338transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
29339to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
29340and a textual description of the error.
495ae4b0
PH
29341
29342The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
29343the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
29344ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
29345exceeded.
29346
29347Each output line from \*exim@_dumpdb*\ for the \*wait-*\$it{xxx} databases
29348consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
29349waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
29350one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
29351may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
29352may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
29353cross-references.
29354
d43194df
PH
29355
29356.section exim@_tidydb
495ae4b0
PH
29357.index \*exim@_tidydb*\
29358The \*exim@_tidydb*\ utility program is used to tidy up the contents of the
29359hints databases. If run with no options, it removes all records from a database
29360that are more than 30 days old. The cutoff date can be altered by means of the
29361\-t-\ option, which must be followed by a time. For example, to remove all
29362records older than a week from the retry database:
29363.display asis
29364exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
29365.endd
29366Both the \*wait-*\$it{xxx} and \*retry*\ databases contain items that involve
29367message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host --
29368they were messages that were waiting for that host -- and in the latter they
29369are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
29370types of error. When \*exim@_tidydb*\ is run, a check is made to ensure that
29371message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
29372queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
29373\*wait-*\$it{xxx} records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are
d43194df
PH
29374deleted. For the \*retry*\ database, records whose keys are non-existent
29375message ids are removed. The \*exim@_tidydb*\ utility outputs comments on the
29376standard output whenever it removes information from the database.
495ae4b0 29377
d43194df
PH
29378.em
29379Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
29380needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
29381down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
29382first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
29383records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
29384
29385It is important, therefore, to run \*exim@_tidydb*\ periodically on all the
29386hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
29387a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
29388work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
29389but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
29390After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
29391point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
29392tidied.
29393
29394\**Warning**\: If you never run \*exim@_tidydb*\, the space used by the hints
29395databases is likely to keep on increasing.
29396.nem
495ae4b0 29397
d43194df
PH
29398
29399.section exim@_fixdb
495ae4b0
PH
29400.index \*exim@_fixdb*\
29401The \*exim@_fixdb*\ program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
29402Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
29403getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
29404is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
29405key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
29406displayed.
29407
29408If `d' is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
29409except the \*retry*\ database, that is the only operation that can be carried
29410out. For the \*retry*\ database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
29411data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
29412by new data, for example:
29413.display asis
29414> 4 951102:1000
29415.endd
29416resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
29417sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
29418used as optional separators.
29419
29420
29421
29422.section Mailbox maintenance (exim@_lock)
29423.rset SECTmailboxmaint "~~chapter.~~section"
29424.index mailbox||maintenance
29425.index \*exim@_lock*\
29426.index locking mailboxes
29427The \*exim@_lock*\ utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
29428Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section ~~SECTopappend.
29429\*Exim@_lock*\ can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
29430a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
29431the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
29432argument is run as a command (using C's \*system()*\ function); if there is no
29433second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
29434is unset or empty, \(/bin/sh)\ is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
29435is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
29436
29437.startoptions
29438
29439.option fcntl
29440Use \*fcntl()*\ locking on the open mailbox.
29441
29442.option flock
4964e932 29443Use \*flock()*\ locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
495ae4b0
PH
29444supports it.
29445
29446.option interval
29447This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
29448interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
29449
29450.option lockfile
29451Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
29452
29453.option mbx
29454Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
29455
29456.option q
29457Suppress verification output.
29458
29459.option retries
29460This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
29461the lock (default 10).
29462
29463.option restore@_time
29464This option causes \exim@_lock\ to restore the modified and read times to the
29465locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
29466example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
29467subsequently sees.
29468
29469.option timeout
29470This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
29471timeout to be used with a blocking \*fcntl()*\ lock. If it is not set (the
29472default), a non-blocking call is used.
29473
29474.option v
29475Generate verbose output.
29476
29477.endoptions
29478
4964e932 29479If none of \-fcntl-\,
495ae4b0
PH
29480\-flock-\,
29481\-lockfile-\ or \-mbx-\ are given, the default is to create a lock file and
29482also to use \*fcntl()*\ locking on the mailbox, which is the same as Exim's
4964e932
PH
29483default. The use of
29484\-flock-\
495ae4b0
PH
29485or \-fcntl-\ requires that the file be writeable; the use of
29486\-lockfile-\ requires that the directory containing the file be writeable.
29487Locking by lock file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is
29488expired if it is more than 30 minutes old.
29489
4964e932 29490The \-mbx-\ option can be used with either or both of \-fcntl-\ or \-flock-\.
495ae4b0
PH
29491It assumes \-fcntl-\ by default.
29492MBX locking causes a shared lock to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an
29493exclusive lock on the file \(/tmp/.$it{n}.$it{m})\ where $it{n} and $it{m} are
29494the device number and inode number of the mailbox file. When the locking is
29495released, if an exclusive lock can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in
29496\(/tmp)\ is deleted.
29497
29498The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
29499\-v-\ option causes some additional information to be given. The \-q-\ option
29500suppresses all output except error messages.
29501
29502A command such as
29503.display asis
29504exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
29505.endd
29506runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
29507.display
29508exim@_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr @<@<End
29509<<some commands>>
29510End
29511.endd
29512runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
29513suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
29514such as
29515.display asis
29516exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
29517 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
29518.endd
29519Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
29520second argument -- hence the quotes.
29521
29522
29523
29524.
29525.
29526.
29527.
29528. ============================================================================
29529.chapter The Exim monitor
29530.set runningfoot "monitor"
29531.rset CHAPeximon ~~chapter
29532.index monitor
29533.index Exim monitor
29534.index X-windows
29535.index \*eximon*\
29536.index Local/eximon.conf
29537.index \(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\
29538The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
29539about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
29540perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
29541such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
29542monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
29543
29544
29545.section Running the monitor
29546The monitor is started by running the script called \*eximon*\. This is a shell
29547script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
29548binary called \(eximon.bin)\. The default appearance of the monitor window can
29549be changed by editing the \(Local/eximon.conf)\ file created by editing
29550\(exim@_monitor/EDITME)\. Comments in that file describe what the various
29551parameters are for.
29552
29553The parameters that get built into the \*eximon*\ script can be overridden for a
29554particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
29555preceded by `$tt{EXIMON@_}'. For example, a shell command such as
29556.display asis
29557EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
29558.endd
29559(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs \*eximon*\ with an overriding setting of the
29560\\LOG@_DEPTH\\ parameter. If \\EXIMON@_LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ is set in the
29561environment, it overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it
29562possible to have \*eximon*\ tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided
29563that MAIL.INFO syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
29564
29565X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
29566way. For example, a resource setting of the form
29567.display asis
29568Eximon*background: gray94
29569.endd
29570changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
29571stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
29572black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
29573data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
29574`highlight' (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
29575For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
29576reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
29577.display asis
29578xrdb -merge <<End
29579Eximon*highlight: gray
29580End
29581.endd
29582
29583.index admin user
29584In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
29585\*eximon*\ must either be run as root or by an admin user.
29586
29587The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
29588more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a `tail' of the
29589main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
29590delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
29591different parts of the display.
29592
29593
29594
29595.section The stripcharts
29596.index stripchart
29597The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
29598be configured by setting \\QUEUE@_STRIPCHART@_NAME\\ in the
29599\(Local/eximon.conf)\ file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
29600configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
29601it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
29602hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
29603received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
29604period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
29605parameter in the \(Local/eximon.conf)\ file.
29606
29607The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
29608displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
29609title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
29610For example, `x2' means that each division represents a value of 2.
29611
29612It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
29613a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
29614to a single partition.
29615.index \statvfs\ function
29616This relies on the availability of the \*statvfs()*\ function or equivalent in
29617the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
29618this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
29619100%, and the scale is given as `x10%'. This chart is configured by setting
29620\\SIZE@_STRIPCHART\\ and (optionally) \\SIZE@_STRIPCHART@_NAME\\ in the
29621\(Local/eximon.conf)\ file.
29622
29623
29624
29625.section Main action buttons
29626.index size||of monitor window
29627.index monitor window size
29628.index window size
29629Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
29630to this is another button marked `Size'. They are placed here so that shrinking
29631the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count stripchart
29632and these two buttons visible. Pressing the `Size' button causes the window to
29633expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum, in which case
29634it is reduced to its minimum.
29635
29636When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
29637currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
29638size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
29639remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
29640
29641The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
29642stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
29643the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
29644The idea is copied from what the \*twm*\ window manager does for its
29645\*f.fullzoom*\ action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
29646the \\MIN@_HEIGHT\\ and \\MIN@_WIDTH\\ values in \(Local/eximon.conf)\.
29647
29648Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
29649built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
29650\\START@_SMALL\\=yes in \(Local/eximon.conf)\.
29651
29652
29653.section The log display
29654.index log||tail of, in monitor
29655The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
4964e932 29656the main log is maintained.
495ae4b0
PH
29657To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
29658removing the date and, if \log@_timezone\ is set, the timezone.
29659The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
29660syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
29661to \*eximon*\ via the \\EXIMON@_LOG@_FILE@_PATH\\ environment variable.
29662
29663The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
29664move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
29665scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
29666\\LOG@_BUFFER\\ in \(Local/eximon.conf)\, which specifies the amount of memory
29667to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded -- this is much
29668more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has a
29669horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
29670only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
29671available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
29672normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
29673configuration file \(Local/eximon.conf)\.
29674
29675Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
29676and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
29677respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
29678It cannot go further back up the log.
29679
29680The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
29681normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
29682by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
29683by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
29684back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
29685the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
29686
29687Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
29688There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
29689the search, and for cancelling. If the `Search' button is pressed, the search
29690happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
29691`Return' key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
29692^C is typed the search is cancelled.
29693
29694The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
29695widget. By default this pops up a window containing both `search' and `replace'
29696options. In order to suppress the unwanted `replace' portion for eximon, a
29697modified version of the \TextPop\ widget is distributed with Exim. However, the
29698linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally provided version
29699of \TextPop\ when the remaining parts of the text widget come from the standard
29700libraries. The compile-time option \\EXIMON@_TEXTPOP\\ can be unset to cut out
29701the modified \TextPop\, making it possible to build Eximon on these systems, at
29702the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup window.
29703
29704
29705.section The queue display
29706.index queue||display in monitor
29707The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
29708are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
29709as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
29710parameters in the configuration file \(Local/eximon.conf)\, and the frequency
29711at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file --
29712the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
29713there is an `Update' action button just above the display which can be used to
29714force an update of the queue display at any time.
29715
29716When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
29717and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
29718with this situation there is a button next to `Update' called `Hide'. If
29719pressed, a dialogue box called `Hide addresses ending with' is put up. If you
29720type anything in here and press `Return', the text is added to a chain of such
29721texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
29722of the texts, the message is not displayed.
29723
29724If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
29725are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
29726example, \*cam.ac.uk*\ specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
29727\*xxx@@foo.com.example*\ specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
29728has been set up, a button called `Unhide' is displayed. If pressed, it cancels
29729all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten, a hide
29730request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
29731
29732While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
29733else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
29734queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
29735pressing the `Hide' button.
29736
29737The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
29738time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
29739message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
29740a bounce message, the sender is shown as `<>'. If there is more than one
29741recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
29742listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
29743an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
29744not shown.
29745.index frozen messages||display
29746If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
29747
29748The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
29749of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
29750The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
29751available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
29752display is updated.
29753
29754
29755.section The queue menu
29756.index queue||menu in monitor
29757If the \shift\ key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
29758pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
29759line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
29760any selected text.
29761
29762If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
29763\\MENU@_EVENT\\ parameter in \(Local/eximon.conf)\ to change the default, or
29764set \\EXIMON@_MENU@_EVENT\\ in the environment before starting the monitor. The
29765value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
29766run eximon using \ctrl\ rather than \shift\ you could use
29767.display asis
29768EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
29769.endd
29770The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
29771follows:
29772.numberpars $.
29773\*message log*\: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed in
29774a new text window.
29775.nextp
29776\*headers*\: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
29777information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
29778~~CHAPspool for a description of the format of spool files.
29779.nextp
29780\*body*\: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
29781displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
29782amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the \\BODY@_MAX\\
29783option at compile time, or the \\EXIMON@_BODY@_MAX\\ option at run time.
29784.nextp
29785\*deliver message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-M-\ option to request
29786delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
29787frozen. The \-v-\ option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
29788a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
29789up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
29790.nextp
29791\*freeze message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mf-\ option to request
29792that the message be frozen.
29793.nextp
29794.index thawing messages
29795.index unfreezing messages
29796.index frozen messages||thawing
29797\*thaw message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mt-\ option to request that
29798the message be thawed.
29799.nextp
29800.index delivery||forcing failure
29801\*give up on msg*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mg-\ option to request
29802that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
29803for any remaining undelivered addresses.
29804.nextp
29805\*remove message*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mrm-\ option to request
29806that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
29807message.
29808.nextp
29809\*add recipient*\: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
29810be typed. If the address is not qualified and the \\QUALIFY@_DOMAIN\\ parameter
29811is set in \(Local/eximon.conf)\, the address is qualified with that domain.
29812Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing \\RETURN\\
29813causes a call to Exim to be made using the \-Mar-\ option to request that an
29814additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
29815which case no action is taken.
29816.nextp
29817\*mark delivered*\: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
29818be typed. If the address is not qualified and the \\QUALIFY@_DOMAIN\\ parameter
29819is set in \(Local/eximon.conf)\, the address is qualified with that domain.
29820Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing \\RETURN\\
29821causes a call to Exim to be made using the \-Mmd-\ option to mark the given
29822recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
29823case no action is taken.
29824.nextp
29825\*mark all delivered*\: A call to Exim is made using the \-Mmad-\ option to mark
29826all recipient addresses as already delivered.
29827.nextp
29828\*edit sender*\: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current sender's
29829address. Pressing \\RETURN\\ causes a call to Exim to be made using the \-Mes-\
29830option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty, in which
29831case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in bounce
29832messages), you must specify it as `<>'. Otherwise, if the address is not
29833qualified and the \\QUALIFY@_DOMAIN\\ parameter is set in
29834\(Local/eximon.conf)\, the address is qualified with that domain.
29835.endp
29836When a delivery is forced, a window showing the \-v-\ output is displayed. In
29837other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
29838particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
29839output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
29840from the log and queue displays. However, if you set \\ACTION@_OUTPUT\\=yes in
29841\(Local/eximon.conf)\, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
29842if no output is generated.
29843
29844The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
29845thawing, unless \\ACTION@_QUEUE@_UPDATE\\=no has been set in
29846\(Local/eximon.conf)\. In this case the `Update' button has to be used to force
29847an update of the display after one of these actions.
29848
29849In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
29850cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
29851and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
29852
29853
29854
29855
29856
29857
29858.
29859.
29860.
29861.
29862. ============================================================================
29863.chapter Security considerations
29864.set runningfoot "security"
29865.rset CHAPsecurity ~~chapter
29866.index security
29867This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
29868which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
29869
29870For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
29871Exim as a `particularly secure' mailer. Perhaps it is because of the existence
29872of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the chapter is
29873simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain security concerns,
29874not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of its security as
29875compared with other MTAs.
29876
29877What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
29878have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
29879absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
29880as soon as possible.
29881
29882.section Building a more `hardened' Exim
29883.index security||build-time features
29884There are a number of build-time options that can be set in \(Local/Makefile)\
29885to create Exim binaries that are `harder' to attack, in particular by a rogue
29886Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
29887penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
29888.numberpars $.
29889\\ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\\ can be set to a string that is required to match the
29890start of any file names used with the \-C-\ option. When it is set, these file
29891names are also not allowed to contain the sequence `/../'. (However, if the
29892value of the \-C-\ option is identical to the value of \\CONFIGURE@_FILE\\ in
29893\(Local/Makefile)\, Exim ignores \-C-\ and proceeds as usual.) There is no
29894default setting for \ALT@_CONFIG@_PREFIX\.
29895
29896If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
29897which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
29898into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
29899configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
29900.nextp
29901If \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is defined, root privilege is retained for \-C-\
29902and \-D-\ only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
29903also use \-C-\ and \-D-\ and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
29904the possibility of testing a configuration using \-C-\ right through message
29905reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
29906that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
29907privilege for the delivery, the use of \-C-\ causes privilege to be lost.
29908However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
29909\\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is not set by default.
29910.nextp
29911If \\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is defined, the use of the \-D-\ command line option
29912is disabled.
29913.nextp
29914\\FIXED@_NEVER@_USERS\\ can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
29915never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the \never@_users\ runtime
29916option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
29917to the list. The default setting is `root'; this prevents a non-root user who
29918is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
29919.endp
29920
29921
29922.section Root privilege
29923.index setuid
29924.index root privilege
29925The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
29926privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
29927example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
29928may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
29929discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
29930is required for two things:
29931.numberpars $.
29932To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
29933the listening daemon. If Exim is run from \*inetd*\, this privileged action is
29934not required.
29935.nextp
29936To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' \(.forward)\ files and
29937perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
29938configuration.
29939.endp
29940It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
29941receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
29942obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
29943For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
29944\(Local/Makefile)\. These are known as `the Exim user' and `the Exim group'.
29945Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this is not
29946recommended. Often a user called \*exim*\ is used, but some sites use \*mail*\
29947or another user name altogether.
29948
29949Exim uses \*setuid()*\ whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
29950abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
29951\*seteuid()*\ was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
29952
29953After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
29954uid and gid in the following cases:
29955.numberpars $.
29956.index \-C-\ option
29957.index \-D-\ option
29958If the \-C-\ option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
29959the \-D-\ option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
29960calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
29961changed to those of the calling process.
4964e932
PH
29962However, if \\ALT@_CONFIG@_ROOT@_ONLY\\ is defined in \(Local/Makefile)\, only
29963root callers may use \-C-\ and \-D-\ without losing privilege, and if
495ae4b0
PH
29964\\DISABLE@_D@_OPTION\\ is set, the \-D-\ option may not be used at all.
29965.nextp
29966.index \-be-\ option
29967.index \-bf-\ option
29968.index \-bF-\ option
29969If the expansion test option (\-be-\) or one of the filter testing options
29970(\-bf-\ or \-bF-\) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
29971calling process.
29972.nextp
29973If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
29974process or a process for testing address routing (started with \-bt-\), the uid
29975and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
29976runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
4964e932 29977testing address verification
495ae4b0
PH
29978.index \-bv-\ option
29979.index \-bh-\ option
29980(the \-bv-\ option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the \-bh-\
29981option).
29982.nextp
29983For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
29984remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
29985.endp
29986The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
29987.numberpars $.
29988A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim user
29989after setting up one or more listening sockets. The \*initgroups()*\ function
29990is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they will be
29991used during message reception.
29992.nextp
29993A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its job
29994is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
29995.nextp
29996A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
29997but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
29998subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
29999deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
30000remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
30001subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
30002while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
30003generating bounce and warning messages.
30004
30005While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
30006process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
30007this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
30008gid. A system filter is run as root unless \system@_filter@_user\ is set.
30009.nextp
30010A process that is testing addresses (the \-bt-\ option) runs as root so that
30011the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
30012.endp
30013
30014
30015.section Running Exim without privilege
d43194df 30016.rset SECTrunexiwitpri "~~chapter.~~section"
495ae4b0
PH
30017.index privilege, running without
30018.index unprivileged running
30019.index root privilege||running without
30020Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
30021operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
30022by the global option \deliver@_drop@_privilege\. When this is set, the uid and
30023gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
30024(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
30025routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
30026to any other uid.
30027
30028Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ means
30029that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
30030correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
30031
30032An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
30033to the Exim group.
30034If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root process. (Calling
30035Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does when it is setuid
30036root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a SIGHUP signal because
30037it cannot regain privilege.
30038
30039It is still useful to set \deliver@_drop@_privilege\ in this case, because it
30040stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
30041been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
30042effect.
30043
d43194df
PH
30044If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if
30045.em
30046\mua@_wrapper\ is set, or
30047.nem
30048\*inetd*\ is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid to the
30049Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
495ae4b0
PH
30050
30051In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
30052those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
30053Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
30054that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
30055discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
30056have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
30057number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
30058address this problem at this time.
30059
30060For this reason, the recommended approach for `mostly unprivileged' running is
30061to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set \deliver@_drop@_privilege\.
30062This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to be used in the most
30063straightforward way.
30064
30065If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
30066number of restrictions on what you can do:
30067.numberpars $.
30068You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
30069\user\ and \group\ options to override routers or local transports that
30070normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
30071work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
30072explicit specification of another user causes an error.
30073.nextp
30074Use of \(.forward)\ files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
30075not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
30076.nextp
30077Users who wish to use \(.forward)\ would have to make their home directory and
30078the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
30079and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
30080enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
30081.nextp
30082Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
30083some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
30084.numberpars $*$
30085They must be owned by the Exim group and be writable by that group. This
30086implies you must set \mode\ in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
30087mode of the mailbox files themselves.
30088.nextp
30089You must set \no@_check@_owner\, since most or all of the files will not be
30090owned by the Exim user.
30091.nextp
30092You must set \file@_must@_exist\, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
30093on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
30094mailboxes need to be created manually.
30095.endp
30096.endp
30097These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
30098However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
30099gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting \deliver@_drop@_privilege\
30100gives more security at essentially no cost.
d43194df
PH
30101.em
30102If you are using the \mua@_wrapper\ facility (see chapter ~~CHAPnonqueueing),
30103\deliver@_drop@_privilege\ is forced to be true.
30104.nem
495ae4b0
PH
30105
30106
30107.section Delivering to local files
30108Full details of the checks applied by \%appendfile%\ before it writes to a file
30109are given in chapter ~~CHAPappendfile.
30110
30111
30112.section IPv4 source routing
30113.index source routing||in IP packets
30114.index IP source routing
30115Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
30116some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
30117IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
30118IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
30119
30120
30121.section The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP
30122Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
30123be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
30124
30125
30126
30127.section Privileged users
30128.index trusted user
30129.index admin user
30130.index privileged user
30131.index user||trusted
30132.index user||admin
30133Exim recognises two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
30134able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
30135addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
30136local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
30137permit a remote host to be specified.
30138
30139.index \-f-\ option
30140However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the \-f-\ command line option in
30141the special form \-f @<@>-\ to indicate that a delivery failure for the message
30142should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope, but it
30143does not affect the ::Sender:: header. Untrusted users may also be permitted to
30144use specific forms of address with the \-f-\ option by setting the
30145\untrusted@_set@_sender\ option.
30146
30147Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
30148other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
30149the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
30150as any user listed in the \trusted@_users\ configuration option, or under any
30151group listed in the \trusted@_groups\ option.
30152
30153Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
30154can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
30155them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
30156the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
30157includes the contents of files on the spool.
30158
30159.index \-M-\ option
30160.index \-q-\ option
30161By default, the use of the \-M-\ and \-q-\ options to cause Exim to attempt
30162delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
30163restriction can be relaxed by setting the \no@_prod@_requires@_admin\ option.
30164Similarly, the use of \-bp-\ (and its variants) to list the contents of the
30165queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
30166setting \no@_queue@_list@_requires@_admin\.
30167
30168Exim recognises an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
30169the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
30170the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
30171group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
30172the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
30173unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
30174files.
30175
30176
30177.section Spool files
30178.index spool directory||files
30179Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
30180set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
30181\(Local/Makefile)\ configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
30182any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
30183
30184
30185.section Use of argv[0]
30186Exim examines the last component of \argv[0]\, and if it matches one of a set
30187of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
30188with the last component of \argv[0]\ set to `rsmtp' is exactly equivalent to
30189calling it with the option \-bS-\. There are no security implications in this.
30190
30191
30192.section Use of %f formatting
30193The only use made of `%f' by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
30194are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
30195Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
30196converted output.
30197
30198
30199.section Embedded Exim path
30200Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
30201to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
30202does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
30203arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
30204
30205
30206.section Use of sprintf()
30207.index \*sprintf()*\
30208A large number of occurrences of `sprintf' in the code are actually calls to
30209\*string@_sprintf()*\, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
30210The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
30211that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
30212conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
30213
30214The remaining uses of \*sprintf()*\ happen in controlled circumstances where
30215the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
30216string.
30217
30218
30219.section Use of debug@_printf() and log@_write()
30220Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
30221formatting by calling the function \*string@_vformat()*\, which runs through
30222the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
30223
30224
30225.section Use of strcat() and strcpy()
30226These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
30227enough to hold the result.
30228
30229
30230
30231
30232.
30233.
30234.
30235.
30236. ============================================================================
30237.chapter Format of spool files
30238.set runningfoot "spool file format"
30239.rset CHAPspool ~~chapter
30240.index format||spool files
30241.index spool directory||format of files
30242.index spool||files, format of
30243.index spool||files, editing
30244A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
30245followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
30246the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
30247kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
30248two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
30249is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
30250themselves are recoverable.
30251
495ae4b0
PH
30252Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
30253need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
30254on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
30255.numberpars $.
30256You must use the \*exim@_lock*\ utility to ensure that Exim does not try to
30257deliver the message while you are fiddling with it. The lock is implemented
30258by opening the -D file and taking out a write lock on it. If you update the
30259file in place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename
30260it, the lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
30261.nextp
30262If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
30263\$body@_linecount$\, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect.
30264.nextp
30265If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
30266.nextp
4964e932 30267If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
495ae4b0
PH
30268signature.
30269.endp
495ae4b0
PH
30270
30271Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the \(input)\ directory (or
30272its subdirectories when \split@_spool@_directory\ is set). These are journal
30273files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
30274the course of a delivery run. At the end of the run, the -H file is updated,
30275and the -J file is deleted.
30276
30277.section Format of the -H file
30278.index uid (user id)||in spool file
30279.index gid (group id)||in spool file
30280The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
30281process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
30282gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
30283message. For a message received over TCP/IP, it is normally the Exim user.
30284
30285The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
30286transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
30287empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
30288in the \\MAIL\\ command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
30289created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
30290\qualify@_domain\. However, this can be overridden by the \-f-\ option or a
30291leading `From' line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
30292`@<@>' or an address that matches \untrusted@_set@_senders\.
30293
30294The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
30295was received, in the conventional Unix form -- the number of seconds since the
30296start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
30297warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
30298
30299There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
30300order, and are omitted when not relevant:
30301.numberpars $.
4964e932
PH
30302\-acl <<number>> <<length>>-\: A line of this form is present for every ACL
30303variable that is not empty. The number identifies the variable; the
30304\acl@_c\*x*\$$\ variables are numbered 0--9 and the \acl@_m\*x*\$$\ variables
30305are numbered 10--19. The length is the length of the data string for the
495ae4b0
PH
30306variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of the next line, and is
30307followed by a newline character. It may contain internal newlines.
30308.nextp
d43194df
PH
30309.em
30310\-active@_hostname <<hostname>>-\: This is present if, when the message was
30311received over SMTP, the value of \$smtp@_active@_hostname$\ was different to
30312the value of \$primary@_hostname$\.
30313.nem
30314.nextp
4964e932
PH
30315\-allow@_unqualified@_recipient-\: This is present if unqualified recipient
30316addresses are permitted in header lines (to stop such addresses from being
30317qualified if rewriting occurs at transport time). Local messages that were
30318input using \-bnq-\ and remote messages from hosts that match
495ae4b0
PH
30319\recipient@_unqualified@_hosts\ set this flag.
30320.nextp
4964e932
PH
30321\-allow@_unqualified@_sender-\: This is present if unqualified sender
30322addresses are permitted in header lines (to stop such addresses from being
30323qualified if rewriting occurs at transport time). Local messages that were
30324input using \-bnq-\ and remote messages from hosts that match
495ae4b0 30325\sender@_unqualified@_hosts\ set this flag.
495ae4b0
PH
30326.nextp
30327\-auth@_id <<text>>-\: The id information for a message received on an
30328authenticated SMTP connection -- the value of the \$authenticated@_id$\
30329variable.
30330.nextp
30331\-auth@_sender <<address>>-\: The address of an authenticated sender -- the
30332value of the \$authenticated@_sender$\ variable.
30333.nextp
30334\-body@_linecount <<number>>-\: This records the number of lines in the body of
30335the message, and is always present.
30336.nextp
d43194df
PH
30337.em
30338\-body@_zerocount <<number>>-\: This records the number of binary zero bytes in
30339the body of the message, and is present if the number is greater than zero.
30340.nem
30341.nextp
495ae4b0
PH
30342\-deliver@_firsttime-\: This is written when a new message is first added to
30343the spool. When the spool file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
30344.nextp
30345.index frozen messages||spool data
30346\-frozen <<time>>-\: The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at
30347<<time>>.
30348.nextp
30349\-helo@_name <<text>>-\: This records the host name as specified by a remote
30350host in a \\HELO\\ or \\EHLO\\ command.
30351.nextp
30352\-host@_address <<address>>.<<port>>-\: This records the IP address of the host
30353from which the message was received and the remote port number that was used.
30354It is omitted for locally generated messages.
30355.nextp
30356\-host@_auth <<text>>-\: If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP
30357connection, this records the name of the authenticator -- the value of the
30358\$sender@_host@_authenticated$\ variable.
30359.nextp
30360\-host@_lookup@_failed-\: This is present if an attempt to look up the sending
30361host's name from its IP address failed. It corresponds to the
30362\$host@_lookup@_failed$\ variable.
30363.nextp
30364.index DNS||reverse lookup
30365.index reverse DNS lookup
30366\-host@_name <<text>>-\: This records the name of the remote host from which
30367the message was received, if the host name was looked up from the IP address
30368when the message was being received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was
30369done.
30370.nextp
30371\-ident <<text>>-\: For locally submitted messages, this records the login of
30372the originating user, unless it was a trusted user and the \-oMt-\ option was
30373used to specify an ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records
30374the ident string supplied by the remote host, if any.
30375.nextp
30376\-interface@_address <<address>>.<<port>>-\: This records the IP address of the
30377local interface and the port number through which a message was received from a
30378remote host. It is omitted for locally generated messages.
30379.nextp
30380\-local-\: The message is from a local sender.
30381.nextp
30382\-localerror-\: The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
30383.nextp
30384\-local@_scan <<string>>-\: This records the data string that was
30385returned by the \*local@_scan()*\ function when the message was received -- the
30386value of the \$local@_scan@_data$\ variable. It is omitted if no data was
30387returned.
30388.nextp
30389\-manual@_thaw-\: The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is,
30390by an explicit Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
30391.nextp
30392\-N-\: A testing delivery process was started using the \-N-\ option to
30393suppress any actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further
30394delivery attempts, \-N-\ is assumed.
30395.nextp
30396\-received@_protocol-\: This records the value of the \$received@_protocol$\
30397variable, which contains the name of the protocol by which the message was
30398received.
30399.nextp
30400\-sender@_set@_untrusted-\: The envelope sender of this message was set by an
30401untrusted local caller (used to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue
30402listings).
30403.nextp
d43194df
PH
30404.em
30405\-spam@_score@_int-\: If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is
30406present. It records the value of \$spam@_score@_int$\.
30407.nem
30408.nextp
4964e932 30409\-tls@_certificate@_verified-\: A TLS certificate was received from the client
495ae4b0
PH
30410that sent this message, and the certificate was verified by the server.
30411.nextp
30412\-tls@_cipher <<cipher name>>-\: When the message was received over an
30413encrypted connection, this records the name of the cipher suite that was used.
30414.nextp
30415\-tls@_peerdn <<peer DN>>-\: When the message was received over an encrypted
30416connection, and a certificate was received from the client, this records the
30417Distinguished Name from that certificate.
30418.endp
30419
30420Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
30421is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
30422line when the \-t-\ option is used and \extract__addresses__remove__arguments\
30423is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
30424the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
30425balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
30426to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
30427original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
30428addresses are complete.
30429
30430If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
30431the text `XX'. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either Y
30432or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
30433tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
30434right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
30435follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
30436.display asis
30437YY darcy@austen.fict.example
30438NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
30439NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30440.endd
30441After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
30442This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
30443recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
30444delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
30445example:
30446.display asis
304474
30448editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30449darcy@austen.fict.example
30450rdo@foundation
30451alice@wonderland.fict.example
30452.endd
30453However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
30454result of the use of the \one@_time\ option on a \%redirect%\ router, each line
30455is of the following form:
30456.display
30457<<top-level address>> <<errors@_to address>> <<length>>,<<parent number>>@#<<flag bits>>
30458.endd
30459The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
30460the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
30461fields. The <<parent number>> is the offset in the recipients list of the
30462original parent of the `one time' address. The first two fields are the
30463envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
30464length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
30465characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a \%redirect%\ router
30466that has an \errors@_to\ setting.
30467
30468
30469A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
30470which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
30471when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
30472character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
30473embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
30474following:
30475.display
30476.tabs 9
30477<<blank>> $t $rm{header in which Exim has no special interest}
30478#B $t $rm{::Bcc:: header}
30479#C $t $rm{::Cc:: header}
30480#F $t $rm{::From:: header}
30481#I $t $rm{::Message-id:: header}
30482#P $t $rm{::Received:: header -- P for `postmark'}
30483#R $t $rm{::Reply-To:: header}
30484#S $t $rm{::Sender:: header}
30485#T $t $rm{::To:: header}
30486#* $t $rm{replaced or deleted header}
30487.endd
30488Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
30489purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
30490typical set of headers:
30491.display asis
30492111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
30493 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
30494049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
30495038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
30496042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
30497049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
30498099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
30499 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30500109T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.fict.example,
30501 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
30502038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
30503.endd
30504The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, ::From:: header, and
30505::To:: header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
30506unqualified domain \*foundation*\.
30507
30508.
30509.
30510.
30511.
30512. ============================================================================
30513.chapter Adding new drivers or lookup types
30514.set runningfoot "adding drivers"
30515.index adding drivers
30516.index new drivers, adding
30517.index drivers||adding new
30518The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
30519authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
30520.numberpars
30521Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
30522existing name; I will use `newdriver' in what follows.
30523.nextp
30524Add to \(src/EDITME)\ the line
30525.display
30526<<type>>@_NEWDRIVER=yes
30527.endd
30528where <<type>> is \\ROUTER\\, \\TRANSPORT\\, \\AUTH\\, or \\LOOKUP\\. If the
30529code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
30530should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
30531.nextp
30532Add to \(src/config.h.defaults)\ the line
30533.display
30534@#define <<type>>@_NEWDRIVER
30535.endd
30536.nextp
30537Edit \(src/drtables.c)\, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
30538and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
30539.nextp
30540Edit \(Makefile)\ in the appropriate sub-directory (\(src/routers)\,
30541\(src/transports)\, \(src/auths)\, or \(src/lookups)\); add a line for the new
30542driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
30543.nextp
30544Create \(newdriver.h)\ and \(newdriver.c)\ in the appropriate sub-directory of
30545\(src)\.
30546.nextp
30547Edit \(scripts/MakeLinks)\ and add commands to link the \(.h)\ and \(.c)\ files
30548as for other drivers and lookups.
30549.endp
30550Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
30551proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
30552occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
30553options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
30554searched using a binary chop procedure.
30555
30556There is a \(README)\ file in each of the sub-directories of \(src)\ describing
30557the interface that is expected.
30558
30559.
30560.
30561.
30562.
30563. ============================================================================
30564. Fudge for the index page number. We want it to be on a right-hand page.
30565.
30566.set indexpage ~~sys.pagenumber + 1
30567.if even ~~indexpage
30568.set indexpage ~~indexpage + 1
30569.fi
30570.if ~~sgcal
30571.%index Index$e~~indexpage--
30572.fi
30573.
30574.
30575. End of Exim specification